You are on page 1of 599

This book is dedicated

to Engineering Students
everywhere.
Especially mine.
Preface to the Electronic Edition
In the Spring of 2000, Brooks/Cole (the most recent publisher of record) declared Energy
Conversion out of print and returned the copyright to the author. Because of the
unavailability of the films used in the printing of the book, the author decided to develop an
electronic edition for the world-wide-web by revising a word processor draft to conform to
the published text, converting it to Adobe Acrobat pdf form, with minor modifications and
corrections where needed.
This electronic textbook is offered in anticipation of the day when students will carry all
of their texts and reference materials to class in a single electronic reader no larger than a
book of a few hundred pages. Such readers are available now and notebook computers
using the Acrobat reader could be used as such. It is in a spirit of conservation that the
author hopes that students and other users will download chapters from the internet as they
are needed and store them on their personal computers rather than printing them.
With the cooperation and assistance of Dr. Dale Schoenefeld and Ms. Janet Cairns of
the University of Tulsa, it was decided to provide the ebook from the university server. The
author very much appreciates their participation and that of the University in this effort. Dr.
Andrew Dykes again contributed to the updated Chapter 10; and my scholar-wife, Ruth,
proof-read the entire book and helped me to avoid a multitude of problems with the text. I
am, of course very grateful for their contributions to this non-profit venture.
As I used the printed text as an instructor, before retiring, and as I worked on the
electronic edition, I found a deeper appreciation of the quantity and quality of the efforts
expended by the production editor of the printed version, Tad W. Bornhoft, and his
associates. I came to admire and appreciate their work more and more. It was a job well-
done. Thank you all very much.
I am grateful to the instructors and students who have used Energy Conversion in the
past. It is for them and future scholars that I am attempting to make this work more readily
available. I hope that they find it useful and that it makes a pleasant and meaningful
contribution to engineering education.
Kenneth C. Weston
December 2000
Preface to the First Edition
A solid grounding in heat and power has long been a characteristic expected of mechanical
engineers. This text deals with energy conversion topics that should be well understood by
all mechanical engineers. It is intended for use in an introductory three-semester-hour
course in energy conversion, to follow first courses in thermodynamics and fluid mechanics
and, where possible, heat transfer. No attempt is made to treat electrical motors, generators,
and other conventional electric power equipment dealt with in electrical engineering power
courses. Rather, it focuses, in the first six chapters, on the three predominant thermal power
systems: the steam power plant, the gas turbine, and the reciprocating engine. These are
considered the mainstream energy converters in which all mechanical engineers should be
well grounded. The remaining five chapters provide a variety of choices for an instructor to
select to round out a three-hour junior or senior level course. While the latter chapters
depend on fundamentals appearing in the first six chapters as much as possible, they are
organized and written to be independent of each other, so that they may be used in almost
any order, or may be completely ignored.
It is the authors experience that many students have difficulty with the concepts of
thermodynamics and fail to grasp its importance and power. A course in energy conversion,
which applies the concepts of thermodynamics and introduces and analyzes the prime
energy conversion devices, can be an eye-opener to those students who need concrete
applications and are stimulated by them. At the same time, a good course in energy
conversion can motivate further study of thermodynamics and the other engineering
sciences.
A number of textbooks are available for the study of energy conversion. Most of these
books are best suited for advanced and graduate students because of an abundance of detail
that may distract the undergraduatefresh from first encounters with thermodynamics and
fluid mechanicsfrom the fundamentals, from the major thrusts of system behavior and
operation, and from engineering analysis. For this reason, the present text is an attempt at
user-friendliness, which trades excessive technical detail for a fuller and easier development
of mainline topics. Thus this text limits the amount of peripheral information presented and
focuses on topics of current importance and those likely to play a significant role in the
careers of the readers. It seeks to act as a convenient bridge between the engineering
sciences and advanced courses and, at the same time, provide a useful terminal course for
students pursuing other interests.
The approach taken is to provide a brief review of fundamentals from thermodynamics
and fluid mechanics and to immediately focus on an in-depth study of a major energy
conversion systemthe steam power planttogether with more advanced fundamentals
needed for its understanding and analysis. The premise is that a thorough understanding of a
major energy conversion system establishes a point of reference by which the student may
better appreciate and understand other systems. This is the major thrust of the first four
chapters. The first chapter is a brief review and introduction to the text. Instructors may
wish to assign the reading of Chapter 1 and a few problems for review at the first class
meeting, and then answer questions and proceed to the important material of Chapter 2 in
the second session.
Chapter 2 starts with the Rankine cycle and examines the important refinements of the
cycle, one at a time, culminating in the study of a typical cycle of a large modern steam
power plant. Sections of the chapter may be assigned at a pace consistent with the students
prior exposure to the Rankine cycle. The author usually assigns one or more problems at
each class and spends one class each on the basic cycle, reheat, efficiencies and pressure
losses, regeneration and feedwater heaters, combined mass conservation and First Law
analysis with heaters, and two classes on the study of the power plant flowsheet. At this
point the student should have the capability to interpret and analyze the flowsheet of any
steam power plant presented to him or her. This may be an appropriate time for a first
examination to assure that the attention of the student has focused on thermodynamic cycle
and system analysis fundamentals before considering the basics of Rankine cycle
implementation.
With a good grasp of the cycles of steam power plants in hand, it is appropriate for the
student to study some of the fundamentals of fuels and combustion in order to proceed
further in understanding steam plant design and operation and to prepare him or her for
later chapters. Thus the student should be easily motivated to the study of fuels and
combustion in Chapter 3. To the extent that this and the preceding chapter are review for
the student, the pace of coverage may be adjusted by the instructor in reading and problem
assignments and class discussions.
Chapter 4 completes the study of conventional steam power generation by following
and analyzing the major flows in a steam plant: water, fuel, and gases, placing emphasis on
the hardware and systems involved in these flows. A brief introduction to the fundamentals
of engineering economy is included in this chapter, so that financial aspects of power plant
operation may be considered. The latter material is not intended to replace a course in
engineering economy. Instead, it provides basic information that may appear too late in
some curricula for use in a junior-level energy conversion course. Chapter 4 concludes with
a back-of-the-envelope type analysis of plant characteristics, which provides the student
with an overview of the magnitudes of parameters associated with large steam plant
operation and with an opportunity to reflect on the roles of thermodynamics, economics,
and analysis in the plant design.
The succeeding chapters provide opportunities to show the universality of many of the
fundamentals and methods presented in the first four. The fifth chapter treats the important
and exciting topics of gas turbines and jet propulsion. The characteristics of stationary gas
turbines are studied and contrasted. The jet engine is studied as a form of gas turbine with
special design and performance characteristics. Care is taken to provide the student with a
conceptual understanding of the basic machine before delving into detailed analysis and
alternate configurations. Advanced topics such as combined cycles, cogeneration, steam
injection, polytropic efficiencies, and turbofan engines are deferred to Chapter 9, for those
instructors who prefer not to treat these topics in an introductory energy conversion course.
As in other chapters, the instructor is largely in control of the level of the presentation
by the choice and the pace of the assignments that he or she makes. One or several text
sections may be assigned per class meeting, along with problems of appropriate number and
difficulty for the students. At the end of Chapter 5, the instructor may wish to assign the
development of a computer program or a spreadsheet for gas turbine analysis, or the use of
an existing program or spreadsheet for optimization of a configuration for a given
application, or for a preliminary design study of a gas turbine or steam plant. Although
combined gas turbine and steam cycles are not considered until Chapter 9, some instructors
may wish to deal with them at this point, and perhaps assign a design problem.
Chapter 6 considers the phenomena and characteristics of the reciprocating engine and
the engineering parameters describing its performance. The chapter develops and compares
models of both Otto and Diesel cycles and explores some of the fundamental problems and
aspects of their implementation in working engines. Chapter 7 complements Chapter 6 by
providing a brief look at the Wankel rotary engine. While not a major player in energy
conversion at this time, the rotary engine offers a unique opportunity for students to analyze
and understand an entirely different, successful, and intriguing implementation of the Otto
cycle. For those instructors wishing to substitute other materials, Chapter 7 may be omitted
without concern for student comprehension of the remainder of the book.
While refrigeration and air conditioning are not power generation technologies, they
clearly involve energy conversion in important ways and represent an important mechanical
engineering discipline. Chapter 8 briefly considers the fundamentals and hardware of this
field briefly, giving a framework within which HVAC engineering may be understood and
upon which engineering analyses may be built. The important topic of the analysis of moist
air is introduced by treating moist air as a binary mixture of ideal gases and carried to the
point where the student is introduced to HVAC system design using the psychrometric
chart.
Chapter 9 considers some of the important technological problems of the day and a
selected collection of advanced energy conversion techniques that mechanical engineers use
to deal with them. The treatments of most of these technologies are largely independent of
each other, so that instructors may elect to use either the entire chapter or only those
advanced topics that they consider most appropriate for their course. A notable exception is
that the presentation on turbofans considers using either isentropic or polytropic
efficiencies. It is recommended to cover the preceding section on polytropic efficiency
before proceeding to turbofans. It is hoped that the study of this chapter will motivate
students to investigate the selected topics in greater detail, aided by the bibliography.
Instructors may wish at this point to assign more in-depth study using the library on one of
these topics or on other advanced systems.
Certainly, nuclear power is controversial. While the development of new nuclear fission
plants in the United States is currently dormant, the subject remains important and is likely
to become more important to mechanical engineers in the future. Some texts devote a great
deal of space to nuclear power while others do not choose to treat it at all. The decision
here was to take the middle ground, to provide a survey that allows mechanical engineers to
place the subject in perspective with respect to other major energy conversion technologies.
Chapter 10 thus focuses on relevant aspects of nuclear fission power without going into
nuclear reactor physics and design in detail. The chapter may be studied at any time after
the first four chapters on steam power, or may be omitted completely if the instructor
desires.
The final chapter offers vistas on a number of promising technologies, some of which
avoid the heat engine approach that dominates todays modern power and propulsion
systems. An introduction to electrical energy storage-battery technology provides a lead-in
to fuel-cell energy conversion, now under intensive development as a flexible solution to a
diversity of electrical power generation problems. Magnetohydrodynamics (MHD) is
considered as a means of producing electricity directly from a hot fluid without the use of a
turbine. The inspiration of the sun as a massive and eternal energy source continues to drive
interest in solar energy, spurred by the success of small-scale photovoltaic conversion in
watches and calculators, and of remote power applications. The chapter closes with a brief
consideration of the use of hydrogen as a secondary energy source and the transition to a
steady-state energy system.
A course in energy conversion may serve as a terminal course in the thermal-fluids-
energy stem for those students pursuing other disciplinary interests. These students emerge
with an appreciation of the purposes and methods of thermodynamics, of engineering
hardware, and of important segments of industry. For others, the course may serve as a
motivating lead-in to electives such as advanced thermodynamics, advanced fluids and heat
transfer, refrigeration and air conditioning, solar energy, turbomachinery, gas turbines, and
propulsion. At the University of Tulsa the course is offered to sixth semester students,
allowing elective studies in the seventh and eighth semesters.
The goal of this book is to provide a lucid learning tool for good students who may feel
insecure in their understanding of the engineering sciences and their uses. An effort is made
to tie theory, concepts, and techniques to earlier courses, which may not have been
mastered. A special effort is made also to help the student become familiar with and
appreciate the important hardware associated with energy conversion, through the
presentation of numerous photographs and diagrams. The author hopes that this study of
energy conversion will not only prepare the student for work in this field but will also
provide motivation for further study of the engineering sciences because their usefulness in
design and analysis is better appreciated.
Numerous examples are provided in the text in connection with the more important
topics. Photographs and schematic diagrams of modern equipment are included to aid the
student in hardware visualization. Students should be encouraged to study these carefully as
the useful learning tools that they are. As a further guide and aid to the student, terms which
should be part of his or her vocabulary are italicized. Many acronyms and abbreviations are
used in energy conversion as in other fields of endeavor. There is no point in delaying the
inevitable. They are used sparingly but where appropriate in the text and are identified in
their first occurrence and in the list of symbols.
We are in the midst of a protracted transition from one system of engineering units, the
English system, to an international system, the Systeme International dUnites, usually
called SI. It is essential that this and other texts provide experience in using both; therefore,
an effort has been made to provide discussions and problems expressed in both the SI and
English systems.
The importance of units, not only as a tool of communication, but as an analytic tool
warrants repeated emphasis. Using units for dimensional analysis may often be the
difference between obtaining a correct problem solution and falling into quantitative error.
To emphasize the importance of units, equations in the text appear with the units of the
dependent variable in both English and SI forms in brackets, as for example in the units of
specific energy: [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg]. When an expression is dimensionless that fact is indicated
by [dl] following the equation.
The personal computer has become a valuable tool for practicing engineers and should
be used by engineering students at every appropriate opportunity. The author has found
spreadsheets to be particularly useful in a variety of activities including energy conversion.
Spreadsheets are provided for the example problems presented in spreadsheet format in the
text. This allows students to examine these calculations in as much detail as they wish, to
conveniently repeat the calculations for alternate inputs, and to substitute alternate
calculation details. Thus instructors may conveniently assign what if studies in these
cases. A spreadsheet of data extracted from the JANAF tables is included to allow easy
flame temperature and heat transfer calculations in connection with Chapter 3. While the
spreadsheets were developed using Quattro Pro, the examples are provided in the WK3
format, so that they may be used with any spreadsheet that is compatible with this popular
Lotus 1-2-3 format.
Those unfamiliar with spreadsheets will find that a few hours with a modern
spreadsheet and a good tutorial will enable its use in powerful ways. One of the
characteristics of spreadsheets is that the new user can usually start solving problems at the
first sitting. After using the tutorial, the new user should pick a modest problem of current
interest to solve, or try a few problems that were previously completed by hand. It is wise
for new users to select a spreadsheet that is widely used in their university or company or by
their friends, so that it will be easy to exchange information with and learn from others.
During the years of preparation of this book, many friends, colleagues, reviewers, and
students have made constructive suggestions and offered ideas and encouragement. They
are too numerous to thank individually here. It is, nevertheless, appropriate to express my
appreciation to them and to acknowledge their invaluable contributions. It is particularly
fitting, however, to recognize the special contributions of friend and colleague, Dr. Andrew
A. Dykes, for both his insightful critique of the first draft and his substantive and continuing
contributions to Chapter 10. Some of his expertise is written into the pages of that chapter;
any deficiencies there are mine. I am greatly indebted also to industry for providing many of
the photographs and illustrations that the reader will find in these pages. Sources are
identified with the figures. Finally, I must acknowledge the patience and support of my
family and the administration, faculty, and staff of the University of Tulsa, who helped ease
the pain and maximize the joys associated with the preparation of this work.
1
C H A P T E R O N E
FUNDAMENTALS OF
ENERGY CONVERSION
1.1 Introduction

Energy conversion engineering (or heat-power engineering, as it was called prior to the
Second World War), has been one of the central themes in the development of the
engineering profession. It is concerned with the transformation of energy from sources
such as fossil and nuclear fuels and the sun into conveniently used forms such as
electrical energy, rotational and propulsive energy, and heating and cooling.
A multitude of choices and challenges face the modern energy conversion
engineer. A few years ago major segments of the energy conversion industry were
settled into a pattern of slow innovation. Most automobile manufacturers were satisfied
to manufacture engines that had evolved from those produced twenty years earlier,
some of which boasted 400 horsepower and consumed a gallon of leaded gasolene
every eight or nine miles. Many electric power utilities were content with state-of-the-
art, reliable, fossil-fuel-consuming steam power plants, except for a few
forward-looking, and in several cases unfortunate, exceptions that risked the nuclear
alternative.
Then came the oil embargo of the 1970s, high fuel prices, and threatened
shortages. Also, the public and legislatures began to recognize that air pollution
produced by factories, power plants, and automobiles and other forms of environmental
pollution were harmful. International competitors, producing quality automobiles with
smaller, lower-pollution engines, exceptional gas mileage, and lower prices shook the
automobile industry. The limitations of the Earth's resources and environment started
to come into clearer focus. These and other influences have been helping to create a
more favorable climate for consideration, if not total acceptance, of energy conversion
alternatives and new concepts.
There are opposing factors, however. Among them are limited research and
development funding due to budgetary constraints, emphasis on short-term rather than
long-term goals because of entrepreneurial insistence on rapid payback on investment,
and managerial obsession with the bottom line. But more open attitudes have become
established. New as well as previously shelved ideas are now being considered or
reconsidered, tested, and sometimes implemented. A few examples are combined
steam and gas turbine cycles, rotary combustion engines, solar and windmill power
farms, stationary and vehicular gas turbine power plants, cogeneration, photovoltaic
solar power, refuse-derived fuel, stratified charge engines, turbocharged engines,
fluidized-bed combustors, and coal-gasification power plants. We are living in a
2
rapidly changing world that requires continuing adaptation of old technologies and the
development of new ones. Energy conversion engineering is a more stimulating,
complex, and viable field today because of this altered climate.
A Look Backward
How did we get where we are today? A good answer requires a study of the history of
science and engineering worthy of many volumes. Table 1.1 identifies a few pivotal
ideas and inventions, some of them landmarks to energy conversion engineers, and the
names of the thinkers and movers associated with them. Of course, the table cannot
present the entire history of energy conversion engineering. Omitted are the
contributions of Newton and Euler, the first rocket engine, the V-8 engine, the ramjet
and fanjet. The reader could easily come up with many other glaring omissions and
extend the table indefinitely.
While the names of one or two persons are associated with each landmark
achievement, most of these landmarks were the products of teams of unheralded
individuals whose talents were crucial to success. Moreover, the successes did not
occur in a vacuum, but benefited and followed from the advances and failures of others.
Unknown or renowned, each engineer and his or her associates can make a contribution
to the progress of mankind.
Table 1.1 can only hint at how the persons, ideas, and events listed there relied on
their predecessors and on a host of less well-known scientific and technological
advances. A brief bibliography of historical sources is given at the end of the chapter.
These works chronicle the efforts of famous and unsung heroes, and a few villains, of
energy conversion and their struggles with ideas and limiting tools and resources to
produce machines for man and industry.
The historical progress of industry and technology was slow until the fundamentals
of thermodynamics and electromagnetism were established in the ninteenth century.
The blossoming of energy technology and its central role in the industrial revolution is
well known to all students of history. It is also abundantly clear that the development of
nuclear power in the second half of the twentieth century grew from theoretical and
experimental scientific advances of the first half century. After a little reflection on
Table 1.1, there should be no further need to justify a fundamental scientific and
mathematical approach to energy conversion engineering.
TABLE 1-1 Some Significant Events in the History of Energy Conversion
___________________________________________________________________________
Giovanni Branca Impulse steam turbine proposal 1629
Thomas Newcomen Atmospheric engine using steam (first widely used 1700
Heat engine)
James Watt Separate steam condenser idea; 1765
and first Boulton and Watt condensing steam engine 1775
3
Table 1.1 (continued)
___________________________________________________________________________
John Barber Gas turbine ideas and patent 1791
Benjamin Thompson Observed conversion of mechanical energy 1798
(Count Rumford) to heat while boring cannon
Robert Fulton First commercial steamboat 1807
Robert Stirling Stirling engine 1816
N. L. Sadi Carnot Principles for an ideal heat engine 1824
(foundations of thermodynamics)
Michael Faraday First electric current generator 1831
Robert Mayer Equivalence of heat and work 1842
James Joule Basic ideas of the First Law of Thermodynamics; 1847
and measured the mechanical equivalent of heat 1849
Rudolph Clausius Second Law of Thermodynamics 1850
William Thompson Alternate form of the Second Law of 1851
(Lord Kelvin) Thermodynamics
Etienne Lenoir Internal combustion engine without
without mechanical compression 1860
A. Beau de Rochas Four-stroke cycle internal combustion engine concept 1862
James C. Maxwell Mathematical principles of electromagnetics 1865

Niklaus Otto Four-stroke cycle internal combustion engine 1876
Charles Parsons Multistage, axial-flow reaction steam turbine 1884
Thomas Edison Pearl Street steam-engine-driven electrical power plant 1884
C.G.P. de Laval Impulse steam turbine with convergent-divergent nozzle 1889
Rudolph Diesel Compression ignition engine 1892
___ First hydroelectric power at Niagara Falls 1895
Albert Einstein Mass-energy equivalence 1905
Ernst Schrodinger Quantum wave mechanics 1926
Frank Whittle Turbojet engine patent application; 1930
and first jet engine static test 1937
4
Table 1.1 (concluded)
___________________________________________________________________________
Otto Hahn Discovery of nuclear fission 1938
Hans von Ohain First turbojet engine flight 1939
J. Ackeret, C. Keller Closed-cycle gas turbine electric power generation 1939
Enrico Fermi Nuclear fission demonstration at the University of Chicago 1942
Felix Wankel Rotary internal combustion engine 1954
Production of electricity via nuclear fission by a utility 1957
at Shippingport, Pennsylvania .

NASA Rocket-powered landing of man on the moon 1969
Electricit de France Superphnix 1200-MW fast breeder reactor first 1986
grid power
________________________________________________________________
Since energy conversion engineering is deeply rooted in thermodynamics, fluid
mechanics, and heat transfer, this chapter briefly reviews those aspects of these
disciplines that are necessary for understanding, analysis, and design in the field of
energy conversion.
1.2 Fundamentals of Thermodynamics
The subject of thermodynamics stems from the notions of temperature, heat, and work.
Although, the following discussion makes occasional reference to molecules and
particles, useful in clarifying and motivating concepts in thermodynamics,
thermodynamics as a science deals with matter as continuous rather than as discrete or
granular.

System, Surroundings, and Universe
We define a pure substance as a homogeneous collection of matter. Consider a fixed
mass of a pure substance bounded by a closed, impenetrable, flexible surface. Such a
mass, called a system, is depicted schematically in Figure 1.1(a). For example, the
system could be a collection of molecules of water, air, refrigerant, or combustion gas
confined in a closed container such as the boundary formed by a cylinder and a fitted
piston, Figure 1.1 (b). A system should always be defined carefully, to ensure that the
same particles are in the system at all times. All other matter which can interact with the
system is called the surroundings. The combination of the system and the surroundings
is termed the universe, used here not in a cosmological sense, but to include only the
5
system and all matter which could interact with the system. Thermodynamics and
energy conversion are concerned with changes in the system and in its interactions with
the surroundings.
State
The mass contained within a system can exist in a variety of conditions call states.
Qualitatively, the concept of state is familiar. For example, the system state of a
gasmight be described qualitatively by saying that the system is at a high temperature
and a low pressure. Values of temperature and pressure are characteristics that identify
a particular condition of the system. Thus a unique condition of the system is called a
state.
Thermodynamic Equilibrium
A system is said to be in thermodynamic equilibrium if, over a long period of time, no
change in the character or state of the system is observed.
6
Thermodynamic Properties
It is a fundamental assumption of thermodynamics that a state of thermodynamic
equilibrium of a given system may be described by a few observable characteristics
called thermodynamic properties, such as pressure, temperature, and volume.
Obviously, this approach excludes the possibility of description of the condition of the
molecules of the system, a concern that is left to the fields of statistical and quantum
mechanics and kinetic theory. Nevertheless, it is frequently useful to think of
thermodynamic phenomena in molecular terms.
The Temperature Property. Temperature is a measure of the vigor of the molecular
activity of a system. How can it be observed? A thermometer measures a system
property called temperature when it is in intimate and prolonged contact
(thermodynamic equilibrium) with the system. A mercury-in-glass thermometer, for
instance, functions by thermal expansion or contraction of mercury within a glass bulb.
The bulb must be in intimate thermal contact with the observed system so that the
temperatures of the bulb and the system are the same. As a result of the equilibrium,
elongation or contraction of a narrow column of mercury connected to the bulb
indicates the temperature change of the system with which it is in contact.
The Pressure Property. Another way to observe changes in the state of a liquid or
gaseous system is to connect a manometer to the system and observe the level of the
free surface of the manometer fluid . The manometer free surface rises or drops as the
force per unit area or pressure acting on the manometer-system interface changes.
Defining a State
It has been empirically observed that an equilibrium state of a system containing a
single phase of a pure substance is defined by two thermodynamic properties. Thus, if
we observe the temperature and pressure of such a system, we can identify when the
system is in a particular thermodynamic state.
Extensive and Intensive properties
Properties that are dependent on mass are known as extensive properties. For these
properties that indicate quantity, a given property is the sum of the the corresponding
properties of the subsystems comprising the system. Examples are internal energy and
volume. Thus, adding the internal energies and volumes of subsystems yields the
internal energy and the volume of the system, respectively.
In contrast, properties that may vary from point to point and that do not change
with the mass of the system are called intensive properties. Temperature and pressure
are well-known examples. For instance, thermometers at different locations in a system
may indicate differing temperatures. But if a system is in equilibrium, the temperatures
7
of all its subsystems must be identical and equal to the temperature of the system. Thus,
a system has a single, unique temperature only when it is at equilibrium.
Work
From basic mechanics, work, W, is defined as the energy provided by an entity that
exerts a force, F, in moving one or more particles through a distance, x. Thus work
must be done by an external agent to decrease the volume, V, of a system of molecules.
In the familiar piston-cylinder arrangement shown in Figure 1.1(b), an infinitesimal
volume change of the system due to the motion of the piston is related to the
differential work through the force-distance product:
dW = Fdx = pAdx = pdV [ft-lb
f
| n-m] (1.1a)
or
dw = pdv [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (1.1b)
where p is the system pressure, and A is the piston cross-sectional area.
Note that in Equation (1.1b), the lower case letters w and v denote work and
volume on a unit mass basis. All extensive properties, i.e., those properties of state that
are proportional to mass, are denoted by lowercase characters when on a unit mass
basis. These are called specific properties. Thus, if V represents volume, then v denotes
specific volume. Although work is not a property of state, it is dealt with in the same
way.
Also note that the English units of energy in Equation (1.1a) are given in
mechanical units. Alternately, the British Thermal unit [Btu] may be used, as in
Equation (1.1b). The two sets of units are related by the famous conversion factor
known as the mechanical equivalent of heat, 778 ft-lb
f
/Btu. The student should pay
close attention to the consistency of units in all calculations. Conversion factors are
frequently required and are not explicitly included in many equations. For the
convenience of the reader, Appendix A lists physical constants and conversion factors.
When work decreases the volume of a system, the molecules of the system move
closer together. The moving molecules then collide more frequently with each other
and with the walls of their container. As a result, the average forces (and hence
pressures) on the system boundaries increase. Thus the state of the system may be
changed by work done on the system.
Heat
Given a system immersed in a container of hot fluid, by virtue of a difference in
temperature between the system and the surrounding fluid, energy passes from the fluid
to the system. We say that heat, Q [Btu | kJ], is transferred to the system. The system is
8
observed to increase in temperature or to change phase or both. Thus heat transfer to
or from the system, like work, can also change the state of the matter within the
system.
When the system and the surrounding fluid are at the same temperature, no heat
is transferred. In this case the system and surroundings are said to be in thermal
equilibrium. The term adiabatic is used to designate a system in which no heat crosses
the system boundaries. A system is often approximated as an adiabatic system if it is
well insulated.
Heat and Work Are Not Properties
Mechanics teaches that work can change the kinetic energy of mass and can change the
elevation or potential energy of mass in a gravitational field. Thus work performed by
an outside agent on the system boundary can change the energy associated with the
particles that make up the system. Likewise, heat is energy crossing the boundary of a
system, increasing or decreasing the energy of the molecules within. Thus heat and
work are not properties of state but forms of energy that are transported across system
boundaries to or from the environment. They are sometimes referred to as energy in
transit. Energy conversion engineering is vitally concerned with devices that use and
create energy in transit.
Internal Energy and The First Law of Thermodynamics
A property of a system that reflects the energy of the molecules of the system is called
the internal energy, U. The Law of Conservation of Energy states that energy can be
neither created nor destroyed. Thus the internal energy of a system can change only
when energy crosses a boundary of the system, i.e., when heat and/or work interact
with the system. This is expressed in an equation known as the First Law of
Thermodynamics. In differential form the First Law is:
du = dq dw [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (1.2)
Here, u is the internal energy per unit mass, a property of state, and q and w are,
respectively, heat and work per unit mass. The differentials indicate infinitesimal
changes in quantity of each energy form. Here, we adopt the common sign convention
of thermodynamics that both the heat entering the system and work done by the system
are positive. This convention will be maintained throughout the text. Thus Equation
(1.2) shows that heat into the system (positive) and work done on the system (negative)
both increase the systems internal energy.
Cyclic Process
A special and important form of the First Law of Thermodynamics is obtained by
9
integration of Equation (1.2) for a cyclic process. If a system, after undergoing
arbitrary change due to heat and work, returns to its initial state, it is said to have
participated in a cyclic process. The key points are: (1) the integral of any state
property differential is the difference of its limits, and (2) the final state is the same as
the initial state (hence there is no change in internal energy of the system)
du = u
f
u
i
= 0
where the special integral sign indicates integration over a single cycle and subscripts i
and f designate, respectively, initial and final states. As a consequence, the integration
of Equation (1.2) for a cycle yields:
dq = dw [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (1.3)
This states that the integral of all transfers of heat into the system, taking into account
the sign convention, is the integral of all work done by the system. The latter is the net
work of the system. The integrals in Equation (1.3) may be replaced by summations for
a cyclic process that involves a finite number of heat and work terms. Because many
heat engines operate in cyclic processes, it is sometimes convenient to evaluate the net
work of a cycle using Equation (1.3) with heat additions and losses rather than using
work directly.
Arbitrary Process of a System
Another important form of the First Law of Thermodynamics is the integral of
Equation (1.2) for an arbitrary process involving a system:
q = u
f
u
i
+ w [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (1.4)
where q and w are, respectively, the net heat transferred and net work for the process,
and u
f
and u
i
are the final and initial values of the internal energy. Equation (1.4), like
Equation (1.2), shows that a system that is rigid (w = 0) and adiabatic (q = 0) has an
unchanging internal energy. It also shows, like Equation (1.3), that for a cyclic process
the heat transferred must equal the work done.
Reversibility and Irreversibility
If a system undergoes a process in which temperature and pressure gradients are always
small, the process may be thought of as a sequence of near-equilibrium states. If each of
the states can be restored in reverse sequence, the process is said to be internally
reversible. If the environmental changes accompanying the process can also be reversed
in sequence, the process is called externally reversible. Thus, a reversible process is
10
one that is both internally and externally reversible. The reversible process becomes
both a standard by which we measure the success of real processes in avoiding losses
and a tool that we can use to derive thermodynamic relations that approximate reality.
All real processes fail to satisfy the requirements for reversibility and are therefore
irreversible. Irreversibility occurs due to temperature, pressure, composition, and
velocity gradients caused by heat transfer, solid and fluid friction, chemical reaction,
and high rates of work applied to the system. An engineers job frequently entails
efforts to reduce irreversibility in machines and processes.
Entropy and Enthalpy
Entropy and enthalpy are thermodynamic properties that, like internal energy, usually
appear in the form of differences between initial and final values. The entropy change of
a system, s [Btu/lb
m
-R | kJ/kg-K], is defined as the integral of the ratio of the system
differential heat transfer to the absolute temperature for a reversible thermodynamic
path, that is, a path consisting of a sequence of well-defined thermodynamic states. In
differential form this is equivalent to:
ds = dq
rev
/T [Btu/lb
m
-R | kJ/kg-K] (1.5)
where the subscript rev denotes that the heat transfer must be evaluated along a
reversible path made up of a sequence of neighboring thermodynamic states. It is
implied that, for such a path, the system may be returned to its condition before the
process took place by traversing the states in the reverse order.
An important example of the use of Equation (1.5) considers a thermodynamic cycle
composed of reversible processes. The cyclic integral, Equation (1.3), may then be used
to show that the net work of the cycle is:
w
n
= dq = Tds [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg]
This shows that the area enclosed by a plot of a reversible cyclic process on a
temperature-entropy diagram is the net work of the cycle.

The enthalpy, h, is a property of state defined in terms of other properties:
h = u + pv [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (1.6)
where h, u and v are, respectively, the system specific enthalpy, specific internal
energy, and specific volume, and p is the pressure.
11
Two other important forms of the First Law make use of these properties.
Substitution of Equations (1.1) and (1.5) in Equation (1.2) yields, for a reversible
process

Tds = du + pdv [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (1.7)
and differentiation of Equation (1.6), combined with elimination of du in Equation
(1.7), gives
Tds = dh - vdp [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (1.8)
Equations (1.7) and (1.8) may be regarded as relating changes in entropy for reversible
processes to changes in internal energy and volume in the former and to changes in
enthalpy and pressure in the latter. The fact that all quantities in these equations are
properties of state implies that entropy must also be a thermodynamic property.
Because entropy is a state property, the entropy change between two equilibrium
states of a system is the same for all processes connecting them, reversible or
irreversible. Figure 1.2 depicts several such processes 1-a-b-c-2, 1-d-2, and a sequence
of nonequilibrium states not describable in thermodynamic terms indicated by the
dashed line (an irreversible path). To use Equation (1.5) directly or as in Equations
(1.7) and (1.8), a reversible path must be employed. Because of the path independence
of state property changes, any reversible path will do. Thus the entropy change, s
2
s
1
,
12
may be evaluated by application of Equations (1.5), (1.7), or (1.8) to either of the
reversible paths shown in Figure 1.2 or to any other reversible path connecting states 1
and 2.
The Second Law of Thermodynamics
While Equation (1.5) may be used to determine the entropy change of a system, the
Second Law of Thermodynamics, is concerned with the entropy change of the universe,
i.e., of both the system and the surroundings. Because entropy is an extensive property,
the entropy of a system is the sum of the entropy of its parts. Applying this to the
universe, the entropy of the universe is the sum of the entropy of the system and its
surroundings. The Second Law may be stated as "The entropy change of the universe is
non-negative":
S
univ
0 [Btu/R | kJ/K] (1.9)
Note that the entropy change of a system may be negative (entropy decrease) if the
entropy change of its environment is positive (entropy increase) and sufficiently large
that inequality (1.9) is satisfied.
As an example: if the system is cooled, heat is transferred from the system. The
heat flow is therefore negative, according to sign convention. Then, according to
Equation (1.5), the system entropy change will also be negative; that is, the system
entropy will decrease. The associated heat flow, however, is into the environment,
hence positive with respect to the environment (considered as a system). Then Equation
(1.5) requires that the environmental entropy change must be positive. The Second Law
implies that, for the combined process to be possible, the environmental entropy change
must exceed the magnitude of the system entropy change.
The First Law of Thermodynamics deals with how the transfer of heat influences
the system internal energy but says nothing about the nature of the heat transfer, i.e.,
whether the heat is transferred from hotter or colder surroundings. Experience tells us
that the environment must be hotter to transfer heat to a cooler object, but the First
Law is indifferent to the condition of the heat source. However, calculation of the
entropy change for heat transfer from a cold body to a hot body yields a negative
universe entropy change, violates the Second Law, and is therefore impossible. Thus
the Second Law provides a way to distinguish between real and impossible processes.
This is demonstrated in the following example:
EXAMPLE 1.1
(a) Calculate the entropy change of an infinite sink at 27C temperature due to heat
transfer into the sink of 1000 kJ.
(b) Calculate the entropy change of an infinite source at 127C losing the same amount
of heat.
13
(c) What is the entropy change of the universe if the aforementioned source supplies
1000 kJ to the sink with no other exchanges?
(d) What are the entropy changes if the direction of heat flow is reversed and the
source becomes the sink?
Solution
(a) Because the sink temperature is constant, Equation (1.5) shows that the entropy
change of the sink is the heat transferred reversibly divided by the absolute temperature
of the sink. This reversible process may be visualized as one in which heat is transferred
from a source which is infinitesimally hotter than the system:
S
sink
= 1000/(273 + 27) = + 3.333 kJ/K.
(b) Treating the source in the same way:
S
source
= 1000/(273 + 127) = 2.5 kJ/K.
(c) Because the entropy change of the universe is the sum of the entropy changes of
source and sink, the two acting together to transfer 1000kJ irreversibly give:
S
universe
= 3.333 2.5 = +0.833 kJ/K > 0
which satisfies the Second Law inequality (1.9).
(d) A similar approach with the direction of heat flow reversed, taking care to observe
the sign convention, gives
S
sink
= ( 1000 )/(273 + 27) = 3.333 kJ/K
S
source
= (1000)/(273 + 127) = + 2.555 kJ
S
univ
= 3.333 + 2.5 = 0.833 kJ/K.
Thus we see that heat flow from a low to a high temperature reduces the entropy of the
universe, violates the Second Law, and therefore is not possible.
____________________________________________________________________
Parts a, b, and c of Example 1.1 show that the entropy change of the universe depends
on the temperature difference driving the heat transfer process:
S
univ
= Q(1/T
sink
1/ T
source
) = Q( T
source
T
sink
) / T
source
T
sink
Note that if the temperature difference is zero, the universe entropy change is also zero
and the heat transfer is reversible. For finite positive temperature differences, S
univ

14
exceeds zero and the process is ireversible. As the temperature difference increases,
S
univ
increases. This exemplifies the fact that the entropy change of the universe
produced by a process is a measure of the irreversibility of the process.
For an isolated system, there is no change in the entropy of the surroundings.
Hence the system entropy change is the entropy change of the universe and therefore
must be non-negative. In other words, the entropy of an isolated system can only
increase or at best stay constant.
1.3 Control Volumes and Steady Flows
In many engineering problems it is preferrable to deal with a flow of fluid particles as
they pass through a given region of space rather than following the flow of a fixed
collection of particles. Thus, putting aside the system concept (fixed collection) for the
moment, consider a volume with well-defined spatial boundaries as shown in Figure
1-3. This is called a control volume. Mass at state 1 enters at a rate m
1
and leaves at
state 2 with mass flow m
2
. If one mass flow rate exceeds the other, mass either
accumulates in the volume or is depleted. The important special case of steady flow, in
which no accumulation or depletion of mass occurs in the control volume, is considered
here. In steady flow, the conservation of mass requires equal mass flows in and out, i.e.,
m
1
= m
2
, [lb
m
/s, | kg /s].
If Q-dot is the rate of heat flow into the control volume and W-dot is the rate at
which shaft work is delivered from the control volume to the surroundings,
conservation of energy requires that the excess of inflowing heat over outgoing work
equal the net excess of the energy (enthalpy) flowing out of the ports, i.e.,
[Btu/s | kJ/s] (1.10)
15
where summations apply to inflows i and outflows o, and where other types of energy
terms, such as kinetic and potential energy flows, are assumed negligible. For clarity,
the figure shows only one port in and one port out. Kinetic and potential energy terms
may be added analogous to the enthalpy termsat each port, if needed.
Equation (1.10) may be the most important and frequently used equation in this
book. Mastery of its use is therefore essential. It is known as the steady flow form of
the First Law of Thermodynamics. It may be thought of as a bookkeeping relation for
keeping track of energy crossing the boundaries of the control volume.
The Second Law of Thermodynamics applied to steady flow through an adiabatic
control volume requires that m
2
s
2
m
1
s
1,
or by virtue of mass conservation:
s
2
s
1
[Btu/lb
m
-R | kJ/kg-K] (1.11)
That is, because entropy cannot accumulate within the control volume in a steady flow,
the exit entropy must equal or exceed the inlet entropy. In steady flows, heat transfer
can increase or decrease the entropy of the flow, depending on the direction of heat
transfer, as long as the entropy change of the surroundings is such that the net effect is
to increase the entropy of the universe.
We will often be concerned with adiabatic flows. In the presence of fluid friction
and other irreversibilities, the exit entropy of an adiabatic flow exceeds its inlet entropy.
Adiabatic flows that have no irreversibilities also have no entropy change and therefore
are called isentropic flows.
1.4 Properties of Vapors: Mollier and T-s Diagrams
When heated, liquids are transformed into vapors. The much different physical
character of liquids and vapors makes engines in which phase change takes place
possible. The Newcomen atmospheric engine, for instance condensed steam to liquid
water in a piston-cylinder enclosure to create a partial vacuum. The excess of
atmospheric pressure over the low pressure of the condensed steam, acting on the
opposite face of the piston, provided the actuating force that drove the first successful
engines in the early eighteenth century. In the latter half of the eighteenth century,
engines in which work was done by steam pressure on the piston rather than by the
atmosphere, replaced Newcomen-type engines. Steam under pressure in reciprocating
engines was a driving force for the industrial revolution for about two centuries. By the
middle of the twentieth century, steam turbines and diesel engines had largely replaced
the steam engine in electric power generation, marine propulsion, and railroad
locomotives. .
Figure 1.4 shows typical saturation curves for a pure substance plotted in
temperature and entropy coordinates. A line of constant pressure (an isobar) is shown
in which the subcooled liquid at state 1 is heated, producing increases in entropy,
temperature, and enthalpy, until the liquid is saturated at state 2. Isobars in the
16
subcooled region of the diagram lie very close to the saturated liquid curve. The
separation of the two is exaggerated for clarity.
Once the substance has reached state 2, further transfer of heat fails to increase the
system temperature but is reflected in increased enthalpy and entropy in a vaporization
or boiling process. During this process the substance is converted from a saturated
liquid at state 2 to a mixture of liquid and vapor, and finally to a saturated vapor at
state 3. The enthalpy difference between the saturation values, h
3
h
2
, is called the
enthalpy of vaporization or heat of vaporization.
Continued addition of heat to the system, starting at state 3, superheats the steam
to state 4, again increasing temperature, enthalpy, and entropy.
Several observations about the isobaric process may be made here. Equation (1.5)
and Figure 1.4 show that the effect of adding heat is to always increase system entropy
and that of cooling to always decrease it. A similar conclusion can be drawn from
Equation (1.10) regarding heat additions acting to increase enthalpy flow through a
control volume in the absence of shaft work.
A measure of the proximity of a superheated state (state 4 in the figure) to the
saturated vapor line is the degree of superheat. This is the difference between the
temperature T
4
and the saturated vapor temperature T
3
, at the same pressure. Thus the
degree of superheat of superheated state 4 is T
4
- T
3
.
In the phase change from state 2 to state 3, the temperature and pressure give no
indication of the relative quantities of liquid and vapor in the system. The quality x is
defined as the ratio of the mass of vapor to the mass of the mixture of liquid and vapor
at any point between the saturation curves at a given pressure. By virtue of this
definition, the quality varies from 0 for a saturated liquid to 1 for a saturated vapor.
17
Because extensive properties are proportional to mass, they vary directly with the
vapor quality in the mixed region. The entropy, for example, varies from the entropy of
the saturated liquid s
l
at state 2 to the saturated vapor entropy s
v
at state 3 in
accordance with the following quality equation:
s = s
l
+ x(s
v
s
l
) [Btu/lb
m
-R | kJ/kg-K] (1.12)
where s is the entropy per unit mass. Other extensive properties such as enthalpy and
volume vary with quality in the same way.
A variable closely related to the quality is moisture fraction (both quality and
moisture fraction can be expressed as percentages). Moisture fraction, M, is defined as
the ratio of the mass of liquid to the total mass of liquid and vapor. It can be easily
shown that the sum of the quality and the moisture fraction of a mixture is one.
A Mollier chart, a diagram with enthalpy as ordinate and entropy as abscissa, is
much like the temperature-entropy diagram. A Mollier diagram for steam is included in
Appendix B. An isobar on a Mollier chart, unlike that on a T-s diagram, has a
continuous slope. It shows both enthalpy and entropy increasing monotonically with
heat addition. Such a diagram is frequently used in energy conversion and other areas
because of the importance of enthalpy in applying the steady-flow First Law.
1.5 Ideal Gas Basics
Under normal ambient conditions, the average distance between molecules in gases is
large, resulting in negligible influences of intermolecular forces. In this case, molecular
behavior and, therefore, system thermodynamics are governed primarily by molecular
translational and rotational kinetic energy. Kinetic theory or statistical thermodynamics
may be used to derive the ideal gas or perfect gas law:
pv = RT [ft-lb
f
/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (1.13)

where p [lb
f
/ft
2
| kN/m
2
], v [ft
3
/lb
m
| m
3
/kg] and T [R | K] are pressure, specific
volume, and temperature respectively and R [ft-lb
f
/lb
m
-R | kJ/kg-K] is the ideal gas
constant. The gas constant R for a specific gas is the universal gas constant R divided
by the molecular weight of the gas.
Thus, the gas constant for air is (1545 ft-lb
f
/lb-mole-R) / (29 lb
m
/lb-mole) =
53.3 ft-lb
f
/lb
m
-R in the English system and (8.31 kJ/kg-mole-K) / (29 kg/kg-mole)
= 0.287 kJ/kg-K in SI units.
The specific heats or heat capacities at constant volume and at constant pressure,
respectively, are:
c
v
= (u / T)
v
[Btu/lb
m
-R | kJ/kg-K] (1.14)
and
18
c
p
= (h /T)
p
[Btu/lb
m
-R | kJ/kg-K] (1.15)
As thermodynamic properties, the heat capacities are, in general, functions of two
other thermodynamic properties. For solids and liquids, pressure change has little
influence on volume and internal energy, so that to a very good approximation: c
v
= c
p
.
A gas is said to be thermally perfect if it obeys Equation (1.13) and its internal
energy, enthalpy, and heat capacities are functions of temperature only. Then
du = c
v
(T) dT [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (1.16)
and
dh = c
p
(T) dT [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (1.17)
A gas is said to be calorically perfect if in addition to being thermally perfect it
also has constant heat capacities. This is reasonably accurate at low and moderate
pressures and at temperatures high enough that intermolecular forces are negligible but
low enough that molecular vibrations are not excited and dissociation does not occur.
For air, vibrational modes are not significantly excited below about 600K, and
dissociation of oxygen does not occur until the temperature is above about 1500K.
Nitrogen does not dissociate until still higher temperatures. Excitation of molecular
vibrations causes specific heat to increase with temperature increase. Dissociation
creates further increases in heat capacities, causing them to become functions of
pressure.
It can be shown (see Exercise 1.4) that for a thermally perfect gas the heat
capacities are related by the following equation:
c
p
= c
v
+ R [Btu/lb
m
-R | kJ/kg-K] (1.18)
This relation does not apply for a dissociating gas, because the molecular weight of the
gas changes as molecular bonds are broken. Note the importance of assuring that R and
the heat capacities are in consistent units in this equation.
Another important gas property is the ratio of heat capacities defined by k = c
p
/c
v
.
It is constant for gases at room temperatures but decreases as vibrational modes
become excited. The importance of k will be seen in the following example.
EXAMPLE 1.2
(a) Derive an expression for the entropy change of a system in terms of pressure and
temperature for a calorically perfect gas.
(b) Derive a relation between p and T for an isentropic process in a calorically perfect
gas.
Solution
(a) For a reversible process, Equation (1.8) gives Tds = dh - vdp. Dividing by T and
applying the perfect gas law gives ds = c
p
dT/T - Rdp/p.
19
Then integration between states 1 and 2 yields
s
2
- s
1
= c
p
ln(T
2
/T
1
) - R ln( p
2
/p
1
)
(b) For an isentropic process, s
2
= s
1
. Then the above equation gives
T
2
/T
1
= (p
2
/p
1
)
(R/cp)

But R/c
p
= (c
p
- c
v
)/c
p
= (k - 1)/k. Hence T
2
/T
1
= (p
2
/p
1
)
(k - 1)/k
.
____________________________________________________________________
This and other important relations for an isentropic process in a calorically perfect gas
are summarized as follows
T
2
/T
1
= (p
2
/p
1
)
(k - 1)/k
[dl] (1.19)
T
2
/T
1
= (v
2
/v
1
)
(k - 1)
[dl] (1.20)
p
2
/p
1
= (v
1
/v
2
)
k
[dl] (1.21)
These relations show that the ratio of heat capacities governs the variation of
thermodynamic properties in an isentropic process. For this reason the ratio of heat
capacities is sometimes called the isentropic exponent.
1.6 Fundamentals of Fluid Flow
Almost all energy conversion devices involve the flow of some form of fluid. Air, liquid
water, steam, and combustion gases are commonly found in some of these devices.
Here we review a few of the frequently used elementary principles of fluid flow.
The volume flow rate, Q [ft
3
/s | m
3
/s] at which a fluid flows across a surface is the
product of the area, A [ft
2
| m
2
], of the surface and the component of velocity normal to
the area, V [ft/s | m/s]. The corresponding mass flow rate is the ratio of the volume rate
and the specific volume, v [ft
3
/lb
m
| m
3
/kg]:
m = AV/v = Q/v [lb
m
/s | kg /s] (1.22)
Alternatively the flow rate can be expressed in terms of the reciprocal of the specific
volume, the density, , [lb
m
/ft
3
| kg /m
3
]:
m = AV, = Q, [lb
m
/s | kg /s] (1.23)
20
The first important principle of fluid mechanics is the conservation of mass, a
principle that we have already used in Section 1.3. For a steady flow, the net inflow to a
control volume must equal the net outflow. Any imbalance between the inflow and
outflow implies an accumulation or a reduction of mass within the control volume, i.e.,
an unsteady flow. Given a control volume with n ports, the conservation of mass
provides an equation that may be used to solve for the nth port flow rate, given the
other n-1 flow rates. These flows may be (1) given, (2) calculated from data at the
ports using Equation (1.22) or (1.23), (3) obtained by solving n-1 other equations, or
(4) a combination of the preceding three.
For isentropic flow of an incompressible (constant density, , ) fluid, the Bernoulli
equation applies:
p
1
/, + V
1
2
/2 = p
2
/, + V
2
2
/2 [ft-lb
f
/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (1.24)
This is an invariant form, i.e. an equation with the same terms on both sides, p/, +
V
2
/2. The subscripts identify the locations in the flow where the invariants are
evaluated. The first term of the invariant is sometimes called the pressure head, and the
second the velocity head. The equation applies only in regions where there are no
irreversibilities such as viscous losses or heat transfer.
The invariant sum of the two terms on either side of Equation (1.24) may be called
the total head or stagnation head. It is the head that would be observed at a point
where the velocity approaches zero. The pressure associated with the total head is
therefore called the total pressure or stagnation pressure, p
o
= p + ,V
2
/2. Each point
in the flow may be thought of as having its own stagnation pressure resulting from an
imaginary isentropic deceleration.
In the event of significant irreversibilities, there is a loss in total head and the
Bernoulli equation may be generalized to:
p
1
/, + V
1
2
/2 = p
2
/, + V
2
2
/2 + loss [ft-lb
f
/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (1.25a)
or
p
o1
/, = p
o2
/, + loss [ft-lb
f
/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (1.25b)
Stagnation pressure or head losses in ducts, such as due to flow turning or sudden
area change, are tabulated in reference books as fractions of the upstream velocity head
for a variety of geometries. Another example is the famous Darcy-Weisbach equation
which gives the head loss resulting from fluid friction in a pipe of constant cross-
section.
1.7 Compressible Flow
While many engineering analyses may reasonably employ incompressible flow
principles, there are cases where the compressibility of gases and vapors must be
considered. These are situations where the magnitude of the kinetic energy of the flow
21
is comparable to its enthalpy such as in supersonic nozzles and diffusers, in turbines and
compressors, and in supersonic flight. In these cases the steady-flow First Law must be
generalized to include kinetic energy per unit mass terms. For two ports:
[Btu /s | kJ/s] (1.26a)
Care should be taken to assure consistency of units, because enthalpy is usually stated
in thermal units [Btu /lb
m
| kJ/kg] and velocity in mechanical units [ft /s | m /s].
Another invariant of significance appears in Equation (1.26a). The form
h
o
= h + V
2
/2 [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (1.27)
is seen to be invariant in applications where heat transfer and shaft work are
insignificant. The invariant, h
o
, is usually given the name stagnation enthalpy because it
is the enthalpy at a point in the flow (real or imagined) where velocity approaches zero.
In terms of stagnation enthalpy, Equation (1.26a) may be rewritten as
[Btu/s | kJ/s] (1.26b)
where conservation of mass with steady flow through two ports has been assumed.
Writing dh
o
= c
p
dT
o
with c
p
constant, we get
h
o2
- h
o1
= c
p
(T
o2
- T
o1
)
Combining this with Equation (1.27), we are led to define another invariant, the
stagnation temperature for a calorically perefect gas:
T
o
= T + V
2
/2c
p
[ R | K] (1.28)
The stagnation temperature may be regarded as the temperture at a real or imaginary
point where the gas velocity has been brought to zero adiabatically. For this special
case of a constant heat capacity, Equation (1.26b) may be written as
[Btu /s | kJ/s] (1.26c)
In both incompressible and compressible flows, the mass flow rates at all stations
in a streamtube are the same. Because the specific volume and density are constant in
incompressible flow, Equation (1.22) shows that the volume flow rates are the same at
all stations also. However for compressible flow, Equation (1.23) shows that density
change along a streamtube implies volume flow rate variation. Thus, while it is
frequently convenient to think and talk in terms of volume flow rate when dealing with
incompressible flows, mass flow rate is more meaningful in compressible flows and in
general.
22
A measure of the compressiblity of a flow is often indicated by a Mach number, defined
as the dimensionless ratio of a flow velocity to the local speed of sound in the fluid. For
ideal gases the speed of sound is given by
a = (kp/,)

= (kRT)

[ft /s | m /s] (1.29)


Compressible flows are frequently classified according to their Mach number:
M = 0 Incompressible
0 < M < 1 Subsonic
M = 1 Sonic
M > 1 Supersonic
Studies of compressible flows show that supersonic flows have a significantly different
physical character than subsonic and incompressible flows. For example, the velocity
fields in subsonic flows are continuous, whereas discontinuities known as shock waves
are common in supersonic flows. Thus the student should not be surprised to find that
different relations hold in supersonic flows than in subsonic flows.
1.8 Energy Clasification
Energy exists in a variety of forms. All human activities involve conversion of energy
from one form to another. Indeed, life itself depends on energy conversion processes.
The human body, through complex processes, transforms the chemical energy stored in
food into external motion and work produced by muscles as well as electrical impulses
that control and activate internal functions.
It is instructive to examine some of the processes for transformation between
technically important forms of energy. Table 1.2 shows a matrix of energy forms and
the names of some associated energy converters.
Table 1.2 Energy Transformation Matrix
From: To: Thermal Energy Mechanical Energy Electrical Energy
Chemical Energy Furnace Diesel engine Fuel cell
Thermal Energy Heat exchanger Steam turbine Thermocouple
Mechanical Energy Refrigerator, heat
pump
Gearbox Electrical generator
Nuclear Energy Fission reactor Nuclear steam turbine Nuclear power plant
The table is far from complete, and other energy forms and energy converters
could readily be added. However, it does include the major energy converters of
interest to mechanical engineers. It is a goal of this book to present important aspects
of the design, analysis, performance, and operation of most of these devices.
One of the major criteria guiding the design of energy conversion systems is
23
efficiency. Each of the conversions in Table 1.2 is executed by a device that operates
with one or more relevant efficiencies. The following section explores some of the
variety of definitions of efficiency used in design and performance studies of energy
conversion devices.
1.9 Efficiencies
Efficiency is a measure of the quality of an operation or of a characteristic of a device.
Several types of efficiencies are widely used. It is important to clearly distinguish
among them. Note that the terms work and power are equally applicable here.
The efficiency of a machine that transmits mechanical power is measured by its
mechanical efficiency, the fraction of the power supplied to the transmission device
that is delivered to another machine attached to its output, Figure 1.5(a). Thus a gear-
box for converting rotational motion from a power source to a device driven at another
speed dissipates some mechanical energy by fluid and/or dry friction, with a consequent
loss in power transmitted to the second machine. The efficiency of the gearbox is the
ratio of its power output to the power input, a value less than one. For example, a
turboprop engine with a gearbox efficiency of 0.95 will transmit only 95% of its power
output to its propeller.
24
Another type of efficiency that measures internal losses of power is used to
indicate the quality of performance of turbomachines such as pumps, compressors and
turbines. These devices convert flow energy to work (power), or vice versa. Here the
efficiency compares the output with a theoretical ideal in a ratio [Figure 1.5(b)]. The
resulting efficiency ranges from 0 to 1 as a measure of how closely the process
approaches a relevant isentropic process. A turbine with an efficiency of 0.9, will, for
example, deliver 90% of the power of a perfect (isentropic) turbine operating under the
same conditions. This efficiency, sometimes referred to as isentropic efficiency or
turbine efficiency, will be considered in more detail in the next chapter.
Another form of isentropic efficiency, sometimes called compressor efficiency (or
pump efficiency), is defined for compressors (or pumps). It is the ratio of the isentropic
work to drive the compressor (or pump) to the actual work required. Because the
actual work required exceeds the isentropic work, this efficiency is also less than to 1.
A third type of efficiency compares the magnitude of a useful effect to the cost of
producing the effect, measured in comparable units. An example of this type of
efficiency compares the net work output, w
n
, of a heat engine to the heat supplied, q
a
,
to operate the engine. This is called the to (
th
= w
n
/q
a
) [Figure 1.5(c)]. For example,
the flow of natural gas to an electrical power plant provides a chemical energy flow
rate or heat flow rate to the plant that leads to useful electric power output. It is known
from basic thermodynamics that this efficiency is limited by the Carnot efficiency, as
will be discussed in the next section.
Another example of this type of efficiency as applied to refrigerators and heat
pumps [Figure 1.5(d)] is called the coefficient of performance, COP. In this case the
useful effect is the rate of cooling or heating, and the cost to produce the effect is the
power supplied to the device. The term "coefficient of performance" is used instead of
efficiency for this measure of quality because the useful effect usually exceeds the cost
in comparable units of measure. Hence, unlike other efficiencies, the COP can exceed
unity. As seen in Figure 1.5(d), there are two definitions for COP, one for a refrigerator
and another for a heat pump. It may be shown using the First Law of Thermodynamics,
that a simple relationship exists between the two definitions: COP
hp
= COP
refr
+ 1.
1.10 The Carnot Engine
On beginning the study of the energy conversion ideas and devices that will serve us in
the twenty-first century, it is appropriate to review the theoretical cycle that stands as
the ideal for a heat engine. The ideas put forth by Sadi Carnot in 1824 in his
Reflections on the Motive Power of Heat (see Historical Bibliography) expressed the
content of the Second Law of Thermodynamics relevant to heat engines, which, in
modern form (attributed to Kelvin and Planck) is: It is impossible for a device which
operates in a cycle to receive heat from a single source and convert the heat completely
to work. Carnots great work also described the cycle that today bears his name and
provides the theoretical limit for efficiency of heat engine cycles that operate between
two given temperature levels: the Carnot cycle.
The Carnot cycle consists of two reversible, isothermal processes separated by two
25
reversible adiabatic or isentropic processes, as shown in Figure 1.6. All of the heat
transferred to the working fluid is supplied isothermally at the high temperature
T
H
= T
3
, and all heat rejected is transferred from the working medium at the low
temperature T
L
= T
1
. No heat transfer takes place, of course, in the isentropic
processes. It is evident from Equation (1.5) and the T-s diagram that the heat added is
T
3
(s
3
- s
2
), the heat rejected is T
1
(s
1
- s
4
), and, by the cyclic integral relation, the net
work is T
3
(s
3
- s
2
) + T
1
(s
1
- s
4
). The thermal efficiency of the Carnot cycle, like that of
other cycles, is given by w
n
/ q
a
and can be expressed in terms of the high and low cycle
temperatures as

:
26
because both isothermal processes operate between the same entropy limits.
The Carnot efficiency equation shows that efficiency rises as T
L
drops and as
T
H
increases. The message is clear: a heat engine should operate between the widest
possible temperature limits. Thus the efficiency of a heat engine will be limited by the
maximum attainable energy-source temperature and the lowest available heat-sink
temperature.
Students are sometimes troubled by the idea of isothermal heat transfer processes
because they associate heat transfer with temperature rise. A moments reflection,
however, on the existence of latent heatse.g., the teakettle steaming on the stove at
constant temperature-makes it clear that one should not always associate heat transfer
with temperature change.
It is important here, as we start to consider energy conversion devices, to recall the
famous Carnot Theorem, the proof of which is given the most thermodynamics texts.
It states that it is impossible for any engine operating in a cycle between two reservoirs
at different temperatures to have an efficiency that exceeds the Carnot efficiency
corresponding to those temperatures. It can also be shown that all reversible engines
operating between two given reservoirs have the same efficiency and that all irreversible
engines must have lower efficiencies. Thus the Carnot efficiency sets an upper limit on
the performance of heat engines and therefore serves as a criterion by which other
engines may be judged.
1.11 Additional Second-Law Considerations
The qualitative relationship between the irreversibility of a process and the entropy
increase of the universe associated with it was considered in section 1.2. Let us now
consider a quantitative approach to irreversibility and apply it to a model of a power
plant.
Reversible Work
Instead of comparing the work output of the power plant with the energy supplied from
fuel to run the plant, it is instructive to compare it with the maximum work achievable
by a reversible heat engine operating between the appropriate temperature limits, the
reversible work. It has been established that any reversible engine would have the same
efficiency as a Carnot engine. The Carnot engine provides a device for determining the
reversible work associated with a given source temperature, T
H
, and a lower sink
temperature,T
L
.
27
Irreversibility
The irreversibility, I, of a process is defined as the difference between the reversible
work and the actual work of a process:
I = W
rev
- W
act
[Btu | kJ]
It is seen that the irreversibility of a process vanishes when the actual work is the same
as that produced by an appropriate Carnot engine. Moreover, the irreversibility of a
non-work-producing engine is equal to the reversible work. It is clear that I 0,
because no real engine can produce more work than a Carnot engine operating between
the same limiting temperatures.
Second-Law Efficiency
We can also define a second-law efficiency,
II
, as the ratio of the actual work of a
process to the reversible work:
[dl]
This is an efficiency that is limited to 100%, as opposed to the thermal efficiency of a
heat engine, sometimes referred to as a first-law efficiency, which may not exceed
that of the appropriate Carnot engine. Note that an engine which has no irreversibility
is a reversible engine and has a second-law efficiency of 100%.
A Power Plant Model
Let us consider a model of a power plant in which a fuel is burned at a high
temperature, T
H
, in order to transfer heat to a working fluid at an intermediate
temperature, T
INT
. The working fluid, in turn, is used in an engine to produce work and
reject heat to a sink at the low temperature, T
L
. Figure 1.7 presents a diagram of the
model that shows explicitly the combustion temperature drop from the source
temperature, T
H
, to the intermediate temperature, T
INT
, the actual work-producing
engine, and a Carnot engine used to determine the reversible work for the situation.
The Carnot engine has an efficiency of
C
= 1 - T
L
/T
H
and develops work in the
following amount:
W
rev
= W
C
= Q
IN
- Q
C
=
C
Q
IN
[Btu|kJ]
Suppose that the engine we are considering is a Carnot engine that operates from the
intermediate source at T
INT
. Its efficiency and work output are, respectively,

I
= 1 - T
L
/T
INT
and W
act
= Q
IN
Q
I
=
I
Q
IN
. The irreversibility, I, of the power plant
is then
28
I = W
rev
- W
act
= (
C
-
I
)Q
IN

= [1 - T
L
/T
H
-

(

1 - T
L
/T
INT
)]Q
IN
= T
L
Q
IN
( T
H
- T
INT
) /T
INT
T
H
[Btu|kJ]
and the second-law efiiciency is:

II
= W
act
/W
rev
= (1 - T
L
/T
INT
) / (1 - T
L
/T
H
) [dl]
Note that when T
INT
= T
H
, the irreveribility vanishes and the second-law efficiency
becomes 100%. Also, when T
INT
= T
L
, the irreversibility is equal to the reversible work
of the Carnot engine and the second- law efficiency is zero. The latter condition
indicates that a pure heat transfer process or any process that produces no useful work
causes a loss in the ability to do work in the amount of W
rev
. Thus the reversible work
associated with the extremes of a given process is a measure of how much capability to
do work can be lost, and the irreversibility is a measure of how much of that work-
producing potential is actually lost. The following example illustrates these ideas.
EXAMPLE 1.3
Through combustion of a fossil fuel at 3500R, an engine receives energy at a rate of
3000 Btu/s to heat steam to 1500R. There is no energy loss in the combustion
process. The steam, in turn, produces 1000 Btu/s of work and rejects the remaining
energy to the surroundings at 500R.
(a) What is the thermal efficiency of the plant?
(b) What are the reversible work and the Carnot efficiency corresponding to the source
29
and sink temperatures?
(c) What is the irreversibility?
(d) What is the second-law efficiency?
(e) What would the irreversibility and the second-law efficiency be if the working fluid
were processed by a Carnot engine rather than by the real engine?
Solution
(a) The thermal efficiency, or first-law efficiency, of the plant is
I
= W
act
/Q
IN
=
1000/3000 = 0.333 or 33.3%.
(b) The relevant Carnot efficiency is 1 - 500/3500 = 0.857, or 85.7%. The engines
reversible work is then
C
Q
IN
= 0.857(3000) = 2571 Btu/s.
(c) The plant irreversibility is 2571 - 1000 = 1571 Btu/s.
(d) The second-law efficiency is then

I
/
C
= 0.333/0.857 = 0.389, or 38.9%
or
W
act
/W
rev
= 1000/2571 = 0.389, or 38.9%.
(e) The Carnot efficiency corresponding to the maximum temperature of the working
fluid is 1 - 500/1500 = 0.667 or 66.7%. The second-law efficiency for this system is
then 0.667/0.857 = 0.778, compared with 0.389 for the actual engine. The actual work
produced by the irreversibly heated Carnot engine is 0.667(3000) = 2001 Btu/s, and its
irreversibility is then I = 2571 -2001 = 570 Btu/s.
___________________________________________________________________
In summary, the thermal efficiency, or first-law efficiency, of an engine is a
measure of how well the engine converts the energy in its fuel to useful work. It says
nothing about energy loss, because energy is conserved and cannot be lost: it can only
be transformed. The second-law efficiency, on the other hand, recognizes that some of
the energy of a fuel is not available for conversion to work in a heat engine and
therefore assesses the ability of the engine to convert only the available work into useful
work. This is a reason why some regard the second-law efficiency as more significant
than the more commonly used first-law efficiency.
Bibliography and References
1. Van Wylen, Gordon J., and Sonntag, Richard E., Fundamentals of Classical
Thermodynamics, 3
rd
ed. New York: Wiley, 1986.
2. Balmer, Robert, Thermodynamics. Minneapolis: West, 1990.

3. Cengel, Yunus A., and Boles, Michael A., Thermodynamics. New York: McGraw-
Hill, 1989.
30
4. Faires, Virgil Moring, Thermodynamics, 5
th
ed. New York: Macmillan, 1970.
5. Silver, Howard F., and Nydahl, John E., Engineering Thermodynamics.
Minneapolis: West, 1977.
6. Bathie, William W., Fundamentals of Gas Turbines. New York: Wiley, 1984
7. Wilson, David Gordon, The Design of High Efficiency Turbomachinery and Gas
Turbines. Boston: MIT Press, 1984.
8. Anderson, John D., Modern Compressible Flow. New York: McGraw-Hill, 1982.

9. Anderson, John D., Introduction to Flight. New York: McGraw-Hill, 1978.
10. Chapman, Alan J. and Walker, William F., Introductory Gas Dynamics. New York:
Holt, Rinehart, and Winston, 1971.
Historical Bibliography
1. Barnard, William N., Ellenwood, Frank E., and Hirshfeld, Clarence F., Heat-Power
Engineering. Wiley, 1926.
2. Bent, Henry, The Second Law.NewYork: Oxford University Press, 1965
3. Cummins, C. Lyle, Jr., Internal Fire, rev. ed. Warrendale, Penna.: Society of
Automotive Engineers, 1989.
4. Tann, Jennifer, The Selected Papers of Boulton and Watt. Boston: MIT Press, 1981.
5. Carnot, Sadi, Reflexions Sur la Puissance Motrice de Feu. Paris: Bachelor,1824.
6. Potter, J. H., The Gas Turbine Cycle. ASME Paper presented at the Gas Turbine
Forum Dinner, ASME Annual Meeting, New York, Nov. 27, 1972.
7. Grosser, Morton, Diesel: The Man and the Machine. New York: Atheneum, 1978.
8. Nitske, W. Robert, and Wilson, Charles Morrow, Rudolph Diesel: Pioneer of the
Age of Power. Norman, Okla: University of Oklahoma Press, 1965.
9. Rolt, L.T. C., and Allen, J. S., The Steam Engine of Thomas Newcomen. New York:
Moorland Publishing Co., 1977.
10. Briggs, Asa, The Power of Steam. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1982.
31
11. Thurston, Robert H., A History of the Growth of the Steam Engine. 1878; rpr.
Ithaca, N.Y.: Cornell University Press, 1939.
EXERCISES
1.1 Determine the entropy of steam at 1000 psia and a quality of 50%.
1.2 Show that the moisture fraction for a liquid water-steam mixture, defined as the
ratio of liquid mass to mixture mass, can be written as 1 - x, where x is steam quality.
1.3 Write expressions for the specific entropy, specific enthalpy, and specific volume as
functions of the moisture fraction. Determine the values of these properties for steam at
500F and a moisture fraction of 0.4.
1.4 Show that for a thermally perfect gas, c
p
- c
v
= R.
1.5 During a cyclic process, 75kJ of heat flow into a system and 25kJ are rejected from
the system later in the cycle. What is the net work of the cycle.
1.6 Seventy-five kJ of heat flow into a rigid system and 25 kJ are rejected later. What
are the magnitude and sign of the change in internal energy? What does the sign
indicate?
1.7 The mass contained between an insulated piston and an insulated cylinder
decreases in internal energy by 50 Btu. How much work is involved, and what is the
sign of the work term? What does the sign indicate?
1.8 Derive Equation (1.8) from Equation (1.7).
1.9 Use Equation (1.8) to derive an expression for the finite enthalpy change of an
incompressible fluid in an isentropic process. If the process is the pressurization of
saturated water initially at 250 psia, what is the enthalpy rise, in Btu /lb
m
and in
ft-lb
f
/ lb
m
, if the final pressure is 4000 psia? What is the enthalpy rise if the initial
pressure is 100 kPa and the final pressure is 950 kPa?
1.10 Sixty kg /s of brine flows into a device with an enthalpy of 200 kJ/kg. Brine flows
out of the other port at a flow rate of 20 kg /s. What is the net inflow? Is the system in
steady flow? Explain.
1.11 Use the steam tables in Appendices B and C to compare the heats of vaporization
at 0.01, 10, and 1000 psia. Compare the saturated liquid specific volumes at these
pressures. What do you conclude about the influence of pressure on these properties?
32
1.12 Using the heat capacity equation for nitrogen:
c
p
= 9.47 - 3.47 x 10
3
/T + 1.16 x 10
6
/T
2
where c
p
is in Btu / lb-mole and T is in degrees Rankine (From Gordon J. Van Wylen
and Richard E. Sonntag, Fundamentals of Classical Thermodynamics, 3rd ed. New
York: Wiley, 1986). Compare the enthalpy change per mole of nitrogen between
540R and 2000R for nitrogen as a thermally perfect gas and as a calorically perfect
gas.
1.13 Use Equation (1.7) to derive Equation (1.20) for a calorically perfect gas.
1.14 Use Equation (1.7) to derive a relation for the entropy change as a function of
temperature ratio for a constant-volume process in a calorically perfect gas.
1.15 Use Equation (1.8) to derive a relation for the entropy change as a function of
temperature for an isobaric process in a calorically perfect gas.
1.16 A convergent nozzle is a flow passage in which area decreases in the streamwise
direction (the direction of the flow). It is used for accelerating the flow from a low
velocity to a higher velocity. Use the generalized form of the steady-flow First Law
given in Equation (1.26a) to derive an equation for the exit velocity for an adiabatic
nozzle.
1.17 Derive an equation for the pressure drop for a loss-free incompressible flow in a
varying-area duct as a function of area ratio.
1.18 Two units of work are required to transfer 10 units of heat from a refrigerator to
the environment. What is the COP of the refrigerator? Suppose that the same amount
of heat transfer instead is by a heat pump into a house. What is the heat pump COP?
1.19 A power plant delivers 100 units of work at 30% thermal efficiency. How many
heat units are supplied to operate the plant? How many units of heat are rejected to the
surroundings?
1.20 A steam turbine has an efficiency of 90% and a theoretical isentropic power of'
100 kW. What is the actual power output?
1.21 Thomas Newcomen used the fact that the specific volume of saturated liquid is
much smaller than the specific volume of saturated steam at the same pressure in his
famous "atmospheric engine." Calculate the work done on the piston by the atmosphere
if steam is condensed at an average pressure of 6 psia by cooling in a tightly fitted
piston-cylinder enclosure if the piston area is 1 ft
2
and the piston stroke is 1 ft. If the
process takes place 10 times a minute, what is the power delivered? Discuss what can
33
be done to increase the power of the engine. Describe the characteristics of a
Newcomen engine that would theoretically deliver 20 horsepower.
1.22 Expand Table 1.2 to include solar and geothermal sources.
1.23 Twenty pounds of compressed air is stored in a tank at 200 psia and 80F. The
tank is heated to bring the temperature to 155F. What is the final tank pressure, and
how much heat was added?
1.24 Ten kilograms of compressed air is stored in a tank at 250 kPa and 50C. The
tank is heated to bring the air temperature to 200

C. What is the final tank pressure,
and how much heat was added?
1.25 An 85-ft
3

tank contains air at 30 psia and 100 F. What mass of air must be added
to bring the pressure to 50 psia and the temperature to 150F?
1.26 A 20-L tank contains air at 2 bar and 300K. What mass of air must be added to
bring the pressure to 2 bar and the temperature to 375K?
1.27 Air enters a wind tunnel nozzle at 160F, 10 atm, and a velocity of 50 ft/s. The
entrance area is 5ft
2
. If the heat loss per unit mass is 10 Btu/lb
m
and the exit pressure
and velocity are, respectively, 1.5 atm and 675 ft/s, what are the exit temperature and
area?
1.28 Air enters a wind tunnel nozzle at 90

C, 250 kPa, and a velocity of 40 m/s. The


entrance area is 3 m
2
. If the heat loss per unit mass is 7 kJ/kg and the exit pressure and
velocity are, respectively, 105 kPa and 250 m/s, what are the exit temperature and
area?
1.29 Air enters a wind tunnel nozzle at 160F, 10 atm, and a velocity of 50 ft/s. The
entrance area is 5ft
2
. If the heat loss per unit mass is 8 Btu/lb
m
and the exit pressure and
temperature are, respectively, 1.25 atm and 120F, what are the exit velocity and area?
1.30 Air enters a wind tunnel nozzle at 90

C, 250 kPa, and a velocity of 40 m/s. The


entrance area is 3 m
2
. If the heat loss per unit mass is 5 kJ/kg and the exit pressure and
temperature are, respectively, 120 kPa and 43

C, what are the exit velocity and area?


1.31 Sketch a Mollier diagram showing the character of three isotherms and three
isobars for a calorically perfect gas. Label each curve with a value in SI units to show
the directions of increasing temperature and pressure. Explain how the diagram would
differ if the gas were not calorically perfect.
35
C H A P T E R T W O
Fundamentals of
Steam Power
2.1 Introduction
Much of the electricity used in the United States is produced in steam power plants.
Despite efforts to develop alternative energy converters, electricity from steam will
continue, for many years, to provide the power that energizes the United States and
world economies. We therefore begin the study of energy conversion systems with this
important element of industrial society.
Steam cycles used in electrical power plants and in the production of shaft power
in industry are based on the familiar Rankine cycle, studied briefly in most courses in
thermodynamics. In this chapter we review the basic Rankine cycle and examine
modifications of the cycle that make modern power plants efficient and reliable.
2.2 A Simple Rankine-Cycle Power Plant
The most prominent physical feature of a modern steam power plant (other than its
smokestack) is the steam generator, or boiler, as seen in Figure 2.1. There the
combustion, in air, of a fossil fuel such as oil, natural gas, or coal produces hot
combustion gases that transfer heat to water passing through tubes in the steam
generator. The heat transfer to the incoming water (feedwater) first increases its
temperature until it becomes a saturated liquid, then evaporates it to form saturated
vapor, and usually then further raises its temperature to create superheated steam.
Steam power plants such as that shown in Figure 2.1, operate on sophisticated
variants of the Rankine cycle. These are considered later. First, lets examine the
simple Rankine cycle shown in Figure 2.2, from which the cycles of large steam power
plants are derived.
In the simple Rankine cycle, steam flows to a turbine, where part of its energy is
converted to mechanical energy that is transmitted by rotating shaft to drive an
electrical generator. The reduced-energy steam flowing out of the turbine condenses to
liuid water in the condenser. A feedwater pump returns the condensed liquid
(condensate) to the steam generator. The heat rejected from the steam entering the
condenser is transferred to a separate cooling water loop that in turn delivers the
rejected energy to a neighboring lake or river or to the atmosphere.
36
As a result of the conversion of much of its thermal energy into mechanical energy,
or work, steam leaves the turbine at a pressure and temperature well below the turbine
entrance (throttle) values. At this point the steam could be released into the
atmosphere. But since water resources are seldom adequate to allow the luxury of one-
time use, and because water purification of a continuous supply of fresh feedwater is
costly, steam power plants normally utilize the same pure water over and over again.
We usually say that the working fluid (water) in the plant operates in a cycle or
undergoes of cyclic process, as indicated in Figure 2.2. In order to return the steam to
the high-pressure of the steam generator to continue the cycle, the low- pressure steam
leaving the turbine at state 2 is first condensed to a liquid at state 3 and then
pressurized in a pump to state 4. The high pressure liquid water is then ready for its
next pass through the steam generator to state 1 and around the Rankine cycle again.
The steam generator and condenser both may be thought of as types of heat
exchangers, the former with hot combustion gases flowing on the outside of water-
37
filled tubes, and the latter with external cooling water passing through tubes on which
the low- pressure turbine exhaust steam condenses. In a well-designed heat exchanger,
both fluids pass through with little pressure loss. Therefore, as an ideal, it is common
to think of steam generators and condensers as operating with their fluids at
unchanging pressures.
It is useful to think of the Rankine cycle as operating between two fixed pressure
levels, the pressure in the steam generator and pressure in the condenser. A pump
provides the pressure increase, and a turbine provides the controlled pressure drop
between these levels.
Looking at the overall Rankine cycle as a system (Figure 2.2), we see that work is
delivered to the surroundings (the electrical generator and distribution system) by the
turbine and extracted from the surroundings by a pump (driven by an electric motor or
a small steam turbine). Similarly, heat is received from the surroundings (combustion
gas) in the steam generator and rejected to cooling water in the condenser.
38
At the start of the twentieth century reciprocating steam engines extracted thermal
energy from steam and converted linear reciprocating motion to rotary motion, to
provide shaft power for industry. Today, highly efficient steam turbines, such as shown
in Figure 2.3, convert thermal energy of steam directly to rotary motion. Eliminating
the intermediate step of conversion of thermal energy into the linear motion of a piston
was an important factor in the success of the steam turbine in electric power
generation. The resulting high rotational speed, reliability, and power output of the
turbine and the development of electrical distribution systems allowed the centralization
of power production in a few large plants capable of serving many industrial and
residential customers over a wide geographic area.
The final link in the conversion of chemical energy to thermal energy to mechanical
energy to electricity is the electrical generator. The rotating shaft of the electrical
generator usually is directly coupled to the turbine drive shaft. Electrical windings
attached to the rotating shaft of the generator cut the lines of force of the stator
windings, inducing a flow of alternating electrical current in accordance with Faraday's
Law. In the United States, electrical generators turn at a multiple of the generation
frequency of 60 cycles per second, usually 1800 or 3600 rpm. Elsewhere, where 50
cycles per second is the standard frequency, the speed of 3000 rpm is common.
Through transformers at the power plant, the voltage is increased to several hundred
thousand volts for transmission to distant distribution centers. At the distribution
centers as well as neighborhood electrical transformers, the electrical potential is
reduced, ultimately to the 110- and 220-volt levels used in homes and industry.
39
Since at present there is no economical way to store the large quantities of
electricity produced by a power plant, the generating system must adapt, from moment
to moment, to the varying demands for electricity from its customers. It is therefore
important that a power company have both sufficient generation capacity to reliably
satisfy the maximum demand and generation equipment capable of adapting to varying
load.
2.3 Rankine-Cycle Analysis
In analyses of heat engine cycles it is usually assumed that the components of the
engine are joined by conduits that allow transport of the working fluid from the exit of
one component to the entrance of the next, with no intervening state change. It will be
seen later that this simplification can be removed when necessary.
It is also assumed that all flows of mass and energy are steady, so that the steady
state conservation equations are applicable. This is appropriate to most situations
because power plants usually operate at steady conditions for significant lengths of
time. Thus, transients at startup and shutdown are special cases that will not be
considered here.
Consider again the Rankine cycle shown in Figure 2.2. Control of the flow can be
exercised by a throttle valve placed at the entrance to the turbine (state 1). Partial valve
closure would reduce both the steam flow to the turbine and the resulting power
output. We usually refer to the temperature and pressure at the entrance to the turbine
as throttle conditions. In the ideal Rankine cycle shown, steam expands adiabatically
and reversibly, or isentropically, through the turbine to a lower temperature and
pressure at the condenser entrance. Applying the steady-flow form of the First Law of
Thermodynamics [Equation (1.10)] for an isentropic turbine we obtain:
q = 0 = h
2
h
1
+ w
t
[Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg]
where we neglect the usually small kinetic and potential energy differences between the
inlet and outlet. This equation shows that the turbine work per unit mass passing
through the turbine is simply the difference between the entrance enthalpy and the
lower exit enthalpy:
w
t
= h
1
h
2
[Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (2.1)
The power delivered by the turbine to an external load, such as an electrical generator,
is given by the following:
Turbine Power = m
s
w
t
= m
s
(h
1
h
2
) [Btu/hr | kW]
where m
s
[lb
m
/hr | kg/s] is the mass flow of steam though the power plant.
40
Applying the steady-flow First Law of Thermodynamics to the steam generator,
we see that shaft work is zero and thus that the steam generator heat transfer is
q
a
= h
1
h
4
[Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (2.2)
The condenser usually is a large shell-and-tube heat exchanger positioned below or
adjacent to the turbine in order to directly receive the large flow rate of low-pressure
turbine exit steam and convert it to liquid water. External cooling water is pumped
through thousands of tubes in the condenser to transport the heat of condensation of
the steam away from the plant. On leaving the condenser, the condensed liquid (called
condensate) is at a low temperature and pressure compared with throttle conditions.
Continued removal of low-specific-volume liquid formed by condensation of the high-
specific-volume steam may be thought of as creating and maintaining the low pressure
in the condenser. The phase change in turn depends on the transfer of heat released to
the external cooling water. Thus the rejection of heat to the surroundings by the
cooling water is essential to maintaining the low pressure in the condenser. Applying
the steady-flow First Law of Thermodynamics to the condensing steam yields:
q
c
= h
3
h
2
[Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (2.3)
The condenser heat transfer q
c
is negative because h
2
> h
3
. Thus, consistent with sign
convention, q
c
represents an outflow of heat from the condensing steam. This heat is
absorbed by the cooling water passing through the condenser tubes. The condenser-
cooling-water temperature rise and mass-flow rate m
c
are related to the rejected heat
by:
m
s
|q
c
| = m
c
c
water
(T
out
- T
in
) [Btu/hr | kW]
where c
water
is the heat capacity of the cooling water [Btu/lb
m
-R | kJ/kg-K]. The
condenser cooling water may be drawn from a river or a lake at the temperature T
in
and
returned downstream at T
out
, or it may be circulated through cooling towers where heat
is rejected from the cooling water to the atmosphere.
We can express the condenser heat transfer in terms of an overall heat transfer
coefficient, U, the mean cooling water temperature, T
m
= (T
out
+ T
in
)/2, and the
condensing temperature T
3
:
m
s
|q
c
| = UA(T
3
- T
m
) [Btu/hr | kJ/s]
It is seen for given heat rejection rate, the condenser size represented by the tube
surface area A depends inversely on (a) the temperature difference between the
condensing steam and the cooling water, and (b) the overall heat-transfer coefficient.
For a fixed average temperature difference between the two fluids on opposite
sides of the condenser tube walls, the temperature of the available cooling water
controls the condensing temperature and hence the pressure of the condensing steam.
41
Therefore, the colder the cooling water, the lower the minimum temperature and
pressure of the cycle and the higher the thermal efficiency of the cycle.
A pump is a device that moves a liquid from a region of low pressure to one of
high pressure. In the Rankine cycle the condenser condensate is raised to the pressure
of the steam generator by boiler feed pumps, BFP. The high-pressure liquid water
entering the steam generator is called feedwater. From the steady-flow First Law of
Thermodynamics, the work and power required to drive the pump are:
w
p
= h
3
h
4
[Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (2.4)
and
Pump Power = m
s
w
p
= m
s
(h
3
h
4
) [Btu/hr | kW]
where the negative values resulting from the fact that h
4
> h
3
are in accordance with the
thermodynamic sign convention, which indicates that work and power must be supplied
to operate the pump.
The net power delivered by the Rankine cycle is the difference between the turbine
power and the magnitude of the pump power. One of the significant advantages of the
Rankine cycle is that the pump power is usually quite small compared with the turbine
power. This is indicated by the work ratio, w
t
/ w
p
, which is large compared with one
for Rankine cycle. As a result, the pumping power is sometimes neglected in
approximating the Rankine cycle net power output.
It is normally assumed that the liquid at a pump entrance is saturated liquid. This
is usually the case for power-plant feedwater pumps, because on the one hand
subcooling would increase the heat edition required in the steam generator, and on the
other the introduction of steam into the pump would cause poor performance and
destructive, unsteady operation. The properties of the pump inlet or condenser exit
(state 3 in Figure 2.2) therefore may be obtained directly from the saturated-liquid
curve at the (usually) known condenser pressure.
The properties for an isentropic pump discharge at state 4 could be obtained from
a subcooled-water property table at the known inlet entropy and the throttle pressure.
However, such tables are not widely available and usually are not needed. The
enthalpy of a subcooled state is commonly approximated by the enthalpy of the
saturated-liquid evaluated at the temperature of the subcooled liquid. This is usually
quite accurate because the enthalpy of a liquid is almost independent of pressure. An
accurate method for estimating the pump enthalpy rise and the pump work is given later
(in Example 2.3).
A measure of the effectiveness of an energy conversion device is its thermal
efficiency, which is defined as the ratio of the cycle net work to the heat supplied from
external sources. Thus, by using Equations (2.1), (2.2), and (2.4) we can express the
ideal Rankine-cycle thermal efficiency in terms of cycle enthalpies as:
42

th
= (h
1
h
2
+ h
3
h
4
)/(h
1
h
4
) [dl] (2.5)
In accordance with the Second Law of Thermodynamics, the Rankine cycle
efficiency must be less than the efficiency of a Carnot engine operating between the
same temperature extremes. As with the Carnot-cycle efficiency, Rankine-cycle
efficiency improves when the average heat-addition temperature increases and the heat-
rejection temperature decreases. Thus cycle efficiency may be improved by increasing
turbine inlet temperature and decreasing the condenser pressure (and thus the
condenser temperature).
Another measure of efficiency commonly employed by power plant engineers is the
heat rate, that is, the ratio of the rate of heat addition in conventional heat units to the
net power output in conventional power units. Because the rate of heat addition is
proportional to the fuel consumption rate, the heat rate is a measure of fuel utilization
rate per unit of power output. In the United States, the rate of heat addition is usually
stated in Btu/hr, and electrical power output in kilowatts, resulting in heat rates being
expressed in Btu/kW-hr. The reader should verify that the heat rate in English units is
given by the conversion factor, 3413 Btu/kW-hr, divided by the cycle thermal efficiency
as a decimal fraction, and that its value has a magnitude of the order of 10,000
Btu/kW-hr. In the SI system of units, the heat rate is usually expressed in kJ/kW-hr, is
given by 3600 divided by the cycle efficiency as a decimal fraction, and is of the same
order of magnitude as in the English system. It is evident that a low value of heat rate
represents high thermal efficiency and is therefore desirable.
EXAMPLE 2.1
An ideal Rankine cycle (see Figure 2.2) has a throttle state of 2000 psia/1000

F and
condenser pressure of 1 psia. Determine the temperatures, pressures, entropies, and
enthalpies at the inlets of all components, and compare the thermal efficiency of the
cycle with the relevant Carnot efficiency. Neglect pump work. What is the quality of
the steam at the turbine exit?
Solution
The states at the inlets and exits of the components, following the notation of
Figure 2.2, are listed in the following table. The enthalpy and entropy of state 1 may be
obtained directly from tables or charts for superheated steam (such as those in
Appendices B and C) at the throttle conditions. A Mollier chart is usually more
convenient than tables in dealing with turbine inlet and exit conditions.
For an ideal isentropic turbine, the entropy is the same at state 2 as at state 1. Thus
state 2 may be obtained from the throttle entropy (s
2
= s
1
= 1.5603 Btu/lb
m
-R) and the
condenser pressure (1 psia). In general, this state may be in either the superheated-
steam region or the mixed-steam-and-liquid region of the Mollier and T-s diagrams. In
the present case it is well into the mixed region, with a temperature of 101.74

F and an
enthalpy of 871 Btu/lb
m
.
43
The enthalpy, h
3
= 69.73 Btu/lb
m
, and other properties at the pump inlet are obtained
from saturated-liquid tables, at the condenser pressure. The steady-flow First Law of
Thermodynamics, in the form of Equation (2.4), indicates that neglecting isentropic
pump work is equivalent to neglecting the pump enthalpy rise. Thus in this case
Equation (2.4) implies that h
3
and h
4
shown in Figure (2.2) are almost equal. Thus we
take h
4
= h
3
as a convenient approximation.
State Temperature
(F)
Pressure
(psia)
Entropy
(Btu/lb
m
-R)
Enthalpy
(Btu/lb
m
)
1 1000.0 2000 1.5603 1474.1
2 101.74 1 1.5603 871.0
3 101.74 1 0.1326 69.73
4 101.74 2000 0.1326 69.73
The turbine work is
h
1
h
2
= 1474.1 871 = 603.1 Btu/lb
m
.
The heat added in the steam generator is
h
1
h
4
= 1474.1 69.73 = 1404.37 Btu/lb
m
.
The thermal efficiency is the net work per heat added = 603.1/1404.37 = 0.4294
(42.94%). This corresponds to a heat rate of 3413/0.4294 = 7946 Btu/kW-hr. As
expected, the efficiency is significantly below the value of the Carnot efficiency
of 1 (460 + 101.74)/(460 + 1000) = 0.6152 (61.52%), based on a source
temperature of T
1
and a sink temperature of T
3
.
The quality of the steam at the turbine exit is
(s
2
s
l
)/(s
v
s
l
) = (1.5603 0.1326)/(1.9781 0.1326) = 0.7736
Here v and l indicate saturated vapor and liquid states, respectively, at pressure p
2
.
Note that the quality could also have been obtained from the Mollier chart for steam as
1 - M, where M is the steam moisture fraction at entropy s
2
and pressure p
2
.
__________________________________________________________________
Example 2-2
If the throttle mass-flow is 2,000,000 lb
m
/hr and the cooling water enters the condenser
at 60F, what is the power plant output in Example 2.1? Estimate the cooling-water
mass-flow rate.
44
Solution: The power output is the product of the throttle mass-flow rate and the power
plant net work. Thus
Power = (2 10
6
)(603.1) = 1.206 10
9
Btu/hr
or
Power = 1.206 10
9
/ 3413 = 353,413 kW.
The condenser heat-transfer rate is
m
s
q
c
= m
s
( h
3
h
2
) = 2,000,000 (69.73 871) = 1.60310
9
Btu/hr
The condensing temperature, T
3
= 101.74 F, is the upper bound on the cooling
water exit temperature. Assuming that the cooling water enters at 60F and leaves at
95F, the cooling-water flow rate is given by
m
c
= m
s
|q
c
| / [ c
water
(T
out
T
in
)] = 1.60310
9
/[(1)(95 - 60)] = 45.6810
6
lb
m
/hr
A higher mass-flow rate of cooling water would allow a smaller condenser cooling-
water temperature rise and reduce the required condenser-heat-transfer area at the
expense of increased pumping power.
____________________________________________________________________
2.4 Deviations from the Ideal Component Efficiencies
In a power plant analysis it is sometimes necessary to account for non-ideal effects such
as fluid friction, turbulence, and flow separation in components otherwise assumed to
be reversible. Decisions regarding the necessity of accounting for these effects are
largely a matter of experience built on familiarity with the magnitudes of the effects,
engineering practices, and the uses of the calculated results.
Turbine
In the case of an adiabatic turbine with flow irreversibilities, the steady-flow First Law
of Thermodynamics gives the same symbolic result as for the isentropic turbine in
Equation (2.1), i.e.,
w
t
= h
1
h
2
[Btu/lb | kJ/kg] (2.6)
except that here h
2
represents the actual exit enthalpy and w
t
is the actual work of an
adiabatic turbine where real effects such as flow separation, turbulence, irreversible
internal heat transfers, and fluid friction exist.
45
An efficiency for a real turbine, known as the isentropic efficiency, is defined as
the ratio of the actual shaft work to the shaft work for an isentropic expansion between
the same inlet state and exit pressure level. Based on the notation of Figure 2.4, we see
that the turbine efficiency is:

turb
= (h
1
h
2
)/(h
1
h
2s
) [dl] (2.7)
where h
2s
, the isentropic turbine-exit enthalpy, is the enthalpy evaluated at the turbine
inlet entropy and the exit pressure. For the special case of an isentropic turbine,
h
2
= h
2s
and the efficiency becomes 1. Note how state 2 and the turbine work change
in Figure 2.4 as the efficiency increases toward 1. The diagram shows that the
difference between the isentropic and actual work, h
2
h
2s
, represents work lost due to
irreversibility. Turbine isentropic efficiencies in the low 90% range are currently
achievable in well-designed machines.
Normally in solving problems involving turbines, the turbine efficiency is known
from manufacturers tests, and the inlet state and the exhaust pressure are specified.
State 1 and p
2
determine the isentropic discharge state 2s using the steam tables. The
actual turbine-exit enthalpy can then be calculated from Equation (2.7). Knowing both
p
2
and h
2
, we can then fully identify state 2 and account for real turbine behavior in any
cycle analysis.
Pump
Work must be supplied to a pump to move liquid from a low pressure to a high
pressure. Some of the work supplied is lost due to irreversibilities. Ideally the remaining
effective work to raise the pressure is necessarily less than that supplied. In order for
46
the efficiency of a pump to be less than or equal to 1, it is defined in inverse fashion to
turbine efficiency. That is, pump efficiency is the ratio of the isentropic work to the
actual work input when operating between two given pressures. Applying Equation
(2.4) and the notation of Figure (2.5), the isentropic pump work, w
ps
= h
3
h
4s
, and the
pump isentropic efficiency is

pump
= w
ps
/w
p
= (h
4s
h
3
)/(h
4
h
3
) [dl] (2.8)
Note the progression of exit states that would occur in Figure 2.5 as pump efficiency
increases for a fixed inlet state and exit pressure. It is seen that the pump lost work,
given by h
4
h
4s
decreases and that the actual discharge state approaches the isentropic
discharge state.
States 4 and 4s are usually subcooled liquid states. As a first approximation their
enthalpies may be taken to be the saturated liquid enthalpy at T
3
. More accurate
approximations for these enthalpies may be obtained by applying the First Law for a
closed system undergoing a reversible process, Equation (1.8): Tds = dh - vdp. For an
isentropic process it follows that dh = vdp. Because a liquid is almost incompressible,
its specific volume, v, is almost independent of pressure. Thus, using the notation of
Figure 2.5, integration with constant specific volume yields
h
4s
= h
3
+ v
3
( p
4
p
3
) [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg]
where a knowledge of state 3 and p
4
determines h
4s
.
47
Using Equation (2.8), and without consulting tables for subcooled water, we can
then calculate the pump work from
w
p
= v
3
(p
3
p
4
)/
p
[ft-lb
f
/lb
m
| kN-m/kg] (2.9)
Note that the appropriate conversion factors must be applied for dimensional
consistency in Equation (2.9).
EXAMPLE 2.3
Calculate the actual work and the isentropic and actual discharge enthalpies for an 80%
efficient pump with an 80F saturated-liquid inlet and an exit pressure of 3000 psia.
Solution
From the saturated-liquid tables, for 80F, the pump inlet conditions are 0.5068 psia,
48.037 Btu/lb
m
, and 0.016072 ft
3
/lb
m
.
Using Equation (2.9), we find that the pump work is
w
p
= [0.016072(0.5068 3000)(144)]/0.8 = 8677 ft-lb
f
/ lb
m
or
w
p
= 8677/778 = 11.15 Btu/lb
m.
Note the importance of checking units here.
The actual discharge enthalpy is
h
4
= h
3
w
p
= 48.037 (11.15) = 59.19 Btu/lb
m.

and the isentropic discharge enthalpy is
h
4s
= h
3

p
w
p
= 48.037 (0.8)( 11.15) = 56.96 Btu/lb
m.
____________________________________________________________________
EXAMPLE 2.4
What is the turbine work, the net work, the work ratio, and the cycle thermal efficiency
for the conditions of Example 2.1 if the turbine efficiency is 90% and the pump
efficiency is 85%? What is the turbine exit quality?
Solution
By the definition of isentropic efficiency, the turbine work is 90% of the isentropic
turbine work = (0.9)(603.1) = 542.8 Btu/lb
m.
By using Equation (2.9), the isentropic pump work is
[(0.01614)(1 2000)(144)] / 778 = 5.97 Btu/lb
m.
48
The actual pump work is then 5.97/.85 = 7.03 Btu/lb
m
and the work ratio is
542.8/| 7.03| = 77.2
The cycle net work is w
t
+ w
p
= 542.8 7.03 = 535.8 Btu/lb
m.
.
Applying the steady-flow First Law of Thermodynamics to the pump, we get the
enthalpy entering the steam generator to be
h
4
= h
3
w
p
= 69.73 ( 7.03) = 76.76 Btu/lb
m.
The steam-generator heat addition is then reduced to 1474.1 76.76 = 1397.3
Btu/lb
m.
and the cycle efficiency is 535.8/1397.3 = 0.383. Study of these examples
shows that the sizable reduction in cycle efficiency from that in Example 2.1 is largely
due to the turbine inefficiency, not to the neglect of pump work.
From Equation (2.6), the true turbine exit enthalpy is the difference between the
throttle enthalpy and actual turbine work = 1474.1 - 542.8 = 931.3 Btu/lb
m.
The quality is then x = (h
2
h
l
)/(h
v
h
l
) = (931.3 69.73)/(1105.8 69.73) =
0.832.
Thus the turbine inefficiency increases the turbine exhaust quality over the
isentropic turbine value of 0.774.
____________________________________________________________________
2.5 Reheat and Reheat Cycles
A common modification of the Rankine cycle in large power plants involves
interrupting the steam expansion in the turbine to add more heat to the steam before
completing the turbine expansion, a process known as reheat. As shown in Figure 2.6,
steam from the high-pressure (HP) turbine is returned to the reheat section of the steam
generator through the "cold reheat" line. There the steam passes through heated tubes
which restore it to a temperature comparable to the throttle temperature of the high
pressure turbine. The reenergized steam then is routed through the "hot reheat" line to
a low-pressure turbine for completion of the expansion to the condenser pressure.
Examination of the T-s diagram shows that reheat increases the area enclosed by
the cycle and thus increases the net work of the cycle by virtue of the cyclic integral,
Equation (1.3). This is significant, because for a given design power output higher net
work implies lower steam flow rate. This, in turn, implies that smaller plant components
may be used, which tends to reduce the initial plant cost and to compensate for added
costs due to the increased complexity of the cycle.
Observe from Figure 2.6 that the use of reheat also tends to increase the average
temperature at which heat is added. If the low-pressure turbine exhaust state is
superheated, the use of reheat may also increase the average temperature at which heat
is rejected. The thermal efficiency may therefore increase or decrease, depending on
specific cycle conditions. Thus the major benefits of reheat are increased net work,
49
drying of the turbine exhaust (discussed further later), and the possibility of improved
cycle efficiency.
Note that the net work of the reheat cycle is the algebraic sum of the work of the
two turbines and the pump work. Note also that the total heat addition is the sum of the
heat added in the feedwater and reheat passes through the steam generator. Thus the
50
thermal efficiency of the reheat cycle is:
(h
1
h
2
) + (h
3
h
4
) + (h
5
h
6
)

th
= ----------------------------------- [dl] (2.10)
(h
1
h
6
) + (h
3
h
2
)
Relations such as this illustrate the wisdom of learning to analyze cycles using
definitions and applying fundamentals to components rather than memorizing equations
for special cases such as Equation (2.5) for the efficiency of the simple Rankine cycle.
Note that the inclusion of reheat introduces a third pressure level to the Rankine
cycle. Determination of a suitable reheat pressure level is a significant design problem
that entails a number of considerations. The cycle efficiency, the net work, and other
parameters will vary with reheat pressure level for given throttle and condenser
conditions. One of these may be numerically optimized by varying reheat pressure level
while holding all other design conditions constant.
Reheat offers the ability to limit or eliminate moisture at the turbine exit. The
presence of more than about 10% moisture in the turbine exhaust can cause erosion of
blades near the turbine exit and reduce energy conversion efficiency. Study of Figure
2.6 shows that reheat shifts the turbine expansion process away from the two-phase
region and toward the superheat region of the T-s diagram, thus drying the turbine
exhaust.
EXAMPLE 2.5
Reanalyze the cycle of Example 2.1 (2000 psia/1000F/1 psia) with reheat at 200 psia
included. Determine the quality or degree of superheat at the exits of both turbines.
Assume that reheat is to the HP turbine throttle temperature.
Solution
Referring to Figure 2.6, we see that the properties of significant states are the
following:
State Temperature
(F)
Pressure
(psia)
Entropy
(Btu/lb
m
-R)
Enthalpy
(Btu/lb
m
)
1 1000.0 2000 1.5603 1474.1
2 400.0 200 1.5603 1210.0
3 1000.0 200 1.84 1527.0
4 101.74 1 1.84 1028.0
5 101.74 1 0.1326 69.73
6 101.74 2000 0.1326 69.73
51
Properties here are obtained from the steam tables and the Mollier chart as follows:
1. The enthalpy and entropy at state 1 are read from the superheated-steam tables
at the given throttle temperature and pressure.
2. State 2 is evaluated from the Mollier diagram at the given reheat pressure and
the same entropy as in state 1 for the isentropic turbine expansion.
3. Reheat at constant pressure p
3
= p
2
to the assumed throttle temperature T
3
= T
1
gives s
3
and h
3
. Normally, T
3
is assumed equal to T
1
unless otherwise specified.
4. The second turbine flow is also specified as isentropic with expansion at s
4
= s
3
to the known condenser pressure p
4
.
5. The condenser exit (pump entrance) state is assumed to be a saturated liquid at
the known condenser pressure.
6. Pump work is neglected here. The steady-flow First Law then implies that
h
6
= h
5
, which in turn implies the T
6
= T
5
.
The turbine work is the sum of the work of both turbines:
(1474.1 - 1210) + (1527 - 1028) = 763.1 Btu/lb
m
.
The heat added in the steam generator feedwater and reheat passes is
(1474.1 - 69.73) + (1527 - 1210) = 1721.4 Btu/lb
m
.
The thermal efficiency then is 763.1/1721.4 = 0.443, or 44.3%.
Both the net work and the cycle efficiency are higher than in the simple Rankine
cycle case of Example 2.1. From the Mollier chart in Appendix B it is readily seen that
state 2 is superheated, with 400 - 381.8 = 18.2 Fahrenheit degrees of superheat; and
state 4 is wet steam, with 7.4% moisture, or 0.926 (92.6%) quality. Thus the first
turbine has no moisture and the second is substantially drier than 0.774 quality value in
Example 2.1.
____________________________________________________________________
Reheat is an important feature of all large, modern fossil-fueled steam power plants.
We now consider another key feature of these plants, but temporarily omit reheat, for
the purpose of clarity.
2.6 Regeneration and Feedwater Heaters
The significant efficiency advantage of the Carnot cycle over the Rankine cycle is due
to the fact that in the Carnot cycle all external heat addition is at a single high
52
temperature and all external heat rejection at a single low temperature. Examination of
Figures 2.2 and 2.6 shows that heat addition in the steam generator takes place over a
wide range of water temperature in both the simple and reheat Rankine cycles.
Presumably, the Rankine-cycle thermal efficiency could be improved by increasing the
average water temperature at which heat is received. This could be accomplished by an
internal transfer of heat from higher-temperature steam to low-temperature feedwater.
An internal transfer of heat that reduces or eliminates low-temperature additions of
external heat to the working fluid is known as regeneration.
Open Feedwater Heaters
Regeneration is accomplished in all large-scale, modern power plants through the use
of feedwater heaters. A feedwater heater (FWH) is a heat exchanger in which the latent
heat (and sometimes superheat) of small amounts of steam is used to increase the
temperature of liquid water (feedwater) flowing to the steam generator. This provides
the internal transfer of heat mentioned above.
An open feedwater heater is a FWH in which a small amount of steam mixes
directly with the feedwater to raise its temperature. Steam drawn from a turbine for
feedwater heating or other purposes is called extraction steam. Feedwater heaters in
which extraction steam heats feedwater without fluid contact will be discussed later.
Consider the regenerative Rankine-cycle presented in Figure 2.7. The steam
leaving the high-pressure (HP) turbine is split with a small part of the mass flow
extracted to an open FWH and the major part of the flow passing to a low pressure
(LP) turbine. The T-s diagram shows that steam entering the FWH at state 2 is at a
higher temperature than the subcooled feedwater leaving the pump at state 5. When the
two fluids mix in the FWH, the superheat and the heat of vaporization of the extraction
steam are transferred to the feedwater, which emerges with the condensed extraction
steam at a higher temperature, T
6.
. It is assumed that all streams entering and leaving
the FWH are the same pressure so that the mixing process occurs at constant pressure.
The T-s and flow diagrams show that heat from combustion gases in the steam
generator need only raise the water temperature from T
7
to T
1
rather than from T
5
when
extraction steam is used to heat the feedwater. The average temperature for external
heat addition must therefore increase. Despite the reduced flow rate through the low-
pressure turbine, we will see by example that the thermal efficiency of the steam cycle is
improved by the transfer of energy from the turbine extraction flow to the feedwater.
The analysis of cycles with feedwater heaters involves branching of steam flows.
In Figure 2.7, for example, conservation of mass must be satisfied at the flow junction
downstream of the high-pressure-turbine exit. Thus, assuming a mass flow of 1 at the
HP turbine throttle and a steam mass-flow fraction, m
1
, through the feedwater heater,
the low-pressure-turbine mass-fraction must be 1 - m
1
. Note that the latter flow passes
through the condenser and pump and is reunited with the extraction flow, m
1
, in the
FWH at state 6, where the exit-flow-rate fraction is again unity.
53
It will be seen later that it is common for more than one FWH to be used in a
single power plant. When more than one FWH is present, mass flows m
1
, m
2
...m
n
are
defined for each of the n FWHs. Conservation of mass is used to relate these flows to
54
condenser flow rate and the reference throttle flow rate. This is accomplished by taking
a mass flow of 1 at the high-pressure-turbine throttle as a reference, as in the case of a
single FWH discussed above. After solving for each of the thermodynamic states and
FWH mass fractions, actual mass flow rates are obtained as the products of the known
(or assumed) throttle flow rate and FWH mass-flow fractions.
The function of feedwater heaters is to use the energy of extraction steam to
reduce the addition of low-temperature external heat by raising the temperature of the
feedwater before it arrives at the steam generator. Feedwater heaters are therefore
insulated to avoid heat loss to the surroundings. Because the resulting heat loss is
negligible compared with the energy throughflow, feedwater heaters are usually treated
as adiabatic devices.
In order to avoid irreversibility associated with unrestrained expansion, constant
pressure mixing of the streams entering the FWH is necessary. Returning to Figure 2.7,
this implies that the pressures of the feedwater at state 5 and at the FWH exit state 6
are chosen to be the same as that of the extraction steam at state 2.
Note that, as with reheat, the inclusion of a FWH also introduces an additional
pressure level into the Rankine cycle as seen in the T-s diagram. In the figure, the
extraction pressure level, p
2
, is another parameter under the control of the designer.
The extraction mass flow rate, m
1
, is in turn controlled by the designers choice of p
2
.
The mass-flow rate is determined by the physical requirement that the feedwater
entering the FWH at state 5 increase in temperature to T
6
through absorption of the
heat released by the condensing extraction steam. This is accomplished by applying the
steady-flow First Law of Thermodynamics, using appropriate mass fractions, to the
insulated open FWH:
q = 0 = (1)h
6
m
1
h
2
(1 m
1
)h
5
+ 0 [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg]
Every term in this equation has dimensions of energy per unit throttle mass, thus
referring all energy terms to the mass-flow rate at the throttle of the high-pressure
turbine. For example, the second term on the right is of the form:
FWH Extraction mass Enthalpy at state 2 Enthalpy at state 2
-------------------------- -------------------------- = ----------------------
Throttle mass FWH Extraction mass Throttle mass
Similarly, the structure of the third term on the right has the significance of
Pump mass Enthalpy at state 5 Enthalpy at state 5
---------------- --------------------- = ----------------------
Throttle mass Pump mass Throttle mass
55
Solving for the extraction mass fraction, we obtain
m
1
= (h
6
h
5
) / (h
2
h
5
) [dl] (2.11)
For low extraction pressures, the numerator is usually small relative to the
denominator, indicating a small extraction flow. The T-s diagram of Figure 2.7 shows
that increasing the extraction pressure level increases both h
6
and h
2
. Thus, because the
small numerator increases faster than the large denominator, we may reason, from
Equation (2.11), that the extraction mass-flow fraction must increase as the extraction
pressure level increases. This conforms to the physical notion that suggests the need
for more and hotter steam to increase the feedwater temperature rise. While such
intuitions are valuable, care should be exercised in accepting them without proof.
The total turbine work per unit throttle mass flow rate is the sum of the work of
the turbines referenced to the throttle mass-flow rate. Remembering that 1 - m
1
is the
ratio of the low-pressure turbine mass flow to the throttle mass flow, we obtain:
w
t
= (h
1
h
2
) + (1 m
1
)(h
2
h
3
) [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (2.12)

The reader should examine the structure of each term of Equation (2.12) in the light of
the previous discussion. Note that it is not important to remember these specific
equations, but it is important to understand, and be able to apply, the reasoning by
which they are obtained.
For a given throttle mass flow rate, m
thr
[lb
m
/s | kg/s], the total turbine power
output is given by m
thr
w
t
[Btu/s | kW].
We see in Figure 2.7 that the heat addition in the steam generator is reduced, due
to extraction at pressure p
6
= p
2
, by about h
7
h
5
to
q
a
= h
1
h
7
[Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (2.13)
At the same time, the net work also decreases, but more slowly, so that the net effect is
that the cycle efficiency increases with increased extraction.
EXAMPLE 2.6
Solve Example 2.1 (2000 psia /1000F/1 psia) operating with an open feedwater heater
at 200 psia.
Solution
Referring to Figure 2.7, we find that the properties of significant states are:
56
State Temperature
(F)
Pressure
(psia)
Entropy
(Btu/lb
m
-R)
Enthalpy
(Btu/lb
m
)
1 1000.0 2000 1.5603 1474.1
2 400.0 200 1.5603 1210.0
3 101.74 1 1.5603 871.0
4 101.74 1 0.1326 69.73
5 101.74 200 0.1326 69.73
6 381.8 200 0.5438 355.5
7 381.8 2000 0.5438 355.5
States 1 through 4 are obtained in the same way as in earlier examples. Constant
pressure mixing requires that p
5
= p
6
= p
2
, the extraction pressure level. State 6, a
pump entrance state, is assumed to be a saturated-liquid state as usual. Subcooled-
liquid states are approximated, as before, consistent with the neglect of pump work.
The extraction mass fraction obtained by applying the steady-flow First Law of
Thermodynamics to the FWH, Equation (2.11), is
m
1
= (355.5 69.73)/(1210 69.73) = 0.251.
The net work (neglecting pump work) by Equation (2.12), is then
w
n
= (1474.1 1210) + (1 0.251)(1210 871) = 518.1 Btu/lb
m
This may be compared with the simple-cycle net work of 603.1 Btu/lb
m
.
The heat added in the steam generator by Equation (2.13) is
q
a
= h
1
h
7
= 1474.1 355.5 = 1118.6 Btu/lb
m
.
The resulting cycle efficiency is
th
= 518.1/1118.6 = 0.463, or 46.3%, a
significantly higher value than the 42.94% for the corresponding simple Rankine cycle.
Note, however, that the LP-turbine exhaust quality is the same as for the simple
Rankine cycle, an unacceptable 77.4%. This suggests that a combination of reheat and
regeneration through feedwater heating may be desirable. We will investigate this
possibility later after looking at closed feedwater heaters.
_____________________________________________________________________
Closed Feedwater Heaters
We have seen that feedwater heating in open feedwater heaters occurs by mixing of
extraction steam and feedwater. Feedwater heating also is accomplished in shell-and-
57
tube-type heat exchangers, where extraction steam does not mix with the feedwater.
Normally, feedwater passes through banks of tubes whereas steam condenses on the
outside of the tube surfaces in these heaters. Such heat exchangers are called closed
feedwater heaters.
Pumped Condensate. Closed feedwater heaters normally are employed in two
configurations in power plants. In the configuration shown in figure 2.8, condensate is
pumped from the condenser through the FWH and the steam generator directly to the
turbine along the path 4-5-8-9-1. Ideally, p
5
= p
1
assuming no pressure drop in the
FWH and steam generator.
Note that if m
1
mass units of steam are extracted from the turbine for use in the
FWH, only 1 - m
1
units of feedwater pass throught the condenser, pump, and the tubes
of the FWH. The condensed extraction steam (condensate) emerging from the FWH at
state 6 is pumped separately from p
6
= p
2
to throttle pressure p
7
= p
1
, where it becomes
part of the steam generator feedwater. The pumped condensate at state 7 thus mixes
with the heated feedwater at state 8 to form the total feedwater flow at state 9.
Constant pressure mixing ( p
7
= p
8
= p
9
) is required at this junction to avoid losses
associated with uncontrolled flow expansion.
The enthalpy of the feedwater entering the steam generator can be determined by
applying the steady-flow First Law of Thermodynamics to the junction of the feedwater
and FWH streams:
h
9
= (1 m
1
)h
8
+ m
1
h
7
[Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg]
As in the open FWH analysis, the extraction mass fraction depends on the choice
of intermediate pressure p
2
and is obtained by applying the steady-flow First Law of
Thermodynamics to the feedwater heater.
Throttled Condensate. The second closed FWH configuration is shown in Figure
2.9 where the FWH condensate drops in pressure from p
6
= p
2
through a trap into the
condenser at pressure p
7
= p
3
= p
4
. The trap allows liquid only to pass from the FWH at
state 6 in a throttling process to state 7. As usual, it is assumed that the throttling
process is adiabatic. The T-s diagram shows that the saturated liquid at state 6 flashes
into a mixture of liquid and vapor in the condenser with no change in enthalpy, h
7
= h
6
.
For this configuration, the closed FWH condensate mass-flow rate is equal to the
extraction mass-flow rate. As a result, conservation of mass applied to the condenser
shows that the mass-flow rate leaving the condenser and passing through the pump and
FWH tubes is the same as the throttle mass-flow rate. The throttled-condensate, closed
feedwater heater is the preferred configuration in power plants, because it is
unnecessary for each FWH to have a condensate pump.
58
59
60
EXAMPLE 2.7
Rework Example 2.1 (2000 psia/1000F/1 psia) with reheat and a closed feedwater
heater with extraction from the cold reheat line and FWH condensate throttled to the
condenser. Both reheat and extraction are at 200 psia. Assume that the feedwater
leaving the FWH is at the temperature of the condensing extraction stream. Draw
appropriate T-s and flow diagrams.
Solution
Referring to the notation of Figure 2.10, verify that the significant the
thermodynamic state properties are:
State Temperature
(F)
Pressure
(psia)
Entropy
(Btu/lb
m
-R)
Enthalpy
(Btu/lb
m
)
1 1000.0 2000 1.5603 1474.1
2 400.0 200 1.5603 1210.0
3 1000.0 200 1.84 1527.0
4 101.74 1 1.84 1028.0
5 101.74 1 0.1326 69.73
6 101.74 2000 0.1326 69.73
7 381.8 200 0.5438 355.5
8 101.74 1 __ 355.5
9 381.8 2000 __ 355.5
Applying the steady-flow First Law of Thermodynamics to the FWH, we obtain:

0 = h
9
+ m
1
h
7
m
1
h
2
h
6
+ 0
which, solved for m
1
, yields:
m
1
= ( h
9
h
6
)/( h
2
h
7
) = (355.5 69.73)/(1210 355.5) = 0.3344
The total net work per unit of mass flow at the throttle of the HP turbine is the sum of
the specific work of each of the turbines adjusted for the HP turbine throttle mass flow:
w
n
= h
1
h
2
+ (1 m
1
)( h
3
h
4
)
= 1474.1 1210 + (1 0.3344)(1527 1028) = 596.2 Btu/lb
m
61
62
As in the earlier examples in this series, pump work has been neglected.
The heat addition per unit HP-turbine-throttle mass is the sum of the heat addition
in the main pass and reheat pass through the steam generator, the latter as adjusted for
the reduced mass flow. Thus the steady-flow First Law of Thermodynamics yields
q
a
= h
1
h
9
+ (1 m
1
)( h
3
h
2
)
= 1474.1 355.5 + (1 0.3344)(1527 1210) = 1329.6 Btu/lb
m
The thermal efficiency of the cycle is w
n
/ q
a
= 596.2 / 1329.6 = 0.448, or 44.8%.
The Mollier chart shows that the discharge of the first turbine (state 2) has 20
degrees of superheat and the second turbine (state 4) 7.4% moisture, or a quality of
0.926.
___________________________________________________________________
In the above calculation it was assumed that the feedwater temperature leaving the
FWH had risen to the temperature of the condensing extraction steam. Since the FWH
is a heat exchanger of finite area, the feedwater temperature T
9
usually differs from the
condensing temperature of the extraction steam T
7
. If the surface area of the FWH is
small, the feedwater will emerge at a temperature well below the extraction-steam
condensing temperature. If the area were increased, the feedwater temperature would
approach the condensing temperature. This aspect of FWH design is reflected in the
parameter known as the terminal temperature difference, TTD, defined as
TTD = T
sat
- T
fw
[R | K]
where T
fw
is the temperature of the feedwater leaving the tubes and T
sat
is the
condensing temperature of the extraction steam in the closed FWH. In Figure 2.10, for
instance, T
fw
= T
9
and T
sat
= T
7
. Thus, if the TTD and the extraction pressure are
known, the true FWH exit temperature may be determined. An application of the TTD
will be considered in a later example.
Table 2.1 summarizes, for comparison, the results of the calculations for the
several plant configurations that we have considered. The reader is cautioned that since
these calculations have not accounted for turbine inefficiency, the thermal efficiencies
are unusually high. While the efficiency differences with respect to the simple cycle may
seem insignificant, they are of great economic importance. It must be realized that
hundreds of millions of dollars may be spent on fuel each year in a power plant and that
capital costs are equally impressive. As a result, the choice of cycle and design
characteristics are of great significance. Some further improvement in net work and
efficiency could be shown by selecting extraction and reheat pressure levels to
maximize these parameters.
63

Table 2.1 Comparison of Rankine Cycle Modifications
Net Work
(Btu/lb
m
)
Efficiency
%
Heat Rate
(Btu/kW-hr)
Turbine Exit
Quality
Simple cycle 603.1 42.9 7956 0.774
Reheat cycle 763.1 44.3 7704 0.926
One open FWH 518.1 46.3 7371 0.774
One closed FWH
and reheat
596.2 44.8 7618 0.926
Multistage Extraction
It has been shown that increases in cycle efficiency may be accomplished in a steam
power plant through regeneration via the feedwater heater. Large steam power plants
typically employ large numbers of feedwater heaters for this purpose. Multistage
extraction refers to the use of multiple extractions to supply steam to these feedwater
heaters. Earlier discussions of examples involved extractions taken only from the flows
between turbines. However, the number of extractions is not limited by the number of
turbines. In fact, large turbines are designed with several extraction points through
which steam may be withdrawn for feedwater heating and other purposes.
Assigning Extraction-Pressure Levels. Given n feedwater heaters, it is necessary to
assign values to the n associated extraction pressures. For preliminary design purposes,
the extraction-pressure levels assigned may be those that give equal feedwater
temperature rises through each heater and through the steam generator to the boiling
point. Thus, for n heaters the appropriate temperature rise is given by
T
opt
= ( T
sl
T
cond
)/( n + 1) [R | K] (2.14)
where T
sl
is the temperature the saturated liquid at the throttle pressure and T
cond
is the
temperature the feedwater leaving the condenser. The corresponding steam condensing
temperature in the ith heater is then
T
i
= T
cond
+ ( i )T
opt

= T
cond
+ i ( T
sl
T
cond
)/( n + 1) [R | K] (2.15)
where i = 1, 2..., n. Steam tables may then be used to evaluate the corresponding
extraction-pressure levels. It is, of course, possible and sometimes necessary to assign
extraction-pressure levels in other ways.
64
EXAMPLE 2.8
Evaluate the recommended extraction-pressure levels for single heater for the
1000 F/2000 psia throttle and one psia condenser that have been used throughout this
chapter.
Solution
The feedwater temperature rise to establish an appropriate extraction-pressure
level for a single heater for a plant such as that shown in Figures 2.7 through 2.9 is
(T
sl
T
4
)/2 = (635.8 101.74)/2 = 267.05F where T
sl
was evaluated at p
1
= 2000
psia. This would make T
6
= 101.74 + 267.05 = 368.79F and the corresponding
extraction pressure level p
6
= p
2
= 171 psia, using the saturated-steam tables.
____________________________________________________________________
At this point we have the tools necessary to evaluate the performance and penalties
associated with a given configuration. The following example examines the gains that
follow from the use a single feedwater heater and the sensitivity of the thermal
efficiency to the assigned feedwater temperature rise.
EXAMPLE 2.9
Consider a single open feedwater heater operating in a Rankine cycle with a 2000 psia
saturated-vapor throttle and a 1 psia condenser. Evaluate the thermal efficiency as a
function of feedwater temperature rise. Compare the temperature rise that maximizes
the thermal efficiency with the results of Equation (2.14).
Solution
Utilizing the notation of Figure 2.7 and taking the throttle state as a saturated vapor,
we get the results that are summarized in spreadsheet format in Table 2.2. (This table is
a direct reproduction of a Quattro Pro spreadsheet used in the analysis. Care should be
taken if this spreadsheet is used for "what if" studies, because it is dependent on manual
entry of thermodynamic properties. To explore other cases, appropriate properties must
be obtained from steam tables or charts and inserted in the spreadsheet. Despite this
drawback, the spreadsheet provides a convenient means of organizing, performing, and
displaying calculations.) Details of the methodology are given in the right-most column.
It is seen that the net work drops, as expected, as more extraction steam is used to heat
the feedwater. Figure 2.11 shows the percentage increase in thermal efficiency as a
function of the feedwater temperature rise for this case. Over a 9% increase in thermal
efficiency is achieved with feedwater temperature rises between 200F and 300F.
Thus the prediction of T
opt
= 267F using Equation (2.14) in Example 2.8 is clearly in
this range.
_____________________________________________________________________
65
Example 2.9 shows that improved thermal efficiency is achieved over a broad range of
feedwater temperature rise and therefore extraction pressure. This gives the designer
freedom to assign extraction-pressure levels so as to make use of existing designs for
feedwater heaters and turbines without severely compromising the efficiency of the
plant design.
Calculation Methodology. Once the extraction- and reheat-pressure levels are
established for a cycle with multistage extraction, and once throttle and condenser
conditions, turbomachine efficiencies, and FWH terminal temperature differences are
known, significant state properties should be determined. Symbols for extraction
mass-fraction variables should be assigned for each heater and related to other
unknown flows using mass conservation assuming unit mass flow at the high-
pressure-turbine throttle. The steady-flow First Law of Thermodynamics should then
be applied to each of the FWHs, starting with the highest extraction pressure and
progressing to the lowest-pressure FWH. Analyzing the heaters in this order allows
each equation to be solved immediately for a mass fraction rather than solving all of
the equations simultaneously. Important performance parameters such as thermal
efficiency, net work, and work ratio may then be evaluated taking care to account
properly for component mass flows. The following example illustrates this
methodology.
66
67
EXAMPLE 2.10
Consider a power plant with 1000F/2000-psia throttle, reheat at 200 psia back to
1000F, and 1-psia condenser pressure. The plant has two closed feedwater heaters,
both with terminal temperature differences of 8F. The high-pressure (HP) heater
condensate is throttled into the low-pressure (LP) heater, which in turn drains into the
condenser. Turbomachine efficiencies are 0.88, 0.9, and 0.8 for the HP turbine, the LP
turbine, and the boiler feed pump, respectively. Draw relevant T-s and flow diagrams
and evaluate FWH mass fractions, thermal efficiency, net work, and work ratio.
Solution
The notation used to study this plant is shown in Figure 2.12. The pertinent
thermodynamic properties and part of the analysis are presented in the spreadsheet
given in Table 2.3. The earlier-stated caution (Example 2.9) about using spreadsheets
that incorporate external data applies here as well, because changing parameters may
require changes in steam-table lookup values.
To start the analysis we first determine the extraction-pressure levels. The ideal
FWH temperature rise is given by
( T
sl
T
7
)/3 = ( 635.8 101.74)/3 = 178.02F
where the saturation temperature is evaluated at the HP-turbine throttle pressure of
2000 psia. The corresponding extraction condensing temperatures and extraction-
pressure levels are

101.74 + 178.02 = 280F $ p
9
= p
5
= 49 psia
and
101.74 + (2)(178.02) = 457.8F $ p
12
= p
2
= 456 psia
where the extraction pressures have been evaluated using the saturated-steam tables.
After the entropy and enthalpy at state 1 are evaluated, the enthalpy h
3s
at the HP-
turbine isentropic discharge state 3s is determined from s
1
and p
3
. The HP-turbine
efficiency then yields h
3
and the steam tables give s
3
. The entropy and enthalpy at the
HP-turbine extraction state 2 may be approximated by drawing a straight line on the
steam Mollier diagram connecting states 1 and 3 and finding the intersection with the
HP-extraction pressure P
2
. This technique may be used for any number of extraction
points in a turbine.
Once the hot reheat properties at state 4 are determined from the steam tables, the
LP-turbine exit and extraction states at 6 and 5 may be obtained by the same method
used for the HP turbine.
68
69
The determination of the FWH condensate temperatures and pressures at states 9
and 12 have already been discussed. The temperatures of the heated feedwater leaving
the FWHs may be determined from the terminal temperature differences:
T
11
= T
9
- TTD = 281 - 8 = 273F
T
14
= T
12
- TTD = 457.5 - 8 = 449.5F
Recalling that the enthalpy of a subcooled liquid is almost independent of pressure, we
note that the enthalpies h
11
and h
14
may be found in the saturated-liquid tables at T
11
and
T
14
, respectively.
70
The pump discharge state 8 is a subcooled-liquid state, which may be
approximated in the same way as in Examples 2.3 and 2.4. Thus
h
8s
= h
7
+ ( p
8
p
7
)v
7

= 69.7 + (2000 1)(144)(0.016136)/778 = 75.7 Btu/lb
m
and
h
8
= h
7
+ ( h
8s
h
7
)/
p
= 69.7 + (75.7 69.7)/0.8 = 77.2 Btu/lb
m
The pump work is then
w
p
= h
7
h
8
= 69.7 77.2 = 7.5 Btu/lb
m
The extraction mass-flow fractions designated m
1
and m
2
relate other flows to the
unit mass flow at the high-pressure-turbine throttle. For example, the condensate flow
rate from the LP heater at state 10 is given by m
1
+ m
2
.
The steady-flow First Law of Thermodynamics may now be applied to the heaters.
For the HP FWH:
0 = m
1
h
12
+ (1)h
14
m
1
h
2
(1)h
ll
may be rewritten as
m
1
= ( h
14
h
ll
)/( h
2
h
12
) [dl]
This and the T-s diagram show that the HP extraction-flow enthalpy drop from
state 2 to state 12 provides the heat to raise the enthalpy in the feedwater from state 11
to state 14. Also, for the LP FWH:
0 = (1)h
ll
+ (m
2

+ m
1
)h
9

(1)h
8

m
2
h
5
m
l
h
l3
becomes
m
2
= [ m
1
( h
9
- h
13
) + h
11
h
8
]/( h
5
h
9
) [dl]
This and the T-s diagram show that the discharge from the HP FWH at state 13 aids
the mass flow m
2
in heating the LP FWH flow from state 8 to state 11. The values of
m
1
and m
2
are evaluated at the bottom of spreadsheet in Table 2.3.
71
With all states and flows known, we may now determine some plant performance
parameters. The turbine work referenced to the throttle mass-flow rate is easily
obtained by summing the flow contributions through each section of the turbines:
w
t
= h
1
h
2
+ (1 m
l
)( h
2
h
3
) + (1 m
l
)( h
4
h
5
)
+ (1 m
l
m
2
)( h
5
h
6
) [Btu/lb
m
| kJ /kg]
The net work is then w
t
+ w
p
, and the heat added in the steam generator is the sum of
heat additions in the feedwater pass and the reheat pass:
q
a
= h
1
- h
14
+ (1 - m
l
)( h
4
- h
3
) [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg]
These parameters and the work ratio are evaluated in Table 2.3.
____________________________________________________________________
Example 2.10 shows that a good thermal efficiency and net work output are
possible with the use of two feedwater heaters despite taking into account realistic
turbomachine inefficiencies. The high work ratio clearly demonstrates the low-
compression work requirements of Rankine cycles.
2.7 A Study of a Modern Steam Power Plant
Modern steam power plants incorporate both reheat and feedwater heating. A
flowsheet for the Public Service Company of Oklahoma (PSO) Riverside Station Unit
#1, south of Tulsa, is shown in Figure 2.13. This natural-gas-burning plant was sized
for two nominal 500-megawatt units. Several other plants in the PSO system have
similar unit flowsheets, including a coal-burning plant. Note the flowsheet coding W, H,
F, and A for flow rate in lb
m
/hr, enthalpy in Btu/lb
m
, temperature in F, and pressure in
psia, respectively.
The steam generator, not shown on the flowsheet, interacts through the feedwater
and steam lines on the right-hand side of the diagram. The high pressure turbine throttle
is at 1000F and 3349 psia and has a mass-flow rate of 2,922,139 lb
m
/hr. This type of
unit is called supercritical, because the pressure in the main steam line to the HP-
turbine throttle exceeds the 3208.2-psia critical pressure of steam. Note that a large
fraction of the HP-turbine mass-flow rate enters the cold reheat line at 630 psia and is
reheated to the intermediate-pressure (IP) turbine throttle conditions of 1000F and
567 psia.
Most of the steam flow through the IP turbine passes through the crossover at 186
psia to the double-flow low-pressure (DFLP) turbine. The term double-flow refers to
the fact that the incoming flow enters at the middle, splits, and flows axially in opposite
72
73
directions through the turbine. This causes the large axial force components on the
blades and shaft to oppose each other so that the resultant axial thrust is small and does
not necessitate heavy thrust bearings. The combined HP and IP turbines are similarly
configured.
The plant is equipped with six closed FWHs and one open FWH (the deaerator).
Note that the condensate of each of the closed feedwater heaters is throttled to the next
lowest pressure FWH or, in the case of the lowest-pressure heater, to the condenser.
The extraction steam for the four lowest-pressure FWHs flows from the DFLP turbine.
Extraction steam for the highest pressure FWH is provided by the HP turbine, and the
IP turbine supplies heater HTR1-6 and the open feedwater heater identified as the
deaerator. The deaerator is specially designed to remove non-condensable gases from
the system, in addition to performing its feedwater heating duties.
The feedwater starts at the "hot well" of the condenser on the left of the diagram,
enters the condensate pump at 101.1F and 2"Hg abs., and starts its passage through
the FWHs. Note that the feedwater increases in temperature from 102.1 to 180,
227.2, 282.7, and 314.4 in passing through the 4 lowest pressure FWHs. The
feedwater from the deaerator is pumped to 405 psia by the booster pump and
subsequently to 3933 psia by the boiler feed pump (BFP). The BFP exit pressure
exceeds the HP-turbine throttle pressure of 3349 psia in order to overcome flow losses
in the high pressure heater, the boiler feed line, the steam generator main steam pass,
and the main steam line, all of which operate at supercritical pressure.
The boiler feed pump turbine (BFPT) shown in the upper left of the diagram
supplies the shaft power to drive the BFP at the lower right. The BFPT receives steam
from an extraction line of the DFLP turbine and exhausts directly to the condenser.
The reader should study Figure 2.13 thoroughly in the light of the preceding
discussions of reheat and feedwater heating. It is particularly useful to consider the flow
rates with respect to mass and energy conservation. Mastery of this flow sheet will
make it possible to quickly understand flowsheets of other major power plants.

Example 2.11
Verify that the steam generator feedwater flow rate satisfies the conservation of mass
into all the feedwater heaters shown for the Riverside Unit #1 in Figure 2.13. You may
neglect all flows of less than 2000 lb
m
/hr.
Solution
The shell side of the low pressure heater, labeled HTR1-1, receives condensate
from heaters 2, 3 and 4 as well as steam entering from the LP turbine. The total
condensate from the low-pressure heaters into the condenser are:
74
Source Flow rate, lb
m
/hr
_______________________________________________
Condensate from HTR1-4 75,005
Extraction steam into HTR1-3 125,412
Extraction steam into HTR1-2 102,897
----------
Total condensate into HTR1-1 303,314
Extraction steam into HTR1-1 157,111
---------
Total condensate leaving HTR1-1 460,425
The feedwater flow rate through the four low-pressure heaters (the condenser
condensate pump flow rate) is the sum of the flows into the condenser:
460,425 + 162,701 + 1,812,971 = 2,436,097 lb
m
/hr.
An easier approach to evaluating this flow rate is by imagining a control volume
around the entire left side of the diagram that cuts it in two parts between the deaerator
and HTR1-4 and through the crossover steam line. Because these are the only points
where the control volume is penetrated by large mass flows, the two flows must be
equal. Consequently the crossover mass-flow rate of 2,434,357 lb
m
/hr agrees very well
with our above calculation of the feedwater flow rate into the deaerator.
Now, observing that the boiler feedwater all flows from the deaerator through the
booster pump, we sum all of the flows into the deaerator:
Feedwater into deaerator 2,434,357
Steam to deaerator 148,321
Steam to HTR1-6 107,661
Steam to HTR1-7 222,876
-----------
Total feedwater into HTR1-7 2,913,215 lb
m
/hr
This compares well with the tabulated value of 2,922,139 lb
m
/hr to the steam
generator. Accounting for the small flows should improve the agreement.
______________________________________________________________
75
2.8 Deviations from the Ideal - Pressure Losses

It is evident from study of Figure 2.13 that there are significant pressure drops in the
flows through the steam generator between the HP FWH and the HP-turbine throttle
and in the reheat line between the HP and IP turbines. While we have neglected such
losses in our calculations, final design analysis requires their consideration. A first
attempt at this may be made by applying a fractional pressure drop based on
experience. Two per cent pressure drops through the main steam and feedwater lines
and a 3.7% loss through the steam generator would, for instance, account for the
indicated 14.8% loss from the boiler feed pump to the HP turbine.
In the final analysis, of course, when realistic values are available for flow rates and
properties, known fluid mechanic relations for pressure drop may be employed to
account for these losses.
Bibliography and References
1. Anon., Steam, Its Generation and Use. New York: Babcock and Wilcox, 1978.
2. Singer, J. G., (Ed.), Combustion/Fossil Power Systems. Windsor, Conn.:
Combustion Engineering, 1981.
3. Wood, Bernard, Applications of Thermodynamics, 2
nd
ed. Reading, Mass.: Addison-
Wesley, 1981.
4. Li, Kam W., and Priddy, A. Paul, Powerplant System Design. New York: Wiley,
1985.
5. El-Wakil, M. M., Power Plant Technology. New York: McGraw-Hill, 1984.
6. Skrotzi, B. G. A. and Vopat, W. A., Power Station Engineering and Economy.
New York: McGraw-Hill, 1960.
EXERCISES
2.1 An ideal Rankine-cycle steam power plant has 800-psia saturated steam at the
turbine throttle and 5-psia condenser pressure. What are the turbine work, pump work,
net work, steam generator heat addition, thermal efficiency, maximum cycle
temperature, and turbine exit quality? What is the Camot efficiency corresponding to
the temperature extremes for this cycle?
2.2 A Rankine-cycle steam power plant has an 800-psia/900F throttle and 5-psia
condenser pressure. What are the net work, turbine work, pump work, steam generator
76
heat addition, thermal efficiency, and turbine exit quality? What is the Carnot efficiency
corresponding to the temperature extremes for this cycle?
2.3 Solve Exercise 2.2 for the cases of (a) an 85% efficient turbine, (b) an 85%
efficient pump, and (c) both together. Tabulate and discuss your results together with
those of Exercise 2.2.
2.4 Solve Exercise 2.2 for the case of (a) 1000F throttle, (b) 2000-psia throttle,
(c) 2-psia condenser, and (d) all three changes simultaneously. Make a table comparing
net work, quality, and thermal efficiency, including the results of Exercise 2.2. What
conclusions can you draw from these calculations?
2.5 Sketch coordinated, labeled flow and T-s diagrams for the ideal Rankine cycle.
Tabulate the temperatures, entropies, pressures, enthalpies, and quality or degree of
superheat for each significant state shown on the diagram for a throttle at 1000 psia and
1000F and a condenser at 5 psia. Determine the net work, heat added, thermal
efficiency, heat rate, and heat rejected in the condenser. If the power plant output is
100 megawatts and the condenser cooling-water temperature rise is 15 Rankine
degrees, what is the steam flow rate and cooling-water flow rate? Neglect pump work.
2.6 Consider a simple Rankine cycle with a 2000-psia/1100F throttle and 1-psia
condenser. Compare the thermal efficiencies and net work for cycles with a perfect
turbine and one having 86% turbine isentropic efficiency. Assume isentropic pumping.
2.7 A boiling-water reactor operates with saturated vapor at 7500 kPa at the throttle
of the high-pressure turbine. What is the lowest turbine exit pressure that ensures that
the turbine exit moisture does not exceed 12% if the turbine is isentropic? What would
the lowest pressure be if the turbine isentropic efficiency were 85%?
2.8 Consider a steam plant with a single reheat and a single open feedwater heater that
takes extraction from the cold reheat line. Sketch carefully coordinated and labeled T-s
and flow diagrams. If the throttle is at 1000F and 3000psia, the condenser is at 1 psia,
and reheat is to 1000F at 400 psia, what is the extraction mass fraction, the heat rate,
and the thermal efficiency? The turbine efficiency is 89%. Neglect pump work.
2.9 A Rankine-cycle power plant condenses steam at 2 psia and has 1000F and 500
psia at the turbine throttle. Assume an isentropic turbine.
(a) Tabulate the temperature, pressure, entropy, and enthalpy of all states. Determine
the quality and moisture fraction for all mixed states.
(b) Calculate the heat transferred in the condenser and the steam generator and the
turbine work, all per unit mass. What is the thermal efficiency?
(c) Calculate the pump work. What is the ratio of turbine to pump work?
77
(d) What is the turbine work and thermal efficiency if the turbine efficiency is 85%?
Include pump work.
2.10 For throttle conditions of 1000F and 1000 psia and a condenser pressure of 2
psia, compare the net work, thermal efficiency, and turbine discharge quality or degree
of superheat for a simple cycle and two reheat cycles with reheat to 1000F at 50 and
200 psia. Tabulate your results. Sketch a single large, labeled T-s diagram comparing
the cycles. Turbine isentropic efficiencies are 85%.
2.11 Consider a regenerative Rankine cycle with a 1000F and 500-psia throttle, 2-psia
condenser, and an open feedwater heater operating between two turbines at 50 psia.
Turbine efficiencies are 85%. Neglect pump work.
(a) Draw labeled, coordinated T-s and flow diagrams.
(b) Determine the fraction of the throttle mass flow that passes through the extraction
line.
(c) Calculate the turbine work per unit mass at the throttle.
(d) Calculate the cycle efficiency, and compare it to the simple-cycle efficiency.
2.12 Consider a 1120F, 2000-psia, 10-psia steam cycle with reheat at 200 psia to
1000F and a closed feedwater heater taking extraction from a line between two
turbines at 100psia. The FWH condensate is throttled to the condenser, and the
feedwater in the FWH is raised to the condensing temperature of the extraction steam.
(a) Draw labeled T-s and flow diagrams for this plant.
(b) Tabulate the enthalpies for each significant state point.
(c) What is the extraction fraction to the FWH?
(d) What are the net work and work ratio?
(e) What are the thermal efficiency and the heat rate?
2.13 A turbine operates with a 860F, 900-psia throttle. Calorimetric measurements
indicate that the discharge enthalpy is 1250 Btu/lb
m
at 100 psia. What is the isentropic
efficiency?
2.14 An ideal Rankine cycle has 1000-psia saturated steam at the turbine throttle. The
condenser pressure is 10psia. What are the turbine work, steam generator heat addition,
maximum cycle temperature, turbine exit quality, and Carnot efficiency corresponding
to the temperature extremes of the cycle? Neglect pump work.
2.15 Assume that the extraction mass-flow rate to FWH #7 in Figure 2.13 is not
known. Calculate the FWH extraction mass fraction (relative to the HP-turbine throttle
flow) and the extraction mass-flow rate. Compare the extraction-steam energy loss rate
with the feedwater energy gain rate.
78
2.16 Compare the inflow and outflow of steam of the DFLP turbine in Figure 2.13,
and calculate the percentage difference. Calculate the power output of the DFLP
turbine in Btu/hr and in kW.
2.17 Calculate the power delivered by the PSO Riverside Unit #1 boiler feed pump
turbine, BFPT. Based on the feedwater enthalpy rise across the BFP, determine its
power requirements, in kilowatts. What fraction of the plant gross output is used by the
BFPT?
2.18 Without performing a detailed analysis of the FWHs, determine the PSO
Riverside Unit #1 feedwater flow rate from heater number 4 to the deaerator. Explain
your methodology.
2.19 Total and compare the inflows and outflows of mass and energy to the PSO
Riverside Unit #1 deaerator.
2.20 Rework Example 2.4 neglecting pump work. Repeat your calculations for an 80%
efficient pump. Compare and comment on the significance of accounting for pump
work and turbomachine efficiency.
2.21 For a 1080F, 2000-psia, 5-psia Rankine cycle with 85% turbine efficiency and
60% pump efficiency:
(a) Compare the actual net work and the isentropic turbine work and the isentropic net
work.
(b) Calculate the actual heat transfer and work for each component, and evaluate the
cyclic integrals of Q and W.
(c) Compare the real cycle efficiency with that for the ideal Rankine cycle.
2.22 For a 1080F, 2000-psia, 5-psia Rankine cycle with 85% turbine efficiency and
60% pump efficiency, evaluate the effect of a single reheat to 1080F at 500 psia on:
(a) Heat addition in the steam generator.
(b) Work of each turbine, total turbine work, and net work. Compare the net work
with the cyclic integral of the external transfers of heat.
(c) Cycle efficiency and heat rate.
(d) Quality or degree of superheat at the exit of the turbines.
Draw labeled flow and T-s diagrams.
2.23 Consider a 1080F, 2000-psia, 5-psia Rankine cycle with 85% turbine efficiency
and 60% pump efficiency. Compare the simple cycle with the same cycle operating with
a single reheat to 1080F at 1000 psia with respect to:
(a) Heat addition in the steam generator.
(b) Work of each turbine, total turbine work and net work, condenser heat rejection,
and cyclic integral of heat added.
79
(c) Cycle efficiency.
(d) Quality or degree of superheat at the exit of the turbines.
Draw labeled flow and T-s diagrams.
2.24 For a 1080F, 2000-psia, 5-psia Rankine cycle with 85% turbine efficiencies and
60% pump efficiencies and using a single open feedwater heater operating at 500 psia:
(a) Draw labeled and coordinated flow and T-s diagrams.
(b) Evaluate the feedwater heater mass fraction.
(c) Evaluate heat addition in the steam generator, work of each turbine, total turbine
work, and net work, all per pound of steam at the HP-turbine throttle.
(d) Evaluate condenser heat transfer per unit mass at the HP-turbine throttle.
(e) Evaluate cycle efficiency and heat rate. Compare with simple-cycle efficiency.
(f) Evaluate the cyclic integral of the differential heat addition, and compare it with
the net work.
2.25 Consider a 1080F, 2000-psia, 5-psia Rankine reheat-regenerative cycle with
perfect turbomachinery and a closed feedwater heater taking extraction from the cold
reheat line at 500 psia. FWH condensate is pumped into the feedwater line downstream
of the feedwater heater. Assume that the enthalpy of the feedwater entering the steam
generator is that of the saturated liquid leaving the FWH.
(a) Draw coordinated and labeled flow and T-s diagrams.
(b) Determine the extraction mass fraction, the net work, and the total heat addition.
(c) Determine the thermal efficiency and heat rate.
(d) Determine the superheat or quality at the turbine exhausts:
2.26 Taking the reheat-pressure level as a variable, plot net work, thermal efficiency,
and turbine exhaust superheat and/or moisture against reheat pressure for the
conditions of Example 2.5. Select a suitable design value based on your analysis.
2.27 Solve Example 2.6 for 1200F throttle substituting a closed FWH for the open
heater. Consider two cases in which the FWH condensate is (a) throttled to the
condenser, and (b) pumped to throttle pressure.
2.28 Solve Example 2.6 using the method for assigning extraction-pressure levels
given in the subsection of Section 2.6 on multistage extraction systems.
2.29 Solve Example 2.7 using the method for assigning extraction-pressure levels
given in the section on multistage extraction systems, and determine by trial and error
the reheat-pressure level that maximizes the thermal efficiency.
2.30 Solve Example 2.7 with the extraction condensate from the closed FWH pumped
ahead to the feedwater-pressure level.
80
2.31 Solve Example 2.6 for 900F throttle temperature with the open FWH replaced
by a closed FWH where the feedwater is (a) throttled to the condenser, and (b) pumped
into the feedwater line downstream of the FWH.
2.32 Compare the work and exhaust quality of 90% efficient turbines with 2500-psia
throttle pressure and 1000F and 1200F throttle temperatures exiting to a 2-psia
condenser.
2.33 Draw a large T-s diagram showing the states associated with the important flows
of the PSO Riverside Unit #1 (Figure 2.13).
2.34 A Rankine-cycle steam power plant has 5-MPa saturated steam at the turbine
throttle and 25-kPa condenser pressure. What are the net work, steam generator heat
addition, thermal efficiency, heat rate, maximum cycle temperature, and turbine exit
quality? What is the Carnot efficiency corresponding to the temperature extremes for
this cycle?
2.35 A Rankine-cycle steam power plant has a 5-MPa/450C throttle and 10-kPa
condenser pressure. What are the net work, steam generator heat addition, thermal
efficiency, heat rate, and turbine exit quality? What is the Carnot efficiency
corresponding to the temperature extremes for this cycle?
2.36 Solve Exercise 2.35 for the cases of (a) an 85% efficient turbine, (b) an 85%
efficient pump, and (c) both together. What conclusions may be inferred from your
results?
2.37 Solve Exercise 2.35 for the case of (a) a 550C throttle, (b) a 15-MPa throttle,
(c) a 5-kPa condenser, and (d) all three changes simultaneously. What conclusions can
you draw from these calculations?
2.38 Sketch coordinated, labeled flow and T-s diagrams for the following Rankine
cycle. Tabulate the temperatures, entropies, pressures, enthalpies, and quality or degree
of superheat for each significant state shown on the diagram for a throttle at 10 MPa
and 550C and condenser at 5 kPa. Determine the net work, heat added, thermal
efficiency, and heat rejected in the condenser. If the power plant output is 100
megawatts and the condenser cooling water temperature rise is 15Rankine, what is the
steam flow rate and cooling-water flow rate? Neglect pump work.
2.39 Consider a Rankine cycle with a 20MPa/600C throttle and 3-kPa condenser.
Compare the thermal efficiencies and net work for cycles with a perfect turbine and one
having 86% turbine isentropic efficiency.
81
2.40 Consider a steam plant, with a single reheat and a single open feedwater heater,
that takes extraction from the cold reheat line. Sketch carefully coordinated and labeled
T-s and flow diagrams. If the throttle is at 550C and 15 MPa, the condenser is at 5
kPa, and reheat is to 3 MPa and 550 C, what are the extraction mass fraction, work
ratio, and thermal efficiency? The pump and turbine efficiencies are 82% and 89%,
respectively.
2.41 A Rankine-cycle power plant condenses steam at 10 kPa and has 550C and 5
MPa at the turbine throttle. Assume an isentropic turbine.
(a) Tabulate the temperature, pressure, entropy, and enthalpy of all states. Determine
the quality and moisture fraction for all mixed states.
(b) Calculate the heat transferred in the condenser and steam generator and the turbine
work, all per unit mass. What is the thermal efficiency?
(c) Calculate the pump work. What is the ratio of turbine to pump work?
(d) What is the turbine work and thermal efficiency if the turbine efficiency is 85%?
Include pump work.
2.42 For throttle conditions of 550C and 5 MPa and a condenser pressure of 10 kPa,
compare the net work, thermal efficiency, and turbine discharge quality or degree of
superheat for a simple cycle and two reheat cycles. Consider reheat to 500C at (a)
4MPa and (b) 1 MPa. Tabulate and compare your results. Sketch a large, labeled T-s
diagram for a reheat cycle. Turbine efficiencies are 85%.
2.43 Consider a regenerative Rankine cycle with a 600C and 4-MPa throttle, a 5-kPa
condenser, and an open feedwater heater at 500 kPa. Turbine efficiencies are 85%.
Neglect pump work.
(a) Draw labeled, coordinated T-s and flow diagrams.
(b) Determine the fraction of the throttle mass flow that passes through the extraction
line.
(c) Calculate the turbine work per unit mass at the throttle.
(d) Calculate the cycle efficiency, and compare it with the simple-cycle efficiency.
(e) Calculate the heat rate.
2.44 Consider a 600C, 15-MPa steam cycle with reheat at 2 MPa to 600C and
extraction to a closed feedwater heater at 600 kPa. The FWH condensate is throttled to
the condenser at 5 kPa, and the feedwater in the FWH is raised to the condensing
temperature of the extraction steam. Neglecting pump work:
(a) Draw labeled T-s and flow diagrams for this plant.
(b) Tabulate the enthalpies for each significant state point.
(c) What is the extraction fraction to the FWH?
(d) What is the net work?
(e) What is the thermal efficiency?
82
(f) What is the heat rate?
2.45 A turbine operates with a 600C, 7-MPa throttle. Calorimetric measurements
indicate that the discharge enthalpy is 3050 kJ/kg at 0.8 MPa. What is the turbine
isentropic efficiency?
2.46 A pressurized water-reactor nuclear power plant steam generator has separate
turbine and reactor water loops. The steam generator receives high-pressure hot water
from the reactor vessel to heat the turbine feedwater. Steam is generated from the
feedwater in the turbine loop. The water pressure in the reactor is 15 MPa, and the
water temperature in and out of the reactor is 289C and 325C, respectively. The plant
has one turbine with a single extraction to a closed FWH with condensate throttled to
the condenser. Throttle conditions are 300C and 8 MPa. The extraction and condenser
pressures are 100 kPa and 5 kPa, respectively. The reactor-coolant flow rate is 14,000
kg/s. Assume no heat losses in heat exchangers and isentropic turbomachines. Neglect
pump work.
(a) What is the rate of heat transfer from the reactor in MWt?
(b) Draw coordinated flow and T-s diagrams that show both loops.
(c) Determine the extraction mass fraction of the throttle flow rate.
(d) Determine the cycle net work, heat rate, and thermal efficiency.
(e) Calculate the steam flow rate.
(f) Assuming the electrical generator has 97% efficiency, calculate the power output,
in MW
e
(electric).
2.47 Perform an optimization of the extraction pressure of a Rankine cycle with a
2000-psia saturated-vapor throttle, a 1-psia condenser with a single closed feedwater
heater, as in Example 2.9. Compare the optimum extraction temperature given by
Equation (2.14) with your results.
2.48 Prepare an optimization study of thermal efficiency with a table and plot of net
work and thermal efficiency as a function of reheat pressure level for Example 2.5.
Discuss the selection of reheat pressure for this case. How does the reheat pressure
used in Example 2.5 compare with your results?
2.49 Solve Exercise 2.25 for reheat and extraction at 200 psia. Compare the extraction
mass fraction, net work, thermal efficiency, heat rate, and turbine exit conditions with
those of Exercise 2.25.
2.50 Rework Exercise 2.25, accounting for 90% turbine efficiencies and a 10F
terminal temperature difference.
2.51 A 1000F/2000-psia-throttle high-pressure turbine discharges into a cold reheat
line at 200 psia. Reheat is to 1000F. The low-pressure turbine discharges into the
83
condenser at 0.5 inches of mercury absolute. Both turbines are 90% efficient. Design
the cycle for the use of three feedwater heaters. Draw coordinated T-s and flow
diagrams. State and discuss your decisions on the handling of the feedwater heater
design.
2.52 A steam turbine receives steam at 1050F and 3000 psia and condenses at 5 psia.
Two feedwater heaters are supplied by extraction from the turbine at pressures of 1000
psia and 200 psia. The low-pressure heater is an open FWH, and the other is closed
with its condensate throttled to the open heater. Assuming isentropic flow in the turbine
and negligible pump work:
(a) Sketch accurately labeled and coordinated T-s and flow diagrams for the system,
and create a table of temperature, pressure, and enthalpy values for each state.
(b) What are the extraction flows to each feedwater heater if the throttle mass flow
rate is 250,000 pounds per hour?
(c) How much power, in kW, is produced by the turbine?
(d) Compare the thermal efficiency of the system with the efficiency if valves of both
extraction lines are closed.
(e) What is the heat rate of the system with both feedwater heaters operative?
2.53 Apply the steady-flow First Law of Thermodynamics to a single control volume
enclosing the two turbines in Example 2.7. Show that the same equation is obtained for
the turbine work as when the work of individual turbines is summed.
2.54 Apply the steady-flow First Law of Thermodynamics to a single control volume
enclosing the two turbines in Example 2.10. Show that the same equation is obtained
for the turbine work as when the work of individual turbines is summed.
2.55 Resolve Example 2.7 with 4% pressure drops in the main steam pass and reheat
pass through the steam generator. Make a table comparing your results with those of
the example to show the influence of the losses on plant performance. Calculate and
display the percentage differences for each parameter. Assume turbine throttle
conditions are unchanged.
2.56 Draw labeled and coordinated T-s and flow diagrams for a steam power plant
with 1000F / 3000-psia / 2" Hg absolute conditions, assuming isentropic
turbomachinery. The plant has reheat at 500 psia to ll00F. The plant has the following
feedwater heaters:
1. A closed FWH with extraction at 1000 psia and pumped condensate.
2. A closed FWH at 400 psia with condensate throttled into the next-lowest-
pressure FWH.
3. An open FWH at 20 psia.
Define mass fraction variables. Show mass-flow variable expressions, with arrows
indicating mass fractions along the various process paths on the T-s and flow diagrams.
84
Write equations for conservation of energy for the FWHs that allow you to solve easily
for the mass fractions in terms of known state enthalpies and other mass fractions.
Indicate a solution method for the mass fractions that involves simple substitution only.
2.57 A pressurized-water nuclear-reactor steam generator has separate turbine and
reactor loops. The steam generator linking the two loops cools high-pressure hot water
from the reactor vessel and transfers the heat to the turbine feedwater producing steam.
The water pressure in the reactor is 2250 psia, and the water temperatures in and out of
the reactor are 559F and 623F, respectively. The plant has one turbine with a single
extraction to an open FWH. Throttle conditions are 555F and 1100 psia. The
extraction and condenser pressures are 100 psia and 1 psia, respectively. The reactor-
coolant flow rate is 147,000,000 lb
m
/hr. Assume no heat losses in heat exchangers and
isentropic turbomachines.
(a) What is the rate of heat transfer from the reactor, in Btu/hr and in MW
t
?
(b) Draw coordinated flow and T-s diagrams that show both loops with states in their
proper relations with respect to each other.
(c) Determine the extraction mass fraction relative to the throttle flow rate.
(d) Determine the cycle net work.
(e) What are the cycle thermal efficiency and heat rate?
(f) Calculate the turbine-steam flow rate.
(g) Assuming the electrical generator has 100% efficiency, calculate the turbine power,
in Btu/hr and in MW
e
.
2.58 Determine the efficiencies of the boiler feed pump and boiler feed pump turbine of
the PSO Riverside Station Unit 4/1 (Figure 2.13).
2.59 A Rankine cycle with a single open feedwater heater has a 1040F and 550-psia
throttle. Extraction from the exit of the first turbine (assumed isentropic) is at 40F of
superheat. The second turbine has an efficiency of 85% and expands into the condenser
at 5 psia.
(a) Draw matched, labeled T-s and flow diagrams.
(b) Accurately calculate and tabulate the enthalpies of all significant states. Neglect
pump work.
(c) What is the feedwater-heater mass fraction relative to the mass flow at the first
throttle?
(d) What is the quality or degree of superheat at the condenser inlet?
(e) What are the net work, thermal efficiency, and heat rate?
(f) Estimate the feedwater-heater condensate pump work and its percentage of turbine
work.
85
C H A P T E R 3
FUELS AND COMBUSTION
3.1 Introduction to Combustion
Combustion Basics
The last chapter set forth the basics of the Rankine cycle and the principles of operation
of steam cycles of modern steam power plants. An important aspect of power
generation involves the supply of heat to the working fluid, which in the case of steam
power usually means turning liquid water into superheated steam. This heat comes from
an energy source. With the exception of nuclear and solar power and a few other exotic
sources, most power plants are driven by a chemical reaction called combustion, which
usually involves sources that are compounds of hydrogen and carbon. Process
industries, businesses, homes, and transportation systems have vast heat requirements
that are also satisfied by combustion reactions. The subject matter of this chapter
therefore has wide applicability to a variety of heating processes.
Combustion is the conversion of a substance called a fuel into chemical compounds
known as products of combustion by combination with an oxidizer. The combustion
process is an exothermic chemical reaction, i.e., a reaction that releases energy as it
occurs. Thus combustion may be represented symbolically by:
Fuel + Oxidizer ; Products of combustion + Energy
Here the fuel and the oxidizer are reactants, i.e., the substances present before the
reaction takes place. This relation indicates that the reactants produce combustion
products and energy. Either the chemical energy released is transferred to the
surroundings as it is produced, or it remains in the combustion products in the form of
elevated internal energy (temperature), or some combination thereof.
Fuels are evaluated, in part, based on the amount of energy or heat that they
release per unit mass or per mole during combustion of the fuel. Such a quantity is
known as the fuel's heat of reaction or heating value.
Heats of reaction may be measured in a calorimeter, a device in which chemical
energy release is determined by transferring the released heat to a surrounding fluid.
The amount of heat transferred to the fluid in returning the products of combustion to
their initial temperature yields the heat of reaction.
86
In combustion processes the oxidizer is usually air but could be pure oxygen, an
oxygen mixture, or a substance involving some other oxidizing element such as
fluorine. Here we will limit our attention to combustion of a fuel with air or pure
oxygen.
Chemical fuels exist in gaseous, liquid, or solid form. Natural gas, gasoline, and
coal, perhaps the most widely used examples of these three forms, are each a complex
mixture of reacting and inert compounds. We will consider each more closely later in
the chapter. First let's review some important fundamentals of mixtures of gases, such
as those involved in combustion reactions.

Mass and Mole Fractions
The amount of a substance present in a sample may be indicated by its mass or by the
number of moles of the substance. A mole is defined as the mass of a substance equal to
its molecular mass or molecular weight. A few molecular weights commonly used in
combustion analysis are tabulated below. For most combustion calculations, it is
sufficiently accurate to use integer molecular weights. The error incurred may easily be
evaluated for a given reaction and should usually not be of concern. Thus a gram-mole
of water is 18 grams, a kg-mole of nitrogen is 28 kg, and a pound-mole of sulfur is 32
lb
m
.
_____________________________________________________________________
Molecule Molecular Weight
-------------------------------------------
C 12
N
2
28
O
2
32
S 32
H
2
2
_____________________________________________________________________
The composition of a mixture may be given as a list of the fractions of each of the
substances present. Thus we define the mass fraction, of a component i, mf
i
, as the
ratio of the mass of the component, m
i
, to the mass of the mixture, m:
mf
i
= m
i
/m
It is evident that the sum of the mass fractions of all the components must be 1. Thus

mf
1
+ mf
2
+ ... = 1
Analogous to the mass fraction, we define the mole fraction of component i, x
i
, as
the ratio of the number of moles of i, n
i
, to the total number of moles in the mixture, n:
x
i
= n
i
/n
87
The total number of moles, n, is the sum of the number of moles of all the components
of the mixture:
n = n
1
+ n
2
+ ...
It follows that the sum of all the mole fractions of the mixture must also equal 1.
x
1
+ x
2
+ ... = 1

The mass of component i in a mixture is the product of the number of moles of i and its
molecular weight, M
i
. The mass of the mixture is therefore the sum, m = n
1
M
1
+ n
2
M
2
+
..., over all components of the mixture. Substituting x
i
n for n
i
, the total mass becomes
m = (x
1
M
1
+ x
2
M
2
+ ...)n
But the average molecular weight of the mixture is the ratio of the total mass to the
total number of moles. Thus the average molecular weight is
M = m /n = x
1
M
1
+ x
2
M
2
+ ...
EXAMPLE 3.1
Express the mass fraction of component 1 of a mixture in terms of: (a) the number of
moles of the three components of the mixture, n
1
, n
2
, and n
3,
and (b) the mole fractions
of the three components. (c) If the mole fractions of carbon dioxide and nitrogen in a
three component gas containing water vapor are 0.07 and 0.38, respectively, what are
the mass fractions of the three components?
Solution
(a) Because the mass of i can be written as m
i
= n
i
M
i
, the mass fraction of component
i can be written as:
mf
i
= n
i
M
i
/(n
1
M
1
+ n
2
M
2
+ ..) [dl]
For the first of the three components, i = 1, this becomes:
mf
1
= n
1
M
1
/(n
1
M
1
+ n
2
M
2
+ n
3
M
3
)
Similarly, for i = 2 and i = 3:
mf
2
= n
2
M
2
/(n
1
M
1
+ n
2
M
2
+ n
3
M
3
)
mf
3
= n
3
M
3
/(n
1
M
1
+ n
2
M
2
+ n
3
M
3
)
88
(b) Substituting n
1
= x
1
n, n
2
= x
2
n, etc. in the earlier equations and simplifying, we
obtain for the mass fractions:
mf
1
= x
1
M
1
/(x
1
M
1
+ x
2
M
2
+ x
3
M
3
)
mf
2
= x
2
M
2
/(x
1
M
1
+ x
2
M
2
+ x
3
M
3
)
mf
3
= x
3
M
3
/(x
1
M
1
+ x
2
M
2
+ x
3
M
3
)
(c) Identifying the subscripts 1, 2, and 3 with carbon dioxide, nitrogen, and water
vapor, respectively, we have x
1
= 0.07, x
2
= 0.38 and x
3
= 1 0.07 0.038 = 0.55.
Then:
mf
1
= (0.07)(44)/[(0.07)(44) + (0.38)(28) + (0.55)(18)]
= (0.07)(44)/(23.62) = 0.1304
mf
2
= (0.38)(28)/(23.62) = 0.4505
mf
3
= (0.55)(18)/(23.62) = 0.4191
As a check we sum the mass fractions: 0.1304 + 0.4505 + 0.4191 = 1.0000.
________________________________________________________________
For a mixture of gases at a given temperature and pressure, the ideal gas law
shows that pV
i
= n
i
T holds for any component, and pV = nT for the mixture as a
whole. Forming the ratio of the two equations we observe that the mole fractions have
the same values as the volume fraction:
x
i
= V
i
/V = n
i
/n [dl]
Similarly, for a given volume of a mixture of gases at a given temperature, p
i
V = n
i
T
for each component and pV = nT for the mixture. The ratio of the two equations
shows that the partial pressure of any component i is the product of the mole fraction
of i and the pressure of the mixture:
p
i
= pn
i
/n = px
i
EXAMPLE 3.2
What is the partial pressure of water vapor in Example 3.1 if the mixture pressure is
two atmospheres?
89
Solution
The mole fraction of water vapor in the mixture of Example 3.1 is 0.55. The partial
pressure of the water vapor is therefore (0.55)(2) = 1.1 atm.
_____________________________________________________________________
Characterizing Air for Combustion Calculations
Air is a mixture of about 21% oxygen, 78% nitrogen, and 1% other constituents by
volume. For combustion calculations it is usually satisfactory to represent air as a 21%
oxygen, 79% nitrogen mixture, by volume. Thus for every 21 moles of oxygen that
react when air oxidizes a fuel, there are also 79 moles of nitrogen involved. Therefore,
79/21 = 3.76 moles of nitrogen are present for every mole of oxygen in the air.
At room temperature both oxygen and nitrogen exist as diatomic molecules, O
2
and N
2
, respectively. It is usually assumed that the nitrogen in the air is nonreacting at
combustion temperatures; that is, there are as many moles of pure nitrogen in the
products as there were in the reactants. At very high temperatures small amounts of
nitrogen react with oxygen to form oxides of nitrogen, usually termed NO
x
. These small
quantities are important in pollution analysis because of the major role of even small
traces of NO
x
in the formation of smog. However, since these NO
x
levels are
insignificant in energy analysis applications, nitrogen is treated as inert here.
The molecular weight of a compound or mixture is the mass of 1 mole of the
substance. The average molecular weight, M, of a mixture, as seen earlier, is the linear
combination of the products of the mole fractions of the components and their
respective molecular weights. Thus the molecular weight for air, M
air
, is given by the
sum of the products of the molecular weights of oxygen and nitrogen and their
respective mole fractions in air. Expressed in words:
M
air
= Mass of air/Mole of air = (Moles of N
2
/Mole of air)(Mass of N
2
/Mole of N
2
)
+ (Moles of O
2
/Mole of air)(Mass of O
2
/Mole of O
2
)
or
M
air
= 0.79 M
nitrogen
+ 0.21 M
oxygen
= 0.79(28) + 0.21(32) = 28.84
The mass fractions of oxygen and nitrogen in air are then
mf
oxygen
= (0.21)(32)/28.84 = 0.233, or 23.3%
and
mf
nitrogen
= (0.79)(28)/28.84 = 0.767, or 76.7%

90
3.2 Combustion Chemistry of a Simple Fuel
Methane, CH
4
, is a common fuel that is a major constituent of most natural gases.
Consider the complete combustion of methane in pure oxygen. The chemical reaction
equation for the complete combustion of methane in oxygen may be written as:
CH
4
+ 2O
2
; CO
2
+ 2H
2
O (3.1)
Because atoms are neither created nor destroyed, Equation (3.1) states that methane
(consisting of one atom of carbon and four atoms of hydrogen) reacts with four atoms
of oxygen to yield carbon dioxide and water products with the same number of atoms
of each element as in the reactants. This is the basic principle involved in balancing all
chemical reaction equations.
Carbon dioxide is the product formed by complete combustion of carbon through
the reaction C + O
2
; CO
2
. Carbon dioxide has only one carbon atom per molecule.
Since in Equation (3.1) there is only one carbon atom on the left side of the equation,
there can be only one carbon atom and therefore one CO
2
molecule on the right.
Similarly, water is the product of the complete combustion of hydrogen. It has two
atoms of hydrogen per molecule. Because there are four hydrogen atoms in the
reactants of Equation (3.1), there must be four in the products, implying that two
molecules of water formed. These observations require four atoms of oxygen on the
right, which implies the presence of two molecules (four atoms) of oxygen on the left.
The coefficients in chemical equations such as Equation (3.1) may be interpreted as
the number of moles of the substance required for the reaction to occur as written.
Thus another way of interpreting Equation (3.1) is that one mole of methane reacts
with two moles of oxygen to form one mole of carbon dioxide and two moles of water.
While not evident in this case, it is not necessary that there be the same number of
moles of products as reactants. It will be seen in numerous other cases that a different
number of moles of products is produced from a given number of moles of reactants.
Thus although the numbers of atoms of each element must be conserved during a
reaction, the total number of moles need not. Because the number of atoms of each
element cannot change, it follows that the mass of each element and the total mass must
be conserved during the reaction. Thus, using the atomic weights (masses) of each
element, the sums of the masses of the reactants and products in Equation (3.1) are
both 80:
CH
4
+ 2O
2
; CO
2
+ 2H
2
O
[12 + 4(1)] + 4(16) ; [12 + 2(16)] + 2[2(1) + 16] = 80
Other observations may be made with respect to Equation (3.1). There are 2 moles of
water in the 3 moles of combustion products, and therefore a mole fraction of water in
the combustion products of x
water
= 2/3 = 0.667. Similarly, x
Carbon dioxide
= 1/3 = 0.333
moles of CO
2
in the products.
There are 44 mass units of CO
2
in the 80 mass units of products for a mass
91
fraction of CO
2
in the products,
mf
carbon dioxide
= 44/80 = 0.55
Likewise, the mass fraction of water in the products is 2(18)/80 = 0.45.
We also observe that there are 12 mass units of carbon in the products and
therefore a carbon mass fraction of 12/80 = 0.15. Note that because the mass of any
element and the total mass are conserved in a chemical reaction, the mass fraction of
any element is also conserved in the reaction. Thus the mass fraction of carbon in the
reactants is 0.15, as in the products.
Combustion in Air
Let us now consider the complete combustion of methane in air. The same combustion
products are expected as with combustion in oxygen; the only additional reactant
present is nitrogen, and it is considered inert. Moreover, because we know that in air
every mole of oxygen is accompanied by 3.76 moles of nitrogen, the reaction equation
can be written as
CH
4
+ 2O
2
+ 2(3.76)N
2
; CO
2
+ 2H
2
O + 2(3.76)N
2
(3.2)
It is seen that the reaction equation for combustion in air may be obtained from the
combustion equation for the reaction in oxygen by adding the appropriate number of
moles of nitrogen to both sides of the equation.
Note that both Equations (3.1) and (3.2) describe reactions of one mole of
methane fuel. Because the same amount of fuel is present in both cases, both reactions
release the same amount of energy. We can therefore compare combustion reactions in
air and in oxygen. It will be seen that the presence of nitrogen acts to dilute the
reaction, both chemically and thermally. With air as oxidizer, there are 2 moles of water
vapor per 10.52 moles of combustion products, compared with 2 moles of water per 3
moles of products for combustion in oxygen. Similarly, with air, there is a mass fraction
of CO
2
of 0.1514 and a carbon mass fraction of 0.0413 in the combustion products,
compared with 0.55 and 0.15, respectively, for combustion in oxygen.
The diluting energetic effect of nitrogen when combustion is in air may be reasoned
as follows: The same amount of energy is released in both reactions, because the same
amount of fuel is completely consumed. However, the nonreacting nitrogen molecules
in the air have heat capacity. This added heat capacity of the additional nitrogen
molecules absorbs much of the energy released, resulting in a lower internal energy per
unit mass of products and hence a lower temperature of the products. Thus the energy
released by the reaction is shared by a greater mass of combustion products when the
combustion is in air.
Often, products of combustion are released to the atmosphere through a chimney,
stack, or flue. These are therefore sometimes referred to as flue gases. The flue gas
composition may be stated in terms of wet flue gas (wfg) or dry flue gas (dfg), because
92
under some circumstances the water vapor in the gas condenses and then escapes as a
liquid rather than remaining as a gaseous component of the flue gas. When liquid water
is present in combustion products, the combustion product gaseous mass fractions may
be taken with respect to the mass of flue gas products, with the product water present
or omitted. Thus, for Equation (3.2), the mass of dry combustion products is 254.56.
Hence the mass fraction of carbon dioxide is 44/254.56 = 0.1728 with respect to dry
flue gas, and 44/290.56 = 0.1514 with respect to wet flue gas.
In combustion discussions reference is frequently made to higher and lower heating
values. The term higher heating value, HHV, refers to a heating value measurement in
which the product water vapor is allowed to condense. As a consequence, the heat of
vaporization of the water is released and becomes part of the heating value. The lower
heating value, LHV, corresponds to a heating value in which the water remains a
vapor and does not yield its heat of vaporization. Thus the energy difference between
the two values is due to the heat of vaporization of water, and
HHV = LHV + (m
water
/m
fuel
)h
fg
[Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg]
where m
water
is the mass of liquid water in the combustion products, and h
fg
is the latent
heat of vaporization of water.
Air-Fuel Ratio
It is important to know how much oxygen or air must be supplied for complete
combustion of a given quantity of fuel. This information is required in sizing fans and
ducts that supply oxidizer to combustion chambers or burners and for numerous other
design purposes. The mass air-fuel ratio, A/F, or oxygen-fuel ratio, O/F, for complete
combustion may be determined by calculating the masses of oxidizer and fuel from the
appropriate reaction equation. Lets return to Equation (3.2):
CH
4
+ 2O
2
+ 2(3.76)N
2
; CO
2
+ 2H
2
O + 2(3.76)N
2
(3.2)
The A/F for methane is [(2)(32) + (2)(3.76)(28)]/(12 + 4) = 17.16 and the O/F is
2(32)/(12 + 4) = 4. Thus 4 kg of O
2
or 17.16 kg of air must be supplied for each
kilogram of methane completely consumed.
Of course it is possible, within limits, to supply an arbitrary amount of air to a
burner to burn the fuel. The terms stoichiometric or theoretical are applied to the
situation just described, in which just enough oxidizer is supplied to completely convert
the fuel to CO
2
and H
2
O. Thus the stoichiometric O/F and A/F ratios for methane are
4.0 and 17.16, respectively. If less than the theoretical amount of air is supplied, the
products will contain unburned fuel. Regardless of the magnitude of A/F, when
unburned fuel remains in the products (including carbon, carbon monoxide, or
hydrogen), combustion is said to be incomplete. Because air is virtually free and fuel is
expensive, it is usually important to burn all of the fuel by using more air than the
theoretical air-fuel ratio indicates is needed. Thus most burners operate with excess air.
93
The actual air-fuel ratio used in a combustor is frequently stated as a percentage of
the theoretical air-fuel ratio
% theoretical air = 100(A/F)
actual
/(A/F)
theor
(3.3)
Thus, for methane, 120% of theoretical air implies an actual mass air-fuel ratio of
(120/100)(17.16) = 20.59.
Excess air is defined as the difference between the actual and the theoretical air
supplied. Accordingly, the percentage of excess air is
% excess air = 100[(A/F)
actual
(A/F)
theor
]/(A/F)
theor
(3.4)
Thus, for methane, 120% of theoretical air implies
% excess air = (100)(20.59 17.16)/17.16 = 20%.
Note also that combining Equations (3.4) and (3.3) yields the following general result:
% excess air = % theoretical air 100% (3.5)
Again, the excess air percentage is 120% 100% = 20%. Table 3.1 shows examples of
ranges of excess air used with certain fuels and combustion systems.
The air/fuel parameters just discussed emphasize the amount of air supplied to burn
a given amount of fuel relative to the theoretical requirement. An alternate approach
considers a given amount of air and indicates the mass of fuel supplied , the fuel-air
ratio, F/A, which is the inverse of the air-fuel ratio. A measure of how much fuel is
actually supplied, called the equivalence ratio, is the ratio of the actual fuel-air ratio to
the theoretical fuel-air ratio:
= (F/A)
actual
/ (F/A)
theor
= (A/F)
theor
/ (A/F)
actual
= 100/( % theoretical air)
Thus 100% theoretical air corresponds to an equivalence ratio of 1, and 20% excess air
to = 100/120 = 0.833. When the equivalence ratio is less than 1, the mixture is called
lean; when greater than 1, it is called rich.
This section has dealt with the application of combustion chemistry or
stoichiometry applied to methane gas. Other fuels for which a reaction equation such as
Equation (3.1) or (3.2) is available may be treated in a similar way. Before considering
more complex combustion problems, it is appropriate to investigate the nature and
description of the various types of fossil fuels.
94
3.3 Fossil Fuel Characteristics
Most chemical fuels are found in nature in the form of crude oil, natural gas, and coal.
These fuels are called fossil fuels because they are believed to have been formed by the
decay of vegetable and animal matter over many thousands of years under conditions of
high pressure and temperature and with a deficiency or absence of oxygen. Other fuels
such as gasoline, syngas (synthetic gas), and coke may be derived from fossil fuels by
some form of industrial or chemical processing. These derived fuels are also called
fossil fuels.
Coal
Coal is an abundant solid fuel found in many locations around the world in a variety of
forms. The American Society for Testing Materials, ASTM, has established a ranking
system (ref. 3) that classifies coals as anthracite (I), bituminous (II), subbituminous
(III), and lignite (IV), according to their physical characteristics. Table 3.2 lists
95
seventeen of the many United States coals according to this class ranking.
Coal is formed over long periods of time, in a progression shown from left to right
in Figure 3.1. The bars on the ordinate show the division of the combustibles between
fixed carbon and volatile matter in the fuels. Fixed carbon and volatile matter
indicate roughly how much of the fuel burns as a solid and as a thermally generated gas,
respectively. It is seen that the volatile matter and oxygen contained in the fuels
decrease with increasing age.
Peat is a moist fuel, at the geologically young end of the scale, that has a relatively
low heating value. It is not considered a coal but, nevertheless, follows the patterns of
characteristics shown in the figure. Peat is regarded as an early stage or precursor of
coal. At the other extreme, anthracite is a geologically old, very hard, shiny coal with
high carbon content and high heating value. Bituminous is much more abundant than
anthracite, has a slightly lower carbon content, but also has a high heating value.
Subbituminous coal, lignite, and peat have successively poorer heating values and
higher volatile matter than bituminous.
Coal is a highly inhomogeneous material, of widely varying composition, found in
seams (layers) of varying thickness at varying depths below the earth's surface. The
wide geographic distribution of coal in the United States is shown in Figure 3.2.
96
According to reference 1, the average seam in the United States is about 5.5 ft. thick.
The largest known seam is 425 ft. thick and is found in Manchuria.
Coal Analyses
It is often difficult to obtain representative samples of coal because of composition
variations from location to location even within a given seam. As a result there are
limits on the accuracy and adequacy of coal analyses in assessing coal behavior in a
given application. Before discussing the nature of these analyses, it is important to
establish the basis on which they are conducted.
Coal contains varying amounts of loosely held moisture and noncombustible
materials or mineral matter (ash), which are of little or no use. The basis of an analysis
helps to specify the conditions under which the coal is tested. The coal sample may be
freshly taken from the mine, the as-mined basis. It may have resided in a coal pile for
months, and be analyzed just before burning, the as-fired basis. It may be examined
immediately after transport from the mine, the as-received basis. Exposure to rain or
dry periods, weathering, and separation and loss of noncombustible mineral matter
through abrasion and the shifting of loads during transport and storage may cause the
same load of coal to have changing mineral matter and moisture content over time. It is
therefore important to specify the basis for any test that is conducted. Published
tabulations of coal properties are frequently presented on a dry, ash-free, or dry and
ash-free basis, that is, in the absence of water and/or noncombustible mineral matter.
Coal ranking and analysis of combustion processes rely on two types of analysis of
coal composition: the proximate analysis and the ultimate analysis. The proximate
analysis starts with a representative sample of coal. The sample is first weighed, then
raised to a temperature high enough to drive off water, and then reweighed. The weight
97
loss divided by the initial weight gives the coal moisture content, M. The remaining
material is then heated at a much higher temperature, in the absence of oxygen, for a
time long enough to drive off gases. The resulting weight-loss fraction gives the
volatile matter content, VM, of the coal. The remainder of the sample is then burned in
air until only noncombustibles remain. The weight loss gives the fixed carbon, FC, and
the remaining material is identified as non-combustible mineral matter or ash, A.
The proximate analysis may be reported as percentages (or fractions) of the four
quantities moisture, ash, volatile matter, and fixed carbon, as in Table 3.2, or without
ash and moisture and with the FC and VM normalized to 100%. Sulfur, as a fraction of
the coal mass, is sometimes reported with the proximate analysis. The proximate
analysis, while providing very limited information, can be performed with limited
laboratory resources.
A more sophisticated and useful analysis is the ultimate analysis, a chemical
analysis that provides the elemental mass fractions of carbon, hydrogen, nitrogen,
oxygen, and sulfur, usually on a dry, ash-free basis. The ash content of the coal and
heating value are sometimes provided also.
Data from a dry, ash-free analysis can be converted to another basis by using the
basis adjustment factor, 1 - A - M, as follows. The mass of coal is the mass of ultimate
or proximate analysis components plus the masses of water (moisture) and ash:
m = m
comp
+ m
ash
+ m
moist
[lb
m
| kg]
98
Dividing through by the total mass m and rearranging, we get the following as the ratio
of the mass of components to the total mass:
m
comp
/ m = 1 A M [dl]
where A is the ash fraction and M is the moisture fraction of the total coal mass. A
component of a coal analysis may be converted from the dry, ash-free basis to some
other basis by forming the product of the component fraction and the basis adjustment
factor. Thus an equation for the wet and ashy volatile matter fraction in the proximate
analysis may be determined from the dry, ash-free proximate analysis by using
VM
as-fired
= (Mass of combustibles/Total mass)VM
dry,ashfree
= ( 1 - A - M ) VM
dry,ash-free
(3.6)
where A and M are, respectively, the ash and moisture fractions for the as-fired coal.
Here the as-fired (wet, ashy) mass fraction of volatile matter is the product of the dry,
ash-free mass fraction and the basis adjustment factor. Fixed carbon, heating values,
and components of the ultimate analysis may be dealt with in a similar way.
Table 3.3 gives proximate and ultimate analyses for a number of United States
coals on a dry basis. Another extensive tabulation of the characteristics of American
and world coals is given in Appendix E.
EXAMPLE 3.3
If the as-fired moisture fraction for Schuylkill, Pa. anthracite culm characterized in
Table 3.3 is 4.5%, determine the as-fired proximate and ultimate analysis and heating
value of the coal. (Culm is the fine coal refuse remaining from anthracite mining.)
Solution
The FC, VM, and ash contents are given in Table 3.3. Because ash is already present in
the analysis, the appropriate adjustment factor is 1 - A - M = 1 0.0 0.045 = 0.955.
Using Equation (3.6) and the data from Table 3.3, we get
VM
as-fired
= (0.955)(8.3) = 7.927
FC
as-fired
= (0.955)(32.6) = 31.133
A
as-fired
= (0.955)(59.1) = 56.411
M
as-fired
= 4.500
Check Sum = 99.971
Heating value
as-fired
= (0.955)(4918) = 4697 Btu/lb
m
Similarly, the as-fired ultimate analysis is 32% C, 1.15% H
2
, 4.87% O
2
, 0.57% N
2
,
0.48% S, 56.44% ash, and 4.5% moisture, with a checksum of 100.01.
_____________________________________________________________________
99
100
101
102
As a solid fuel, coal may be burned in a number of ways. Starting with the smallest
of installations, coal may be burned in a furnace, in chunk form on a stationary or
moving grate. Air is usually supplied from below with combustion gases passing
upward and ash falling through a stationary grate or dropping off the end of a moving
grate into an ash pit. A wide variety of solid fuels can be burned in this way.
Though all furnaces were onced fired manually, today many are fired by or with the
assistance of mechanical devices called stokers. Figure 3.3 shows a spreader stoker,
which scatters coal in a uniform pattern in the furnace, the finer particles burning in
suspension in the rising combustion air stream while the heavier particles drop to the
grate as they burn. The particles that reach the grate burn rapidly in a thin layer, and the
remaining ash drops off the end into the ash pit. This type of combustion system has
been in use for over fifty years for hot water heating and steam generation.
In large installations, coal is crushed to a particular size, and sometimes pulverized
to powder immediately before firing, to provide greater surface exposure to the
103
oxidizer and to ensure rapid removal of combustion gases. Because of the wide
variation in the characteristics of coals, specialized types of combustion systems
tailored to a specific coal or range of coal characteristics are used.
Natural Gas
Natural gas is a mixture of hydrocarbons and nitrogen, with other gases appearing in
small quantities. Table 3.4 shows the composition of samples of natural gases found in
several regions of the United States. For these samples, it is seen that the gases contain
83-94% methane (CH
4
), 0-16% ethane (C
2
H
6
), 0.5-8.4% nitrogen and small quantities
of other components, by volume. The ultimate analysis shows that the gases contain
about 65-75% carbon, 20-24% hydrogen, 0.75-13% nitrogen, and small amounts of
oxygen and sulfur in some cases. The higher heating values are in the neighborhood of
1000 Btu/ft
3
on a volume basis and 22,000 Btu/lb
m
on a mass basis. In regions where it
is abundant, natural gas is frequently the fuel of choice because of its low sulfur and ash
content and ease of use.
104
EXAMPLE 3.4
Determine the molecular weight and stoichiometric mole and mass air-fuel ratios for the
Oklahoma gas mole composition given in Table 3.4.
Solution
Equation (3.2),
CH
4
+ 2O
2
+ 2(3.76)N
2
; CO
2
+ 2H
2
O + 2(3.76)N
2
(3.2)
shows that there are 2 + 2(3.76) = 9.52 moles of air required for complete combustion
of each mole of methane. Similarly for ethane, the stoichiometric reaction equation is:
C
2
H
6
+ 3.5O
2
+ (3.5)(3.76)N
2
; 2CO
2
+ 3H
2
O + 13.16N
2

where 2 carbon and 6 hydrogen atoms in ethane require 2 CO
2
molecules and 3 H
2
O
molecules, respectively, in the products. There are then 7 oxygen atoms in the
products, which implies 3.5 oxygen molecules in the reactants. This in turn dictates the
presence of (3.5)(3.76) = 13.16 nitrogen molecules in both the reactants and products.
The reaction equation then indicates that 3.5(1 + 3.76) = 16.66 moles of air are
required for complete combustion of one mole of ethane.
In Table 3.5, the molecular weight of the gas mixture, 18.169, is found in the
fourth column by summing the products of the mole fractions of the fuel components
and the component molecular weights. This is analogous to the earlier determination of
the average air molecular weight from the nitrogen and oxygen mixture mole fractions.
The products of the mole fractions of fuel components and the moles of air
required per mole of fuel component (as determined earlier and tabulated in the fifth
column of Table 3.5) then yield the moles of air required for each combustible per mole
of fuel (in the sixth column). Summing these, the number of moles of air required per
mole of fuel yields the stoichiometric mole air-fuel ratio, 9.114.
The stoichiometric mass A/F is then given by the mole A/F times the ratio of air
molecular weight to fuel molecular weight: (9.114)(28.9)/18.169 = 14.5.
Table 3.5 Calculations for Example 3.4
i M
i
x
i
x
i
M
i
Moles air per
mole i
Moles air per mole fuel
Methane 16 0.841 13.456 9.52 (0.841)(9.52) = 7.998
Ethane 30 0.067 2.010 16.66 (0.067)(16.66) = 1.116
CO2 44 0.008 0.351 0.0
Nitrogen 28 0.084 2.352 0.0
Totals 1.000 18.169 moles air /mole fuel = 9.114
105

Liquid Fuels
Liquid fuels are primarily derived from crude oil through cracking and fractional
distillation. Cracking is a process by which long-chain hydrocarbons are broken up into
smaller molecules. Fractional distillation separates high-boiling-point hydrocarbons
from those with lower boiling points. Liquid fuels satisfy a wide range of combustion
requirements and are particularly attractive for transportation applications because of
their compactness and fluidity. Table 3.6 gives representative analyses of some of these
liquid fuels. Compositions of liquid and solid fuels, unlike gaseous fuels, are usually
stated as mass fractions.
3.4 Combustion Reactions and Analysis
Mechanism of Combustion
Details of the mechanics of combustion depend to a great extent on the fuel and the
nature of the combustion system. They are sometimes not well understood and are
largely beyond the scope of this book. There are, however, certain fundamentals that
are useful in dealing with combustion systems.
The chemical reaction equations presented here do not portray the actual
mechanism of combustion; they merely indicate the initial and final chemical
compositions of a reaction. In most cases the reactions involve a sequence of steps,
leading from the reactants to the products, the nature of which depends on the
temperature, pressure, and other conditions of combustion. Fuel molecules, for
instance, may undergo thermal cracking, producing more numerous and smaller fuel
molecules and perhaps breaking the molecules down completely into carbon and
hydrogen atoms before oxidation is completed.
In the case of solid fuels, combustion may be governed by the rate at which
oxidizer diffuses from the surrounding gases to the surface and by the release of
combustible gases near the surface. Combustion of solids may be enhanced by
increasing the fuel surface area exposed to the oxidizer by reducing fuel particle size.
106
The following simple model illustrates the effect.
Example 3.5 is, of course, an idealized example. In reality, the reacting surface area of
solid fuels is usually much larger than the spherical surface area implied by their size.
We have seen that, for combustion to occur, molecules of oxidizer must affiliate
with fuel molecules, an action enhanced by the three Ts of combustion: turbulence,
time, and temperature. Chemical reactions take place more rapidly at high temperatures
but nevertheless require finite time for completion. It is therefore important that burners
be long enough to retain the fuel-air mixture for a sufficiently long time so that
combustion is completed before the mixture leaves. Turbulence, or mixing, enhances
the opportunities for contact of oxidizer and fuel molecules and removal of products of
combustion.
A flame propagates at a given speed through a flammable mixture. It will
propagate upstream in a flow of a combustible mixture if its flame speed exceeds the
flow velocity. If a fixed flame front is to exist at a fixed location in a duct flow in which
the velocity of the combustion gas stream exceeds the propagation speed, some form of
flame stabilization is required. Otherwise the flame front is swept downstream and
flameout occurs. Stabilization may be achieved by using fixed flameholders (partial
107
flow obstructions that create local regions of separated flow in their bases where the
flame speed is greater than the local flow velocity) or by directing a portion of the flow
upstream to provide a low-speed region where stable combustion may occur.
Each combination of oxidizer and fuel has been seen to have a particular
stoichiometric oxidizer-fuel ratio for which the fuel is completely burned with a
minimum of oxidizer. It has also been pointed out that it is usually desirable to operate
burners at greater than the theoretical air-fuel ratio to assure complete combustion of
the fuel and that this is sometimes referred to as a lean mixture. Occasionally it may be
desirable to have incomplete combustion, perhaps to produce a stream of products in
which carbon monoxide exists or to assure that all the oxidizer in the mixture is
consumed. In that case a burner is operated at less than the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio
with what is called a rich mixture.
There are limits to the range of air-fuel ratios for which combustion will occur
called limits of flammability. Here the density of the mixture is important. The limits of
flammability around the stoichiometric A/F are reduced at low densities. If combustion
is to occur reliably in mixtures at low densities, it is necessary to closely control the
air-fuel ratio.
Combustion Analysis of Solid Fuels
In the determination of the air-fuel ratio and flue gas composition for the combustion of
solid fuels, it is important to account for the ash and moisture in the fuel in the as-fired
condition. In the following analyses, all of the elements of the reactants in the fuel and
oxidizer are assumed to be present in the flue gas products except for the ash, which is
assumed to fall as a solid or flow as molten slag to the furnace bottom. Nitrogen and
oxygen are present in many solid fuels and should be accounted for in predicting the
flue gas composition. While both carbon monoxide and oxygen may be present in
combustion products at the same time because of imperfect mixing of combustibles and
oxygen in some instances, we will assume for prediction of the flue gas composition
that perfect mixing occurs such that no carbon monoxide is present when excess air is
supplied.
EXAMPLE 3.6
A coal with a dry, ash-free composition of 0.87 C, 0.09 H
2
, 0.02 S, and 0.02 O
2
is
burned with 25% excess air. The as-fired ash and moisture contents are 6% and 4%,
respectively.
(a) What are the stoichiometric and actual air-fuel ratios?
(b) What is the flue gas composition?
Solution
(a) Before performing combustion calculations, it is necessary to convert coal
composition data to an as-fired basis. The ratio of as-fired to dry, ash-free
108
109
mf
j
= (kg j / kg fg) = (kg j / kg coal) / (kg fg / kg coal)
110
111
112
113
114
115
(Note: The reference conditions of the 1985 JANAF Thermochemical tables used differ
slightly from those of preceding editions.) Heats of formation are usually determined
based on statistical thermodynamics and spectroscopic measurements.
By definition, heats of formation are zero for all elements in the standard state.
Hence, from the steady-flow First Law of Thermodynamics, the heat transferred in a
formation reaction of a compound created from elements in the standard state is the
heat of formation for the compound, as in the hydrogen-to-water example just
mentioned.
Heat Transfer in a Chemically Reacting Flow
Consider now the combustion problem in which fuel and oxidizer flow into a control
volume and combustion products flow out. The steady-flow First Law of Thermo-
dynamics applied to the control volume may be written as
Q = H
p
H
r
+ W
s
[Btu | kJ] (3.7)
where Q is heat flow into the control volume, W
s
is the shaft work delivered by the
control volume, and the enthalpies, H, include chemical as well as thermal energy. The
subscripts r and p refer to the reactants entering and products leaving the control
volume, respectively. The enthalpy H
p
is the sum of the enthalpies of all product
streams leaving the control volume. A similar statement applies to H
r
for the entering
reactant streams.
116
The individual enthalpies may each be written as the product of the number of
moles of the component in the reaction equation and its respective enthalpy per mole of
the component. For example, for k products:
H
p
= n
1
h
1
+ n
2
h
2
+...+ n
k
h
k
[Btu | kJ] (3.8)
where the ns are the stoichiometric coefficients of the chemical equation for the
combustion reaction, and the enthalpies are on a per-mole bases.
EXAMPLE 3.9
Write an equation for the enthalpy of the products of complete combustion of octane in
oxygen.
Solution The balanced equation for the complete combustion of octane is
C
8
H
18
+ 12.5O
2
; 8CO
2
+ 9H
2
O
The mole coefficients, 8 and 9, of the products are stoichiometric coefficients that yield
H
p
= 8h(CO
2
) + 9h(H
2
O) [Btu | kJ]
per mole of octane consumed.
___________________________________________________________________

The enthalpy of any component of the reactants or products may be written as the
sum of (1) its enthalpy of formation at the standard temperature, T
o
, and standard
pressure, and (2) its enthalpy difference between the actual state and the standard state
of the components. Thus, for each component:
h(T) = h
f
(T
o
) + [h(T) h(T
o
)] [Btu /mole | kJ /mole] (3.9)
where it is assumed that the sensible gas enthalpy difference is independent of pressure.
Sensible enthalpies (those that depend on temperature but do not involve reactions or
phase change) relative to the standard reference state are given in Appendix D.
Thus, returning to the formation reaction for the combustion of hydrogen in
oxygen at the standard state to produce water, as discussed in the preceding section,
we see that the steady-flow First Law of Thermodynamics becomes
Q = (1)h
f, H2O
(1)h
f, H2
(0.5)h
f, O2
= 103,996 0 0 = 103,996 Btu/lb-mole
with water in the vapor phase as the product of combustion of one mole of H
2
. Here
the sensible enthalpy differences are zero, because both the products and the reactants
are at the standard state. Note that because the stoichiometric coefficients of both
117
hydrogen and water are the same in this reaction, the resulting heat transfer may be
interpreted as either per mole of water formed or per mole of hydrogen consumed.
If, instead, liquid water is the combustion product, the heat transfer is given by
Q = 122,885 0 0 = 122,885 Btu/lb-mole
of H
2
O. The difference between the two cases, 18,919 Btu/lb-mole H
2
O, is equivalent
to 18,935/18 = 1,051.9 Btu/lb
m
of water, the enthalpy of vaporization of water. This
result compares with the enthalpy or latent heat of vaporization of water at 77F,
1050.1 Btu/lb
m
, given in the steam tables.
With either liquid or gaseous water as the product, the heat transfer term for the
control volume is negative, indicating, in accordance with the usual sign convention,
that the heat flows from the control volume to the surroundings. The two calculations
above illustrate the fact that the heat transfer in a formation reaction at the standard
state is the heat of formation of the compound created.
EXAMPLE 3.10
What is the enthalpy of water vapor at 1800R and 1 bar? What is the heat transfer in
the formation reaction of water from hydrogen and oxygen if the products are at
1800R and the reactants are (a) at the standard state, and (b) at 900R?
Solution
The heat of formation of water vapor at the standard state of 298.15K. (536.7R)
and one bar is 103,966 Btu/lb-mole. The enthalpy of water vapor at 1800R is the
sum of the heat of formation at the standard state and the sensible enthalpy difference
of water vapor between 536.7R and 1800R. Thus:
H
p
= 103,966 + 11,185 = 92,781 Btu/lb-mole of water.
(a) In this case, the reactants, oxygen and hydrogen, have zero enthalpies because they
are in the standard state and, as elements, their heats of formation are zero. Thus the
heat transferred is 92,781 Btu/lb-mole, or 5154.5 Btu/lb
m
of water.

(b) For reactants at 900R , Appendix D gives h
H2
(900) h
H2
(536.7) = 2530 Btu/mole
of H
2
and h
O2
(900) h
O2
(536.7) = 2617 Btu/mole of O
2
. The enthalpy of the reactants
is then H
r
= (1.0)(2530) + (0.5)(2617) = 3838.5 Btu/lb-mole H
2
O. The heat transferred
is then:
Q = H
p
H
r
= 92,781 3,838.5 = 96,619.5 Btu/lb-mole of water,
or
Q = 96,619.5 / 18 = 5,367.8 Btu/lb
m
of water.
118
Thus more heat must be transferred from the control volume to form water vapor at
1800R if the reactants are at 900R than if they are in the 536.7R standard state.
Combustion Flame Temperature
In many combustion problems, the reactants enter the combustor near room tempera-
ture and products emerge at an elevated temperature. The temperature of the products
flowing from the control volume depends on the energy released in the combustion
reaction and heat gain or loss through the boundary of the control volume. The
resulting combustion product temperature is sometimes called the flame temperature.
EXAMPLE 3.11
Methane and stoichiometric air enter a combustor at the standard state. Using a spread-
sheet, calculate the heat transfer as a function of the exit (flame) temperature of the
products of complete combustion. Assume the water in the products remains a vapor.
Solution
The reaction equation for complete combustion of methane in air is:
CH
4
+ 2O
2
+ (2)3.76N
2
; CO
2
+ 2H
2
O + 7.52N
2

The enthalpy of the products at temperature T and of the reactants at the standard state
is
H
p
= (1)h
f, CO2
+ (1)[h
CO2
(T) h
CO2
(537)] + (2)h
f, H2O
+ (2)[h
H2O
(T) h
H2O
(537)] + (7.52)[h
N2
(T) h
N2
(537)]
H
r
= h
f, CH4
= 32,189.6 Btu/lb-mole
of methane, where the heats of formation of elemental nitrogen and oxygen are zero
and the heat of formation of water is for the vapor phase. Writing the enthalpy
differences as hs and applying the steady-flow First Law of Thermodynamics, we get
Q = H
p
H
r
= 169,184 + h
CO2
(T) + (2)( 103,966)
+ (2) h
H2O
(T) + 7.52 h
N2
(T) ( 32,189.6)
= 344,926.4 + h
CO2
(T) + (2)h
H2O
(T) + 7.52 h
N2
Btu/lb-mole
of methane. This function is tabulated in the spreadsheet in Table 3.10 and plotted in
Figure 3.4 using values of enthalpies at the temperature T from the the JANAF tables.
Negative values of Q indicate that heat must be rejected from the control volume to
maintain product effluent temperature below about 4200R. Beyond 4200R, the CO
2
,
119
N
2
, and H
2
O outflow carries more energy than is released in the control volume by
chemical reaction; hence, heat must flow into the control volume to achieve the
resulting high exit temperatures. Thus the final flame temperature clearly depends on
the chemical composition of the flow and on the consequent control volume heat
transfer.
____________________________________________________________________
120
Heat of Combustion and Heating Value
The heat of combustion, or enthalpy of combustion, of a fuel is defined as the energy
transferred during a steady-flow process in which the fuel is completely burned and
where the products are returned to the temperature and pressure of the reactants. It will
be seen that the enthalpy of combustion evaluated at the standard state may be deter-
mined from the heats of formation. The heat of combustion of hydrogen has, in fact,
been determined in a preceding section that examined the formation reaction for water.
The negative of the enthalpy of combustion of a fuel burned in air is usually
referred to as the heating value of the fuel. When water in the combustion products is
condensed, the heat of vaporization of the water adds to the chemical energy released,
and the resulting heating value is called the higher heating value, HHV. Recall also
that the heating value obtained when the product water stays a vapor is called the lower
heating value, LHV. The difference between HHV and LHV has been illustrated in the
previous section for the formation reaction of water resulting from the combustion of
hydrogen.
For methane, note also that the heat of combustion, and thus the magnitude of the
lower heating value, appears in the value of Q in the top row of table 3.10, since there
the combustion products are at the reference temperature.
EXAMPLE 3.12
Illinois no. 6 raw coal has the following dry mass composition: 61.6% C, 4.2% H
2
,
9.7% O
2
, 1.3% N
2
, 4.6% S, and 18.5% ash. Using heats of formation, determine the
higher and lower heating values, in kJ / kg, of the as-fired coal with 10% moisture, and
compare them with the heating value in Table 3.3.
Solution
To adjust the composition for 10% moisture, the factor 1 A M becomes 1 0
0.1 = 0.9. The resulting moist coal composition is given in the following table.
It was seen earlier that the heat of reaction of hydrogen in its standard state, and
thus its heat of combustion, is the heat of formation of its product of combustion. The
reaction equation
H
2
+ 0.5O
2
; H
2
O
shows that one mole of hydrogen produces one mole of water. Thus, from Table 3.9,
the heat of formation of steam, 241,826 kJ per kg-mole of water formed or per kg-
mole of hydrogen burned, is also the heat of combustion of hydrogen in the standard
state. Thus the hydrogen contributes 241,826/2 kJ per kg of hydrogen in the coal. The
total energy released by the hydrogen in the coal is then 241,826/2 times the mass
fraction of hydrogen in the coal, as shown in the following table. Similar arguments
may be made for hydrogen with product water in the liquid phase and the carbon and
sulfur components of the coal.
121
Element i Dry mf
i
Wet mf
i
Heat of Combustion kJ/kg coal
H
2
:
For LHV 0.042 0.0378 (241,826)(0.0378)/2 = 4,570.5 (v)
For HHV (285,830)(0.0378)/2 5402.2 (l)
C 0.616 0.5544 (393,522)(0.5544)/12 = 18,180.7
O
2
0.097 0.0873
N
2
0.013 0.0117
S 0.046 0.0414 (296,842)(0.0414)/32 = 384.0
Ash 0.185 0.1665
H
2
O _____ 0.1000
0.999 0.9991 23,135.2 (v)
23,966.9 (l)
Thus the lower and higher heating values of the coal are 23,135.2 and 23,966.9 kJ/kg,
respectively. Table 3.3 lists a heating value of dry Illinois no. 6 raw coal of 11,345
Btu/lb
m
. The corresponding heating value for the wet coal is (0.9)(11,345) = 10,210.5
Btu/lb
m
. This corresponds to (10,210.5)/(0.43) = 23,745 kJ/kg.
____________________________________________________________________
Adiabatic Flame Temperature
The results of Example 3.11, tabulated in Figure 3.10, show that for a given air-fuel
mixture there is a unique product temperature for which the control volume is
adiabatic. This temperature is known as the adiabatic flame temperature. It can be
determined as in Example 3.11, or it may be calculated from the steady-flow First Law
of Thermodynamics by setting Q = 0. The resulting First Law equation for the adiabatic
flame temperature, designated T*, becomes:
H
p
(T*) = H
r
(T
r
) [Btu | kJ] (3.10)
where the reactants are at the temperature T
r
. The enthalpy terms depend on the
individual enthalpies of the components as functions of temperature. Thus a trial-and-
error solution is required using data on heat of formation from Table 3.9 and the
enthalpy tables in Appendix D. Given a known T
r
, the adiabatic flame temperature may
also be obtained as the intercept (Q = 0) on a graph of Q versus temperature, T, such as
Figure 3.4.
Adiabatic Flame Temperature for Solid Fuels
122
As a final example, we will determine the combustion products, heat of combustion,
and adiabatic flame temperature for a solid fuel specified by its ultimate analysis. The
solution is presented in a spreadsheet in which enthalpies are tabulated as a function of
temperature for the relevant chemical components as given in the JANAF tables.
123
124
The number of moles of excess O
2
in the flue gas per pound of coal may also be
obtained from the excess air-fuel ratio:
[(A/F)
actual
(A/F)
theor
](0.233)/32 = (8.288 6.375)(0.233)/32 = 0.0139
The number of moles of flue gas nitrogen is also given by
[(A/F)
actual
](1 0.233)/28 + d = 8.288(0.767)/28 + 0.000357 = 0.227
With the actual balanced reaction equation known, the mole coefficients may then be
used to write an equation for the enthalpy of the products per unit mass of coal.
Because all the reactants are assumed to be elements at the reference temperature, the
enthalpy of the reactants is zero. By setting Q = H
p
= 0, we can solve this First Law
equation for the adiabatic flame temperature by trial and error. However, with a
spreadsheet, it is convenient to calculate the heat transfer at each temperature-enthalpy
data point and determine the adiabatic flame temperature by inspection and, if
additional precision is required, by explicit interpolation. The heat transfer equation is
shown on the spreadsheet, and the values of the flue gas mole coefficients and heats of
formation are shown above the appropriate JANAF enthalpies to which they relate.
It is seen that the adiabatic flame temperature for combustion with 30% excess air
is about 2110K, or 3800R. Note also that the heat of combustion of the coal, 8506.7
Btu/lb
m
of coal, may be read from the spreadsheet at the JANAF table reference
temperature. This is possible because the heat of reaction is independent of the amount
of excess air employed in the reaction.
_____________________________________________________________________
The spreadsheet for Example 3.13 is easily modified to compute and plot the
composition of the flue gas as a function of the percentage of excess air. Figure 3.5
shows that the mole fractions of excess oxygen and of nitrogen increase while the
fractions of other products decrease. Excess oxygen measured from a flue gas sample
is commonly used as a measure of excess air in adjusting the air-fuel ratio of
combustion systems.
3.6 Molecular Vibration, Dissociation, and Ionization
The temperature of a gas is a measure of the random translational kinetic energy of
molecules. The simple kinetic theory of the heat capacity of a gas predicts heat
capacities that are independent of temperature and determined by the number of
degrees of freedom of the molecules. The kinetic theory is usually regarded as
applicable at low pressures and moderate and high temperatures, conditions at which
collisions between molecules are rare.
125
For monatomic gases, kinetic theory predicts an internal energy per atom of
u = 3kT/2
and an enthalpy of
h = u + pv = 3kT/2 + kT = 5kT/2
Here k, the Boltzmann constant, is the ideal-gas constant per molecule, which can be
calculated from the universal gas constant, , and Avogadros number of molecules
per mole. Thus
k = /N
o
= 8.32/(6.025 10
23
) = 1.38 10
-23
J/K
From their definitions, Equations (1.14) and (1.15), this leads to c
v
= 3k/2 and c
p
= 5k/2
per atom and to a heat capacity ratio of k = c
p
/c
v
= 5/3 = 1.667.
The concept of equipartition of energy assumes that the energy of a particle is
equally divided among its various degrees of freedom. Each mode of energy storage of
a molecule is assigned an energy kT/2. The theory then represents the internal energy
as nkT/2, the enthalpy as (n + 2)kT/2, and the heat capacity ratio as k = (n + 2)/n,
where n is the number of modes of energy storage, or degrees of freedom, of the
molecule. For atoms with three translational and no rotational degrees of freedom,
n = 3 (an atom is presumed to be a point and to have no rotational kinetic energy
126
because it has zero radius); and these relations reduce to the findings described in the
preceding paragraph.
The simple kinetic theory suggests that a diatomic molecule has five degrees of
freedom: three degrees of translational freedom and two modes having significant
rotational kinetic energy. For this case we obtain u = 5kT/2, h = 7kT/2, and
k = 7/5 = 1.4, in agreement with experiment for oxygen and nitrogen at moderate
temperatures and densities.
At higher temperatures, diatomic molecules start to vibrate, adding additional
degrees of freedom that reduce the heat capacity ratio k below 1.4. As the temperature
increases and the collisions between molecules become more vigorous, molecules not
only vibrate but they start to be torn apart, each forming separate atoms, the process
known as dissociation. The energy required to break the bonds between atoms in
molecules is called the dissociation energy. At low temperatures, few molecules have
sufficient kinetic energy to provide the energy needed to cause dissociation by collision.
At higher temperatures, when more molecules have energies exceeding the dissociation
energy, the chemical equilibrium shifts to a composition in which there are more atoms
and fewer molecules in the gas. This trend continues as temperature increases.
At still higher temperatures, when particle kinetic energies exceed the ionization
energy of the gas, outer electrons are separated from atoms, forming positively charged
ions, in a process known as the ionization. Particles lose kinetic energy when causing
dissociation and ionization. This lost energy is then not reflected in the temperature.
Thus, when vibration, dissociation, and ionization occur, the internal energy and
enthalpy increase more rapidly than the temperature. Then the simple linear relations
just given for u and T are no longer correct. Stated another way, the temperature of a
gas rises less rapidly with heat addition when it is at temperature levels where
significant vibration, dissociation, or ionization take place. The phenomenon may be
thought of as analogous to phase change, in which enthalpy increases with heat addition
while temperature does not.
As a result of these phenomena, high flame temperatures determined with ideal gas
enthalpies may be overestimated. At temperatures exceeding 2000K (3600R), flame
temperature calculations based on the JANAF gas enthalpies may start to become
inaccurate. At these temperature levels, dissociation (and at still higher temperatures,
ionization) starts to influence the composition of the gases and hence their
thermodynamic properties. The progression of dissociation and ionization with
temperature is shown for air at sea level density in Figure 3.6. It is seen that, at this
density, little dissociation of nitrogen occurs below about 6000 K. but that oxygen
starts to dissociate significantly above 3000 K.. At lower densities, the onset of
dissociation occurs at progressively lower temperatures. In Figure 3.6, the number of
particles per initial atom of air may be obtained by multiplying the ordinates by 1.993.
Usually, dissociation does not seriously influence combustion calculations when the
oxidizer is air, but the high combustion temperatures resulting from use of pure oxygen
may be significantly influenced by dissociation. The reader is referred to advanced
thermodynamics, physical chemistry, and advanced engineering texts for methods of
predicting the effects of dissociation and ionization.
127
Bibliography and References
1. Anon, Steam, Its Generation and Use, 39
th
ed. New York,: Babcock and Wilcox,
1978.

2. Singer, Joseph G. (Ed.), Combustion / Fossil Power Systems. Windsor, Conn.:
Combustion Engineering Inc., 1981.
3. Anon., Classification of Coals by Rank, Standard D-388. Philadelphia: American
Society for Testing Materials, Section 5, Volume 05.05, 1983.
4. Chase, M. W. Jr., et.al., JANAF Thermochemical Tables, 3
rd
ed., J. Phys. Chem.
Ref. Data 14, Supplement No. 1, 1985.
5. Van Wylen, Gordon J., and Sonntag, Richard E., Fundamentals of Classical
Thermodynamics. New York: Wiley, 1986.
128
6. El-Wakil, M. M., Powerplant Technology. New York: McGraw-Hill, 1984.
7. Campbell, Ashley S., Thermodynamic Analysis of Combustion Engines. New York:
Wiley, 1979.
8. Culp, Archie W., Principles of Energy Conversion. New York: McGraw-Hill, 1979.
9. Wood, Bernard D., Applications of Thermodynamics. Reading, Mass.: Addison-
Wesley, 1982.
10. Lefebvre, Arthur H., Gas Turbine Combustion, New York: McGraw-Hill, 1983.
11. Baumeister, Theodore, and Marks, Lionel S. (Eds.), Standard Handbook for
Mechanical Engineers, 7
th
ed. New York: McGraw-Hill, 1967.
12. Sorenson, Harry A., Energy Conversion Systems. New York: Wiley, 1983.
13. Hill, Phillip G., Power Generation. Cambridge, Mass.: MIT Press, 1977.
14. Anon., Coal Quality Information Book, CS-5421, Interim Report. Palo Alto:
Electric Power Research Institute, December 1987.
15. Moeckel, W. E., and Weston, Kenneth C., Composition and Thermodynamic
Properties of Air in Chemical Equilibrium, NACA TN 4265, April 1958.
EXERCISES
3.1 Determine the mass fractions of a mixture of six grams of carbon, three grams of
sulfur, and one gram of sodium chloride.
3.2 Determine the mole fractions of a gas consisting of a mole of oxygen, eight moles
of nitrogen, a mole of CO, and two moles of CO
2
. Determine also the mass fractions.
What is the average molecular weight of the gas?
3.3 Write the balanced reaction equation for the complete combustion of sulfur in
oxygen. What are the mass and mole fractions of oxygen in the reactants?
3.4 Write the balanced reaction equation for the complete combustion of carbon in
oxygen. What are the mass and mole fractions of oxygen in the reactants?
3.5 Write the balanced reaction equation for the complete combustion of carbon in air.
What are the mass and mole fractions of fuel, air, oxygen, and nitrogen in the reactants?
129
3.6 Write the balanced reaction equation for the complete combustion of ethane, C
2
H
6
,
in air. What are the mass and mole fractions of fuel, air, oxygen, and nitrogen in the
reactants? What are the mass and mole fractions of carbon dioxide and water vapor in
the combustion products?
3.7 Write the balanced reaction equation for the complete combustion of propane,
C
3
H
8,
, in air. What are the mass and mole fractions of fuel, air, oxygen, and nitrogen in
the reactants? What are the mass and mole fractions of carbon dioxide and water vapor
in the combustion products. What are the mass and mole air-fuel ratios?
3.8 Write the balanced reaction equation for the complete combustion of C
8
H
18
in air.
What are the mass and mole fractions of fuel, air, oxygen, and nitrogen in the reactants?
What are the mass and mole fractions of carbon dioxide and water vapor in the
combustion products? What are the mass and mole air-fuel ratios?
3.9 Gasoline, sometimes represented as C
8
H
18,
is burned in 25% excess air mass. What
are the mass and mole stoichiometric and actual air-fuel ratios? Determine the mass
and mole fractions of the combustion products.
3.10 Determine the lower and higher heating values of methane using the JANAF table
of heats the formation.
3.11 Determine the as-fired stoichiometric and actual air-fuel ratios for Greene,
Pennsylvania raw coal (Table 3.3) with 5% moisture and the mass and mole flue gas
compositions for combustion with 20% excess air.
3.12 Compare the stoichiometric and actual air-fuel ratios and the mole flue gas
composition for combustion with 20% excess air for the following raw and clean
(process #1) coals (Table 3.3): (a) Freestone, Texas, big brown lignite; (b) Indiana,
Pennsylvania, Freeport (upper); (c) British Columbia, Hat Creek (A zone); (d) Perry,
Illinois no. 6; (e) Muhlenberg, Kentucky no. 9; (f) Nicholas, West Virginia, Kittanning;
(g) Belmont, Ohio, Pittsburgh; (h) Big Horn, Montana, Robinson; (i) Greene,
Pennsylvania, Sewickley; (j) Kanawha, West Virginia, Stockton-Lewiston; (k) Belmont,
Ohio, Waynesburg.
3.13 If Union, Kentucky no. 11 raw coal has 10% moisture, as mined, determine the as-
mined proximate and ultimate analyses for this coal.
3.14 If Big Horn, Montana, Robinson raw coal has 15% moisture, as-mined, what are
its as-mined proximate and ultimate analyses?
3.15 Determine the ultimate analyses of the raw coals listed in Exercise 3.12 (a-e)
assuming 10% as-mined moisture.
130
3.16 Write the balanced chemical equation for the combustion of methane in
stoichiometric air. Use the table of heats of formation to determine the heats of
reaction of methane (in Btu/lb
m
and Btu/lb-mole), with products and reactants all at the
standard state and product water as liquid. What are the values if the product water is
vapor? Would the heat of reaction be different if the combustion were in pure oxygen?
Compare your results with tabulated heating values for methane.
3.17 Solve Exercise 3.16 in SI units: kJ/gm-mole and kJ/kg.
3.18 Calculate the heating values, in Btu/lb
m
and Btu/lb-mole, for the complete
combustion of hydrogen, with product water in liquid and in vapor phases. Compare
with tabulated heating values. Repeat the calculations in SI units.
3.19 Determine the heat transferred when ethane is burned (a) in stoichiometric air, and
(b) in 100% excess air. In both cases the reactants are in the standard state and
products at 1000K. Use a heat of formation of 36,420 Btu/lb-mole.
3.20 What is the adiabatic flame temperature for the combustion of ethane in air,
ignoring dissociation? Use a heat of formation of 36,420 Btu/lb-mole of ethane.
3.21 Compare the adiabatic flame temperatures for the stoichiometric combustion of
hydrogen in air and in pure oxygen, ignoring dissociation.
3.22 Determine the adiabatic flame temperature for the stoichiometric combustion in
air of Illinois no. 6 coal after the clean #2 process. Determine also its heat of
combustion, and compare with the tabulated value.
3.23* Develop a spreadsheet that determines the air-fuel ratio for coal characterized by
a dry ultimate analysis, such as given in Table 3.3. Apply it to several of the coals in
the table, as assigned by your instructor.
3.24* Develop a spreadsheet that determines the air-fuel ratio for a coal characterized
by a dry ultimate analysis, such as given in Table 3.3, and a given moisture content.
Apply it to a coal in the table and several different moisture contents, as assigned by
your instructor.
3.25* Develop a spreadsheet that determines the mass and mole, wet and dry flue gas
compositions for a coal characterized by a dry ultimate analysis, such as given in Table
3.3, and a given percentage of excess air. Apply it to several coals in the table for 20%
and 40% excess air.
______________________
*Exercise numbers with an asterisk involve computer usage.
131
3.26* Develop a spreadsheet that determines the average molecular weight, and the
mass and mole, wet and dry flue gas compositions for a coal characterized by a dry
ultimate analysis, such as given in Table 3.3, a given percentage of excess air, and a
given moisture content. Apply it to a coal in the table for 10% moisture and 10% and
20% excess air.
3.27* Develop a spreadsheet that determines the theoretical air-fuel ratio for a gas
characterized by any combination of the components of Table 3.4. Apply it to the
gases in the table, as assigned by your instructor.
3.28* Develop a spreadsheet that determines the average molecular weight, and the
mass and mole, wet and dry flue gas compositions for a gas characterized by any
combination of the components of Table 3.4 and a given percentage of excess air.
Apply it to several the gases in the table for 20% excess air.
3.29 What are the theoretical and actual air-fuel ratios and the wet and dry mole flue
gas compositions for 20% excess air for the Oklahoma natural gas in Table 3.4?
3.30 What are the theoretical and actual air-fuel ratios and the wet and dry mole flue
gas compositions for 15% excess air for the Ohio natural gas in Table 3.4?
3.31 An adiabatic gas turbine combustor burns methane at 77F with air at 400F. The
combustion products emerge from the combustion chamber at 3200F. What is the air-
fuel ratio? What is the equivalent external heat transferred per lb
m
of air to produce this
temperature rise, assuming a mean heat capacity of 0.24 Btu/lb
m
-R?
3.32 An adiabatic gas turbine combustor burns methane at 25C with air at 250C. The
combustion products emerge from the combustion chamber at 2000K. What is the air-
fuel ratio? What is the equivalent external heat transferred per kilogram of air to
produce this temperature rise, assuming a mean heat capacity of 1.005 kJ/kg-K?
3.33 An adiabatic combustor burns methane with 400% excess air. Both air and
methane are initially at 298K. What is the exit temperature?
3.34 An adiabatic combustor burns methane with 500% theoretical air. Both air and
methane are initially at 77F. What is the flame temperature?
3.35 An adiabatic combustor burns methane in 100% excess oxygen. Both fuel and
oxidizer enter at the JANAF tables reference temperature. What is the flame
temperature?
3.36 Calculate and tabulate the higher and lower heating values of methane, in kJ/kg-
mole and in kJ/kg.
132
3.37 Determine the theoretical air-fuel ratio and the air-fuel ratio for 20% excess air
for Muhlenberg, Kentucky, raw coal with 10% moisture.
3.38 Determine the air-fuel ratio and wet and dry flue gas mole and mass fractions for
dry Muhlenberg, Kentucky no. 9 raw coal with 20% excess air.
3.39 Solve Exercise 3.38 for the coal having 10% moisture in the as-fired condition.
3.40 Solve Exercise 3.38 for 40% excess air.
3.41* Set up a spreadsheet to solve Exercises 3.383.40 where it is necessary to
change only one parameter for each of the latter cases.
3.42 Using the compound composition data of Table 3.4, calculate the ultimate
(elemental) analysis, and compare with the tabular results for the following natural
gases: (a) Pennsylvania, (b) Southern California, (c) Ohio, (d) Louisiana, (e) Oklahoma.
3.43* Develop an interactive computer program to solicit and receive ultimate analysis
data for an arbitrary coal, arbitrary as-fired ash and moisture fractions, an excess air
percentage, and output the appropriate air-fuel ratio and mass and mole, wet and dry
flue gas compositions.
3.44* Develop an interactive computer program to solicit and receive ultimate analysis
data for an arbitrary coal, arbitrary as-fired ash and moisture fractions, and Orsat CO,
CO
2
, and O
2
data. The program should determine the actual operating air-fuel ratio.
3.45* Apply the spreadsheet of Example 3.13 to determine the adiabatic flame
temperature, heat of combustion, and wet flue gas composition for stoichiometric
combustion of the liquid fuels in Table 3.6.
3.46* Develop a well-organized spreadsheet in which the user may enter a coal
ultimate analysis for C, H, O, N, and S; dry flue gas mole compositions for CO, CO2,
and 0
2
; and as-fired moisture and ash mass fractions to determine theoretical and actual
air-fuel ratios and percentage of excess air.
133
C H A P T E R F O U R
ASPECTS of STEAM
POWER PLANT DESIGN
4.1 Introduction
After studying the fundamental thermodynamic cycles of steam power plants and con-
sidering the characteristics and thermochemistry of fuels, it is appropriate to consider
the design of the systems and flow processes that are operative in steam plants and
other large-scale power production facilities. This chapter will focus first on the
processing of several fundamental streams that play a major role in power plant
operation. Up to this point, a great deal of attention has been focused on the water path
from the point of view of the thermodynamics of the steam cycle. Additional aspects of
the water path related to plant design are considered here.
Another fundamental flow in the power plant, the gas stream, includes the intake
of combustion air, the introduction of fuel to the air stream, the combustion process,
combustion gas cooling in the furnace heat exchange sections, and processing and
delivery of the gas stream to the atmosphere through a chimney or stack. A third
important stream involves the transportation and preparation of fuel up to the point that
it becomes part of the combustion gas.
A major non-physical aspect of power production is the economics of power plant
design and operation. This is considered in conjunction with some preliminary design
analyses of a prototype plant. Environmental considerations also play an important part
in planning and design. The chapter concludes with back-of-the-envelope type
calculations that define the magnitudes of the flows in a large plant and identify major
design aspects of steam power plants.
4.2 The Water Path
The Liquid-Water-to-Steam Path

Several pumps are employed in the feedwater path of a steam power plant to push the
working fluid through its cycle by progressively elevating the pressure of the water
from the condenser to above the turbine throttle pressure. These pumps are usually
driven by electric motors powered by electricity generated in the plant or by steam
turbines powered by steam extracted from the main power cycle.
134
The power requirement of a pump is proportional to the liquid mass-flow rate and the
pump work, as given by Equation 2.9, and inversely proportional to the pump
efficiency:
Power = mv
sat
p/
pump
[ft-lb
f
/s | kW]
The pumps are required to overcome frictional pressure losses in water-flow and
steam-flow passages, to provide for the pressure differences across turbines, and to
elevate the liquid to its highest point in the steam generator. The pump power
requirements are typically a small percentage of the gross power output of the plant.
Thus condensate leaving the condenser passes through one or more pumps and
feedwater heaters on its way to the steam generator. A typical shell-and-tube closed
feedwater heater is shown in Figure 4.1. Normally, feedwater passes through the tubes
while extracton steam enters at the top and condenses as it flows over the tubes to the
bottom exit.
135
After passing through the chain of feedwater heaters and pumps, the feedwater
enters the steam generator through the economizer. An economizer is a combustion-
gas-to-feedwater tubular heat exchanger that shares the gas path in a steam generator,
as seen in Figure 4.2. The economizer heats the feedwater by transferring to it some of
the remaining energy from the cooled exhaust gas before the gas passes to the air
heater, the pollution control equipment, and the stack.
136
Steam Generators
Figures 4.3 and 4.4 show two-drum steam generators in which the design
vaporization pressure is below the critical pressure of water. Hot, subcooled liquid
feedwater passes from the economizer and through the boiler tube walls to the drum
loop located near the top of the steam generator. Liquid water circulates by free
convection through the many boiler tubes between the drums until it is vaporized by the
hot gas stream flowing over the tubes. A fixed liquid level is maintained in the upper
steam drum, where the steam separates from the liquid and passes to the superheater.
Solids settle in the bottom of the so-called mud drum below it.
A steam drum mounted on a railroad flat car en route to a construction site is
shown in Figure 4.5. The many stub tubes around the bottom and on top are to be
137
connected to steam-generating loops and to steam-superheating pipes, respectively, as
seen at the top of Figure 4.4. The large pipes on the bottom and the ends are for
connection to downcomers, which supply recirculated liquid water to various heating
circuits in the steam generator.
Steam produced in the steam drum, at a boiling temperature corresponding to the
vapor pressure in the drum, passes to superheater tube or plate heat-exchanger banks.
The superheater tube banks are located in the gas path upstream of the drum loop, as
seen in Figures 4.3 and 4.4, taking advantage of the highest gas temperatures there to
superheat the steam to throttle temperature. The hottest gases are used to heat the
138
hottest water-tube banks, to minimize the irreversibility associated with the heat
transfer through the large temperature differences between the combustion gas and the
steam or liquid water. The dry steam from the superheater then passes from the steam
generator through the main steam line to the HP turbine. The progression of tube
banks, with decreasing water temperatures exposed to successively cooler gas temp-
eratures from the secondary superheater to the economizer to the air heater are also
seen in the universal-pressure (supercritical pressure) steam generator in Figure 4.2.
As the design throttle steam pressure increases toward the critical pressure of
water, the density difference between liquid water and vapor decreases, finally
vanishing at the critical point (3208.2 psia, 705.47F.). As a consequence, in steam-
generator boiling loops, natural convection water circulationwhich is driven by the
density difference between liquid and steambecomes impractical at pressures above
about 2500 psia. Thus modern high-throttle-pressure power plants use circulating
pumps to provide forced to circulation to augment or replace natural circulation of
water in the steam generator.
In single-drum steam generators, water flows downward from the steam drum
through large pipes called downcomers located outside the furnace wall, then through
circulating pumps to headers at the bottom of the steam generator. From the headers,
water flows upward in vertical tubes forming the inside of the furnace walls. The water
is heated by the furnace gases as it rises, and eventually boils and forms a two-phase
flow that returns to the steam drum. There, vapor separates and passes to the
superheater.
Steam generators may utilize natural convection flow through downcomers and
139
vapor-laden upward flow through the tube walls alone or may combine natural
convection with the use of booster pumps to provide adequate circulation for a wider
range of operating loads. It is important to recognize that at the same time steam is
being generated in the boiler, the tube walls are being cooled by the water. Adequate
water circulation must be ensured to provide waterside heat transfer rates high enough
to maintain tube wall temperatures below their limiting design values and thereby to
avoid tube failure.
A once-through supercritical steam generator, operates at a throttle pressure
above the critical pressure of water as in the Riverside station discussed in Chapter 2.
There are no drums and no water recirculation in a once-through steam generator.
Water from the economizer passes to the bottom of the furnace, where it starts its
upward flow through the furnace tube walls. Steam formed in the tubes flows upward
to be collected in headers and mixed to provide a unifrom feed to the superheater.
The feedwater passes directly from the liquid to the vapor phase as it is heated at a
pressure above the saturation pressure. It may be compared to a flow of water pumped
through a highly heated tube with a downstream valve. The state of the steam emerging
from the tube depends on the valve setting, the heat addition rate, and the feedwater
flow rate. In the same way, the steam conditions at the turbine throttle may be adjusted
by changing the turbine throttle valve setting, the fuel firing rate, and the feedwater
flow rate. If the flow rate is decreased by closing the throttle valve, it is necessary to
decrease the fuel firing rate to maintain the same thermodynamic conditions at the
throttle. On the other hand, if the rate of heat transfer is increased without changing the
flow rate, the steam discharge temperature will increase. Other adjustments, such as
increasing condenser cooling-water flow rate, may then be appropriate to avoid an
increase in condenser temperature and pressure. Similarly, an increase in fuel flow rate
must be accompanied by an increase in air flow rate to maintain a constant air-fuel
ratio.
In cycles with reheat, the reduced-pressure steam from the HP turbines passes
through the cold reheat line to the reheater section in the steam generator, where the
steam temperature is returned to approximately the original throttle temperature. The
steam then returns to the next turbine through the hot reheat steam line, as Figure 2.13
indicates.
After leaving the LP turbine, low-pressure steam then passes over the
water-cooled tubes in the condenser and returns to the feedwater heating system as
saturated liquid condensate. A condensate pump then raises the pressure of the liquid
and transports it to the first low-pressure feedwater heater, where it begins another trip
through the cycle.
In order to avoid corrosion, scaling and the deposits of solids along the water path
can result in losses of efficiency and unscheduled shutdowns, water of extreme purity is
required in the steam cycle. Chemical and filtration processes are employed to ensure
that high water quality is maintained, to avoid deterioration or clogging of water path
components. An example of the potential deposits when proper water treatment is
neglected is seen in Figure 4.6. The deaerator, an open feedwater heater mentioned in
140
Chapter 2, provides for the removal of noncondensable gases, particularly oxygen,
from the working fluid. The deaerator allows noncondensable gases to escape to the
atmosphere through a vent condenser, while accompanying steam is retained by
condensing it on cool surfaces and returning it to the feedwater heater stream by
gravity flow.
The turbine room at the Bull Run coal-burning power plant of the Tennessee
Valley Authority (TVA) is shown in Figure 2.3. Electrical generators are seen in the
left and right foreground. Behind them, high-pressure turbines on the left are seen
joined to low-pressure turbines on the right by two large, vee-shaped crossover steam
lines. The side-by-side condensers are seen on either side of the low pressure turbines,
a departure from the usual practice of locating the condenser below the low-pressure
turbines. Figure 4.7 shows the turbogenerator room at TVAs Browns Ferry nuclear
power plant with a turbine in the foreground.
The Condenser Cooling-Water Loop
The cooling loop, in which water passes through tubes in the condenser removing heat
from the condensing steam, is an important water path in large steam plants. This
cooling water, clearly separate from the working fluid, is usually discharged into a
nearby body of water (a river, or a natural or man-made lake) or into the atmosphere.
Figure 4.8 shows a typical wood-framed, induced-draft cooling tower used to
dissipate heat from the condenser cooling water into the atmosphere. The tower is
usually located a few hundred yards from a plant. Typically, the cooling water entering
the tower is exposed to a flow of air created by upward-blowing fans at the bases of the
funnels at the top of the towers. A fraction of the condenser cooling water, which
passes over extensive aerating surfaces in the tower, evaporates and exits to the
141
atmosphere, cooling the rest of the water. The remaining chilled water is then returned
to the condenser by a cooling-water circulating pump. A continuing supply of liquid
makeup water is required for these towers to compensate for vapor loss to the
atmosphere.
In areas where large structures associated with power plants are acceptable, large
natural-draft cooling towers may be used. Figure 4.9 shows two large natural-draft
hyperbolic cooling towers serving a large power plant. The height of these towers,
which may reach over 500 feet, creates an upward draft due to the difference in density
between the warm air in the tower and the cooler ambient air. Heat from the condenser
cooling water warms the air, inducing an upward air flow through the heat transfer
surfaces at the base. These towers offer long-term fan-power savings over mechanical
draft towers. Under some conditions, these power savings may offset high construction
costs of hyperbolic towers.
142
143
4.3 The Fuel Path for a Coal-Burning Plant
The supply and handling of fuel for a modern coal-burning power plant is a complex
and expensive undertaking. In contrast to the relatively simple steady flow of fluid fuels
in power plants that consume natural gas and fuel oil, solid-fuel-burning plants offer
major and continuing challenges to engineers. The discussion here focuses on these
operations and their challenges.
Getting the Coal to the Plant
The source of coal for a plant may be a surface mine or a deep underground mine.
Power plants are sometimes located adjacent to mines, where conveyors may provide
the only transportation required. This significantly reduces coal transportation costs
which otherwise can be higher than the cost of the coal alone. Such plants are called
mine-mouth plants. A mine-mouth plant may be an attractive option if its selection
does not result in significant transmission costs to bring the electrical power to distant
load centers where the utilities customers are located.
Today the power plant and coal mines are likely to be a considerable distance
apart, perhaps a thousand miles or more. The most widely used modern transportation
link between mine and plant is the unit train, a railroad train of about a hundred cars
dedicated to transporting a bulk product such as coal. Although slurry pipelines (a
slurry is a fluid mixture of solid lumps and liquid, usually water, which can be pumped
through pipes by continuous motion) sometimes offer attractive technical solutions to
coal transport problems, economic and political forces frequently dictate against their
use. Dedicated truck transport is an occasional short-haul solution, and barges are
sometimes used for water transport. Here, we will focus on unit trains.
Several unit trains may operate continuously to supply a single plant. Trains
carrying low-sulfur coal from Wyoming, Montana, and the Dakotas supply coal to
plants as distant as Michigan, Illinois, and Oklahoma. This strange situation, in which
utilities located in states with large quantities of coal purchase coal from distant states,
was a response to pollution control requirements. It was preferred to purchase low-
sulfur coal from a distant state rather than pay a high price for sulfur removal
equipment (perhaps 10% of the cost of the plant construction), some of which has a
reputation for unreliability. In response to such choices, the Oklahoma legislature
passed a law requiring utilities to burn at least 10% Oklahoma coal in their
coal-burning steam generators. Such mixing of small quantities of high-sulfur coal with
low-sulfur coal is an expedient to protect local businesses and to spread out resource
utilization geographically.
New plants, however, no longer have the option to choose low-sulfur coal
or sulfur removal equipment. Best available control technology, BACT, has become
the rule. The Environmental Protection Agency now requires new plants to have
scrubbers (sulfur removal equipment) even if the plants use low-sulfur coal, and they
are required to employ the currently most effective pollution control technology.
144
Coal Unloading and Storage
On arrival at the plant, the unit train passes through an unloading station. Some coal
cars have doors on the bottom that open and dump their load to a conveyor below.
Others have couplings between cars that allow the rotation of individual cars about
their coupling-to-coupling axis, by a dumping machine, without detachment from the
train, as seen in Figure 4.10. The figure shows a breaker in the dumping facility that
reduces large coal chunks to a smaller, more uniform size for transport on a belt
conveyor. The under-track conveyor at the unloading station then carries the newly
arrived coal up and out to a bunker or to a stacker-reclaimer in the coal yard as seen in
Figure 4.11. The stacker-reclaimer either feeds the coal through a crusher to the plant
or adds it to the live storage pile.
A permanent coal storage pile sufficient to supply the plant for several months is
usually maintained. While the first-in-first-out approach common in handling perishable
goods seems logical, a first-in-last-out storage system is usually used. A primary
reason for this approach is the hazard and expense of coal pile fires, which can occur
due to spontaneous combustion. Once a stable storage pile is achieved by packing and
other treatment to restrict air acccess, it is usually not disturbed unless coal must be
withdrawn by the stacker-reclaimer to satisfy unusual demands caused by labor strikes,
extreme weather, rail accidents, or the like.
145
146
A conveyor transports coal from the reclaimer to a crusher house, where hammer
mills, ball crushers, or roller crushers break up large chunks to a more manageable
size. Another conveyor may then carry the crushed coal to one of several bunkers or
silos for temporary storage prior to firing. Some of these features may be seen in the
photograph of the PSO Northeastern Station in Figure 2.1.
The rate of feeding coal from the silos is controlled to maintain the desired steam
generator energy-release rate. In a pulverized-coal plant, the coal is fed from the silos
to pulverizers, where it is further reduced in size to a powdery form. Warm air drawn
through an air preheater in the steam generator by the primary air fan flows through
the pulverizer, where it picks up the fine coal particles and transports them pneumatic-
ally through piping to the steam generator burners. Several arrangements of silos,
feeders, pulverizers, and pneumatic transport systems are seen in Figures 4.2 to 4.4.

4.4 The Gas Path
Fans
While natural or free convection may be used to provide combustion air to small boilers
and heaters, modern power plants employ large fans or blowers to circulate air to the
burners and to assist flue gas in escaping from the furnace. These fans are called
forced-draft fans and induced-draft fans, respectively. A common arrangement of
these fans is shown in Figure 4.4. Atmospheric air drawn into the steam generator by
one or more forced-draft fans is heated as it passes through the cold gas side of an air
heater on its way to the furnace. At the same time, combustion gases that have passed
through the furnace heat transfer sections are cooled as they passed through the hot
side of the air heater on their way to induced-draft fans and thence to the stack. In the
case of pulverized-coal-burning plants, primary air fans, as seen in Figures 4.3 and 4.4,
supply enough pre-heated air to pulverizers to transport coal pneumatically to the
burners. Primary air usually pre-heated to 300-600F to dry the coal as it passes
through the pulverizer.
With a forced-draft fan alone, the furnace pressure is above atmospheric pressure,
causing large outward forces on the furnace walls and a tendency for leakage of
combustion gas from the furnace. On the other hand, the use of an induced-draft fan
alone would cause the furnace pressure to be below atmospheric pressure, producing
large inward forces on the walls and possible air leakage into the furnace. The forces
on the walls, which can be significant, can be minimized by keeping the furnace
pressure near atmospheric by using balanced draft, that is, the use of both forced- and
induced-draft fans, which produce a gas path pressure distribution such as shown by
the heavy line in Figure 4.12. In this design the forced-draft fan raises the pressure to
15 in. of water gauge entering the steam generator, and the induced-draft fan depresses
its inlet pressure about 21 in. of water below atmospheric. As a result, the furnace
inside-wall pressure is less than an inch of water below atmospheric. This substantially
reduces both the potential for furnace leakage and the forces on the furnace walls.
147
The power requirements for fans may be determined in much the same way that
pump power requirements are determined. Fans are primarily gas-moving devices that
produce small pressure rises. Pressure and density changes across fans are usually
small fractions of the fan inlet values. This justifies the approximation that the fan
process is incompressible. Fan power requirements then closely follow the pump
power prediction method discussed earlier. Thus, for a forced-draft fan, power may be
estimated by using
Power
FD
= Q
air
p
air
/
FDfan
[ft-lb
f
/s | kW]
For the induced-draft fan
Power
ID
= ,
air
Q
air
p
gas
(1 + F/A)/,
gas

FDfan
[ft-lb
f
/s | kW]
where Q
air
is the volume flow rate of air entering the forced-draft fan. The second
equation accounts for the additional fuel mass handled by the induced-draft fan and the
148
density of the gas leaving the furnace, assuming no leakage or diversion of air from that
leaving the forced-draft fan.
The drawing of a centrifugal forced-draft fan is shown in Figure 4.13; a
photograph of a rotor and open housing is presented in Figure 4.14. In a centrifugal
fan, air is spun by the rotor blades, producing tangential motion and pressure rise and
leaving behind a vacuum for air to flow in along the axis of the fan. It the fan entrance
is open to the atmosphere, its exhaust is pressurized; if its exhaust is atmospheric, its
entrance pressure is below atmospheric. Fans typically do not produce large pressure
rises but do produce large flows of gases.
A diagram of an axial-flow fan designed for induced-draft use is shown in Figure
4.15. Figure 4.16 presents a photo of the same type of fan. Induced-draft fans
must be able to withstand high-temperature service and erosion due to airborne
particulates. Large electrostatic precipitators located upstream of the induced-draft
fans remove most of the flyash by inducing a static charge on the flowing particles
and collecting them on plates of opposite charge. The plates are periodically rapped
mechanically to free ash deposits that drop to the bottom of the precipitator and are
collected and removed. Figure 2.1 shows electrostatic precipitators, to the right of the
steam generator. The large structure behind the fans, air heater, and ducting and below
the stack in Figure 4.4 is an electrostatic precipitator.
Air Preheaters
The air leaving the forced-draft fan usually flows through an air preheater to a windbox
around the furnace and then to the burners. A Ljungstrom rotary air preheater, used
149
150
in many large plants, is shown in Figures 4.17 and 4.18. The rotary air heater is a
slowly rotating wheel with many axial-flow passages, having large surface area and
heat capacity, through which air and flue gas pass in counterflow parallel to the wheel
axis. When the wheel surfaces heated by the flue gas rotate to the air side, they are
cooled by the air from the forced-draft fan. As result, the air temperature rises several
hundred degrees before passing to the furnace windbox.
Although the Ljungstrom rotary air heater is widely used in utility and industrial
power plants, heat-pipe air and process heaters are now being considered and applied
for use in power plants and industry. A heat pipe, shown in Figure 4.19, is a sealed
tube in which energy is transported from one end to the other by a thermally driven
vapor. The heat-pipe working fluid absorbs heat and vaporizes at the lower, hot end.
After rising to the higher, cold end, the vapor condenses, releasing its heat of
vaporization, which is carried away by conduction and convection through external fins
to the combustion air. The liquid then returns to the hot end by gravity and/or by
capillary action through wicking, to complete the cycle. The wicking may be spiral
grooves around the inside of the tube that ensure that the entire inside surface is wetted
for maximum heat transfer. The wicking in the cold section is particularly important,
because it provides increased surface area that increases inside-gas heat transfer rates.
The outside the tube is usually finned to provide adequate external heat transfer rates,
both from the flue gas and to the incoming air.
151
152
As a heat transfer device, a well-designed heat pipe has an effective thermal
conductance many times that of a copper rod. Note that the energy transfer inside the
heat pipe is essentially isothermal, since the liquid and the vapor are in near
equilibrium. Although heat pipes will operate in a horizontal orientation, their
effectiveness is augmented by gravity by inclining them about 5 10 to assist in liquid
return to the hot end.
In power plant air heater applications (see Figures 4.19 and 4.20), finned heat
pipes supported by a central partition between the incoming air stream and the flue gas
153
stream are free to expand outward. This reduces thermal expansion problems and
virtually eliminates the possibility of leakage between the flows. Such heaters often
have been installed in process plants and have been retrofitted in power plants originally
built without air heaters, because of their ease of installation and compact size
compared with stationary tubular air heaters.
EXAMPLE 4.1
The heat-pipe air heater in Figure 4.20 has an air flow of 360,800 lb
m
/hr and a flue gas
flow rate of 319,000 lb
m
/hr. The flue gas enters at 705F and leaves at 241F; the
combustion air enters at 84F. What is the rate of energy recovery from the flue gas,
and what is the air temperature entering the windbox? Assume a flue gas heat capacity
of 0.265 Btu/lb
m
-R.
Solution
The rate of heat recovery from the flue gas is
mc
p
(T
out
T
in
) = 319,000(0.265)(705 241) = 39,224,240 Btu/hr
The air temperature is then
84 + 39,224,240/[(0.24)(360,800)] = 537F
_____________________________________________________________________
An analysis of the gas flow through a steam generator must take into account the
streamwise pressure rise through the fans and pressure losses due to friction and losses
through flow restrictions and turns. These include losses due to flow through furnace
tube and plate heat exchanger banks and other passages, such as in both the air and the
gas passes through the air heater.
Power Plant Burners
Burner design depends on the choice of fuel and the steam generator design. Figure
4.21 shows a burner designed for forced-draft applications burning natural gas and oil.
Oil and steam under pressure are mixed in the central feed rod to atomize the oil to a
fine mist coming out of the oil tip. The cone at the oil tip stabilizes the flame in the
surrounding air flow. The gas pilot next to the oil feed rod provides a continuous
ignition source. A separate duct for the natural gas supply feeds gas to the two types
of gas tip. Separate air registers control the flow of air to the gas and oil tips. Figure
4.22 shows an oil burner, with a water-cooled throat, installed in a furnace wall.
Registers that control the flow of air from the windbox are also visible.
154
In the case of the pulverized-coal plant, primary air flows through the pulverizer and
carries the fuel directly to the burners (Figure 4.23). Secondary (and sometimes
tertiary) air helps to control the temperature of the control nozzle and of the furnace
wall, and mixes with the combustion gases to provide for essentially complete
combustion of the fuel. Features of a burner designed for pulverized-coal firing in
planar furnace walls are shown in Figure 4.24. Note that the secondary air flow
through the windbox registers helps to cool the nozzle through which the coal and the
primary air flow.
Another approach to burning pulverized coal uses corner burners in tangentially
fired steam generators. A plan view of such a furnace is shown in Figure 4.25. The
burners induce a circular motion, in the horizontal plane, on the upward-rising
combustion gases, promoting vigorous mixing, which hastens completion of
combustion in the furnace. For control purposes, the corner burners can be tilted in the
vertical direction to adjust the furnace heat transfer distribution.
A cyclone furnace type of burner installation, used for burning slagging coals
(those that form liquid ash, or slag, at moderate temperatures) in steam generators, is
shown in Figure 4.2. The cyclone furnace is a cylindrical furnace with very large
155
156
volumetric heat release rates that lies adjacent to and opens onto the main furnace.
Details of a cyclone furnace are shown in Figures 4.26 and 4.27.
The coal supplied to cyclone furnaces, which is crushed but not pulverized, is fed
to the cyclone by a mechanical feeder. The coal and primary air entering the cyclone
157
move tangentially to the inside of the furnace cylinder. There the momentum of the
coal carried by the swirl flows forces the coal pieces toward the cylindrical burner wall.
The very high temperature and vigorous mixing produce a high rate of burning. As a
result, combustion is virtually complete by the time the combustion gas flow enters the
158
main furnace. The cooled walls stimulate formation of a protective slag layer on the
cylinder walls. Because the main furnace is only required for steam generation and to
cool the combustion gases, and not to provide time for completion of combustion, the
cyclone furnace steam generator can be significantly smaller than the pulverized-coal
steam generator. A steady flow of slag drains from the cyclone furnace into a slag tank
at the bottom of the main furnace.
In both cyclone and pulverized-coal steam generators the combustion gases flow
upward from the burners, transferring heat to the tube walls by radiation and
convection. The cooling gases then flow through superheater, reheat, and boiler tube or
plate sections. The combustion gas temperature drops as it passes through these steam
generator sections in essentially a counterflow arrangement with the water flow. The
combustion gases undergo their final cooling as they pass through the economizer and
then the air preheater. From there they pass through an electrostatic precipitator for
removal of airborne particles and through scrubbers for control of oxides of nitrogen
and sulfur (NO
x
and SO
x
) and through an induced-draft fan before entering the stack.
The serious degradation of the environment caused by oxides of sulfur and
nitrogen in the flue gas of power plants and from other sources has led to widespread
chemical processing of flue gases. Figure 4.28 shows a schematic diagram of the gas
flow path for removal of NO
x
and SO
x
after particulate removal in the precipitator and
passage through an induced-draft fan. In this scheme, gas-to-gas heat exchangers
(GGH) provide the proper temperatures for the flue gas desulfurization (FGD) unit and
the DENOX catalyst unit. This additional equipment increases the pressure drop
through the system, sometimes necessitating an additional fan.
With high smokestacks, the stack effect also influences the gas path and must be
taken into account.The stack effect is the upward movement of exhaust gas produced
by the density difference between the hot gases inside the stack and the surrounding
cooler atmospheric air. Because of hot gas buoyancy, a smaller pressure gradient along
the stack length is required to expel the combustion gases from the stack. This effect is
opposed by the usual viscous friction pressure losses. The diameter and height of the
stack control the relative influence of frictional forces in opposing the stack effect.
Other considerations, such as cost and a possible need to disperse the stack gas above a
particular height, also have a significant influence on these dimensions.
It is obvious that the air heater of the steam generator should extract as much
energy from the combustion gas as possible to maximize its regenerative heat transfer
effect. This implies cooling the gas to a low tempeature. However, practical limits exist
on the minimum combustion gas temperature, to avoid the condensation of water vapor
in the presence of sulfur and nitrogen compounds in the gas and to meet the temp-
erature requirements of the pollution control equipment. Condensation of water vapor
in the presence of gaseous oxides of sulfur and nitrogen leads to the formation of acids
that erode the materials on which the liquid condenses. The temperature at which the
vapor condenses is called the acid dew point. Typical acid dew points for coal range to
about 320F. As a result, stack gas design temperatures may exceed that value,
depending on the coal and flue gas treatment.
159
4.5 Introduction to Engineering Economics

The success of any engineering undertaking depends on adequate financial planning
to ensure that the proceeds of the activity will exceed the costs. The construction of a
new power plant or the upgrading of an old one involves a major financial investment
for any energy company. Financial planning therefore starts long before ground is
broken, detailed design is begun, and orders are placed for equipment. Cost analysis
and fiscal control activities continue throughout the construction project and the
operating life of the plant. This section briefly introduces fundamentals of engineering
economics, with a slant toward power plant cost analysis as well as issues of
maintenance and equipment replacement.
160
The cost to construct a power plant, waterworks, dam, bridge, factory, or other
major engineering work is called its capital cost. It is common to discuss the capital
cost of building a power plant in terms of dollars per kilowatt of plant power output. A
plant may cost $1100 per kilowatt of installed power generation capacity, for instance.
In addition to the cost of building the plant, there are many additional expenditures
required to sustain its operation. These are called operating costs. They may be
occasional, or they may occur regularly and continue throughout the life of the plant.
Often these costs are periodic, or are taken to be periodic for convenience of analysis.
There are, for instance, annual fuel costs, salary expenses, and administrative and
maintenance costs that are not associated with the initial cost of the plant but are the
continuing costs of generating and selling power. Operating costs are sometimes
related to the amount of electrical energy sold. Usually they are expressed in cents per
kilowatt-hour of energy distributed to customers.
Thus the expenses associated with power generation and other business endeavors
may be thought of as two types: (1) initial costs usually associated with the purchase of
land, building site preparation, construction, and the purchase of plant equipment; and
(2) recurring operating costs of a periodic or cyclic nature.
It is frequently desirable to express all costs on a common basis. The company and
its investors may wish to know what annual sum of money is equivalent to both the
capital and operating costs. The company may, for example, borrow money to finance
the capital cost of the plant and then pay the resulting debt over the expected useful life
of the plant, say, 30 or 40 years. On the other hand, they may wish to know what
present sum would be required to ensure the payment of all future expenses of the
enterprise.
It is clear that $100 in hand today is not the same as $100 in hand ten years from
now. One difference is that money can earn interest. One hundred dollars invested
today at 8% annual compound interest will become $215.89 in ten years. Clearly, an
important aspect of engineering economics is the time value of money.
Compound Interest
If Alice lends Betty $500, who agrees to pay $50 each year for five years for the use of
the money, together with the original $500, then at the end of the fifth year, Alice will
have earned $250 in simple interest and receive a total of $750 in return. The annual
interest rate is
i = Annual interest / Capital = 50 / 500 = 0.1
or (0.1)(100) = 10% rate of return.
If, however, Betty keeps the interest instead of paying it to Alice annually, and
eventually pays 10% on both the retained interest and the capital, the deal involves
compound interest. The total sum to be returned to Alice after 5 years is computed as
follows: At the end of the first year Alice has earned $50 in interest. The interest for the
161
next year should be paid on the original sum and on the $50 interest earned in the first
year, or $550. The interest on this sum for the second year is 0.1 $550 = $55. The
following table shows the calculation of the annual debt for the five-year loan of $500
at 10% interest:
At the End
of:
The Accumulated Debt is: This Sum
First year $500 + 0.1 x $500 = $550.00
Second year $550 + 0.1 x $550 = $605.00
Third year $605 + 0.1 x $605 = $665.50
Fourth year $665.50 + 0.1 x $665.50 = $732.05
Fifth year $732.05 + 0.1 x $732.05 = $805.26
It is evident that the interest earned on the preceding interest accumulation causes
the annual indebtedness to grow at a increasing rate. It can be shown that the future
sum, S, is given by
S = P (1 + i)
n
where P is the principal, the initial sum invested; i is the interest rate, and n is the
number of investment periods, in this case the number of years. Here the factor
multiplying the principal,
S / P = (1 + i)
n
is called the compound amount factor, CAF. The difference between simple and
compound interest may not be spectacular for short investment periods but it is very
impressive for long periods of time such as the operating life of a power plant. For our
example, the CAF is (1 + 0.1)
5
= 1.6105, and S = 500(1.6105) = $805.26. Now,
consider the following closely related problem.
EXAMPLE 4.2
What sum is required now, at 8% interest compunded annually, to produce one million
dollars in 25 years?
Solution
The future sum is
S = P (1 + i)
n
= 1,000,000 = P (1 + 0.08)
25
Solving for P, the present sum is 1,000,000/(1.08)
25
= $146,017.90. Thus, compound
interest brings a return of almost over seven times the original investment here. The
162
same present sum invested at 8% simple interest for twenty-five years would produce a
future sum of less than half a million dollars.
_____________________________________________________________________
In the example, the inverse of the CAF was used to determine the present worth of
a future sum. The inverse of the CAF is called the present-worth factor, ( PWF):
PWF = P/ S = 1 / (1 + I)
n

Thus we see that the time value of money is related to the compound interest that
can be earned, and that taking compounding into account can be important. To
recklessly adapt an old adage, A dollar in the hand is worth two (or more) in the
future (if invested wisely).
Capital Recovery
Another important aspect of compound interest is the relationship between a
present sum of money and a regular series of uniform payments. Consider a series of
five annual payments of R dollars each, when the interest rate is i. What is the present
dollar equivalent of these payments? Applying the CAF as in the preceding example,
with R as the future sum, the present sum associated with the first payment is R/(1 + i).
The present sum associated with the second payment is R/(1 + i)
2
. Thus the present
worth of the five payments is
P = R [ (1 + i)
1
+ (1 + i)
2
+ (1 + i)
3
+ (1 + i)
4
+ (1 + i)
5
]
It may be shown that this expression can be written as
P = R [(1 + i)
5
1]/[i(1 + i)
5
].
The factor multiplying the annual sum R is called the series present-worth factor,
SPWF, which for n years is:
SPWF = P/ R = [(1 + i)
n
1]/[i(1 + i)
n
] (4.1)
Solving for R, we obtain an expression for the regular annual payment for n years
needed to fund a present expenditure of P dollars at an interest rate i. The resulting
factor is called the capital recovery factor, CRF, which is the reciprocal of the series
present worth factor:
CRF = R / P = i(1 + i)
n
/ [(1 + i)
n
1] (4.2)
163
EXAMPLE 4.3
What uniform annual payments are required for forty years at 12% interest to retire the
debt associated with the purchase of a $500,000,000 power plant?
Solution
Using equation (4.2), we get
R = Pi (1 + i)/[(1 + i)
n
1] = 510
8
(0.12)(1 + 0.12)
40
/(1.12
40
1)
= $60,651,813
This sum may be regarded as part of the annual operating expense of the plant. It must
be recovered annually by the returns from the sale of power.
_____________________________________________________________________
4.6 A Preliminary Design Analysis of a 500-MW Plant
Consider the design of a 500-megawatt steam power plant with a heat rate of
10,000 Btu/kW-hr and a water-cooled condenser with a 20F cooling-water
temperature rise produced by heat transfer from the condensing steam. The plant uses
coal with a heating value of 10,000 Btu/lb
m
. Let us estimate the magnitude of some of
the parameters that characterize the design of the plant. The reader should verify
carefully each of the following calculations.
A 500-megawatt plant operating at full load produces 500,000 kW and an annual
electrical energy generation of
500,000 ( 365 ( 24 = 4.38 10
9
kW-hr
With a heat rate of 10,000 Btu/kW-hr, this requires a heat addition rate of
500,000 ( 10,000 = 5 10
9
Btu/hr
Coal with an assumed heating value of 10,000 Btu/lb
m
must therefore be supplied at a
rate of 5 10
9
/ 10
4
= 500,000 lb
m
/hr or 500,000 / 2000 = 250 tons/hr. A dedicated
coal car carries about 100 tons. Hence the plant requires 250 /100 = 2.5 cars per hour
of continuous operation. A coal unit train typically has about 100 cars. Then the plant
needs 2.5 ( 24 / 100 = 0.6 unit trains per day, or a unit train roughly every two days.
If coal costs $30 per ton, the annual cost of fuel will be
30 ( 250 ( 24 ( 365 = $65,700,000
The cost of fuel alone per kW-hr, based on 100% annual plant capacity, will be
65,700,000/(500,000 ( 365 ( 24) = $0.015/kW-hr ; 1.5 cents/kW-hr
164
The annual plant factor, or annual capacity factor, expressed as a decimal fraction , is
the ratio of the actual annual generation to the annual generation at 100 % capacity.
If the coal has 10% ash, the plant will produce 250 ( 0.1 = 25 tons of ash per hour.
Under some circumstances the ash may be used in the production of cement or other
paving materials. If it is not marketable, it is stabilized and stored in nearby ash ponds
until it can be moved to a permanent disposal site.
Similarly, if 2% of the coal is sulfur and half of it is removed from the combustion
products, 2.5 tons per hour is produced for disposal. If the sulfur is of sufficient purity,
it may be sold as an industrial chemical.
With an air-fuel ratio of 14, an air flow rate of 14 ( 500,000 = 7,000,000 lb
m
/hr

is
required for combustion. This information is important in determining the size of the
induced- and forced-draft fans, that of their driving motors or turbines, and of the
plants gas path flow passages.
The heat rate of 10,000 Btu/kW-hr corresponds to a thermal efficiency of
3413/10,000 = 0.3413 or 34.13%. If we approximate the heat of vaporization of water
as 1000 Btu/lb
m
, the throttle steam flow rate, with no superheat, would be about
10,000 ( 500,000 / 1000 = 5,000,000 lb
m
/hr
This determines the required capacity of the feedwater pumps and is important in sizing
the passages for the water path. The above thermal efficiency implies that about 65% of
the energy of the fuel is rejected into the environment, mostly through the condenser
and the exiting stack-gas energy. As an upper limit, assume that all of the heat is
rejected in the condenser. Thus
(1 0.3413)(5 10
9
) = 3.29 10
9
Btu/hr
must be rejected to condenser cooling water. With 20 water temperature rise in the
condenser, this rate of cooling requires a cooling-water flow rate to the condenser of
3.29 10
9
/(1.0 20) = 1.65 10
8
lb
m
/ hr
assuming a water heat capacity of 1.0 Btu/lb
m
-R. This gives information relevant to the
design sizing of cooling-water lines, cooling towers, and water pump capacities.
These back-of-the-envelope calculations should not be regarded as precise, but
they are reasonable estimates of the magnitudes of important power plant parameters.
Such estimates are useful in establishing a conceptual framework of the relationships
among design factors and of the magnitude of the design problem.
EXAMPLE 4.4
Relating to the above rough design of a 500-MW plant, and assuming the capital cost
information of Example 4.3, determine the capital cost per kW of generation capacity
and estimate the minimum cost of generation for the plant if it is predicted to have an
165
annual plant factor of 80% and maintenance and administrative costs of $0.007 /kW-hr.
Solution
The unit cost of the power plant is
$500,000,000/(500 (1000) = $1000 per kW-hr
of capacity. The capital cost part of the annual cost of power generation is
(60,651,813 (100)/(365 ( 24 ( 0.8 (500,000) = 1.73 cents per kW-hr
The cost of coal was determned to be 1.5 cents/kW-hr. The minimum cost of
producing electricity is then
1.73 + 1.5 + 0.7 = 3.93 cents per kW-hr
_____________________________________________________________________
Bibliography and References
1. Singer, Joseph G., (Ed.), Combustion /Fossil Power Systems. Windsor, Conn.:
Combustion Engineering, Inc.,, 1981.
2. Anon., Steam, Its Generation and Use. New York: Babcock and Wilcox, 1978.
3. Hensley, John C., Cooling Tower Fundamentals. Mission, Kan.: Marley Cooling
Tower Co., 1985.
4. Li, Kam W., and Priddy, A. Paul, Power Plant Systems Design. New York: Wiley,
1985.
EXERCISES
4.1 Derive an equation for the sum, S, resulting from P dollars invested at simple
interest rate i for a period of n years.
4.2 For the power plant design discussed in Section 4.6, estimate the horsepower of a
motor required to drive the fans used to overcome a steam generator gas-path pressure
drop of 1 psia. Assume a fan efficiency of 80%. What is the fractional and percentage
reduction in power plant output due to the fans?
4.3 Estimate the horsepower required by the feedwater pumps in the Section 4.6
design if the HP-turbine throttle pressure is 3200 psia. Assume a pump efficiency of
70%. What fractional and percentage reduction of the power plant output does this
represent?
166
4.4 What are the annual savings in fuel costs in the Section 4.6 plant design if the plant
heat rate can be reduced to 8500 Btu/kW-hr?
4.5 If the total capital cost of the Section 4.6 plant design is $600,000,000 and the
annual administrative and maintenance costs are one cent per kW-hr, what is the
minimum cost of electricity per kW-hr, assuming an annual interest rate of 9% and an
expected plant lifetime of thirty-five years?
4.6 What is the present worth of a sequence of five annual payments of $4500, $6500,
$3500, $7000, and $10,000 at an annual interest rate of 8%?
4.7 You have collected the following data on 1.5-MW steam turbines, as alternatives to
the purchase of utility power, for a new process plant to operate at 60% plant factor:
Turbine Number
1 2 3
Heat rate, Btu/kW-hr 12,000 10,600 9,500
Installed cost $124,000 $190,000 $245,000
Estimated annual
maintenance cost
$2,000 $1,800 $2,550
Coal (14,000 Btu/lb
m
) is the fuel to be used, at a cost of $26 per ton. Assuming an
annual interest rate of 8%, compare the annual cost of of the turbines for thirty-year
turbine lifetimes. Which turbine would you select? What other factors would you
consider before making a decision?
4.8 Using the data of Exercise 4.7, compare the turbines on the basis of present worth
of all costs.
4.9 For the power plant design discussed in Section 4.6, estimate the motor horse-
power required to drive a 75% efficient fan that is used to overcome a steam generator
gas-path pressure drop of 50 kPa.
4.10 Estimate the total power required by 65% efficient feedwater pumps operating in
parallel in the Section 4.6 design for a throttle pressure of 20 MPa.
4.11 Work out a back-of-the-envelope analysis similar to that of Section 4.6 in SI units.
4.12* Develop an interactive computer program that implements a steam power plant
system analysis of the type presented in Section 4.6 at one of the following levels, to be
167
assigned by your instructor.
Level 1: User supplies parameters in response to screen prompts, and one or more
output screens display the resulting input and output parameters.
Level 2: Same as Level 1, but also provide a capability for the user to change the
design by varying one input while holding all others constant.
Level 3: Allow the user to select a dependent variable from a list of outputs, and a
parameter to be varied and its range from another list. Display a graph of the variation
of user-selected outputs over the range of the parameter.
4.13* Construct a spreadsheet that systematizes the computations for a steam power
plant along the lines presented in this chapter. Set up a version of the spreadsheet that
allows easy variation of input parameters. Use the spreadsheet to develop graphs that
show the influence of plant heat rate on fuel costs and sulfur byproduct production.
4.14 An electric utility, expecting to increase its system capacity by 400 megawatts,
must choose between a high-technology combined-cycle plant, at a cost of $1800 per
kW of installed capacity, and an oil-burning steam plant, at $1150 per kW. The
combined-cycle plant has a variable cost of 18 mills per kW-hr, while the oil-burning
plant variable cost is 39 mills per kW-hr. For an annual plant factor of 0.6 and fixed
charges of 15% of the capital cost, determine (a) the total annual cost of operation of
each plant, and (b) the cost of electricity, in cents per kW-hr, for each plant.
4.15 Estimate the mass-flow rate of makeup water required by an evaporative cooling
tower satisfying the cooling requirements of the example power plant of Section 4.6.
4.16 An 800-MW steam power plant operates at a heat rate of 8700 Btu/kW-hr. It has
a 16F rise in condenser cooling-water temperature. Neglecting energy losses, estimate
the condenser cooling-water flow rate and the flow-rate of cooling-tower makeup
water. Estimate the amount of pump power required to circulate the cooling water to
the cooling tower.
4.17 Plot a curve of condenser cooling-water flow rate and makeup-water flow rate as
a function of condenser cooling-water temperature rise for Riverside Station Unit #1.
4.18 The average temperature in an 800 ft. high power plant exhaust gas stack is 350F
and the ambient temperature is 60F. Neglecting fluid friction and exhaust gas kinetic
energy, estimate the pressure inside the base of the stack.
4.19 The average temperature in a 200 meter power plant exhaust gas stack is 150C,
and the ambient temperature is 20C. Neglecting fluid friction and exhaust gas
momentum, estimate the pressure, in kPa, at the inside of the base of the stack.
168
4.20 Estimate the heat transfer rates in the Riverside Station Unit #1 in the air pre-
heater, an economizer that heats liquid water to saturation, the boiling surfaces, the re-
heater, and the superheater. Estimate the temperature drops in the combustion gas
across each of these, assuming that they are arranged in the same order as just listed.
4.21 After completing Exercise 4.20, estimate the flow area of combustion gas through
a crossflow economizer in the Riverside Station Unit #1, and define a suitable design.
4.22 After completing Exercise 4.20, estimate the flow area of combustion gas through
a pendant superheater consisting of parallel U-tubes in cross flow, and define a suitable
design.
4.23 The following is a list of ten air and gas path components of a steam power plant.
Number the components so as to put them in order, starting with the air into the plant
as number 1 and concluding with the flue gas out as number 10.
_________ superheater __________ boiler tubewall
_________ economizer __________ windbox
_________ induced-draft fan __________ air heater, gas side
_________ burner __________ electrostatic precipitator
_________ forced-draft fan __________ air heater, air side
4.24 Upon hiring on with Hot Stuff Engineering Company after graduation, you
purchase a $30,000 automobile to establish an image as a prosperous engineer. You
pay no money down, but 1% interest per month, compounded monthly, for four years.
What are your monthly payments? What will your payments be if you are paying
simple interest?
4.25 A forced-draft fan with an efficiency of 70% supplies 1,000,000 ft
3
per minute of
air to a furnace that produces a pressure drop of 0.7 psia. What is the fan power
requirement, in horsepower and in kilowatts?
169
C H A P T E R F I V E
GAS TURBINES AND JET ENGINES
5.1 Introduction
History records over a century and a half of interest in and work on the gas turbine.
However, the history of the gas turbine as a viable energy conversion device began
with Frank Whittle's patent award on the jet engine in 1930 and his static test of a jet
engine in 1937. Shortly thereafter, in 1939, Hans von Ohain led a German
demonstration of jet-engine-powered flight, and the Brown Boveri company intro-
duced a 4-MW gas-turbine-driven electrical power system in Neuchatel, Switzerland.
The success of the gas turbine in replacing the reciprocating engine as a power plant for
high-speed aircraft is well known. The development of the gas turbine was less rapid as
a stationary power plant in competition with steam for the generation of electricity and
with the spark-ignition and diesel engines in transportation and stationary applications.
Nevertheless, applications of gas turbines are now growing at a rapid pace as research
and development produces performance and reliability increases and economic benefits.
5.2 An Ideal Simple-Cycle Gas Turbine
The fundamental thermodynamic cycle on which gas turbine engines are based is called
the Brayton Cycle or Joule cycle. A temperature-entropy diagram for this ideal cycle
and its implementation as a closed-cycle gas turbine is shown in Figure 5.1. The cycle
consists of an isentropic compression of the gas from state 1 to state 2; a constant
pressure heat addition to state 3; an isentropic expansion to state 4, in which work is
done; and an isobaric closure of the cycle back to state 1.
As Figure 5.1(a) shows, a compressor is connected to a turbine by a rotating shaft.
The shaft transmits the power necessary to drive the compressor and delivers the
balance to a power-utilizing load, such as an electrical generator. The turbine is similar
in concept and in many features to the steam turbines discusssed earlier, except that it is
designed to extract power from a flowing hot gas rather than from water vapor. It is
important to recognize at the outset that the term "gas turbine" has a dual usage: It
designates both the entire engine and the device that drives the compressor and the
load. It should be clear from the context which meaning is intended. The equivalent
term combustion turbine is also used occasionally, with the same ambiguity.
170
Like the simple Rankine-cycle power plant, the gas turbine may be thought of as a
device that operates between two pressure levels, as shown in Figure 5.1(b). The
compressor raises the pressure and temperature of the incoming gas to the levels of p
2
and T
2
. Expansion of the gas through the turbine back to the lower pressure at this
point would be useless, because all the work produced in the expansion would be
required to drive the compressor.
171
Instead, it is necessary to add heat and thus raise the temperature of the gas before
expanding it in the turbine. This is achieved in the heater by heat transfer from an
external source that raises the gas temperature to T
3
, the turbine inlet temperature.
Expansion of the hot gas through the turbine then delivers work in excess of that
needed to drive the compressor. The turbine work exceeds the compressor requirement
because the enthalpy differences, and hence the temperature differences, along
isentropes connecting lines of constant pressure increase with increasing entropy (and
temperature), as the figure suggests.
The difference between the turbine work, W
t
, and the magnitude of the compressor
work, |W
c
|, is the net work of the cycle. The net work delivered at the output shaft may
be used to drive an electric generator, to power a process compressor, turn an airplane
propeller, or to provide mechanical power for some other useful activity.
In the closed-cycle gas turbine, the heater is a furnace in which combustion gases
or a nuclear source transfer heat to the working fluid through thermally conducting
tubes. It is sometimes useful to distinguish between internal and external combustion
engines by whether combustion occurs in the working fluid or in an area separate from
the working fluid, but in thermal contact with it. The combustion-heated, closed-cycle
gas turbine is an example, like the steam power plant, of an external combustion
engine. This is in contrast to internal combustion engines, such as automotive engines,
in which combustion takes place in the working fluid confined between a cylinder and a
piston, and in open-cycle gas turbines.
5.3 Analysis of the Ideal Cycle
The Air Standard cycle analysis is used here to review analytical techniques and to
provide quantitative insights into the performance of an ideal-cycle engine. Air
Standard cycle analysis treats the working fluid as a calorically perfect gas, that is, a
perfect gas with constant specific heats evaluated at room temperature. In Air Standard
cycle analysis the heat capacities used are those for air.
A gas turbine cycle is usually defined in terms of the compressor inlet pressure and
temperature, p
1
and T
1
, the compressor pressure ratio, r = p
2
/p
1
, and the turbine inlet
temperature, T
3
, where the subscripts correspond to states identified in Figure 5.1.
Starting with the compressor, its exit pressure is determined as the product of p
1
and
the compressor pressure ratio. The compressor exit temperature may then be deter-
mined by the familiar relation for an isentropic process in an ideal gas, Equation (1.19):
T
2
= T
1
( p
2
/p
1
)
(k1)/k
[R | K] (5.1)
For the two isobaric processes, p
2
= p
3
and p
4
= p
1
. Thus the turbine pressure ratio,
p
3
/p
4
, is equal to the compressor pressure ratio, r = p
2
/p
1
. With the turbine inlet
temperature T
3
known, the turbine discharge temperature can be determined from
T
4
= T
3
/( p
2
/p
1
)
(k1)/k
[R | K] (5.2)
172
and the temperatures and pressures are then known at all the significant states.
Next, taking a control volume around the compressor, we determine the shaft
work required by the compressor, w
c
, assuming negligible heat losses, by applying the
steady-flow energy equation:
0 = h
2
h
1
+ w
c

or
w
c
= h
1
h
2
= c
p
( T
1
T
2
) [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (5.3)
Similarly, for the turbine, the turbine work produced is
w
t
= h
3
- h
4
= c
p
( T
3
T
4
) [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (5.4)

The net work is then
w
n
= w
t
+ w
c
= c
p
( T
3
T
4
+ T
1
T
2
) [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (5.5)
Now taking the control volume about the heater, we find that the heat addition per
unit mass is
q
a
= h
3
h
2
= c
p
( T
3
T
2
) [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (5.6)
The cycle thermal efficiency is the ratio of the net work to the heat supplied to the
heater:

th
= w
n
/q
a
[dl] (5.7)
which by substitution of Equations (5.1), (5.2), (5.5), and (5.6) may be simplified to

th
= 1 ( p
2
/p
1
)
(k1)/k
[dl] (5.8)
It is evident from Equation (5.8) that increasing the compressor pressure ratio increases
thermal efficiency.
Another parameter of great importance to the gas turbine is the work ratio, w
t
/|w
c
|.
This parameter should be as large as possible, because a large amount of the power
delivered by the turbine is required to drive the compressor, and because the engine net
work depends on the excess of the turbine work over the compressor work. A little
algebra will show that the work ratio w
t
/|w
c
| can be written as:
w
t
/|w
c
| = (T
3
/T
1
) / ( p
2
/p
1
)
(k1)/k
[dl] (5.9)

173
Note that, for the ideal cycle, the thermal efficiency and the work ratio depend on only
two independent parameters, the compressor pressure ratio and the ratio of the turbine
and compressor inlet temperatures. It will be seen that these two design parameters are
of utmost importance for all gas turbine engines.
Equation (5.9) shows that the work ratio increases in direct proportion to the ratio
T
3
/T
1
and inversely with a power of the pressure ratio. On the other hand, Equation
(5.8) shows that thermal efficiency increases with increased pressure ratio. Thus, the
desirability of high turbine inlet temperature and the necessity of a tradeoff involving
pressure ratio is clear. Equation (5.9) also suggests that increases in the ratio T
3
/T
1
allow the compressor pressure ratio to be increased without reducing the work ratio.
This is indicative of the historic trend by which advances in materials allow higher
turbine inlet temperatures and therefore higher compressor pressure ratios.
It was shown in Chapter 1 that the area of a reversible cycle plotted on a Ts
diagram gives the net work of the cycle. With this in mind, it is interesting to consider a
family of cycles in which the compressor inlet state, a, and turbine inlet temperatures
are fixed, as shown in Figure 5.2. As the compressor pressure ratio p
b
/p
a
approaches 1,
the cycle area and hence the net work approach 0, as suggested by the shaded cycle
labeled with single primes. At the other extreme, as the compressor pressure ratio
approaches its maximum value, the net work also approaches 0, as in the cycle denoted
by double primes. For intermediate pressure ratios, the net work is large and positive,
indicating that there is a unique value of compressor pressure ratio that maximizes the
net work. Such information is of great significance in gas turbine design,
174
because it indicates the pressure ratio that yields the highest power output for given
turbomachine inlet temperatures and mass flow rate. This is an important approach to
the pressure ratio tradeoff mentioned earlier. It will be considered from an analytic
viewpoint for a more realistic gas turbine model in a later section.
Up to this point the discussion has focused on the closed-cycle gas turbine, an
external combustion or nuclear-heated machine that operates with a circulating fixed
mass of working fluid in a true cyclic process. In fact, the same Air Standard cycle
analysis may be applied to the open-cycle gas turbine. The open cycle operates with
atmospheric air that is pressurized by the compressor and then flows into a combustion
chamber, where it oxidizes a hydrocarbon fuel to produce a hot gas that drives the
turbine. The turbine delivers work as in the closed cycle, but the exiting combustion
gases pass into the atmosphere, as they must in all combustion processes.
A diagram of the cycle implementation is shown in Figure 5.3. Clearly, the open-
cycle gas turbine is an internal combustion engine, like the automotive engine. Note
that the diagram is consistent with Figure 5.1 and all the preceding equations in this
chapter. This is true because (1) the atmosphere serves as an almost infinite source and
sink that may be thought of as closing the cycle, and (2) the energy released by
combustion has the same effect as the addition of external heat in raising the
temperature of the gas to the turbine inlet temperature. A cutaway of an open-cycle
utility gas turbine is presented in Figure 5.4.
175
5.4 Realistic Simple-Cycle Gas Turbine Analysis
The preceding analysis of the Air Standard cycle assumes perfect turbomachinery, an
unachievable but meaningful ideal, and room-temperature heat capacities. Realistic
quantitative performance information can be obtained by taking into account
efficiencies of the compressor and the turbine, significant pressure losses, and more
realistic thermal properties.
Properties for Gas Turbine Analysis
It is pointed out in reference 1 that accurate gas turbine analyses may be performed
using constant heat capacities for both air and combustion gases. This appears to be a
specialization of a method devised by Whittle (ref. 4). The following properties are
therefore adopted for all gas turbine analyses in this book:
Air:
c
p
= 0.24 Btu/lb
m
-R or 1.004 kJ /kg-K
k

= 1.4 implies k /(k 1) = 3.5
Combustion gas:
c
p,g
= 0.2744 Btu/lb
m
-R or 1.148 kJ /kg-K
k
g
= 1.333 implies k
g
/(k
g
1) = 4.0
The properties labeled as combustion gas above are actually high-temperature-air
properties. Because of the high air-fuel ratio required by gas turbines, the
176
thermodynamic properties of gas turbine combustion gases usually differ little from
those of high-temperature air. Thus the results given below apply equally well to
closed-cycle machines using air as the working fluid and to open-cycle engines.
Analysis of the Open Simple-Cycle Gas Turbine
A simple-cycle gas turbine has one turbine driving one compressor and a
power-consuming load. More complex configurations are discussed later. It is assumed
that the compressor inlet state, the compressor pressure ratio, and the turbine inlet
temperature are known, as before. The turbine inlet temperature is usually determined
by the limitations of the high-temperature turbine blade material. Special metals or
ceramics are usually selected for their ability to withstand both high stress at elevated
temperature and erosion and corrosion caused by undesirable components of the fuel.
As shown in Figure 5.3, air enters the compressor at a state defined by T
1
and p
1
.
The compressor exit pressure, p
2
, is given by
p
2
= rp
1
[lb
f
/ft
2
| kPa] (5.10)
where r is the compressor pressure ratio. The ideal compressor discharge temperature,
T
2s
is given by the isentropic relation
T
2s
= T
1
r
(k1)/k
[R | K] (5.11)
The compressor isentropic efficiency, defined as the ratio of the compressor isentropic
work to the actual compressor work with both starting at the same initial state and
ending at the same pressure level, may be written as

c
= ( h
1
h
2s
)/( h
1
h
2
) = ( T
1
T
2s
)/( T
1
T
2
) [dl] (5.12)
Here the steady-flow energy equation has been applied to obtain expressions for the
work for an irreversible adiabatic compressor in the denominator and for an isentropic
compressor in the numerator. Solving Equation (5.12) for T
2
, we get as the actual
compressor discharge temperature:
T
2
= T
1
+ ( T
2s
T
1
) /
c
[R | K] (5.13)
Equation (5.3) then gives the work needed by the compressor, w
c
:
w
c
= c
p
( T
1
T
2
) = c
p
( T
1
T
2s
)/
c
[Btu /lb
m
| kJ/kg] (5.14)
Note that the compressor work is negative, as required by the sign convention that
defines work as positive if it is produced by the control volume. The compressor power
requirement is, of course, then given by m
a
w
c
[Btu/hr | kW], where m
a
is the
177
compressor mass flow rate [lb
m
/ hr | kg / s].
After leaving the compressor at an elevated pressure and temperature, the air then
enters the combustion chamber, where it completely oxidizes a liquid or a gaseous fuel
injected under pressure. The combustion process raises the combustion gas temperature
to the turbine inlet temperature T
3
. One of the goals of combustion chamber design is
to minimize the pressure loss from the compressor to the turbine. Ideally, then, p
3
= p
2
,
as assumed by the Air Standard analysis. More realistically, a fixed value of the
combustor fractional pressure loss, fpl, (perhaps about 0.05 or 5%) may be used to
account for burner losses:
fpl = (p
2
p
3
)/p
2
[dl] (5.15)
Then the turbine inlet pressure may be determined from
p
3
= (1 fpl) p
2
[lb
f
/ft
2
| kPa] (5.16)

Rather than deal with its complexities, we may view the combustion process simply as
one in which heat released by exothermic chemical reaction raises the temperature of
combustion gas (with hot-air properties) to the turbine inlet temperature. The rate of
heat released by the combustion process may then be expressed as:
Q
a
= m
a
(1 + f )c
p,g
(T
3
T
2
) [Btu/hr | kW] (5.17)
where f is the mass fuel-air ratio. The term m
a
(1 + f) is seen to be the sum of the air and
fuel mass flow rates, which also equals the mass flow rate of combustion gas. For gas
turbines it will be seen later that f is usually much less than the stoichiometric fuel-air
ratio and is often neglected with respect to 1 in preliminary analyses.
The turbine in the open-cycle engine operates between the pressure p
3
and
atmospheric pressure, p
4
= p
1
, with an inlet temperature of T
3
. If the turbine were
isentropic, the discharge temperature would be
T
4s
= T
3
( p
4
/p
3
)
(kg 1) / kg
[R | K] (5.18)
From the steady-flow energy equation, the turbine work can be written as
w
t
= c
p,g
(T
3
T
4
) =
t
c
p,g
( T
3
T
4s
) [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (5.19)
referenced to unit mass of combustion gas, and where
t
is the turbine isentropic
efficiency. The turbine power output is then m
a
(1 + f)w
t
, where, as seen earlier, m
a
(1 +
f) is the mass flow rate of combustion gas flowing through the turbine. The net work
based on the mass of air processed and the net power output of the gas turbine, P
n
, are
then given by
178
w
n
= (1 + f )w
t
+ w
c
[Btu/lb
m
air| kJ/kg air] (5.20)
and
P
n
= m
a
[(1 + f )w
t
+ w
c
] [Btu/hr | kW] (5.21)
and the thermal efficiency of the engine is

th
= P
n
/Q
a
[dl] (5.22)
EXAMPLE 5.1
A simple-cycle gas turbine has 86% and 89% compressor and turbine efficiencies,
respectively, a compressor pressure ratio of 6, a 4% fractional pressure drop in the
combustor, and a turbine inlet temperature of 1400F. Ambient conditions are 60F and
one atmosphere. Determine the net work, thermal efficiency, and work ratio for the
engine. Assume that the fuel-mass flow rate is negligible compared with the air flow
rate.
Solution
The notation for the solution is that of Figure 5.3. The solution details are given in
Table 5.1 in a step-by-step spreadsheet format. Each line presents the parameter name,
symbol, and units of measure; its value; and the right-hand side of its specific
determining equation.
179
When an entire cycle is to be analyzed, it is best to start at the compressor with the
inlet conditions and proceed to calculate successive data in the clockwise direction on
the T-s diagram. The compressor isentropic and actual discharge temperatures and
work are determined first using Equations (5.11), (5.13), and (5.14). The turbine
pressure ratio is determined next, accounting for the combustor pressure loss, using
Equation (5.16). The isentropic relation, Equation (5.18), gives the isentropic turbine
exit temperature, and the turbine efficiency and Equation (5.19) yields the true turbine
exit temperature and work. Once all the turbomachine inlet and exit temperatures are
known, other cycle parameters are easily determined, such as the combustor heat
transfer, net work, thermal efficiency, and work ratio.
_____________________________________________________________________
An important observation may be made on the basis of this analysis regarding the
magnitude of the compressor work with respect to the turbine work. Much of the
turbine work is required to drive the compressor. Compare the work ratio of 1.66, for
example, with the much higher values for the steam cycles of Chapter 2 (the Rankine-
cycle pumps have the same function there as the compressor here). Example 2.4 for the
Rankine cycle with a 90% turbine efficiency has a work ratio of 77.2. Thus the gas
turbines pressurization handicap relative to the Rankine cycle is substantial.
The unimpressive value of the thermal efficiency of the example gas turbine, 25%
(not typical of the current state of the art) compares with a Carnot efficiency for the
same cycle temperature extremes of 72% The large amount of compressor work requi-
red clearly contributes to this weak performance. Nevertheless, current gas turbines are
competitive with many other engines on an efficiency basis, and have advantages such
as compactness and quick-start capability relative to Rankine cycle power plants. One
approach to the improvement of thermal efficiency of the gas turbine will be addressed
later in Section 5.5. First lets look at what can be done about gas turbine work.
Maximizing the Net Work of the Cycle
Using Equations (5.14) and (5.19), we can rewrite the cycle net work as
w
n
=
t
c
p,g
( T
3
T
4s
) c
p
( T
2s
T
1
)/
c
[Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (5.23)
where the fuel-air ratio has been neglected with respect to 1. In the following, the
combustor pressure losses and the distinction between hot-gas and air heat capacities
will be neglected but the very important turbomachine efficiencies are retained.
Nondimensionalizing the net work with the constant c
p
T
1
we get:
w
n
/c
p
T
1
=
t
(T
3
/T
1
)(c
p,g
/c
p
)(1 r
(k1)/k
) + (1 r
(k1)/k
)/
c
[dl] (5.24)
By differentiating w
n
with respect to the compressor pressure ratio r and setting the
180
result equal to 0, we obtain an equation for r*, the value of r that maximizes the net
work with fixed turbomachine efficiencies and with a constant ratio of the temperatures
of the turbomachine inlets, T
3
/T
1
. For constant gas properties throughout, the result is
r* = (
c

t
T
3
/T
1
)
k/2(k1)
[dl] (5.25)
This relation gives a specific value for the compressor pressure ratio that defines an
optimum cycle, in the sense of the discussion of Figure 5.2. There it was established
qualitatively that a cycle with maximum net work exists for a given value of T
3
/T
1
.
Equation (5.25) defines the condition for this maximum and generalizes it to include
turbomachine inefficiency.
The pressure ratio r* given by Equation (5.25) increases with increasing
turbomachine efficiencies and with T
3
/T
1
. This is a clear indicator that increasing
turbine inlet temperature favors designs with higher compressor pressure ratios. This
information is important to the gas turbine designer but does not tell the whole design
story. There are other important considerations; for example, (1) compressors and
turbines become more expensive with increasing pressure ratios, and (2) the pressure
ratio that maximizes thermal efficiency is different from that given by Equation (5.25).
Figure 5.5 shows the influence of compressor pressure ratio on both efficiency and net
work and the position of the value given by Equation (5.25). Thus, when all factors are
taken into account, the final design pressure ratio is likely to be in the vicinity of, but
not necessarily identical to, r*.
181
5.5 Regenerative Gas Turbines
It was shown in Chapter 2 that the efficiency of the Rankine cycle could be improved
by an internal transfer of heat that reduces the magnitude of external heat addition, a
feature known as regeneration. It was also seen in Chapter 2 that this is accomplished
conveniently in a steam power plant by using a heat exchanger known as a feedwater
heater.
Examination of Example 5.1 shows that a similar opportunity exists for the gas
turbine cycle. The results show that the combustion process heats the incoming air from
924R to 1860R and that the gas turbine exhausts to the atmosphere at 1273R. Thus
a maximum temperature potential of 1273 924 = 349F exists for heat transfer. As in
the Rankine cycle, this potential for regeneration can be exploited by incorporation of a
heat exchanger. Figure 5.6 shows a gas turbine with a counterflow heat exchanger that
extracts heat from the turbine exhaust gas to preheat the compressor discharge air to T
c
ahead of the combustor. As a result, the temperature rise in the combustor is reduced to
T
3
T
c
, a reduction reflected in a direct decrease in fuel consumed.
Note that the compressor and turbine inlet and exit states can be the same as for a
simple cycle. In this case the compressor, turbine, and net work as well as the work
ratio are unchanged by incorporating a heat exchanger.
The effectiveness of the heat exchanger, or regenerator, is a measure of how well
it uses the available temperature potential to raise the temperature of the compressor
discharge air. Specifically, it is the actual rate of heat transferred to the air divided by
the maximum possible heat transfer rate that would exist if the heat exchanger had
infinite heat transfer surface area. The actual heat transfer rate to the air is mc
p
(T
c
T
2
),
and the maximum possible rate is mc
p
(T
4
T
2
). Thus the regenerator effectiveness can
be written as

reg
= ( T
c
T
2
)/( T
4
T
2
) [dl] (5.26)
and the combustor inlet temperature can be written as
T
c
= T
2
+
reg
( T
4
T
2
) [R | K] (5.27)
It is seen that the combustor inlet temperature varies from T
2
to T
4
as the
regenerator effectiveness varies from 0 to 1. The regenerator effectiveness increases as
its heat transfer area increases. Increased heat transfer area allows the cold fluid to
absorb more heat from the hot fluid and therefore leave the exchanger with a higher T
c
.
On the other hand, increased heat transfer area implies increased pressure losses
on both air and gas sides of the heat exchanger, which in turn reduces the turbine
pressure ratio and therefore the turbine work. Thus, increased regenerator effectiveness
implies a tradeoff, not only with pressure losses but with increased heat exchanger size
and complexity and, therefore, increased cost.
182
The exhaust gas temperature at the exit of the heat exchanger may be determined
by applying the steady-flow energy equation to the regenerator. Assuming that the heat
exchanger is adiabatic and that the mass flow of fuel is negligible compared with the air
flow, and noting that no shaft work is involved, we may write the steady-flow energy
equation for two inlets and two exits as
q = 0 = h
e
+ h
c
h
2
h
4
+ w = c
p,g
T
e
+ c
p
T
c
c
p
T
2
c
p,g
T
4
+ 0
Thus the regenerator combustion-gas-side exit temperature is:
T
e
= T
4
(c
p
/c
p,g
)( T
c
T
2
) [R | K] (5.28)
While the regenerator effectiveness does not appear explicitly in Equation (5.28),
the engine exhaust temperature is reduced in proportion to the air temperature rise in
the regenerator, which is in turn proportional to the effectiveness. The dependence of
the exhaust temperature on
reg
may be seen directly by eliminating T
c
from Equation
(5.28), using Equation (5.27) to obtain
T
4
T
e
=
reg
(c
p
/c
p,g
)(T
4
T
2
) [R | K] (5.29)
183
The regenerator exhaust gas temperature reduction, T
4
T
e,
is seen to be jointly
proportional to the effectiveness and to the maximum temperature potential, T
4
T
2
.
The regenerator, like other heat exchangers, is designed to have minimal pressure
losses on both air and gas sides. These may be taken into account by the fractional
pressure drop approach discussed in connection with the combustor.

EXAMPLE 5.2
Lets say we are adding a heat exchanger with an effectiveness of 75% to the engine
studied in Example 5.1. Assume that the same frictional pressure loss factor applies to
both the heat exchanger air-side and combustor as a unit, and that gas-side pressure
loss in the heat exchanger is negligible. Evaluate the performance of the modified
engine.
Solution
The solution in spreadsheet format, expressed in terms of the notation of Figures
5.6 and 5.7, is shown in Table 5.2. Examination of the spreadsheet and of the T-s
diagram in Figure 5.7 shows that the entry and exit states of the turbomachines are not
influenced by the addition of the heat exchanger, as expected. (There would have been
a slight influence if a different pressure loss model had been assumed.)
With the heat exchanger, it is seen that the combustor inlet temperature has
increased about 262 and the exhaust temperature reduced 229. The net work and
184
work ratio are clearly unchanged. Most importantly, however, the thermal efficiency
has increased 10 percentage counts over the simple cycle case in Example 5.1. Such a
gain must be traded off against the added volume, weight, and expense of the
regenerator. The efficiency gain and the associated penalties may be acceptable in
stationary power and ground and marine transportation applications, but are seldom
feasible in aerospace applications. Each case, of course, must be judged on its own
merits.
_____________________________________________________________________
Figure 5.8 shows the influence of regenerator effectiveness and turbine inlet
temperature on the performance of the gas turbine, all other conditions being the same
as in the example. The values for
reg
= 0 correspond to a gas turbine without
regenerator. The abscissa is arbitrarily truncated at
reg
= 0.8 because gas turbine heat
exchanger effectivenesses usually do not exceed that value. The impressive influence of
both design parameters is a strong motivator for research in heat exchangers and high-
temperature materials. The use of regeneration in automotive gas turbines is virtually
mandated because good fuel economy is so important.
185
Figure 5.9 shows the layout of a regenerative gas turbine serving a pipeline
compressor station. Gas drawn from the pipeline may be used to provide the fuel for
remotely located gas-turbine-powered compressor stations. (A later figure, Figure 5.12,
shows details of the turbomachinery of this gas turbine.)
186
5.6 Two-Shaft Gas Turbines
Problems in the design of turbomachinery for gas turbines and in poor part-load or
off-design performance are sometimes avoided by employing a two-shaft gas turbine, in
which the compressor is driven by one turbine and the load by a second turbine. Both
shafts may be contained in a single structure, or the turbines may be separately
packaged. Figure 5.10 shows the flow and T-s diagrams for such a configuration. The
turbine that drives the compressor is called the compressor turbine. The compressor,
combustor, compressor-turbine combination is called the gas generator, or gasifier,
because its function is to provide hot, high-pressure gas to drive the second turbine, the
power turbine. The compressor-turbine is sometimes also referred to as the gasifier
turbine or gas-generator turbine.
The analysis of the two-shaft gas turbine is similar to that of the single shaft
machine, except in the determination of the turbine pressure ratios. The pressure rise
produced by the compressor must be shared between the two turbines. The manner in
which it is shared is determined by a power, or work, condition. The work condition
expresses mathematically the fact that the work produced by the gasifier turbine is used
to drive the compressor alone. As a result, the gas generator turbine pressure ratio,
p
3
/p
4
, is just high enough to satisfy the compressor work requirement.
Thus the compressor power (work) input is the same as the delivered gas-
generator turbine power(work) output:
|w
c
| =
mech
(1 + f )w
t
[Btu /lb
m
| kJ/kg] (5.30)
where f is the fuelair ratio and
mech
is the mechanical efficiency of transmission of
power from the turbine to the compressor. The mechanical efficiency is usually close to
unity in a well-designed gas turbine. For this reason, it was not included in earlier
analyses.
The gasifier turbine work may be written in terms of the turbine pressure ratio:
w
t
=
t
c
p,g
T
3
( 1 T
4s
/T
3
)
=
t
c
p,g
T
3
[1 1/( p
3
/p
4
)
(kg-1)/kg
] [Btu /lb
m
| kJ/kg] (5.31)
With the compressor work determined, as before, by the compressor pressure ratio and
the isentropic efficiency, the compressor-turbine pressure ratio, p
3
/p
4
, is obtained by
combining Equations (5.30) and (5.31):
p
3
/p
4
= [ 1 |w
c
| /
mech

t
c
p,g
(1 + f )T
3
]
kg/(kg-1)
= ( 1 wf )
kg/(kg-1)
[dl] (5.32)
where wf is the positive, dimensionless work factor, |w
c
| /
mech

t
c
p,g
(1 + f )T
3
, used as
187
a convenient intermediate variable. The power turbine pressure ratio may then be
determined from the identity p
4
/p
5
= p
4
/p
1
= ( p
4
/p
3
)( p
3
/p
2
)( p
2
/p
1
). This shows that the
power turbine pressure ratio is the compressor pressure ratio divided by the gasifier
turbine pressure ratio when there is no combustion chamber pressure loss ( p
3
= p
2
).
With the pressure ratios known, all the significant temperatures and performance
parameters may be determined.
EXAMPLE 5.3
Lets consider a two-shaft gas turbine with a regenerative air heater. The compressor
pressure ratio is 6, and the compressor and gas generator turbine inlet temperatures are
520

R and 1860R, respectively. The compressor, gasifier turbine, and power turbine
isentropic efficiencies are 0.86, 0.89, and 0.89, respectively. The regenerator
effectiveness is 75%, and a 4% pressure loss is shared by the high-pressure air side of
the regenerator and the combustor. Determine the pressure ratios of the two turbines,
and the net work, thermal efficiency, and work ratio of the engine.
188
Solution
The solution in spreadsheet form shown in Table 5.3 follows the notation of Figure
5.10. The solution proceeds as before, until the calculation of the turbine pressure
ratios. The available pressure ratio shared by the two turbines is p
3
/p
5
= p
3
/p
1
=
(p
2
/p
1
)(p
3
/p
2
) = r ( 1 fpl) = 5.76. The gasifier turbine pressure ratio is determined by
the work-matching requirement of the compressor and its driving turbine, as expressed
in Equation (5.32), using the dimensionless compressor work factor, wf. The resulting
gas generator and power turbine pressure ratios are 2.61 and 2.2, respectively.
Comparison shows that the design point performance of the two-shaft gas turbine
studied here is not significantly different from that of the single-shaft machine
considered an Example 5.2. While the performance of the two machines is found to be
essentially the same, the single-shaft machine is sometimes preferred in applications
189
with fixed operating conditions where good part-load performance over a range of
speeds is not important. On the other hand, the independence of the speeds of the gas
generator and power turbine in the two-shaft engine allows acceptable performance
over a wider range of operating conditions.
_____________________________________________________________________
Let us examine further the characteristics of regenerative two-shaft gas turbines,
starting with the spreadsheet reproduced in Table 5.3. By copying the value column of
that spreadsheet to several columns to the right, a family of calculations with identical
methodologies may be performed.. The spreadsheet /EDIT-FILL command may then
be used to vary a parameter in a given row by creating a sequence of numbers with a
specified starting value and interval. Such a parametric study of the influence of
compressor pressure ratio on two-shaft regenerative gas turbine performance is shown
in Table 5.4, where the pressure ratio is varied from 2 to 7. The fifth numeric column
contains the values from Table 5.3. The data of Table 5.4 are included in the Example
190
5-4.wk3 spreadsheet that accompanies this text.
Table 5.4 shows that, for the given turbine inlet temperature, the thermal efficiency
maximum is at a pressure ratio between 4 and 5, while the net work maximum is at a
pressure ratio of about 7. The work ratio is continually declining because the
magnitude of the compressor work requirement grows faster with compressor pressure
ratio than the turbine work does.
Figure 5.11, plotted using the spreadsheet, compares the performance of the
regenerative two-shaft gas turbine with a nonregenerative two-shaft engine (
reg
= 0 ).
Net work for both machines has the same variation with pressure ratio. But notice the
high efficiency attained with a low-compressor pressure ratio, a significant advantage
attributable to regeneration.
A cutaway view of a two-shaft regenerative gas turbine of the type used in pipeline
compressor stations such as that shown in Figure 5.9 is seen in Figure 5.12. The figure
shows that the compressor blade heights decrease in the direction of flow as the gas is
compressed. The exhaust from the last of the sixteen compressor stages is reduced in
velocity by a diffusing passage and then exits through the right window-like flange,
which connects to a duct (not shown) leading to the regenerator. The heated air from
the external regenerator reenters the machine combustor casing, where it flows around
and into the combustor cans, cooling them. The air entering near the combustor fuel
nozzles mixes with the fuel and burns locally in a near-stoichiometric mixture. As the
mixture flows downstream, additional secondary air entering the combustor through
slots in its sides mixes with, and reduces the temperature of, the combustion gas before
it arrives at the turbine inlet.
A cutaway view of an industrial two-shaft gas turbine with dual regenerators is
presented in Figure 5.13. From the left, the air inlet and radial compressor and axial
flow gasifier turbine and power turbine are seen on the axis of the machine, with the
combustion chamber above and one of the rotary regenerators at the right. Due to the
relatively low pressure ratios required by regenerative cycles, centrifugal compressors
are normally used in regenerative machines because of their simplicity, good efficiency,
compactness, and ruggedness.
Performance data for the turbine of Figure 5.13 is graphed in Figure 5.14. The GT
404 gas turbine delivers about 360 brake horsepower at 2880-rpm output shaft speed.
The torque-speed curve of Figure 5.14 shows an important characteristic of two-shaft
gas turbines with respect to off-design point operation. Whereas the compressor
pressure ratio and output torque of a single-shaft gas turbine drop as the shaft speed
drops, the compressor speed and pressure ratio in a two-shaft machine is independent
of the output speed. Thus, as the output shaft speed changes, the compressor may
maintain its design speed and continue to develop high pressure and mass flow. Thus
the torque at full stall of the output shaft of the GT404 is more than twice the full-load
design torque. This high stall torque is superior to that of reciprocating engines and is
important in starting and accelerating rotating equipment that has high initial turning
resistance. This kind of engine may be used in truck, bus, and marine applications as
well as in an industrial setting.
191
192
193
A unique patented feature of some of the Allison gas turbines, called power
transfer, is the ability to link the duel shafts. A hydraulic clutch mechanism between
the two turbine shafts acts to equalize their speeds. This tends to improve part-load
fuel economy, and provides engine braking and overspeed protection for the power
turbine. When the clutch mechanism is fully engaged, the shafts rotate together as a
single-shaft machine.
5.7 Intercooling and Reheat
Intercooling
It has been pointed out that the work of compression extracts a high toll on the output
of the gas turbine. The convergence of lines of constant pressure on a T-s diagram
indicates that compression at low temperatures reduces compression work. The ideal
compression process would occur isothermally at the lowest available temperature.
Isothermal compression is difficult to execute in practice. The use of multistage
compression with intercooling is a move in that direction.
Consider replacing the isentropic single-stage compression from p
1
to p
2
= p
2*
in
Figure 5.15 with two isentropic stages from p
1
to p
is
and p
i*
to p
2s
. Separation of the
compression processes with a heat exchanger that cools the air at T
is
to a lower
temperature T
i*
acts to move the final compression process to the left on the T-s
194
diagram and reduces the discharge temperature following compression to T
2s
. A heat
exchanger used to cool compressed gas between stages of compression is called an
intercooler.
The work required to compress from p
1
to p
2s
= p
2*
= p
2
in two stages is
w
c
= c
p
[(T
1
T
is
) + ( T
1*
T
2s
)] [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg]
Note that intercooling increases the net work of the reversible cycle by the area
isi*2s2*is. The reduction in the work due to two-stage intercooled compression
is also given by this area. Thus intercooling may be used to reduce the work of
compression between two given pressures in any application. However, the favorable
effect on compressor work reduction due to intercooling in the gas turbine application
may be offset by the obvious increase in combustor heat addition, c
p
(T
2*
T
2s
), and by
increased cost of compression system. The next example considers the selection of the
optimum pressure level for intercooling, p
i
= p
is
= p
i*
.
EXAMPLE 5.4
Express the compressor work, for two-stage compression with intercooling back to the
original inlet temperature, in terms of compressor efficiencies and pressure ratios.
Develop relations for the compressor pressure ratios that minimize the total work of
compression in terms of the overall pressure ratio.
Solution
Taking T
i*
= T
1
as directed in the problem statement, and letting r = p
2
/p
1
, r
1
= p
is
/p
1
and
r
2
= p
2s
/p
i*
= r/r
1
as in Figure 5.15, we get for the compression work,
w
c
= c
p
[(T
1
T
is
)/
c1
+ ( T
1
T
2s
)/
c2
]
= c
p
T
1
[(1 T
is
/T
1
)/
c1
+ ( 1 T
2s
/ T
1
)/
c2
]
= c
p
T
1
[(1 r
1
(k 1 )/k
)/
c1
+ ( 1 r
2
(k 1 )/k
)/
c2
] [Btu /lb
m
| kJ/kg]
Eliminating r
2
, using r = r
1
r
2
, yields
w
c
= c
p
T
1
[(1 r
1
(k 1 )/k
)/
c1
+ ( 1 (r/r
1
)
(k 1 )/k
)/
c2
]
Differentiating with respect to r
1
for a fixed r and setting the result equal to zero, we
obtain
r
1
1/k
/
c1
+ (r
(k 1 )/k
/
c2
) r
1
(2k 1 )/k

= 0
which simplifies to
195
r
1opt
= (
c1
/
c2
)
k/(2k 1)
r
1/2
Using this result we find also that
r
2opt
= (
c2
/
c1
)
k/(2k 1)
r
1/2
Examination of these equations shows that, for compressors with equal efficiencies,
both compressor stages have the same pressure ratio, which is given by the square root
of the overall pressure ratio. For unequal compressor efficiencies, the compressor with
the higher efficiency should have the higher pressure ratio.
_____________________________________________________________________
Reheat
Let us now consider an improvement at the high-temperature end of the cycle. Figure
5.16 shows the replacement of a single turbine by two turbines in series, each with
appropriately lower pressure ratios, and separated by a reheater. The reheater may be a
combustion chamber in which the excess oxygen in the combustion gas leaving the first
turbine burns additional fuel, or it may be a heater in which external combustion
provides the heat necessary to raise the temperature of the working fluid to T
m*
. The
high temperature at the low-pressure turbine inlet has the effect of increasing the area
of the cycle by mm*44*m and hence of increasing the net work.
196
Like intercooling, the increase in net work is made possible by the spreading of the
constant pressure lines on the T-s diagram as entropy increases. Thus the increase in
turbine work is
w
t
= c
p,g
[(T
m*
T
4
) ( T
m
T
4*
) ] [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (5.33)
Also as with intercooling, the favorable effect in increasing net work is offset by the
reduction of cycle efficiency resulting from increased addition of external heat from the
reheater:
q
rh
= c
p,g
(T
m*
T
m
) [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (5.34)
As with intercooling, the question arises as to how the intermediate pressure for
reheat will be selected. An analysis similar to that of Example 5.4 shows the unsur-
prising result that the reheat pressure level should be selected so that both turbines have
the same expansion ratio if they have the same efficiencies and the same inlet
temperatures.
Combining Intercooling, Reheat, and Regeneration
Because of their unfavorable effects on thermal efficiency, intercooling and reheat alone
or in combination are unlikely to be found in a gas turbine without another feature that
has already been shown to have a favorable influence on gas turbine fuel economy: a re-
generator. The recuperator or regenerator turns disadvantage into advantage in a cycle
involving intercooling and/or reheat. Consider the cycle of Figure 5.17, which
incorporates all three features.
The increased turbine discharge temperature T
4
produced by reheat and the
decreased compressor exit temperature T
2
due to intercooling both provide an enlarged
temperature potential for regenerative heat transfer. Thus the heat transfer c
p
(T
c
T
2
)
is accomplished by an internal transfer of heat from low pressure turbine exhaust gas.
This also has the favorable effect of reducing the temperature of the gas discharged to
the atmosphere. The requisite external heat addition for this engine is then
q
a
= c
p
[(T
3
T
c
) + ( T
m*
T
m
)] [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (5.35)
Thus the combination of intercooling, reheat, and regeneration has the net effect of
raising the average temperature of heat addition and lowering the average temperature
of heat rejection, as prescribed by Carnot for an efficient heat engine.
197
The Ericsson cycle
Increasing the number of intercoolers and reheaters without changing the overall pres-
sure ratio may be seen to cause both the overall compression and the overall expansion
to approach isothermal processes. The resulting reversible limiting cycle, consisting of
two isotherms and two isobars, is called the Ericsson cycle. With perfect internal heat
198
transfer between isobaric processes, all external heat addition would be at the maximum
temperature of the cycle and all heat rejected at the lowest temperature. Analysis of the
limiting reversible cycle reveals, as one might expect, that its efficiency is that of the
Carnot cycle. Plants with multistage compression, reheat, and regeneration can have
high efficiencies; but complexity and high capital costs have resulted in few plants that
actually incorporate all these features.
5.8 Gas Turbines in Aircraft Jet engines
Gas turbines are used in aircraft to produce shaft power and hot, high-pressure gas for
jet propulsion. Turbine shaft power is used in turboprop aircraft and helicopters to
drive propellers and rotors. A modern turboprop engine and an aircraft that uses it are
shown in Figures 5.18 through 5.20. While its jet exhaust provides some thrust, the
bulk of the propulsive thrust of the turboprop is provided by its propeller. The rear-
199
ward acceleration of a large air mass by the propeller is responsible for the good fuel
economy of turboprop aircraft. Thus the turboprop is popular as a power plant for
small business aircraft. At higher subsonic flight speeds, the conventional propeller
loses efficiency and the turbojet becomes superior.
Auxiliary power units, APUs, are compact gas turbines that provide mechanical
power to generate electricity in transport aircraft while on the ground. The thermo-
dynamic fundamentals of these shaft-power devices are the same those of stationary gas
turbines, discussed earlier. Their design, however, places a premium on low weight
and volume and conformance to other constraints associated with airborne equipment.
Thus their configuration and appearance may differ substantially from those of other
stationary gas turbines.
The jet engine consists of a gas turbine that produces hot, high-pressure gas but
has zero net shaft output. It is a gasifier. A nozzle converts the thermal energy of the
hot, high-pressure gas produced by the turbine into a high-kinetic-energy exhaust
stream. The high momentum and high exit pressure of the exhaust stream result in a
forward thrust on the engine.
Although the analysis of the jet engine is similar to that of the gas turbine, the
configuration and design of jet engines differ significantly from those of most
stationary gas turbines. The criteria of light weight and small volume, mentioned
earlier, apply here as well. To this we can add the necessity of small frontal area to
minimize the aerodynamic drag of the engine, the importance of admitting air into the
200
engine as efficiently (with as little stagnation pressure loss) as possible, and the efficient
conversion of high-temperature turbine exit gas to a high-velocity nozzle exhaust. The
resulting configuration is shown schematically in Figure 5.21.
Up to now we have not been concerned with kinetic energy in the flows in gas
turbines, because the flows at the stations of interest are usually designed to have low
velocities. In the jet engine, however, high kinetic energy is present in the free stream
ahead of the engine and in the nozzle exit flow. The analysis here will therefore be
presented in terms of stagnation, or total, temperatures and pressures, where kinetic
201
energy is taken into account implicitly, as discussed in Section 1.7. The preceding
analyses may be readily adapted to deal with the stagnation properties associated with
compressible flow. In the following discussion, engine processes are first described and
then analyzed.
It should be recalled that if there are no losses, as in an isentropic flow, the
stagnation pressure of a flow remains constant. All loss mechanisms, such as fluid
friction, turbulence, and flow separation, decrease stagnation pressure. Only by doing
work on the flow (with a compressor, for example) is it possible to increase stagnation
pressure.
In Figure 5.21, free-stream ambient air, denoted by subscript a, enters an engine
inlet that is carefully designed to efficiently decelerate the air captured by its frontal
area to a speed low enough to enter the compressor, at station 1, with minimal
aerodynamic loss. There is stagnation pressure loss in the inlet, but efficient
deceleration of the flow produces static and stagnation pressures at the compressor
entrance well above the ambient free-stream static pressure. This conversion of relative
kinetic energy of ambient air to increased pressure and temperature in the engine inlet is
sometimes called ram effect.
The compressor raises the stagnation pressure of the air further to its maximum
value at station 2, using power delivered by the turbine. Fuel enters the combustion
chamber and is burned with much excess air to produce the high turbine inlet
temperature at station 3. We adopt here, for simplicity, the familiar idealization that no
pressure losses occur in the combustion chamber. The hot gases then expand through
the turbine and deliver just enough power to drive the compressor (the work condition
again). The gases leave the turbine exit at station 4, still hot and at a stagnation pres-
sure well above the ambient. These gases then expand through a nozzle that converts
the excess pressure and thermal energy into a high-kinetic-energy jet at station 5. The
forward thrust on the engine, according to Newtons Second Law, is produced by the
reaction to the internal forces that accelerate the internal flow rearward to a high jet
velocity and the excess of the nozzle exit plane pressure over the upstream ambient
pressure.
Inlet Analysis
Given the flight speed, V
a ,
and the free-stream static temperature and pressure, T
a
and
p
a
, at a given altitude, the free-stream stagnation temperature and pressure are
T
oa
= T
a
+ V
a
2
/ 2c
p
[R | K] (5.36)
and
p
oa
= p
a
( T
oa
/T
a
)
k/(k 1)
[lb
f
/ft
2
| kPa] (5.37)
Applying the steady-flow energy equation to the streamtube entering the inlet, we find
202
that the stagnation enthalpy h
oa
= h
o1
for adiabatic flow. For subsonic flight and
supersonic flight at Mach numbers near one, the heat capacity of the air is essentially
constant. Thus constancy of the stagnation enthalpy implies constancy of the stagnation
temperature. Hence, using Equation (5.36),
T
o1
= T
oa
= T
a
+ V
a
2
/ 2c
p
[R | K] (5.38)

The effects of friction, turbulence, and other irreversibilities in the inlet flow are
represented by the inlet pressure recovery, PR, defined as
PR = p
o1
/ p
oa
[dl] (5.39)
where an isentropic flow through the inlet has a pressure recovery of 1.0. Lower values
indicate reduced inlet efficiency and greater losses. For subsonic flow, values on the
order of 0.9 to 0.98 are typical. At supersonic speeds the pressure recovery decreases
with increasing Mach number.
Compressor Analysis
With the stagnation conditions known at station 1 in Figure 5.21, the compressor
pressure ratio, r = p
o2
/p
o1
, now yields p
o2
; and the isentropic relation, Equation (1.19),
gives the isentropic temperaure, T
o2s
:
T
o2s
= T
o1
r
(k 1)/k
[R | K] (5.40)
The actual compressor discharge stagnation temperature is then obtained from the
definition of the compressor efficiency in terms of stagnation temperatures:

comp
= ( T
o1
T
o2s
) / ( T
o1
T
o2
) [dl] (5.41)
Combustor and Turbine Analysis
The turbine inlet temperature, T
03
, is usually assigned based on turbine blade material
considerations. For preliminary analysis it may be assumed that there are negligible
pressure losses in the combustion chamber, so that p
03
= p
02
. As with the two-shaft gas
turbine, the condition that the power absorbed by the compressor equal the power
delivered by the turbine determines the turbine exit temperature, T
04
:
c
p
(T
o2
T
o1
) = (1 + f )c
p,g
T
o3
( 1 T
o4
/ T
o3
) [Btu | kJ] (5.42)
where f is the engine fuel-air ratio, which often may be neglected with respect to 1 (as
in our earlier studies) when high precision is not required.
203
The turbine efficiency equation then yields the isentropic discharge temperature
T
04s
, and Equation (1.19) yields the turbine pressure ratio:
T
o4s
= T
o3


( T
o3
T
o4
) /
turb
[R | K] (5.43)
p
o3
/p
o4
= ( T
o3
/T
o4s
)
kg/(kg 1)
[dl] (5.44)
Thus the stagnation pressure and temperature at station 4 are known. Note that the
turbine pressure ratio is usually significantly lower than the compressor pressure ratio.
Nozzle Analysis
The flow is then accelerated to the jet velocity at station 5 by a convergent nozzle that
contracts the flow area. A well-designed nozzle operating at its design condition has
only small stagnation pressure losses. Hence the nozzle here is assumed to be loss-free
and therefore isentropic.
Under most flight conditions the exhaust nozzle is choked; that is, it is passing the
maximum flow possible for its upstream conditions. A choked nozzle has the local
flow velocity at its minimum area, or throat, equal to the local speed of sound. As a
result, simple relations exist between the upstream stagnation conditions at station 4
and the choked conditions at the throat. Thus, for a choked isentropic nozzle,
T
o4
= T
o5
= T
5
+ V
5
2
/ 2c
p,g

= T
5
+ k
g
RT
5
/2c
p,g
= T
5
( 1 + k
g
R/2c
p,g
)
= T
5
( k
g
+ 1

)/2 [R | K] (5.45)
where k
g
R/c
p,g
= k
g
1. With k
g
= 1.333 for the combustion gas, this determines the exit
temperature T
5
. Combining the isentropic relation with Equation (5.45) then gives the
nozzle exit static pressure p
5
:
p
5
/p
o4
= (T
5
/T
04
)
kg/(kg 1)
= [2/(k
g
+ 1)]
kg/(kg 1)
[dl] (5.46)
EXAMPLE 5.5
The stagnation temperature and pressure leaving a turbine and entering a convergent
nozzle are 970.2K. and 2.226 bar, respectively. What is the static pressure and
temperature downstream if the nozzle is choked? If the free-stream ambient pressure is
0.54 bar, is the nozzle flow choked? Compare the existing nozzle pressure ratio with
the critical pressure ratio.
204
Solution
If the nozzle is choked, then from Equations (5.45) and (5.46),
T
5
= 2T
o4
/( k
g
+ 1) = 2(970.2)/2.333 = 831.6 K
and the static pressure at the nozzle throat is
p
5
= p
o4
[2/(k
g
+ 1)]
kg/(kg 1)
= 2.226( 2 / 2.333 )
4
= 1.202 bar
The fact that p
5
> p
a
= 0.54 indicates that the nozzle is choked.
The critical pressure ratio of the nozzle is
p
o4
/p
5
= [(k
g
+ 1)/2]
kg/(kg 1)
= (2.333/2)
4
= 1.852
and the applied pressure ratio is 2.226/0.54 = 4.12. Thus the applied pressure ratio
exceeds the critical pressure ratio.This also indicates that the nozzle is choked.
_____________________________________________________________________
For the isentropic nozzle, the steady-flow energy equation gives
0 = h
5
+ V
5
2
/2 h
o4
or, with c
p,g
constant,
V
5
= [2c
p,g
(T
o4
T
5
)]

[ft/s | m/s] (5.47)


Thus the jet velocity is determined from Equation (5.47), where T
5
is obtained from
Equation (5.45).
The thrust of the engine is obtained by applying Newtons Second Law to a
control volume, as shown in Figure 5.22. If the mass flow rate through the engine is m,
the rates of momentum flow into and out of the control volume are mV
a
and mV
5
,
respectively. The net force exerted by the exit pressure is (p
5
p
a
)A
5
, where A
5
is the
nozzle exit area. Thus, applying Newtons Second Law to the control volume, we can
relate the force exerted by the engine on the gases flowing through, F, and the net exit
pressure force to the rate of increase of flow momentum produced by the engine:
m(V
5
V
a
) = F (p
5
p
a
)A
5
[lb
f
| kN]
or
F = m(V
5
V
a
) + ( p
5
p
a
)A
5
[lb
f
| kN] (5.48)
Here, F is the engine force acting on the gas throughflow. The reaction to this force is
the thrust on the engine acting in the direction of flight. Thus the magnitude of the
205
thrust is given by Equation (5.48). It is the sum of all the pressure force components
acting on the inside the engine in the direction of flight.
The exit area, A
5
, is related to the mass flow rate by
m = A
5
,
5
V
5
[lb
m
/s | kg /s] (5.49)
where the density at station 5 is obtained from the perfect gas law using p
5
and T
5
from
Equations (5.45) and (5.46). If A
5
is known, the mass flow rate through the engine may
be determined from Equation (5.49) and the thrust from Equation (5.48).
Another type of nozzle used in high-performance engines and in rocket nozzles is a
convergent-divergent nozzle, one in which the flow area first contracts and then
increases. It differs from the convergent nozzle in that it can have supersonic flow at
the exit. For such a fully expanded, convergent-divergent nozzle operating at its design
condition, p
5
= p
a
, and the engine thrust from Equation (5.48) reduces to m(V
5
V
a
).
Jet Engine Performance
It is seen that engine thrust is proportional to the mass flow rate through the engine and
to the excess of the jet velocity over the flight velocity. The specific thrust of an engine
is defined as the ratio of the engine thrust to its mass flow rate. From Equation (5.48)
206
the specific thrust is
F/m = (V
5
V
a
) + ( p
5
p
a
)A
5
/m [lb
f
-s/lb
m
| kN-s/kg] (5.50)
Because the engine mass flow rate is proportional to its exit area, as seen in Equation
(5.49), A
5
/m depends only on design nozzle exit conditions. As a consequence, F/m is
independent of mass flow rate and depends only on flight velocity and altitude.
Assigning an engine design thrust then determines the required engine-mass flow rate
and nozzle exit area and thus the engine diameter. Thus the specific thrust, F/m, is an
important engine design parameter for scaling engine size with required thrust at given
flight conditions.
Another important engine design parameter is the thrust specific fuel consumption,
TSFC, the ratio of the mass rate of fuel consumption to the engine thrust
TSFC = m
f
/F [lb
m
/ lb
f
-s | kg / kN-s ] (5.51)
Low values of TSFC, of course, are favorable. The distance an aircraft can fly without
refueling, called its range, is inversely proportional to the TSFC of its engines. The
following example demonstrates the evaluation of these parameters.
EXAMPLE 5.6
An aircraft flies at a speed of 250 m/s at an altitude of 5000 m. The engines operate at
a compressor pressure ratio of 8, with a turbine inlet temperature of 1200K. The
compressor and turbine efficiencies are 0.9 and 0.87, respectively, and there is a 4%
pressure loss in the combustion chamber. The inlet total pressure recovery is 0.97, and
the engine-mass flow rate is 100 kg/s. Use an engine mechanical efficiency of 0.99 and
a fuel heating value of 43,000 kJ/kg. Assume that the engine has a convergent,
isentropic, nozzle flow. Determine the nozzle exit area, the engine thrust, specific
thrust, fuel flow rate, and thrust specific fuel consumption.
Solution
The solution details are presented in Table 5.5 in spreadsheet form. At 5000 m
altitude, the ambient static temperature and pressure are determined from standard-
atmosphere tables such as those given in Appendix H. The ambient stagnation pressure
and temperature are then determined for the given flight speed. The stagnation
temperature at the compressor entrance is the same as the free-stream value for an
adiabatic inlet. The inlet pressure recovery determines the total pressure at the com-
pressor entrance. Using the notation of Figures 5.21 and 5.22, and given the com-
pressor pressure ratio and turbine inlet temperature, the stagnation conditions at the
compressor, combustor, and turbine exits may be determined in the same way as the
static conditions were determined earlier for stationary two-shaft gas turbines.
207
The calculated available nozzle pressure ratio p
o4
/p
a
= 4.118 is then compared with
the critical pressure ratio p
04
/p
c
= 1.852, which indicates that the convergent nozzle is
choked; i.e., sonic velocity exists at the throat. The nozzle exit plane pressure must
then be given by p
04
divided by the critical pressure ratio. Equation (5.45) for a sonic
condition then determines the nozzle exit plane temperature, and the exit plane density
follows from the ideal gas law. Because the exit is choked, the exit plane temperature
determines the exit velocity through the sonic velocity relation.
The nozzle exit area may then be determined by using the given mass flow rate and
208
the exit velocity and density from Equation (5.49). The fuel-air ratio for the combustor
is estimated from a simple application of the steady-flow energy equation to the
combustor, which neglects the fuel sensible heat with respect to its heating value and
assumes hot-air properties for the combustion products. The thrust, specific thrust, and
TSFC are then found from Equations (5.48), (5.50), and (5.51).
_____________________________________________________________________
The spreadsheet in Table 5.5 (available from Spreadsheet Examples as Example
5.6) is set up with conditional statements that treat the convergent nozzle for both the
choked and subsonic exit conditions. The calculations of T
5
, V
5
, and p
5
depend on
whether the throat is choked or not. The format for the spreadsheet conditional
statements is:
Conditional test, Result if true, Result if not true
The low value of fuel-air ratio, f = 0.0174, obtained in this example is typical of most
gas turbines and jet engines. In comparison with the stoichiometric value of 0.068, it
corresponds to an equivalence ratio of 0.256.
Modern Jet Engines
Full and cutaway views of a small modern jet engine used in business aircraft are shown
in Figure 5.23. The engine is a turbofan engine, a type of gas turbine engine that is
used in all large commercial aircraft and is gaining popularity in the business jet market.
The fan referred to in the turbofan name is seen at the left in Figure 5.23(b). The
incoming air splits after passing through the fan, with the flow through the outer
annulus passing to a nozzle that expels it without heating. The inner-core flow leaving
the fan passes through an axial flow compressor stage and a centrifugal compressor
before entering the combustor, turbine stages, and exit nozzle. Thus the core flow
provides the turbine power to drive the fan and the compressors. The thrust specific
fuel consumption and the thrust/weight ratio of turbofans is superior to those of
conventional jet engines, because a larger mass flow rate of air is processed and exits at
high velocity. The lower average exit velocity of the turbofan engine (compared to
turbojets) is secondary in importance to the increased total mass flow rate through the
engine.
A large turbofan engine designed to power Boeing 747 and 767, Airbus A310 and
A300, and McDonnell-Douglas MD-11 aircraft is shown in Figure 5.24. In large
turbofans and most large jet engines, axial compressors and turbines are used rather
than centrifugal compressors. The axial compressors are capable of much higher
pressure ratios, allow compression without turning the flow through a large angle, and
have somewhat higher efficiencies than centrifugals. Large axial compressors have
many axial stages and are capable of overall pressure ratios in excess of 30. Turbofans
are studied in more detail in Chapter 9.
209
Afterburning
The exhaust of a jet engine contains a large amount of unused oxygen because of the
high air-fuel ratios necessary to limit the gas stagnation temperature to which the
210
turbine blading is exposed. This excess oxygen at the turbine exit makes it possible to
burn additional fuel downstream and thereby to increase the nozzle exit temperature
and jet velocity. By extending the interface between the turbine and the nozzle in a jet
engine and by adding fuel spray bars to create a large combustion chamber called an
afterburner, it is possible to dramatically increase the thrust of a jet engine. Much
higher afterburner stagnation temperatures are allowed than those leaving the
combustor, because (a) there is no highly stressed rotating machinery downstream of
the afterburner, and (b) afterburner operating periods are usually limited to durations of
a few minutes. Afterburners are used for thrust augmentation of jet aircraft to assist in
takeoff and climb and to provide a brief high-speed-dash capability and increased
maneuver thrust in military aircraft. However, the substantial fuel consumption penalty
of afterburning restricts its use to brief periods of time when it is badly needed.
The T-s diagram for a jet engine with afterburner seen in Figure 5.25 shows that
afterburning is analogous to reheating in an open-cycle stationary gas turbine, as shown
in Figure 5.16. The energy release in the afterburner at approximately constant
stagnation pressure shifts the nozzle expansion process to the right on the T-s diagram.
As a result, the nozzle enthalpy and temperature differences between T-s diagram
211
constant-pressure lines increase as the nozzle inlet stagnation temperature increases.
This produces higher jet velocities. Using Equation (5.47) and the notation
of Figure 5.16, we get for the ratio of fully expanded nozzle isentropic jet velocity with
afterburning to that without:
V/V
wo
= [(T
om*
T
4
)/(T
om
T
4*
)]

= (T
om*
/T
om
)

[(1 T
4
/T
om*
)/(1 T
4*
/T
om
)]

= (T
om*
/T
om
)

where the static-to-stagnation temperature ratios are eliminated using the


corresponding equal isentropic pressure ratios. Thus, for example, the jet velocity ratio,
and therefore the thrust ratio, for a reheat temperature ratio of 4 is about 2. The
analysis of a jet engine with afterburner is illustrated in the following example.
EXAMPLE 5.7
Consider the performance of the engine analyzed in Example 5.6 when an afterburner is
added. Assume that heat addition in the afterburner raises the nozzle entrance
stagnation temperature to 2000 K, with a 5% stagnation pressure loss in the
afterburner. What is the increase in nozzle exit temperature, jet velocity, and thrust?
212
Solution
Table 5.6 is from an adaptation of the spreadsheet (Table 5.5) used for Example
5.6. The calculations are identical up to the turbine exit at station 4. Heat addition in
the afterburner raises the stagnation temperature at the nozzle entrance, T
ob,
to 2000K,
while the 5% pressure loss drops the stagnation pressure to 2.115 bar. Comparing the
applied nozzle pressure ratio (p
ob
/p
a
) with the critical pressure ratio (p
ob
/p
c
) shows that
213
the nozzle remains choked. The remainder of the calculation follows Example 5.6
except that the fuel consumption associated with the afterburner temperature rise is
taking into account in the fuel-air ratio, fuel flow rate, and specific fuel consumption.
_____________________________________________________________________
Table 5.7 compares some of the performance parameters calculated in Examples 5.6
and 5.7. The table shows clearly the striking gain in thrust provided by the high nozzle
exit temperature produced by afterburning and the accompanying high penalty in fuel
consumption. Note, however, that even with afterburning the overall equivalence ratio
0.0448/0.068 = 0.659 is well below stoichiometric.
Table 5.7 Examples 5.6 and 5.7 Compared
Parameter Without Afterburner With Afterburner
Temperature, K
Nozzle entrance 970.2 2000.0
Nozzle exit 831.6 1714.3
Nozzle exit velocity, m/s 564.1 809.9
Thrust, kN 54.7 87.99
Fuel-air Ratio 0.0174 0.0448
TSFC, kg/kN-s 0.032 0.051
Bibliography and References
1. Cohen, H., Rogers, G. F. C., and Saravanamuttoo, H. I. H., Gas Turbine Theory,
3rd Edition. New York: Longman Scientific and Technical, 1987.

2. Potter, J. H., The Gas Turbine Cycle." ASME paper presented at the Gas Turbine
Forum Dinner, ASME Annual Meeting, New York, N.Y., November 27, 1972.
3. Bathie, William W., Fundamentals of Gas Turbines. New York: Wiley, 1984.

4. Whittle, Sir Frank, Gas Turbine Aerothermodynamics. New York: Pergamon, 1981.
5. Wilson, David Gordon, The Design of High-Efficiency Turbomachinery and Gas
Turbines. Cambridge, Mass.: MIT Press, 1984.
6. Chapman, Alan J., and Walker, William F., Introductory Gas Dynamics. New York:
Holt, Rinehart and Winston, 1971.
214
7. Oates, Gordon C., Aerothermodynamics of Gas Turbine and Rocket Propulsion.
Washington, D. C.: American Institute of Aerodynamics and Astronautics, 1988.
8. Bammert, K., and Deuster, G., Layout and Present Status of the Closed-Cycle
Helium Turbine Plant Oberhausen. ASME paper 74-GT-132, 1974.
9. Bammert, Karl, The Oberhausen Heat and Power Station with Helium Turbine.
Address on the Inauguration of the Helium Turbine Power Plant of EVO at
Oberhausen-Sterkrade, Westdeutschen Allgemeinen Zeitung, WAZ, December 20,
1974.
10. Zenker, P., The Oberhausen 50-MW Helium Turbine Plant, Combustion, April
1976, pp. 21-25.
11. Weston, Kenneth C., Gas Turbine Analysis and Design Using Interactive
Computer Graphics. Proceedings of Symposium on Applications of Computer
Methods in Engineering, University of Southern California, August 23-26, 1977.
12. United States Standard Atmosphere, 1976, NOAA, NASA, and USAF, October
1976.
13. Weston, Kenneth C., Turbofan Engine Analysis and Optimization Using
Spreadsheets. ASME Computers in Engineering Conference, Anaheim, California,
July 30-August 3, 1989.
14. Kerrebrock, Jack K., Aircraft Engines and Gas Turbines. Cambridge, Mass.: MIT
Press, 1983.
15. Dixon, S. L., Fluid Mechanics, Thermodynamics of Turbomachinery. New York:
Pergamon Press, 1978.
16. Bammert, K., Rurik, J., and Griepentrog, H., Highlights and Future Development
of Closed-Cycle Gas Turbines. ASME paper 74-GT-7, 1974.
EXERCISES
5.1 For the Air Standard Brayton cycle, express the net work in terms of the
compressor pressure ratio, r, and the turbine-to-compressor inlet temperature ratio,
T
3
/T
1
. Nondimensionalize the net work with c
p
T
1
, and derive an expression for the
pressure ratio that maximizes the net work for a given value of T
3
/T
1
.

5.2 For a Brayton Air Standard cycle, work out an expression for the maximum
possible compressor pressure ratio for a given turbine-to-compressor inlet temperature
215
ratio. Draw and label the cycle on a T-s diagram. What is the magnitude of the net
work for this cycle? Explain.
5.3 For a calorically perfect gas, write an expression for the temperature difference,
T
2
T
1
, on an isentrope between two lines of constant pressure in terms of the initial
temperature T
1
and the pressure ratio p
2
/p
1
. Sketch a T-s diagram showing two different
isentropes between the two pressure levels. Explain how your expression demonstrates
that the work of an isentropic turbomachine operating between given pressure levels
increases with temperature.
5.4 Derive an expression for the enthalpy difference, h
2
h
1
, along a calorically perfect
gas isentrope spanning two fixed pressure levels, p
2
and p
1
, in terms of the discharge
temperature T
2
. Note that as T
2
increases, the enthalpy difference also increases.
5.5 Derive Equation (5.9).
5.6 Derive Equations (5.24) and (5.25).
5.7 A simple-cycle stationary gas turbine has compressor and turbine efficiencies of
0.85 and 0.9, respectively, and a compressor pressure ratio of 20. Determine the work
of the compressor and the turbine, the net work, the turbine exit temperature, and the
thermal efficiency for 80F ambient and 1900F turbine inlet temperatures.
5.8 A simple-cycle stationary gas turbine has compressor and turbine efficiencies of
0.85 and 0.9, respectively, and a compressor pressure ratio of 20. Determine the work
of the compressor and the turbine, the net work, the turbine exit temperature, and the
thermal efficiency for 20C ambient and 1200C turbine inlet temperatures.
5.9 A regenerative-cycle stationary gas turbine has compressor and turbine isentropic
efficiencies of 0.85 and 0.9, respectively, a regenerator effectiveness of 0.8, and a
compressor pressure ratio of 5. Determine the work of the compressor and the turbine,
the net work, the turbine and regenerator exit temperatures, and the thermal efficiency
for 80F ambient and 1900F turbine inlet temperatures. Compare the efficiency of the
cycle with the corresponding simple-cycle efficiency.
5.10 A regenerative-cycle stationary gas turbine has compressor and turbine isentropic
efficiencies of 0.85 and 0.9, respectively, a regenerator effectiveness of 0.8, and a
compressor pressure ratio of 5. Determine the work of the compressor and the turbine,
the net work, the turbine and regenerator exit temperatures, and the thermal efficiency
for 20C ambient and 1200C turbine inlet temperatures. Compare the efficiency of the
cycle with the corresponding simple-cycle efficiency.
5.11 A two-shaft stationary gas turbine has isentropic efficiencies of 0.85, 0.88, and 0.9
216
for the compressor, gas generator turbine, and power turbine, respectively, and a
compressor pressure ratio of 20.
(a) Determine the compressor work and net work, the gas generator turbine exit
temperature, and the thermal efficiency for 80F ambient and 1900F compressor-
turbine inlet temperatures.
(b) Calculate and discuss the effects of adding reheat to 1900F ahead of the
power turbine.
5.12 A two-shaft stationary gas turbine has isentropic efficiencies of 0.85, 0.88, and
0.9 for the compressor, gas generator turbine, and power turbine, respectively, and a
compressor pressure ratio of 20.
(a) Determine the compressor work and net work, the gas generator turbine exit
temperature, and the thermal efficiency for 20C ambient and 1200C compressor-
turbine inlet temperatures.
(b) Calculate and discuss the effects of adding reheat to 1200C ahead of the
power turbine.
5.13 A two-shaft stationary gas turbine with an intercooler and reheater has
efficiencies of 0.85, 0.88, and 0.9 for the compressor, gas-generator turbine, and power
turbine, respectively, and a compressor pressure ratio of 5.
(a) Determine the compressor work and net work, the gas generator turbine exit
temperature, and the thermal efficiency for 80F ambient and 1900F turbine inlet
temperatures.
(b) Calculate and discuss the effect on thermal efficiency, exhaust temperature, and
net work of adding a regenerator with an effectiveness of 75%.
5.14 A two-shaft stationary gas turbine with an intercooler and reheater has
efficiencies of 0.85, 0.88, and 0.9 for the compressor, gas-generator turbine, and power
turbine, respectively, and a compressor pressure ratio of 5.
(a) Determine the compressor work and net work, the gas generator turbine exit
temperature, and the thermal efficiency for 20C ambient and 1200C turbine inlet
temperatures.
(b) Calculate and discuss the effect on thermal efficiency, exhaust temperature, and
net work of adding a regenerator with an effectiveness of 75%.
5.15 Consider a pulverized-coal-burning, single-shaft gas turbine in which the
combustion chamber is downstream of the turbine to avoid turbine blade erosion and
corrosion. The combustion gases leaving the burner heat the compressor discharge air
through the intervening walls of a high temperature ceramic heat exchanger.
(a) Sketch the flow and T-s diagrams for this gas turbine, showing the influence of
pressure drops through the combustor and the heat exchanger. The ambient, turbine
inlet, and combustor exhaust temperatures are 80F, 1900F, and 3000F, respectively.
The compressor pressure ratio is 5. Assume perfect turbomachinery.
217
(b) For zero pressure drops, determine the net work, the thermal efficiency, and
the heat exchanger exhaust temperature.
(c) If the coal has a heating value of 14,000 Btu/lb
m
, what is the coal consumption
rate, in tons per hour, for a 50-MW plant?
5.16 Consider a pulverized-coal-burning, single-shaft gas turbine in which the
combustion chamber is downstream of the turbine to avoid turbine blade erosion and
corrosion. The combustion gases leaving the burner heat the compressor discharge air
through the intervening walls of a high-temperature ceramic heat exchanger.
(a) Sketch the flow and T-s diagrams for this gas turbine, showing the influence of
pressure drops through the combustor and the heat exchanger. The ambient, turbine
inlet, and combustor exhaust temperatures are 20C, 1200C, and 2000C,
respectively. The compressor pressure ratio is 5. Assume perfect turbomachinery.
(b) For zero pressure drops, determine the net work, the thermal efficiency, and
the heat exchanger exhaust temperature.
(c) If the coal has a heating value of 25,000 kJ/kg, what is the coal consumption
rate, in tons per hour, for a 50-MW plant?
5.17 A stationary gas turbine used to supply compressed air to a factory operates with
zero external shaft load. Derive an equation for the fraction of the compressor inlet air
that can be extracted ahead of the combustion chamber for process use in terms of the
compressor pressure ratio, the ratio of turbine-to-compressor inlet temperatures, and
the turbomachinery efficiencies. Plot the compressor mass extraction ratio as a
function of compressor pressure ratio for temperature ratios of 3 and 5, perfect
turbomachinery, and identical high- and low-temperature heat capacities.
5.18 A stationary gas turbine used to supply compressed air to a factory operates with
zero external shaft load. Derive an equation for the fraction of the inlet air that can be
extracted ahead of the combustion chamber for process use in terms of the compressor
pressure ratio, the ratio of turbine-to-compressor inlet temperatures, and the turbo-
machinery efficiencies. What is the extraction mass flow for a machine that has a
compressor pressure ratio of 10, turbomachine inlet temperatures of 1800F and 80F,
turbomachine efficiencies of 90%, and a compressor inlet mass flow rate of 15 lb
m
/s?
5.19 A stationary gas turbine used to supply compressed air to a factory operates with
zero external shaft load. Derive an equation for the fraction of the inlet air that can be
extracted ahead of the combustion chamber for process use in terms of the compressor
pressure ratio, the ratio of turbine-to-compressor inlet temperatures, and the turbo-
machinery efficiencies. What is the extraction mass flow for a machine that has a
compressor pressure ratio of 8, turbomachine inlet temperatures of 1000C and 25C,
turbomachine efficiencies of 90%, and a compressor inlet mass flow rate of 10 kg

/s?
5.20 Do Exercise 5.18, but account for combustion chamber fractional pressure drops
218
of 3% and 5% of the burner inlet pressure. How does increased pressure loss influence
process mass flow?
5.21 Do Exercise 5.19, but account for combustion chamber fractional pressure drops
of 3% and 5% of the burner inlet pressure. How does increased pressure loss influence
process mass flow?
5.22 A gas-turbine-driven car requires a maximum of 240 shaft horsepower. The
engine is a two-shaft regenerative gas turbine with compressor, gas generator turbine,
and power turbine efficiencies of 0.86, 0.9, and 0.87, respectively, and a regenerator
effectiveness of 0.72. The compressor pressure ratio is 3.7, and the turbine and
compressor inlet temperatures are 1800F and 90F, respectively. What air flow rate
does the engine require? What is the automobile exhaust temperature? What are the
engine fuel-air ratio and specific fuel consumption if the engine burns gaseous methane?
5.23 A gas-turbine-driven car requires a maximum of 150kW of shaft power. The
engine is a two-shaft regenerative gas turbine with compressor, gas generator turbine,
and power turbine efficiencies of 0.84, 0.87 and 0.9, respectively, and a regenerator
effectiveness of 0.75. The compressor pressure ratio is 4.3, and the turbine and
compressor inlet temperatures are 1250C and 20C, respectively. What air flow rate
does the engine require? What is the automobile exhaust temperature? What are the
engine fuel-air ratio and specific fuel consumption if the engine burns gaseous
hydrogen?
5.24 A simple-cycle gas turbine is designed for a turbine inlet temperature of 1450F,
a compressor pressure ratio of 12, and compressor and turbine efficiencies of 84% and
88%, respectively. Ambient conditions are 85F and 14.5 psia.
(a) Draw and label a T-s diagram for this engine.
(b) Determine the compressor, turbine, and net work for this cycle.
(c) Determine the engine thermal efficiency.
(d) Your supervisor has requested that you study the influence of replacing the
compressor with dual compressors and an intercooler. Assume that the new
compressors are identical to each other and have the same efficiencies and combined
overall pressure ratio as the original compressor. Assume intercooling to 85F with no
intercooler pressure losses. Show clearly the T-s diagram for the modified system
superimposed on your original diagram. Calculate the revised system net work and
thermal efficiency.
5.25 Determine the air and kerosene flow rates for a 100-MW regenerative gas turbine
with 1800K turbine inlet temperature, compressor pressure ratio of 5, and 1 atm. and
300K ambient conditions. The compressor and turbine efficiencies are 81% and 88%,
respectively, and the heat exchanger effectiveness is 75%. Use a heating value for
kerosene of 45,840 kJ/kg. What is the engine specific fuel consumption?
219
5.26 A regenerative gas turbine has compressor and turbine discharge temperatures of
350K and 700K, respectively. Draw and label a T-s diagram showing the relevant
states. If the regenerator has an effectiveness of 70%, what are the combustor inlet
temperature and engine exhaust temperature?
5.27 A gas turbine has a turbine inlet temperature of 1100K, a turbine pressure ratio of
6, and a turbine efficiency of 90%. What are the turbine exit temperature and the
turbine work?
5.28 A two-shaft gas turbine with reheat has turbine inlet temperatures of 1500F, a
compressor pressure ratio of 16, and turbomachine efficiencies of 88% each. The
compressor inlet conditions are 80F and 1 atm. Assume that all heat capacities are
0.24 Btu/lb
m
-R and k = 1.4.
(a) Draw T-s and flow diagrams.
(b) Make a table of temperatures and pressures for all real states, in R and atm.
(c) What are the compressor work and power turbine work?
(d) What is the power-turbine-to-compressor work ratio?
(e) What is the cycle thermal efficiency?
(f) Evaluate the recommendation to add a regenerator to the system. If a 4-count
(0.04) increase in thermal efficiency can be achieved, the addition of the regenerator is
considered economically feasible. Give your recommendation, supporting arguments,
and substantiating quantitative data.
5.29 Consider a gas turbine with compressor and turbine inlet temperatures of 80F
and 1200F, respectively. The turbine efficiency is 85%, and compressor pressure
ratio is 8.
(a) Draw coordinated T-s and plant diagrams.
(b) What is the turbine work?
(c) What is the minimum compressor efficiency required for the gas turbine to
produce a net power output?
(d) What is the thermal efficiency if the compressor efficiency is raised to 85%?
5.30 The first closed-cycle gas turbine power plant in the world using helium as a
working fluid is a 50-MW plant located in Oberhausen, Germany (ref. 8). It was
designed as an operating power plant and as a research facility to study aspects of
component design and performance with helium as a working fluid. It has two
compressors, with intercooling, connected directly to a high-pressure turbine. The high-
pressure turbine is in turn connected through a gearbox to a low-pressure turbine with
no reheat. Helium is heated first by regenerator, followed by a specially designed
heater that burns coke-oven gas. A water-cooled pre-cooler returns the helium to the
low-pressure compressor inlet conditions. The high-pressure turbine mass flow rate is
84.4 kg/s, and the heater efficiency is 92.2%. The following design data are given in
the reference:
220
Temperature, C Pressure, Bar
1. Low-pressure compressor inlet 25 10.5
2. Intercooler inlet 83 15.5
3. High-pressure compressor inlet 25 15.4
4. Regenerator inlet, high-pressure side 125 28.7
5. Heater inlet 417 28.2
6. High-pressure turbine inlet 750 27.0
7. Low-pressure turbine inlet 580 16.5
8. Regenerator inlet, low-pressure side 460 10.8
9. Precooler inlet 169 10.6
In the following, assume k = 1.67 and c
p
= 5.197 kJ/kg-K for helium.
(a) Sketch and label flow and T-s diagrams for the plant.
(b) What is the overall engine pressure ratio of the gas turbine?
(c) Estimate the mechanical power output and plant thermal efficiency. Reference
8 gives 50-MW and 31.3% as net electrical output and efficiency, respectively.
Evaluate your calculations with these data.
5.31 Determine the thrust for a turbojet engine flying at 200 m/s with a compressor
inlet temperature of 27C, a compressor pressure ratio of 11, a turbine inlet
temperature of 1400K, and compressor and turbine efficiencies of 0.85 and 0.9,
respectively. The engine mass flow rate is 20 kg/s. You may use k = 1.4 and c
p
=
1.005 kJ/kg-K throughout and neglect the differences between static and stagnation
properties in the turbomachinery. Assume an ambient pressure of 0.2615 atmospheres.
5.32 The gas generator of a two-shaft gas turbine has a compressor pressure ratio of 5
and compressor and turbine inlet temperatures of 80F and 2000F, respectively, at sea
level. All turbomachines have efficiencies of 90%, and the inlet air flow is 50 lb
m
/s.
(a) What are the net work, pressure ratio, and horsepower of the power turbine
and the cycle efficiency?
(b) Suppose the power turbine is removed and the gas generator exhaust gas flows
isentropically through a convergent-divergent propulsion nozzle that is fully expanded
(exit pressure is ambient). What are the nozzle exhaust velocity and the static thrust?
(c) Repeat part (b) for a choked conversion nozzle.
5.33 A gas turbine with reheat has two turbines with efficiencies e
1
and e
2
. Derive
relations for the turbine pressure ratios r
1
and r
2
that maximize the total turbine work
for a given overall turbine pressure ratio, r, if both turbines have the same inlet
temperature. How do the pressure ratios compare if the turbine efficiencies are equal?
221
If the efficiency of one turbine is 50% higher than the other, what is the optimum
pressure ratio?
5.34* For a simple-cycle gas turbine, develop a multicolumn spreadsheet that
tabulates and plots (a) the net work, nondimensionalized by using the product of the
compressor constant-pressure heat capacity and the compressor inlet temperature, and
(b) the thermal efficiency, both as a function of compressor pressure ratio (only one
graph with two curves). Use 80F and 2000F as compressor and turbine inlet
temperatures, respectively, and 0.85 and 0.90 as compressor and turbine efficiencies,
respectively. Use appropriate constant heat capacities. Each of the input values should
be entered in separate cells in each column so that the spreadsheet may be used for
studies with other parametric values. Use your plot and table to determine the pressure
ratio that yields the maximum net work. Compare with your theoretical expectation.
5.35* Solve Exercise 5.34 for a regenerative cycle. Use a nominal value of 0.8 for
regenerator effectiveness.
5.36* Solve Exercise 5.34 for a two-shaft regenerative cycle. Use a nominal value of
0.8 for regenerator effectiveness and 0.88 for the power turbine efficiency. Account
also for 3% pressure losses in both sides of the regenerator.
5.37 For the conditions of Exercise 5.31, but using more realistic properties in the
engine hot sections, plot curves of thrust and specific fuel consumption as a function of
gaseous hydrogen air-fuel ratio. Determine the maximum thrust corresponding to the
stoichiometric limit for gaseous hydrogen fuel.
5.38* Use the spreadsheet corresponding to Table 5.4 to plot a graph showing the
influence of turbine inlet temperature on net work and thermal efficiency for two-shaft
gas turbines, with and without regeneration, for a compressor pressure ratio of 4.
5.39 Extend Example 5.6 by using hand calculations to evaluate the thrust and the
thrust specific fuel consumption for the engine if it were fitted with a fully expanded
(exit pressure equal to ambient pressure) convergent-divergent isentropic nozzle.
5.40* Modify the spreadsheet corresponding to Table 5.6 to evaluate the thrust and the
thrust specific fuel consumption for the engine if it were fitted with a fully expanded
(exit pressure equal to ambient pressure) convergent-divergent isentropic nozzle.
5.41 A gas turbine engine is being designed to provide work and a hot, high-velocity
exhaust flow. The compressor will have a pressure ratio of 4 and an isentropic
efficiency of 90% at the design point. The compressor and load are driven by separate
___________________
* Exercise numbers with asterisks involve computer usage.
222
turbines, but the overall expansion pressure ratio across the turbines will be 3 to 1, and
the efficiency of each turbine will be 90%. The exhaust of the low-pressure turbine is
expanded through a convergent nozzle to provide the high-velocity exhaust. At the
design point the turbine inflow air temperature will be held to 1140F, and the air flow
rate will be 300,000 pounds mass per hour. Ambient conditions are 60F and 14.7 psia.
Calculate the brake power of the engine, in kW, and the temperatures at the entrance
and the exit of nozzle.
5.42 A ramjet is a jet engine that flies at speeds high enough that the pressure rise
produced by ram effect in the inlet makes a compressor and turbine unnecessary. At
50,000 feet and Mach 3, the inlet has a stagnation pressure recovery of 85%.
Combustion raises the air temperature to 2500K. What is the thrust per unit mass flow
rate of air and the exit velocity of the engine if the nozzle is (a) convergent, and (b)
fully expanded (exit pressure equal to ambient pressure) convergent-divergent?
5.43 Using the First Law of Thermodynamics, derive an equation for the work of
compression in a reversible steady flow in terms of volume and pressure. Use the
equation to derive an expression for the reversible isothermal work of compression of a
calorically perfect gas, with compressor pressure ratio as an independent variable.
5.44 Sketch a pressure-volume diagram comparing isothermal and isentropic
compressions starting at the same state and having the same pressure ratio. Show for a
thermally perfect gas that, at a given state, the isentrope has a steeper (negative) slope
than an isotherm. Use your diagram to prove that the isothermal work of compression
is less than the isentropic work.
5.45 A supersonic aircraft flies at Mach 2 at an altitude of 40,000 feet. Its engines
have a compressor pressure ratio of 20 and a turbine inlet temperature of 2000F. The
inlets have total pressure recoveries of 89%, the compressors and turbines all have
efficiencies of 90%, and the nozzles are convergent and isentropic. Determine the
nozzle exit velocity and thrust, and estimate the thrust specific fuel consumption of
each engine. The mass flow rate of air of each engine is 750 lb
m
/s. Use a fuel heating
value of 18,533 Btu/lb
m
.
5.46 A supersonic aircraft flies at Mach 2 at an altitude of 13,000 m. Its engines have
a compressor pressure ratio of 20 and a turbine inlet temperature of 1500K. The inlets
have total pressure recoveries of 89%, the compressors and turbines all have
efficiencies of 90%, and the nozzles are convergent and isentropic. Determine the
nozzle exit velocity and thrust, and estimate the thrust specific fuel consumption of an
engine for an engine air mass flow rate of 100 kg

/s. Use a fuel heating value of 43,100
kJ/kg.
5.47 A supersonic aircraft flies at Mach 2 at an altitude of 40,000 feet. Its engines
223
have a compressor pressure ratio of 20 and a turbine inlet temperature of 2000F. The
inlets have total pressure recoveries of 89%, and the compressors and turbines all have
efficiencies of 90%. The engines have afterburners that raise the temperature of the gas
entering the nozzles to 3000F. The nozzles are convergent and isentropic. Compare
the design thrust and thrust specific fuel consumption with the afterburner on and off
for an engine air mass flow rate of 100 lb
m
/s.
5.48* For a simple-cycle gas turbine, develop a multicolumn spreadsheet that tabulates
and plots (a) the net work, nondimensionalized by using the compressor constant-
pressure heat capacity and the compressor inlet temperature, and (b) the thermal
efficiency, as a function of compressor pressure ratio (only one graph with two curves).
Use 30 C and 1500C as compressor and turbine inlet temperatures, respectively, and
0.85 and 0.90 as compressor and turbine efficiencies, respectively. Assume appropriate
constant heat capacities. Each of the input values should be entered in separate cells in
each column, so that the spreadsheet may be used for studies with other parametric
values. Use your plot and table to determine the pressure ratio that yields the
maximum net work. Compare with your theoretical expectation.
5.49* Solve Exercise 5.48 for a regenerative cycle. Use a nominal value of 0.85 for
regenerator effectiveness.
5.50 Methane is burned in an adiabatic gas turbine combustor. The fuel enters the
combustor at the reference temperature for the JANAF tables and mixes with air
compressed from 80F through a pressure ratio of 16 with a compressor efficiency of
90.5%. Determine the equivalence ratio that limits the turbine inlet temperature to
2060F by:
(a) Using the JANAF tables.
(b) Using an energy balance on the combustion chamber and the lower heating
value for methane.
224
C H A P T E R 6
RECIPROCATING INTERNAL
COMBUSTION ENGINES
6.1 Introduction
Perhaps the best-known engine in the world is the reciprocating internal combustion
(IC) engine. Virtually every person who has driven an automobile or pushed a power
lawnmower has used one. By far the most widely used IC engine is the spark-ignition
gasoline engine, which takes us to school and work and on pleasure jaunts. Although
others had made significant contributions, Niklaus Otto is generally credited with the
invention of the engine and with the statement of its theoretical cycle.
Another important engine is the reciprocating engine that made the name of Rudolf
Diesel famous. The Diesel engine, the workhorse of the heavy truck industry, is widely
used in industrial power and marine applications. It replaced the reciprocating steam
engine in railroad locomotives about fifty years ago and remains dominant in that role
today.
The piston, cylinder, crank, and connecting rod provide the geometric basis of the
reciprocating engine. While two-stroke-cycle engines are in use and of continuing
interest, the discussion here will emphasize the more widely applied four-stroke-cycle
engine. In this engine the piston undergoes two mechanical cycles for each
thermodynamic cycle. The intake and compression processes occur in the first two
strokes, and the power and exhaust processes in the last two. These processes are made
possible by the crank-slider mechanism, discussed next.
6.2 The Crank-Slider Mechanism
Common to most reciprocating engines is a linkage known as a crank-slider mechan-
ism. Diagramed in Figure 6.1, this mechanism is one of several capable of producing
the straight-line, backward-and-forward motion known as reciprocating. Fundament-
ally, the crank-slider converts rotational motion into linear motion, or vice-versa. With
a piston as the slider moving inside a fixed cylinder, the mechanism provides the vital
capability of a gas engine: the ability to compress and expand a gas. Before delving into
this aspect of the engine, however, let us examine the crank-slider mechanism more
closely.
225
It is evident from Figure 6.2 that, while the crank arm rotates through 180, the
piston moves from the position known as top-center (TC) to the other extreme, called
bottom-center (BC). During this period the piston travels a distance, S, called the
stroke, that is twice the length of the crank.
For an angular velocity of the crank, 6, the crank pin A has a tangential velocity
component 6S/2. It is evident that, at TC and at BC, the crank pin velocity component
in the piston direction, and hence the piston velocity, is zero. At these points,
corresponding to crank angle = 0 and 180, the piston reverses direction. Thus as
varies from 0 to 180, the piston velocity accelerates from 0 to a maximum and then
returns to 0. A similar behavior exists between 180 and 360.
The connecting rod is a two-force member; hence it is evident that there are both
axial and lateral forces on the piston at crank angles other than 0 and 180. These
lateral forces are, of course, opposed by the cylinder walls. The resulting lateral force
component normal to the cylinder wall gives rise to frictional forces between the piston
rings and cylinder. It is evident that the normal force, and thus the frictional force,
alternates from one side of the piston to the other during each cycle. Thus the piston
motion presents a challenging lubrication problem for the control and reduction of both
wear and energy loss.
The position of the piston with respect to the crank centerline is given by
x = (S/2)cos + Lcos [ft | m] (6.1)
where y
A
= (S/2)sin = Lsin can be used to eliminate to obtain
x/L = (S/2L)cos + [1 (S/2L)
2
sin
2
]

[dl] (6.2)
Thus, while the axial component of the motion of the crank pin is simple harmonic,
x
A
= (S/2)cos, the motion of the piston and piston pin is more complex. It may be
226
seen from Equation (6.2), however, that as S/L becomes small, the piston motion
approaches simple harmonic. This becomes physically evident when it is recognized
that, in this limit, the connecting rod angle, , approaches 0 and the piston motion
approaches the axial motion of the crank pin. Equations (6.1) and (6.2) may be used to
predict component velocities, accelerations, and forces in the engine.
The volume swept by the piston as it passes from TC to BC is called the piston
displacement, disp. Engine displacement, DISP, is then the product of the piston
displacement and the number of cylinders, DISP = (n)(disp). The piston displacement is
the product of the piston cross-sectional area and the stroke. The cylinder inside
diameter (and, approximately, also the piston diameter) is called its bore. Cylinder bore,
stroke, and number of cylinders are usually quoted in engine specifications along with
or instead of engine displacement. It will be seen later that the power output of a
reciprocating engine is proportional to its displacement. An engine of historical interest
that also used the crank-slider mechanism is discussed in the next section.
6.3 The Lenoir Cycle
An early form of the reciprocating internal combustion engine is credited to Etienne
Lenoir. His engine, introduced in 1860, used a crank-slider-piston-cylinder arrangement
227
in which a combustible mixture confined between the piston and cylinder is ignited after
TC. The resulting combustion gas pressure forces acting on the piston deliver work by
way of the connecting rod to the rotating crank. When the piston is at BC, combustion
gases are allowed to escape. The rotational momentum of the crank system drives the
piston toward TC, expelling additional gases as it goes. A fresh combustible mixture is
again admitted to the combustion chamber (cylinder) and the cycle is repeated.
The theoretical Lenoir cycle, shown in Figure 6.3 on a pressure-volume diagram,
consists of the intake of the working fluid (a combustible mixture) from state 0 to state
1, a constant-volume temperature and pressure rise from state 1 to state 2, approxim-
ating the combustion process, an isentropic expansion of the combustion gases to state
3, and a constant-pressure expulsion of residual gases back to state 0. Note that a
portion of the piston displacement, from state 0 to state 1, is used to take in the
combustible mixture and does not participate in the power stroke from state 2 to state
3. The engine has been called an explosion engine because the power delivered is due
only to the extremely rapid combustion pressure rise or explosion of the mixture in the
confined space of the cylinder.
Hundreds of Lenoir engines were used in the nineteenth century, but the engine is
quite inefficient by todays standards. In 1862, Beau de Rochas pointed out that the
228
efficiency of internal combustion could be markedly improved in reciprocating engines
by compression of the air-fuel mixture prior to combustion. In 1876 Niklaus Otto (who
is thought to have been unaware of Rochas suggestion) demonstrated an engine that
incorporated this important feature, as described next.
6.4 The Otto Cycle
The Otto cycle is the theoretical cycle commonly used to represent the processes in
the spark ignition (SI) internal combustion engine. It is assumed that a fixed mass of
working fluid is confined in the cylinder by a piston that moves from BC to TC and
back, as shown in Figure 6.4. The cycle consists of isentropic compression of an
air-fuel mixture from state 1 to state 2, constant-volume combustion to state 3,
isentropic expansion of the combustion gases to state 4, and a constant-volume heat
rejection back to state 1. The constant-volume heat rejection is a simple expedient to
close the cycle. It obviates the need to represent the complex expansion and outflow of
229
combustion gases from the cylinder at the end of the cycle. Note that the Otto cycle is
not concerned with the induction of the air-fuel mixture or with the expulsion of
residual combustion gases. Thus only two mechanical strokes of the crank-slider are
needed in the Otto cycle, even when it is used to represent an ideal four-stroke-cycle
Otto engine. In this case the remaining strokes are used to execute the necessary intake
and exhaust functions. Because it involves only two strokes, the Otto cycle may also
represent a two-stroke-cycle engine. The two-stroke-cycle engine is in principle
capable of as much work in one rotation of the crank as the four-stroke engine is in
two. However, it is difficult to implement because of the necessity of making the
intake and exhaust functions a part of those two strokes. It is therefore not as highly
developed or widely used as the four-stroke-cycle engine. We will focus on the four-
stroke-cycle here.
The simplest analysis of the Otto cycle assumes calorically perfect air as the work-
ing fluid in what is called the Air Standard cycle analysis. Following the notation of
Figure 6.4, the compression process can be represented by the isentropic relation for a
calorically perfect gas, Equation (1.21), as
p
2
/p
1
= (V
1
/V
2
)
k
[dl] (6.3)
where the compression ratio, CR = V
1
/V
2
, is a fundamental parameter of all recipro-
cating engines. The diagram shows that the expansion ratio for the engine, V
4
/V
3
, has
the same value, V
1
/V
2
. The clearance volume, V
2
, is the volume enclosed between the
cylinder head and the piston at TC. Thus the compression ratio may be expressed as the
ratio of the sum of the clearance and displacement volumes to the clearance volume:
CR = [V
2
+ (V
1
V
2
)]/V
2
Thus, for a given displacement, the compression ratio may be increased by reducing the
clearance volume.
The efficiency of the cycle can be most easily determined by considering constant-
volume-process heat transfers and the First Law cyclic integral relation, Equation (1.3).
The heat transferred in the processes 2$3 and 4$1 are
q
2$3
= c
v
(T
3
T
2
) [Btu/lb
m
| kj/kg] (6.4)
and

q
4$1
= c
v
(T
1
T
4
) [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (6.5)
Both the expansion process, 3$4, and the compression process, 1$2, are assumed to
be isentropic. Thus, by definition, they are both adiabatic. From the cyclic integral, the
net work per unit mass is then:
w = q
2$3
+ q
4$1
= c
v
(T
3
T
2
+ T
1
T
4
) [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (6.6)
230
As before, the cycle thermal efficiency is the ratio of the net work to the external heat
supplied:

Otto
= w/q
2$3
= c
v
(T
3
T
2
+ T
1
T
4
) / [c
v
(T
3
T
2
)]

= 1 + (T
1
T
4
) / (T
3
T
2
)
= 1 T
1
/T
2
= 1 1 /

CR
k-1
[dl] (6.7)
where Equation (1.20) has been used to eliminate the temperatures. Equation (6.7)
shows that increasing compression ratio increases the cycle thermal efficiency. This is
true for real engines as well as for the idealized Otto engine. The ways in which real
spark ignition engine cycles deviate from the theoretical Otto cycle are discussed later.
EXAMPLE 6.1
An Otto engine takes in an air-fuel mixture at 80F and standard atmosphere presssure.
It has a compression ratio of 8. Using Air Standard cycle analysis, a heating value of
20,425 Btu/lb
m
, and A/F = 15, determine:
(a) The temperature and pressure at the end of compression, after combustion, and
at the end of the power stroke.
(b) The net work per pound of working fluid.
(c) The thermal efficiency.
Solution
We use the notation of Figure 6.4:
(a) p
2
= p
1
(V
1
/V
2
)
k
= 1(8)
1.4
= 18.38 atm
T
2
= T
1
(V
1
/V
2
)
k 1
= (540)(8)
0.4
= 1240.6R
T
3
= T
2
+ q
a
/c
v
= T
2
+ (F/A)(HV)k/c
p
= 1240.6 + 1.4(20,425/15(0.24 = 9184R
p
3
= p
2
T
3
/T
2
= 18.38(9184/1240.6) = 136.1 atm
T
4
= T
3
/CR
k1
= 9184/ 8
0.4
= 3997.2R
p
4
= p
3
/CR
k
= 136.1/8
1.4
= 7.4 atm
(b) The constant-volume heat addition is governed by the fuel-air ratio and the fuel
heating value:
q
a
= HV(F/A) = 20,425/15 = 1361.7 Btu/lb
m
of air
231
q
r
= c
v
(T
1
T
4
) = (0.24/1.4)( 540 3997.4) = 592.7 Btu/lb
m
w = q
a
+ q
r
= 1361.7 + ( 592.7) = 769 Btu/lb
m
(c) The cycle termal efficiency may then be determined from the definition of the
heat engine thermal efficiency or Equation (6.7):

th
= w/q
a
= 769/1361.7 = 0.565

th
= 1 1/8
0.4
= 0.565
_____________________________________________________________________
In view of the discussion of gas properties and dissociation in Chapter 3, the values
of T
3
and T
4
in Example 6.1 are unrealistically high. Much of the energy released by the
fuel would go into vibration and dissociation of the gas molecules rather than into the
translational and rotational degrees of freedom represented by the temperature. As a
result, significantly lower temperatures would be obtained. Thus, while the analysis is
formally correct, the use of constant-low-temperature heat capacities in the Air
Standard cycle makes it a poor model for predicting temperature extremes when high
energy releases occur. Some improvement is achieved by using constant-high-
temperature heat capacities, but the best results would be achieved by the use of real
gas properties, as discussed in several of the references.
6.5 Combustion in a Reciprocating Engine
The constant-volume heat transfer process at TC in the Otto cycle is an artifice to
avoid the difficulties of modeling the complex processes that take place in the
combustion chamber of the SI engine. These processes, in reality, take place over a
crank angle span of 30 or more around TC. Let us consider aspects of these processes
and their implementation in more detail.
Normally, the mixture in the combustion chamber must have an air-fuel ratio in the
neighborhood of the stoichiometric value for satisfactory combustion. A more or less
homogeneous mixture may be produced outside the cylinder in a carburetor, by
injection into the intake manifold, or by throttle-body injection into a header serving
several intake manifolds. In the case of the carburetor, fuel is drawn into the engine
from the carburetor by the low pressure created in a venturi through which the
combustion air flows. As a result, increased air flow causes lower venturi pressure and
hence increased fuel flow. The fuel system thus serves to provide an air-fuel mixture
that remains close to the stoichiometric ratio for a range of air flow rates. Various
devices designed into the carburetor further adjust the fuel flow for the special
operating conditions encountered, such as idling and rapid acceleration.
Maximum fuel economy is usually attained with excess air to ensure that all of the
fuel is burned. A mixture with excess air is called a lean mixture. The carburetor
232
usually produces this condition in automobiles during normal constant-speed driving.
On the other hand, maximum power is achieved with excess fuel to assure that all
of the oxygen in the air in the combustion chamber is reacted. It is a matter of exploit-
ing the full power-producing capability of the displacement volume. A mixture with
excess fuel is called a rich mixture. The automotive carburetor produces a rich mixture
during acceleration by supplying extra fuel to the air entering the intake manifold.
The equivalence ratio is sometimes used to characterize the mixture ratio, whether
rich or lean. The equivalence ratio, , is defined as the ratio of the actual fuel-air ratio
to the stoichiometric fuel-air ratio. Thus > 1 represents a rich mixture and < 1
represents a lean mixture. In terms of air-fuel ratio, = (A/F)
stoich
/(A/F).
Homogeneous air-fuel mixtures close to stoichiometric may ignite spontaneously
(that is, without a spark or other local energy source) if the mixture temperature
exceeds a temperature called the autoignition temperature. If the mixture is brought to
and held at a temperature higher than the autoignition temperature, there is a period of
delay before spontaneous ignition or autoignition This time interval is called the
ignition delay, or ignition lag. The ignition delay depends on the characteristics of the
fuel and the equivalence ratio and usually decreases with increasing temperature.
In spark-ignition engines, compression ratios and therefore the temperatures at the
end of compression are low enough that the air-fuel mixture is ignited by the spark plug
before spontaneous ignition can occur. SI engines are designed so that a flame front
will propagate smoothly from the spark plug into the unburned mixture until all of the
mixture has been ignitied. However, as the flame front progresses, the temperature and
pressure of the combustion gases behind it rise due to the release of the chemical
energy of the fuel. As the front propagates, it compresses and heats the unburned
mixture, sometimes termed the end-gas. Combustion is completed as planned when the
front smoothly passes completely through the end-gas without autoignition. However,
if the end-gas autoignites, a pinging or low-pitched sound called knock is heard.
The avoidance of knock due to autoignition of the end-gas is a major constraint on
the design compression ratio of an SI engine. If hot spots or thermally induced
compression of the end-gas ignite it before the flame front does, there is a more rapid
release of chemical energy from the end-gas than during normal combustion. Knock is
sometimes thought of as an explosion of the end gas that creates an abrupt pulse and
pressure waves that race back and forth across the cylinder at high speed, producing
the familiar pinging or low-pitched sound associated with knock. Knock not only
reduces engine performance but produces rapid wear and objectionable noise in the
engine. Thus it is important for a SI engine fuel to have a high autoignition
temperature. It is therefore important for SI engine fuel to have a high autoignition
temperature. Thus the knock characteristics of commercially available fuels limit the
maximum allowable design compression ratio for SI engines and hence limit their best
efficiency.
The octane number is a measure of a gasoline's ability to avoid knock. Additives
such as tetraethyl lead have been used in the past to suppress engine knock. However,
the accumulation of lead in the environment and its penetration into the food cycle has
233
resulted in the phaseout of lead additives. Instead refineries now use appropriate blends
of hydrocarbons as a substitute for lead additives in unleaded fuels.
The octane number of a fuel is measured in a special variable-compression-ratio
engine called a CFR (Cooperative Fuels Research) engine. The octane rating of a fuel is
determined by comparison of its knocking characteristics with those of different
mixtures of isooctane, C
8
H
18
, and n-heptane, C
7
H
16
. One hundred percent isooctane is
defined as having an octane number of 100 because it had the highest resistance to
knock at the time the rating system was devised. On the other hand, n-heptane is
assigned a value of 0 on the octane number scale because of its very poor knock
resistance. If a gasoline tested in the CFR engine has the same knock threshold as a
blend of 90% isooctane and 10% n-heptane, the fuel is assigned an octane rating of 90.
In combustion chamber design, the designer attempts to balance many factors to
achieve good performance. Design considerations include locating intake valves away
from and exhaust valves near spark plugs, to keep end-gas in a relatively cool area of
the combustion chamber and thereby suppress hot-surface-induced autoignition
tendencies. Valves are, of course, designed as large as possible to reduce induction and
exhaust flow restrictions. More than one intake and one exhaust valve per cylinder are
now used in some engines to improve engine breathing. In some engines, four valves
in a single cylinder are employed for this purpose. The valves are also designed to
induce swirl and turbulence to promote mixing of fuel and air and to improve
combustion stability and burning rate.
Pollution and fuel economy considerations have in recent years profoundly
influenced overall engine and combustion chamber design. Stratified-charge engines,
for example, attempt to provide a locally rich combustion region to control peak
temperatures and thus suppress NO
x
formation. The resulting combustion gases
containing unburned fuel then mix with surrounding lean mixture to complete the
combustion process, thus eliminating CO and unburned hydrocarbons from the exhaust.
These processes occur at lower temperatures than in conventional combustion chamber
designs and therefore prevent significant nitrogen reactions.
6.6 Representing Reciprocating Engine Perfomance
In an earlier section, the theoretical work per unit mass of working fluid of the Otto
engine was evaluated for a single cycle of the engine, using the cyclic integral of the
First Law of Thermodynamics. The work done by pressure forces acting on a piston
can also be evaluated as the integral of pdV. It is evident therefore that the work done
during a single engine cycle is the area enclosed by the cycle process curves on the
pressure-volume diagram. Thus, instead of using the cyclic integral or evaluating pdV
for each process of the cycle, the work of a reciprocating engine can be found by
drawing the theoretical process curves on the pV diagram and graphically integrating
them. Such a plot of pressure versus volume for any reciprocating engine, real or
theoretical, is called an indicator diagram.
234
In the nineteenth and early twentieth centuries a mechanical device known as an
engine indicator was used to produce indicator cards or diagrams to determine the
work per cycle for slow-running steam and gas reciprocating engines. The indicator
card was attached to a cylinder that rotated back and forth on its axis as the piston
oscillated, thus generating a piston position (volume) coordinate. At the same time a
pen driven by a pressure signal from the engine cylinder moved parallel to the cylinder
axis, scribing the p-V diagram over and over on the card. The work of high speed
engines is still evaluated from traces of pressure obtained with electronic sensors and
displayed on electronic monitors and through digital techniques.
The work done per cycle (from an indicator card, for instance) can be represented
as an average pressure times a volume. Because the displacement volumes of engines
are usually known, an engine performance parameter known as the mean effective
pressure, MEP, is defined in terms of the piston displacement. The mean effective
pressure is defined as the value of the pressure obtained by dividing the net work per
cylinder per cycle at a given operating condition by the piston displacement volume:
MEP = W/disp [lb
f
/ft
2
| kPa] (6.8)
Thus the MEP is a measure of the effectiveness of a given displacement volume in
producing net work.
The power output of an engine with identical cylinders may be represented as the
product of the work per cycle and the number of cycles executed per unit time by the
engine. Thus if the engine has n cylinders, each executing N identical thermodynamic
cycles per unit time, and delivering W work units per cylinder, with a piston
displacement, disp, the power output is given by
P = n(N(W = n(N (MEP ( disp [ft-lb
f
/min | kW] (6.9)
Expressed for the entire engine, the engine displacement is DISP = n(disp and the
engine work is MEP (DISP. Hence the engine power is:
P = N (MEP(DISP [ft-lb
f
/min | kW] (6.10)
where N, the number of thermodynamic cycles of a cylinder per unit time, is the number
of crank-shaft revolutions per unit time for a two-stroke-cycle engine and one-half of
the revolutions per unit time for a four-stroke-cycle engine. The factor of for the
four-stroke-cycle engine arises because one thermodynamic cycle is executed each time
the crank rotates through two revolutions.
EXAMPLE 6.2
What is the displacement of an engine that develops 60 horsepower at 2500 rpm in a
four-stroke-cycle engine having an MEP of 120 psi?
235
Solution
From Equation (6.10), the displacement of the engine is
DISP = P/(N (MEP) = (60)(33,000)(12)/[(2500/2)(120)] = 158.4 in
3
Checking units: (HP)(ft-lb
f
/HP-min)(in/ft)/[(cycles/min)(lb
f
/in
2
)] = in
3
_____________________________________________________________________
If the work is evaluated from an indicator diagram the work is called indicated
work; the MEP is called the indicated mean effective pressure, IMEP; and the power is
indicated power, IP. Note that the indicated work and power, being associated with the
work done by the combustion chamber gases on the piston, do not account for
frictional or mechanical losses in the engine, such as piston-cylinder friction or the drag
of moving parts (like connecting rods) as they move through air or lubricating oil.
Brake Performance Parameters
Another way of evaluating engine performance is to attach the engine output shaft
to a device known as a dynamometer, or brake. The dynamometer measures the
torque, T, applied by the engine at a given rotational speed. The power is then
calculated from the relation
P = 2*(rpm (T [ft-lb
f
/min | N-m/min] (6.11)
A simple device called a prony brake, which was used in the past, demonstrates the
concept for the measurement of the shaft torque of engines. Figure 6.5 shows the prony
brake configuration in which a stationary metal band wrapped around the rotating
flywheel of the engine resists the torque transmitted to it by friction. The product of the
force measured by a spring scale, w, and the moment arm, d , gives the resisting torque.
The power dissipated is then given by 2*(rpm)w (d.
Modern devices such as water brakes and electrical dynamometers long ago
replaced the prony brake. The water brake is like a centrifugal water pump with no
outflow, mounted on low-friction bearings, and driven by the test engine. As with the
prony brake, the force required to resist turning of the brake (pump) housing provides
the torque data. This, together with speed measurement, yields the power output from
Equation (6.11). The power dissipated appears as increased temperature of the water
in the brake and heat transfer from the brake. Cool water is circulated slowly through
the brake to maintain a steady operating condition. The torque measured in this way is
called the brake torque, BT, and the resulting power is called the brake power, BP. To
summarize: while indicated parameters relate to gas forces in the cylinder, brake
parameters deal with output shaft forces.
Thus the brake power differs from the indicated power in that it accounts for the
effect of all of the energy losses in the engine. The difference between the two is
referred to as the friction power, FP. Thus FP = IP BP.
236
Friction power varies with engine speed and is difficult to measure directly. An
engine is sometimes driven without fuel by a motor-dynamometer to evaluate friction
power. An alternative to using friction power to relate brake and indicated power is
through the engine mechanical efficiency,
m
:

m
= BP/IP [dl] (6.12)
Because of friction, the brake power of an engine is always less than the indicated
power; hence the engine mechanical efficiency must be less than 1. Clearly, mechanical
efficiencies as close to 1 as possible are desired.
The engine indicated power can also be expressed in terms of torque, through
Equation (6.11). Thus an indicated torque, IT, can be defined. Similarly, a brake mean
effective pressure, BMEP, may be defined that, when multiplied by the engine displace-
ment and speed, yields the brake power, analogous to Equation (6.10). Table 6.1
summarizes these and other performance parameters and relations.
The thermal efficiency, as for other engines, is a measure of the fuel economy of a
reciprocating engine. It tells the amount of power output that can be achieved for a
given rate of heat release from the fuel. The rate of energy release is, in turn, the
product of the rate of fuel flow and the fuel heating value. Thus, for a given thermal
efficiency, power output can be increased by employing a high fuel flow rate and/or
selecting a fuel with a high heat of combustion.
If the thermal efficiency is evaluated using the brake power, it is called the brake
thermal efficiency, BTE. If the evaluation uses the indicated power, it is called the
indicated thermal efficiency, ITE.
237
It is common practice in the reciprocating engine field to report engine fuel
economy in terms of a parameter called the specific fuel consumption, SFC, analogous
to the thrust specific fuel consumption used to describe jet engine performance. The
specific fuel consumption is defined as the ratio of the fuel-mass flow rate to the power
output. Typical units are pounds per horsepower-hour or kilograms per kilowatt-hour.
Obviously, good fuel economy is indicated by low values of SFC. The SFC is called
brake specific fuel consumption, BSFC, if it is defined using brake power or indicated
specific fuel consumption, ISFC, when based on indicated power. The SFC for a
reciprocating engine is analogous to the heat rate for a steam power plant in that both
are measures of the rate of energy supplied per unit of power output, and in that low
values of both are desirable.
Volumetric Efficiency
The theoretical energy released during the combustion process is the product of the
mass of fuel contained in the combustion chamber and its heating value if the fuel is
completely reacted. The more air that can be packed into the combustion chamber, the
Table 6.1 Engine Performance Parameters
Indicated Brake Friction
Mean effective pressure IMEP BMEP FMEP = IMEP BMEP

m
= BMEP / IMEP
Power IP BP FP = IP BP

m
= BHP / IHP
Torque IT BT FT = IT BT

m
= BT / IT
Thermal efficiency ITE BTE
m
= BTE / ITE
Specific fuel consumption ISFC BSFC
m
= ISFC / BSFC
more fuel that can be burned with it. Thus a measure of the efficiency of the induction
system is of great importance. The volumetric efficiency,
v
, is the ratio of the actual
mass of mixture in the combustion chamber to the mass of mixture that the displace-
ment volume could hold if the mixture were at ambient (free-air) density. Thus the
average mass-flow rate of air through a cylinder is
v
(disp) ,
a
N. Pressure losses
across intake and exhaust valves, combustion-chamber clearance volume, the influence
of hot cylinder walls on mixture density, valve timing, and gas inertia effects all
influence the volumetric efficiency.
EXAMPLE 6.3
A six-cylinder, four-stroke-cycle SI engine operates at 3000 rpm with an indicated
mean effective pressure of five atmospheres using octane fuel with an equivalence ratio
238
of 0.9. The brake torque at this condition is 250 lb
f
ft., and the volumetric efficiency is
85%. Each cylinder has a five inch bore and 6 inch stroke. Ambient conditions are
14.7 psia and 40F. What is the indicated horsepower, brake horsepower, and friction
horsepower; the mechanical efficiency; the fuel flow rate; and the BSFC?
Solution
The six cylinders have a total displacement of
DISP = 6*5
2
6/4 = 706.86 in
3

Then the indicated horsepower is
IP = MEPDISPN /[1233,000] [lb
f
/in
2
][in
3
][cycles/min]/[in/ft][ft-lb
f
/HP-min]
= (5)(14.7)(706.86)(3000/2)/[1233,000] = 196.8 horsepower
The brake horsepower, from Equation (6.11), is:
BP = 2* 3000 250 / 33,000 = 142.8 horsepower
Then the friction power is the difference between the indicated and brake power:
FP = 196.8 142.8 = 54 horsepower
and the mechanical efficiency is

m
= 142.8/196.8 = 0.726
The ambient density is
,
a
= 14.7 144/ [53.3 500] = 0.0794 lb
m
/ft
3
and the mass flow rate of air to the engine is
m
a
= 0.850.0794706.86(3000/2)/1728 = 41.4 lb
m
/min
For octane the stoichiometric reaction equation is
C
8
H
18
+ 12.5O
2
+ (12.53.76)N
2
$ 8CO
2
+ 9H
2
O + (12.53.76)N
2
The fuel-air ratio is then
F/A = 0.9[(812) + (181)]/[12.5(32 + 3.7628)] = 0.0598 lb
m
-fuel /lb
m
-air
239
The fuel flow rate is
m
f
= m
a
(F/A) = 41.4 0.0598 = 2.474 lb
m
/min
The brake specific fuel consumption is
BSFC = 60 m
f
/BHP

= 602.474/142.8 = 1.04 lb
m
/BHP-hr
____________________________________________________________________
6.7 Spark-Ignition Engine Performance
A typical indicator diagram showing intake and exhaust processes, valve actuation,
and spark timing for a four-stroke-cycle SI engine is shown in Figure 6.6. It is assumed
that an appropriate air-fuel mixture is supplied from a carburetor through an intake
manifold to an intake valve, IV, and that the combustion gas is discharged through an
exhaust valve, EV, into an exhaust manifold.
The induction of the air-fuel mixture starts with the opening of the intake valve at
point A just before TC. As the piston sweeps to the right, the mixture is drawn into the
cylinder through the IV. The pressure in the cylinder is somewhat below that in the
intake manifold due to the pressure losses across the intake valve. In order to use the
momentum of the mixture inflow through the valve at the end of the intake stroke to
improve the volumetric efficiency, intake valve closure is delayed to shortly after BC at
point B. Power supplied from inertia of a flywheel (and the other rotating masses in the
engine) drives the piston to the left, compressing and raising the temperature of the
trapped mixture.
The combustion process in a properly operating SI engine is progressive in that the
reaction starts at the spark plug and progresses into the unburned mixture at a finite
speed. Thus the combustion process takes time and cannot be executed instantaneously
as implied by the theoretical cycle. In order for the process to take place as near to TC
as possible, the spark plug is fired at point S. The number of degrees of crank rotation
before TC at which the spark occurs is called the ignition advance. Advances of 10 to
30 are common, depending on speed and load. The spark advance may be controlled
by devices that sense engine speed and intake manifold pressure. Microprocessors are
now used to control spark advance and other functions, based on almost instantaneous
engine performance measurements.
Recalling the slider-crank analysis, we observ that the piston velocity at top center
is momentarily zero as the piston changes direction. Therefore no work can be done at
this point, regardless of the magnitude of the pressure force. Thus, to maximize the
work output, it is desired to have the maximum cylinder pressure occur at about 20
after TC. Adjustment of the spark advance (in degrees before TC) allows some control
of the combustion process and the timing of peak pressure. For a fixed combustion
duration, the combustion crank-angle interval must increase with engine speed. As a
consequence, the ignition advance must increase with increasing engine speed to
240
maintain optimum timing of the peak pressure.
Following combustion, the piston continues toward bottom center as the high
pressure gases expand and do work on the piston during the power stroke. As the
piston approaches BC, the gases do little work on the piston as its velocity again
approaches zero. As a result, not much work is lost by early opening of the exhaust
valve before BC (at point E) to start the blowdown portion of the exhaust process. It is
expedient to sacrifice a little work during the end of the power stroke in order to
reduce the work needed to overcome an otherwise-high exhaust stroke cylinder
pressure. Inertia of the gas in the cylinder and resistance to flow through the exhaust
valve opening slow the drop of gas pressure in the cylinder after the valve opens.
Thus the gases at point E are at a pressure above the exhaust manifold pressure and,
during blowdown, rush out through the EV at high speed. Following blowdown, gases
remaining in the cylinder are then expelled as the piston returns to TC. They remain
above exhaust manifold pressure until reaching TC because of the flow resistance of the
exhaust valve. The EV closes shortly after TC at point C, terminating the exhaust
process. The period of overlap at TC between the intake valve opening at point A and
exhaust valve closing at point C in Figure 6.6 allows more time for the intake and
exhaust processes at high engine speeds, when about 10 milliseconds may be available
for these processes. At low engine speed and at idling there may be some mixture loss
through the exhaust valve and discharge into the intake manifold during this valve
overlap period.
The combined exhaust and induction processes are seen to form a pumping loop
that traverses the p-V diagram in a counterclockwise direction and therefore
241
represents work input rather than work production. The higher the exhaust stroke
pressure and the lower the intake stroke pressure, the greater the area of the pumping
loop and hence the greater the work that must be supplied by the power loop
(clockwise) to compensate. Great attention is therefore paid to valve design and other
engine characteristics that influence the exhaust and induction processes. Volumetric
efficiency is a major parameter that indicates the degree of success of these efforts.
Performance Characteristics
A given ideal Otto-cycle engine produces a certain amount of work per cycle. For such
a cycle, MEP = W/disp is a constant. Equating the power equations (6.9) and (6.11)
shows that the average torque is proportional to MEP and independent of engine
engine speed. Therefore power output for the ideal engine is directly proportional to
the number of cycles executed per unit time, or to engine speed. Thus an Otto engine
has ideal torque and power characteristics, as shown by the solid lines in Figure 6.7.
The characteristics of real engines (represented by the dashed lines) tend to be
similar in nature to the ideal characteristics but suffer from speed-sensitive effects,
particularly at low or high speeds. Torque and power characteristics for a 3.1 liter V6
engine (ref. 9) are shown by the solid lines in Figure 6.8. Note the flatness of the
torque-speed curve and the expected peaking of the power curve at higher speed than
the torque curve. Rather than present graphical characteristics such as this in their
242
brochures, automobile manufacturers usually present only values for the maximum
power and torque and the speeds at which they occur. Engine characteristics such as
those shown in the figure are invaluable to application engineers seeking a suitable
engine for use in a product.
6.8 The Compression-Ignition or Diesel Cycle
The ideal Diesel cycle differs from the Otto cycle in that combustion is at constant
pressure rather than constant volume. The ideal cycle, shown in Figure 6.9, is
commonly implemented in a reciprocating engine in which air is compressed without
fuel from state 1 to state 2. With a typically high compression ratio, state 2 is at a
temperature high enough that fuel will ignite spontaneously when sprayed directly into
the air in the combustion chamber from a high-pressure fuel injection system.
By controlling the fuel injection rate and thus the rate of chemical energy release in
relation to the rate of expansion of the combustion gases after state 2, a constant-
243
pressure process or other energy release pattern may be achieved as in Figure 6.9. For
example, if the energy release rate is high, then pressure may rise, as from 2 to 3', and
if low may fall to 3''. Thus constant-pressure combustion made possible by controlling
the rate of fuel injection into the cyclinder implies the use of a precision fuel injection
system.
Instead of injecting fuel into the high-temperature compressed air, the cycle might
be executed by compression of an air-fuel mixture, with ignition occurring either
spontaneously or at a hot spot in the cylinder near the end of the compression process.
Inconsistency and unpredictability of the start of combustion in this approach, due to
variations in fuel and operating conditions, and to lack of control of the rate of heat
release with the possibility of severe knock, makes the operation of such an engine
unreliable, at the least, and also limits the maximum compression ratio. The Diesel
engine therefore usually employs fuel injection into compressed air rather than
carbureted mixture formation.
In the Air Standard cycle analysis of the Diesel cycle, the heat addition process is at
constant pressure:
q
2$3
= c
p
(T
3
T
2
) [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (6.13)
and, as with the Otto cycle, the closing process is at constant volume:
q
4$1
= c
v
(T
1
T
4
) [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (6.14)
244
The net work and thermal efficiency are then:
w = q
2$3
+ q
4$1

= c
p
(T
3
T
2
) + c
v
(T
1
T
4
)
= c
v
T
1
[k(T
3
/T
1
T
2
/T
1
) + 1 T
4
/T
1
] [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (6.15)

Diesel
= w/q
2$3
= 1 + q
4-$1
/q
2$3
= 1 + (c
v
/c
p
)(T
1
T
4
)/(T
3
T
2
)
= 1 (1/k)(T
1
/T
2
)(T
4
/T
1
1)/(T
3
/T
2
1) [dl] (6.16)
The expressions for the net work and cycle efficiency may be expressed in terms
two parameters, the compression ratio, CR = V
1
/V
2
(as defined earlier in treating the
Otto cycle) and the cutoff ratio, COR = V
3
/V
2
. The temperature ratios in Equations
(6.15) and (6.16) may be replaced by these parameters using, for the constant-pressure
process,
COR = V
3
/V
2
= T
3
/T
2
and by expanding the following identity:
T
4
/T
1
= (T
4
/T
3
)(T
3
/T
2
)(T
2
/T
1
)
= (V
3
/V
4
)
k-1
(V
3
/V
2
)(V
1
/V
2
)
k-1

= [(V
3
/V
4
)(V
1
/V
2
)]
k-1
COR = (COR)
k-1
COR
= COR
k
where the product of the volume ratios was simplified by recognizing that V
4
= V
1
.
Thus the nondimensionalized net work and Diesel-cycle thermal efficiency are given by
w /c
v
T
1
= kCR
k-1
(COR 1) + (1 COR
k
) [dl] (6.17)
and

Diesel
= 1 (1/k)[(COR
k
1)/(COR 1)]/CR
k-1
[dl] (6.18)
where the cutoff ratio, COR, is the ratio of the volume at the end of combustion, V
3
, to
that at the start of combustion, V
2
. Thus the cutoff ratio may be thought of as a
measure of the duration of fuel injection, with higher cutoff ratios corresponding to
longer combustion durations.
245
Diesel-cycle net work increases with both compression ratio and cutoff ratio. This is
readily seen graphically from Figure 6.9 in terms of p-V diagram area. As with the
Otto cycle, increasing compression ratio increases the Diesel-cycle thermal efficiency.
Increasing cutoff ratio, however, decreases thermal efficiency. This may be rationalized
by observing from the p-V diagram that much of the additional heat supplied when
injection is continued is rejected at increasingly higher temperatures. Another view is
that heat added late in the expansion process can produce work only over the remaining
part of the stroke and thus adds less to net work than to heat rejection.
EXAMPLE 6.4
A Diesel engine has a compression ratio of 20 and a peak temperature of 3000K. Using
an Air Standard cycle analysis, estimate the work per unit mass of air, the thermal
efficiency, the combustion pressure, and the cutoff ratio.
Solution
Assuming an ambient temperature and pressure of 300K and 1 atmosphere, the
temperature at the end of the compression stroke is
T
2
= (300)(20)
1.4 1
= 994.3K
and the combustion pressure is
p
2
= (1)(20)
1.4
= 66.3 atm
Then the cutoff ratio is
V
3
/V
2
= T
3
/T
2
= 3000/994.3 = 3.02
The expansion ratio is calculated as follows:
V
4
/V
3
= (V
1
/V
2
)/(V
3
/V
2
) = 20/3.02 = 6.62
T
4
= T
3
(V
3
/V
4
)
1.4 1
= 3000/6.62
0.4
= 1409K
w = 1.005(3000 994.3) + (1.005/1.4)(300 1409) = 1219.6 kJ/kg
q
a
= 1.005(3000 994.3) = 2015.7 kJ/kg

th
= w/q
a
= 1219.6/2015.6 = 0.605, or 60.5%
_____________________________________________________________________
246
6.9 Comparing Otto-Cycle and Diesel-Cycle Efficiencies
A reasonable question at this point is: Which cycle is more efficient, the Otto cycle or
the Diesel cycle? Figure 6.10 assists in examining this question. In general notation,
the cycle efficiency may be written as

th
= w
net
/q
in
= w
net
/(w
net
+ |q
out
|)
= 1 /(1 + |q
out
| /w
net
) [dl] (6.19)

Comparing the Otto cycle 1234 and the Diesel cycle with the same compression
ratio 123'4, we see that both have the same heat rejection but that the Otto cycle
has the higher net work. Equation (6.19) then shows that, for the same compression
ratio, the Otto cycle has the higher efficiency.
It has been observed that Diesel-cycle efficiency decreases with increasing cutoff
ratio for a given compression ratio. Let us examine the limit of the Diesel-cycle
efficiency for constant CR as COR approaches its minimum value, 1. We may write
Equation (6.18) as

Diesel
= 1 1 /(kCR
k-1
) f (COR)
where f(COR) = (COR
k
1)/(COR 1). Applying L'Hospital's rule, with primes
247
designating differentiation with respect to COR, to the limit of f(COR) as COR $1,
yields
lim f(COR) = lim (COR
k
1)'/ Lim (COR 1)' = lim kCOR
k 1
= k
COR$1

COR$1 COR$1
and
lim
Diesel
= 1 1 /CR
k 1
=
Otto
COR$1
Thus the limit of the Diesel-cycle efficiency as COR approaches 1 is the Otto cycle
efficiency. Hence Equation (6.18) shows that the efficiency of the Diesel cycle must be
less than or equal to the Otto-cycle efficiency if both engines have the same
compression ratio, the same conclusion we reached by examination of the p-V diagram.
Suppose, however, that the compression ratios are not the same. Compare the Otto
cycle 12'3'4 with the Diesel cycle 123'4 having the same maximum temperature
in Figure 6.10. The Otto cycle has a smaller area, and therefore less work, than the
Diesel cycle, but the same heat rejection. Equation (6.19) demonstrates that the Otto
cycle has a lower thermal efficiency than the Diesel cycle with the same maximum
temperature.
The conclusion that must be drawn from the above comparisons is quite clear. As in
most comparative engineering studies, the result depends on the ground rules which
were adopted at the start of the study. The Otto cycle is more efficient if the
compression ratio is the same or greater than that of the competing Diesel cycle. But
knock in spark-ignition (Otto) engines limits their compression ratios to about 12,
while Diesel-engine compression ratios may exceed 20. Thus, with these higher
compression ratios, the Air Standard Diesel-cycle efficiency can exceed that of the Otto
cycle. In practice, Diesel engines tend to have higher efficiencies than SI engines
because of higher compression ratios.
6.10 Diesel-Engine Performance
In 1897, five years after Rudolph Diesel's first patents and twenty-one years after
Otto's introduction of the spark-ignition engine, Diesel's compression-ignition engine
was proven to develop 13.1 kilowatts of power with an unprecedented brake thermal
efficiency of 26.2% (ref. 7). At that time, most steam engines operated at thermal
efficiencies below 10 %; and the best gas engines did not perform much better than the
steam machines.
Diesel claimed (and was widely believed) to have developed his engine from the
principles expounded by Carnot. He had developed "the rational engine." Whether his
claims were exaggerated or not, Diesel's acclaim was well deserved. He had developed
an engine that operated at unprecedented temperatures and pressures, had proven his
concept of ignition of fuel by injection into the compressed high-temperature air, and
had overcome the formidable problems of injecting a variety of fuels in appropriate
248
amounts with the precise timing required for satisfactory combustion. His is a
fascinating story of a brilliant and dedicated engineer (refs. 7, 8).
In the Diesel engine, the high air temperatures and pressures prior to combustion
are attributable to the compression of air alone rather than an air-fuel mixture.
Compression of air alone eliminates the possibility of autiognition during compression
and makes high compression ratios possible. However, because of the high pressures
and temperatures, Diesel engines must be designed to be structurally more rugged.
Therefore, they tend to be heavier than SI engines with the same brake power.
The energy release process in the Diesel engine is controlled by the rate of injection
of fuel. After a brief ignition lag, the first fuel injected into the combustion chamber
autoignites and the resulting high gas temperature sustains the combustion of the
remainder of the fuel stream as it enters the combustion chamber. Thus it is evident that
the favorable fuel characteristic of high autoignition temperature for an SI engine is an
unfavorable characteristic for a Diesel engine.
In the Diesel engine, a low autoignition temperature and a short ignition delay are
desirable. Knock is possible in the Diesel engine, but it is due to an entirely different
cause than knock in a spark-ignition engine. If fuel is ignited and burns as rapidly as it
is injected, then smooth, knock-free combustion occurs. If, on the other hand, fuel
accumulates in the cylinder before ignition due to a long ignition lag, an explosion or
detonation occurs, producing a loud Diesel knock. The cetane number is the parameter
that identifies the ignition lag characteristic of a fuel.
The cetane number, like the octane number, is determined by testing in a CFR
engine. The ignition lag of the test fuel is compared with that of a mixture of n-cetane,
C
16
H
34
, and heptamethylnonane, HMN (ref. 10). Cetane, which has good ignition
qualities, is assigned a value of 100; and HMN, which has poor knock behavior, a value
of 15. The cetane number is then given by the sum of the percentage of n-cetane and
0.15 times the percentage of HMN in the knock-comparison mixture. A cetane number
of 40 is the minimum allowed for a Diesel fuel.
6.11 Superchargers and Turbochargers
The importance of the volumetric efficiency, representing the efficiency of induction
of the air-fuel mixture into the reciprocating-engine cylinders, was discussed earlier.
Clearly, the more mixture mass in the displacement volume, the more chemical energy
can be released and the more power will be delivered from that volume.
During the Second World War, the mechanical supercharger was sometimes used
with SI aircraft engines to increase the power and operational ceiling of American
airplanes. Today supercharging is used with both Diesel engines and SI engines. The
supercharger is a compressor that supplies air to the cylinder at high pressure so that
the gas density in the cylinder at the start of compression is well above the free-air
density. The piston exhaust gases are allowed to expand freely to the atmosphere
through the exhaust manifold and tailpipe. The supercharger is usually driven by a belt
or gear train from the engine crank shaft.
249
Figure 6.11 shows a modification of the theoretical Otto cycle to accommodate
mechanical supercharging. The supercharger supplies air to the engine cyclinders at
pressure p
7
in the intake process 7 $ 1. The processes 4 $ 5 $ 6 purge most of the
combustion gas from the cylinder. The most striking change in the cycle is that the
induction-exhaust loop is now traversed counterclockwise, indicating that the cylinder
is delivering net work during these processes as well as during the compression-
expansion loop. It should be remembered, however, that part of the cycle indicated
power must be used to drive the external supercharger.
The turbosupercharger or turbocharger, for short, is a supercharger driven by a
turbine using the exhaust gas of the reciprocating engine, as shown schematically in
Figure 6.12. A cutaway view of a turbocharger is shown in Figure 6.13(a). Figure
6.13(b) presents a diagram for the turbocharger. Compact turbochargers commonly
increase the brake power of an engine by 30% or more, as shown in Figure 6.8, where
the performance of an engine with and without turbocharging is compared. There, a
substantial increase in peak torque and flattening of the torque-speed curve due to
turbocharging is evident.
For a supercharged engine, the brake power, BP, is the indicated power (as in
Figure 6.11) less the engine friction power and the supercharger shaft power:
BP = DISP ( IMEP ( N P
m
FP [ft-lb
f
/min | kJ/s] (6.15)
250
where P
m
is the supercharger-shaft mechanical power supplied by the engine (0 for a
turbocharger). The IMEP includes the positive work contribution of the exhaust loop.
The exhaust back pressure of the reciprocating engine is higher with a turbocharger
than for a naturally aspirated or mechanically supercharged engine because of the drop
in exhaust gas pressure through the turbine. The engine brake power increases
primarily because of a higher IMEP due to the added mass of fuel and air in the
cylinder during combustion. Intercooling between the compressor and the intake
manifold may be used to further increase the cylinder charge density. Turbocharging
may increase engine efficiency, but its primary benefit is a substantial increase in brake
power.
In a turbocharged engine, a wastegate may be required to bypass engine exhaust
gas around the turbine at high engine speeds. This becomes necessary when the
compressor raises the intake manifold pressure to excessively high levels, causing
engine knock or threatening component damage. Thirty to forty percent of the exhaust
flow may be bypassed around the turbine at maximum speed and load (ref. 1).
251
252
6.12 The Automobile Engine and Air Pollution
Since the Second World War, concern for environmental pollution has grown from
acceptance of the status quo to recognition and militance of national and international
scope. Among other sources, causes of the well-known Los Angeles smog problem
were identified as hydrocarbons (HC) and oxides of nitrogen (NO
x
) in exhaust
emissions from motor vehicle reciprocating engines. As a result, national and
California automobile air pollution limits for automobiles have been established and
toughened. Prior to the Clean Air Act of 1990, the U.S. federal exhaust-gas emissions
standards limited unburned hydrocarbons, carbon monoxide, and oxides of nitrogen to
0.41, 3.4, and 1.0 g/mile, respectively. According to reference 12, today it takes 25
autos to emit as much CO and unburned hydrocarbons and 4 to emit as much NO
x
as a
single car in 1960. The reference anticipated that, led by existing California law and
other factors, future engine designs should be targeted toward satisfying a tailpipe
standard of 0.25, 3.4, 0.4 g/mile. Indeed, the 1990 Clean Air Act (refs. 15,16)
specified these limits for the first 50,000 miles or five years of operation for all
passenger cars manufactured after 1995. In addition to the regulations on gaseous
emissions, the Clean Air Act of 1990 adopted the California standard for particulate
matter of 0.08 g/mile for passenger cars. The standards on particulates are particularly
difficult for the Diesel engine, because of its of soot-producing tendency.
The automobile air pollution problem arises in part because the reactions in the
exhaust system are not in chemical equilibrium as the gas temperature drops. Oxides of
nitrogen, once formed in the cylinder at high temperature, do not return to equilibrium
concentrations of nitrogen and oxygen in the cooling exhaust products. Likewise, CO
formed with rich mixtures or by dissociation of CO
2
in the cylinder at high temperature
does not respond rapidly to an infusion of air as its temperature drops in the exhaust
system. Their concentrations may be thought of as constant or frozen. Unburned
hydrocarbons are produced not only by rich combustion but also by unburned mixture
lurking in crevices (such as between piston and cylinder above the top piston ring), by
lubricating oil on cylinder walls and the cylinder head that absorbs and desorbs
hydrocarbons before and after combustion, and by transient operating conditions.
Starting in 1963, positive crankcase ventilation was used in all new cars to duct
fuel-rich crankcase gas previously vented to the atmosphere back into the engine intake
system. Later in the 60s, various fixes were adopted to comply with regulation of
tailpipe unburned hydrocarbons and CO, including lowering compression ratios.
In 1973, NO
x
became federally regulated, and exhaust gas recirculation (EGR) was
employed to reduce NO
x
formation through reduced combustion temperatures. At the
same time, HC and CO standards were reduced further, leading to the use of the
oxidizing catalytic converter. Introduction of air pumped into the tailpipe provided
additional oxygen to assist in completion of the oxidation reactions. In 1981, a
reducing catalytic converter came into use to reduce NO
x
further. This device does not
perform well in an oxidizing atmosphere. As a result, two-stage catalytic converters
were applied, with the first stage reducing NO
x
in a near-stoichiometric mixture and the
253
second oxidizing the combustibles remaining in the exhaust with the help of air
introduced between the stages. This fresh air does not the increase NO
x
significantly,
because of the relatively low temperature of the exhaust. The three-way catalytic
converter using several exotic metal catalysts to reduce all three of the gaseous
pollutants was also introduced.
The use of catalytic converters to deal with all three pollutants brought about
significant simultaneous reductions in the three major gaseous pollutants from
automobiles. This allowed fuel-economy-reducing modifications that had been
introduced earlier to satisfy emission reduction demands to be eliminated or relaxed,
leading to further improvements in fuel economy.
Catalytic converters, however, require precise control of exhaust gas oxygen to
near-stoichiometric mixtures. The on-board computer has made possible control of
mixture ratio and spark timing in response to censor outputs of intake manifold
pressure, exhaust gas oxygen, engine speed, air flow, and incipient knock. The oxygen,
or lambda, censor located in the exhaust pipe upstream of the three-way converter
or between the two-stage converters is very sensitive to transition from rich to lean
exhaust and allows close computer control of the mixture ratio to ensure proper
operation of the catalytic converter. Computer control of carburetors or fuel injection
as well as other engine functions has allowed simultaneous improvement in fuel
economy and emissions in recent years. Thus, while emissions have been drastically
reduced since 1974, according to reference 11 the EPA composite fuel economy of the
average U.S. passenger car has nearly doubled; although this improvement has not
come from the engine alone. Despite the hard-won gains in emissions control and fuel
economy, further progress may be expected.
EXAMPLE 6.5
The 1990 NO
x
emissions standard is 0.4 grams per mile. For an automobile burning
stoichiometric octane with a fuel mileage of 30 mpg, what is the maximum tailpipe
concentration of NO
x
in parts per million? Assume that NO
x
is represented by NO
2
and
that the fuel density is 692 kilograms per cubic meter.
Solution
For the stoichiometric combustion of octane, C
8
H
18
, the air-fuel ratio is 15.05 and
the molecular weight of combustion products is 28.6. The consumption of octane is
m
f
= (692)(1000)(3.7910
-3
)/ 30 = 87.4 g/mile
[Note: (kg/m
3
)(g/kg)(m
3
/gal)/(mile/gal) = g/mile.] The concentration of NO
x
is the ratio
of the number of moles of NO
x
to moles of combustion gas products:
mole
Nox
/mole cg = (m
NOx
/m
f
)(m
f
/ m
cg
)(M
cg
/M
NOx
)
= (0.4/87.4)(28.6/46)/ (15.05 + 1) = 0.0001773
254
or 177.3 parts per million (ppm).
_____________________________________________________________________
Bibliography and References
1. Heywood, John B., Internal Combustion Engine Fundamentals. New York:
McGraw-Hill, 1988.
2. Ferguson, Colin R., Internal Combustion Engines. New York: Wiley, 1986.
3. Adler, U., et al., Automotive Handbook, 2nd ed. Warrendale, Pa.: Society of
Automotive Engineers., 1986.
4. Lichty, Lester C., Internal Combustion Engines. New York: McGraw Hill, 1951.
5. Crouse, William H., Automotive Engine Design. New York: McGraw-Hill, 1970.
6. Obert, Edward, Internal Combustion Engines, Analysis and Practice. Scranton,
Pa.: International Textbook Co., 1944.
7. Grosser, Morton, Diesel: The Man and the Engine. New York: Atheneum, 1978.
8. Nitske, W. Robert, and Wilson, Charles Morrow, Rudolph Diesel: Pioneer of the
Age of Power. Norman, Okla.: University of Oklahoma Press, 1965.
9. Demmler, Albert W. Jr., et al., 1989 Technical Highlights of Big-three U.S.
Manufacturers, Automotive Engineering. Vol. 96, No. 10, October 1988, p. 81.
10. Anon., Ignition Quality of Diesel Fuels by the Cetane Method, ASTM D 613-84,
1985 Annual Book of ASTM Standards, Section 5.
11. Amann, Charles A., The Automotive Spark Ignition Engine-A Historical
Perspective, American Society of Mechanical Engineers, ICE-Vol. 8, Book No.
100294, 1989.
12. Amann, Charles A., The Automotive Spark-Ignition Engine-A Future
Perspective, Society of Automotive Engineers Paper 891666, 1989.
13. Amann, Charles A., The Passenger Car and the Greenhouse Effect, Society of
Automotive Engineers Paper, 1990.
14. Taylor, Charles Fayette, The Internal Combustion Engine in Theory and Practice,
2
nd
ed., revised. Cambridge, Mass.: MIT Press, 1985.
255
15. Public Law 101-549, An Act to Amend the Clean Air Act to Provide for
Attainment and Maintenance of Health, Protection, National Air Quality Standards,
and Other Purposes, November 15, 1990.
16. Anon., ProvisionsClean Air Amendments, Congressional Quarterly, November
24, 1990.
EXERCISES
6.1 Plot dimensionless piston position against crank angle for S/2L = 0.5, 0.4, 0.3,
and 0.2.
6.2* Obtain expressions for the piston velocity and acceleration as a function of the
crank angle, constant angular velocity, and S/2L ratio. Use a spreadsheet to
calculate and plot velocity and acceleration against crank angle for S/2L = 0.5,
0.4, 0.3, and 0.2.
6.3 Determine the equation for the piston motion for a scotch yoke mechanism in
terms of crank angle. Obtain an equation for the piston velocity for a crank that
turns with a given angular velocity, 6.
6.4 Derive an equation for the Otto-engine net work by integration of pdV for the Air
Standard cycle. Compare with Equation (6.6).
6.5* Use a spreadsheet to calculate and plot cycle efficiency as a function of
compression ratio for the Diesel cycle for cutoff ratios of 1, 2, and 3. Indentify
the Otto-cycle efficiency on the plot. Explain and show graphically from the plot
how a Diesel engine can be more efficient than an Otto engine.
6.6 A single-cylinder Air Standard Otto engine has a compression ratio of 8.5 and a
peak temperature of 3500F at ambient conditions of 80F and one atmosphere.
Determine the cycle efficiency, maximum cylinder pressure, and mean effective
pressure.
6.7 A six-cylinder engine with a compression ratio of 11 runs at 2800 rpm at 80F
and 14.7 psia. Each cylinder has a bore and stroke of three inches and a
volumetric efficiency of 0.82. Assume an Air Standard, four-stroke Otto cycle
_______________________
* Exercise numbers with an asterisk indicate that they involve computer usage.
256
with stoichiometric octane as fuel. Assume that the energy release from the
fuel is equally divided between internal energy increase in cylinder gases and
cylinder wall heat loss. What are the cylinder mean effective pressures and the
engine horsepower and specific fuel consumption?
6.8 A single-cylinder four-stroke-cycle spark-ignition engine has a BSFC of 0.4
kg/kW-hr and a volumetric efficiency of 78% at a speed of 45 rps. The bore is 6
cm and the stroke is 8.5 cm. What is the fuel flow rate, fuel-air ratio, and brake
torque if the brake power output is 6 kW with ambient conditions of 100 kPa and
22C?
6.9 A single-cylinder four-stroke-cycle spark-ignition engine operating at 3500 rpm
has a brake mean effective pressure of 1800 kPa and a displacement of 400 cm
3
.
Atmospheric conditions are 101kPa and 27C.
(a) If the stroke is 6 cm, what is the bore?
(b) What is the brake power?
(c) If the mass air-fuel ratio is 16 and the fuel flow rate is 0.00065 kg/s, what
is the volumetric efficiency?
(d) Compare your results with the performance of a two-cylinder engine with
the same overall geometric characteristics.
6.10 A four-cylinder four-stroke-cycle spark-ignition engine operating at 3500 rpm has
a brake mean effective pressure of 80 psi and a displacement of 400 cm
3
.
Atmospheric conditions are one bar and 80F.
(a) If the stroke is 3 inches, what is the bore?
(b) What is the brake power?
(c) If the mass air-fuel ratio is 16 and the fuel flow rate is 0.00065 kg/s, what
is the volumetric efficiency?
6.11 A four-cylinder four-stroke-cycle spark-ignition engine with 200 cm
3
displacement and operating in air at 27C and 110 kPa has a friction power of 27
kW and a brake power output of 136 kW at 3600 rpm.
(a) What is the mechanical efficiency?
(b) If it has a volumetric efficiency of 74% and burns liquid methanol with
15% excess air, what is the brake specific fuel consumption?
6.12 An eight-cylinder four-stroke-cycle engine has a bore of three inches and a stroke
of 4 inches. At a shaft speed of 3000 rpm, the brake horsepower is 325 and the
mechanical efficiency is 88%. Fuel with a heating value of 19,000 Btu/lb
m
is
supplied at a rate of 80 lb
m
/hr. What are the engine displacement, BMEP, brake
257
torque, and indicated specific fuel consumption in lb
m
/HP-hr?
6.13 An eight-cylinder four-stroke-cycle engine has a bore of 10 cm and a stroke of 12
cm. At a shaft speed of 53 rps, the brake power is 300kW and the mechanical
efficiency is 85%. Fuel with a heating value of 40,000 kJ/kg is supplied at a rate
of 40 kg/hr. What are the engine displacement, BMEP, brake torque, and
indicated specific fuel consumption in kg/kW-hr?
6.14 Consider a naturally aspirated eight-cylinder four-stroke-cycle Diesel engine with
a compression ratio of 20 and cutoff ratio of 2.5. Air is inducted into the cylinder
from the atmosphere at 14.5 psia and 80F. Assume an Air Standard cycle.
(a) Determine the temperatures and pressures immediately before and after
combustion.
(b) What is the heat added in the combustion process, in Btu/lb
m
?
(c) What is the net work, in Btu/lb
m
, and the thermal efficiency?
(d) If the volumetric efficiency is 85%, the engine displacement is 300 in
3
, and the
engine speed is 2000 rpm, what is the mass flow rate of air through the engine in
lb
m
/min?
(e) What is the engine horsepower?
(f) Assuming that losses through the valves cause a 20-psi pressure differential
between the pressures during the exhaust and intake strokes, estimate the
actual and fractional losses, in horsepower, due to these processes. Sketch
the appropriate p-V diagram.
6.15 A two-cylinder four-stroke-cycle engine produces 30 brake horsepower at a brake
thermal efficiency of 20% at 2600 rpm. The fuel is methane burning in air with an
equivalence ratio of 0.8 and a heating value of 21,560 Btu/lb
m
. Ambient
conditions are 520R and 14.7 psia. The engine mechanical efficiency is 88%,
and the volumetric efficiency is 92%. What are the fuel flow rate, the
displacement volume per cylinder, and the brake specific fuel consumption? What
is the bore if the bore and stroke or equal?
6.16 Sketch carefully a single pV diagram showing Otto and Diesel cycles having the
same minimum and maximum temperatures. Shade the area representing the
difference in net work between the cycles. Repeat for cycles having the same
compression ratio. Discuss the implications of these sketches.
6.17 An eight-cylinder reciprocating engine has a 3-in. bore and a 4-in. stroke and
runs at 1000 cycles per minute. If the brake horsepower is 120 and the mechanical
efficiency is 80%, estimate the indicated mean effective pressure.
258
6.18 Consider a naturally aspirated eight-cylinder two-stroke-cycle Diesel engine with
a compression ratio of 20 and a cutoff ratio of 2.5. Air is inducted into the
cylinder at 1 atm and 23C. Assume an Air Standard cycle.
(a) Determine the temperatures and pressures immediately before and after
combustion.
(b) What is the heat added in the combustion process, in kJ/kg?
(c) What is the net work, in kJ/kg, and the thermal efficiency?
(d) If the volumetric efficiency is 85%, the engine displacement is 2500 cc, and
the engine speed is 2200 rpm, what is the mass flow rate of air through the
engine, in lb
m
per minute?
(e) What is the engine horsepower?
(f) If losses through the valves cause a 120-kPa pressure differential between the
pressures during the exhaust and intake strokes, estimate the actual and
fractional losses, in horsepower, due to these processes. Sketch the
appropriate pV diagram.
6.19 A twelve-cylinder four-stroke-cycle Diesel engine has a 4-in. bore, a 4.5-in.
stroke, and a compression ratio of 20. The mechanical efficiency is 89%, the
cutoff ratios is 2, and the engine speed is 1200 rpm. The air entering the cylinder
is at 14.5 psia and 60 F. Assuming Air Standard cycle performance, determine
the cycle temperatures, indicated power, IMEP, and engine brake horsepower.
6.20 A hypothetical engine cycle consists of an isentropic compression, a constant-
pressure heat addition, and a constant-volume blowdown, consecutively.
(a) Draw and label a pV diagram for the cycle.
(b) Use the cyclic integral of the First Law to derive an equation for the cycle net
work in terms of the temperature.
(c) Use the definition of mechanical work to derive an equation for the cycle net
work also. Show that your equation is equivalent to the result obtained in
part (b) using the cyclic integral.
(d) Express an equation for the cycle thermal efficiency in terms of cycle
temperature ratios and k.
(e) If T
1
= 60F and the volume ratio is 10, determine the other cycle
temperatures; and compare the cycle efficiency with the efficiency the Otto
cycle having the same compression ratio.
6.21 A slightly more complex model of a reciprocating engine cycle than those
discussed combines constant-pressure and constant-volume heat additions in a
single Air Standard cycle.
(a) Sketch and label a pV diagram for this cycle that consists of the following
259
consecutive processes: isentropic compression, constant-volume heat addition,
constant-pressure heat addition, isentropic expansion, and constant-volume
blowdown.
(b)The engine may be characterized by three parameters: the compression ratio;
the Diesel engine cutoff ratio; and a third parameter, the ratio of the pressure
after to that before the constant-volume combustion. Define these parameters in
terms of the symbols in your sketch and derive an equation for the thermal
efficiency of the cycle.
(c) Show how varying the parameters appropriately reduces your efficiency
equation to the equations for the Otto and Diesel cycles.
6.22 As a plant engineer you must recommend whether electric power for a plant
expansion (2.5 MW continuous generation requirement) will be purchased from a
public utility or generated using a fully attended Diesel-engine-driven generator or
an automatic remotely controlled gas turbine generator set. The price of
electricity is 4.8 cents per kW-hr, and the price of natural gas is 60 cents per
thousand cubic feet. Both Diesel engine and gas turbine are to be natural-gas
fired. The gas turbine has a heat rate of 11,500 Btu/kW-hr, and the Diesel engine
13,200 Btu/kW-hr. The initial costs of Diesel engine and gas turbine are
$750,000 and $850,000, respectively. Control equipment for the gas turbine
costs an additional $150,000. The engines and control equipment are estimated
to have a useful life of 20 years. The annual wages and benefits for a Diesel
engine operating engineer working eight-hour daily shifts is $36,000. Assume a
10% per annum interest-rate. Evaluate the alternatives for a natural gas heating
value of 1000 Btu/ft
3
, and present a table of their costs, in cents per kW-hr.
Discuss your recommendation.
6.23 Evaluate the alternatives in Exercise 6.22 based on the present-worth method.
6.24 In terms of the notation of Figure 6.3, what are the piston displacement,
compression ratio, and expansion ratio for the Lenoir cycle?
6.25 What are the fuel and air flow rates and brake specific fuel consumption for an
eight-cylinder engine with a 3.75-in. bore and 3.5-in. stroke delivering 212
horsepower at 3600 rpm with a brake thermal efficiency of 25%? The fuel is
C
8
H
18
, and the equivalence ratio is 1.2. What is the power per cubic inch of
engine displacement?
6.26* Construct a spreadsheet to perform an Air Standard cycle analysis for a Diesel
engine with a compression ratio of 20 and a range of peak temperatures from
1000K to 3000K, in 500 increments. Use it to tabulate and plot both the net work
per unit mass of air and the thermal efficiency against the cutoff ratio.
260
6.27 Determine the maximum tailpipe concentrations of the three federally regulated
gaseous pollutants based on the existing standards for an automobile that achieves
28 mile/gal of iso-octane. Assume that the engine mixture equivalence ratio is
0.9, that NO
x
is represented by NO
2
and unburned hydrocarbons by monatomic
carbon, and that the fuel density is 700 kg/m
3
.
6.28 A single-cylinder Air Standard Otto engine has a compression ratio of 9.0 and a
peak temperature of 3000F at 80F and one atmosphere ambient conditions.
Determine the net work, cycle efficiency, maximum cylinder pressure, and mean
effective pressure.
6.29 A six-cylinder engine with a compression ratio of 11 runs at 3200 rpm and 80F
and 14.7 psia. Each cylinder has a bore of 3 inches, a stroke of 3.25 inches, and a
volumetric efficiency of 0.85. Assume an Air Standard four-stroke Otto cycle
with stoichiometric octane as fuel. Assume that the energy release from the fuel
is equally divided between internal energy increase in cylinder gases and cylinder
wall heat loss. What are the cylinder mean effective pressures and the engine
horsepower and specific fuel consumption? Assume a heating value of 20,600
Btu/lb
m
.
6.30 An eight-cylinder four-stroke-cycle compression-ignition engine operates with a
fuel-air ratio of 0.03 at 2400 rpm. It has a turbocharger and intercooler, as
diagrammed nearby, with compressor pressure ratio of 1.7 and intercooler exit
temperature of 320K. The engine bore and stroke are 10 cm and 12 cm,
respectively. The compressor efficiency, turbine efficiency, and volumetric
efficiency are 70%, 75%, and 87%, respectively. The entrance temperature of the
turbine gases is 1000K. What are the compressor power, the turbine pressure
ratio, and the engine power, in kW and in horsepower? Assume that the engine is
constructed of ceramic components that minimize engine heat losses so that they
may be neglectedand ideal adiabatic engine.
261
261
C H A P T E R 7
THE WANKEL
ROTARY ENGINE
7.1 A Different Approach to the Spark-Ignition Engine
The reciprocating internal combustion engine has served mankind for over a century,
and will continue to do so for the foreseeable future. The Wankel rotary engine, a
much more recent development, is said to have been conceived in its present form in
1954 (ref. 2). An implementation of the rotary engine used in the 1990 Mazda RX-7
automobile and its turbocharger are shown in Figures 7.1(a) and 7.1(b). As of 1987,
over 1.5 million Wankel engines had been used in Mazda automobiles (ref. 6).
The rotary engine has a host of advantages that make it a formidable contender for
some of the tasks currently performed by reciprocating engines. The piston in a four-
stroke-cycle reciprocating engine must momentarily come to rest four times per cycle
as its direction of motion changes. In contrast, the moving parts in a rotary engine are
in continuous unidirectional motion. Higher operating speeds, ease of balancing, and
absence of vibration are a few of the benefits. The high operating speeds allow the
engine to produce twice as much power as a reciprocating engine of the same weight. It
has significantly fewer parts and occupies less volume than a reciprocating engine of
comparable power.
With all these advantages, why are there so few Wankel engines in service? Part of
the answer lies in the reciprocating engines remarkable success in so many applications
and its continuing improvement with research. Why change a good thing?
Manufacturing techniques for reciprocating engines are well known and established,
whereas production of rotary engines requires significantly different tooling.
It must be admitted, however, that the rotary engine has some drawbacks. A major
problem of the Wankel automobile engine is that it does not quite measure up to the
fuel economy of some automotive reciprocating SI engines. It is the judgment of some
authorities that it does not offer as great a potential for improvement in fuel economy
and emissions reduction as reciprocating and gas turbine engines. However, although
the rotary engine may never dominate the automotive industry, it is likely to find
applications where low weight and volume are critical, such as in sports cars, general
aviation, and motorcycles.
262
While the rotary engine may not enjoy the great success of reciprocating engines, it
is worthy of study as an unusual and analytically interesting implementation of the
familiar Otto cycle. Even the present success of this latter-day Otto engine should serve
as an inspiration to those who search for novel ways of doing things. This chapter is a
tribute to Felix Wankel and those who are helping to develop this remarkable engine.
7.2 Rotary Engine Operation
Figure 7.2 shows a cross-section of a rotary engine. The stationary housing encloses a
moving triangular rotor that rotates with its apexes in constant contact with the housing
inner surface. Air and combustion gases are transported in the spaces between the
rotor and the housing. The rotor rides on an eccentric that is an integral part of a shaft,
as shown in the dual rotor crank shaft of Figure 7.3(a). The housing and rotor of a
rotary engine designed for aircraft application are shown in Figure 7.3(b).
The operation of the Wankel engine as an Otto-cycle engine may be understood by
following in Figure 7.4 the events associated with the counterclockwise movement of a
gas volume isolated between the housing and one of the rotor flanks. The air-fuel
mixture may be supplied, by a conventional carburetor, through the intake port labeled
I in Figure 7.4(a). As the shaft and rotor turn, the intake port is covered, trapping a
fixed mass of air and fuel (assuming no leakage). This is analogous to the gas mass
captured within the cylinder-piston volume by closure of a reciprocating engine intake
valve. As the rotor continues to turn, the captured (crosshatched) volume contained
263
between the rotor and housing decreases, compressing the air-fuel mixture [part (b)].
When it reaches the minor diameter, the active mixture volume is a minimum
corresponding to the volume at top center in the reciprocating engine. One or more
spark plugs, as indicated at the top of each housing, initiate combustion, causing rapid
rises in pressure and temperature [part (c)]. The hot, high-pressure combustion gas
[part (d)] transmits a force to the eccentric through the rotor. Note that, during the
264
265
power phase, the line of action of the force F provides a counterclockwise torque
acting about the shaft axis. As the rotation proceeds, the expanding gases drive the
rotor until the exhaust port is exposed, releasing them [part (e)]. The exhaust process
continues as the intake port opens to begin a new cycle. This port overlap is apparent
in the lower volume shown in part (b). In summary, each flank of the rotor is seen to
undergo the same intake, compression, ignition, power, and exhaust processes as in a
four-stroke-cycle reciprocating Otto engine.
All three flanks of the rotor execute the same processes at equally spaced intervals
during one rotor rotation. Hence three power pulses are delivered per rotation of the
rotor. Because there are three shaft rotations per rotor rotation, the Wankel engine has
one power pulse per shaft rotation. Thus it has twice as many power pulses as a single-
cylinder four-stroke-cycle reciprocating engine operating at the same speed, a clear
advantage in smoothness of operation. This feature of one power pulse per shaft
rotation causes many people to compare the Wankel engine with the two-stroke-cycle
reciprocating engine.
7.3 Rotary Engine Geometry
The major elements of the rotary enginethe housing and the rotor are shown in
cross-section in Figure 7.2. The housing inner surface has a mathematical form known
as a trochoid or epitrochoid. A single-rotor engine housing may be thought of as two
parallel planes separated by a cylinder of epitrochoidal cross-section. Following the
notation of Figure 7.5, the parametric form of the epitrochoid is given by
x = e cos 3 + Rcos [ft | m] (7.1a)
y = e sin 3 + R sin [ft | m] (7.1b)
where e is the eccentricity and R is the rotor center-to-tip distance. For given values of
e and R, Equations (7.1) give the x and y coordinates defining the housing shape when
is varied from 0 to 360 degrees.
The rotor shape may be thought of as an equilateral triangle, as shown in Figures
7.2 and 7.4 (flank rounding and other refinements are discussed later in the chapter).
Because the rotor moves inside the housing in such a way that its three apexes are in
constant contact with the housing periphery, the positions of the tips are also given by
equations of the form of Equations (7.1):
x = e cos 3 + R cos( + 2n*/3) [ft | m] (7.2a)
y = e sin 3 + R sin( + 2n*) [ft | m] (7.2b)
where n = 0, 1, or 2, the three values identifying the positions of the three rotor tips,
each separated by 120. Because R represents the rotor center-to-tip distance, the
266
motion of the center of the rotor can be obtained from Equations (7.2) by setting R = 0.
The equations and Figure 7.5 indicate that the path of the rotor center is a circle of
radius e.
Note that Equations (7.1) and (7.2) can be nondimensionalized by dividing through
by R. This yields a single geometric parameter governing the equations, e/R, known as
the eccentricity ratio. It will be seen that this parameter is critical to successful
performance of the rotary engine.
The power from the engine is delivered to an external load by a cylindrical shaft.
The shaft axis coincides with the axis of the housing, as seen in Figure 7.2. A second
circular cylinder, the eccentric, is rigidly attached to the shaft and is offset from the
shaft axis by a distance, e, the eccentricity. The rotor slides on the eccentric. Note that
the axes of the rotor and the eccentric coincide. Gas forces exerted on the rotor are
transmitted to the eccentric to provide the driving torque to the engine shaft and to the
external load.
The motion of the rotor may now be understood in terms of the notation of Figure
7.5. The line labeled e rotates with the shaft and eccentric through an angle 3, while
the line labeled R is fixed to the rotor and turns with it through an angle about the
moving eccentric center. Thus the entire engine motion is related to the motion of these
two lines. Clearly, the rotor (and thus line R) rotates at one-third of the speed of the
shaft, and there are three shaft rotations for each rotor revolution.
267
EXAMPLE 7.1
Derive expressions for the major (largest) and minor (smallest) diameters of an
epitrochoid in terms the notation of Figure 7.5.
Solution
The major diameter is defined by adding the lengths of the lines representing the
eccentricity and the rotor radius when they are horizontal and colinear or by using
Equation 7.1(a). Thus the major diameter at y = 0 corresponds to = 0 and 180, for
which x = e + R and x = e R, respectively. The distance between these x coordinates
is the length of the major diameter 2(e + R).
The minor diameter is similarly defined along x = 0, but with e and R lines
oppositely directed. The two cases correspond to = 90 and 270. For = 90, the e
line is directed downward and the R line upward in Figure 7.5. This yields y = R e
and, by symmetry, the minor diameter is 2(R e). Hence
Major diameter = 2(R + e)
Minor diameter = 2(R e)
_____________________________________________________________________
7.4 A Simple Model for a Rotary Engine
Additional important features of the rotary engine can be easily studied by considering
an engine with an equilateral triangular rotor. Figure 7.6 shows the rotor in the position
where a rotor flank defines the minimum volume. We will call this position top center,
TC, by analogy to the reciprocating engine. The rotor housing clearance parameter, d,
is the difference between the housing minor radius, R e, and the distance from the
housing axis to mid-flank, e + R cos 60 = e + R/2:
d = (R e) (e + R/2) = R/2 2e [ft | m] (7.3)
Setting the clearance to zero establishes an upper limiting value for the eccentricity
ratio: (e/R)
crit
= 1/4. Study of Equations (7.1), at the other extreme, shows that, for e/R
= 0, the epitrochoid degenerates to a circle. In this case the rotor would spin with no
eccentricity and thus produce no compression and no torque. Thus, for the flat-flanked
rotor, it is clear that usable values of e/R lie between 0 and 0.25.
Now let's examine some other fundamental parameters of the flat-flanked engine
model. Consider the maximum mixture volume shown in Figure 7.7. For a given rotor
width w, the maximum volume can be determined by calculating the area between the
housing and the flank of the rotor. Using Equations (7.1), the differential area 2y dx can
be written as:
268
269
dA
max
= 2y dx
= 2(e sin3 + R sin) d(e cos3 + R cos) [ft
2
| m
2
] (7.4)
Dividing by R
2
and differentiating on the right-hand side, we obtain an equation for
the dimensionless area in terms of the eccentricity ratio and the angle :
A
max
/R
2
= 2 [(e/R)sin3 + sin][3(e/R)sin3 + sin]d [dl] (7.5)

In order for the differential area to sweep over the maximum trapped volume in
Figure 7.7, the limits on the angle must vary from 0 to 60. Thus integration of
Equation (7.5) with these limits and using standard integrals yields
A
max
/R
2
= * [(e/R)
2
+ 1/3] 3
1/2
/4[1 6(e/R)] [dl] (7.6)
Similarly, using Figure 7.6 and the differential volume shown there, the nondimension-
alized minimum area can be written as:
A
min
/R
2
= * [(e/R)
2
+ 1/3] 3
1/2
/4 [1 + 6(e/R)] [dl] (7.7)
These maximum and minimum volumes (area-rotor width products) are analogous
to the volumes trapped between the piston and cylinder at BC and TC in the
four-stroke reciprocating engine. In that engine the difference between the volumes at
BC and TC is the displacement volume, and their ratio is the compression ratio. A little
thought should convince the reader that the analogy holds quantitatively for the
displacement and compression ratio of the rotary engine. Therefore, subtracting
Equation (7.7) from Equation (7.6) gives the displacement for a rotor width w for one
flank of the flat-flanked engine as
disp = 3 (3
1/2
wR
2
(e/R) [ft
3
| m
3
] (7.8)
and forming their ratio yields the compression ratio as
A
max
/R
2
* [(e/R)
2
+ 1/3] 3
1/2
/4[1 6(e/R)]
CR = --------- = ------------------------------------------- [dl] (7.9)
A
min
/R
2
* [(e/R)
2
+ 1/3] 3
1/2
/4 [1 + 6(e/R)]
Thus the displacement increases with increases in rotor width, the square of the
rotor radius, and with the eccentricity ratio, whereas the compression ratio is
independent of size but increases with increase in eccentricity ratio.
270
EXAMPLE 7.2
What are the displacement and the compression ratio for a flat-flanked rotary engine
with a rotor radius of 10 cm, an eccentricity of 1.5 cm, and a rotor width of 2.5 cm?
Solution
For this engine, e/R = 1.5/10 = 0.15. Equation (7.8) then yields the displacement:
3(3)
0.5
(0.15)(10)
2
(2.5) = 194.9 cm
3
or (194.9)(0.0610) = 11.89 in.
3
Equation (7.9) can be written as
CR = (a + b)/(a b)
where a = (3.14159)[(0.15)
2
+ 1/3] 3
1/2
/4 = 0.6849, and b = 3( 3
1/2
(0.15)/2 = 0.3897.
Then
CR = (0.6849 + 0.3897)/(0.6849 - 0.3897) = 3.64
_____________________________________________________________________
The very low compression ratio of Example 7.2 would yield a poor Otto-cycle
thermal efficiency. The compression ratio could be increased by increasing e/R, but it
would still be low for most applications. It is therefore important to consider the
favorable influence of flank rounding on rotary engine performance.
7.5 The Circular-Arc-Flank Model
While the triangular rotor model represents a possible engine and is useful as a learning
tool, such an engine would perform poorly compared with one having a rotor with
rounded flanks. A more realistic model is one in which the triangular rotor is
augmented with circular-arc flanks, as shown in Figure 7.8. The radius of curvature, r,
of a flank could vary from infinity, corresponding to a flat flank, to a value for which
the arc touches the minor axis of the epitrochoid. Note that the center of curvature of
an arc terminated by two flank apexes depends on the value of r. It can also be seen
from Figure 7.8 that r is related to the angle, , subtended by the flank arc by
r sin(/2) = R sin(*/3) = 3
1/2
R/2 [ft | m]
or
r/R = 3
1/2
/[2sin(/2)] [dl] (7.10)
Thus either the included angle, , or the radius of curvature, r, may be used to define
the degree of flank rounding for a given rotor radius R.
271
Clearance with Flank Rounding
The additional area obtained by capping a side of a triangle with a circular arc is called
a segment. The segment height, h, shown in Figure 7.8, is the difference between r and
the projection of r on the axis of symmetry:
h/R = (r/R)[1 cos( /2)] [dl] (7.11)
Substitution of Equation (7.10) in Equation (7.11) yields
h/R = 3
1/2
[1 cos( /2)] / [2sin( /2)] [dl] (7.12)
It is evident from the figure that the clearance for the rotor with circular arc flanks is
the difference between the clearance of the flat-flanked rotor and h. Thus, using
Equation (7.3), the clearance is given by
d/R = 1/2 2(e/R) 3
1/2
[1 cos( /2)] / [2sin( /2)] [dl] (7.13)
In a real engine, of course, the clearance must be non-negative.
272
Added Volume per Flank Due to Rounding
The segment area is the difference between the pie-shaped area of the sector subtended
by its included angle, , and the enclosed triangular area. The sector area, or volume
per unit rotor width, is the fraction of the area of a circle of radius, r, subtended by the
angle ; i.e., * r
2
( /2* ) = r
2
/2. Thus using Equation (7.10), the dimensionless
segment volume is
A
s
/R
2
= (A
sec
A
tri
) /R
2
= (r/R)
2
( sin ) /2
= (3/8)( sin ) /sin
2
/2 [dl] (7.14)
Displacement and Compression Ratio
It was pointed out earlier that the displacement of the flat-flanked engine is the differ-
ence between the maximum and minimum capture volumes, and is given by Equation
(7.8). This is true also for the engine with rounded flanks. The additional volume added
to the rotor by flank rounding subtracts from both of the flat-flanked maximum and
minimum capture volumes, leaving the difference unchanged. Thus the displacement of
one flank of a rounded-flank engine is
disp = 3 (3
1/2
wR
2
(e/R) [ft
3
| m
3
] (7.15)
Likewise, the ratio of the maximum and minimum capture volumes given by
Equations (7.6) and (7.7), corrected for the segment volume from Equation (7.14)
provides a relation for the rounded-flank engine compression ratio:
* [(e/R)
2
+ 1/3] 3
1/2
/4 [1 6(e/R)] A
s
/R
2
CR = ----------------------------------------------------- [dl] (7.16)
* [(e/R)
2
+ 1/3] 3
1/2
/4 [1 + 6(e/R)] A
s
/R
2
The added rotor volume due to rounding subtracts from the flat-flanked capture
volumes and therefore reduces the denominator of Equation (7.16) more than the
numerator. As a result, the compression ratio is greater for rounded-flank than for flat-
flanked engines. Rotary engines usually have the maximum rounding possible consistent
with adequate engineering clearances.
Effect of the Recess Volume
Equation (7.16) accounts for flank rounding but not for the recess usually found in
rotor flanks. The additional capture volume associated with the recess is seen in Figure
7.9. Its influence on the displacement and compression ratio may be reasoned in the
273
same way as with the segment volume. The recess increases both minimum and
maximum mixture volumes by the same amount. It therefore has no effect on
displacement and it decreases the compression ratio.
Figure 7.10 shows the influence of flank rounding and recession on clearance and
compression ratio. While flank recession reduces the compression ratio for given values
of and e/R, it improves the shape of the long, narrow combustion pocket forming the
minimum capture volume. Rotary engines usually have more than one spark plug, to
help overcome the combustion problems associated with this elongated shape.
EXAMPLE 7.3
Rework Example 7.2, taking into account a flank-arc included angle of 0.65 radians.
What is the flank clearance for this engine?
Solution
Because flank rounding does not influence it, the displacement is still 194.9 cm
3
.
Equation (7.16) rewritten using the notation of Example 7.2 becomes
274
CR = (a + b A
s
/R
2
) / (a b A
s
/R
2
)
where A
s
/R
2
= (3/8)[0.65 sin(0.65)]/sin
2
(0.65/2) = 0.1648. Then the compression
ratio is
CR = [0.6849 + 0.3897 0.1648] / [0.6849 0.3897 0.1648] = 6.98
This represents a significant improvement over the value of 3.64 for the flat-flanked
rotor.
The flank clearance is given by Equation (7.13):
d = 10{0.5 2(0.15) 3
1/2
[1 cos(0.65/2)]} / [2sin(0.65/2)] = 0.58 cm.
_____________________________________________________________________
We have already noted that the displacement volume associated with one flank of
the rotary engine produces one power stroke during each rotor revolution and during
three shaft rotations. Because there are three flanks per rotor, a rotor executes one
complete thermodynamic cycle per shaft rotation. Thus the power produced by a single
rotor is determined by the displacement volume of a single flank and the rotational
speed:
(disp [cm
3
/Rev])(MEP [kN/cm
2
])(N [Rev/min])
Power = ------------------------------------------------------- [kW]
(60 [sec/min])(100 [cm/m])
or
(disp [in
3
/Rev])(MEP [lb/in
2
])(N [Rev/min])
Power = --------------------------------------------------- [HP]
(12 [in/ft])(33,000 [ft-lb/HP-min])
7.6 Design and Performance of the Wankel Engine
It is evident from Figure 7.4 that, in the Wankel engine, the opening and closing of the
intake and exhaust ports by the motion of the rotor apexes serves a function equivalent
to that of mechanical valves in reciprocating engines. This simple operation in the
Wankel engine eliminates the need for many of the moving parts required by the
reciprocating engine, such as cams, camshafts, tappets, valves, and lifters. There are, in
fact, many more parts in a reciprocating engine than in a comparable rotary engine.
However, sealing at the apexes and sides of the rotor is critical for efficient
operation of the rotary engine. Significant pressure differences between the three active
mixture volumes of a rotor in different phases of the Otto cycle require efficient seals
275
analogous to piston rings in the reciprocating engine. These are needed to avoid
leakage between adjacent volumes, which causes a loss of compression and power. Seal
friction has been estimated to account for about 25% of rotary engine friction. Spring
loaded, self-lubricating apex seals, as shown in Figure 7.11, allow for sliding with low
friction over the treated-chrome-alloy-plated housing inner surface.
The figure shows improvements in apex seal design (ref. 6). The three-piece seal
design, with two leaf springs rather than one, decreases seal mass through reduced
thickness, and offers a configuration that promotes area contact rather than line contact
between seal and rotor. Side seals are also important to maintain pressure integrity of
each flank mixture pocket. Reductions in the thickness of both apex and side seals have
decreased friction with the housing by reducing the seal area producing the friction-
276
causing normal force on the housing. Oil seals, also on the rotor sides, are used to
control oil consumption.
Though the peripheral intake port shown in Figures 7.4 and 7.9 provides better
performance under heavy loads than a single side port, its associated intake-exhaust
port overlap may allow excessive flow of exhaust gas into the fresh mixture, causing
unreliable combustion in low-speed operation. Consequently, one or more side intake
ports, in addition to or instead of a peripheral intake port, are sometimes used. Side
ports, of course, are also opened and closed by rotor motion. In addition to reducing
intake-exhaust overlap at light loads, side intake ports also induce combustion-
enhancing swirl in the air-fuel mixture.
It is evident that the moving combustion volume at the time of ignition has a long
and narrow flame propagation path. Rounded rotor flanks are usually recessed to
provide a wider flame front path between the two lobes of the active volume. In high-
speed operation, the brief time for combustion may dictate additional design features.
Multiple spark plugs, swirl induced by side intake ports and multiple ports, the "squish"
produced by the the relative motion of the walls of the active volume, fuel injection,
and stratified-charge design all can contribute to improvement of the combustion
process.
It may be noted in Figures 7.3 and 7.9 that an internal ring gear is attached to the
rotor. This gear meshes with a stationary gear attached to the engine housing. The
function of this gearset is to position the rotor as the shaft turnsnot to transmit
torque. Engine torque, as indicated earlier, is transmitted by direct contact of surface
forces between the rotor and the eccentric.
Stratified-Charge Rotary Engine
Reference 7 discusses the design and performance of stratified-charge rotary engines
developed for commercial aviation propulsion and APU (auxiliary power unit)
application as well as for marine, industrial, and military requirements. Figure 7.12
shows a direct fuel injection configuration that has performed well under a wide range
of speed, load, and environmental conditions and with a variety of liquid fuels. The
reference reports a lack of octane and cetane sensitivities, so that diesel, gasoline, and
jet fuel can all be used with this configuration.
As air in the rotor recess passes below, the spark plug ignites a locally rich pilot
stream that in turn ignites the fuel from the main injector. The net fuel-air ratio is lean,
resulting in improved fuel economy over normal carburetion. Figure 7.13 presents data
for full-load brake horsepower and specific fuel consumption obtained with Jet-A fuel
for the twin-rotor 2034R engine. The maximum takeoff power at 5800 rpm was 430
horsepower, with a brake specific fuel consumption (BSFC) of 0.44 lb
m
/BHP-hr.
Throughout a range of loads and altitude conditions the engine operates with a fuel-air
ratio between 0.035 and 0.037, well below the stoichiometric value. The reference
reports a best thermal efficiency of 35.8% (BSFC = 0.387 lb
m
/BHP-hr) at 3500 rpm
and 225-horsepower output.
277
278
Closure
Continued engineering research on the rotary engine has resulted in performance
improvements through improved seals, lean-burn combustion, fuel injection, integral
electronic control, improved intake design, weight reduction, and turbocharging.
Despite vehicle weight increases, the Mazda RX-7 with a two-rotor 80-in
.3
-displace-
ment engine improved 9.4% in fuel consumption and 8% in power output between
1984 and 1987 (ref. 6). During this time period, the addition to the engine of a
turbocharger with intercooling increased its power output by 35%.
Reference 8 reports that the Mazda RX-Evolv, a year-2000 concept car, has a
naturally-aspirated rotary engine called RENESIS. The two-rotor, side intake and
exhaust engine is reported to have reduced emissions and improved fuel economy and
to have attained 280 horsepower at 9000 rpm and 226 N-m torque at 8000 rpm.
EXAMPLE 7.4
If the BMEP of the 11.89-in
3
-diplacement engine in Example 7.2 is 150 psi at 4000
rpm, what is the brake horsepower?
Solution
The brake horsepower is
BHP = (150)(4000)(11.89)/(12)(33000) = 18 horsepower
or
BHP = (18)(0.746) =13.44kW
_____________________________________________________________________

Bibliography and References
1. Cole, David E. "The Wankel Engine," Scientific American, Vol. 227, No. 2, (August
1972): 1423.
2. Ansdale, R. F., The Wankel R C Engine. South Brunswick, N.J.: A. S. Barnes, 1969.
3. Yamamoto, Kenichi, Rotary Engine, Tokyo: Sankaido Co., 1981.
4. Weston, Kenneth C. "Computer Simulation of a Wankel Rotary EngineAnalysis
and Graphics." Proceedings of the Conference of the Society for Computer Simulation,
July 1986, pp. 213-216.
5. Weston, Kenneth C., "Computerized Instruction in the Design of the Wankel Rotary
Engine." ASEE Annual Conference Proceedings, June 1988.
279
6. Fujimoto, Y. et al., "Present and Prospective Technologies of Rotary Engine."
Society of Automotive Engineers Paper 870446, 1987.
7. Mount, Robert E., and LaBouff, Gary A., Advanced Stratified-Charge Rotary
Engine Design. Society of Automotive Engineers Paper 890324 (also in SAE SP-768,
Rotary Engine Design; Analysis and Developments), 1989.
8. Jost, Kevin, (ed.), Global ConceptsMazda RXEvolv, Automotive Engineering
International, Vol 8, No.8, (August 2000), p 59.
EXERCISES
7.1 Using graph paper, plot, on a single sheet, epitrochoids for e/R = 0, 0.15, 0.2, 0.25,
0.3, and 0.4. On a separate sheet, draw the epitrochiod and the triangular rotor for
three rotor positions (separated by 30) for the case of e/R = 0.15.
7.2 Verify the results of Example 7.1 by specializing Equations (7.1) for the appropriate
values of .
7.3 Derive Equation (7.5) using a differential area given by (x x
f
) dy, where x
f
is the
constant x-coordinate of the flank.
7.4 Following the approach in the derivation of Equations (7.3)(7.6), and using the
notation of Figure 7.6, derive Equation (7.7).
7.5 Derive Equation (7.7) using a differential area (y y
f
) dx, where y
f
is the constant
y-coordinate of the flank.
7.6 Derive Equation (7.8).
7.7 Derive Equation (7.9).
7.8 Show that the radius of curvature for a circular-arc flank that touches the
epitrochoid at its midpoint is given by
r/R = 1 e/R + 3(e/R)/(1 4e/R)
7.9 Use Equation (7.13) to derive an expression for the limiting value of e/R as a
function of the flank included angle. Plot the limiting value of e/R as a function of
the included angle.

7.10 Solve Example 7.3, accounting for a rotor flank recess of 3% of R
2
w.
280
7.11 If combustion takes place in an engine rotor rotation interval of 40 in an engine
operating at 8000 rpm, how much time is available for the combustion process?
7.12* Develop a single-column spreadsheet that determines the compression ratio,
clearance ratio, and nondimensional displacement for a given value of e/R and
flank-rounding angle. Use a copy command to replicate the column, forming a table
of alternative design characteristics, for a reasonable range of rounding angles.
7.13* Use the spreadsheet graphics option to develop plots of compression ratio and
clearance ratio, as seen in Figure 7.10.

7.14 A snowmobile single-rotor Wankel engine developed 6.65 brake horsepower at
5500 rpm with a displacement volume of 108 cc and a compression ratio of 8.5.
The fuel consumption was 2.77 lb
m
/hr. Determine the BMEP (in psi), the BSFC
(in lb
m
/hp-min), the brake torque (in lb
f
-ft), and the brake thermal efficiency,
assuming a fuel heating value of 18,900 Btu/lb
m
.
7.15 A rotary engine mounted on a dynamometer develops 23 lb
f
-ft of torque at 5000
rpm. When driven by a motor-generator at the same speed, a torque of 7 lb
f
-ft is
required. Determine the brake and indicated horsepower and the engine
mechanical efficiency. What additional information is needed to determine the
indicated mean effective pressure?
7.16 A rotary engine has an eccentricity of 2 in. and an equilateral triangular rotor with
a tip radius of 10 in.
(a) Determine the major and minor diameters of the epitrochoidal housing.
(b) Sketch the housing and its axes of symmetry and the rotor when it is in
the nominal spark-plug firing position.
(c) For the configuaration of part (b), determine the minimum rotor
clearance.
(d) Write equations for the relations between the shaft speed (rpm), the spark
plug firing rate (FR), and the rotor speed (RS). Identify any new symbols
used.
7.17 A rotary engine has an eccentricity of 3 cm and an equilateral triangular rotor
with a tip radius of 13 cm.
(a) Determine the major and minor diameters of the epitrochoidal housing.
(b) Sketch the housing and its axes of symmetry and the rotor when it is in
the nominal spark-plug firing position.
(c) For the configuaration of part (b), determine the minimum rotor
clearance.
281
(d) Write equations for the relations between the shaft speed (rpm), the spark
plug firing rate (FR), and the rotor speed (RS). Identify any new symbols
used.
7.18 A rotary engine with a flat-flanked rotor has a ratio of maximum to minimum
housing inside diameters of 1.4. What is the engine compression ratio?
7.19 The major diameter of the epitrochoidal housing of a flat-flanked single-rotor
industrial rotary engine is 39.6 inches. The engine turns at 1000 rpm while
delivering 500 brake horsepower at a BMEP of 79.2 psi. If the eccentricity ratio
is 0.14, what are the minor diameter, the rotor thickness, and the rotor
displacement, [in
.3
]?
7.20 A flat-flanked dual-rotor industrial rotary engine has a 60-cm minor diameter.The
engine delivers 800kW from an IMEP of 700kPa at a shaft speed of 20 rps. The
mechanical efficiency is 89%, and the eccentricity ratio is 0.16. Determine the
major diameter and the thickness and displacement of each rotor.
7.21 A Wankel rotary engine has an eccentricity of 2.2 in. and a major diameter of 28
in. It has a compression ratio of 9.5 and a 600 in
.3
displacement. Determine the
rotor width and the rotor sector included angle if the rotor flanks are circular and
have no indentations.
7.22 A Wankel rotary engine has an eccentricity of 2.5 cm and a major diameter of 32
cm. The engine compression ratio is 9.0, and the displacement is 540 cm
3
. What
are the eccentricity ratio, the rotor width, and the rotor sector included angle if
the rotor flanks are circular and have no indentations?

282
C H A P T E R 8
REFRIGERATION AND AIR CONDITIONING
8.1 Introduction
Up to this point we have considered fossil-fueled heat engines that are currently in use. These
devices have provided society's answers to the thermodynamic question: How can the chemical
energy of fossil fuels be converted into mechanical work and motive power? Let us now turn our
attention to the another great thermodynamic question: How can thermal energy be transferred
from cold to warmer regions?
The well-known Clausius statement of the Second Law of Thermodynamics asserts: It is
impossible to construct a device that, operating in a cycle, has no effect other than the transfer
of heat from a cooler to a hotter body. Thus the Clausius statement tells us that energy (heat) will
not flow from cold to hot regions without outside assistance. The devices that provide this help
are called refrigeration units and heat pumps. Both types of devices satisfy the Clausius
requirement of external action through the application of mechanical power or natural transfers of
heat (more on this later).
The distinction between refrigerator and heat pump is one of purpose more than technique.
The refrigeration unit transfers energy (heat) from cold to hot regions for the purpose of cooling
the cold region while the heat pump does the same thing with the intent of heating the hot region.
The following will focus on refrigeration and make the distinction between refrigeration and heat
pumps only when it is essential to the discussion.
It should be pointed out that any heat engine cycle, when reversed, becomes a refrigeration
cycle, becuase the cyclic integral of the heat transfer, and thus the net work, becomes negative.
This implies heat rejection at higher than the lowest cycle temperature.
The vapor compression refrigeration system is the mainstay of the refrigeration and air
conditioning industry. Absorption refrigeration provides an alternative to the vapor compression
approach, particularly in applications where a heat source is economical and readily available. This
chapter considers both of these system types in turn, and closes with a discussion of moist air
behavior and its influence on air conditioning system design.
Numerous other specialized refrigeration systems exist. As just stated, in principle any heat
engine cycle, when reversed, becomes a refrigeration cycle. Such cycles are usually discussed in
thermodynamics texts. Other systems that are occasionally used in special applications include
thermoelectric coolers, which employ electrical work, and Hilsch or vortex tubes, which employ
compressed gas as an energy source.
283
8.2 Vapor Compression Refrigeration
Consider an insulated cold region of temperature T
L
as shown in Figure 8.1. Heat leakage from
the surroundings to the system tends to increase the systems temperature. In order to keep the
cold region at temperature T
L
, the conservation of energy requires the removal of an amount of
heat equal to the energy inflow. This is done by a cold region heat exchanger that has an even
colder liquid flowing through it to carry away the heat. If the fluid is a saturated liquid, it will
evaporate and absorb energy from the cold region in its heat of vaporization. Such a heat
exchanger is called an evaporator. Thus the basic problem of refrigeration may be reduced to one
284
of providing a mechanism to supply cool saturated liquid or a mixture of liquid and vapor, the
refrigerant, to an evaporator.
Vapor compression refrigeration, as the name suggests, employs a compression process to
raise the pressure of a refrigerant vapor flowing from an evaporator at pressure p
1
to p
2
, as shown
in Figure 8.2. The refrigerant then flows through a heat exchanger called a condenser at the high
pressure, p
2
= p
3
, through a throttling device, and back to the low pressure, p
1,
in the evaporator.
The pressures p
2
= p
3
and p
4
= p
1
correspond to refrigerant saturation temperatures, T
3
and T
1
=
T
4
, respectively. These temperatures allow natural heat exchange with adjacent hot and cold
regions from high temperature to low. That is, T
1
is less than T
L
; so that heat, Q
L
, will flow from
the cold region into the evaporator to vaporize the working fluid. Similarly, the temperature T
3
allows heat, Q
H
, to be transferred from the working fluid in the condenser to the hot region at T
H
.
This is indicated by the arrows of Figure 8.2.
Thus the resulting device is one in which heat is transferred from a low temperature, T
L
, to a
high temperature, T
H
, using a compressor that receives work from the surroundings, therein
satisfying the Clausius statement.
The throttling device, as shown in Figure 8.2, restrains the flow of refrigerant from the
condenser to the evaporator. Its primary purpose is to provide the flow resistance necessary to
maintain the pressure difference between the two heat exchangers. It also serves to control the
rate of flow from condenser to evaporator. The throttling device may be a thermostatic expansion
valve (TEV) controlled by evaporator exit temperature or a long, fine-bore pipe called a capillary
tube.
For an adiabatic throttling device, the First Law of Thermodynamics requires that h
3
= h
4
for
the irreversible process, because Q and W are zero and kinetic energy change is negligible. Thus
saturated liquid at T
3
flashes to a mixture of liquid and vapor at the evaporator inlet at the
enthalpy h
4
= h
3
and pressure p
4
= p
1
. Also the evaporator entrance has the quality x
4
and
temperature T
4
= T
1
. Heat from the cold source at T
L
> T
4
boils the mixture in the evaporator to a
saturated or slightly superheated vapor that passes to the suction side of the compressor.
The compressor in small and medium-sized refrigeration units is usually a reciprocating or
other positive-displacement type, but centrifugal compressors often are used in large systems
designed for commercial and industrial service.
It may be noted from the T-s diagram in Figure 8.2 that the vapor compression cycle is a
reversed Rankine cycle, except that the pressure drop occurs through a throttling device rather
than a turbine. In principle, a turbine or expansion device of some kind could be used to
simultaneously lower the refrigerant pressure and produce work to reduce the net work required
to operate the compressor. This is very unlikely because of the difficulty of deriving work from a
mixture of liquid and vapor and because of the low cost and simplicity of refrigeration throttling
devices.
An exploded view of a through-the-wall type room air conditioner commonly used in motels
and businesses is shown in Figure 8.3. A fan coil unit on the space side is the evaporator. A
thermally insulating barrier separates a hermetically sealed, electric-motor-driven positive
displacement compressor unit and a finned-tube heat exchanger condenser from the room on the
outdoor side.
285
286
Figure 8.4 shows a packaged air-conditioning unit designed for in-space use or for a nearby
space with short duct runs. Units sometimes are designed to operate with either one or two
compressors, coils, and fans to better accommodate varying cooling demands. A unit with water-
cooled condensers such as that shown requires an external heat sink, usually provided by a nearby
ground-level or rooftop evaporative cooling tower.
Rather than being combined in a single enclosure, refrigeration units frequently are installed
as split systems. Figure 8.5 shows an uncovered rooftop condensing unit that contains a
compressor and air cooled condenser. Such units are, of course, covered to resist the outdoor
environment over many years. Cooled refrigerant is piped in a closed circuit to remote air
distribution units that contain cooling coils (evaporators) and throttling devices. Figure 8.6
shows a skid-mounted air-cooled condensing unit also designed to function with remote
evaporators in applications such as walk-in coolers.
Refrigerants
Refrigerants are specially selected substances that have certain important characteristics including
good refrigeration performance, low flammability and toxicity, compatibility with compressor
lubricating oils and metals, and good heat transfer characteristics. They are usually identified by a
number that relates to their molecular composition.
287
The ASHRAE Handbook (ref. 1) identifies a large number of refrigerants by number, as
shown in Table 8.1. Inorganic refrigerants are designated by 700, plus their molecular weight. For
hydrocarbon and halocarbon refrigerants, the number scheme XYZ works as follows: (1) Z, on the
right is the number of fluorine atoms; (2) Y is the number of hydrogen atoms plus one; and (3) the
leftmost digit, X, is one less than the number of carbon atoms in the compound.
Two important examples are refrigerants R-12 and R-22. R-12, dichlorodifluoromethane, has
two fluorine, one carbon, and two chlorine atoms in a methane-type structure. Thus the halogens,
288
289
290
291
chlorine and fluorine, replace hydrogen atoms in the CH
4
molecular structure as shown in Figure
8.7. R-22, monochlorodifluoromethane, has a similar structure to R-12, except for a single
hydrogen atom replacing a chlorine atom. Charts of the thermodynamic properties of these
refrigerants are given in Appendix F.
The commonly used chlorofluorocarbon (CFC) refrigerants are a cause of great concern,
because their accumulation in the upper atmosphere creates a hole in the ozone layer that
normally shields the earth from solar ultraviolet radiation (refs. 8 and 9). In 1987, more than 35
countries, including the United States, signed the Montreal Protocol on Substances that Deplete
the Ozone Layer. The Montreal Protocol called for a freeze in 1989 and reductions in the 1990s
on the production levels of R-11, R-12, R-113, R-114, and R-115. The halocarbon refrigerants,
some of which are also widely used as aerosol propellants, foams, and solvents, are now
categorized as chlorofluorocarbons (CFCs), hydrochlorofluorocarbons (HCFCs), or
hydrofluorocarbons (HFCs). The HFCs, lacking chlorine, are no threat to the ozone layer but are
not in common usage as refrigerants. CFCs, which contain more chlorine than do HCFCs, are the
most serious offenders, are very stable, and do not break down rapidly in the lower atmosphere.
The Clean Air Act of 1990 (ref. 15) mandated termination of production in the United States of
all CFCs such as R-12 by the year 2000. Government data indicate that, because of the structural
difference between them, R-12 has twenty times the ozone-depletion potential in the upper
atmosphere of R-22. Nevertheless, R-22 and other HCFCs are also scheduled by the law for
phaseout of production by the year 2030.
Thus, the search for alternate refrigerants to replace those used in existing applications
(worth hundreds of billions of dollars) has assumed enormous importance. It is a difficult,
expensive, and continuing task to which industry is vigorously applying its efforts. Charts of
thermodynamic properties for two of the newer refrigerants, R-123 and R134a, are given in
Appendix F.
292
Vapor-Compression Cycle Analysis
A vapor-compression cycle was shown in Figure 8.2, The work required by the refrigeration
compressor, assuming adiabatic compression, is given by the First Law of Thermodynamics:
w = h
1
h
2
[Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (8.1)
where the usual thermodynamic sign convention has been employed. The enthalpies h
1
and h
2
usually are related to the temperatures and pressures of the cycle through the use of charts of
refrigerant thermodynamic properties such as those given in Appendix F.
In the ideal vapor compression cycle, the compressor suction state 1 is assumed to be a
saturated vapor. The state is determined when the evaporator temperature or pressure is given.
For the ideal cycle, for which compression is isentropic, and for cycles for which the compression
is determined using a compressor efficiency, state 2 may be defined from state 1 and the
condensing temperature or pressure by using the chart of refrigerant thermodynamic properties.
Assuming no heat exchanger pressure losses, the evaporator and condenser heat transfers are
easily determined per unit mass of refrigerant by application of the First Law of Thermodynamics:
q
L
= h
1
h
4
[Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (8.2)
q
H
= h
3
h
2
[Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (8.3)
The evaporator heat transferred, q
L
, is commonly referred to as the refrigeration effect, RE.
The product of the refrigerant mass flow rate and RE, the rate of cooling produced by the unit, is
called the refrigeration capacity [Btu/hr | kW].
Applying the First Law to the refrigerant in the system as a whole, we find that the work and
heat-transfer terms are related by
q
L
+ q
H
= w [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (8.4)
where q
H
and w are negative for both refrigerators and heat pumps. Hence

q
L
+ |w| = |q
H
| [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (8.5)
Equation (8.5) is written here with absolute values to show that the sum of the compressor work
and the heat from the low-temperature source is the energy transferred by the condenser to the
high-temperature region. This may be seen graphically by addition of the enthalpy increments
representing Equations (8.1) to (8.3) in the pressure-enthalpy diagram shown in Figure 8.8. The
ph diagram is applied often in refrigeration work because of its ease of use in dealing with
enthalpy differences and constant-pressure processes.
EXAMPLE 8.1
Derive Equation (8.1) by using Equations (8.2) to (8.4).
293
Solution
From Equation (8.4),
w = q
L
+ q
H
= (h
1
h
4
) + (h
3
h
2
)
But for the adiabatic throttling valve, h
3
= h
4
. Hence,
w = h
1
h
2
as in Equation (8.1).
_____________________________________________________________________________
System Performance
As mentioned in Chapter 1, a measure of the efficiency of a refrigerator or heat pump is the
coefficient of performance, COP. The COP for a refrigerator is defined as the ratio of the useful
294
effect or desired energy transfer accomplished by the evaporator (RE) to the energy cost to
achieve the effect (the compressor work), in equivalent units:
COP
r
= q
L
/|w| [dl] (8.6)
Like a refrigerator, a heat pump may be a vapor compression system; but unlike the
refrigerator it takes energy from a cold source and transfers it to a hot region for the purpose of
raising the temperature of the region or compensating for heat losses from the region. Some
commercial heat pumps are systems that combine both cooling and heating actions in a single
package. These systems are discussed more fully later.
For a heat pump, the useful effect or desired energy transfer is the passage of energy from the
condenser to the high-temperature region at T
H
. Thus the COP for a heat pump is
COP
hp
= |q
H
| / |w| [dl] (8.7)
It is evident from Equations (8.6) and (8.7) that high values of COP are desired and may be
achieved by minimizing the compressor work input for given values of heat transfer. It may be
particularly advantageous to apply a vapor compression system in situations and applications in
which simultaneous heating and cooling functions are requiredto cool a computer room with the
evaporator while heating rooms on the cold side of the building with the condenser, for example.
EXAMPLE 8.2
Show that the COP for a heat pump exceeds 1.
Solution
Combining Equations (8.7) and (8.5) yields
COP
hp
= |q
H
| / |w| = (q
L
+ |w|) / |w|
= 1 + q
L
/ |w| = 1 + COP
r
> 1
Thus, because q
L
> 0 and COP
r
>0 , the heat pump COP must always exceed 1. This is also
evident directly from the definition Equation (8.7) because the First Law [Equation (8.5)] requires
that |q
H
| > |w|. Note the relationship of refrigerator and heat pump COPs for the same cycle.
_____________________________________________________________________________
The T-s diagram in Figure 8.2 shows that condenser and evaporator pressures of both
refrigerators and heat pumps are determined largely by the source and sink (cold-region and hot-
region) temperatures, T
L
and T
H
, respectively. Thus, the greater the difference between the hot-
region and cold-region temperatures (the application temperature difference), the higher the
compressor pressure ratio and the higher the compressor work. For low application temperature
differences, |w| can be significantly less than q
L
; and thus COP
r
may also exceed 1. Conversely,
large application temperature differences lead to low coefficients of performance.
295
Prior to the twentieth century, the cooling of both people and perishable goods was achieved
by using ice formed in the winter by nature from liquid water. Ice from lakes and ponds in
northern climates was cut, hauled to ice storage houses, and delivered to customers as needed.
As late as the 1930s and 40s, the ice vendor would make a daily delivery of ice so that
perishable goods could be kept fresh in insulated ice storage boxes, the predecessors of the
modern refrigerator. By then, ice was being made by freezing water via large refrigeration units
with ammonia compressors; and comfort air cooling was being installed in the best theaters and
wealthiest homes in the United States.
It is not surprising that a measure of rate of cooling, or cooling capacity, is often related to
the cooling capability of a ton of ice. A ton of refrigeration is defined as the rate of cooling
produced by melting a ton of ice in 24 hours. Based on this definition, and on the fact that the
latent heat of fusion of water is 144 Btu/lb
m
, it may be deduced that a ton of refrigeration is a rate
of cooling of 200 Btu/min, or 12,000 Btu/hour (see Exercise 8.3). Thus a 3-ton air conditioner is
one that nominally removes 36,000 Btu/hr from the cooled space.
When shopping for an air conditioner, one encounters labels that give the product's energy
efficiency ratio (EER), that is, the ratio of the cooling capacity of the unit, measured in Btu/hr, to
the power required to operate it, in watts. It is evident that the EER is proportional to the COP,
neglecting fan power. Applying the conversion factor between Btus and watt-hours one sees that
EER = 3.413(COP.
EXAMPLE 8.3
For an ideal vapor compression refrigeration system operating with refrigerant 22 at an
evaporator temperature of 0F and condensing at 100F, find the following: the compressor
suction and discharge pressures, enthalpies, and specific volumes; the condenser discharge
pressure and enthalpy; the refrigeration COP; and the refrigerant mass flow rate and power
requirement for a 10-ton refrigeration unit.
Solution
Following the notation of Figures 8.2 and 8.8, from the chart (Appendix F) for refrigerant 22
at T
1
= 0F, the other properties at state 1 are p
1
= 38 psia, h
1
= 104 Btu/lb
m
, v
1
= 1.4 ft
3
/lb
m
, and
s
1
= 0.229 Btu/lb
m
-R.
The saturated-liquid condenser discharge properties at T
3
= 100F are p
3
= 210 psia and h
3
=
39 Btu/lb
m
.
The compressor discharge-state properties at s
2
= s
1
and p
2
= p
3
= 210 psia are h
2
= 123
Btu/lb
m
, T
2
= 155F, and v
2
= 0.31 ft
3
/lb
m
.
The evaporator inlet enthalpy is the same as that at condenser discharge, h
4
= h
3
= 39
Btu/lb
m
.
The refrigeration effect and the compressor work are then

RE = h
1
h
4
= 104 39 = 65 Btu/lb
m
w = h
2
h
1
= 123 - 104 = 19 Btu/lb
m
296
Thus
COP
r
= RE /w = 65/19 = 3.42.
The rate of cooling, or cooling capacity, for a 10-ton unit is 10200 = 2000 Btu/min. The
refrigerant mass flow rate is the capacity divided by the refrigeration effect = 2000/65 = 30.8
lb
m
/min.
The power required by the compressor is the product of the mass flow rate and the
compressor work = 30.819 = 585.2 Btu/min, or 585.260/ 3.413 = 10,290 W, or 10.29 kW.
The ideal EER may then be calculated from the capacity and power as 200060/10,290 =
11.7 Btu/Watt-hr, or from the COP as 3.4133.42 = 11.7 Btu/Watt-hr.
_____________________________________________________________________________
Compressors
While most small- and medium-capacity refrigeration systems use hermetically sealed, electric-
motor-driven compressor units or open (externally powered) reciprocating compressors,
centrifugal compressors are frequently found in large units for cooling buildings and for industrial
applications.
The reciprocating compressor has much in common geometrically with a simple two-stroke
reciprocating engine with intake and exhaust valves. As in that case, the compressor clearance
volume V
c
is the volume at top center, and the piston sweeps out the displacement volume, as
indicated in Figure 8.9. The processes 1-2-3-4-1 on the idealized pressure-volume diagram
represent the following:
+ 12 Both valves are closed. Compression of the maximum cylinder volume V
1
= V
c
+ V
d
of refrigerant vapor through the pressure ratio p
2
/p
1
to a volume V
2
.
+ 23 Exhaust valve is open. Discharge of refrigerant through the exhaust valve at
condenser pressure p
3
until only the clearance volume V
3
= V
c
remains when the piston is
at top center.
+ 34 Both valves are closed. Expansion of the clearance gas with both valves closed from
V
3
to V
4
. Note that the inlet valve cannot open until the cylinder pressure drops to p
4
= p
1
without discharging refrigerant back into the evaporator.
+ 41 Intake valve is open. Refrigerant is drawn from the evaporator into the cylinder at
constant pressure p
1
through an intake valve by the motion of piston. Refrigerant in the
amount V
1
V
4
is processed per cycle.
Assuming polytropic compression and expansion processes with the same exponent k:
V
4
= V
3
( p
3
/p
4
)
1/ k
= V
c
( p
2
/p
1
)
1/ k
297
Then the volume of refrigerant vapor processed per cycle (or per shaft revolution)
V
1
V
4
= V
d
+ V
c
V
c
( p
2
/p
1
)
1/ k
= V
d
V
c
[( p
2
/p
1
)
1/ k
1]
is less than the displacement volume and depends on the compressor pressure ratio. Neglecting
the difference between the refrigerant density leaving the evaporator and that in the compressor
cylinder just before compression, we may write the compressor volumetric efficiency as the ratio
of V
1
V
4
to the displacement:

v
= (V
1
V
4
)/V
d
= 1 (V
c
/V
d
)

[( p
2
/p
1
)
1/ k
1]
Examination of the compressor processes for different pressure ratios, as in Figure 8.9 ( p
2
' /p
1
,
for example), shows that the refrigerant volume processed per cycle, and thus the volumetric
298
efficiency, decreases with increasing pressure ratio. It is also evident that the clearance volume
must be kept small to attain high volumetric efficiency. It is clear that, for a given positive-
displacement compressor, the volumetric efficiency limits the usable pressure ratio and thus the
difference between the condensing and evaporating temperatures.
EXAMPLE 8.4
What is the volumetric efficiency of the reciprocating compressor used with the refrigeration
system of Example 8.3 if the clearance volume is 3% of the displacement volume and the
polytropic exponent is 1.16?
Solution
The compressor pressure ratio is p
2
/p
1
= 210/38 = 5.526. From the preceding equation, the
volumetric efficiency is then

v
= 1 (0.03)

[(5.526)
1/1.16
1] = 0.899
_____________________________________________________________________________
The centrifugal compressor used in refrigeration is similar in principle to that introduced
earlier in connection with the turbocharger. It is fundamentally different than the positive-
displacement reciprocating compressor in that it operates on a fluid dynamic principal in which
kinetic energy imparted to the refrigerant by an impeller is converted to pressure analogous to that
indicated by the Bernoulli equation. The high-speed rotor accelerates and thus increases the
kinetic energy of the refrigerant, which is then converted to pressure in diffuser passages.
Because the efficiency of small centrifugal compressors is limited, centrifugals are used primarily
in large-scale applications with cooling loads in tens or hundreds of tons of refrigeration.
The scroll compressor, shown in Figure 8.10, though based on a century-old concept, is a
recent development in rotary compressors. In it, an electric-motor-driven orbiting scroll meshes
with a stationary scroll. Six crescent-shaped pockets formed between the involute scrolls trap,
transport, and compress low-pressure refrigerant from the outside of the scrolls to the discharge
passage at the scroll center. This process is more easily visualized by following the shaded pocket
of refrigerant in Figure 8.11. Some of the advantages attributed to the scroll compressor are:
continuous and smooth compression with 100% volumetric efficiency, no valves, physical
separation of suction and discharge lines (which avoids the temperature cycling of reciprocating
compressors), and higher compression efficiency than the best reciprocating units (ref. 10).
Seasonal energy efficiency ratios (EERs averaged over a cooling season) in excess of 10 are
readily attained with this technology. An animation of a scroll compressor may be seen on the
internet at www.copeland-corp.com.
Suction and Subcooling Considerations
Let's examine two items of concern with respect to some vapor compression systems. In systems
with reciprocating compressors, there is a danger that, due to changing cooling loads, that the
liquid refrigerant in the evaporator may not be completely vaporized, causing slugs of liquid to
299
enter the compressor. Because liquids are essentially incompressible, positive-displacement
compressors with fixed clearance volumes can be damaged when such "slugging" occurs.
The use of a thermostatic expansion valve (TEV) that responds to change in the degree of
superheat in the suction line provides one solution to this problem. A bulb filled with refrigerant
attached to the suction line, when heated by superheated vapor, transmits an increasing pressure
signal to a diaphragm in the TEV, which adjusts the valve flow area and in turn changes the mass
300
flow rate of refrigerant. This control is usually set to maintain a minimum of about five degrees of
superheat to avoid liquid slugs entering the compressor inlet.
A second concern is the possibility of entry of vapor into the throttling valve if the refrigerant
at the condenser exit is not completely condensed. Because vapor occupies much more space than
liquid, the throttling valve will not function properly if vapor can enter from the condenser. One
approach to dealing with this is to locate a liquid receiver downstream of the condenser to assure
the availability of liquid to the expansion device.
Both of the above concerns may be dealt with simultaneously by the addition of a suction-line
heat exchanger that superheats the evaporator discharge about five degrees, ensuring that only
vapor enters the compressor. The heat exchanger that provides suction superheat from state 6 to
state 1 in Figure 8.12 may be set up to receive heat from the subcooling of the condenser
discharge from state 3 to state 4. This ensures the absence both of vapor entering the throttling
valve and of liquid slugs entering the compressor. Note that the subcooling also tends to increase
the refrigeration effect over that of the ideal cycle by decreasing the enthalpy entering the
301
evaporator. This effect may be accomplished by running the compressor suction line next to the
condenser discharge, allowing some thermal contact.
Combining Heating and Cooling in a Single System
It is possible to combine both heating and cooling functions in a single system by providing heat
exchangers that can operate as both evaporator and condenser and a control system that can
reroute the flow of refrigerant when switching functions is required. Figure 8-13 presents a
302
schematic diagram for such a system, commonly called a heat pump (context usually determines
whether the term heat pump refers to a device that heats only or that combines heating and
cooling functions). The key component in a commercial heat pump is a reversing valve. With the
valve shown in the figure, rotation through an angle of 90 reroutes the flow of refrigerant from
the indoor coil to the outdoor coil, and vice versa. As a result of this change, the indoor coil that
served as a condenser in the winter becomes an evaporator in the summer. The outdoor coil
changes accordingly. Separate throttling devices may be used to accommodate differing load
conditions in winter and summer. One-way check valves ensure that refrigerant flow is through
the appropriate throttling device during each season.
8.3 Absorption Refrigeration
Example 8.3 shows that vapor compression refrigeration requires a significant supply of work
from an electric motor or other source of mechanical power. Absorption refrigeration is an
alternate approach to cooling that is largely thermally driven and requires little external work.
This form of refrigeration is growing in importance as energy conservation considerations demand
closer scrutiny of the disposition of heat rejection from thermal processes. Absorption
refrigeration provides a constructive means of utilizing waste heat or heat from inexpensive
sources at a temperature of a few hundred degrees, as well as directly from fossil fuels. The
eventual abolition of the use of CFCs may also boost absorption refrigeration technology.
This system relies on the fact that certain refrigerant vapors may be dissolved in liquids called
absorbents. For instance, water vapor is a refrigerant that tends to dissolve in liquid lithium
bromide, an absorbent. Just as when they condense, vapors release heat when they go into
solution. This heat must be removed from the system in order to maintain a constant temperature.
Thus, cooling causes vapor to be absorbed in absorbents, just as cooling causes vapor to
condense. On the other hand, heating tends to drive vapor out of solution just as it turns liquid to
vapor. This solution phenomenon and the fact that pumping liquid requires a relatively small
amount of work compared with that required to compress a gas are the secrets of absorption
refrigeration.
Consider the schematic diagram in Figure 8.14, which shows a basic absorption refrigeration
unit. The condenser / throttling valve / evaporator subsystem is essentially the same as in the
vapor compression system diagram of Figure 8.2. The major difference is the replacement of the
compressor with a different form of pressurization system. This system consists primarily of an
absorber at the pressure of the evaporator, a vapor generator at the pressure of the condenser,
and a solution pump. A second throttling valve maintains the pressure difference between the
absorber and the generator.
The system operates as follows: Refrigerant vapor from the evaporator flows into the
absorber, where it mixes with the absorbent. The mixture is cooled by heat transfer Q
A
to air or
water at the temperature of the environment, causing the vapor to go into solution. The
refrigerant-absorbent solution flows to the solution pump where it is pressurized to the pressure
level of the generator and condenser. Heat from an energy source, Q
G
, then drives the vapor from
the cold liquid solution. The vapor flows into the condenser while the heated liquid in the
303
304
generator passes back to the absorber through an absorbent throttling valve, thus completing the
absorbent loop.
As in vapor compression systems, the condensed vapor from the condenser passes through
the refrigerant throttling valve into the evaporator as a chilled refrigerant liquid-vapor mixture,
where its vaporization creates the desired refrigeration effect. The evaporator vapor then flows
back to the absorber to again go into solution and repeat the process. It should be noted that the
only work required is a relatively small amount needed to operate the solution pump.
Thus the major energy requirement of an absorption refrigeration system is a transfer of heat
Q
G
from a source of moderate temperature, such as an engine combustion-gas exhaust, steam
from a low-pressure boiler, or perhaps a heat transfer fluid from solar collectors. The coefficient
of performance of an absorption system is therefore defined as the ratio of the refrigeration
capacity to the rate of heat addition in the generator. This definition is fundamentally different
305
from that of the COP of a vapor compression system, because the energy source is in the form of
heat rather than work. Therefore, it should not be surprising that absorption system COPs are
much lower than those for vapor compression systems.

8.4 Comfort Air Conditioning
Professionals define air conditioning to include heating, humidifying, dehumidifying, circulating,
cleaning, and those other operations involving air (in addition to cooling) that provide thermal
comfort to people and effectiveness to processes. Studies of what constitutes thermal comfort to
individuals have identified air temperature, humidity, ventilation, air movement, and air cleanliness
as important control parameters. The systems needed to control all of these parameters are
discussed in many references, including refs. 1 through 5. This chapter is concerned primarily with
temperature and humidity control.
Space cooling and space heating are the primary functions that rely on vapor compression
and absorption systems. In specifying systems to perform these functions, it is necessary to define
the winter heating loads and summer cooling loads [Btu/hr | kW] for the space to be heated or
cooled. Most HVAC (heating, ventilating, and air conditioning) professionals now have computer
programs that assist in defining these loads.
The determination of cooling loads involves delimiting the space to be conditioned and
defining the appropriate indoor and outdoor design conditions. For example, for some
applications the indoor design temperature and humidity might be specified as 74F and 50%
relative humidity based on thermal comfort data and experience. For a given locale, the ASHRAE
Handbook gives outdoor temperatures that are not exceeded during a given fraction of the
summer season. For example, the Handbook indicates that the temperature in Tulsa, Oklahoma is
usually not greater than 98F during 97.5% of the four-month period from June to September.
This, therefore, might be selected as a suitable summer outdoor design temperature.
A thermal cooling load analysis is performed with these design conditions and data on the
structure and contents of the enclosure of the conditioned space for times when the load is
expected to be greatest. The analysis involves heat transfer through walls, roofs, doors, and
windows; and internal heat generation due to electrical devices, gas burning appliances, human
occupants, and other sources. At such times, solar radiation is usually a strong influence. In most
applications, additions of water vapor to air in the space must be considered also. The results of
these calculations yield the design rates at which heat and moisture must be removed from the
space. The air conditioning evaporator cooling capacity and the fan air circulation rate are then
sized to provide for these near-extreme rates.
Cooling and heating loads at a given locale may be expected to vary approximately linearly
with the deviation of the ambient temperature from a break-even temperature of about 65F. At
this outdoor temperature, no mechanical heating or cooling is required for thermal comfort. The
break-even ambient temperature is usually below the indoor design temperature because of the
necessity of a temperature difference for the rejection of heat through the walls required to
balance the energy generation from sources in the space. Figure 8.15 shows typical performance
behavior of vapor compression heating and cooling equipment superimposed on corresponding
load curves. The equipment is necessarily oversized for mild temperatures. In the case of the heat
306
pump, there is an ambient temperature at which the equipment capacity matches the heating load,
the balance point. At lower temperatures the heat pump is unable to maintain the design indoor
temperature, a heating deficit. This situation is usually handled by the use of electrical resistance
heaters to supplement the heat pump output. The electric resistance heaters usually are switched
on in banks as the ambient temperature decreases further below the break-even point. While the
heat pump itself may be quite efficient, pure resistance heating with COP = 1.0 results in
degradation in overall efficiency and economy while the resistance heaters are in operation.
Operationally, for the frequent periods when capacity exceeds load, a thermostat is usually
used to cycle the system on and off to provide for indoor comfort in a limited range of
temperature around the indoor design value. More sophisticated systems resulting from advances
in motor control, compressors, and fans may allow the system to operate at part load continuous-
ly, to avoid the discomfort and inefficiency of temperature cycling associated with simple
thermostat operation.
The dual-fuel heat pump, a new approach to dealing with the weaknesses of the heat pump
at low temperatures, has been proposed and studied by the Electric Power Research Institute, an
equipment manufacturer, and several electric utilities (ref. 14). Instead of expensive and energy-
wasteful resistance heating making up the heating deficit when ambient temperatures require
operation below the heat pump balance point, a gas furnace built into the heat pump package
comes online and economically satisfies the need for additional heat. The combined electric heat
pump and gas unit operate together, unless the ambient temperature drops to still lower
307
temperature levels at which the cost of gas operation falls below the cost of electricity. Below
this break-even point electric heat pump component shuts down and gas heat is used exclusively.
The break-even point may be adjusted when energy prices change. According to the
reference, in regions where gas prices are high and electricity low, dual-fuel heat pump users will
benefit from substantial reductions in operating costs and the utilities from increased off-peak
sales in the winter months. However, the purchase price of the dual-fuel heat pump unit is
expected to be higher than combined gas heating and electric cooling systems now used. This
creates a marketing problem, because consumers often are more impressed by low purchase price
than by low life-cycle costs resulting from low operating costs.
8.5 Moist Air and Air Conditioning System Design
Psychrometrics
Although the mass fraction of water vapor in ambient air usually is numerically small, water vapor
can have a significant influence on an individual's thermal comfort and on the design of air
conditioning equipment. Most people can recall instances of discomfort associated with both
excessively dry or moist air. Numerous industrial processes also require moisture control to
maintain high standards of quality and productivity. The engineering fundamentals of dealing with
moist air and the application of those fundamentals are treated here.
The study of the behavior of moist air is called psychrometrics. We will consider moist air as
a two-component mixture of dry air and water vapor, and treat both components and the mixture
as ideal gases in the context of the mixture theory discussed in Chapter 3.
Humidity Ratio
Properties of moist air are commonly referred to the mass of dry air m
da
, apart from the water
vapor, contained in the air. For example, the humidity ratio is defined as the ratio of the mass of
water vapor to the mass of dry air present in the moist air:
W = m
wv
/m
da
[dl] (8.8)
Together, the humidity ratio and the ambient temperature and pressure define the
thermodynamic state of moist air, and therefore may be used to define other properties of moist
air. Using the ideal gas law, the humidity ratio may be written as
W = ( p
wv
V/R
wv
T)/( p
da
V/R
da
T) = ( p
wv
/p
da
)(R
da
/R
wv
)
= (p
wv
/p
da
)(M
wv
/M
da
)
= 0.622( p
wv
/p
da
) [dl] (8.9)
308
where we have used the facts that the water vapor and dry air occupy the same space and
therefore have the same volume, and that both components are in thermal equilibrium and
therefore are at the same temperature. The ratio of gas constants in Equation (8.9), expressed in
terms of the Universal Gas Constant, reduces to the inverse ratio of molecular weights M
wv
/M
da
=
18/28.9 = 0.622.
Thus the humidity ratio is equivalent to the ratio of partial pressures of water vapor and dry
air. Going one step further, consider the total air pressure P, the pressure that we measure with a
barometer, as the sum of partial pressures of dry air and water vapor according to Dalton's Law:
P = p
da
+ p
wv
[lb
f
/ft
2
| kPa] (8.10)
The humidity ratio then may be written as:
W = 0.622p
wv
/(P p
wv
) [dl] (8.11)
Thus, for a given ambient pressure, the humidity ratio is determined by the existing partial
pressure of water vapor. It is evident that because p
wv
<< P, the humidity ratio varies
approximately linearly with the partial pressure of water vapor in the air. Humidity ratio is
sometimes expressed in grains of water vapor per pound of dry air where there are 7000 grains
per pound.
Saturated Air
Moist air is said to be saturated when its humidity ratio is a maximum for the existing temperature
and total pressure. The humidity ratio for saturated air may be determined using Equation (8.11)
with the saturation pressure of water vapor obtained from saturated steam tables at the known
temperature.
EXAMPLE 8.5
Determine the partial pressures of water vapor and dry air and the humidity ratio in saturated
moist air for an ambient total pressure and temperature of 14.7 psia and 80F, respectively.
Solution
From the saturated-steam tables at 80F, the partial pressure of water vapor is 0.50683 psia.
The partial pressure of the dry air component is then 14.7 0.50683 = 14.2 psia, and the humidity
ratio is
W = 0.622(0.50683)/(14.7 0.50683) = 0.0222
Thus, at 80F, the moist air may have no more than 0.0222 lb (or 155.4 grains) of moisture per
pound of dry air.
_____________________________________________________________________________
309
While air at a given temperature and pressure can have no more water vapor than indicated
by the humidity ratio for saturated air, the air can be drier. This is, of course, indicated by lower
values of humidity ratio and also by relative humidity, as discussed next.
Relative Humidity and Dew Point
An alternative parameter for indicating the moisture content of air is the relative humidity, . The
relative humidity is defined as the ratio of the mole fraction of water vapor in unsaturated air to
the mole fraction of water vapor in air that is saturated at the same temperature and total
pressure:
= x
wv
/x
wv,sat
[dl] (8.12)
It has been shown in Chapter 3 that the mole fraction of a component of an ideal gas is the ratio
of the partial pressure of that component to the total pressure of the gas. Thus the relative
humidity may be written as
= (p
wv
/P)/(p
wv
/P)
sat
= p
wv
/p
wv,sat
[dl] (8.13)
where the partial pressures are evaluated at the same temperature and total pressure. The relative
humidity of the air may be related to the p-V diagram for its water component in Figure 8-16. The
diagram shows two isotherms where T
1
= T
2
> T
3
. Considering the top isotherm, the relative
humidity of state 1 is the ratio of the pressure of water vapor at state 1 to that at the saturation
vapor state at the same temperature, state 2. The figure shows that the maximum pressure of
water vapor possible at a given temperature corresponds to the saturation pressure of water at
that temperature. Thus increasing amounts of water vapor in air at a given ambient temperature
are indicated by higher relative humidity, higher humidity ratio, higher water vapor partial
pressure, and by vapor states closer to the saturated-vapor line for water. Thus the term
"saturated air" implies that the water vapor in the air is a saturated vapor. These two uses of the
term "saturated" should be distinguished to avoid confusion.
When a given mass of moist air cools slowly, the mass of water vapor in the air remains
constant until the air becomes saturated. Thus the humidity ratio and the partial pressure of the
water vapor are also fixed. This process is depicted by the line of constant pressure from 1 to 3 to
4 in Figure 8.16. Note that, once state 4 is reached, no further cooling can occur without
condensation of water vapor. This condition, at which liquid water first appears, is known as the
dew point. The formation of dew is a familiar early morning occurrence in which water vapor
condenses, leaving drops of liquid on grass and other surfaces that are cooler than the
surrounding air. The temperature at which water vapor begins to condense is therefore called the
dew point temperature. It is evident from Figure 8.16 that as the air temperature at state 1 drops,
approaching the dew point temperature, the relative humidity increases until it finally reaches
100% at state 4. Thus the dew point temperature for any moist air state may be obtained from the
saturated-steam tables, if the partial pressure of the water vapor is known.
310
EXAMPLE 8.6
In ambient moist air, the temperature and pressure are 70F and 14.7 psia, respectively, and the
relative humidity is 50%. What are the partial pressures of dry air and water vapor and the
humidity ratio and dew point?
Solution
At 70F, the steam tables give the saturation pressure of water as 0.36292 psia. This is the
partial pressure of water vapor in saturated air. From Equation (8.13), the partial pressure of
water vapor in the ambient air is then (0.5)(0.36292) = 0.181, and the corresponding partial
pressure of dry air is 14.7 0.181 = 14.52 psia. Equation (8.11) then gives the humidity ratio:
W = 0.622(0.181)/14.52 = 0.0078 lb
of water vapor per pound of dry air.
311
The tables for saturated steam give the dew point temperature of about 51F for the vapor
partial pressure of 0.181 psia.
_____________________________________________________________________________
Enthalpy of Moist Air
Since any extensive property of a mixture of ideal gases is the sum of the corresponding
properties of the components, the enthalpy of moist air is the sum of the enthalpies of dry air and
water vapor. Hence
H = H
da
+ H
wv
= m
da
h
da
+ m
wv
h
wv
[Btu | kJ]
where the mass of the mixture is m
da
+ m
wv
. In order to define an enthalpy per unit mass for the
mixture, it must be decided which mass to select as a reference for the specific enthalpy of the
mixture. As with the humidity ratio, the usual choice in psychrometrics is the mass of dry air.
Thus the specific enthalpy of moist air is given by h = H /m
da
:
h = h
da
+ (m
wv
/m
da
)h
wv
= h
da
+ Wh
wv
[Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (8.14)
Because the temperature range of most air conditioning operations is limited, it is usually
satisfactory to use constant heat capacities in dealing with enthalpy calculations. Selecting the
reference temperatures for enthalpy as 0 on both scales, the enthalpies of the dry air, expressed in
terms of Fahrenheit and Celsius temperatures, may be written as
h
da
= c
pda
T [F] = 0.24T [F] [Btu/lb
m
]
and
h
da
= c
pda
T [C] = 1.004T [C] [kJ/kg]
The enthalpy of water vapor is the sum of the sensible and latent enthalpies:
h
wv
= h
s
+ h
fg
= c
pwv
T + h
fg
= 0.446T [F] + 1061.2 [Btu/lb
m
] (8.15a)
= 1.867 T [C] + 2501.3 [kJ/kg] (8.15b)
EXAMPLE 8.7
Compare the enthalpy of water vapor from Equation (8.15a) with that from the steam tables for
32, 100, 150, and 200F.
312
Solution
For 32F, the enthalpy is
h
wv
= 0.446(32) + 1061.2 = 1075.47 Btu/lb
m
This compares with 1075.5 Btu/lb
m
from the steam tables. The comparison for other temperatures
is as follows:
Temperature, F Enthalpy, Btu/lb
m
Equation (8.15a)


Enthalpy, Btu/lb
m
Steam Tables
32 1075.47 1075.5
100 1105.8 1105.1
150 1128.1 1126.1
200 1150.4 1146
Thus the approximation is quite accurate in and beyond the air conditioning range, but it
decreases in accuracy as temperature increases.
_____________________________________________________________________________
Combining the above relations, we may then write the enthalpies of moist air as
h = c
pda
T [F] + W{c
pwv
T [F] + h
fg
}
= 0.24T [F] + W{0.446T [F] + 1061.2} [Btu/lb
m
] (8.16a)
h = c
pda
T [C] + W{c
pwv
T [C] + h
fg
}

= 1.004T [C] + W{1.867T [C] + 2501.3} [kJ/kg] (8.16b)
Adiabatic Saturation
Consider a steady-flow process in which air flows through a liquid water spray in a duct where the
air entrains moisture until it becomes saturated. If the duct is insulated so that the flow is
adiabatic, and the water spray and the moist air leaving the duct are at the same temperature, the
process is referred to as an adiabatic saturation process. It is shown shortly that measurement of
the temperature and pressure of the air entering the duct and the final moist air temperature,
called the adiabatic saturation temperature, determines the state of the moist air entering the
duct. Thus two temperature measurements and a pressure measurement are sufficient to
determine the state of moist air.
313
Figure 8.17 shows a schematic of an adiabatic saturation device in which liquid water at the
adiabatic saturation temperature T
2
is evaporated at a rate m
w
into a moist air stream flowing at a
rate of m
da
(1 + W) through the duct. Thus conservation of mass applied separately to both dry air
and water components yields
m
da2
= m
da1
= m
da
[lb
m
/s | kg/s]
m
da
W
1
+ m
w
= m
da
W
2
[lb
m
/s | kg/s]
Combining these equations, we find that the ratio of the mass flow rate of entrained water or
makeup water to the mass of dry air is
m
w
/m
da
= (W
2
W
1
) [dl] (8.17)
The steady flow form of the First Law yields
m
da 1
(h
da 1
+ W
1
h
wv 1
) + m
w
h
f
= m
da 2
(h
da 2
+ W
2
h
wv 2
)
where h
f
is the enthalpy of the saturated liquid at T
2
. Substituting Equation (8.17) into this
314
equation yields
(h
da1
+ W
1
h
wv1
) + (W
2
W
1
)h
f
= (h
da 2
+ W
2
h
wv 2
)
or
W
1
(h
wv 1
h
f
) = c
pda
(T
2
T
1
) + W
2
(h
wv 2
h
f
) [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg]

or
W
1
={c
pda
(T
2
T
1
) + W
2
(h
wv 2
h
f
)}/(h
wv 1
h
f
) [dl] (8.18)
Given the initial temperature T
1
, h
wv 1
is determined from Equation (8.15). If T
2
and P
1
= P
2
are
also measured, the saturation partial pressure, the humidity ratio W
2
, the vapor enthalpy h
wv 2
, and
the liquid-water enthalpy h
f
= h
f
(T
2
) may also be determined using the steam tables and Equations
(8.11) and (8.15). Equation (8.18) may then be solved for the upstream (ambient) humidity ratio.
The following example demonstrates the use of the adiabatic saturation concept in the
determination of the ambient moist air state.
EXAMPLE 8.8
Ambient air at 14.7 psia and 70F drops to 56F in passing through an adiabatic saturator. What is
the ambient humidity ratio and the relative humidity?
Solution
Saturated air at 56F yields a partial pressure of 0.22183 psia, a humidity ratio
W
2
= 0.622(0.22183)/(14.7 0.22183) = 0.00953
a water-vapor enthalpy h
wv 2
= 1086 Btu/lb
m
, and makeup-water enthalpy h
f
= 24.059 Btu/lb
m
.
At the inlet where T
1
= 70F, the water-vapor enthalpy h
wv 1
= 1092.1 Btu/lb
m
. Thus, from
Equation (8.18)

W
1
= [0.24(56 70) + 0.00953(1086 24.059)] /(1092.1 24.059) = 0.00633 lb
of water vapor per pound of dry air.
Solving Equation (8.11) for the partial pressure of water vapor gives
p
wv 1
= (W
1
)(P)/(0.622 + W
1
) = (0.00633)(14.7)/(0.622 + 0.00633) = 0.1481 psia
Because the saturation partial pressure of water vapor at 70F is p
wv 1, sat
= 0.36292 psia, the
relative humidity at state 1 is
= 0.1481/0.36292 = 0.408, or 40.8%.
_____________________________________________________________________________
315
We may summarize the adiabatic saturation process as one in which liquid water
evaporates into the air flow, increasing the mass of water vapor in the air and therefore
increasing the humidity ratio and, according to Equation (8.11), increasing the partial pressure
of the vapor also. Because the flow is adiabatic, the heat of vaporization for the water must
come from the flow of moist air, decreasing the air temperature. The increase in vapor partial
pressure implies that the air dew point temperature increases as the flow passes through the
saturator, ending at the adiabatic saturation temperature.
In order to distinguish among the various temperatures dealt with in psychrometrics, the
temperature of moist ambient air, as measured by a mercury-in-glass thermometer, a
thermocouple, or an equivalent device, is known as the dry bulb temperature.
The sling psychrometer, a more convenient and inexpensive device for determining moist
air states than the adiabatic saturator, uses two mercury-in-glass thermometers rigidly
attached to a frame with a pivoted handle as shown in Figure (8.18). The bulb of one
thermometer, called the wet bulb, is wrapped in moistened wicking, and the other is left bare
to measure the dry-bulb temperature. In operation, the user twirls the psychrometer for a
minute or two until the readings of the thermometers stabilize. Evaporation of water from the
wicking cools the wet bulb in proportion to the dryness of the ambient air. The temperature
difference between the bulbs is commonly called the wet-bulb depression. Tables are
sometimes provided to give relative humidity in terms of wet-bulb depression, but a
psychrometric chart may be conveniently used to identify the moist air properties, as discussed
in the next section.
The wet-bulb temperature, as an approximation to the adiabatic saturation temperature,
together with the dry-bulb temperature and barometric pressure, determines the state of the
moist ambient air. While the wet-bulb process differs fundamentally from the adiabatic
saturation process, in practice it provides a reliable approximation to the wet-bulb
temperature. Thus the adiabatic saturation temperature is sometimes referred to as the
thermodynamic wet-bulb temperature.
Devices that give direct readings of humidity are called hygrometers. These devices are
usually more complicated and expensive and less reliable than the psychrometer. They
316
commonly make use of properties of materials that are influenced by the presence of water
vapor, such as elongation and shrinkage. Human hair, paper, and nylon are examples of such
materials. More information on hygrometers is available in reference 2.

The Psychrometric Chart
The properties and processes described above are conveniently related on a graph commonly
known as a psychrometric chart. Although close examination of the skeleton chart of Figure
8.19 and the detailed chart in the Appendix shows that it is not quite a rectangular coordinate
plot, for most purposes it may be thought of as such, with humidity ratio as ordinate and dry
bulb temperature as abscissa. A psychrometric chart is constructed for a specified value of
barometric pressure. Thus charts for different barometric pressures should be selected for
analyses for high altitudes, such as at Denvers, where atmospheric pressure is low, and those
near sea level, such as Houstons, where it is normally high.
317
While most psychrometric charts are based on the precise methods of reference 7, it is
instructive to consider how a chart could be constructed based on the ideal gas theory
discussed earlier and on the steam tables. The curve labeled "saturation" on the psychrometric
chart corresponds to states of air containing saturated water vapor at each dry-bulb
temperature. For each value of dry-bulb temperature, the saturation partial pressure obtained
from the steam tables determines the saturation humidity ratio for a specified atmospheric
pressure [Equation (8.11)]. Thus the saturation curve relates the dew point temperature
(measured on the abscissa) to the humidity ratio and to the corresponding partial pressure of
water vapor. The saturation line also defines the conditions for 100% relative humidity.
For a given dry-bulb temperature, Equation (8.13) shows that the vapor partial pressure
varies linearly with :
p
wv
= (p
wv, sat
For a given value of , the humidity ratio can then be established using Equation (8.11).
Hence the value of and the dry-bulb temperature determine the value of the ordinate W.
Thus a line of constant relative humidity lies between the horizontal axis (p
wv
= 0 or W = 0)
and the chart saturation curve at a vertical position in proportion of the magnitude of .
Lines of constant volume of moist air per unit mass of dry air may be approximated using
the ideal gas law applied to the dry air component:
v = R
da
T/p
da
= R
da
T/(P p
wv
) [ft
3
/lb
m
| m
3
/kg] (8.19)
where R
da
is the gas constant for dry air. Because dry air and water vapor occupy the same
volume independently, the specific volume of moist air based on unit mass of dry air is the
same as that for dry air. For zero humidity ratio, the air is dry and p
wv
= 0. Then the dry-bulb
temperature and ambient pressure alone determine the specific volume for each point on the
horizontal axis of the chart. As the humidity ratio and hence the vapor partial pressure
increase at constant ambient pressure, Equation (8.19) shows that the dry-bulb temperature
must decrease to hold v constant. This establishes the negative slope of constant-specific-
volume lines on the psychrometric chart. It is also easily seen from Equation (8.19) that, for
dry air along the horizontal axis, lines of higher specific volume are located at higher dry-bulb
temperatures. The same conclusion follows for any constant value of humidity ratio.
Similar arguments may be used, together with Equation (8.14), to explain the slope and
variation of lines of constant enthalpy with dry-bulb temperature on the psychrometric chart.
Processes on the Psychrometric Chart
Consider point A on the psychrometric chart in Figure 8.19. The processes of heating and
cooling to points B and C, respectively, are called sensible heating and sensible cooling. The
term sensible implies change in dry-bulb temperature without change in moisture content.
These processes occur at constant humidity ratio and thus at constant dew point temperature,
T
dp
.
318
Next consider processes in which either moistening or drying of air takes place. An
example of a humidification, or air-moistening, process already considered is the adiabatic
saturation process. It is represented by movement along a line of constant wet-bulb
temperature toward the saturation curve, such as the line AD on the figure.
A pure humidification process is one in which the humidity ratio increases at constant
dry-bulb temperature. The line AE in Figure 8.19 represents this process. The process requires
the addition of water vapor to the air, with a consequent energy increase corresponding to the
heat of vaporization of water, (W
E
W
A
)h
fg
. The enthalpy increase between points A and E
indicated by the chart is equal to this quantity because no sensible heating has occurred. The
process is said to involve latent heat as opposed to sensible heat. Thus an isothermal change
in humidity ratio represents a latent heat load associated with the moist air mass and the
equipment dealing with it. The reverse process EA may be thought of as pure
dehumidification. The modifier "pure" is meant to suggest that there are other, more common
and easily executed, humidification and dehumidification processes in which dry bulb
temperature change is involved. Examples are air washer processes like the adiabatic saturator
and desiccant drying (to be discussed later).
Let us now consider the steady-flow, adiabatic mixing of two moist air streams at states i
and o to form a single stream at state m as shown in Figure 8.20. Conservation of mass of dry
air and water vapor yields
m
i
+ m
o
= m
m
[lb
m
/s | kg/s] (8.20)
319
and
m
i
W
i
+ m
o
W
o
= m
m
W
m
Dividing through by the mixture mass flow rate, the latter equation becomes
W
m
= (m
i
/m
m
)W
i
+ (m
o
/m
m
)W
o
[dl] (8.21)
Thus the mixture humidity ratio is the mass-weighted average of the humidity ratios of the
two streams. Applying conservation of energy to the adiabatic mixing process, we obtain
0 = m
m
h
m
m
i
h
i
m
o
h
o
which may be written as
h
m
= (m
i
/m
m
)h
i
+ (m
o
/m
m
)h
o
[Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (8.22)
This equation is of the same form as Equation (8.21).
Thus, given the flow rates and properties of the two streams, the mass flow of the
mixture is the sum of the masses of the two inflowing streams and the humidity ratio and
enthalpy of the mixture may be obtained by calculating the weighted means of the humidity
ratios and enthalpies from Equations (8.21) and (8.22).
A graphical solution for the mixture state can be easily obtained on the psychrometric
chart. For fixed states i and o, Equations (8.21) to (8.22) depend on a single parameter,
m
i
/m
m
, or
m
o
/m
m
= m
o
/(m
o
+ m
i
) = 1 m
i
/m
m
Rearranging Equations (8.21) and (8.22) they become

(W
m
W
i
)/(W
o
W
i
) = m
o
/m
m
[dl] (8.23a)
(h
m
h
i
)/(h
o
h
i
) = m
o
/m
m
[dl] (8.23b)
Eliminating the mass ratio between these equations defines a linear relation between the
mixture humidity ratio W
m
and enthalpy h
m
:
W
m
= W
i
+ (h
m
h
i
)(W
o
W
i
)/(h
o
h
i
) [dl]
as shown in Figure 8.20. The explicit linear dependence of W
m
and h
m
on m
o
/m
m
is shown by
rearranging Equations (8.23a and b) into
W
m
= W
i
+ (W
o
W
i
)(m
o
/m
m
) [dl] (8.23c)
h
m
= h
i
+ (h
o
h
i
)(m
o
/m
m
) [Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg] (8.23d)
320
When the flow rates and properties of states i and o are known, the latter two equations define
the mixture state.
These equations are the basis for a graphical method to determine the mixture state, as
suggested earlier. A straight line connecting states i and o is drawn on the psychrometric
chart, and the mass fraction m
o
/m
m
in Equations (8.23) is laid out as the fraction of the
distance between i and o measured from state i. The resulting point defines the properties of
the mixture state.
EXAMPLE 8.9
Ten lb
m
/sec of outdoor air at 100F dry-bulb and 60% relative humidity at sea level is mixed
with 20 lb
m
/sec of indoor air at 75F dry-bulb and 40% relative humidity. Determine the moist
air properties of the mixture.
Solution
From the psychrometric chart for the outdoor air state: h
o
= 51.8 Btu/lb
m
and W
o
= 0.0252 lb
m
water vapor per lb
m
dry air. For indoor air: h
i
= 26 Btu/lb
m
and W
i
= 0.0074 lb
m
of water vapor
per lb
m
dry air. From Equations (8.20) and (8.21), the humidity ratio is then:
W
m
= (10/30)(0.0252) + (20/30)(.0074) = 0.01333 lb
m
water vapor per lb
m
dry air, and the enthalpy is
h
m
= (10/30)(51.8) + (20/30)(26) = 34.6 Btu/lb
m
Other mixture properties from the psychrometric chart are then 83.4F dry-bulb, 65F
dew point, and 70.8F wet-bulb temperatures, 54% relative humidity, and 13.97 ft
3
/lb
m
specific volume.
__________________________________________________________________________
Psychrometric Analysis of Space Cooling
An important application of psychrometrics is in the analysis and design of air conditioning
systems. In comfort cooling, a control volume (see Figure 8.21), usually referred to as a space
or zone, is identified as a room or group of rooms that have common thermal conditions and
are to be put under the control of a single thermostat or control. Those conditions are usually
defined by the atmospheric pressure, dry-bulb temperature, a humidity parameter such as
humidity ratio, and specified sensible and latent cooling loads, q
s
and q
L
. The design sensible
and latent loads are defined based on the characteristics of the boundaries of the zone and on
its external and desired internal environments, as discussed earlier. The sensible heat factor,
SHF = q
s
/q
t
= q
s
/(q
s
+ q
L
) [dl] (8.24)
defines the fraction of the total load q
t
due to the sensible load. The sensible heat factor, SHF,
321
together with the sensible load, is frequently used in defining the conditions for cooling a
zone.
Consider the conditioned space in Figure 8.21 as having specified latent and sensible
loads. It is desired to hold the dry-bulb temperature of the indoor space at T
DBi
and relative
humidity,
i
(the wet-bulb temperature T
WBi
or humidity ratio W
i
could be used instead). The
design outdoor environment is represented by design dry-bulb and wet-bulb temperatures,
T
DBe
and T
WBe,
respectively, as shown on the psychrometric chart in Figure 8.22. A system is
to be designed to supply cool, dry air to offset the sensible and latent loads imposed on the
zone. The system is represented by a frictionless adiabatic ducting system that supplies
conditioned air, the supply air (state su on the chart), to replace an equal mass of room air at
the space conditions (state i). Part of the air leaving the zone is exhausted to the environment;
and the balance, the return air, is mixed with fresh outdoor ventilation air (state e). The
mixture of return air and ventilation air (state m) is cooled and dehumidified by a cooling coil
and circulated back to the space by a supply-air fan. It is desired to determine suitable values
for supply-air temperature, coil cooling rate, and fan volume flow rate.
Assuming that air leaves the space at temperature T
DBi
, the steady-flow form of the First
Law applied to the space yields
q
t
= q
s
+ q
L
= m
su
(h
i
h
su
) [Btu/hr | kW] (8.25)
The enthalpy difference in this equation can be written as
h
i
h
su
= h
i
h
3
+ h
3
h
su
[Btu/lb
m
| kJ/kg]
322
This decomposition is seen graphically in the psychrometric chart in terms of the triangle
i $su $3. Thus
q
t
= m
su
(h
i
h
3
+ h
3
h
su
) [Btu/hr | kW] (8.26)
Because the sensible heat, reflecting the supply-air dry-bulb temperature rise, may be written
as
q
s
= m
su
(h
3
h
su
) [Btu/hr | kW] (8.27a)
it is clear from Equation (8.26) that the latent heat is given by
q
L
= m
su
(h
i
h
3
) [Btu/hr | kW] (8.27b)

Equations (8.27) show that both sensible and latent loads are proportional to the supply-air
mass flow rate. Graphically, Equations (8.27) indicate that the line segments su $3 and 3 $i
represent sensible and latent zone heat loads, respectively.
The sensible heat factor may be expressed as
323
SHF = q
s
/q
t
= [(h
i
h
3
)/(h
3
h
su
) + 1]
-1
[dl] (8.28)
It is seen from Equation (8.28) and Figure 8.22 that the space sensible heat factor depends on
the slope of the room condition line. The ASHRAE psychrometric chart includes a
"protractor" that relates the condition line slope to the sensible heat factor. Thus the design
indoor state and the cooling loads determine the room condition line.
Selection of the supply-air dry-bulb temperature together with the room condition line
determines the supply-air state. The supply-air temperature must be chosen within the
capabilities of available refrigeration cooling coils. Note that the coil cooling load
q
c
= m
su
(h
m
h
su
) [Btu/hr | kW]
exceeds the space-cooling load whenever warm ventilation air is provided.
The fan mass flow rate requirement may be evaluated from Equation (8.25) or (8.27)
when the supply-air state is known. The fan volume flow rate is then m
su
v
m
[ft
3
/hr | m
3
/s].
However, it is usually quoted in ft
3
/min or CFM as
CFM = m
su
v
m
/60 [ft
3
/min]
where the mass flow rate is in lb
m
/hr of dry air.
There is a significant tradeoff here which may be considered with the help of the
psychrometric chart. Higher supply-air dry-bulb temperatures allow higher evaporator coil
temperatures, which improve the system cooling COP. However, the resulting lower supply-
air to room-air temperature difference [according to Equation (8.25)] implies a larger air flow
rate and thus a larger fan and larger ducts.
A moisture mass balance on the cooling coil gives the mass rate of condensation of water
from the supply air:
m
w
= m
su
(W
m
W
su
) [lb
m
/hr | kg/s]
It should be recognized that this is usually greater than the rate of removal of water vapor
from the zone because of the higher vapor content of the ventilation air.
EXAMPLE 8.10
A single zone is to be maintained at 70F dry-bulb and 50 % relative humidity by a
refrigeration coil in a forced-air system. The total cooling load on the zone is 55,000 Btu/hr
and the latent load is 11,000 Btu/hr. Outdoor air at 98F dry-bulb and 80F wet-bulb is
provided at a mass rate that is 25% of the supply-air rate. Air leaving the coil is at 50F dry-
bulb.
(a) Show the states of the indoor and outdoor air on a psychrometric chart and identify
their enthalpy, wet-bulb temperature, humidity ratio, specific volume, and relative humidity.
(b) Show the mixture line and state on a psychrometric chart.
(c) Show the space and coil condition lines on a psychrometric chart. What are the
324
enthalpy, wet-bulb temperature, humidity ratio, specific volume, and relative humidity of the
supply air?
(d) What are the mass and volume flow rates of the outdoor and supply air?
(e) What is the total coil cooling load, in Btu/hr and in tons?
Solution
(a) From the psychrometric chart, the zone and outdoor properties are:
T
DBi
= 70F T
DBe
= 98F

i
= 50% T
WBe
= 80F
W
i
= 0.0078 W
e
= 0.018
h
i
= 25.3 Btu/lb
m
da h
e
= 43.4 Btu/lb
m
da
v
i
= 13.51 ft
3
/lb
m
da v
e
= 14.47 ft
3
/lb
m
da
T
WBi
= 58F
e
= 47%
(b) For the properties listed above and for m
o
/m
m
= 0.25 in Equation (8.23), the mixture
enthalpy and humidity ratio are
h
m
= 25.3 + 0.25(43.4 25.3) = 29.83 Btu/lb
m
da
W
m
= 0.0078 + 0.25(0.018 0.0078) = 0.01035 lb
m
/lbda
It is seen in Figure 8.22 that these properties verify that the mixture state lies on a straight line
between the outdoor and indoor states. Thus the mixture line and either h
m
or W
m
could have
been used to identify state m. The mixture dry-bulb temperature read from the chart is 77F
and the specific volume is 13.7 ft
3
/lb
m
da.
(c) The sensible heat factor is SHF = 44,000/55,000 = 0.8. A line parallel to the room
condition line is obtained using the chart protractor and the space sensible heat factor. Using
two triangles, a parallel line through state i gives the space (room) condition line shown in
Figure 8.22. From the intersection of the space condition line and the 50F dry-bulb
temperature line, the supply-air properties are:
h
su
= 19.2 Btu/lb
m
da
W
su
= 0.0066
v
su
= 12.95 ft
3
/lb
m
da

su
= 86%
The coil condition line is drawn to connect states m and su.
(d) The enthalpy of the supply air rises as it mixes with room air. The rise rate must equal the
total space load in order for the space temperature to remain unchanged. Thus
m
su
= (q
s
+ q
L
)/(h
i
h
su
) = 55,000/(25.3 19.2) = 9016.4 lb
m
da/hr
Using the v
su
, the supply air volume flow rate is 9016.4(12.95)/60 = 1946 cfm. Similarly, the
325
on-coil volume flow rate is 9016.4(13.7)/60 = 2059 cfm. The outdoor-air mass and volume
flow rates are then, respectively, 9016.4/4 = 2254.1 lb
m
da/hr and 2254.1(14.45)/60 = 543 cfm.
Note that, because of the different specific volumes, the outdoor-air volume flow rate is not
one-fourth of the supply-air rate; and the supply-air and on-coil volume flow rates are not
equal.
(e) The mixed ventilation and return air are cooled and dehumidified by heat transfer to the
refrigeration coil. The coil load is therefore
q
coil
= m
su
(h
m
h
su
) = 9016.4(29.83 19.2) = 95,844 Btu/hr, or 95,844/12,000 = 8 tons
The coil load is greater than the space-cooling load because of the cooling and
dehumidification of the outdoor ventilation air.
__________________________________________________________________________
Dehumidification Without Cooling Coils
It was shown in Example 8.10 that dehumidification usually accompanies cooling in typical
space-cooling systems using refrigerant coils. In industrial processes and other applications
where precise humidity control is important, special equipment often is used. Substances
known as desiccants, which absorb water vapor, may be employed in such dehumidification
applications, alone or in combination with refrigerant coil cooling and dehumidification.
Examples of solid desiccants are silica gel, lithium chloride, and activated alumina. You may
have observed that cartons which contain merchandise that must be kept dry are often shipped
with small packets of a desiccant such as silica gel.
The difference in water vapor pressure between neighboring regions is a driving force for
water vapor transport by diffusion from the high-vapor-pressure region to the lower-pressure
region. A desiccant absorbs water vapor from air adjacent to its surface, lowering the local
vapor pressure and thereby attracting an inflow of additional vapor from the surroundings.
As a desiccant absorbs water vapor, however, the water vapor pressure at its surface
gradually increases. The material will continue to accept water vapor until its vapor pressure
equals or exceeds that of the surrounding air. Thus the material must be reactivated to
continue the drying process. Since vapor pressure increases with temperature, a desiccant can
be reactivated by heating it with hot air. At high temperatures the desiccant vapor pressure
exceeds that of the surrounding air, and water vapor then passes from the desiccant to the
surrounding air.
Commercial dehumidifiers may use liquid or solid desiccants. Figure 8.23(a) shows a
schematic of a compact desiccant-wheel dehumidification system that has a wide range of
industrial applications and that allows the drying of process air to a very low dew point. In the
dehumidifier, the process air passes through a duct leading to a sector of a rotating,
fiberglass-composite honeycomb wheel having many small passages impregnated with lithium
chloride dessicant. The water-laden sector rotates slowly into another duct, sealed off from
326
the process air, through which a separate air flow passes at a temperature from 250 300 F.
This hot air reactivates the desiccant in preparation for its next exposure to the process air.
Though heat (not work) is required to reactivate the desiccant, the process requires less
energy than other dehumidification processes. A desiccant-wheel storage room installation is
shown in Figure 8.23(b). As in the figure, heated outdoor air is usually provided for
reactivation of the desiccant. The reader is referred to references 11 and 12 for further
information on dessicant dehumidification.
327
Bibliography and References
1. Parsons, Robert A. (Ed.), ASHRAE Handbook of Fundamentals. Atlanta: American
Society of Heating, Refrigerating, and Air-Conditioning Engineers, 1989, p. 16.3.
2. McQuiston, Faye C. and Parker, Jerald D., Heating Ventilating, and Air Conditioning,
3
rd
ed. Wiley, New York, N.Y., 1988.
3. Stoecker, W. F. and Jones, J. W., Refrigeration and Air Conditioning, 2
nd
ed.
McGraw-Hill, New York, N.Y., 1982.

4. Threlkeld, James L., Thermal Environmental Engineering, 2
nd
ed. Prentice-Hall, Inc.,
Engelwood Cliffs, N.J., 1970.
5. Jennings, Burgess H., The Thermal Environment Conditioning and Control, Harper
and Row, 1978.
6. Stoecker, W.F., Design of Thermal Systems, 3
rd
ed. McGraw-Hill, New York, N.Y.,
1989.
7. Goff, John A. and Gratch, S., Thermodynamic Properties of Moist Air," ASHRAE
Handbook of Fundamentals, Atlanta: American Society of Heating, Refrigerating, and
Air-Conditioning Engineers, 1972.
8. Derra, Skip, "CFCs No Easy Solutions," R&D Magazine, May 1990, pp. 56-66.
9. Moore, Taylor, "CFCs: The Challenge of Doing Without," EPRI Journal, Vol. 14, No. 6,
September 1989.
10. Purvis, Ed, "Applications of Scroll Compressors in Heat Pumps," Energy Technology
XVI, Government Institutes, Inc., February 1989, pp. 410-420.
11. Parsons, Robert A. (Ed.), Sorbents and Desiccants, ASHRAE Handbook of
Fundamentals. Atlanta: American Society of Heating, Refrigerating, and Air-
Conditioning Engineers, 1989, Ch 19.
12. Parsons, Robert A. (Ed.), Sorption Dehumidification and Pressure Drying Equipment,
ASHRAE Handbook of Equipment. Atlanta: American Society of Heating, Refrigerating,
and Air-Conditioning Engineers, 1988, Ch 7.
13. Althouse, Andrew D., et al., Modern Refrigeration and Air-Conditioning. South
Holland, Ill.: Goodheart-Wilcox Co., 1975.
328
14. York, Thomas, Heat Pumps: Developing the Dual Fuel Option, EPRI Journal,
December 1990, pp. 22-27.
15. Public Law 101-549, An Act to Amend the Clean Air Act to Provide for Attainment
and Maintenance of Health Protection, National Air Quality Standards, and Other
Purposes, November 15, 1990.
16. Anon., Refrigeration and Ice Making. Alymer, Ontario: Ontario Arenas Association Inc.,
March 1988.
EXERCISES
8.1 Derive a relationship between the coefficient of performances for the heat pump and
refrigerator using the ideal cycles of Figure 8.1.
8.2 Carefully sketch a flow diagram and T-s diagram for a refrigeration cycle that uses a
single heat exchanger for suction line heating and condenser discharge subcooling.
Explain how the addition of this heat exchanger influences the cycle refrigeration effect?
8.3 Derive the conversion factors in Btu/hr and in kJ/hr, for a ton of refrigeration, based on
the latent heat of fusion of ice of 144 Btu/lb.
8.4 Derive the following convenient relation for the horsepower required to produce a
cooling capacity of one ton of refrigeration: horsepower/ton = 4.72/COP.
8.5 When shopping for an air conditioner, one encounters labels that give the product's EER.
What is the coefficient of performance for an air conditioner with an EER of 9.3?
8.6 Determine the capacity and COP of a vapor compression chiller operating with a
reciprocating compressor between 35C condensing and 10C evaporating with
refrigerant 22. The compressor has a volumetric efficiency of 70% and operates at 1800
rpm with a displacement volume of 750 cubic centimeters.

8.7 Compare the refrigeration effect, compressor work, and COP
r
for refrigerants 12 and 22
for a refrigeration system that has a 40F evaporator and condenses at 140F.
8.8 Compare the refrigeration effect, COP
r
, compressor work, and EER for an R-12
refrigeration unit with 120F condensing and 50, 30, and 10F evaporators. Tabulate
the results.
8.9 Compare the refrigeration effect, COP
r
, compressor work, and EER for an R-22
refrigeration unit with 120F condensing and 50, 30, and 10F evaporators. Tabulate
the results.
329
8.10 Compare the refrigeration effect, COP
r
, compressor work, and EER for an R-22
refrigeration unit with 100, 120, and 140F condensing and 50F evaporator.
Tabulate the results.

8.11 Compare the refrigeration effect, COP
r
, compressor work, and EER for an R-12
refrigeration unit with 100, 120, and 140F condensing and 50F evaporator.
Tabulate the results.

8.12 Compare the results of Exercise 8.10 with those for a similar system, accounting for a
compressor with a 75% isentropic efficiency.
8.13 Compare the results of Exercise 8.11 with those for a similar system, accounting for a
compressor with a 75% isentropic efficiency.
8.14 Consider a two-stage refrigeration system that operates with a 40F evaporator and
condenses at 140F. Draw labeled T-s and flow diagrams for the cycle that consists of
two ideal vapor compression cycles connected by a heat exchanger that serves as the
condenser for the low-pressure cycle and the evaporator for the high-pressure cycle.
The evaporating and condensing temperature in the heat exchanger is 80F. For R-12,
determine the ratio of refrigerant flows for the two cycles and compare the refrigeration
effect, total compressor work, COP
r
, and EER with that for the single-stage system.

8.15 Consider a two-stage refrigeration system that operates with a 40 F evaporator and
condenses at 140F. Draw labeled Ts and flow diagrams for the cycle that consists of
two ideal vapor compression cycles connected by a heat exchanger that serves as the
condenser for the low-pressure cycle and the evaporator for the high-pressure cycle.
The evaporating and condensing temperature in the heat exchanger is 80F. For R-22,
determine the ratio of refrigerant flows for the two cycles; and compare the
refrigeration effect and the total compressor work per unit mass in the evaporator, the
COP
r
, and the EER with that for the single-stage system.
8.16 A Diesel engine develops 500 horsepower at an efficiency of 38%. Almost all of the
heat loss from the engine is transferred through the lubricating oil, through the cooling
water, and through an exhaust gas heat exchanger to the generator of an absorption
refrigeration system with a COP of 0.8. Derive an equation for the capacity of the
evaporator in terms of the engine efficiency and power output and the COP of the
refrigeration system. What is the capacity of the evaporator of the refrigeration system
in Btu/min and in tons?
8.17 The volumetric efficiency, mv
s
/(N(disp), of a reciprocating compressor may be crudely
modeled as:
Vol. eff. = 1 + C Cr
(1/n)
330
where C is the ratio of the clearance volume to the piston displacement disp, v
s
is the
compressor suction specific volume, r is the compressor pressure ratio, and n is the
polytropic exponent. Taking C = 0.15 and n = 1.2, plot capacity and compressor power
versus evaporator temperature for a condensing temperature of 140F for R-12. The
compressor has a 3 in
3
displacement and operates at 1200 rpm.
8.18 To attempt to compare COPs for vapor compression and absorption refrigeration
systems, consider a vapor compression system (with COP
r
) driven by a heat engine
(with efficiency
E
). The combined system is one that accepts heat from a high-
temperature source and uses it to cool a low-temperature region. Work out an equation
for the COP for the combined system COP
a
,and compare it with the COP
r
for the
corresponding vapor compression system. What is COP
a
, when COP
r
= 6 and the
engine efficincy is 25%?
8.19 Determine the COP of an ideal vapor-compression-refrigeration system using R-22
with a 40F evaporator and a condensing temperature of 110F. Next, assume that the
work for the system is provided by a Carnot engine operating between 250F and
100F reservoirs. Diagram the system. Considering the combined system as a model of
an absorption system, compare its absorption COP with the COP of the vapor
compression system alone. Discuss the conditions under which higher-absorption COPs
could be attained.
8.20 Sketch and discuss thoroughly the slope and variation of lines of constant enthalpy on
the psychrometric chart.
8.21 Compare the sea level relative humidity, enthalpy, specific volume, wet-bulb
temperature, and dew point using (a) steam tables and ideal gas mixture relations and
(b) the psychrometric chart for the following conditions:
1. 60F dry-bulb, W = 0.01.
2. 90F dry-bulb, W = 0.02.
3. 90F dry-bulb, W = 0.01.
8.22 Compare the sea level humidity ratio, enthalpy, specific volume, wet bulb temperature
and dew point using (a) steam tables and ideal gas relations and (b) the psychrometric
chart for the following conditions:
1. 60F dry-bulb, = 50%
2. 90F dry-bulb, W = 80%
3. 90F dry-bulb, W = 40%
8.23 Compare the sea level relative humidity, humidity ratio, enthalpy, specific volume, and
dew point using (a) steam tables and ideal gas relations, and (b) the psychrometric chart
for the following conditions:
1. 60F dry-bulb, 55F wet-bulb.
331
2. 90F dry-bulb, 55F wet-bulb.
3. 90F dry-bulb, 80F wet-bulb.
8.24 Two hundered lb
m
/hr of moist air at 65F dry-bulb and 50F wet-bulb temperatures
mixes with 40 lb
m
/hr of air at 100F and 85F wet-bulb. What is the mixture dry-bulb
temperature, humidity ratio, relative humidity, and dew point? What are these
parameters if the second stream flow rate is increased to 80 lb
m
/hr?
8.25 One hundred lb
m
/hr of moist air at 70F dry-bulb and 50% relative humidity mixes with
35 lb
m
/hr of air at 90F wet-bulb and 70% relative humidity. What are the mixture dry-
bulb and wet-bulb temperatures, humidity ratio, relative humidity, enthalpy, specific
volume, and dew point?
8.26 Determine the sensible, latent, and total heat transfer for moist air flowing over a
cooling coil. The on-coil wet-bulb and dry-bulb temperatures are 85F and 105F,
respectively, and the coil-leaving conditions are 60F dry-bulb and 60% relative
humidity. How much water is condensed per unit mass of dry air?
8.27 Determine the sensible, latent, and total heat transfer for moist air flowing over a
cooling coil. The on-coil wet-bulb and dry-bulb temperatures are 75F and 95F,
respectvely, and the coil-leaving conditions are 50F dry-bulb and 85% relative
humidity. How much water is condensed per unit mass of dry air?
8.28 Air at sea level has a dry-bulb temperature of 80F and an adiabatic saturation
temperature of 60F. Evaluate the humidity ratio, relative humidity, and dew point
temperature using (a) equations and steam tables and (b) the psychrometric chart
method.
8.29 Air at sea level has a dry-bulb temperature of 85F and an adiabatic saturation
temperature of 55F. Evaluate the humidity ratio, relative humidity, and dew point
temperature using (a) equations and steam tables and (b) the psychrometric chart
method.
8.30 A zone is to be maintained at 72F dry-bulb and 50% relative humidity. The zone
sensible and latent loads are 150,000 Btu/hr and 50,000 Btu/hr, respectively. The
supply-air temperature is to be 48F. What is the supply-air mass flow rate and volume
flow rate?
8.31 Rework the parts of Example 8.10 that are changed by reducing ventilation air to 10%
of supply air. Compare the coil cooling load and volume flow rate with the given
results.
8.32 Rework the parts of Example 8.10 that are changed by increasing the supply-air dry-
332
bulb temperature to 55F. Compare the coil mass and volume flow rates and cooling
load with the given results.
8.33 A room is to be maintained at 74F dry-bulb and 62F wet-bulb by a vapor compression
air conditioner. The total cooling load on the zone is 24,000 Btu/hr, and the latent load
is 4,000 Btu/hr. Outdoor air is provided for ventilation at 100F dry-bulb and 60%
relative humidity. The ventilation mass rate is 15% of the supply-air rate. Air leaving
the coil is at 52F dry-bulb.
(a) Show the significant states and processes on the psychrometric chart, and
construct a table of wet- and dry-bulb and dew point temperatures, enthalpy, humidity
ratio, specific volume and relative humidity for the space, outdoor, mixture, and
supply- air conditions.
(b) What are the mass and volume flow rates of return air, ventilation air, and supply
air?
(c) What is the coil cooling load in Btu/hr and in tons?
8.34 Resistance heaters are switched on in 5-kW increments to satisfy the demand for heat
from the electric heat pump system characterized by Figure 8.15. At what temperatures
should the first and second 5-kW banks be turned on?
8.35 Indicate whether the following are true or false:
(a) An isotherm on a steam p-V diagram is a line of constant relative humidity for a
given total moist air pressure.
(b) The saturated vapor line on a steam p-V diagram is a line of constant relative
humidity for a given total moist air pressure.
(c) Increasing partial pressure of water vapor for fixed moist air pressure always
increases relative humidity.
(d) Increasing partial pressure of water vapor for a fixed moist air pressure and fixed
dry-bulb temperature always increases relative humidity.
(e) Decreasing dry-bulb temperature for fixed moist air pressure and fixed water
vapor pressure always increases relative humidity.
333
C H A P T E R 9
ADVANCED SYSTEMS
9.1 Introduction
For decades the response to the ever-growing need for electric generation capacity
was to build a new steam power plant, one not very different from the last. Today
the energy conversion engineer is faced with a variety of issues and emerging
technologies and a changing social and technological climate in which a diversity
of approaches is likely to be accepted. This chapter intends to indentify some of
these concerns and opportunities. No claim of completeness is made. No chapter,
or book for that matter, could thoroughly cover this domain. The reader is referred
to the bibliography at the end of the chapter as a starting point for continued study.
A few characteristics of importance in new power initiatives are: low capital
and operating costs, ability to operate with a variety of fuels and with high
tolerance to fuel variability, short construction time, low emission of pollutants,
marketable or at least inert and easily disposable waste products, and high
efficiency, maintainability, financeability, and reliability. Increasingly, the new
initiative may take the form of repowering the the old plant so as to increase
efficiency, meet pollution standards, and minimize the financial impact of meeting
new power demands.
The improvement of the efficiency of power plants using conventional cycles
is usually evolutionary in nature, by virtue of high temperature limitations and
advances in materials. Hence, only gradual improvements in efficiency can be
expected. On the other hand, significant improvements in efficiency can
sometimes be obtained by combining conventional cycles in appropriate ways.
Such power plants are referred to as combined-cycle plants. This chapter will
examine the characteristics of several combined-cycle plants.
It is evident from the study of the Rankine and Brayton cycles, and in fact all
heat engines, that the rejection of large amounts of thermal energy to the
surroundings accompanies the production of useful power. This heat rejection can
be reduced by improving the thermal efficiency of the cycle but cannot be
eliminated. If this energy is not to be wasted, it is logical to seek applications
where both power and rejected heat may be utilized. Power plants that produce
mechanical or electrical power and utilize waste heat for industrial processes are
called cogeneration plants. Several examples of cogeneration are considered in
this chapter. District heating and other possible applications of waste heat are also
discussed.
Another key problem facing the energy conversion engineer is the anticipated
scarcity, in a few decades, of fuels such as natural gas and oil, relative to the vast
resources of coal available in the United States and elsewhere. Perhaps future
power plants should utilize this coal and nuclear energy to save the natural gas and
334
petroleum for industrial feedstocks and other more critical future needs. On the
other hand, serious problems exist with respect to utilization of these resources.
Nuclear power, an important alternative, replete with problems, is considered in
the next chapter. Much of the readily available coal has unacceptably high sulfur,
which significantly degrades the environment when released from power plant
stacks in untreated combustion products. The well-known problem of acid rain has
been attributed to emissions from coal-burning power plants. Thus the search for
technology to utilize medium- and high-sulfur coal and to reduce levels of
pollutant emissions of all types is an important area for research and development.
In this chapter advanced technologies that may contribute solutions to these
and other crucial problems are considered. Some recent U.S. Department of
Energy efforts in these areas may be found in Reference 66.
9.2 Combined-Cycle Power
One of the unfavorable characteristics of the gas turbine is that the exhaust gas
issuing from the turbine is at high temperature, thereby wasting much energy and
creating a local hazard. One solution to this problem was considered in Chapter 5:
the addition of an exhaust gas heat exchanger to preheat the combustion air. The
resulting regenerative cycle was found to be much more efficient than the
corresponding simple cycle and to produce a lower exhaust gas temperature.
An alternative approach to dealing with the high gas turbine exhaust
temperature is to provide a separate bottoming cycle to convert some of the energy
of the turbine exhaust into additional power. Lets consider the use of a Rankine
cycle that uses gas turbine exhaust as its energy source. It is clear that, if the
Rankine cycle does not interfere with the operation of the gas turbine, the
combined cycle will produce additional power and will have a higher efficiency
than the gas turbine alone. Even if more heat is required for the Rankine
bottoming cycle to produce additional work, the overall combined efficiency will
increase if the additional work is large enough and supplemental heat small
enough.
A combined gas turbineRankine cycle can be implemented in several ways.
One method makes use of the fact that the exhaust of gas turbines usually has a
high residual oxygen content because of the high air-fuel ratio required to limit the
turbine inlet temperature when burning conventional fossil fuels. This hot,
oxygen-rich exhaust gas can be used instead of air as the oxidizer in a steam
generator as shown in Figure 9.1. For a moderate expenditure of additional natural
gas in the furnace the resulting combustion products can provide heat for a high-
temperature steam cycle with conventional steam plant technology.
The Horseshoe Lake combined-cycle plant was designed in this way to yield
additional power and high efficiency when operating in the combined mode, and to
operate with the gas turbine alone or with the steam turbine alone by direct-firing
335
of the steam generator with fuel and air. The plant, about ten miles east of
Oklahoma City, was the first its kind, first producing power in 1963. It was
designed for a net output of 200 MW and a net heat rate of 9350 Btu/kW-hr. The
plant cross-section and photos of the turbines are seen in Figures 9.29.4. Note the
evaporative cooler to reduce the temperature and to increase the density of the air
entering the gas turbine compressor. This reduces compressor work and increases
inlet mass flow rate. Twenty years of successful operating experience with the
Horseshoe Lake plant and information on similar German plants is documented in
reference 46.
An open-cycle gas turbine also may be linked to a steam cycle through what
may be considered a gas turbine exhaust heat exchanger containing an economizer,
a boiler, and perhaps a superheater. This device, called a heat-recovery steam
generator (HRSG), may be used to create and superheat steam as in a conven-
tional steam cycle. A flow diagram for such a cycle is shown in Figure 9.5,
together with a T-s diagram for the steam bottoming cycle. Gas turbine exhaust
gas cools as it superheats, boils, and then warms liquid water in counterflow as it
passes through the HRSG.
336
337
Combined-Cycle Analysis
Assuming a constant heat capacity for the gas turbine combustion gas, we may
compare gas temperatures with adjacent HRSG local water temperatures on the T-
s diagram, Figure 9.5, by applying the steady-flow First Law of Thermodynamics
to appropriate sections of the HRSG:
m
s
(h
12
h
11
) = m
g
C
pg
(T
6
T
7
) = m
s
A
1
[Btu/hr | kJ/hr] (9.1)
m
s
(h
13
h
12
) = m
g
C
pg
(T
5
T
6
) = m
s
A
2
[Btu/hr | kJ/hr] (9.2)
m
s
(h
8
h
13
) = m
g
C
pg
(T
4
T
5
) = m
s
A
3
[Btu/hr | kJ/hr] (9.3)
where m
s
and m
g
are the mass flow rates for the steam and gas turbine cycles,
respectively, and the A
i
(i = 1, 2, 3) are the areas on the T-s diagram representing
heat transfer per unit mass of steam. By adding the three equations, we obtain the
same equation as would result from application of the steady-flow First Law of
Thermodynamics to the entire HRSG:
m
s
(h
8
h
11
) = m
g
C
pg
(T
4
T
7
)
= m
s
( A
1
+ A
2
+ A
3
) [Btu/hr | kJ/hr] (9.4)
Thus the enthalpy rise of the steam in the HRSG is controlled by the ratio of mass
flow rates and the hot-gas temperature drop. Expressing gas temperature in the
HRSG in terms of steam enthalpy allows us to condense these equations into
T = T
7
+ (m
s
/m
g
C
pg
)(h h
11
) [R | K] (9.5)
It is evident that the gas temperature is linearly proportional to the water enthalpy
on a T-h diagram, as shown in Figure 9.6. The abscissa may be viewed as the
cumulative heat transfer per unit mass of water, which is in turn proportional to the
exhaust gas heat transfer.
The temperature difference T
6
T
12
, known as the pinchpoint temperature
difference, is at a critical location in the heat recovery steam generator, because it
occurs at the point of minimum temperature difference between the two fluids. It
should exceed some minimum design value (about 30F) for all operating
conditions of the system to make effective use of all of the HRSG heat transfer
surface. Smaller temperature differences would substantially increase the heat
transfer surface area needed, while significantly larger values would necessitate
reducing the boiling temperature and would adversely affect the combined-cycle
thermal efficiency.
338
EXAMPLE 9.1
Let us examine several possible Rankine bottoming cycles for the gas turbine
considered earlier in Example 5.1. There a gas turbine with a compressor pressure
ratio of 6 and a turbine inlet temperature of 1860R was analyzed. The turbine
exhaust temperature was found to be 1273R, or 813F. With 813F as the HRSG
gas entrance temperature, select the steam turbine throttle temperature as 700F
and consider Rankine cycles with a range of boiling temperatures, a condensing
temperature of 100F, and a pinchpoint temperature difference of at least 30F.
Determine a cycle with a satisfactory boiling temperature, and compare it with
339
other cycles in the family. Take the HRSG gas exit temperature as 350F to avoid
condensation.
Solution
The spreadsheet in Table 9.1 follows the notation of Figures 9.5 and 9.6. It
tabulates three combined-cycle cases in which the boiling temperatures, T
12
= T
13
,
were selected as 300, 400, and 500F. These temperatures, together with the
throttle and condensing temperatures and the turbine efficiency, determine the
Rankine-cycle thermodynamic conditions (neglecting pump work). Equation (9.5)
relates the HRSG enthalpy changes to the corresponding gas temperatures. Thus
with a mass ratio R
mass
given by (h
8
h
11
)/(T
4
T
7
), the pinchpoint temperature T
6
for Case 2 is
T
6
= T
7
+ (m
s
/m
g
C
pg
)(h
12
h
11
) = T
7
+ (h
12
h
11
)/R
mass
= 350 + (375.1 68)/2.82 = 350 + 108.9 = 459F
340
and the pinchpoint temperature difference is
T
6
T
12
= 459 400 = 59F
Again, by Equation (9.5),
T
5
= 350 + (1201 68)/2.82 = 350 + 401.8 = 752F
With temperatures and enthalpies determined, work, heat, and efficiency
values may be determined as usual, observing carefully the distinction between
steam-mass and gas-mass references. It is seen that Case 2 has a satisfactory
pinchpoint temperature difference and a combined-cycle efficiency of 39%, which
is significantly greater than that of the gas turbine cycle (25%) and Rankine-cycle
(29%) operating separately. The temperature distributions for this case are shown
in Figure 9.7.
__________________________________________________________________
341
More than one gas turbine could be used in conjunction with a single steam
turbine by using a larger HRSG and multiple gas turbine exhaust ducts.
Alternatively, each gas turbine may have its own HRSG, with all HRSGs
thermally coupled to the steam turbine through feedwater and steam line headers.
An HRSG may be designed to burn additional fuel at its inlet using oxygen
remaining in the gas turbine combustion gas to raise the temperature the HRSG
gas and provide higher heat transfer to the water. Such a design is called a fired
HRSG, and its use is usually referred to as supplemental firing.
Figure 9.8 shows large heat-recovery steam generators built for a nominal 450-
MW combined-cycle plant in Texas utilizing three 100-MW gas turbines and one
140-MW steam turbine.
The Comanche power station, located near Lawton, Oklahoma, is an example
of a combined-cycle facility that employs HRSGs. Two Westinghouse simple-
cycle natural-gas-fired gas turbines, as diagramed in Figure 9.9, drive 85-MW
electrical generators and exhaust into separate HRSGs designed for supplemental
firing. Steam at 1200 psia and 950F produced by the HRSGs is supplied to one
nonreheat, single-extraction (not shown) steam turbine that drives a 120-MW
electrical generator.
The Comanche unit, first operated in 1974 (ref. 10) was upgraded in 1986 (ref.
11), resulting in a measured plant heat rate of 8508 Btu/kW-hr (40.1% thermal
efficiency), with a gas turbine inlet temperature of 1993F, an HRSG gas inlet
342
temperature of 1200F, and supplemental firing. In 1986, the plan was indentified
by the Utility Data Institute as the most efficient steam-electric generating station
in the United States, with an average net plant heat rate of 8821 Btu/kW-hr
(thermal efficiency of 38.7%).
High-temperature combined-cycle plants are now achieving thermal
efficiencies exceeeding 50%. A combined-cycle heat rate for a United Technol-
ogies Turbo Power FT8 gas turbine is said to operate at a gross plant heat rate of
6815 Btu/kW-hr (50.1%) based on lower heating value (ref. 51). Reference 50
indicates that the Pegus Unit 12 combined-cycle cogeneration plant in the
Netherlands produces 223.3 MW at maximum electrical output, with a net
electrical yield of 51.74% based on lower heating value. According to reference
67, Both GE and Siemens Westinghouse turbines will be able to break the 60 per
cent efficiency barrier in combined-cycle operation, and a 3 to 6 per cent reduction
in CO
2
emissions should be possible because of the increased efficiency.
343
9.3 Integrated Gasification Combined-Cycle (IGCC) Power Plants
The Cool Water IGCC Plant
One approach to the problem of clean coal utilization lies in the technology
exemplified by the Cool Water integrated gasification combined cycle (IGCC)
power plant located near Barstow, California. This plant, which went into
operation in 1984, demonstrated the capability of producing power for the
344
Southern California Edison System with very low levels of pollutants by using
both low-sulfur and medium-sulfur coals. The Cool Water demonstration plant
shown in Figure 9.10 (named after the ranch on which it is located) utilized a coal
gasification technique known as the Texaco process. The medium-heating-value
synthetic gas called syngas produced by the process has about one-third the
heating value of natural gas, about 265 Btu per standard cubic foot on a dry basis.
As it is produced, the syngas is first cooled, then treated to remove pollutants,
and finally burned to drive turbine generators, as seen in Figure 9.11. The initial
cooling in the syngas coolers produces saturated steam,which is later superheated
by gas turbine exhaust gas in an HRSG, to power a steam turbine (path A in the
diagram). The syngas emerging from the coolers (path B) is processed to remove
particulates and sulfur and to control oxides of nitrogen, and is then burned in the
gas turbine to produce additional power. The high-temperature gas turbine exhaust
(path C) then passes through the heat-recovery steam generator, adding energy to
the steam before it passes to the steam turbine. Thus the gasifier flows and the
steam turbine and gas turbine flows interact, hence the name integrated
gasification combined cycle, IGCC.
The Texaco process requires oxygen of at least 95% purity to gasify the coal in
the gasifier. The Cool Water plant thus has a small, independently owned oxygen
plant (seen surrounding the single tower left of center in figure 9.10) that separates
345
oxygen from air to feed the gasifier. The Cool Water plant produces oxygen of
99.5% purity in order to produce argon as a by-product (as mentioned earlier, the
process otherwise requires only 95% purity). Nitrogen is also a by-product.
Oxygen is produced continually for gasifier use, but oxygen is also stored so that
the IGCC plant can continue to operate if the oxygen plant is shut down.
A coal slurry, a mixture of nominally 60% coal and 40% water produced in a
wet grinding process, is introduced with oxygen into the Texaco gasifier (Figure
9.11), where partial combustion of the coal takes place at about 600 psig and
2500F. The gasifier yields a mixture of mainly carbon dioxide, carbon monoxide,
and hydrogen gases, with sulfur primarily in the form of hydrogen sulfide. A
relatively inert slag containing most of the mineral matter of the coal passes from
the gasifier into a pool of water in the bottom of the radiant cooler. The slag is
taken out periodically through a lockhopper process. The seal at the bottom of the
radiant cooler is maintained by the water that is recycled.
The syngas, after cooling in the radiant and convective coolers, passes through
a carbon scrubber, where a water spray removes most of the particulates and
further cools the gas. After additional cooling to ambient temperature, the gas
flows to a sulfur-removal unit, where a solvent removes the hydrogen sulfide and
therefore most of the sulfur from the stream. The relatively particle-free and
sulfur-free gas is then saturated with moisture to control the formation of oxides of
nitrogen (NO
x
) during combustion in the gas turbine. The water-quenching process
suppresses NO
x
formation by reducing the gas combustion temperature, and it also
increases the turbine power output by adding to the mass flow in the gas turbine
combustor. Combustion gases from the gas turbine then pass through the heat
346
recovery steam generator, where they produce additional steam as they drop in
temperature to about 400F. The combustion products leaving the plant are
remarkably pollutant free. Performance of the Cool Water Station is summarized
in Table 9.2 below.
Table 9.2 Cool Water IGCC Station Nominal Performance
Gas turbine electric generator power 65 MW
Steam turbine electric generator power +55 MW
Gross power 120 MW
Air-separation oxygen plant 17 MW
Internal plant consumption 7 MW
Net power 96 MW
Design heat rate 11,510 Btu/kW-hr
Observed heat rate 10,950 Btu/kW-hr
Source: Reference 3.
The operators of the Cool Water station have demonstrated values of critical
pollutants well below current environmental limits for both permit and regulatory
limits and New Source Performance Standards (NSPS), as indicated in Table 9.3.
The Cool Water plant has operated successfully with Utah run-of-mine coal with
0.4% sulfur, Illinois #6 coal with 3.1% sulfur, and Pittsburg #8 coal with 2.9%
sulfur. The sulfur removal process in the plant yields about 99.6% pure elemental
sulfur, which can be sold for the production of sulfuric acid and fertilizers. The
slag produced by the gasifier is considered nonhazardous and suitable for the
production of road-making materials or cement.
Table 9.3 Emissions from the Cool Water Station HRSG (lb/million Btu)
High Sulfur
Coal SO
2
Low Sulfur
Coal SO
2
NO
x
CO Particulate
Matter
Permit and regulatory limit 0.16 0.033 0.13 0.07 0.01
Utah coal 0.018 0.07 0.004 0.001
Illinois #6 0.068 0.094 0.004 0.009
Pittsburgh #8 0.122 0.066 <0.002 0.009
Federal NSPS 0.6 0.24 0.6 0.03
Source: Reference 3
The net effect of the plant then is to generate power efficiently by utilizing
widely available coals with sulfur content up to 3.5% in an environmentally sound
347
way while producing nonhazardous waste that offers the possibility of constructive
use.
It should be understood that the Cool Water plant was built as a demonstration
plant to prove a technology on a large but not a full scale. Engineering studies
based on the Cool Water operating experience (ref. 4) have indicated that a 360-
MW full-scale IGCC plant using Illinois #6 coal could be built with a net heat rate
of 9000 Btu/kW-hr at a capital cost of $1530/kW and with operating and
maintenance costs of 2.3 cents/kW-hr (or 5.2 cents/kW-hr, which includes all fixed
charges) (ref. 3). These costs are competitive with those for conventional new
coal-burning power plants using flue gas desulfurization.
An important feature of the IGCC plant concept is the attractiveness of phased
construction. A conventional coal-burning steam power plant must be constructed
as a unit and takes a relatively long time to erect. On the other hand, one or more
gas turbines of a planned IGCC plant may be quickly put into service using natural
gas as a fuel. Additional gas and steam turbines may be added later to transform
the plant into a combined-cycle plant, with coal gasifiers and an oxygen plant
added still later at a third stage. Because the units may be paid for as they are built,
phased construction offers significant financial benefits as well as ordely growth.
Significant materials problems have been overcome in the Texaco and Cool
Water plant technology. The inside of the gasifier requires refractory materials to
withstand the severely corrosive high-temperature environment. Cool Water
experience (ref . 5) indicates that 10,00014,000 hours of refractory life is
attainable. This implies that gasifier overhaul will be required at least every two
years. Additional problems with cooler tube-wall materials, coal slurry pumps, and
piping; and other severe material operating environments offer challenges for
materials research to improve IGCC operation.
Several of the references expand on the idea of cogenerationpolygeneration
by pointing out that, based on the Cool Water technology today, a single facility
whose only major requirements are air, water, and coal can simultaneously
produce electricity, steam, sulfur, inert slag for road construction, oxygen,
nitrogen, hydrogen, carbon monoxide, carbon dioxide, argon, methanol, other
chemical products, and even syngas.

The Dow Gasification Process
Another coal gasification process combined-cycle system (CGCC), developed by
Dow Chemical Co., operates in Plaquemine, Louisiana. Like the IGCC system,
the Dow process reacts a coal slurry with oxygen to produce syngas, from which
most of the sulfur is removed for by-product use. The raw syngas from the
gasifier produces steam in an HRSG, is cooled, passes through pollutant removal
equipment, and is burned in gas turbines. Reference 47 indicates that of the new
coal-based technologies, the CGCC system has the highest efficiency and the
lowest emission of environmental pollutants. The 161-MW plant, built in the
remarkable time of twenty-one months, was completed in 1987. The reference
indicates for CGCC plants a net heat rate based on lower heating value of 8670
348
Btu/kW-hr (39.4%) and a total capital cost of $1201/kW, based on 1988 dollars.
Additional information on combined-cycle coal gasification systems is given
references 58, 59, and 65. Tampa Electrics 250-MW IGCC Polk Power Station
began commercial operation in 1996. A website (ref. 65) indicates that the station
is 10-12% more efficient than conventional coal-fired plants.Three dimensional
views may be seen at the website.
9.4 Combustion in Fluidized Beds
The need to develop environmentally sound methods for utilizing a variety of
coals, industrial and municipal wastes, and other solids as fuels has stimulated
research in a variety of areas. Another prominent and promising technology
applicable to these goals is fluidized bed combustion (FBC). Atmospheric
fluidized bed combustors (AFBCs) operate near atmospheric pressure; pressurized
fluidized combustors (PFBCS) are enclosed in a pressure vessel and operate at a
pressure of about 12 atmospheres.
As the name suggests, a principal unique feature of this technology is that
combustion takes place in a bed of solid particles supported in vigorous, turbulent
motion on an upwardly directed stream of air. The bed may consist of a
combination of particles of fuel, sand, ash, waste materials, limestone, and other
compounds, depending on the function and design of the fluidized bed combustor.
The key point is that these materials mingle and react in continually changing
orientations, providing ample opportunity for intimate contact of fuel and oxidizer
and for removal of combustion products, while supported on the fluidizing air
stream. The name bubbling bed is sometimes used to decribe this action.
It has been found that horizontal water tubes located within the fluidized bed,
in crossflow to the upward air stream, experience very high heat transfer
coefficients in comparison with those in normal furnace convective and radiative
environments. It is even more important that fluidized beds containing coal and
limestone produce combustion gases with both low sulfur content and low
concentrations of oxides of nitrogen.
Limestone reacts with sulfur in the coal to produce particles of calcium sulfate
that are removed as bed materials are renewed. More specifically, the limestone,
CaCO
3
, reacts to form CO
2
and lime, CaO:
CaCO
3
=> CaO + CO
2
and the CaO reacts with the sulfate vapors:
H
2
SO
4
+ CaO => CaSO
4
+ H
2
O.
The calcium sulfate forms as a solid that becomes a bed material, and the water
vapor passes off as a component of the flue gas.
349
Oxides of nitrogen (NO
x
) produced by the FBC are maintained at low values,
because bed and gas temperatures are well below those at which NO
x
forms in
conventional combustors. The bed temperature is determined primarily by the rates
of air and fuel supplied. Normally, FBC bed temperatures are about 1550F,
compared with conventional furnace temperatures in the neighborhood of 3000F.
The reactivity of nitrogen is low at 1500F, and chemical equilibrium calculations
and laboratory observations show that the nitrogen in flue gas is almost entirely in
its normal, diatomic form.
The combustion of coal or other solids occurs largely at the interface between
the solid and the surrounding oxidizing gases. The rate at which the solid burns
depends on the rate at which oxygen is brought to the solid interface and on the
rate at which combustion products are removed, as well as on the rate of chemical
reaction at the interface itself. The vigorous relative motion of the bed particles
and the intervening air flow provide an excellent mechanism for delivery of
oxygen to and the transport of combustion products from the interface.
Normally, FBC occurs with enough excess air, in the primary supporting air
350
stream and possibly in a secondary over-fire air flow, that combustion is virtually
complete. Flyash and other airborne particles are removed by centrifugal
separators and baghouse filters. Solids from the separators may be reinjected into
the bed to further ensure almost complete burnup of carbon.
The circulating fluidized bed (CFB) combustor (refs. 26 and 30) is one in
which smaller solid bed materials are carried upward by the combustion air/gas
stream. A return passage transports the unburnt and inert particles and part of the
combustion gas back to the main furnace, allowing the remaining flue gas to pass
to the heat-recovery area, as seen in Figure 9.12. The solid bed materials continue
to burn as they circulate, thus maintaining an approximately uniform temperature
of about 1550F throughout the furnace. As a result, there is a long residence time
for particles of the furnace to complete their reactions. A mechanical cyclone
separator built into the furnace helps to separate the particles from the exiting flue
gas. As a result, reinjection of the unburnt carbon makes possible very high
combustion efficiencies.
According to reference 26, CFB designs achieve higher combustion efficiency,
reduced NO
x
emissions, minimum CO formation, and reduced limestone
utilization in capturing SO
2
when compared with bubbling fluidized bed
combustors. Much continues to be learned about problems and opportunities
inherent in fluidized bed combustion as more units come into use. In a December
1998 work (ref. 65), the U.S. Department of Energy (DOE) proposed a 379-MWe,
pressurized circulating fluidized bed combustor combined-cycle plant with a net
efficiency of 47%.
9.5 Energy Storage
It has been observed that there is no existing means of storing electrical power on a
large scale. As a consequence, power generation varies from instant to instant, to
satisfy the immediate demands of consumers. Utility generation capacity must
therefore be great enough to satisfy the peak demand, or the utility must purchase
power at a premium from other utilities to make up its generation deficit.
Demand varies from place to place, seasonally, daily, and hourly. For
instance, the loads of utilities in the southern United States are usually greatest
during hot summer days, when air conditioning and industrial demands coincide.
As a result, southern utilities may have excess capacity at night and in the winter.
It were possible to generate a full capacity during off-peak hours and store the
energy in excess of demand, the utilities could operate with installed capacity
below the demand peak and operate more units as base-load plants close to their
high-efficiency design points.
351
Pumped Storage
One approach to off-peak energy storage utilizes a high reservoir into which water
from a low elevation is pumped, using electricity generated during off-peak hours.
Thus energy may be stored in the form of potential energy of the elevated water
for later use during peak loads. There are about thirty such pumped-storage
facilities in the United States.
Figure 9.13 depicts the two phases of operation of a pumped-storage facility.
These installations usually employ motor-generator sets driven by hydraulic
turbines. Mechanically reversible pump-turbines generate electricity by using
water from an elevated reservoir during periods of peak demand. When there is an
excess of base-load power, the motor-generators can be reversed to drive the
pump-turbines as pumps for filling the reservoir.
It is clear that net energy is lost in the use of pumped storage. Its success relies
on the availability of cheap power during off-peak hours and consistent demand
for electricity, with its associated high price during peak hours. Pumped storage
allows utilities to generate more electricity with their most efficient base-load
plants instead of handling peaks with less efficient equipment.
Figure 9.14 is a photograph of the Salina pumped-storage facility (ref. 34) of
the Grand River Dam Authority, located about 50 miles from Tulsa, Oklahoma.
The facility was designed for gradual expansion, in three steps, from the 130-MW
configuration that went online in 1968, to the current 260-MW facility shown in
352
the figure, to a 520-MW final modification. The eventual completion of the
project will require the development of an additional upper reservoir as well as
construction of six additional penstocks and the installation of their hydroelectric
pump-turbine motor-generator sets. The present plant is capable of producing
power at full-rated load for eight hours a day or at part load for twelve hours a day.
The reservoir is 251 feet above the lower lake. The penstocks are 14 feet in
diameter and 720 feet long.
Reference 36 identifies an early pumped-storage facility named Rocky River at
New Milford, Conn., which was in operation in 1928. The limited number of high
head surface sites for such facilities, the high capital cost of building a dam, and
the large land area impacted by these facilities make the future use of pumped
storage questionable. Reference 37, however, predicted continued growth in
pumped storage capacity. One possibility that would support such growth is to
have the upper pool at ground level and to use underground mines for the lower
pool (ref. 38). Another is the development of low head facilities.
353
Compressed-Air Energy Storage
A relatively new approach to energy storage is compressed-air energy storage
(CAES), which employs underground caverns for storage of air under pressure
(refs. 25 and 49). Air is compressed into the cavern using off-peak power and later
is released to oxidize fuel in a gas turbine combustor to generate electrical power
during hours of peak demand. The first CAES plant, a 290-MW unit, first
operated at Huntorf, West Germany, in 1978. A second CAES plant located in
McIntosh, Ala, with phased construction of two 110-MW units, first went on-line
in May, 1991 (ref. 64).
CAES plants are located in the vicinity of underground caverns. The caverns
may be natural or may be created and/or enlarged by solution-mining of under-
ground salt domes. In solution-mining, water is pumped into a salt formation, the
water dissolves salt locally, enlarging the cavern, and the resulting brine is pumped
to the surface, where the salt is driven from the solution and the water reused.
Figure 9.15 shows a schematic of the McIntosh plant. During off-peak hours a
motor-generator, powered by electricity produced elsewhere in the utility system
and with turbine-expander clutch disengaged, drives the compressor set that packs
air into the salt cavern. Later, air is allowed to escape from the cavern to oxidize
fuel at the high cavern pressure, forming combustion gas to pass through the gas
turbines (expanders) that drive the motor-generator in the generation mode with
354
the compressor clutch disengaged. The generator thus is able to return electricity to
the utility system during periods of peak demand.
The CAES plant is essentially a gas turbine in which the compression process
is decoupled from the power delivery process. During daily cyclical operation, the
mass of air supplied to the cavern at night is utilized during the day. Since the
charging period may be different than the utilization period, the average mass rates
of storage and delivery may differ. The McIntosh plant is designed for twenty-six
hours of storage capacity and therefore does not operate on a strict daily cycle but
rather on a weekly cycle that takes advantage of less expensive weekend power.
The presence of the recuperator in the McIntosh plant, the first in use in a
CAES facility, provides regeneration, which, as discussed in Chapter 5,
substantially reduces gas turbine fuel consumption and thus improves plant
efficiency. Regeneration may also be accomplished by absorption and storage of
the heat of compression of the air in an aftercooling, high heat capacity heat
exchanger such as a pebble bed recuperator. The stored energy is later returned to
the air discharged from the cavern as it flows to the turbines.
The success of a CAES plant, like that of pumped storage, depends on the
availability of cheap, off-peak power. The objective is to drive the compressor
train during these periods so that high-priced power may be produced later in
periods of high demand. It should be noted that the compression process is not
only decoupled mechanically from the power delivery process, but the compress-
ion process may take place over a longer period of time than the period of CAES
power production. This allows the use of smaller compressors than would be
needed for a conventional peaking gas turbine. According to reference 25, the
Huntorf plant compresses for 4 hours, and the McIntosh plant for 1.7 hours, for
each hour of power production. CAES may become a more viable option in the
United States than surface pumped storage because of the existence of more
potential sites and lower land surface area requirements for CAES.
9.6 District Heating and Cooling and Cogeneration
Comfort heating and cooling in homes, businesses, and industry consumes large
quantities of energy. Much of this low-temperature-energy use is accomplished by
the direct or indirect burning of fossil fuels and high temperature. Electrical
resistance heating, especially, and heat pumps may be included in this because the
electricity they consume is produced largely from high-temperature sources. Many
believe that these are inappropriate uses of fossil fuels, in a conservation sense,
because of the unnecessary loss of the availability of high-temperature energy to
do work. It is simply a reflection of the desirability of using high temperatures
where needed and low-temperature sources for low-temperature functions. For
instance, it is no revelation that some of the obligatory heat rejection by modern
heat engines is at a high enough temperature to supply energy for comfort heating
and cooling.
355
District heating, the provision of heat to a populated area by a nearby central
heating plant, has been in use for one hundred years or more. More recently the
addition of cooling to such plants has become widespread. Now, colleges and
universities frequently have such a facility. Shopping malls and blocks of business
districts in many cities also take advantage of the economic benefits provided by a
central plant. This is usually accomplished through the use of boilers that produce
hot water or steam for heating, and by vapor compression or steam-driven
absorption refrigeration machines that produce chilled water for cooling. Water,
steam, or brine is usually used to deliver the energy to the user.
In municipal facilities, the steam, water, or brine is metered and circulated in
insulated pipes under the streets to air-handling units and other point-of-use
devices in the customers buildings, and thence to return pipes that bring the fluid
back to the central plant or, in single-pipe one-way systems, to sewer mains.
Until recently, most of the district heating facilities the United States did not
find significant advantage in producing electrical power and using the waste heat
for district heating, cooling, or industrial process energy. With Europes more
limited energy resources, combined heat and power (CHP), or cogeneration, the
synergistic generation of electric power and heat, found more extensive use there
than in United States following the Second World War. In fact, a number of steam
turbines and closed-cycle gas turbines burning a variety fuels were developed for
simultaneous electric power generation and district heating or industrial
cogeneration purposes (refs. 12 and 1520). These activities are closely related to
total energy systems, which seek to utilize natural gas for other purposes while
generating electricity (ref. 17). In the United States this term has been used in the
past for the promotion of natural-gas-burning systems that provided heating,
cooling, and electricity for shopping malls, colleges, and similar customers.
Some of the possible cogeneration steams include:
1. Steam turbine power with condenser heat rejection for low-temperature
processes, facility heating, or district heating.
2. Steam turbine power with steam extraction or use of a back-pressure turbine
for process or district heating use.
3. Steam turbine power with exhaust steam or steam extraction heat transfer to
absorption refrigeration system generators for chilling processes or district
cooling in summer.
4. Closed-cycle gas turbine power with coolers (intercoolers and pre-coolers)
used for district heating.
5. Closed-cycle gas turbine power with coolers used with absorption
refrigeration system for chilling processes or district cooling in summer.
356
6. Open-cycle gas turbine power with exhaust heat recovery for process use or
district heating.
7. Diesel or gas reciprocating engine power with water-jacket cooling, oil
cooler, and/or exhaust gas heat recovery used for process or district heating.
A measure of the efficiency of energy utilization in a cogeneration plant is the
energy utilization factor, EUF, which is the sum of the net work, w, and the useful
heat produced, q
u
, divided by the energy supplied to achieve the combined heat
and work, q
in
, (ref. 18):
EUF = (w + q
u
)/q
in
[dl] (9.6)
Care should be taken when considering the EUF and the thermal efficiency of
a plant. The EUF is not restricted by the Carnot efficiency and can therefore
approach 100%. For instance, when there is no useful heat transfer, the EUF is the
plant thermal efficiency. At the other extreme, when no power is produced the
plant can utilize almost all the energy supplied by the fuel for useful heat; and
therefore the EUF could approach 100%. Thus the EUF is a measure of the extent
of productive use of the energy source, with no consideration for workuseful heat
proportions. An EUF in excess of 80 percent is possible for a CHP plant.
Other efficiencies for CHP plants may be defined. For instance, a weighting
factor might be used in the numerator of the EUF to attempt to give appropriate
weight to both heat and work. For example, since conventional power plants
convert heat to work with about 33% efficiency, one might define a special EUF*
as (w + 0.33q
u
)/q
in
for comparison with thermal efficiencies. While such factors
may be useful in evaluating the design of a plant, they should be applied with care.
Reference 18 discusses alternative definitions more fully.
9.7 Electricity Generation and Legislation
Historically, the electric power industry in the United States developed by
recognizing the economic advantages of scale of large central plants that used
extensive power transmission and distribution systems, following the lead of the
great governmental hydroelectric power projects. They also recognized the
enhanced growth potential inherent in the societys becoming totally electric.
The productive disposition of condensor rejected heat had no place as a revenue
producer in this scheme, for the important reasons that it would reduce plant
efficiency and power output and could not reach across the miles as power
transmission lines could. Individual consumers as well as industry happily
accepted this approach to the electrification of America, as electricity prices
dropped decade after decade. Natural-gas and fuel oil companies were also there
to satisfy the vast needs for heat.
More recently, energy-consuming industries came to recognize the possibilities
of simultaneous power and heat generation to satisfy their energy requirements. At
357
the same time, a consciousness grew that there are limits to the worlds energy
resources and that a more thoughtful stewardship of them would be prudent, when
it is economically attractive. However, in the early 1970s the OPEC oil embargo
brought these notions into clearer focus, and federal legislation in 1978 brought
cogeneration to everyones attention with the enactment of PURPA, the Public
Utility Regulatory Policies Act (ref. 14).
PURPA, a part of the National Energy Act, was intended to bring competition
into the electric power generation business and to increase the national
effectiveness of energy utilization by making cogeneration more economically
attractive. It required that utilities purchase power from qualified cogenerators at a
reasonable price, created tax incentives for developers, and established the Federal
Energy Regulatory Commission, FERC, to regulate and administer the activity.
Prospective cogenerators must apply to the FERC for certification as a qualified
facility, QF. The FERC, however, left the deliberation of what constitutes a fair
price to state public utility commissions. As a result, industrial cogeneration
thrives in some states and is virtually nonexistent and others. PURPA requires
utilities to buy electricity from QFs at the marginal cost of new generation, that is,
the cost of electricity generated by new power plant if it were built, the so-called
avoided cost.
The growth of cogeneration, state and national actions to change the regulatory
structure of the electric utility industry, the difficulties of acquiring capital for
large, long-term projects and other uncertainties are significantly changing the
outlook and structure of the utility industry (ref. 21). Utilities now appear to be
looking toward incremental and modular growth and the avoidance of long-term
commitment, which is reflected in their reluctance or inability to undertake the
construction of large, capital-intensive base-load plants. Legislative changes in the
1990's and beyond are bringing substantial deregulation to the industry, open
access to power transmission systems, and the introduction of merchant plants
created to offer electricity to the highest bidder in the new free-enterprise climate
(ref. 66).
9.8 Steam-Injected Gas Turbines
Water injection has been used for many years for brief augmentation of the thrust
of jet engines. More recently, liquid water injection and steam injection have been
used to control the formation of NO
x
in gas turbines. Injection of water or steam
into the combustion chamber reduces the combustion temperature, which in turn
suppresses the formation of NO
x
caused by high temperature. Power output is
maintained or increased because the injection increases both the turbine mass flow
and the energy extraction by the turbine. The latter is possible because the heat
capacity of steam is almost twice that of normal combustion products. Thus the
enthalpy change of steam for a given temperature drop is about double that of air
or combustion gas. If water is injected as a liquid, additional energy must be
extracted from the combustion gas to vaporize the water.
358
As a consequence of these considerations, an important cogeneration technol-
ogy is emerging. The steam-injected gas turbine, STIG
TM*
or SIGT, uses the gas
turbine exhaust flow through an HRSG to produce steam that is partially or
entirely injected into the gas turbine combustion chamber and possibly the
compressor and/or turbine, as indicated in Figure 9.16, resulting in augmented gas
turbine power output. Reduced steam requirements for process use in an industrial
cogeneration plant may be used to increase electrical power generation, which in
turn may be sold to a local utility under PURPA if it is not needed for other on-site
uses.
References 13, 22, 23, and 31 show increased power output, increased thermal
efficiency, and reduced NO
x
as benefits of steam injection. Table 9.4, for example,
lists performance measurements of the effects of steam injection into two
industrial gas turbines. The table shows that as the cogeneration process steam
percentage is reduced and the steam flow to the gas turbine increases accordingly,
substantial increases in power output and thermal efficiency are consistently
attained. Thus the steam-injected gas turbine holds considerable promise for
cogeneration and process applications.
A cross-section of the General Electric LM 5000 gas turbine without steam
injection is shown in Figure 9.17; a photo of the same is presented in Figure 9.18.
The LM 5000 is a compact, high-performance, aeroderivative gas turbine intended
for marine and industrial applications. It is derived from the CF6 family of high-
bypass-ratio turbofan engines but burns either distillates or natural gas fuels. The
LM 5000 has a dual-rotor gas generator and a three-stage power turbine. The
manufacturer quotes a power output of 46,200 shaft horsepower (34,451 kW) and
a heat rate of 9160 Btu/kW-hr at a power turbine speed of 3600 rpm for the LM
5000 without STIG.
____________________
*STIG is a trademark of General Electric Co., U.S.A.
359
Table 9.4 Performance of Steam-Injected Gas Turbines with Unfired HRSG
Cogeneration Steam
Percentage
Power Output (kW) Thermal Efficiency
Allison 501-KH
100% 3500 0.24
50% 4750 0.30
0% 6000 0.35
General Electric LM5000
100% 33000 0.33 (0.36)
50% 40000 0.36 (0.38)
0% 47000 0.38 (0.42)
Adapted from reference 22. Data in parentheses from references 56 and 57.
360
361
A schematic of the LM 5000 STIG configuration is shown in Figure 9.19; a photo
of the same is presented in Figure 9.20. The steam manifolds and injection lines
may be seen in both figures. Table 9.4 shows the performance of this configur-
ation without supplemental firing of the HRSG. With full STIG and supplemental
firing, the power output increases to 72,100 shaft horsepower (53,765 kW) and a
heat rate of 7580 Btu/kW-hr (or a thermal efficiency of 45%) is attained.
362
Figure 9.21 shows the average steam generation capability of the engine exhaust
with an unfired HRSG having a 30F pinchpoint temperature difference. It is seen
that, as expected, higher steam flow rates are obtained with reduced steam temp-
erature and pressure for given HRSG exhaust and turbine exhaust temperatures.
A study the economic advantages of steam-injected gas turbines for utility use
relative to the combined-cycle power plant (ref. 33) has shown combined cycles to
be superior in unit sizes above 50 MW. However, utilities are becoming
increasingly interested in plants of 50 MW or less because of their small size and
quick availability.
Intercooled Steam-Injected Gas Turbines
A modification of the steam-injected gas turbine is ISTIG, or, intercooled STIG, in
which steam is injected into compressor bleed air for turbine cooling, together with
steam injection into the combustor and into one or more turbine stages (ref. 22).
The enhanced blade cooling allows increased turbine inlet temperature and further
power and efficiency increases. The reference predicts efficiencies for ISTIG
turbines better than for existing combined cycles and comparable to advanced
combined cycles. Thus STIG and ISTIG show great promise for cogeneration
applications and are likely to find their way into future power generation plans.
Steam-Injected Gas Turbine Analysis
The influence of steam injection into the combustor can be analyzed with a model
that accounts for the major effects on the engine performance: the added mass and
363
364
heat capacity of steam in the turbine flow. The model assumes the following:
+Downstream steam injection has no effect on the compressor.
+The properties of steam may be represented by constant values of the heat
capacity C
ps
: 1.86 kJ/kg-K and 0.444 Btu / lb
m
-R.
+The heat capacity of the mixture of combustion gas and steam may be repre-
sented by a temperature-independent mass-weighted heat capacity given by
C
pm
= C
pg
+ (m
s
/m
a
)C
ps
[Btu/lb
m
-R | kJ/kg-K]
where m
s
/m
a
is the steam-air mass ratio. Here, as before, the mass of fuel is
neglected with respect to the mass of air.
+The isentropic exponent of the mixture, k
m
, remains the isentropic exponent
of combustion gas with no water injection, k
m
= k
g
= 4/3.
+The fuel control system maintains the turbine inlet temperature at a constant
value, irrespective of steam injection rate.
EXAMPLE 9.2
Consider the injection of steam in the combustion chamber of the single-shaft gas
turbine studied in Example 5.1. Five pounds of steam are injected for every
hundred pounds of compressor discharge air. The fuel flow rate is adjusted to
maintain the turbine inlet temperature at a constant 1400F. Compare the power
output for a compressor flow rate of 100 lb
m
/s, the thermal efficiency, the work
ratio, and the fuel-air ratio with like parameters for the machine with no injection.
Assume that the steam injected is saturated at the combustor pressure level and is
heated by the turbine exhaust from pressurized feedwater at 70F in a heat-
recovery steam generator as shown in Figure 9.22.
Solution
Table 9.5 presents the spreadsheet solution as well as the no-injection
reference solution, which is repeated there for convenience.
The algorithm is based on the assumptions just enumerated and uses the HRSG
analysis techniques discussed in section 9.2 in connection with the combined-cycle
steam generator study. Steam conditions entering the combustor are obtained from
the saturated-vapor tables, assuming constant pressure mixing at the known com-
bustor pressure level; feed water conditions are for saturated liquid water at 70F.
365
366
A 3-point increase in thermal efficiency and a substantial increase in power
output due to steam injection are evident.
The steam generator easily provides the required steam mass with a large
pinchpoint temperature difference. This indicates that the turbine exhaust gas is
capable of producing a still larger steam fraction with a smaller pinchpoint
temperature difference while maintaining acceptable exhaust gas temperature with
respect to the exhaust gas dew point.
__________________________________________________________________
By expanding the spreadsheet, with mass rate as a parameter, we present the
influences of increased steam mass rate on performance and on steam generator
steam-air temperature differences in Figures 9.23 and 9.24, respectively. The
figures indicate that steam-air mass ratios up to about 0.18 are possible with this
configuration and that substantial performance benefits are the result.
367
368
9.9 Resource Recovery
The disposal of municipal and industrial solid waste has become a national
concern with significant energy conversion aspects. It has been estimated that
50% of sanitary landfills that are convenient or accessible to urban areas would be
fully utilized in the 1990s and that satisfactory new sites will be progressively
more difficult to find. This has led to the rapid growth of the resource recovery
industry.
Resource recovery deals with the environmentally sound disposal of municipal
and industrial waste. It starts, at one extreme, with garbage landfills and
incineration and extends to the ultimate conversion of components of waste to
their useful constituent elements, with recovery of available energy in the process.
Vigorous activity in this area is producing a variety of approaches to the problem.
Many of the solutions focus on the development of a central waste disposal facility
that receives and prepares waste for efficient landfill disposal. This section
considers a modern facility that reduces the volume of about 1125 tons per day of
solid waste by over 90% by burning, to produce steam for industrial use and to
generate electricity when steam is not needed.
369
Figure 9.25 shows a modern facility designed to serve the waste disposal needs
of almost 500,000 Tulsa-area residents. The plant is similar in many respects to
the power plant steam generators discussed earlier. Major exceptions are the
modifications required to deal with the unique problems of handling municipal
solid waste (MSW). The right foreground of Figure 9.25 shows where waste
haulers trucks are weighed on outside scales and enter the facilitys tipping floor.
Large noncombustible materials and other refuse that cannot be burned in the
facility, such as steel bars and tires, are left outside the plant by the hauler for
separate disposal. The trucks dump the MSW in or near a large refuge storage pit
adjacent to the tipping floor and leave from the opposite side of the tipping floor
from which they entered.
Haulers are held responsible for the waste that they deliver, although overhead
crane operators who feed refuse to the three boilers also attempt to sort the refuse,
to help achieve uniform heat release in the furnace and to keep large, noncombust-
ible, hazardous, and otherwise inappropriate materials from entering the furnaces.
Figure 9.26 shows how refuse handled by cranes is hoisted from the holding pit
and lowered through near-vertical feed chutes (4) to inclined reciprocating-grate
furnaces (5). There, rugged hydraulically operated rams meter the flow of refuse
as they push it onto the grates. The combination of underfire air from a forced-
draft fan (6) and vertically reciprocating grates keeps the refuse in continuous
motion. Overfire air assures 98% burnup of combustible materials. Supply air for
the forced-draft fans is drawn from the tipping-floor enclosure (1), to retain odors
within the plant.
At the end of the grate, a variable-speed ash discharge roller controls the rate
of discharge and hence the depth of the ash bed at the end the grate. The ash falls
370
from the roller into a water-bath ash discharger that cools the residue. The water
also seals the bottom of the furnace, which is slightly below atmospheric pressure.
The cooling ash residue is pushed by a ram out of the water bath, up an inclined
surface, and into a compartment where water is allowed to drain off and evaporate
from the residue for fifteen minutes. The ash residue then falls to a conveyor,
where it is transported to the ash house. There, salvageable metals are separated
and recycled. The remaining ash is then trucked to a sanitary landfill. The plant
achieves about a 90% reduction in refuse volume delivered to the landfill.
In the furnaces, the combustion gas from the burning MSW on the grates heats
the water in the welded-membrane water walls of the furnaces and the various
steam generator tube banks (8-12). Each of the steam generators produces 88,500
lb
m
/hr of steam at 680 psia and 700F. The entire steam production passes in a 12-
inch underground steam line to a refinery about a mile away, for process use. In
figure 9.25, the refinery process plant utilizing the steam is located just beyond the
tank farm in the upper left. A steam turbine and generator set rated at 16 MW is
available for electrical generation as an alternative to refinery use of steam
production. The electricity may be used on site or sold to the local electric utility.
After leaving the economizer (12), combustion gas passes into an electrostatic
precipitator (14), where most of the fly ash remaining from the numerous passes
through the boiler is collected. The precipitators have automatic rapping systems
that free the collected particles, allowing them to drop into flyash hoppers to be
transported to the residue conveyor. Induced-draft fans (16) transport the cleaned
combustion gas from the precipitators to the stacks.
Tulsas Walter B. Hall Resource Recovery Facility, described here, is an
environmentally sound example of an increasing number of facilities operating or
under construction. These facilities typically are externally neat and are suited for
operation in industrial and some commercial locations. Massive reductions in
waste volumes are achieved in these facilities, with the possibility of generating
steam for process use, district heating, and steam turbine generation of electricity.
In resource recovery facilities of differing design, fluidized bed combustors might
be employed, and the released refuse heat might instead be used in connection
with closed-cycle gas turbines or other heat-driven devices.
9.10 Polytropic Efficiency
To this point the performance of turbomachinery has been represented by
isentropic efficiencies. In comparisons of turbomachines with differing pressure
ratios, the use of the isentropic efficiency gives an undeserved advantage to some
machines over others with different pressure ratios. Another approach to
efficiency, called the small-stage efficiency or polytropic efficiency, is considered
here as an alternative and, under certain circumstances, a more consistent way of
representing the quality of turbine and compressor performance.
371
Axial compressors and turbines consist of alternating rows of stationary, or
stator, blades and rotating, or rotor, blades, with the rotor rows firmly attached to
a rotating shaft. In a turbine, the stationary blades act as nozzles to increase flow
velocity, and the rotor blades downstream turn and decelerate (change the
momentum of) the flow. The reaction to the momentum change is a force with a
large component in the direction of blade rotation. This blade force delivers
torque and power about the rotor axis. The combination of the stator row and a
rotor row is called a stage.
Instead of thinking in terms of efficiency for the entire machine, we focus our
attention on the efficiency of a single turbine stage. The efficiency of a stage may
be defined in terms analogous to the definition of the isentropic efficiency.
Consider the T-s diagram of Figure 9.27, which shows the temperature drop of a
calorically perfect gas in a stage of a multistage turbine. We assume here that all
stages have identical pressure ratios. In the notation of the figure, the turbine
isentropic efficiency is given by (T
1
T
2
)/(T
1
T
2i
), and by analogy the stage
isentropic efficiency is T/ T
i
.
The expansion process in the turbine may be thought of as a stairstep sequence
of expansions through individual small stages, each having its own efficiency. A
few such steps are indicated in the figure. It should be observed that, in each
successive stage, the isentropic temperature drop T
i
moves to the right on the
diagram and therefore is larger than the corresponding drop between the same
pressure levels on the expansion line from 1 to 2i; i.e., T
i
> T
s
. Thus the
irreversibility of the expansions through earlier stages results in a sum of stage
isentropic temperature drops greater than the overall isentropic temperature drop
and hence greater work-producing capability for successive stages.
372
Let us now imagine the turbine as comprised of an infinite number of stages
with infinitesimal pressure drops of equal efficiency. Thus the Ts become dTs
and the small-stage efficiency becomes

s
= dT/dT
i
[dl] (9.7)
The isentropic relation for a calorically perfect gas, Equation (1.19), may be
written in the form T/p
(k 1)/k
= a constant. Using differentiation by parts yields
dT
i
[(k 1)/k]Tp
1
dp = 0
which combined with Equation (9.7), gives
dT/T = [
s
(k 1)/k] p
1
dp [dl] (9.8a)
If it is assumed that the stage efficiency is constant, integration of Equation
(9.8a) between the turbine inlet and exit states gives
T
1
/T
2
= (p
1
/p
2
)
s (k 1)/k
[dl] (9.8b)
Thus the requirement that all stages have equal efficiency yields a temperature
pressure relationship of the same form as Equation (1.19), except for the exponent.
Such relationships, of the form T
1
/T
2
= (p
1
/p
2
)
(n 1)/n
are called polytropic. For
example, the isentropic Equation (1.19) is polytropic with n = k. Because the use
of constant small-stage efficiency yields a pressure-temperature relation of
polytropic form,
s
is often called the polytropic efficiency. The exponent for the
turbine expansion with constant stage efficiency is then given by
(n 1)/n =
s
(k 1)/k [dl] (9.9)
If the polytropic efficiency is unity, n becomes k, and Equations (9.8) become the
usual isentropic relation. Values of
s
less than 1 reduce the turbine temperature
ratio, T
1
/T
2
, for a given turbine pressure ratio, p
1
/p
2
, below the isentropic value in
qualitatively the same way that decreasing turbine isentropic efficiency does. A
similar statement applies to turbine work.
The turbine isentropic efficiency,
t
, can be expressed in terms of the
polytropic efficiency by substitution in the isentropic efficiency definition:

t
= (T
2
/T
1
1)/(T
2i
/T
1
1)
= (1/r
s(k 1)/k
1)/ (1/r
(k 1)/k
1) [dl] (9.10)
373
where r is the turbine pressure ratio, p
1
/p
2
.
If we define a compressor polytropic efficiency as a small-stage isentropic
efficiency, a similar analysis yields relations analogous to Equations (9.8) (9.10):
T
2
/T
1
= ( p
2
/p
1
)
(k 1)/(ks)
[dl] (9.11)
(n 1)/n = (k 1)/(k
s
) [dl] (9.12)

c
= (r
(k 1)/k
1)/ (r
(k 1)/(ks)
1) [dl] (9.13)
where
c
and r are the compressor isentropic efficiency and pressure ratio,
respectively. Figure 9.28 shows isentropic efficiencies for both compressors and
turbines as functions of pressure ratio for two values of polytropic efficiencies.
Applying LHospitals rule to Equations (9.10) and (9.13), we can show that the
isentropic efficiency of both turbines and compressors approaches the polytropic
efficiency in the limit as the pressure ratio approaches 1. This fact is evident in the
figure, and it is apparent that as pressure ratio increases, isentropic efficiencies
increase for turbines and decrease for compressors for fixed values of the
polytropic efficiencies.
374
The polytropic efficiencies may be regarded as measures of the internal quality
of turbomachines, that is, superior internal blade passage design. For example, for
two turbines having the same internal aerothermodynamic quality, Figure 9.28
indicates that a machine with a high pressure ratio will have a higher overall
isentropic efficiency than one with a low pressure ratio.
As another example, the compressor curves imply that, in a comparison of two
compressors having the same isentropic efficiency, the one with the higher
pressure ratio has a superior aerothermodynamic quality. This suggests that
parametric studies involving varying compressor pressure ratio should use a
constant value of polytropic efficiency rather than constant isentropic efficiency to
represent comparable compressor quality.
9.11 Turbofan Engines
The turbofan engine, ducted fan, or fanjet, discussed briefly in Chapter 5, is the
dominant gas turbine engine in commercial aircraft and is extensively employed in
military aircraft is well. Its primary feature is a large fan that accelerates a large
mass of unheated air in an annular duct surrounding the central core engine, as in
Figures 9.29 and 9.30, which show, respectively, a cutaway diagram and a photo-
graph of the General Electric CF6-80C2 high-bypass-ratio engine. The large fan
diameter produces a large jet exhaust consisting of a cylindrical wake of hot
combustion gas surrounded by an annular flow of slower-moving warm air.
The bypass ratio, B, is the ratio of the mass flow rate through the outer cooler
duct, m
c
, to the flow rate of the hot core engine, m
h
:
B = m
c
/m
h
[dl] (9.14)
Bypass ratios range from 0 for the pure turbojet engine studied in Chapter 5 to
values in the neighborhood of 10. The bypass ratio is a design parameter that is
primarily determined by the mission of the aircraft. High-bypass-ratio engines are
desirable for long-range commercial aircraft because of their excellent fuel
economy. The CF6-80C2 engine has a bypass ratio of 5.05 and a total airflow of
1769 lb
m
/s (802 kg/s).
The bypass air may have its own nozzle, separate from the core engine as in
the CF6 engine, or the core and bypass flows may be mixed in a specially designed
nozzle. The mixing nozzle helps to reduce jet noise by transferring momentum
from the fast-moving core gas to the slower-moving bypass air, thereby reducing
the wake shear noise source. The mixing process, however, involves a thrust-loss
penalty.
375
376
Figure 9.31 presents some of the nomenclature and notation that will be used
in discussing the turbofan engine. For the configuration shown in the figure, the
fan pressurizes the compressor inlet air as well as delivering the power needed to
accelerate the bypass air through its nozzle downstream. While other fan configur-
ations are possible, this frequently used arrangement is the only one analyzed here.
In addition to the bypass ratio, a second important design parameter is the fan
pressure ratio, the ratio of the stagnation pressure downstream to that upstream of
the fan:
FPR = p
o2
/p
o1
[dl] (9.15)
The fan pressure ratio, together with the bypass ratio, determines the power
transferred between the hot core engine and the bypass flow. For a given core
engine configuration, higher bypass ratios and fan pressure ratios cause more
power to be extracted from the turbine and passed to the bypass air by the fan. This
produces higher bypass duct thrust. However, as more power is extracted from the
core flow, the core nozzle velocity and core engine thrust are reduced. The
determination of the design values of these parameters therefore involves a
complex tradeoff with numerous other design factors.
The combination of a compressor and a turbine joined by a shaft is sometimes
referred to as a spool. High-pressure-ratio engines are frequently arranged in a
twin-spool or even a three-spool configuration. In a twin-spool engine, a high-
pressure turbine drives a high-pressure compressor with a hollow shaft, and a low-
pressure turbine delivers power to a low-pressure compressor and/or a fan by
means of a shaft that turns inside of the high-pressure-spool shaft. The turbofan
configuration in Figure 9.31 has the low-pressure turbine driving both the fan and
377
the low-pressure compressor, as does the PW 4000 fanjet shown in Figure 5.24. In
another arrangement, the low pressure turbine powers the fan only, and the entire
compressor is driven by the high-pressure turbine. Regardless of engine layout, the
objective of the fanjet is to accelerate a large mass of air and thereby increase the
propulsive efficiency of the engine.
Let us now consider the analysis of the turbofan configuration shown in Figure
9.31. The following parameters are assumed to be specified:
+ Ambient conditions at a specified altitude and flight speed or Mach number,
p
a
, t
a
, c
a
, or M
a
+ Inlet stagnation-pressure recovery, IPR
+ High-pressure-turbine inlet stagnation temperature, T
o5

+ Fan pressure ratio, FPR = p
o2
/p
o1
+ Bypass ratio, B
+ Low-pressure-compressor pressure ratio, LPCPR = p
o3
/p
o2
+ High-pressure-compressor pressure ratio, HPCPR = p
o4
/p
o3
+ Low- and high-pressure compressor efficiencies,
LPC
,
HPC
+ Low- and high-pressure turbine efficiencies,
LPT
,
HPT
+ Fan efficiency,
F
(defined analogous to compressor efficiency)
The inlet is assumed adiabatic, the nozzles are assumed to be isentropic, and all
mechanical efficencies are taken to be unity.
The calculation procedure parallels that of the turbojet analysis of Chapter 5.
Free-stream stagnation conditions are determined from the ambient conditions and
flight speed or Mach number. For an adiabatic inlet, the stagnation temperature at
the fan face, T
o1
, is the same as the free-stream value, T
oa
, and the fan face stag-
nation pressure, p
o1
, is given by the product of the inlet stagnation-pressure
recovery and the free-stream stagnation pressure: p
o1
= IPR(p
oa
.
The conditions immediately downstream of the fan, assumed to be the same for
both hot and cold paths, are given by
p
o2
= p
o1
(FPR [lb
f
/in
2
| kPa] (9.16)
and
T
o2
= T
o1
+ T
o1
[FPR
(k 1)/k
1]/
F
[R | K] (9.17)
378
The pressurized flow in the bypass duct then accelerates from p
o2
and T
o2
through
the convergent nozzle to a high velocity c
9
with static pressure p
9
, contributing
m
9
(c
9
c
a
) + A
9
( p
9
p
a
) to the engine thrust. Here, p
9
= p
a
if the nozzle pressure
ratio, p
o2
/p
9
, is less than or equal to the critical pressure ratio; otherwise it is equal
to the critical pressure ratio.
The stagnation conditions downstream of both low- and high-pressure
compressors are determined in the same way as for the fan. For instance, for the
low-pressure compressor,
p
o3
= p
o2
(LPCPR [lb
f
/in
2
| kPa] (9.18)
and
T
o3
= T
o2
+ T
o2
[LPCPR
(k 1)/k
1]/
LPC
[R | K] (9.19)
Similarly, for the high-pressure compressor,
p
o4
= p
o3
(HPCPR [lb
f
/in
2
| kPa] (9.20)
and
T
o4
= T
o3
+ T
o3
[HPCPR
(k 1)/k
1]/
HPC
[R | K] (9.21)
Neglecting combustor pressure losses, the high-pressure-turbine inlet pressure is
p
o5
= p
o4
and the known turbine inlet temperature is T
o5
. Recognizing that, apart
from assumed-small frictional losses, the power delivered by the high-pressure
turbine is delivered to the high-pressure compressor; the steady-flow form of the
First Law of Thermodynamics applied to the high-pressure spool yields the
stagnation temperature upstream of the low-pressure turbine:
m
8
C
pa
(T
o4
T
o3
) = m
8
C
pg
(T
o5
T
o6
)
T
o6
= T
o5
(C
pa
/C
pg
)(T
o4
T
o3
) [R | K] (9.22)
The turbine isentropic efficiency definition then gives the isentropic discharge
temperature, T
o6s
, which in turn yields the high-pressure-turbine pressure ratio.
A similar procedure for the low-pressure turbine spool results in the energy
rate balance:
(m
9
+ m
8
)C
pa
(T
o2
T
o1
) + m
8
C
pa
(T
o3
T
o2
) = m
8
C
pg
(T
o6
T
o7
) [Btu/hr | kW]
which, after dividing by m
8
C
pa
and using the bypass ratio equation, yields
(B + 1)(T
o2
T
o1
) + (T
o3
T
o2
) = (C
pg
/ C
pa
)(T
o6
T
o7
) [R | K]
379
This equation may be solved for the nozzle entrance stagnation temperature:
T
o7
= T
o6
(C
pa
/C
pg
)[(B + 1)(T
o2
T
o1
) + (T
o3
T
o2
)] [R | K] (9.23)
The turbine pressure ratio follows from the application of the isentropic turbine
efficiency definition and the isentropic temperature-pressure relation, as in the
earlier high-pressure-turbine analysis.
Alternatively, polytropic efficiencies may be used in the solutions. This is done
for the fan and compressors by replacing Equations (9.16) to (9.21) by their
polytropic equivalents:
p
o2
= p
o1
(FPR [lb
f
/in
2
| kPa] (9.24)
T
o2
= T
o1
+ T
o1
[FPR
(n 1)/n
1] [R | K] (9.25)
p
o3
= p
o2
(LPCPR [lb
f
/in
2
| kPa] (9.26)
T
o3
= T
o2
+ T
o2
[LPCPR
(n 1)/n
1] [R | K] (9.27)
p
o4
= p
o3
(HPCPR [lb
f
/in
2
| kPa] (9.28)
T
o4
= T
o3
+ T
o3
[HPCPR
(n 1)/n
1] [R | K] (9.29)
where (n 1)/n is given by Equation (9.12) for the appropriate compressor
poltytropic efficiency.
Equations (9.22) and (9.23) are still applicable for the analysis of the turbines.
However, polytropic equations, using exponents given by Equation (9.9):
n /(n 1) = k /(k 1)
s
where
s
is the appropriate turbine polytropic efficiency, are required to determine
the turbine pressure ratios, namely
p
o6
/p
o5
= (T
o6
/T
o5
)
n/(n 1)
[dl] (9.30)
and
p
o7
/p
o6
= (T
o7
/T
o6
)
n/(n 1)
[dl] (9.31)
Once p
o7
and T
o7
are known, the core nozzle may be treated in the same way as the
turbojet nozzle in Chapter 5. The engine thrust is then the sum of the thrusts
produced by the core and bypass flows.
380
EXAMPLE 9.3
A turbofan engine has a fan and a low-pressure compressor driven by the low-
pressure turbine, as shown in Figure 9.31. It operates at a flight velocity of 200 m/s
at 12,000 meters altitude, where the ambient temperature and pressure are 216.65K
and 0.1933 bar, respectively. The overall pressure ratio the engine is 19, and the
fan and low-pressure-compressor pressure ratios are 1.65 in 2.5, respectively. The
fan, compressors, and turbines have 90% polytropic efficiencies. Assume an
isentropic inlet and separate isentropic convergent nozzles, a fuel heating value of
43,000 kJ/kg, and a combustor total pressure loss of 6.5%.
Determine the core engine and bypass duct exit velocities, the engine thrust
specific fuel consumption, thrust, and specific thrust for an engine with an inlet air
flow of 100 kg/s and a bypass ratio of 3.0. Determine whether the nozzles are
choked.
Solution

Table 9.6 tabulates, in spreadsheet format, the design data for the example and
systematically calculates the engine parameters. After computing the fan and LP-
turbine exit total pressures, the nozzles may be checked for choking at the throats.
The applied pressure ratios are compared with the critical pressure ratios for cold
bypass air (k = 1.4) and for hot gas (k = 4/3), respectively. Branching in the
computation required by the presence or absence of choking is easily handled by
the @IF function of popular spreadsheets, which allows a conditional selection
between specified alternatives, as discussed previously in connection with
Example 5.6.

TABLE 9.6 Spreadsheet Solution to Example 9.3
AEROTHERMODYNAMIC ANALYSIS OF A FANJET
Ca 200 m/s Flight velocity
Ta 216.65 K Ambient temperature
Pa 0.1933 Bar Ambient pressure
Fuel HV 43000 kJ/kg Heating value
Cpa 1.005 kJ/kg Air heat capacity
Cpa/Cpg 0.8754 Air/gas heat capacity ratio
OPR 19.0000 Overall pressure ratio
FPR 1.6500 Fan pressure ratio
LPCPR 2.5000 Low pressure compressor pressure ratio
HPCPR 4.6100 HPCPR = OPR/[(FPR)(LPCPR)]
B 3.0000 Bypass Ratio
mair 100 kg/s Inlet total mass flow rate
cpeta 0.9 Compressor and fan polytropic efficiencies
(n-1)/n l comp 0.3175 (n-1)/n = (k-1)/[k+cpeta] (for fan & comp.)
381
tpeta 0.9 Turbine polytropic efficiency
n/(n-1) l turbine 4.4400 Turbine polytropic factor, k/[(k-1)+tpeta]
(dp/p) l combust 0.065 Combustor fractional pressure drop
To5 1027 C High pressure turbine inlet temperature
To5 1300 K To5 (K) = To5 (C) + 273
To1=Toa 236.550 K Toa=Ta+Ca^2/(2+Cpa*1000)
Poa = Po1 0.263 Bar Po1 = Poa = Pa+(Toa/Ta)^3.5
Po2 0.434 Bar Po2=FPR+Po1
Po3 1.085 Bar Po3=(LPCPR)Po2
Po4 4.995 Bar Po4=Po3(HPCPR)
Po5 4.671 Bar Po5=Po4+[1 - (dp/p)] | combust
To2 277.31 K To2=To1+FPR^[(n-1)/n] I comp
To3 370.93 K To3=To2+(LPCPR)^[(n-1)/n] | comp
To4 602.39 K To4=To3+HPCPR^[(n-1)/n] | comp
To6 1097.38 K To6=To5-(Cpa/Cpg)+(To4-To3)
To7 872.68 K To7=To6-(Cpa/Cpg)[(B+1)(To2-To1)+(To3-To2)]
Po6 2.199 Bar Po6=Po5+(To6/To5)^[n/(n-1)] | turbine
Po7 0.795 Bar Po7=Po6+(To7/To6)^[n/{n-1)] | turbine
Po7/Pc8 1.8530 Crit. press. ratio: Po7/Pc8=[(4/3+1)/2]^4
Po7/Pa 4.1100 Core flow is choked
Po2/Pc9 1.8930 Crit. Press. ratio: Po2/Pc9=[(7/5+1)/2]^3.5
Po2/Pa 2.2440 Bypass flow is choked
T8 748.02 K IF (Po7/Pc8) < (Po7/Pa) THEN T8=2+To7/(4/3+1)
ELSE T8=To7/(Po7/Pa)^0.25
C8 535.02 m/s IF (Po7/Pc8)<(Po7/Pa) THEN C8=(287+T8+4/3)^0.5
ELSE C8 = [(To7-T8)+2000+Cpg)]^0.5
P8 0.429 Bar IF Pc8>Pa THEN P8=Po7/(Po7/Pc8) ELSE P8=Pa
Rho8 0.200 kg/m^3 Rho8=100+P8/(0.287*T8)
A8/m8 0.0094 m^2-s/kg A8/m8 = 1 / (C8+Rho8)
T9 231.09 K IF Pc9>Pa THEN T9=2To2/(7/5+1)
ELSE T9=To2/(Po2/Pa)^(1/3.5)
C9 304.72 m/s IF Pc9>Pa THEN C9=(287+T8+7/5)^0.5
ELSE C=[(To2-T9)+2000+Cpa]^0.5
P9 0.229 Bar IF Pc9>Pa THEN P9=Po2/(Po2/Pc9) ELSE P9=Pa
rho9 0.346 kg/m^3 Rho9=100+P9/(0.287+T9)
A9/m9 0.009 m^2-s/kg A9/m9=1 / (C9+Rho9)
Specific Thrust, ST 242.9 N-s/kg ST = C8+C9+B-Ca+(B+1)+[(P8-Pa)+(A8/m8)
+(P9-Pa)+(A9/m9)+B]+10^5/(B+1)
Thrust 24294.4 N Total engine thrust= mair(specific thrust)
f/a 0.0186 f/a=Cpg(To5-To4)/HV
mfuel 0.466 kg/s Fuel flow rate=mair+(f/a)/(B+1)
TSFC 0.000019 kg/N-s TSFC=(f/a)/[spec. thrust)(B+1)]
TSFC' 0.069 kg/N-hr TSFC'=3600+TSFC
ST | core m 971.8 N-s/kg ST based on m8 = (B+1)+ST
The specific thrust is presented in two forms, one based on the total mass flow
rate to the engine and the other based on the mass flow rate to the core engine. The
former, ST, allows easy comparison with engines of comparable frontal area,
while the latter, ST | core m, is useful in showing the thrust increase due to adding
382
a fan to a given core engine. Both definitions reduce to the common turbojet
definition for B = 0, but deviate progressively with increasing bypass ratio.
__________________________________________________________________
It is of interest to compare the performance of a turbofan and twin-spool turbojet
in flight at the same altitude and velocity based on our computations. This is easily
accomplished with the spreadsheet of Table 9.6 by setting FPR = 1.0 and B = 0 for
the turbojet engine. Table 9.7 shows some of the parameters resulting from this
comparison.
Table 9.7 TurbofanTurbojet Comparison
Turbofan Turbojet
Core jet velocity, m/s 535.02 566.88
Bypass jet velocity, m/s 304.72 ---------
Thrust, N 24,294.4 67,745
Specific thrust based on total mass, N-s/kg 242.9 677.5
Specific thrust based on core mass, N-s/kg 971.8 677.5
Fuel mass flow rate, kg/s 0.466 1.862
TSFC, kg/N-hr 0.069 0.099
It is evident that the extraction of power to drive the fan reduces the core jet
velocity. The lower jet velocities substantially reduce the turbofan engine thrust
for the same size inlet and total engine mass flow rate. Thus the high-bypass-ratio
turbofan is less likely to be used for military applications requiring high speed and
therefore high thrust per unit of frontal area. This is reflected in the specific thrust
based on total engine mass flow. On the other hand, the specific thrust based on
core mass flow shows that a significant increase in thrust can be achieved by
adding a fan to an existing turbojet design. The major advantage of the fanjet is
shown in the fuel flow rate and TSFC comparisons, where the superior fuel
economy of the fanjet appears.
The success of the turbofan or ducted-fan engine has made it clear that further
advances in jet engine fuel economy are possible with higher bypass ratios. The
large-diameter cowlings necessary for drastic increases in turbofan bypass ratio,
however, appear impractical. Still, advances in propeller technology now make
flight at high subsonic Mach numbers possible with gas-turbine-driven unducted
fans.
383
Figures 9.32 and 9.33 show a UDF
*
engine featuring contrarotating fans
installed in an engine nacelle. A twin-spool gas generator upstream of the fans
supplies combustion gas to the cantilevered fan section. In this design the forward
fan blades are coupled directly to the outer fan-turbine blades, as shown in Figure
9.34, and rotate clockwise. The free-wheeling aft fan section, which includes the
_________
* UDF

is a registered trademark of General Electric Co., U.S.A..


384
inner fan-turbine blades, rear fairing, and tailcone assembly, is cantilevered at the
rear of the engine and rotates counterclockwise.
With unducted-fan engines, very high bypass ratios are possible. The UDF
engine, with an overall pressure ratio of approximately 42 at top of climb, has
demonstrated substantial SFC reductions over modern turbo fans, approximately
20% lower than the best of the current turbofan engines. In-cabin noise, originally
expected to be a problem with unducted fans, was very lowequal to or less than
that of todays turbofan-powered aircraft (ref. 55).
Despite the attractiveness of the unducted fan concept, it appears that in the
next decade large transport aircraft will use ducted fans that incorporate more
modest increases in bypass ratio together with increases in overall pressure ratio
for improved performance. Reference 63, for example, anticipated the family of
75,000 to 95,000 pounds-thrust turbofans coming into use around 1995. They were
expected to have a bypass ratio of 9 and overall pressure ratio about 45 to give a
9% improvement in SFC over then-existing engines. The reference anticipated that
the engines would have a low speed, low pressure ratio fan for low noise. The fans
were expected to be made of composite materials to save about 25% weight over
competing metal fans.
Bibliography and References
1. Curran, Paul F., "Clean Power at Cool Water," Mechanical Engineering, Vol.
109, No. 8 (August 1987): 68-71.
2. Grover, Ralph W., et al.; "Preliminary Environmental Monitoring Results for
The Cool Water Coal Gasification Program." Proceedings of the EPRI Sixth
Annual Conference on Coal Gasification, Palo Alto, Calif., October 1516, 1986.
3. Watts, Donald H., Dinkel, Paul W., and McDaniel, John E., "Cool Water IGCC
Performance to Date and its Future in the Electric Utility Industry," U.S. Utility
Symposium, Palm Springs, Calif., October 1987.

4. Gluckman, Michael J., et al., "A Reconciliation of the Cool Water IGCC Plant
Performance and Cost Data with Equivalent Projections for a Mature 360-MW
Commercial IGCC Facility." Cool Water Gasification Program, October 1987.
5. Fahrion, M. E., "Materials Development Experience at Cool Water Coal
Gasification Plant." Cool Water Coal Gasification Program, October 1987.
6. Anon., "Boilers and Auxiliary Equipment," Power, June 1988: 91229.
7. Ehrlich, Shelton, "Fluidized-Combustion Boiler Technology1988 Update."
Missouri Valley Electric Association Engineering Conference, Kansas City, Mo.,
March 1988.
8. Ehrlich, Shelton, "Fluidized Combustion: Is It Achieving Its Promise?" Electric
Power Research Institute, Palo Alto, Calif.
385
9. Pollak, Robert, Status of First U.S. CAES Plant, EPRI Journal, December
1988: 4952.
10. Allison, P. R., and Berman, P. A., PACE 260 at Comanche, the First Two
Years. ASME Gas Turbine Conference, ASME Paper 76-GT-109, 1976.
11. Anon., Upgraded Combined Cycle Will Save Over $6 Million per Year in
Fuel, Gas Turbine World, MayJune 1968: 1318.
12. Bammert, K. and Groschup, G., Status Report on Closed-Cycle Gas Turbines
in the Federal Republic of Germany. ASME Gas Turbine Conference, ASME
paper 76-GT-54, 1976.
13. Williams, Robert H., and Larsen, Eric D., Aeroderivative Gas Turbines for
Stationary Power, Annual Review of Energy, Vol. 13 (1988): 429-489.
14. Anon., The Purpose of PURPA, Mechanical Engineering, August 1988: 56.
15. Henneforth, James C., and Todd, Douglas M., Cogeneration on a Large
Scale, Mechanical Engineering, August 1988: 51-53.
16. Anon., Modular Cogeneration: A Capital Idea, Mechanical Engineering,
August 1988: 54-57.
17. Diamant, R. M. E., Total Energy. New York: Pergamon Press, 1970.
18. Horlock, J. H., Cogeneration: Combined Heat and Power. New York:
Pergamon Press, 1987.
19. Williams, R. H., Industrial Cogeneration, Annual Review of Energy, Vol. 3,
1978: 313-356.
20. Clarke, E. L., Cogeneration, Efficient Energy Source, Annual Review of
Energy, Vol. 11, 1986: 275-294.
21. Joskow, P. L., The Evolution of Competition in the Electric Power Industry,
Annual Review of Energy, Vol. 13, 1988: 215-238.
22. Larson, E. D., and Williams, R. H., Steam-Injected Gas Turbines, ASME
Journal of Engineering for Gas Turbines and Power, Vol. 109, January 1987: 55-
63.
23. Burnham, J. B., Giuliani, M. H., and Moeller, D. J., Development, Install-
ation, and Operating Results of a Steam-Injection System (STIG) in a General
Electric LM 5000 Gas Generator, ASME Journal of Engineering for Gas Turbines
and Power, Vol. 109 (July 1987): 257-262.
24. Boutacoff, David, Pioneering CAES for Energy Storage, EPRI Journal,
January-February 1989: 31-39.
386
25. Pollak, Robert, Status of First U.S. CAES Plant, EPRI Journal, December
1998: 49-52.
26. Anon., The Circulating Fluidized Bed Boiler, Heat Engineering, Foster
Wheeler Corp., September-December 1986: 88-89.
27. Anon., A Combined-Cycle Cogeneration Plant, Heat Engineering, Foster
Wheeler Corp., January-April 1986: 67-73.
28. Douglas. John, Quickening the Pace of Clean Coal Technology, EPRI
Journal, January-February 1989: 5-15.
29. Clarke, Ed, Cool Water Coal Gasification Program: An Update, EPRI
Journal, September 1988: 45-48.
30. Johnson, Gordon L., Tailoring Controls to Accomodate Circulating Fluidized
Bed Boilers, Power, May 1989:72-73.
31. Kolp, D. A., and Moeller, D. J., Worlds First Full STIG LM5000 Installed at
Simpson Paper Company, ASME Journal of Engineering for Gas Turbines and
Power, Vol. 111 (April 1989): 200-210.
32. Scalzo, A. J., et al., A New 150-MW High-Efficiency Heavy-Duty
Combustion Turbine, ASME Journal of Engineering for Gas Turbines and Power,
Vol. 111 (April 1989): 211-217.
33. Cohn, Art, Steam-Injected Gas Turbines Versus Combined Cycles, EPRI
Journal, October-November 1988: 40-43.
34. Holway, Donal K., and Moody, Joe R., Jr., Salina Pumped StorageDesign
and Operating History, Waterpower 83, Proceedings of the International
Conference on Hydropower, Vol. 2, 861-870, 1983.
35. Anon., Pumped Storage, Engineering Foundation Conference, American
Society of Civil Engineers, 1975.
36. Barrows, H. K., Water Power Engineering. New York: McGraw-Hill, 1934.
37. Douglas, John, Tools of the Trade for Hydro Relicensing, EPRI Journal,
July-August 1988: 4-13.
38. Holway, Donal K., Private Communication, June 21, 1989.
39. Makansi, Jason., Ultralow Emissions, Performance Tied to Process
Knowhow, Power, June 1989: 64-66.
40. Bretz, Elizabeth A., Examine Full Impact of Injecting Steam into Gas Turbine
Systems, Power, June 1989: 53-61.
387
41. Brunner, Calvin R., Handbook of Hazardous Waste Incineration. Blue Ridge
Summit, Pa: Tab Books, 1989.
42. Spiewak, Scott A., Cogeneration and Small Power Production Manual, 3
rd
ed.
Lilburn, Ga.: Fairmont Press, 1991.
43. Weston, Kenneth C., Turbofan Engine Analysis and Optimization Using
Spreadsheets, Proceedings of the ASME Computers in Engineering Conference,
August 1, 1989.
44. Cohen, H., Rogers, G. F. C., and Saravanamuttoo, H. I. H., Gas Turbine
Theory, 3
rd
ed. New York: Longman, 1987.
45. Wilson, David Gordon, The Design of High-Efficiency Turbomachinery and
Gas Turbines. Cambridge, Mass.: MIT Press, 1984.
46. Chenoweth, C. V., Schreiber, H., and Dolbec, A. C., 20 Years of Operation at
Horseshoe Lake StationOklahoma Gas and Electric Company, Procedings of the
American Power Conference, Vol. 96, 1984.
47. Roll, Mark W., The Dow Syngas Project, Turbomachinery International,
Vol. 32, No. 1, January-February 1991: 28-32.
48. Larson, E. D., and Williams, R. H., Biomass-Gasifier Steam-Injected Gas
Turbine Cogeneration, ASME Journal of Engineering for Gas Turbines and
Power, Vol 112, April 1990: 157-163.
49. Zaugg, P., and Stys, Z. S., Air-Storage Power Plants with Special
Consideration of USA Conditions, Brown Boveri Review, Vol. 67 (December
1990): 723-733.
50. Kehlhofer, Rolf, Combined-Cycle Gas and Steam Turbine Power Plants.
Lilburn, Ga: Fairview Press, 1991.
51. United Technologies Turbo Power and Marine Systems, Inc. FT8 Gas Turbine
Brochure.

52. Goldstein, Gina, Rechanneling the Waste Stream, Mechanical Engineering,
Vol. 111 (August 1989): 44-50.
53. Butler, Arthur J., and Hufnagel, Karl R., Skagit County Resource Recovery
Facility Design of a 2500-kW Waste-to-Energy Plant, ASME 89JPGC/Pwr-12,
October 1989.
54. Douglas, John, Beyond Steam, EPRI Journal, December 1990: 4-11.
55., G.E. Aircraft Engines source, personal communication.
56. Riley, Shaun T., (manager of LM 5000 and Industrial programs, G. E. Marine
and Industrial Engines & Service Div.), personal communication.
388
57. Riley, Shaun T., STIG Increases Output from Aeroderivative Gas Turbines,
Modern Power Systems, June 1990: 41-47.
58. Stewart, Norman, Shell Coal Gasification, EPRI Journal, June 1989: 38-41.

59. Sundstrum, David G., Status of the Dow Syngas Project: Three Years of
Experience at the Worlds Largest Single Train Coal Gasification Plant,
Proceedings of the American Power Conference, Vol. 52, 1990, pp. 512-515.
60. Anon., Gasifier Demo Heralds New Era for Gas Turbines, Power, October
1989: S-24S-28.
61. Anon., Cogen System Balances Steam Cycle Demand, Power, October
1989: S-42S-44.
62. Ullman, Ronald R., and Duffy, Thomas J., Integrated Material and Energy
Recovery from Municipal Solid Waste, Proceedings of the American Power
Conference, Vol. 52, 1990, pp. 570-577.
63. Smith Jeffrey J., The GE90 ... When is Big Big Enough? ASME Turbo
ExpoLand, Sea, and Air, Orlando, Fla., June 6, 1991.
64. Lamarre, Leslie, Alabama Cooperative Generates Power from Air, EPRI
Journal, December 1991: 12-19.
65. United States Department of Energy website, www.fe.doe.gov.
66. Schroeter, Jeffrey W., The Merchant Revolution, Mechanical Engineering
Power, May, 2000.

67. Lane, Jon, More Power, Fewer Players, Mechanical Engineering Power,
May, 2000.
EXERCISES
9.1 A 10-MW gas turbine operating at the conditions in Example 5.1 exhausts
through a process heat exchanger, with the combustion gas leaving at 200F.
What is the rate of heat transfer to the process? If the heat transfer is to liquid
water, what flow rate of water can be increased in temperature from 50F to
160F in the heat exchanger? How many homes with an average heating
demand of 60,000 Btu/hr could be serviced by the gas turbine in a district
heating application where there is a 20% energy loss in the system distribut-
ing heat to the customers? What is the unweighted system energy utilization
factor?
9.2 Design the combustion gas heat exchanger required in Exercise 9.1. Indicate
the type selected, the required surface area, the geometric configuration, and
overall size.
389
9.3 The oxygen remaining in the exhaust gas of a 5-MW gas turbine supplies the
oxidizer for a process heater that burns methane completely. The gas turbine
operates at the conditions of Example 5.1. What is the nominal heat transfer
rating if the heater is designed for an exit temperature of 300F? What is the
rated of fuel consumption and the unweighted energy utilization factor of this
combined heat and power system? What would the maximum heater output
be if the gas turbine were shut down and atmospheric air were supplied to the
heater with the same supplemental fuel firing rate?
9.4 Compare the unweighted energy utilization factors for the simple-cycle and
regenerative gas turbines of Examples 5.1 and 5.2, assuming their exhausts
serve unfired process heat exchangers with 250F exit gas temperatures.
Compare the energy utilization factors, assuming the useful heat in each is
weighted by the cycles thermal efficiency.
9.5 The exhaust of a 2-MW gas turbine, operating at the conditions of Example
5.1, transfers heat to an absorption chiller with a COP of 0.78. The exhaust
gas leaves the chiller at a temperature of 220F. How many tons of
refrigeration can be produced by the chiller? What is the unweighted EUF
based on shaft power and chiller rate of cooling?
9.6 A 20-MW simple-cycle gas turbine operates with compressor inlet
conditions of 101 kPa and 15C, a turbine inlet temperature of 1200C, and a
compressor pressure ratio of 12. The compressor and turbine isentropic
efficiencies are 84% and 88%, respectively. The turbine exhaust flows
through a process heat exchanger and exits to the atmosphere at 110C.
Determine the gas turbine cycle state properties, the thermal efficiency, and
the work ratio, accounting for an 80-kPa pressure drop on the process heat
exchanger gas turbine exhaust side. What is the rate of heat transfer to the
process through the heat exchanger? If the heat transfer is to liquid water,
what flow rate of water can be boiled at atmospheric pressure if water enters
the heat exchanger at 30C? How many homes with an average heating
requirement of 20 kW can be heated in a district heating application where
there is a 15% loss in the distribution of heat to customers? What is the
unweighted system energy utilization factor?
9.7 Design the combustion gas heat exchanger required in Exercise 9.6. Indicate
the type selected, the required surface area, the geometric configuration,
overall size, and the estimated pressure drops. Can you improve significant-
ly on the assumed heat exchanger pressure drop used in Example 9.6?
9.8 The exhaust of a 5-MW gas turbine supplies the oxidizer for a heater that
burns methane completely. The gas turbine operates the 101 kPa and 15C
compressor inlet conditions and 1060K turbine inlet temperature. The engine
has compressor and turbine isentropic efficiencies of 86% and 88%, respect-
ively, and a compressor pressure ratio of 10. What is the nominal heat
transfer rating of the heater? What is the total rate of fuel consumption and
the unweighted energy utilization factor? Combustion gases leave the heater
at 200C.
390
9.9 The exhaust of a 2-MW gas turbine operating at 960C turbine inlet temp-
erature with a compressor pressure ratio of 9 transfers heat without loss to
operate an absorption chiller with a COP of 0.83. The exhaust gas leaves the
chiller at a temperature of 120C. The compressor inlet conditions are 105
kPa and 25C, and the compressor and turbine isentropic efficiencies are
82% and 86%, respectively. How many tons of refrigeration can be produced
by the chiller?
9.10*Develop a spreadsheet like that in Table 9.1, and investigate the influence on
the combined-cycle efficiency of varyingeach of the following:
(a) HRSG exit temperature.
(b) Steam turbine throttle temperature.
(c) Gas turbine inlet temperature.
(d) Compressor pressure ratio.
9.11 A closed-cycle gas turbine using air as a working fluid has an intercooler, a
reheater, and a recuperator. The overall pressure ratio is 6. The low-pressure
compressor has a pressure ratio of 2. Both compressors are driven by the
high-pressure turbine. All turbomachines are 85% efficient. Compressor
inlet temperatures are 80F, and turbine inlet temperatures are 1500F.
Regenerator effectiveness is 75%.
(a) Draw T-s and flow diagrams, and label both compatibly.
(b) Identify actual temperatures, in degrees Rankine, at all stations of sig-
nificance.
(c) If the low-pressure compressor inlet pressure is 6 atm, what are the
intercooler and reheater gas pressures?
(d) Calculate the total compressor work, and compare with the work for a
single compressor with 85% efficiency without intercooling.
(e) What is the gas turbine net work?
(f) What is the total external heat addition?
(g) How much heat is available from the precooler for district heating ?
(h)What is the plant thermal efficiency?
(i) What is the plant energy utilization factor if 80% of the precooler heat
rejection is used for district heating?
(j) If the turbines deliver 100MW of power, what is the air flow rate and
(k) the rate of consumption of coal, in tons per hour (12,000 Btu/lb
m
heating value and 90% combustion efficiency)?
______________________
* Exercise numbers with an asterisk involve computer usage.
9.12 A closed-cycle gas turbine using air as a working fluid has an intercooler, a
reheater, and a recuperator. The overall pressure ratio is 6. The low-pressure
compressor has a pressure ratio of 2. Both compressors are driven by the
high-pressure turbine. All turbomachines are 85% efficient. Compressor
inlet temperatures are 15C, and turbine inlet temperatures are 1000C.
Regenerator effectivenesss is 75%.
(a) Draw T-s and flow diagrams, and label both compatibly.
(b) Identify actual temperatures, in degrees Kelvin, at all stations of signif-
icance.
391
(c) If the low-pressure compressor inlet pressure is 6 atm, what are the
intercooler and reheater gas pressures?
(d) Calculate the total compressor work, and compare with the work for a
single compressor with 85% efficiency without intercooling.
(e) What is the gas turbine net work?
(f) What is the total external heat addition?
(g) How much heat is available from the precooler for district heating?
(h) What is the plant thermal efficiency?
(i) What is the plant energy utilization factor if 80% of the precooler heat
rejection is used for district heating?
( j) If the turbine delivers 100 MW of power, what is the air flow rate and
(k) the rate of consumption of coal in kilograms per second (25,000 kJ/kg
heating value and 90% combustion efficiency)?
9.13 Starting with the selected combined-cycle design for Example 9.1, consider a
modification to the heat-recovery steam generator that allows saturated liquid
water at state 12 to be extracted for industrial process use. Assume that the
water is returned to the condenser as a saturated liquid at the condensing
temperature. Assume that process use dictates the mass flow rate extracted,
with the balance of the water going as steam to the steam turbine. Calculate
and tabulate the heat supplied per unit of gas turbine mass flow as a function
of the process liquid mass fraction of the total water flow entering the steam
generator. Also calculate and plot the energy utilization factor as a function
of the process mass fraction. If the gas turbine power output is 6 MW, what
is the maximum saturated-liquid-water process heat transfer rate?
9.14* Starting with the selected combined-cycle design for Example 9.1, consider
superheated steam at state 8 to be extracted for industrial process use.
Assume that the water is returned to the condenser as a saturated liquid at
the condensing temperature. Assume that process use dictates the mass
flow rate extracted, with the balance of the steam created going to the
steam turbine. Calculate and tabulate the process heat supplied per unit of
gas turbine mass flow as a function of the process steam mass fraction of
the water flow through the steam generator. Also calculate and plot the
energy utilization factor as a function of the process mass fraction. If the
gas turbine power output is 6 MW, what is the maximum superheated-
steam process heat transfer rate?

9.15 Extend the analysis of Table 9.1 to include supplemental firing of the HRSG,
to provide an inlet gas temperature of 1500F and a steam turbine throttle
temperature of 1000F. Determine the influence of boiling temperature on
the pinchpoint temperature difference, and on the net work per pound of gas
turbine flow; and compare the combined-cycle thermal efficiency with the
efficiencies of the individual cycles. Discuss the results of the analysis.
9.16 Extend the analysis of Table 9.1, to consider a modification of the heat-
recovery steam generator that allows saturated water vapor at state 13 to be
extracted for industrial process use. Assume that the water is returned to the
condenser as a saturated liquid at the condensing temperature. Assume that
process use of the steam has priority, with the balance of the steam going to
392
the steam turbine. Calculate and tabulate the process heat supplied per unit of
gas turbine mass flow as a function of the process water mass fraction of the
water flow through the steam generator. Also calculate and plot the energy
utilization factor as a function of the process mass fraction. It the total power
output of the combined cycle is 6 MW, what is the maximum process heat
transfer rate?
9.17 Extend Exercise 9.15 to consider a modification of the heat-recovery steam
generator that allows superheated steam at state 8 to be extracted for
industrial process use. Assume that the water is returned to the condenser as
a saturated liquid at the condensing temperature. Assume that process use of
the steam has priority, with the balance of the steam going to the steam
turbine. Calculate and tabulate the process heat supplied per unit of gas
turbine mass flow as a function of the process steam mass fraction of the
water flow through the steam generator for a boiling temperature of 600F.
Also calculate and plot the energy utilization factor as a function of process
mass fraction. If the total power output of the combined cycle is 20 MW with
no process heat, what is the maximum process heat transfer rate?
9.18 Design an open-cycle regenerative gas turbine cogeneration system in which
a fraction of the turbine exhaust gas can bypass the heat exchanger for
process use. Prepare a report stating your design criteria, defining your
analysis methodology, and presenting performance data for the nominal
design condition that you selected.
9.19 Perform the design required in Exercise 9.18, and include consideration of
performance for a range of off-design process heat transfer requirements that
are lower than the design value.
9.20 A 20-MW electric motor in a simple compressed-air-storage plant drives a
compressor with a pressure ratio of 10 and an efficiency of 85% for six hours
nightly. What power output can be obtained with a turbine inlet temperature
of 1600F if the plant operates for four hours during the day at constant
power output? The turbine efficiency is 90%. What is the air-fuel ratio if
methane is the fuel used? What is the net generation efficiency, considering
only the fuel consumption of the turbine? Assume a daily cycle, that cavern
pressure changes are negligible, and that the heat of compression is
dissipated before generation begins.
9.21* An ideal steam turbine operates with 1000F, 2000-psia throttle, and 1-psia
condenser and produces 15 MW without extraction. When steam is extracted
for process use at 500 psia, after use it is condensed to a saturated liquid at
that pressure and throttled to the condenser. Tabulate and plot the process
heating rate and the EUF as a function of extraction mass fraction.
9.22* A 25 MW steam turbine operates in 1000F and 2000 psia with an efficiency
of 87%. Eighty percent of the condenser heat transfer is used for an
industrial process. Tabulate and plot the process heating rate and the EUF as
a function of condenser pressure between 1 psia and 2 atmospheres.
393
9.23* Develop the equations and an algorithm for the analysis of the steam-
injected gas turbine with an unfired steam generator producing superheated
steam at the combustion chamber pressure and using methane as a fuel . Use
the JANAF tables for thermodynamic properties of steam in the gas turbine.
State clearly the assumptions made. Write a computer programming
implementing the algorithm.
9.24 Consider a compressor operating at a pressure ratio of 20 and a polytropic
efficiency of 86% that compresses ambient air at 101 kPa and 15C into a
cavern. Assume that heat losses from the cavern maintain the air at 15C and
constant pressure during the filling period from midnight to 6 am daily. The
compressor is driven by a 20 MW electric motor. What is the daily mass
addition to the cavern? From 2 pm to 6 pm daily the same mass of air that
was added to the cavern during the night is heated to 1200K and allowed to
escape to the atmosphere at a constant flow rate through a turbine expander
with a 90% isentropic efficiency. What is the expander power output? What
is the daytime energy output? What is the fractional fuel consumption
reduction if a regenerator with 80% effectiveness is added to the system?
9.25 Resolve Example 9.2 for superheated steam injection at 400, 500, 600,
and 700F and the combustor pressure level. Write a brief report on your
findings on the influence of temperature of injected steam on STIG perform-
ance.
9.26* Use the STIG spreadsheet shown in Table 9.5 to verify the performance
calculations of Figures 9.23 and 9.24.
9.27* Investigate the influence of compressor pressure ratio variation on STIG
performance for the model of Example 9.2, and prepare a memo reporting
your results.
9.28* Evaluate the separate influences of steam heat capacity and added mass on
the thermal efficiency, power output, and work ratio for the model of
Example 9.2.
9.29 Consider a two-shaft gas turbine to be modified for steam injection. The
compressor pressure ratio is 9.3, and the turbine inlet temperature is 982C.
The isentropic efficiencies of the compressor and turbines are 83% and 90%,
respectively. The gas generator mechanical efficiency is 99%, and the power
turbine drives an electrical generator that has a 93% efficiency. Accounting
for a 4% pressure loss in the combustor and a fuel heating value of 43,000
kJ/ kg, compare the electrical power output, specific fuel consumption,
thermal efficiency, and fuel-air ratios for 0.0 and 0.05 steam-air ratios.
Briefly described your selection of steam system design conditions.
9.30 It has been decided that the heat-recovery steam generator for a steam-
injected gas turbine must be retubed to continue running it in the steam
injection mode. The expected cost of retubing is $230,000. Steam injection
produces an additional 4000 MW-hr per year, adding two cents per kW-hr to
394
revenue. What is the break-even operating time to recover the cost of this
maintenance operation?
9.31 Compare the isentropic efficiencies of two compressors, each having a
polytropic efficiency of 87% and pressure ratios of 6 and 18.
9.32 What is the polytropic efficiency of a turbine, with a pressure ratio 30, that
has the same isentropic efficiency as a turbine having a polytropic efficiency
of 92% at a pressure ratio of 12?
9.33* Compare the performance of a twin-spool turbofan engine with separate fan
and compressor to that of a turbojet engine, both with an overall pressure
ratio of 30 and a turbine inlet temperature of 1300K, and designed for an
altitude of 15,000m and a flight speed of 275 m/s. The bypass ratio is 6 and
the fan pressure ratio is 1.6. Assume turbine, fan, and compressor polytropic
efficiencies of 90% and a combustor pressure loss of 3% of the compressor
exit total pressure. Compare specific thrusts for engines built from the same
core engine. Compare, also, specific fuel consumption and jet velocities.
9.34* Build a multicase spreadsheet for the conditions of Exercise 9.33, and use it
to plot specific thrust and TSFC as a function of fan pressure ratio. Use the
spreadsheet to explore further the influence of varying bypass ratio for a
value of fan pressure ratio suggested by your plot. Write a memo discussing
briefly the results of your study.
9.35 Develop an analysis for a turbofan engine, sometimes called an aftfan
engine, in which the fan is located at the same axial station and directly
attached to a low pressure turbine dedicated to driving the fan. The high-
pressure turbine drives the compressor, and is located upstream of the fan.
The compressor and fan each have their own separate inlets.
9.36 Express the work of a compressor in terms of its inlet temperature and
pressure ratio using (a) the isentropic efficiency, and (b) the polytropic
efficiency. Equate the relations, and solve for the compressor isentropic
efficiency. Compare your result with Equation (9.13).
9.37 Express the work of a turbine in terms of its inlet temperature and pressure
ratio using (a) the isentropic efficiency, and (b) the polytropic efficiency.
Equate the relations, and solve for the turbine isentropic efficiency. Compare
your result with Equation (9.10).


395
C H A P T E R 10
Nuclear Power Plants*
10.1 Introduction
Nuclear power is universally controversial. Many would say that it is also universally
neededas an alternative or supplement to power generated by fossil fuels.
The combustion of fossil fuels produces carbon dioxide, now notorious for the
threat of global warming. Nuclear power plants produce neither carbon dioxide nor
oxides of sulfur and nitrogen, as does the burning of fossil fuels. Thus nuclear power
reduces the global production of carbon dioxide and other pollutants, and helps to
alleviate many of the pervasive problems of fossil fuel supply.
Petroleum is least available in regions of widest use; natural gas is, for the time
being, plentiful and sought after by all; and widely abundant coal has come to be
regarded as the great Satan of air pollution. Water power is important, but it offers
limited possibility for growth. Solar energy, while promising, is far from being a
mainstay of the worlds energy supply. Thus sources other than fossil fuels and nuclear
power offer little hope to become major suppliers during our lifetimes.
Nuclear power, in stasis for many years, may make a comeback. Engineers have
been quietly working on new and safer designs for nuclear power plants, and the
political climate may be swinging slowly back in favor of nuclear power. According to
references 31 and 34, there were 434 operating nuclear plants producing 17% (350,000
megawatts) of the worlds electricity in 1998. Regardless of ones position towards it,
nuclear power is a major factor in world power production.
Knowledge of nuclear power is not American, French, Indian, or British; it is
virtually universal. Nuclear power plants such as those shown in Figure 10.1 are
producing power in many nations around the world. Blockage of the growth of nuclear
power in the United States did not prevent the development and extensive use of
nuclear-generated electricity in France or Canada. Should developing countries with
minimal fossil resources not use nuclear power? Should a country that has seen the
terror wrought by nuclear weapons be denied the benefits of electricity from the
nucleus? Can attempts to halt the growth of nuclear power stop the proliferation of
nuclear weapons? These and many other issues around nuclear power, which obviously
extend far beyond the bounds of engineering, are much too broad to be pursued here.
Nuclear power is controversial, but it is here; it is important and likely to remain so.
*Thanks to Dr. Andrew A. Dykes for his valuable inputs and comments on this
chapter.
396
This chapter is concerned largely with nuclear fission power reactors. Most nuclear
power plants use steam cycles that differ little from those of fossil fuel plants except for
the source of heat for the steam generator and for steam supply conditions. Steam
turbine cycles were considered in some detail in Chapter 2. Thus this chapter will focus
primarily on (a) the characteristics of nuclear reactor steam supply systems and, to a
lesser extent, on (b) the climate for future nuclear development. In preparation for this
study let us first review relevant aspects of atomic and nuclear structure.

397
10.2 Review of Atomic Structure
Atoms and Molecules
Somewhat more than a hundred elements are known and are thought to be the building
blocks of everything in the universe. The atom is the basic unit of structure for each
element. An important connection between the microscopic world of the atom and the
macroscopic world of experience is given by Avogadro's number. A gram-mole of any
element has Avogadro's number (6.023 x 10
23
) of atoms.
The atom may be considered as consisting of a positively charged nucleus at its
center and one or more negative charges around the nucleus called electrons that make
the atom electrically neutral. The electron is the fundamental unit of negative charge. It
may be viewed as a particle which is much smaller than the nucleus and which orbits
around the nucleus as a planet orbits the sun, or it may be viewed as a diffuse electron
cloud around the nucleus. Still another concept is that of a particle whose location is
not known but which is more likely to be in some places than others, its position being
given by a probability distribution. We will not concern ourselves with the rationales
for these views.
Thus atoms consist of nuclei surrounded by electrons. The sizes of atoms are
conveniently measured in Angstroms (10
-8
cm). The nucleus typically is of the order of
10
5
Angstroms. Thus the volume of the atom is largely due to the size of the outer
electrons orbit or to the atoms electron cloud.
Molecules are collections of atoms held together by electromagnetic forces between
the nuclei and the electrons. Atoms and molecules can exist in a variety of energy states
associated with their electron distributions. These microscopic states and their
macroscopic influences are dealt with theoretically in the fields of quantum mechanics
and statistical thermodynamics.
Molecules and atoms can interact with each other to form different molecules in
ways that are controlled by their electron structures. These interactions, called
chemical reactions, have little to do with the nucleus. In Chapter 3, we considered
aspects of these reactions that are relevant to combustion. The magnitudes of the
energy associated with these chemical changes, while of great importance in thermal
engineer-ing, are so small that they have no significant influence on the nuclei of the
reacting atoms. Thus the nuclei may be thought of as merely going along for the ride
when a chemical reaction occurs.
An electrically neutral particle, however, can penetrate an atom's electromagnetic
field and approach the nucleus, where it interacts via short range but powerful nuclear
forces. Then the electrical forces holding the nucleus together may be overcome,
resulting in changes in the nucleus. In these cases the interatomic forces are largely
irrelevant and are overpowered by nuclear events. It is these changes that are the
concern of this chapter.
398
The Nucleus
The nucleus, for our purposes, may be thought of as being made up of integral numbers
of protons and neutrons. The proton is a particle with a positive charge of the same
magnitude as that of the electron, so that pairing a proton with an electron produces
exact electrical neutrality. Thus protons account for the charge of the nucleus, and a
like number of electrons ensures the electrical neutrality of the atom. Compared with
the electron, the proton is a massive particle, having a mass which is about 1800 times
the mass of the electron. Thus the hydrogen atom, which consists of one proton in the
nucleus and a single electron in orbit around the nucleus, is electronically neutral and
has a mass only slightly larger than that of the nucleus.
Atoms larger than the hydrogen atom have more than one proton in the nucleus and
have one or more neutrons as well. A neutron, as the name suggests, is an electrically
neutral particle with a mass only slightly larger than that of the proton. As components
of the nucleus, protons and neutrons are called nucleons, and are thought of
interchangeably with respect to mass because their masses differ so little from each
other.
The number of protons in an atom of an element is called the atomic number of the
element. Thus hydrogen has an atomic number of 1. The atomic number of a given
element is unique to that element. Thus we could identify the elements by their atomic
numbers rather than by their names if we wished. Elements are ordered in the periodic
table in part by their atomic numbers.
The mass number of an element is the number of nucleons in an atom of that
element and is therefore the sum of the number of protons and neutrons in the nucleus.
Atoms of a given element that have differing mass numbers are called isotopes of the
element. A given isotope of an element is sometimes designated by a notation that
includes the element's chemical symbol, its mass number, and its atomic number. For
example, the most common isotope of uranium is denoted as
92
U
238
, where 92 is the
atomic number of the element uranium and 238 is the sum of the number of protons
and neutrons in the isotope nucleus. The isotopes are also sometimes simply identified
by their name or symbol and mass number, such as U-235 or Uranium-235. Other
significant examples are the isotopes of hydrogen, deuterium,
1
H
2
, and tritium,
1
H
3
,
which have, respectively, one and two neutrons accompanying the proton. These
isotopes are sometimes written
1
D
2
and
1
T
3
to reflect their commonly used names. The
form of water, H
2
O, in which the isotope deuterium replaces hydrogen is commonly
called heavy water, D
2
O, because of the added mass of the extra neutron in each
nucleus. It will be seen later that heavy water has characteristics that are advantageous
in some nuclear processes.
10.3 Nuclear Reactions
Just as chemical fuels undergo chemical reactions that release energy, nuclei may also
participate in energy-releasing nuclear reactions. When this happens atoms of the
399
reacting elements are converted to atoms of other elements, the sort of transmutation
sought by the alchemists of the past.
Mass-Energy Equivalence
Two nuclear processes are known to be capable of releasing energy on a scale large
enough to influence the personal and business lives of humans. The reality of both
processes has been amply demonstrated by the production and detonation of the atomic
and hydrogen bombs. Both processes owe their energy release to the annihilation of
matter consistent with the famous Einstein formula, E = mc
2
, which asserts the
convertibility of mass to energy. Because the speed of light is so large, the equation
shows that the annihilation of a small amount of mass yields a large quantity of energy.
These energy releases are usually measured in MEV, millions of electron-volts. The
electron-volt, EV, is defined as the energy required for an electron to pass through a
potential difference of one volt. The reactions of individual nuclei typically produce
particles with energies measured in MEV. On the other hand, as indicated earlier, the
most energetic of chemical reactions releases much less energy, only a few EV per
molecule.
As a result of our encounter with Einstein's energy-mass relation we must adjust
our philosophical position on the conservation laws of mass and energy and think
instead in terms of conservation of mass-energy. Mass and energy may be thought of as
different forms of the same thing. Any change in the mass of an isolated system must be
accompanied by a corresponding change in system energy. This in no way influences
the discussions in previous chapters, because changes in mass are entirely insignificant
in chemical and other nonnuclear processes.
Fission and Fusion
The process known as nuclear fusion occurs in nature in the stars, including our own
sun. Since the Second World War, scientists have been attempting to achieve the
conditions for fusion in the laboratory. Because it can use heavy water from the sea as
a fuel, controlled thermonuclear fusion offers the hope of vast quantities of power for
many centuries in the future.
Fusion occurs when light atoms interact to form a heavier atom in reactions such as

1
D
2
+
1
D
2
;
2
He
3
+
0
n
1
+ 3.2 MEV.
Here, two deuterium atoms collide to form helium-3 and a neutron while releasing 3.2
MEV of energy. Other fusion reactions exist that provide comparable amounts of
energy. Using precise atomic masses measured with mass spectrometers, we can
determine the differences of the masses of the reactants and products in this reaction.
Application of the Einstein relation to the mass loss yields the same energy release (in
this case 3.2 MEV) as is obtained by energy measurements. Thus the energy yield of
400
known nuclear reactions may be determined with only mass measurements.
For over fifty years, researchers have pursued the goal of achieving controlled
thermonuclear fusion on a scale suited for commercial power production. Since the
reactants are two positively charged nuclei, they must have high kinetic energies to
overcome their mutual repulsion. These high energies imply a gaseous state with
enormously high temperature, a condition known as a plasma. Because solid materials
cannot exist at plasma conditions and plasmas would be cooled by the presence of
solids, magnetic confinement of plasmas has been one approach to achieving a
thermonuclear plasma. Large experimental devices called Stellerators, Tokamaks, and
mirror machines have been built to help solve the problems inherent in achieving large-
scale fusion reactions and in stably confining the associated thermonuclear plasma.
While progress continues, controlled thermonuclear fusion remains, and will likely
continue, in the research stage for many years. It will therefore not be considered
further here.
Whereas nuclear fusion annihilates mass by forming larger atoms from light atoms,
fission is a process of breaking massive atoms into two large, more-or-less equal-sized
atoms, with an accompanying mass loss and energy release. While controlled fusion
remains elusive, nuclear fission has been producing electrical power on a commercial
scale for decades. The remainder of this chapter therefore deals with the fundamentals
and commercial use of nuclear fission.
401
10.4 Fundamentals of Nuclear Fission
Nuclear fission involves the breakup of certain massive elements resulting from col-
lisions with neutrons. Uranium U-235, for instance, the isotope of uranium with 235
nucleons, forms an highly excited isotope with 236 nucleons upon capture of a neutron,
as in Figure 10.2(a). These excited U-236 atoms are unstable and break up into a
variety of pairs of large atoms shortly after they are created. The many such fissions
occurring in a reactor may be expressed as an average reaction:
92
U
235
+
0
n
1
;
92
U
236
; F
1
+ F
2
+ 2.47
0
n
1
+ 203 MEV
where F
1
and F
2
represent fission fragment elements, as in Figure 10.2(b). On the
average, 2.47 neutrons are released in the process, one of which must initiate another
fission to sustain a chain reaction, as illustrated schematically in Figure 10.3. In
addition alpha, beta, and gamma radiation is released. One of the many reactions that
participate in the average reaction above creates xenon and strontium fission fragments
and two neutrons:
92
U
235
+
0
n
1
;
92
U
236
;
54
Xe
139
+
38
Sr
95
+ 2
0
n
1
+ energy
U-235 reactions exemplified by the Xe-Sr reaction create diverse fission fragments and
small integral numbers of neutrons that average to 2.47 and release energies that
average to 203 MEV.
Over 80% of the 203 MEV of energy released by the average U-235 fission
reaction is the kinetic energy of the fission fragments associated with their large mass
and high velocity. Because of their high energy, the fission fragments become ionized
and ionize nearby atoms as they tear their way through surrounding materials. The
fission fragments, however, travel only a very short distance, for interactions cause
them to lose much of their energy to the surrounding solid. Thus most of the fission
402
energy appears immediately as internal energy and therefore locally high temperature of
the surrounding materials. It is, therefore, necessary that the fuel be cooled
continuously to counter the fission heat generation to avoid temperature buildup and
possible melting. The heated coolant is then provides the energy input for a
thermodynamic (usually steam) cycle.
As the fission fragments come to rest, their presence changes the character of the
reactor materials. Non-fissionable material exists where fissionable and other atoms
once resided. In time these materials may decay radioactively, forming still different
substances and releasing additional heat. But, importantly, they absorb neutrons
without offering the possibility of fission. Thus the fission fragments are said to poison
the reactor.
Fission Reactor Design Considerations
While most of the fission heat generation is due to the fission fragments, reactor design
focuses on the actions of neutrons. This is because neutron captures produce fissions,
fissions produce more neutrons, and, as we will see later, fissile material may also be
produced using neutrons. Thus neutrons are the currency of the reactor and may be
used constructively or wastefully. The manner in which the neutrons in a reactor are
used is called the neutron economy. The reactor designer pays close attention to all of
the details of the neutron economy. One of these details is the distribution of the kinetic
energy of the neutrons, that is, the fractions of the neutrons that lie in given energy
ranges.
Almost all commercial power reactors (as opposed to experimental reactors) are
thermal reactors in which fission is caused by thermal neutrons. A thermal neutron is a
neutron that is in thermal equilibrium with the surrounding atoms. This implies that
they have energies on the order of 0.02 EV. Because they move relatively slowly,
thermal neutrons are much more likely to cause fission of U-235 than are higher-energy
neutrons; therefore, they are the choice for most power reactor designs. However, the
neutrons created by the fission reaction are not thermal neutrons. The neutrons created
by fission have kinetic energies that range from about 1 to 10 MEV. They are called
fast neutrons because of this high kinetic energy.
Thus, if a chain reaction is to be sustained in a thermal reactor, it is necessary for
the fast neutrons to be slowed, or thermalized, to much lower energies so that they can
cause fissions before they are absorbed in nonproductive captures in reactor material or
before they escape from the reactor. They do this by colliding with certain other nuclei
in the core, put there for that purpose. These nuclei are called moderators. A good
moderator is a light element that, on collision with a neutron, is speeded up by the
collision, and thereby extracts energy from the neutron without absorbing it.
The moderator concept may be understood by considering what happens when a
billiard cue ball hits another ball head-on. The cue ball stops, and the second ball carries
away the kinetic energy. However, with balls of differing mass, if the second ball is
heavy the cue ball bounces off without losing energy, whereas light balls are propelled
403
at high speed and extract significant energy from the cue ball. In neutron collisions with
atoms, it is the lightest atoms that extract the most energy.
Ordinary water, heavy water, graphite, and beryllium are all used as moderators
because they are light and are poor absorbers of neutrons. Hydrogen and deuterium are
the moderators in water. The oxygen in the water is not an effective moderator but has
low absorption and therefore does not interfere significantly with the moderation
process.
It is evident that conservation of neutrons is a prime consideration in any reactor
design. The number of neutrons per unit volume, or neutron density, in a reactor is an
important design parameter. Neutrons diffuse about in the reactor as they are scattered
and slowed by moderator atoms. Because they have no charge, they are uninfluenced
by electromagnetic fields and therefore may travel further than charged particles.
Four events can influence local neutron densities as they pass through the
surrounding reactor core:
1. The neutrons can be captured by a fissionable atom and produce a fission.
2. They can be absorbed non-productively by fission products, structural materials,
or nonfissioning fuel.
3. They can escape through the walls of the reactor.
4. They can be absorbed in nuclei that create more fuel.
The last possibility will be considered in Sections 10.5 and 10.8.
Events 2 and 3, absorption and escape, result in nonproductive waste of neutrons in
the neutron economy. The necessity that enough events of type 1, rather than types 2
and 3, occur to sustain the chain reaction suggest several important considerations for
reactor design:
+ The reactor should be large enough that only events of types 1, 2, and 4 take
place and hence that escape of neutrons from the reactor is rare. Since reactor size
is dictated primarily by the cooling requirements imposed by nuclear heat
generation, this usually follows automatically from the design process. In addition,
positioning moderating material such as water at the boundaries of the reactor as a
reflector, to deflect escaping neutrons back into the reactor, may allow a more
compact design, in some cases.

+ Materials to be used in the reactor design are selected so that type 2 events are
minimized. The gradual buildup of poisons must also be considered in designing for
the change in reactor performance with time between refuelings.
+ The reactor should be designed to minimize the amount of structural materials in
the active fuel region, to reduce the frequency of type 2 events.
+ Neutron-absorbing materials may be moved into and out of the reactor to change
the average neutron density for reactor control purposes.
404
A reactor can function over a range of neutron densities. When the neutron density
and power levels are constant, the reactor is said to be critical. This implies that the
number of neutrons producing fission at one instant is the same as at a later instant, a
situation depicted in Figure 10.4. Since high neutron densities produce more fissions,
each of which produces 203 MEV in the case of a U-235 thermal reactor, heat
generation, and thus power output, increases with neutron density.
Let's assume that 2.5 fast neutrons are produced per fission in a critical thermal
reactor and track the activities of 100 fast neutrons created in an instant. In a critical
reactor, about 40 of these fast neutrons must thermalize and undergo fission to produce
another 100 fast neutrons. Figure 10.4 shows that 2 of the original 100 fast neutrons
produce (fast) fissions and 5 more neutrons immediately so that there are 103 fast
neutrons diffusing around. Of these, about 10 escape from the core or are absorbed in
non-fissile materials while slowing down. Of the remaining 93 thermal neutrons, about
405
3 escape from the core and about 43 are absorbed in non-U-235 materials while
diffusing around at thermal energies. The remaining 47 captures by U-235 result in 7
non-fission captures and 40 fissions. These 40 fissions, in turn, produce 100 fast
neutrons for the next generation in a reactor operating at critical. This sequence
representing a single generation in a critical reactor is repeated over and over by an
enormous number of neutrons. By slight changes in the reactor configuration during
operation (for instance, by addition or removal of a small amount of poisons), the
neutron economy can be adjusted to increase or decrease the number of neutrons in the
next generation and thus change the reactor operating condition.
A parameter, k, called the multiplication factor, is defined as the ratio of the
number of neutrons in one generation to the number in the preceding generation. Thus
k = 1 for a critical reactor. If k is less than or greater than 1, the neutron density is
decreasing or building and the reactor is said to be subcritical or supercritical,
respectively.
A reactor is designed to have a maximum value of k > 1 so that it may be brought
up to a desired power level and maintained there over the duration of the fuel cycle.
Once the reactor approaches the desired power level, control actions are taken to
adjust the value of k to 1, bringing the reactor to critical and stabilizing its operation.
The control action requires the introduction of additional neutron-absorbing material or
the reduction of the amount of moderator in the reactor, to reduce the rate of buildup
of the neutron density to zero. As fissionable material is depleted and poisons build up,
control material is gradually withdrawn from the reactor to maintain critical operation.
When the reactor can no longer maintain critical at its design power level with no
control material present, it must be refueled.
The presence of a nuclear heat source is the major difference between fossil fuel
and nuclear plants. In that connection, there are several important factors that must be
considered in the design of a nuclear power plant that are not factors in conventional
power plant design and operation. First, the entire amount of fuel needed to operate a
nuclear power plant for up to two years is loaded into the plant at one time. The rate
at which power is generated must then be maintained by controlling the neutron chain
reaction over the wide range of reactor operating and fuel depletion conditions that can
arise between refueling operations. This calls for detailed planning and analysis, both
before and throughout the operating cycle.
Second, because the products of fission are highly radioactive and their rate of
decay cannot be controlled, the heat from radioactive decay of fission products after
shutdown amounts to as much as 7% of full power output. Consequently, provision
must be made in the thermal design to remove this heat under all credible operating and
accident conditions. (The reactor at Three Mile Island melted over an hour after the
nuclear chain reaction was terminated, because the operators misinterpreted their
instruments and turned off the emergency systems that were removing the decay heat.)
The nuclear decay process is not self-limiting and has no maximum temperature, as
with chemical reactions. If the heat generated is not removed from the reactor core, the
core will melt and be destroyed.
406
Third, if radioactive materials from the reactor core find their way to the
environment, they can be hazardous to nearby life. Although the proper cooling of the
core will ensure that these materials will remain contained inside the fuel assemblies, a
defense-in-depth approach to safety must be employed to make the possibility of a
release extremely remote.
Table 10.1 Nuclear Fuels
Fertile Fuels Fuels Fissionable by Thermal Neutrons
U-235
U-238 ; Pu-239
Th-232 ; U-233
10.5. Nuclear Fuels
Uranium-235 is the only material that is both fissionable by thermal neutrons and found
in nature in sufficient abundance for power production. Other fissile fuels are uranium-
233 and plutonium-239 (Table 10.1) which are created from thorium-232 and uranium-
238, respectively, by absorption of neutrons. Substances from which fissionable fuels
are created, called fertile fuels, are transmuted into fissionable fuels in a reactor by
extra neutrons not needed to sustain the fission chain reaction. Fertile fuel used in this
way is said to have been converted. The resulting fissile materials may be processed to
make new fuel elements when sufficient quantities have accumulated. Some of the
converted material may be consumed directly by fissions during reactor operation.
The composition of uranium ore is about 99.3% U-238 and 0.7% U-235. Because
of the ores small percentage of U-235, it is difficult to design a water-cooled, thermal
reactor that uses natural uranium. Therefore the power reactors in the United States
and most other parts of the world are thermal reactors that employ uranium enriched to
between 2% and 5% U-235. Such reactors use ordinary (light) water for both cooling
and moderation and are therefore commonly called light-water reactors.
Uranium enrichment is an expensive and difficult process because it involves
separation of two isotopes of the same element, which rules out most chemical
methods. Thus processes that rely on the small mass difference between U-235 and
U-238 are usually used. The gaseous diffusion process involves conversion of a
uranium compound processed from the ore to gaseous uranium hexafluoride, UF
6
. The
gaseous UF
6
flows in hundreds of stages of diffusion through porous walls that
eventually produce separate UF
6
gas flows containing enriched and depleted uranium.
The enriched UF
6
then is processed to UO
2
powder which is sintered into hard ceramic
fuel pellets such as those shown in Figure 10.5. The pellets are sealed in long cylindrical
metal tubes for use in the reactor.
Newer enrichment processes currently available or under development include: high
speed centrifugal separation; which also relies on the uranium isotopic mass difference;
407
a separation process that relies on differences in chemical reactivity between the
isotopes; and laser enrichment, which relies on ionization of uranium by an intense light
beam with subsequent chemical or physical separation of the ions (ref. 8).
10.6 Light-Water Power Reactors
Power reactors active in the United States today are light-water reactors. They are
designed so that the core is both moderated and cooled by highly purified water and
therefore must use a fuel that fissions with thermal neutrons.
Water has many advantages in thermal reactors. From a neutron point of view,
H
2
O is an extremely efficient moderator. As we know from its extensive use in
conventional power plants, water has excellent heat transfer characteristics, and the
technologies of its use in steam power plants are well established.
Water has disadvantages as well. To maintain its excellent moderation and heat
transfer capabilities, it must remain a liquid. Thus water reactors are currently limited to
producing hot liquid or steam with little superheat. Moreover, boiling temperatures
suited to an efficient plant require very high pressures, as in fossil fuel plants. Thus
water-cooled reactor cores must be encased in pressure vessels that operate with high
temperatures nearby. In addition, they must endure, for the design life of the plant, the
408
409
severe environment resulting from the fission reactions. Finally, and perhaps most
importantly, should reactor pressure integrity be lost while the reactor is operating, the
liquid water will flash to steam, losing much of its heat transfer advantages. All of
these factors contribute significantly to the challenges that an engineer faces in the
thermal and mechanical design of light-water reactors.
There are two major types of light water reactors (Figures 10.6 and 10.7), which
are differentiated primarily by the thermodynamic conditions of the water used to cool
uranium fuel elements in the reactor vessel. The boiling water reactor (BWR) operates
at a pressure that allows boiling of the coolant water adjacent to the fuel elements. The
water in the pressurized water reactor (PWR) is at about the same temperature as in
the BWR but is at a higher pressure, so that the reactor coolant remains a liquid
throughout the reactor coolant loop. In addition to their use in utility power reactors,
PWRs are used in American nuclear submarines.
Boiling Water Reactors
A schematic of the layout of the General Electric BWR/6 system is shown in Figure
10.8. There the turbines, condenser, pumps, and feedwater heaters studied in Chapter 2
appear in a familiar configuration. Water boils inside the reactor core, producing
slightly radioactive steam that passes directly to the steam turbines. The radioactivity in
the steam, however, has a half-life of only a few seconds. The carryover of radioactivity
to the turbine-feedwater system is virtually nonexistent, and experience has shown that
components outside the reactor vessel (turbine, condensate pump, etc.) may be
serviced essentially as in a fossil-fueled system. Some other reactor designs, such as the
pressurized water reactor to be considered later, have an additional separate water
loop, as seen in Figure 10.7, that isolates the turbine steam loop from the reactor
coolant to provide further assurance that the turbine-feedwater system components
remain free of radioactivity.
410
Fuel Assemblies
Uranium appears in most boiling water reactors in the form of sintered cylindrical
pellets of uranium dioxide (UO
2
) (Figure 10.5), about 0.4 inches in diameter and about
0.4 inches long. These pellets are stacked inside of long sealed zirconium alloy
(zircaloy) tubes called fuel rods. Fuel rods, in turn, are mounted in an eight-by-eight
array in a fuel bundle, as seen in Figure 10.9. The fuel bundle and the fuel channel that
surrounds the fuel rods comprise a fuel assembly, as shown in Figure 10.10.
411
The lower-tie-plate nose piece seen there, together with the fuel channel, directs the
coolant water flow over the fuel rods inside of the fuel assembly.
The fuel assemblies, mounted vertically in the core, are designed to minimize
operating stresses on the fuel rods. For example, Figure 10.10 shows that the fuel rods
are spring loaded so they are free to expand in the axial direction in response to
changes in reactor operating temperatures.
The Reactor Assembly
The core of a BWR/ 6 1220-MW
e
reactor (MW
e
stands for electrical generator power
output, as opposed to MW
t
for reactor thermal output) has 732 fuel assemblies and 177
control rod assemblies in an approximately 16-ft-diameter circular array, as shown in
Figure 10.11. Cooling water receives heat from the fuel rods by forced-convection and
412
two-phase nucleate boiling as it flows upward through the fuel assemblies. As the water
cools the fuel assemblies, it also thermalizes the fast neutrons that diffuse through the
core.
Water that bypasses the fuel assemblies and flows upward on the outside of the fuel
channels is confined by the cylindrical core shroud, as seen in Figure 10.11. This flow
cools the channels and the neutron absorber control rods. The control rods are
mounted in cruciform assemblies, as seen in Figure 10.12. The control rod assemblies
fit vertically in a fuel module between 4 fuel assemblies in the core, as diagrammed in
Figure 10.13. The control rod assemblies move vertically between the fuel bundles to
change the effective multiplication factor to compensate for changes in reactor
operating conditions due to buildup of poisons over time. The stainless-steel-clad
control rods contain boron carbide (B
4
C), which absorbs neutrons and hence tends to
413
terminate fission processes when in place in the core. The control rod assemblies are
moved up and down through the core to change the rate of absorption of neutrons
when significant changes in power level or adjustments to account for fuel burnup are
required, or in the event of an emergency shutdown.
The positions of the control rods are adjusted by hydraulic drives located below the
core. The rods are fully inserted in the core during a shut down making the
multiplication factor less than 1. Most of the control rods are fully out of the core
during critical operation. When all of the rods are out of the reactor the multiplication
factor slightly exceeds 1, which allows the neutron density and power level to increase.
The bottom-entry fuel rod drives in the GE BWR are an unusual feature in reactors.
Their location below the reactor simplifies the refueling process which is carried out
from above in most reactor designs.
The quality of the steam leaving the top of the core is approximately 11%, indicat-
ing that most of the water is still liquid and must be recirculated through the core for
additional heating. The liquid water leaving the top of the core and the steam
separators flows downward outside the core shroud, driven by the jet pumps located
between the shroud and the reactor vessel wall, as shown in Figure 10.14. The jet
pumps, in turn, are driven by recirculation pumps located outside the reactor vessel.
The jet pumps induce the downward flow outside the shroud by momentum transfer to
the slower-moving liquid.
414
Vapor bubbling up through the fuel assemblies leaves the core and passes upward
with the liquid. The flow is turned by stationary vanes in the steam separator, where
the higher angular momentum of the liquid separates it from the vapor. The separated
liquid flows to the outside of the reactor vessel where it is recirculated outside the core
shroud.
The steam passing through the separator is further dried in the steam dryer
assembly before it leaves the reactor vessel as a slightly superheated or saturated vapor.
The turbines are specially designed to operate with saturated vapor at the throttle and
small amounts of liquid within. Liquid is separated from the wet steam leaving the HP
turbine. Steam tapped from the HP-turbine-throttle steam line is used to reheat the HP
exit steam before its entry to the LP turbines. The low HP-turbine-throttle conditions
of 550F and 1040 psia lead to a plant thermal efficiency of about 32%.
In the boiling water reactor, control is primarily achieved by adjustment of the rate
of recirculation through the reactor by the recirculation and jet pumps shown in Figures
10.11 and 10.14. Change in the rate of water recirculating through the core changes
both the onset of boiling and the volume fraction of steam in the cooling channels, and
thus the amount of moderator in the core at a given time. This allows significant
adjustment of reactor power output without control rod movement. For example,
increasing the recirculation and jet pump speeds sweeps bubbles away faster, increasing
moderation and raising the power level until the additional boiling restores the proper
void fraction for critical operation at a higher power level.
415
As the coolant passes upward through the fuel assemblies, heat from the fuel rods
produces vapor bubbles via nucleate-boiling heat transfer. Nucleate boiling is
characterized by the local formation of bubbles of vapor that break away from the fuel
rod surface, causing vigorous, agitated, fluid motion with resulting high heat transfer
rates. This may be contrasted with film boiling, in which a stable vapor layer covers the
tube surface, resulting in low heat transfer rates. Film boiling occurs at high surface-to-
bulk fluid temperature differences. It is crucial that a departure from nucleate boiling,
DNB, be avoided, because reduced heat transfer coefficients and cooling rates produce
drastic increases in tube temperatures, leading to fuel melting or zircaloy fuel rod
burnout. Thus the ratio of maximum heat flux to the critical heat flux for DNB is a
major thermal design parameter for the water reactor. The reactor fuel rod heat-
generation rate and flow-channel convective cooling are designed to maintain
tube-to-fluid heat fluxes well below the unstable transition range between nucleate and
film boiling. The maximum UO
2
fuel temperature based on the maximum design fuel
rod heat-generation rate of 13.4 kW/ft is approximately 3400F, whereas the fuel
melting temperature is about 5100F.
The boiling water reactor, like other reactors, has numerous active and passive
safety systems. A thick pressure vessel, for instance, surrounds the reactor core. An
even thicker concrete containment structure surrounds the pressure vessel to confine
anything that may escape from it. An emergency core cooling system (ECCS) senses
overheating of the core and supplies a flood of water to take away the heat generated
by the fuel elements. These and other safety systems clearly reduce the danger of
accidents but also increase the cost and complexity of plant operation.
416
Pressurized Water Reactors
The pressurized water reactor, PWR, is currently the predominant reactor type in the
world. It is a light-water reactor that uses slightly enriched U-235 as fuel. Figure 10.15
shows the three reactor containment buildings of the Oconee PWR Nuclear Station.
A major difference between BWRs and PWRs is that the pressure of the PWR
coolant is above the saturation pressure (it is subcooled liquid) through the entire
cooling loop so that there is no possibility of bulk boiling in the core. As shown in
Figure 10.7, separate steam generators receive heat from the reactor liquid cooling
loop, thus preventing radioactive material from entering the turbine power loop.
Another difference is that control rods are at the top of the PWR and can drop by
gravity into the reactor when necessary. Figure 10.16 shows a sectional view of the
reactor building of the Oconee plant. The stairs and landings give some idea of the size
of the equipment within the containment. Figure 10.17 gives a less cluttered view of the
major components. Table 10.2 shows that, for PWRs, the turbine loop is at a lower
pressure than the liquid in the reactor loop and therefore produces an outflow of steam
to the turbine throttle with about 50 Fahrenheit degrees of superheat.
417
418
419
420
421
We have seen that, in contrast to the BWR, which circulates the reactor coolant
through the turbine, the PWR uses two loops: a primary loop that cools the reactor
core, and a secondary loop, heated by the primary loop, that provides steam for the
turbines, as diagrammed in Figure 10.18. The primary loop is contained completely
within the reactor containment building (Figure 10.16) and is designed so that the
water that cools the core is completely isolated from the environment. The secondary
loop executes a steam turbine cycle similar to those of conventionally fueled power
plants, with the exceptions that the steam is generated by heat transported from the
reactor and that the maximum turbine inlet temperature and superheat are limited by
the maximum temperature in the reactor core.
The Babcock & Wilcox steam generator is a counterflow shell-and-tube heat
exchanger, as seen in Figure 10.19. The primary water enters the top of the unit and
flows downward through thousands of small-diameter tubes to provide a large heat
transfer surface. Feedwater is piped into the bottom of the shell side of the steam
generator and is first heated, then boiled by heat from the hot tubes containing the
primary water flow. As the steam rises, it encounters the hotter portions of the primary
tubing, reaching 50 Fahrenheit degrees of superheat at the top of the steam generator.
An important thermal design parameter of the steam generator is its size. A larger
unit increases the heat transfer area from the primary loop, but it also increases the
capital cost of the plant, both in the cost of manufacturing the generator itself and in
the larger size required of the primary containment. This must be balanced with the cost
savings, lower heat exchanger effectiveness and consequent lower thermal efficiency
achieved, if the heat transfer area is made smaller.
422
The pressurizer (Figure 10.17) controls the pressure in the primary loop and serves
as a surge tank to accommodate the reactor coolant waters expansion and contraction
with temperature changes. It is a large tank designed to contain saturated water and
steam, each occupying about one-half of the tank volume. As shown in Figures 10.17
and 10.18, the pressurizer is connected to the primary loop at the outlet of the reactor
through a single pipe. The temperature of the pressurizer contents are controlled with
internal electric heaters and water sprays. The resulting saturation temperature
establishes the operating pressure of the reactor.
An important part of the PWR thermal design is sizing the pressurizer tank to
permit the primary system to respond to all possible transients without bursting the
coolant pipes. Recalling that water is an almost incompressible fluid that expands when
heated, if the reactor power rises and heats the primary water to a higher temperature,
the expanding water will flow into the pressurizer, compressing the steam bubble.
Pressure sensors will detect the increased pressure and open spray valves at the top of
the pressurizer to condense some of the steam, thus restoring a lower operating
pressure. Conversely, if the primary loop temperature declines, heaters in the bottom
423
of the pressurizer will turn on, creating more steam to fill the volume formerly occupied
by the contracting water and thus increasing the reactor temperature and pressure.
Although there is no bulk boiling in a PWR core, heat transfer to the coolant is by
subcooled nucleate boiling. In subcooled nucleate boiling, steam bubbles are formed
on the surface of the cladding. As the bubbles expand they become detached from the
tubes and immediately collapse as they are swept into the coolant channel. The lateral
motion in the coolant achieved by this action is an extremely effective mechanism to
transport the energy from the cladding into the coolant stream. With subcooled-
nucleate-boiling heat transfer, the cladding surface temperature will stay within 10F of
the water's saturation temperature while providing the very high rates of heat transfer
needed to remove the fission energy from the fuel rods.
An extremely important design limitation is the critical heat flux at which steam
bubbles form and grow so fast that they coalesce to form a vapor film over the clad. At
this point the heat transfer undergoes a departure from nucleate boiling to film boiling,
and the clad no longer touches liquid water. Since metal to vapor heat transfer is much
more inefficient than nucleate boiling, the fuel rod temperature rises in order to transfer
the accumulating heat that is created by fissions. Unfortunately, film boiling heat
transfer coefficients are so low that the high surface temperatures needed to achieve a
steady state are sufficient to melt the clad and severely damage the fuel rods. For this
reason the Nuclear Regulatory Commission has established safety factors for the ratio
between the critical heat flux and the maximum heat flux expected in a reactor under its
most severe overpower transient conditions. In its application for an operating license,
every nuclear power plant must be able to demonstrate through engineering analysis
that it will maintain the required safety factor under all credible overpower and
undercooling transients.
The Babcock and Wilcox PWR uses U-235 enriched to about 3% in the form of
UO
2
fuel pellets (Figure 10.20) encased in a zircaloy-clad tube similar to the fuel rods
described for the BWR. Table 10.2 shows that a 1300-MW
e
plant has 205 fuel
assemblies with 54,120 fuel rods. Figure 10.21 shows fuel assemblies for an electric
424
425
utility PWR and for the Nuclear Ship Savannah. Each fuel assembly for electric power
generation is fitted for the inclusion of sixteen control rods, as seen attached to an
activating spider in the left fuel assembly photo. Positioning of the fuel assemblies in
the core and those assemblies containing control rods are shown in Figure 10.22. There
are sixty-nine control rod assemblies in Oconee Unit 1, of which sixty-one are for
control of power level; the remaining eight contain poisons in the lower part of the rods
for shaping of the reactor power distribution. The control rod neutron-absorbing
material, silver-indium-cadmium, is encased in stainless steel.
10.7 The CANDU Reactor
The CANadian Deuterium Uranium, CANDU, reactor is a reactor of unique design that
utilizes natural uranium as a fuel and heavy water as a moderator and coolant. These
reactors produce a substantial saving due to the absence of fuel enrichment costs, but a
large chemical plant is required to supply the quantities of heavy water required. The
Pickering station near Toronto, an Ontario Hydro plant shown in Figure 10.23, uses
eight CANDU reactors to generate 4800 MW
e
and has been generating power since
1971.
One of the important and unique features of the CANDU reactor is that, whereas
light-water reactors are shut down for refueling annually, CANDU reactors are
refueled daily. The pressurized heavy-water-cooled fuel bundles are horizon-tally
oriented in individual fuel channels inside the unpressurized "calandria," as
diagrammed in Figure 10.24. Each bundle may be individually accessed, rearranged in
426
the calandria, or replaced using special fuel handling equipment while the reactor is
operating. Heavy water at atmospheric pressure in the calandria surrounds the fuel
channels and moderates the reactor. Thus, in an emergency, the reactor can be shut
down by draining the calandria to remove the moderator, thereby depriving the fuel of
thermal neutrons. The pressurized heavy-water loop draws hot coolant from the fuel
channels through headers to supply heat to steam generators as in a PWR. A light-
water loop passing through the steam generator in turn supplies steam to the
turbine-feedwater loop. A turbine hall at the Pickering Station is shown in Figure
10.25.
The largest cylindrical structure seen in Figure 10.23 is a vacuum building that
connects with each of the reactor buildings. In the event of an emergency, escaping
steam and radioactive materials would be drawn by vacuum into the structure. A cold-
water spray would condense the steam to limit any pressure buildup.
The thermal efficiency of a CANDU reactor plant is only about 29%, but the
CANDU reactor uses a larger fraction of U-235 in uranium ore than other reactors and
also makes better use of the U-238 to Pu-239 conversion process to extend fuel
burnup.
427
Moreover, statistics show that, among large reactors, CANDU reactors have
outstanding reliability records, with annual capacity factors (the ratio of annual
electrical energy output to maximum possible annual output) as high as 96% and
cumulative capacity factors as high as 88% (ref. 14).
10.8 Fast Reactors
Reactors may be designed to fission with fast neutrons, but these fast reactors must
be more compact than thermal reactors so that the fast neutrons may produce fissions
quickly before they are absorbed or moderated by surrounding materials. They are
designed with structural materials that are poor absorbers and moderators of neutrons,
such as stainless steel. The core of a fast reactor must contain a fissionable fuel of
about 20% enrichment to compensate for the lowered probability of fissioning with
high-energy neutrons.
Because of their high fuel density, fast reactors have a high power density that
poses a difficult cooling problem. One solution is the use of a liquid metal as coolant.
Liquid metals such as sodium and potassium have excellent heat transfer characteristics
and do not interfere significantly with neutron functions.
428
The choice of fuel used for thermal and fast reactors depends on the fuels fission
probability and the net number of neutrons produced per neutron absorbed. Most
effective for thermal reactors is U-235, whereas Pu-239 is most suitable for fast
reactors. In fissioning with fast neutrons, Pu-239 emits almost 20% more neutrons than
does U-235. These additional neutrons are extremely important for making breeding
practical, as will be discussed shortly. Because Pu-239 must be created from fertile
U-238, a plutonium reactor can use fuel processed from fuel produced in a uranium
thermal reactor or in another plutonium reactor. This would occur in the core of a
plutonium fast reactor and in a blanket of U-238 surrounding the core, where
additional plutonium is created using neutrons that escape from the core.
Figure 10.26 diagrams two steps in a chain reaction in a fast reactor where a plu-
tonium atom is created for each one consumed. Note that each fission must produce a
minimum of two neutrons for this reaction to continue. As a practical matter, more
than two neutrons are required for complete replacement because of non-productive
neutron captures.
A reactor that transmutes a fertile fuel to a fissionable fuel is called a converter. The
conversion efficiency is the ratio of the number of new fissionable atoms produced to
the number of atoms consumed in the fission. Thus the conversion efficiency of the
reaction shown in Figure 10.26 is 1, because a new fissionable atom is created for each
atom consumed. In this case there is no net fissionable fuel consumption.
Fast Breeder Reactors
The cover of a 1971 U. S. Atomic Energy Commission booklet (ref. 7), (see Figure
10.27) shows a notebook page that poses and answers the following question: Johnny
had 3 truckloads of plutonium. He used 3 of them to light New York for 1 year. How
much plutonium did Johnny have left? Answer: 4 truckloads. This neatly emphasizes
the point that if unproductive neutrons in the process shown in Figure 10.26 were to
429
transmute a U-238 atom to Pu-239 occasionally, the chain reaction would produce
more fissionable fuel than it consumes. The reactor would have a conversion efficiency
greater than 1. A reactor that does this is called a breeder reactor. Thus, the breeder
reactor provides a means of increasing the world supply of fissionable fuel as it
generates power. While it may appear that the breeder provides something for nothing,
it actually only takes advantage of the possibility of conversion of the fertile fuels
through more efficient use of fission neutrons.
The breeder reactor is of great importance because it would allow the use of the
vast store of U-238 in uranium ore that remains as a by-product of the U-235
enrichment process to provide fuel for current LWRs. This supply of U-238 has the
potential to provide fuel for many years without further uranium mining. Fission of
U-235 is currently the only natural large-scale source of neutrons. The continued use of
low-conversion-efficiency reactors could preclude the eventual use of much of the
energy resource of the U-238 in uranium ore.
One possibility for the design of a breeder reactor is a liquid-metal fast breeder
reactor, LMFBR, which has the characteristics described briefly in the preceding
section. The development of such a reactor involves careful design of its neutron
economy and the development of a system of fuel reprocessing and nuclear waste
storage. These topics will be considered in the next section.
In 1971, President Nixon set the development of a breeder reactor as a national
goal and established a program for the development of an LMFBR pilot plant in
Tennessee to be known as the Clinch River Breeder Reactor, CRBR. The vocal
opposition of segments of the American public to all forms of nuclear power, coupled
430
with well-known nuclear accidents, bureaucratic and construction delays, and concern
for diversion of nuclear fuels to foreign military or terrorist uses, brought the
development of new nuclear plants in the United States, including the CRBR, to a
standstill. While some other nations, notably Japan, France, and Russia, continue to
support extensive nuclear establishments and research, the path to the development of
breeder reactors has been slow. The French, in particular, have developed experience
with their 233-MW Phnix reactor, in operation since 1974, and an advanced 1200-
MW LMFBR called the Super-Phnix, which went into operation in 1986. In 1994, the
status of Super-Phnix was changed from production to a research facility; and in 1998
the French government directed that it be shut down, well before its planned 2015
shutdown (refs. 24 to 26). In Japan, delayed reporting of a minor sodium leak during
commisioning of the Monjo breeder in 1995 produced a national turmoil that had
serious repercussions for the Japanese breeder program. (Ref. 27).
10.9 Innovation in Reactor Design
During the hiatus in new domestic nuclear plant orders in the United States since the
late 1970s, the industry has been working to incorporate new ideas and recommend-
ations, based on utility operating experience, into the design of plants that will be more
capable of winning public, government, and industry acceptance.
Popular opinion notwithstanding, the safety record of nuclear power plants in the
United States has been a good one. No one has been killed in a nuclear accident in a
U.S. power plant. Few other industries can approach that record. Nevertheless, serious
and expensive accidents have taken place at home and abroad; and the threat of
catastrophic accidents, while extremely remote, remains.
Designs are being considered by industry, the U.S. Department of Energy (DOE),
the Electric Power Research Institute (EPRI), and the Nuclear Regulatory Commission
(NRC) that would provide built-in systems and safeguards that are passive, rather than
active, that must be depended on to perform when a malfunction occurs (ref. 15).
Providing for natural conduction/convection cooling of the core in case of an accident,
rather than depending on pumps to force water through the core, is one of such
features under consideration. The General Electric Company, with an international
team, is developing a 600 MW
e
simplified / small boiling water reactor (SBWR) that
incorporates this approach (ref. 28).
Nuclear plant incidents sometimes result from failure of an operator to interpret
instrument data and act thereon or from instrument failure. Redundant instrumentation
is provided to avoid such problems, but operators do not always analyze the readings
correctly or make the right decisions. If the plant is designed to minimize the necessity
of such actions, the likelihood of accidents can be significantly reduced. Thus, much
effort focuses on reducing the complexity of reactor control. Designs have been
produced that appear to accomplish this to a significant degree. The NRC must, of
course, conduct hearings and evaluate the adequacy of any design before a plant is
built.
431
One of the problems of the power industry is the lack of standardization. Every
American power plant is different from every other because of the number of reactor
suppliers and power plant engineering firms and the diverse requirements of the
different utilities that buy them. One of the obvious reasons for the reliability of the
CANDU reactors is that they are planned and constructed by Ontario Hydro and
Atomic Energy of Canada, largely for Ontario Hydro. American suppliers are also
striving for standardization, but resolving the differences between differing require-
ments and standards is a formidable problem. An advanced boiling water reactor
(ABWR) program with an NRC certification (ref. 29) addresses these issues by
providing a standardized design that places pumps within the reactor envelope,
eliminates much external piping, and incorporates other passive safety features.
Reference 23 indicates that this system benefits from a new NRC licensing process in
which safety issues are resolved, with full public participation, before construction
begins. ABWR planning calls for a forty-eight-month construction schedule once a site
has been approved.
The long-term trend has been for utilities to seek larger and larger plants to take
advantage of the economies of scale. When the annual rate of growth of the electrical
power industry dropped drastically in the 1970s to 23% due to conservation and other
factors, many of the utility requirements for large reactors became less critical or
disappeared. Interest has appeared in smaller reactors that can be constructed
economically and on a timely basis. One hope is that better quality control could be
exercised, and better economics result if small reactors were built, entirely or in
modular fashion, in a factory and shipped to and installed at the power plant site, rather
than erected there. Some of theses issues are addressed in the ABWR and SBWR
programs (ref. 23).
10.10. Nuclear Reprocessing and Waste Disposal
Spent fuel is fuel that has resided in a reactor for a year or more, has been depleted of
much of its fissionable material, and includes a buildup of radioactive fission products.
When a reactor is shut down for refueling, spent fuel assemblies are removed and
partially spent assemblies may be repositioned in the core to obtain further fuel
utilization. Ideally, the spent fuel would be reprocessed to reclaim the unused and
newly created fissionable materials for use in new fuel rods, and the high-level waste
would be isolated to minimize the volume of highly toxic wastes. Even without breeder
reactors, current spent fuel inventories can provide ample Pu-239 to support
reprocessing. In the United States, by law, fuel assemblies are being stored indefinitely
in reactor-fuel storage pools in nuclear power plants until legal decisions are made on
whether reprocessing will take place and on the final disposition of nuclear waste.
Unfortunately, these decisions are among the most politically difficult ones of our
times.
432
10.11 Concluding Remarks
Nuclear power engineering has become so hopelessly intertwined with politics that any
speculation on the future of nuclear power must simultaneously consider both technical
and political realities. Even the continuation and expansion of nuclear power generation
in the United States is in question.
A major concern for many years has been the availability of fissionable resources
for an expanding nuclear power generation industry. It has been widely recognized that
U-235, as the sole natural neutron resource, places limits on extensive nuclear
development. For that reason, countries with nuclear generation capability have
planned on developing breeder reactors to greatly extend that neutron resource. It is
possible that the continuing long-term use of reactors that do not provide for efficient
conversion of the fertile fuels may result in the waste of this enormous energy resource.
While the American nuclear power industry languishes, foreign development of
nuclear power continues in some areas. The eventual recovery of the American nuclear
power industry may depend on the success of international nuclear development. The
absence of CO
2
production by nuclear plants, and its global warming implications, gives
an added incentive for international perpetuation and development of the industry.
Expansion of the nuclear power industry and development of a breeder reactor
nuclear power economy inevitably entails the development of nuclear processing and
hazardous waste disposal facilities and reactor fuel recycling. These activities arouse
concerns about the possible diversion of nuclear materials for the production of
weapons, (refs. 13 and 1719). The tradeoffs among nuclear power, coal, and other
energy conversion alternatives are also becoming more prominent as concerns over
global warming and atmospheric pollution intensify. Well-thought-out and consistent
government policies and regulation, as well as international cooperation, would give
welcome direction to the power generation industry. Reference 16 observes that
success in nuclear programs in other countries seems to correlate with limiting public
intervention, and it questions whether the democratic institutions of the United States
are consistent with the growth of the American nuclear power industry.
Bibliography and References
1. Hulme, H. R., Nuclear Fusion. London: Wykeham Publications Ltd., 1969.
2. Semat, Henry, Introduction to Atomic and Nuclear Physics. New York : Holt,
Rinehart & Winston, 1959.
3. Spitzer, Lyman, Physics of Fully Ionized Gases. New York: Interscience Publishers,
1956.
4. Glasstone, Samuel, Principles of Nuclear Reactor Engineering. New York: D. Van
Nostrand, 1960.
433
5. Glasstone, S., and Sesonske, A., Nuclear Reactor Engineering. New York: Van
Nostrand Reinhold, 1981.
6. Steam / Its Generation and Use, 39
th
ed. New York: Babcock and Wilcox, 1978.
7. Mitchell, Walter III, and Turner, Stanley E., Breeder Reactors. U. S. Atomic
Energy Commission, 1971.
8. Nero, Anthony V. Jr., A Guidebook to Nuclear Reactors. Berkeley, Calif.:
University of California Press, 1979.
9. Winterton, R. H. S., Thermal Design of Nuclear Reactors. New York: Pergamon
Press, 1981.
10. Judd, A. M., Fast Breeder Reactors, An Engineering Introduction. New York:
Pergamon Press, 1981.
11. Bromberg, Joan Lisa, Fusion. Cambridge, Mass.: MIT Press, 1982.
12. Robinson, Mark Aaron, 100 Grams of Uranium Equal 290 Tons of Coal. Kelso,
Wash.: R & D Engineering, 1987.
13. Nuclear Proliferation and SafeguardsSummary. Congress of the United States,
Office of Technology Assessment, OTA-E-148, March 1982.
14. Nuclear Power in an Age of Uncertainty. Congress of the United States, Office of
Technology Assessment, OTA-E-216, February 1984.
15. Catron, Jack, "New Interest in Passive Reactor Designs." EPRI Journal,
April/May 1989: 513.
16. Campbell, Jack, Collapse of an Industry-Nuclear Power and the Contradictions of
U.S. Policy. Ithaca, New York: Cornell University Press, 1988.
17. Blocking the Spread of Nuclear Weapons. New York: Council on Foreign
Relations, 1986.
18. Muller, Harald, A European Non-Proliferation Policy, New York: Clarendon
Press, 1987.
19. Snyder, Jed C., and Wells, Samuel F. Jr., (Eds.) Limiting Nuclear Proliferation.
Cambridge, Mass.: Ballinger, 1985.
434
20. Lovins, Amory, Soft Energy Paths. New York: Harper and Row, 1979.
21. Nealey, Stanley M., Nuclear Power DevelopmentProspects for the 1990s.
Columbus, Ohio: Battelle Press, 1990.
22. World List of Nuclear Power Plants. Nuclear News, February 1991.
23. Wilkins, D. R., Quirk, J. F., and McCandless, A. H., Status of Advanced Boiling
Water Reactors. American Nuclear Society, 7
th
Pacific Basin Nuclear Conference,
March 1990.
24. Electricit de France, Super Phnix Shutdown.
www.info-france-usa.org/america/embassy/nuclear/facts/superpr.htm
(Oct. 30, 2000).
25. Electricit de France, Permanent Shutdown.
www.info-france-usa.org/america/embassy/nuclear/facts/superpff.htm
(Oct. 30, 2000).
26. Electricit de France, Shutdown of the Superphnix breeder reactor.
www.info-france-usa.org/america/embassy/nuclear/facts/supersum.htm
(Oct. 30, 2000).
27. Japan Nuclear Cycle Development Institute, Monju Reactor Website.
www.jnc.go.jp/zmonju/mjweb/index.htm (October 30, 2000).
28. The Simplified Boiling Water Reactor.
www.nuc.berkeley.edu/designs/sbwr/sbwr.html (December 19, 2000).
29. The Advanced Boiling Water Reactor.
www.nuc.berkeley.edu/designs/abwr/abwr.html (December 19, 2000).
30. Davis, Mary Bird, Nuclear France: Materials and SitesCreys-Malville-
Superphnix. www.francenuc.org/en_sites/rhone_crey_e.htm (Oct. 30, 2000).
31. Fetter, Steve, Energy 2050, Bulletin of the Atomic Scientists. July/August 2000.
www.bullatomsci.org/issues/2000/ja00/ja00fetter.html (October 30, 2000).
32. Nuclear Regulatory Commission, U.S. Commercial Nuclear Power Reactors.
www.nrc.gov/AEOD/pib/states.html (November 2, 2000).
33. Nuclear Regulatory Commission, Nuclear Reactors.
www.nrc.gov/NRC/reactors.html (November 2, 2000).
435
34. Environment News Service, World Total: 434 Nuclear Power Plants.
ens.lycos.com/ens/may99/1999L-05-06-06.html (November 4, 2000).
EXERCISES
10.1 Consider the collision of a particle of mass m and velocity v with a stationary
particle of mass M. Write energy and momentum equations for the collision.
Derive an equation for the ratio of the final to the initial kinetic energy of the
original moving particle in terms of the masses of both particles. Use the result to
show why light atoms are used as moderators.
10.2 Evaluate the assertion of the title of reference 12 that 100 grams of uranium equal
290 tons of coal. Assume coal to be represented by pure carbon. Could you make
the title of the book more accurate? If so how?
10.3 Estimate the core thermal power and thermal efficiency of a 1220-MW
e
boiling
water reactor that has 46,376 fuel rods in a 150-in.-high core with a maximum
fuel rod linear energy density of 13.4 kW / ft and a fuel rod peak-to-average
power release of 2.2. If there are 748 fuel assemblies, what is the average number
of fuel rods per assembly? Estimate the number of thermally inactive rods in a
reactor with an eight-by-eight fuel assembly array.
10.4 Assuming the fuel temperature to be 295K, calculate the energy of a thermal
neutron using 3kT/ 2 where k is the Boltzmann constant.
10.5 Study the literature and then discuss the details of the nuclear processes by which
neutrons convert U-238 to fissionable fuel. Include nuclear reaction equations.
10.6 Study the literature, then discuss the details of the nuclear processes by which
neutrons convert thorium to a fissionable fuel. Include nuclear reaction equations.
10.7 Sketch and label a PWR steam generator flow diagram and a T-s diagram for the
two flows through the PWR steam generator, using the data from Table 10.2.
10.8 Determine the ratio of the reactor-loop flow rate to the steam flow rate from the
data for the PWR given in Table 10.2.
10.9 Sketch a T-h diagram and determine the pinchpoint temperature difference for a
PWR steam generator that has, respectively, 572.5F and 630F reactor inlet and
outlet temperatures and steam generator inlet and outlet temperatures of 473F
and 603F.
10.10 Discuss the changes in the neutron economy diagram (Figure 10.4) due to (a)
insertion of control rods, (b) withdrawal of control rods, (c) increase and (d)
436
decrease in recirculation flow rate in the boiling water reactor.
10.11 List from BWRs, PWRs, CANDUs, and LMFBRs those power reactors that are
(a) Thermal reactors
(b) Fast reactors
(c) Heavy-water reactors
(d) Light-water reactors
(e) Natural uranium reactors
(f) Enriched uranium reactors
(g) Plutonium reactors
10.12 Identify those power reactors that use moderators and those that do not.
10.13 Which power reactor (a) uses light water as coolant and has separate reactor
coolant and steam loops, (b) uses heavy water and natural uranium, and (c) uses
plutonium as fuel and liquid metal as coolant?
10.14 Based on data in Table 10.2 for the Oconee Unit 1 PWR, estimate the turbine-
loop thermodynamic conditions (temperature and pressure) and power delivered
by a simple Rankine-cycle steam turbine with 85% efficiency.
10.15 Compare the reactor temperature rise shown in Table 10.2 for the Oconee Unit 1
with an analysis based on heat transfer data given in the table. Discuss your result.
10.16 Compare the reactor temperature rise shown in Table 10.2 for the 1300-MW
e
PWR with an analysis based on heat transfer data given in the table. Discuss your
result.
10.17 Based on the data given in Table 10.2, determine the heat transfer rating for the
Oconee Unit 1 PWR steam generator, and evaluate the average reactor-loop heat
transfer loss rate and fraction. Discuss your result.
10.18 Based on data in Table 10.2, estimate the turbine-loop thermodynamic conditions
(temperature and pressure) and power delivered by a simple Rankine-cycle steam
turbine with 85% efficiency for the 1300-MW PWR.
10.19 Based on the data given in Table 10.2, determine the heat transfer rating for the
1300-MW
e
PWR steam generator, and evaluate the average reactor-loop heat
transfer loss rate and fraction. Discuss your result.
10.20 Develop a thermal design for a 2000-MW
e
pressurized water reactor core with
0.4 in. diameter, 15-ft-long fuel rods having an average linear power output of 16
kW/ft. Assume an average film coefficient of 4500 Btu/hr-ft
2
-R. Prepare a report.
437
C H A P T E R E L E V E N
Energy System Alternatives
Part 1. Electromagnetic Principles, Batteries, and Fuel Cells
11.1 Introduction
So far we have considered energy conversion systems that are in widespread use. In
this chapter we turn our attention to systems that, to date, have not had major impacts
in power generation but appear to have the potential to profoundly influence society
within the next few decades.
Most of the preceding study has examined power and propulsion systems that were
primarily the outgrowth of thermodynamics and fluid mechanics. We now consider
systems among which are several of a fundamentally different character. To better un-
derstand these systems, we must invest a little more time in reviewing electromagnetic
fundamentals.
In earlier chapters we considered numerous systems that employ the energy con-
version chain:
Energy source ; Heat ; Mechanical energy ; Electricity
In this chapter we are concerned with several conversion processes in which the heat-
to-mechanical energy transformation link is not essential:
Energy source ; Electricity
Such processes, in which the source energy is converted directly to electricity, are
called direct energy conversion processes. While direct energy conversion techniques
other than those discussed here exist, we will concentrate on a few that show potential
for large-scale power production and that could reach commercialization in the next
few decades. Specifically, we focus on fuel cells, solar photovoltaics, and magneto-
hydrodynamic systems. In addition, the application of batteries and hydrogen as energy
storage media are considered. Let us first develop some principles needed in the
analysis of these systems. It would be advantageous for students to relate the
fundamental material reviewed in the following sections to chemistry and physics texts
with which they are familiar.
438
11.2 Review of Electromagnetic Principles
A few principles of electromagnetics, fundamental to alternative energy systems, are
now reviewed. We will work almost exclusively with SI units in this chapter, except for
a few problems framed in the English system.
Charge
A unit of electrical charge, q, is the coulomb [C]. The electron has a negative charge of
1.610
-19
C and a mass of 9.110
-31
kg. Even the smallest positively charged particle,
the proton or hydrogen ion, has a mass more than a thousand times that of the electron.
As a result, the electron is much more mobile than neighboring ions and is usually the
dominant charge carrier. However, because electromagnetic theory is usually based on
the concept of the positive charge, we will think of an electric current as a flow of
positive charge, even though motion of electrons in the opposite direction usually
transports the charge.
Potential and Field
A positively charged particle influenced by other charged particles may be thought of as
being in a force field created by these particles. This field, known as an electric field,
may be represented by nonintersecting, usually curved surfaces of constant potential
(V) in three-dimensional space, as sketched in Figure 11.1.
Consider a charged particle located between two potential surfaces of potential
difference V
2
V
1
. A force is exerted on the particle in a direction perpendicular to the
local potential surface. The larger the potential difference between the two surfaces, the
larger the force. Also, the smaller the distance between surfaces of fixed potential
difference, the larger the force. The direction of the force on positively charged
particles is from high potential to low, and is oppositely directed for negative particles.
It was indicated that the strength of the force acting on a charged particle between
two potential surfaces depends on both the magnitude of V
2
V
1
and how close
together the surfaces are. An electric field vector is defined to account for both of these
factors. In one dimension, the electric field intensity E
x
is the negative of the rate of
change of potential with respect to distance, dV/dx, the limit of the local potential
difference per unit distance in the direction normal to the potential surface. Thus
E
x
= dV/dx lim (V
2
V
1
)/x [V/m] (11.1)
For a three-dimensional potential field given by V = V(x, y, z), the electric field intensity
is a vector, E (vectors are represented by boldface symbols here) which in terms of
Cartesian unit vectors i, j, k is
E = E
x
i + E
y
j + E
z
k [V/m] (11.2)
439
The electric field vector is related to the potential function V(x, y, z) by
E = V (x, y, z) = (iV/x + jV/y + kV/z) [V/m] (11.3)
where the derivatives in Equation (11.3) are partial derivatives. For a one-dimensional
potential, V = V(x), the derivatives with respect to y and z vanish; and the remaining
partial derivative becomes the total derivative dV/dx, consistent with Equation (11.1).
The electric field vector gives the magnitiude and direction of the force on a
positive charge in three-dimensional space. The force on the charge due to the electric
field is explicitly represented by the vector equation
F = qE [N] (11.4)
Equation (11.4) indicates that a force of one newton is exerted on a charge of one
coulomb in an electric field of one volt per meter. Hence one coulomb is one
newton-meter per volt, or one joule per volt [1 C = 1 N-m/V = 1 J/V].
440
The work done to move a positive charge a small distance dl against the electric
field (to a higher potential) is given by the scalar product of the force F and the
differential distance that the charge moves, dl = dxi + dyj + dzk. Using Equation (11.3),
the work is
w = 1 11 1F(dl = q1 11 1E( (( (dl = q (V
2
V
1
) [C-V] (11.5)
Work is done on the positive charge when the differential distance (dx in Figure 11.1)
has a component parallel to the force (and the electric field vector).
Consistent with the observation made in connection with the units of Equation
(11.4), Equation (11.5) shows that a coulomb-volt is the same as the usual measure of
work, the newton-meter or joule.
When the electric field is specified it becomes unnecessary to think in terms of the
associated charge distribution. The electric field may give rise to or resist motions of
positive charges or free electrons in the space occupied by the field, just as the original
charge distribution would have.
Current and Power
A motion of charges through an electrically conducting medium is called a current. The
current is the rate at which positive charge passes through a given surface. It is
measured in coulombs per second [C/s] or amperes [A]
I = dq/dt [A] (11.6)
A current flow produced by an electric field is in the direction of the field and thus is in
the direction of decreasing potential, as shown in Figure 11.2. Correspondingly,
electrons flow from low to high potential in a direction opposite to the conventional
current.
Power is the rate at which work is done. Using Equation (11.5)
Power = dw/dt = Vdq/dt = VI [W] (11.7)
where we now use V for potential difference, as is common. Here it is seen that the unit
of power, the watt [W], is the equivalent of the product of amperes and volts [A-V].
Current flows in a medium because of the forces exerted on the charges. For a
given potential difference, the current is smaller or larger depending on the ease with
which the charges pass through the medium. Thus the current is proportional to the
applied potential difference and the conductance, G, of the conducting medium. The
conductance is usually expressed in terms of its inverse, the resistance R = 1/G.
Resistance is defined by Ohm's Law:
R = V / I = 1/G [ 5 ] (11.8)
441
Ohms Law defines the unit of resistance, the ohm, as the ratio of a volt to an ampere
5 =V/A. Thus the unit of conductance is the inverse ohm or mho 5
1
.
EXAMPLE 11.1
A 12-V battery produces a current of 7 A in a load resistor. Estimate the power deliv-
ered to the resistor by the electric field created by the terminals and the magnitude of
the resistance. Explain the phenomena in terms of current and electron flow.
Solution
The resistive load has a resistance of R = V/I = 12 / 7 = 1.71 5
The power output of the battery is IV =7 12= 84 W.
Current flows from the positive terminal through the load resistor to the negative
terminal because of work done by the electric field applied by the battery terminals. In
reality, work is done on electrons passing from the negative to the positive terminals.
Chemical reactions within the battery provide the energy to move the electrons from
the positive to the negative terminals within the battery.
_____________________________________________________________________
442
The terms conductance and resistance refer to characteristics of a specific configur-
ation of a conducting material. The terms electrical conductivity and electrical
resistivity refer to intrinsic electrical properties of the material itself. We shall see that
the latter properties often are used in dealing with currents in multidimensional fields.
The current density J [A/m
2
] is defined as the current per unit cross-sectional area
normal to the direction of the current. The electric field vector and the current density
are related (Figure 11.2) in a generalized form of Ohm's Law by
J = .E [A/m
2
] (11.9)
where . is the electrical conductivity of an isotropic conducting medium. In general,
when a medium has conductivity varying in direction, the medium is called
anisotropic. Here we need only consider the isotropic case, where the conductivity of
the medium is the same in all directions.
Note that Equation (11.9) indicates that . must have units of (A/m
2
)/(V/m) or
(5-m)
1
. For a cylindrically-shaped conductor, Equation (11.9) may be expressed in
terms of the current and potential difference to show that the electrical conductivity is
related to the resistance of the conductor by
. = J/E = (I/A)/(V/L) = L/(RA) [(5-m)
-1
] (11.10)
where L and A are the length and cross-sectional area of the conductor, respectively.
Rewriting Equation (11.10) as R = L/(A.), we see that the resistance of a conductor is
proportional to its length and inversely proportional to the electrical conductivity and
cross-sectional area, as expected. The electrical resistivity , [5-m] is the inverse of
the electrical conductivity. Thus the resistance of a cylindrical conductor may be
written in terms of resistivity as R = L,/A.
Magnetic Field
We have seen that the electric field may be thought of as representing the effect of a
charge distribution on a test charge. Now we turn our attention to a fundamentally
different field.
A stationary magnetic field exists between the north and south poles of a bar or
horseshoe magnet (Figure 11.3). A magnet may be thought of as a collection of tiny
magnetic elements, or domains, each having its own north and south poles, which are
aligned to produce the magnetic field of the magnet. Magnetic field lines are always
closed or terminate on magnetic poles, as opposed to electric field lines, which
terminate on charges.
It was observed by Oersted in 1819 that a small magnet deflects when placed in the
neighborhood of a wire carrying an electric current. This is explained by the existence
of circular magnetic field lines that surround the conductor, as shown in Figure 11.4.
Thus not only magnets but electric currents and moving electric charges give rise to
443
magnetic fields. In view of the connection of currents and electric fields, Oersteds
discovery indicates that electric fields may produce magnetic fields.
A magnetic field vector B, called the magnetic induction or magnetic flux density,
is a measure of the strength of a magnetic field and indicates its direction at any point in
space (Figures 11.3 and 11.4). Magnetic flux density is measured in webers per square
meter [Wb/m
2
]. A weber is equivalent to a volt-second. The unit of weber per square
meter is also called a tesla.
444
The magnetic field lines around a circular conductor of electricity are continuous
concentric circles, as indicated in Figure 11.4. The direction of the magnetic flux or
lines of force around a current carrying conductor is given by the direction of the
fingers of the right hand when they are wrapped around it with the thumb pointing in
the direction of the current flow.
Twelve years after Oersted observed that electric fields (which produce charge
motion, or electric currents) give rise to magnetic fields, Michael Faraday (1831)
discovered that magnetic fields can create electric fields. Faraday observed that a
current was induced in a stationary circuit by a changing magnetic field produced by a
nearby moving magnet. That changing magnetic field could have been created by (1) a
transient current in a nearby stationary circuit, (2) motion of a nearby circuit with a
constant current, or (3) motion of a magnet in the vicinity. A current, and thus an
electric field, is generated in any conductor that experiences a change in its local
magnetic field, regardless of whether the observed change is due to the motion of a
magnet or to motion of the conductor itself through a stationary magnetic field. The
latter phenomenon is the basis of the operation of an electrical generator in which
stationary magnets create a current in a rotating armature.
The force exerted on a positive charge in a magnetic field is proportional to the
vector product of the charge velocity and the magnetic field strength:

F = quB [N] (11.11)
The vector product indicates that charges in a conductor moving with a velocity u
through a magnetic field experience a force in a direction perpendicular to the plane
defined by the vectors u and B. As indicated in Figure 11.5, the sense of the force is
readily determined by rotating the four fingers of the right hand from the velocity
vector to the B vector. The direction of the extended thumb during this operation gives
the direction of the force. The force exerted on a coil of an armature of an electric
motor is an example of this magnetic action.
In general, both electric and magnetic fields occupy the same space, Thus it is not
unusual to speak of a single electromagnetic field represented by the electric and
magnetic field vectors. If the electric field intensity is Eand the magnetic flux density is
B at a given location, the total electromagnetic force acting on a charged particle there,
called the Lorentz force, is given by
F = q(E' + uB) [N] (11.12)
Thus the charge experiences a force that is the vector sum of the electric field vector
and a vector perpendicular to both the charge velocity and magnetic flux vectors.
In a coordinate system moving with the velocity u, the Lorentz force would be
given by F = qE because the observer in this system sees no motion of the charge. Thus
the electromagnetic field felt by the charge may be expressed as an electric field:
445
E = E' + uB [N/C] (11.13)
Here E' is the field existing at the charge location in a stationary coordinate system and
E is the effective electric field sensed by the charge. Thus in a moving coordinate
system, the influence of the magnetic field appears as part of the electric field vector.
While our purpose here has been to establish the concepts and relations necessary
for an understanding of the energy conversion systems discussed in this chapter, we
would be remiss to move on without a few closing comments. We have discussed the
interactions of two invisible fields. These spatially varying fields may be thought of as
existing in all of space. These are not merely mathematical abstractions but real
phenomena. What better proofs of their reality than the electromagnetic waves that a
portable radio picks out of space and converts to music to entertain us as we walk or
jog, the warmth of solar radiation and the chill of its absence when passing through
shade, and the interplanetary signals from space probes that provide amazing views of
other planets?
The study of the physics and mathematics of these fields and related phenomena
culminated in the formulation of a set of four partial differential equations involving E
and B that govern electromagnetics. These famous equations known as Maxwell's
equations, were firmly established on a consistent basis by James Clerk Maxwell in
446
1860. They mark one of the great triumphs of science because they are capable of
quantitatively defining details of countless phenomena in the areas of electricity,
magnetism, and radiation. Their use in detailed research and development in energy
conversion devices goes well beyond the brief introduction to electromagnetic theory
given here. Interested readers may consult, among others, references 6, 26, and 64 for
broader and deeper treatments of the subject.

11.3 Batteries and Fuel Cells
Batteries and fuel cells, while structurally and functionally distinct, are based on similar
electrochemical principles and technologies. For that reason we have chosen to
introduce them together to emphasize their common scientific foundations. They are,
however, easily distinguishable, because batteries are devices for the storage of
electrical energy, while fuel cells are energy converters with no inherent energy storage
capability. A battery contains a finite amount of chemicals that spontaneously react to
produce a flow of electrons when a conducting path is connected to its terminals, as
447
shown in Figure 11.6. Fuel cells behave similarly, except that chemical reactants are
continuously supplied from outside the cell and products are eliminated in continuous,
steady streams.
The chemical reactions in batteries and fuel cells are oxidation-reduction reactions.
A common terminology exists for both types of cells. Both contain electrode pairs in
contact with an intervening electrolyte (the charge-carrying medium), as in Figure 11.6.
The electrolyte is a solution through which positively charged ions pass from the anode
to the cathode. The negative electrode, called the anode, is where an oxidation reaction
takes place, delivering electrons to the external circuit. The positive electrode, where
reduction occurs, is called the cathode. Electrons flow through the external load from
the negative to the positive electrode, while the conventional current flows in the
opposite direction from high to low potential. At the cathode, electrons arriving from
the external load are neutralized by reaction with positive ions from the electrolyte.
The use of electrical storage cells dates back to the early 1800s. In 1800, Alessan-
dro Volta gave the first description of an electrochemical cell in a letter to the British
Royal Society. The invention of the telegraph in the 1830s provided strong motivation
for the development and manufacture of this electrical energy source. Though the
electrochemical cell provided electrical energy for the telegraph and other inventions, it
would be half a century before central plant electrical power became available. In 1839,
Sir William Grove demonstrated the fuel cell concept, but it was not until the 1950s
that significant progress was made toward the development of useful fuel cells.
Batteries designed for a single discharge cycle (flashlight batteries, for example) are
called primary cells; those that can be discharged and recharged numerous times are
called secondary cells. Fuel cells, on the other hand, utilize chemicals that flow into the
cell to provide a more or less continuous supply of direct current. Before considering
the exciting possibilities of fuel cells, we will take a brief look at batteries, with
emphasis on secondary cells because of their current and future technical importance.
Batteries
Enormous numbers of batteries are used in a variety of applications, from the tiny
button cells in wristwatches, to the cells in flashlights, to the starting, lighting, and
ignition (SLI) batteries in automobiles, to the large batteries found in submarines for
submersed operations, as well as in emergency power supplies, and remote relay
stations. Batteries have been considered for some time for load-leveling power plants as
alternatives to pumped hydroelectric and compressed-air storage. While batteries have
been used as propulsion power sources for road vehicles for about a century (according
to ref. 10 an electric car held the world land speed record of 66 mph in 1899), they
have not been competitive with the fossil-fueled internal combustion engine. However,
448
a renewed interest in this application has developed as research in battery technology
and the public sensitivity to pollution by internal combustion engine-propelled vehicles
has become more advanced.
It has been pointed out that batteries are basically devices for storing charge and
automatically delivering an electrical current flow, on demand, for a limited time. A
battery consists of one or more cells connected in series to provide a particular open
circuit voltage or electromotive force (EMF). Each chemical cell typically has an EMF
of about two volts, although the exact value is dependent on the specific cell reactants.
A Simple Mathematical Model of a Battery. When current is drawn from a battery,
the voltage across its terminals decreases below its EMF, largely due to the internal
voltage drop associated with the battery's internal resistance. Thus a simple model of a
battery involves a constant voltage source in series with a constant resistance.
Following Figure 11.7, the terminal voltage for this model is given by the difference
between the EMF and the internal resistive potential drop:
V = E IR
i
[V] (11.14)
and the current is
I = E /(R
i
+ R
o
) [A] (11.15)
EXAMPLE 11.2
The voltage of a lead-acid battery with an EMF of 12.7 V is measured as 11.1 V when
it delivers a current of 50 amperes to an external resistance. What are the internal and
external resistances? What is the battery voltage and the current flow through a 5-5
resistor? Sketch the voltagecurrent characteristic.
449
Solution
Solving Equation (11.14) for R
i
and Equation (11.15) for R
o
, we obtain the internal and
external resistances:
R
i
= (E V)/I = (12.7 11.1)/50 = 0.032 5
R
o
= E / I R
i
= 12.7/50 0.032 = 0.222 5
With the constant internal resistance established, the current flow through a 5-5
external resistor is then given by Equation (11.15):
I = E/(R
i
+ R
o
) = 12.7/(0.032 + 5) = 2.524 A
Note that if R
o
were infinite in Equation (11.15), the current would vanish and the cell
voltage would be equal to the EMF, as in an open circuit.
The cell voltage with the 5-5 resistor is given by equation (11.14):
V = E IR
i
= 12.7 2.524(0.032) = 12.62 V
or
V = IR
o
= 2.524(5) = 12.62 V
By Equation (11.14), the voltage characteristic is a straight line (see Figure 11.8) with
intercept E and slope R
i
.
_____________________________________________________________________
450
While the linear model is useful and informative, it does not conform precisely to
real battery characteristics. As in the model, real batteries are capable of providing
current and power to a wide range of resistances with little voltage drop for short
periods of time. However, the model fails for long periods of time and when large
currents are drawn, because it does not account for the finite amount of stored chemical
energy and reaction rate limitations encountered in real batteries. In these circumstan-
ces, the terminal voltage and power output drop drastically as cell chemicals are
consumed.
Secondary cell reactions are approximately internally reversible. Thus, by applica-
tion of an external direct current source, internal battery reactions may be reversed over
a period of time in a process called charging. In a conventional automotive application,
electrical power for lighting, ignition, radio, and so on is supplied by an engine-driven
alternator. Normally, the battery is required only for engine starting and to compensate
for possible alternator output deficits when the engine runs slowly. A voltage regulator
maintains a steady electrical system voltage and controls battery charging when excess
alternator current is available and needed. According to reference 27, the regulator
limits the charging voltage of a 12-V battery to about 14.4 V.
Battery Performance Parameters. Important parameters characterizing battery
performance are the storage capacity, cold-cranking amperes, reserve capacity, energy
efficiency, and energy density.
The storage capacity, a measure of the total electric charge of the battery, is usually
quoted in ampere-hours rather than in coulombs ( 1 amp-hour = 3600 C). It is an
indication of the capability of a battery to deliver a particular current value for a given
duration. Thus a battery that can discharge at a rate of 5 A for 20 hours has a capacity
of 100 A-hr. Capacity is also sometimes indicated as energy storage capacity, in
watt-hours.
Cold-cranking-amperage, CCA, for a battery composed of nominal 2-V cells is the
highest current, in amperes, that the battery can deliver for 30 seconds at a temp-
erature of 0F and still maintain a voltage of 1.2 V per cell (ref. 27). The CCA is
commonly used in automotive applications, where the problem of high engine
resistance to starting in cold winter conditions is compounded by reduced battery
performance. At 0F the cranking resistance of an automobile engine may be increased
more than a factor of two over its starting power requirement at 80F, while the battery
output at the lower temperature is reduced to 40% of its normal output. The reduction
in battery output at low temperatures is due to the fact that chemical reaction rates
decrease as temperature decreases.
The reserve capacity rating is the time, in minutes, that an SLI battery will deliver
25 amperes at 80F. This is an indication of how long the battery would continue to
satisfy essential automotive operating requirements if the alternator were to fail.
Other parameters evaluate batteries with respect to energy for traction or other
deep-cycling applications where, in contrast to SLI applications, their state of charge
becomes low regularly. The energy efficiency is the ratio of the energy delivered by a
451
fully charged battery to the recharging energy required to restore its original state of
charge. For transportation purposes where weight and volume are critical, the energy
density is an important parameter. It may be represented on a mass basis, in watt-hours
per kilogram, or on a volume basis, in watt-hours per cubic meter.
Analysis of a Cell. Consider a reversible cell with a terminal potential difference V
discharging with a current I through a variable resistance. The flow of electrons
through the load produces the instantaneous electrical power, IV. At low currents the
cell voltage is close to the cell EMF and the external work done and power output are
small. Suppose that chemical reaction in the battery consumes reactant at an electrode
at a rate of n
c
moles per second. Electrons released in the reaction flow through the
electrode to the external load at a rate proportional to the rate of reaction, jn
c
, where j
is the number of moles of electrons released per mole of reactants. It will be seen later
that, for a lead-acid battery, two moles of electrons are freed to flow through the
external load for each mole of lead reacted. Hence, in this case j = 2. Thus jn
c
is the
rate of flow of electrons from the cell, in moles of electrons per second. There are
6.02310
23
electrons per gram-mole of electrons, and each has a charge of 1.60210
-19
C. Thus the product
F = (6.02310
23
)(1.60210
-19
) = 96,488 C/gram-mole
is the charge transported by a gram-mole of electrons. The constant F is called
Faraday's Constant, in honor of Michael Faraday, a great pioneer of electrochemistry.
The electric current from a cell may then be related to the rate of reaction in the cell as
I = jn
c
F [A] (11.16)
and the instantaneous power delivered by the cell is:
Power = jn
c
FV [W] (11.17)

The cell electrode and electrolyte materials and cell design determine the maximum cell
voltage. Equations (11.16) and (11.17) show that the nature and rate of chemical
reaction control the cell current and maximum power output of a cell. Moreover, it is
clear that the store of consumable battery reactants sets a limit on battery capacity.
Lead-Acid Batteries. By far the most widely used secondary battery is the
lead/sulfuric acid/lead oxide (Pb/H
2
SO
4
/PbO
2
), or lead-acid battery, by virtue of its
widespread application in automomobiles for starting, lighting, and ignition and in
452
traction batteries used in rail and street vehicles, golf carts, and electrically powered
industrial trucks. An automotive lead-acid battery is shown schematically in Figure
11.9. Today most lead-acid batteries are 12-V designs, assembled as six 2-V cells in
series.
Each cell consists of a porous sponge lead anode and a lead dioxide cathode
(usually in the form of plates) separated by porous membranes in a sulfuric acid
solution. The aqueous electrolyte contains positive hydrogen and negative sulfate ions
resulting from dissociation of the sulfuric acid in solution:
2H
2
SO
4
=> 4H
+
+ 2(SO
4
)
2
At the anode, the lead releases two electrons to the external load as it is converted to
lead sulfate:
453
Pb(s) + SO
4
2
(aq) => PbSO
4
(s) + 2e

This shows that two moles of electrons are produced for each mole of sulfate ions and
sponge lead reacted. Thus j = 2 for the lead-acid cell in Equations (11.16) and (11.17).
Meanwhile at the cathode, lead dioxide is converted to lead sulfate in the reduction
reaction involving hydrogen and sulfate ions from the electrolyte and electrons from the
external circuit:
PbO
2
(s) + 4H
+
(aq) + SO
4
2
(aq) +2e

<=> PbSO
4
+ 2H
2
O (l)
The equations show that the sulfate radical (and thus sulfuric acid) is consumed at both
electrodes, and that hydrogen ions combine with oxygen from the cathode material to
form water that is retained in the cell. Thus the water formed as the battery discharges
makes the sulfuric acid electrolyte more dilute. This is also seen in the net cell reaction,
obtained as the sum of the electrode and electrolyte reactions:
Pb(s) + PbO
2
(s) + 2H
2
SO
4
(aq) <=> 2PbSO
4
(s) + 2H
2
O (l)
It is clear that during battery discharge the lead and lead oxide electrodes are con-
verted to lead sulfate. Furthermore, sulfuric acid is consumed and water is produced.
The production of water and the consumption of sulfuric acid make the electrolyte
more dilute and decrease its specific gravity. The specific gravity drops from about
1.265 when the battery is fully charged to about 1.12 when fully discharged (ref. 27).
Thus the cell specific gravity is a measure of the state of discharge of the battery. A
simple device called a hydrometer, which temporarily withdraws electrolyte from an
open battery, gives a visual indication of the electrolyte specific gravity. The depth of
the float in the hydrometer electrolyte indicates its specific gravity and thus the battery
state of charge. When any of the reactants is depleted, the battery ceases to function.
When the battery is charged by applying an external power source, the electron flow is
reversed, the previously displayed reactions also reverse, and water is consumed to
produce sulfate and hydrogen ions from the lead sulfate on the electrodes.
EXAMPLE 11.3
Consider the battery model of Example 11.2 for the case of 50-A current. Determine
the instantaneous power output, in watts, and the rate of consumption of sulfuric acid
of the cell, in kilograms per hour.
Solution
Power = IV = (11.1) (50) = 555 W
Two moles of electrons are produced for each mole of sulfuric acid consumed at the
anode. From Equation (11.16),
454
n
c
= I/jF = 50/(2 ( 96,487) = 0.000259 gm-moles/s
Because sulfuric acid is consumed at the cathode at the same rate as at the anode, the
total rate of acid consumption is 0.000518 gm-moles /s, or 5.18 10
7
kg-moles/s. The
molecular weight of sulfuric acid is 98, so the mass rate of acid consumption is
(5.18 10
7
)(98) = 5.078 10
5
kg/s
or
(5.078 10
5
)(3600) = 0.1828 kg/hr
_____________________________________________________________________
Battery Applications. It is important to distinguish between SLI and traction
batteries. The design of the SLI battery is governed primarily by the cranking
requirements of the vehicle, usually a high current flow for a brief time interval. Once
the engine is started, the alternator provides power for vehicle operating loads and to
recharge the battery. During normal driving the alternator satisfies the power needs of
lighting, ignition, and other electrical functions. Thus a SLI battery is usually close to
fully charged and seldom deeply discharged.
455
The traction battery, on the other hand, usually has no energy converter available to
continuously maintain the fully charged level. Thus the traction battery must be capable
of operation from fully charged to almost fully discharged over a period of several
hours. At least eight hours daily are normally required to return the battery to its fully
charged level. This type of secondary cell is appropriate for vehicle propulsion and
power plant peak-shaving applications. In the latter instance, off-peak base-load power
is used to charge the battery. Later, during peak-demand periods, the battery returns a
large fraction of the charging energy to the system. Such a battery is designed for
thousands of charge and discharge cycles.
According to reference 4, a 10-MW, 40 MW-hr lead-acid battery storage facility
was built at the Southern California Edison Company at Chino. It was designed for
load-leveling use for at least 2000 deep-discharge cycles and 80% energy efficiency. Six
of the cells were tested at 50C and achieved 2300 cycles while retaining 108% of rated
capacity (ref. 33). The facility, shown in Figure 11.10, uses strings of 1032
deep-discharge, 2-V lead-acid cells connected in series to provide a nominal bus
voltage of 2000 V DC. A total of 8256 2-V cells, each weighing 580 pounds, are used
to store 40 MW-hr for a 4-hr daily discharge cycle. A power conditioning system acts
as both an inverter to provide AC output to the utility and as a rectifier to convert
utility AC to DC for battery charging. The system is designed to utilize the responsive-
ness of battery storage to deal with wide load swings. The Chino facility is said to be
able to swing from 10-MW discharge to 10-MW charge in about 16 milliseconds.
According to references 4 and 11, lead-acid batteries can now deliver energy
densities of more than 40 W-h/kg. This is less than the expected performance of several
other battery types. Nickel-iron batteries with an energy density of 50.4 W-hr/kg, for
instance, were among 10 types endurance-tested in an electric vehicle. A van with
nickel-iron batteries logged over 44,000 miles, as compared to fewer than 27,000 miles
for the best performance by a lead-acid-battery-equipped van. Nickel-iron batteries,
while noted for ruggedness and long life, suffer from a low energy efficiency of about
60% (ref. 34).
Space limitations allow the present discussion to only hint at the more than a
century of research and the sophistication of the science and engineering of batteries.
Fuel Cells
Whereas batteries store energy in the form of chemical energy and subsequently trans-
form it to electricity, fuel cells are capable of continuous transformation of chemical
energy into electrical energy without intermediate thermal-to-mechanical conversion.
Fuel cells may be thought of as chemical reactors similar to storage batteries, but with
external supplies of fuel and oxidizer that react for indefinitely long time periods
without substantial change in cell materials. Thus fuel cells do not run down or require
recharging. As in a storage battery, reactions take place at electrodes, giving rise to a
456
flow of electrons through an external circuit as depicted in Figure 11.11. An electrolyte,
between the electrodes, again provides a medium for ion transfer. This allows electrons
to flow through the external load while ion transport through the electrolyte maintains
overall electrical neutrality of the cell.
An important element of fuel cell design is that, like large batteries, they are built
from a large number of identical unit cells. Each has an open-circuit voltage on the
order of one volt, depending on the oxidation-reduction reactions taking place. The fuel
cells are usually built in sandwich-style assemblies called stacks. The schematic in
Figure 11.12 shows crossflows of fuel and oxidant through a portion of a stack.
457
Electrically conducting bipolar separator plates serve as direct current transmission
paths between successive cells. This modular type of construction allows research and
development of individual cells and engineering of fuel cell systems to proceed in
parallel.
A photograph of a 32-kW phosphoric acid fuel cell stack is shown in Figure
11.13(a). A conceptual design of a nominal 100-kW stack using three of the 32-kW
stacks appears in Figure 11.13(b). Phosphoric acid fuel cells ideally operate with
hydrogen as fuel and oxygen as oxidizer. To be economically practical in most
applications, these fuel cells will probably require the use of a hydrocarbon fuel as a
source of hydrogen and air as an oxidizer.
Consider the basic chemical reactions in a hydrogen-oxygen fuel cell as shown in
Figure 11.11. Hydrogen molecules supplied at the anode are oxidized (lose electrons),
each forming two hydrogen ions that drift through an electrolyte to the cathode.
Electrons liberated from the hydrogen at the anode pass through an external circuit to
the cathode, where they combine in a reduction reaction with the H
+
ions from the
electrolyte and an external supply of oxygen to form water. The electrode and overall
cell reaction equations are:
458
H
2
; 2H
+
+ 2e

at the anode
2H
+
+ 2e

+ 0.5O
2
; H
2
O at the cathode
H
2
+ 0.5O
2
; H
2
O overall cell reaction
Thus the sole reaction product of a hydrogenoxygen fuel cell is water, an ideal
product from a pollution standpoint. In manned-space-vehicle applications the water is
used for drinking and/or sanitary purposes. In addition to electrons, heat is also a
reaction product. This heat must be continuously removed, as it is generated, in order
to keep the cell reaction isothermal.
In the fuel cell, as in the battery, the reactions at the electrodes are surface pheno-
mena. They occur at a liquid-solid or gas-solid interface and therefore proceed at a rate
proportional to the exposed area of the solid. For this reason porous electrode materials
are used, frequently porous carbon impregnated or coated with a catalyst to speed the
reactions. Thus, because of microscopic pores, the electrodes effectively have a surface
area many times their visible area. Any phenomenon that prevents the gas from entering
the pores or deactivates the catalyst must be avoided if the cell is to function effectively
over long time periods. Because of the reaction ratearea relation, fuel cell current and
power output increase with increased cell area. The power density [W/m
2
] therefore is
an important parameter in comparing fuel cell designs, and the power output of a fuel
cell can be scaled up by increasing its surface area.
The electrolyte acts as a medium for ion transport between electrodes. The rate of
passage of positive charge through the electrolyte must match the rate of electron
arrival at the opposite electrode to satisfy the physical requirement of electrical neutral-
ity of the discharge fluids. Impediments to the rate of ion transport through the electro-
lyte can limit current flow and hence power output. Thus care must be taken in design
to minimize the length of ion travel path and other factors that retard ion transport.
Fuel Cell Thermodynamic Analysis and Efficiencies. The theoretical maximum
work of an isothermal fuel cell (or other isothermal reversible control volume) is the
difference in Gibbs function (or free energy) of the reactants (r) and the products (p).
Because the enthalpy, entropy, and temperature are all thermodynamic properties, the
Gibbs function, g = h Ts, is also a thermodynamic property. From the First Law, the
work leaving the control volume is
w = h
r
h
p
+ q [J/g-mole] (11.18)
For a reversible isothermal process, q = T(s
p
s
r
), and the maximum work can be
written as
w
max
= h
r
h
p
+ T(s
p
s
r
) = g
r
g
p
[J/g-mole] (11.19)
459
Thus the maximum work output of which a fuel cell is capable is given by the decrease
in the Gibbs function.
But the maximum energy available from the fuel in an adiabatic steady-flow process
is the difference in inlet and exit enthalpies, h
r
h
p
. Defining the fuel cell thermal
efficiency as w
max
/(h
r
h
p
), we obtain

th
= (g
r
g
p
)/(h
r
h
p
)
= 1 T(s
r
s
p
)/(h
r
h
p
) [dl] (11.20)
The enthalpies and Gibbs function may be obtained from the JANAF tables for the
appropriate substances (ref. 77).
EXAMPLE 11.4
Evaluate the open-circuit voltage, maximum work, and thermal efficiency for a direct
hydrogen-oxygen fuel cell at the standard reference conditions for the JANAF tables.
Consider the two cases when the product water is in the liquid and vapor phases.
Solution
The maximum work of the fuel cell is given by equation (11.19). The thermodynamic
properties needed are obtained from the formation properties of the JANAF
thermodynamic tables:
h
p
(l) = h
f
[H
2
O(l)] = 285,830 kJ/kg-mole
h
p
(g) = h
f
[H
2
O(g)] = 241,826 kJ/kg-mole
h
r
= h
f
[H
2
] + 0.5h
f
[O
2
] = 0.0 kJ/kg-mole
g
p
(l) = g
f
[H
2
O(l)] = 237,141 kJ/kg-mole
g
p
(g) = g
f
[H
2
O(g)] = 228,582 kj/kg-mole
g
r
= g
f
[H
2
] + 0.5g
f
[O
2
] = 0.0 kJ/kg-mole
Thus the maximum work for liquid-water product is:
w
max
(l) = g
r
g
p
(l) = 0 ( 237,141) = 237,141 kJ/kg-mole
and for water-vapor product is
w
max
(g) = g
r
g
p
(g) = 0 ( 228,582) = 228,582 kJ/kg-mole
of H
2
consumed or water produced in the reaction.
The theoretical ideal open-circuit voltage of the cell may also be determined from
the Gibbs function using, for liquid-water product,
EMF(l) = w
max
(l)/( jF) = 237,14110
3
/(29.648710
7
) = 1.229 V
460
For water-vapor product:
EMF(g) = w
max
(g)/( jF) = 228,582x10
3
/(29.648710
7
) = 1.18 V
By Equation (11.20), the thermal efficiency with liquid-water product is

th
(l) = 237,141/285,830 = 0.8297
and with water-vapor product is

th
(g) = 228,582/241,826 = 0.945
Regardless of the phase of the product water, a large fraction of the available enthalpy
of the reactant flow is converted to work in the ideal isothermal hydrogen-oxygen fuel
cell. Because the fuel cell operates as a steady-flow isothermal process and not in a
cycle, the Carnot efficiency limit does not apply.
_____________________________________________________________________
Fuel cells, like other energy conversion systems do not function in exact conform-
ance with simplistic models or without inefficiencies. Open-circuit potentials of 0.70.9
volts are typical, and losses or inefficiencies in fuel cells, often called polarizations, are
reflected in a cell voltage drop when the fuel cell is under load. Three major types of
polarization are:
Ohmic Polarization: The internal resistance to the motion of electrons through
electrodes and of ions through the electrolyte.
Concentration Polarization: Mass transport effects relating to diffusion of gases
through porous electrodes and to the solution and dissolution of reactants and
products.
Activation Polarization: Related to the activation energy barriers for the various
steps in the oxidation-reduction reactions at the electrodes.
The net effect of these and other polarizations is a decline in terminal voltage with
increasing current drawn by the load. This voltage drop is reflected in a peak in the
power-current characteristic.
The high thermal efficiencies predicted in Example 11.4 are based on operation of
the fuel cell as an isothermal, steady-flow process. Although heat must be rejected, the
transformation of chemical energy directly into electron flow does not rely on heat
rejection in a cyclic process to a sink at low temperature as in a heat engine, which is
why the Carnot efficiency limit does not apply. However, inefficiency associated with
the various polarizations and incomplete fuel utilization reduce overall cell conversion
efficiencies to well below the thermal efficiencies predicted in the example.
461
Fuel cell conversion efficiency,
fc
, is defined as the electrical energy output per
unit mass (or mole) of fuel to the corresponding heating value of the fuel consumed.
Defining the voltage efficiency,
V
, as the ratio of the terminal voltage to the
theoretical EMF, V/EMF, and the current efficiency,
I
, as the ratio of the cell
electrical current to the theoretical charge flow associated with the fuel consumption,
we find that the conversion efficiency is related to the thermal efficiency by

fc
= (V/EMF)[I /( jFn
c
)]
th
=
V

I

th

Thus the voltage efficiency accounts for the various cell polarizations previously
described. Fuel cell conversion efficiencies in the range of 4060% have been
demonstrated and are possible in large-scale power plants.
EXAMPLE 11.5
The DC output voltage of a hydrogen-oxygen fuel cell with liquid-water product is 0.8
V. Assuming a current efficiency of 1, what is the fuel cell conversion efficiency?
Solution
From Example 11.4, the thermal efficiency is 0.8297 and the EMF is 1.229 V. The fuel
cell conversion efficiency is then

fc
=
V

I

th
= (0.8/1.229)(0.8297(1.0 = 0.54
_____________________________________________________________________
If heat rejected in high-temperature fuel cells is used and not wasted, overall energy
efficiencies as high as 80% may be attainable. In cells that operate at high temperatures,
there is an opportunity to use the thermal energy of the cell reaction products for
cogeneration purposes or in a combined cycle, with a steam turbine or a gas turbine
using the waste heat.
It is evident that the power output of fuel cells depends on the rate at which the
reactants are consumed in the cell, just as the output of other steady-flow energy
conversion systems depend on fuel and air supply rates. In low-temperature fuel cells,
expensive catalysts (such as platinum) are required, to increase the rates of chemical
reaction at the electrodes so that the fuel cells will be small enough to achieve
reasonable power densities (per unit mass and volume).
Because chemical reaction rates increase with temperature, high-temperature fuel
cells can achieve satisfactory reaction rates without catalysts or with reduced quantities.
This advantage of high temperature may be offset by increased corrosion rates and
other adverse effects of high temperature that reduce the fuel cells active life. For
utility applications, long, active cell life (about 40,000 hours) is considered an
462
important design characteristic. It has been suggested, however, that the fuel cell stack
may be a relatively small part of the cost of generation in large combined-cycle fuel cell
power plants designed for long life, so that it may be acceptable to replace fuel cell
stacks after shorter operating periods than other plant components, as is done with fuel
rods in nuclear reactors.
While space vehicle fuel cells successfully operate on pure hydrogen and oxygen,
stationary and vehicle power plants are more likely to be viable if they consume
hydrocarbon fuels and air. Thus the goals of major fuel cell research and development
programs focus on systems that incorporate the use of natural gas or other
hydrogen-rich fuels. A utility fuel cell system appears schematically as in Figure 11.14.
A fuel processor upstream of the fuel cell stack is used to prepare the incoming fuel. Its
primary functions are conversion of the incoming fuel to a hydrogen-rich gas and
removal of impurities such as sulphur. For natural gas, syngas, or other gaseous fuels,
463
the hydrocarbons may be converted by a steam-reforming process such as that for
methane:
CH
4
+ H
2
O ; CO + 3H
2
to produce a mixture of hydrogen and carbon monoxide. The carbon monoxide in the
products can then be converted to CO
2
and produce more hydrogen in the so-called
shift reaction:
CO + H
2
O ; CO
2
+ H
2

The direct current generated by a fuel cell for utility use must be converted to
alternating current by a power conditioner, as the figure suggests. High-efficiency solid,
state inverters are used for this function.
Following Figure 11.14, the overall fuel cell system efficiency is then the product of
a power conditioner efficiency (AC power output / DC power output), a fuel
processing efficiency (enthalpy change of hydrogen / heating value of supply fuel), and
the ratio of the sum of the fuel cell DC output and bottoming cycle power to the
hydrogen enthalpy change.
Fuel Cell Types. Table 11.1 indicates the major fuel cell types, their convenient
abbreviations, and their nominal operating temperatures. Fuel cells are usually
classified according to their electrolytes, as indicated by the types in the table. While the
alkaline and polymer electrolyte fuel cells were successfully demonstrated in the NASA
Gemini (1-kW PEFC), Apollo (1.5-kW AFC), and Space Shuttle Orbiter (7-kW AFC)
programs, these were applications with short design operating lives that used expensive
catalysts to attain satisfactory reaction rates and thus may be appropriate only to space
and military applications and certain limited transportation uses.
Table 11.1 Fuel Cells of Current Technical Interest
Type Abbreviation Operating Temperature
Polymer electrolyte fuel cell PEFC 80C
Alkaline fuel cell AFC 100C
Phosphoric acid fuel cell PAFC 200C
Molten carbonate fuel cell MCFC 650C
Solid oxide fuel cell SOFC 1000C
464
The last three fuel cell types listed in the table (PAFC, MCFC, and SOFC) are
widely believed to be most likely to achieve commercialization for stationary power
production early in the 21
st
century. Figure 11.15 summarizes the reactants and flow
paths of these three types. The PAFC is most likely to be commercialized first, but
significant progress is being made in the advanced high-temperature technologies
represented by the MCFC and the SOFC.
Large-scale phosphoric acid fuel cell power plants have been explored based on
fuel cell stacks developed by International Fuel Cells, Inc. (IFC). A basic 10-ft
2
, 700-
kW unit is shown in Figure 11.16, together with its pressure vessel. According to
reference 36, The Tokyo Electric Power Company 11-MW Goi Station had twenty
700-kW fuel cell assemblies with an expected heat rate of 8300 Btu/kW-hr using
liquefied natural gas as fuel.
More recently, the IFC website (ref. 81) states that the PC 25
TM
(a 200-kW unit) is
one of five units comprising the largest commercial fuel cell system in the United
States, which became operational in the year 2000 for the U.S. Postal Service in
Anchorage, Alaska. The PC 25
TM
operates with hydrogen, natural gas, propane,
butane, naptha, or waste gases as its energy source. The website states that IFC
delivered its 200
th
PC25 in the year 2000, with 3.5 million total operating hours. The
PC 25 originally went into production in 1991.
465
Reference 82 states that the ONSI Corporation (a subsidiary of IFC) PC 25 fuel cell
delivers 35 to 40 percent electrical efficiency and up to 80 percent total efficiency with
heat recovery. A 1997 DOE report (ref. 87) explores the potential for a PC 25 fuel
cell cogeneration system retrofit in a large office building.
The first molten carbonate fuel cell power plant, a 100-kW plant operated by
Pacific Gas and Electric, despite being conservatively designed for simplicity and
reliability, was expected to have a heat rate of about 7000 Btu/kW-hr without a
bottoming cycle. This pilot plant, located at San Ramon, Calif., uses natural gas as fuel
and aimed for a cell lifetime of 25,000 hours (refs. 15 and 36). Reference 78 indicates
that verification and durability testing began in June 1991 leading to a series of 2-MW
demonstration plants starting in 1994, with first commercial units scheduled for 1997.
The Santa Clara Fuel Cell Demonstration project, fueled by natural gas, started
construction in 1994, produced first power in March 1996, and concluded the
demonstration in April 1997. Reference 84 indicates that it was the largest and most
efficient fuel cell power plant ever operated in the U.S...
Reference 85 announces the successful completion of the grid-connected operation
of a 250-kW, Fuel Cell Energy, Inc., demonstration plant as of June 2000. The plant
logged more than 11,800 hours and generated more than 1.8 million kilowatt-hours of
electricity. The plant is to be refitted to demonstrate a very-high-efficiency combined-
cycle operation with a gas turbine.
Perhaps the most promising fuel cell type is the solid oxide fuel cell. The use of a
solid electrolyte, as shown in Figure 11.17, allows a radical departure from the plate or
sandwich type of design. The individual cells are of a closed-end cylindrical design with
466
fuel manifolded to flow over the outside electrode and air on the inside communicating
with the inner electrode through a porous cylindrical support structure. The clever fuel,
air, and exhaust manifolding and electrical connections of this design are apparent in
Figures 11.17 and 11.18. The high-temperature design allows operation without
catalysts and provides an excellent opportunity to use a bottoming cycle.
Beyond high efficiency, there are several additional major characteristics of fuel
cells that make them particularly attractive as energy conversion systems. First, fuel cell
operation has been shown to occur with very low levels of environmental pollution (ref.
15). It has been projected that commercial fuel cells may attain pollution levels that are
factors of ten below those of new conventional coal-burning power plants using the
best available pollution control equipment (ref. 16).
A second important characteristic is that, because most fuel cells operate with a
hydrogen-rich fuel or pure hydrogen, the fuel can be obtained from a number of
sources, such as petroleum, natural gas, naptha, methanol, and syngas made from coal.
Thus a commercial stationary power plant will have a chemical processor upstream of
the fuel cell stack as in Figure 11.14. The reforming and shift reactions likely to be used
will produce carbon dioxide as a product. This somewhat tarnishes the environmental
467
beauty of the hydrogen-oxygen fuel cell concept. The chemical process to obtain
hydrogen from some of the fuels may in some cases take place within the fuel cell stack.
Electrolysis of water may also be used to produce hydrogen and oxygen for fuel cell
use. This provides an opportunity for energy storage by using electricity generated by
base-loaded nuclear or conventional fossil fuel plants operating at off-peak hours. The
hydrogen and, when appropriate, oxygen could then be reacted in fuel cells to generate
electricity during periods of peak electrical demand at the central plant site or at other
locations.
It has been pointed out that the modular nature of fuel cells and of fuel cell stacks is
an important characteristic of this technology. Because of this modularity, a given cell
design could lead to a range of power plant designs such as large utility-scale plants,
smaller environmentally acceptable neighborhood plants, and industrial facilities
providing combined heat and power. It has been demonstrated that scaling based on
fuel cell modularity does not necessarily adversely influence stack efficiency. Their
compact construction suggests that stacks and other power plant components could be
factory-built and assembled in plug-in style at plant sites.
The modular nature of the fuel cell offers real possibilities for distributed power
production, contrary to the historic long-term trend in electrical power production.
468
Because of the expected short manufacturing time for fuel cells, their apparent
environmental acceptability, and their ability to function well in a variety of sizes, they
offer utilities alternatives to the long construction times and the financial risks of large
fossil fuel and nuclear plants that have required as much as ten years to bring into
service. Thus significant advantages may be expected to accrue from the ability to
construct small, high-efficiency, environmentally acceptable plants in areas where
demand is growing.
While its expected high efficiency commends its use as a utility base-load plants
with constant power output, the fuel cell also offers the potential for serving varying
loads without substantial losses in performance. Thus fuel cells may prove useful in
load-following applications as well as in base-load application.
Another potential application for fuel cells is in the large vehicle transportation
sectorbuses, trucks, locomotives, and the like. A likely entry for the fuel cell may be
in public transportation vehicles in large cities with significant pollution problems.
Reference 18 reports on studies of alternatives to battery-powered trucks in Paris,
where almost 200 electric garbage trucks are currently in use. It was found that fuel-
cell-powered trucks and, to a lesser degree, hybrid fuel cell/flywheel trucks (the
flywheel stores extra energy for occasional vehicle accelerations while the fuel cell
handles the base-load propulsion and flywheel reenergizing) would have significantly
lower operating costs per ton of garbage per day than the existing battery-powered
trucks. Studies also showed that diesel-powered buses were only about 10% to 20%
cheaper to operate in Europe than fuel-cell-powered buses.
A simulation study, reported in reference 67, considered hypothetical fuel-cell-
powered bus designs operating on three urban bus routes. A bus design specification,
resulting from the study, combined two 30-kW phosporic acid fuel cells with a 38-kW-
hr battery to power a 50-kW electric traction motor. The motor transmits power to a
rear wheel-axle assembly through a conventional transmission. The specification was
for a 23 passenger bus for use at speeds up to 45 mph.
In April 2000, Daimler-Chrysler announced (ref. 88) an offering of 20-30 buses
employing 250-kW fuel cells operating on hydrogen fuel for delivery in 2002. In these
vehicles, hydrogen would be stored in eight tanks mounted on the roof over the
forward axle.
These studies suggest that fuel cell technology is maturing. In many cases the
economics of these systems is not yet competitive with that of existing systems.
However, further advances may soon make fuel cells competitive for some transport-
ation and stationary applications. Reference 68 gives further evidence that the quest for
commercial fuel cell technology is truly international in scope.
469
Bibliography and References
1. Angrist, Stanley W., Direct Energy Conversion, 3
rd
ed. Newton, Mass.: Allyn &
Bacon, 1976.
2. Spitzer, Lyman, Physics of Fully Ionized Gases, New York: Wiley-Interscience,
1956.
3. Appleby, A. J., "Advanced Fuel Cells and Their Future Market," Ann. Rev. Energy,
13 (1988): 267316.
4. McLarnon, Frank R., and Cairns, Elton J., "Energy Storage," Ann. Rev. Energy, 14
(1989): 241271.
5. Mellde, Rolf W., "Advanced Automobile Engines For Fuel Economy, Low
Emissions, and Multifuel Capability," Ann. Rev. Energy, 14 (1989): 425444.
6. Jackson, John David, Classical Electrodynamics. New York: Wiley, 1962.
7. Fraas, Arthur P., Engineering Evaluation of Energy Systems. New York:
McGraw-Hill, 1982.
8. Vincent, Colin A., et al., Modern Batteries. Baltimore: Edward Arnold, 1984.
9. Sperling, Daniel and DeLuchi, Mark A., Transportation Energy Futures, Ann. Rev.
Energy, 14 ( 1989): 375424.
10. Fickett, A. P., " Fuel Cell Power Plants," Scientific American, December 1978: 70.
11. Society of Automotive Engineers, Automotive Handbook, 4
th
ed., Robert Bosch
GmbH, 1996.
12. Mayfield, Manville J., Beyma, Edmund F., and Nelkin, Gary A., "Update on U.S.
Department of Energys Phosphoric Acid Fuel Cell Program." Proceedings of the
Sixteenth Energy Technology Conference, February 28March 2, 1989, Government
Institutes, Inc., pp. 184196.
13. Myles, K. M., and Krumpelt, M., "Status of Molten Carbonate Fuel Cell Technol-
ogy." Proceedings of the Sixteenth Energy Technology Conference, February 28
March 2, 1989, Government Institutes, Inc., pp. 197-204.
14. Bates, J. Lambert, "Solid Oxide Fuel Cells: A Materials Challenge." Proceedings of
the Sixteenth Energy Technology Conference, February 28March 2, 1989, Govern-
ment Institutes, Inc., pp. 205219.
470
15. Gillis, Edward, "Fuel Cells," EPRI Journal, September 1989: 3436.
16. Harder, Edwin L., Fundamentals of Energy Production. New York: Wiley, 1982.
17. Sissine, F., "Fuel Cells for Electric Power Production: Future Potential, Federal
Role and Policy Options," in Fuel Cells:Trends In Research and Applications, Ed. A.
J. Appleby. Washington: Hemisphere, 1987.
18. Appleby, A. J., "Phosphoric Acid Fuel Cells," in Fuel Cells:Trends In Research
and Applications, Ed. A. J. Appleby. Washington: Hemisphere, 1987.
19. Appleby, A. J. (Ed.), Fuel Cells:Trends In Research and Applications,
Washington: Hemisphere, 1987.
20. Ketelaar, J. A. A., "Molten Carbonate Fuel Cells," Fuel Cells:Trends In Research
and Applications, Ed. A. J. Appleby. Washington: Hemisphere, 1987.
21. Kinoshita, K., McLarnon, R. R., and Cairns, E.J., Fuel Cells: A Handbook., U.S.
Department of Energy METC-88/6096, 1988.
22. Berry, D.A., and Mayfield, M.J., Fuel Cells, Technology Status Report, U.S.
Department of Energy METC-89/0266, 1988.
23. Anon., Fuel Cell Systems Program Plan, FY 1990, U.S.Department of Energy,
FE-0106P, October 1989.
24. Huber, W. J., Proceedings of the First Annual Fuel Cells Contractors Review
Meeting, U.S.Department of Energy METC-89/6105, May 1989.
25. Anon., 1988 Fuel Cell Seminar. Washington, D.C.: Courtesy Associates, 1988.
26. Feynman, Richard P., Leighton, Robert B. and Sands, Matthew, The Feynman
Lectures on Physics, Vol. 2. Reading, Mass.: Addison-Wesley, 1964.
27. Anon., Battery Service Manual. Chicago: Battery Council International, 1987.
28. Kotz, John C., and Purcell, Keith F., Chemistry and Chemical Reactivity.
Philadelphia: Saunders, 1987.
29. Goodman, Frank, "Power Electronics for Renewables," EPRI Journal,
January/February 1988: 4447.
471
30. Schaefer, John, "Photovoltaic Operating Experience," EPRI Journal, March 1988:
4042.
31. Peterson, Terry, "Amorphous Silicon Thin Film Solar Cells," EPRI Journal, June
1988: 4144.
32. Dostalek, Frank, "High Concentration Photovoltaics," EPRI Journal, March 1989:
4649.
33. Morris, Douglas, "The Chino Battery Facility," EPRI Journal, March 1988: 4650.
34. Purcell, Gary, and Driggans, Rick, "Electric Vehicle Testing at TVA," EPRI
Journal, March 1988: 4446.
35. Anon., The Storage Battery. Horsham, Pa.: Exide Corp., 1980.
36. Makanski, Jason, "Fuel Cells Extend Boundaries of Process/Power Integration,"
Power, May 1990: 8286.
37. Chapman, Alan J., Heat Transfer, New York: Macmillan, 1968.
38. Swanson, Theodore D., "Large Scale Photovoltaic System Design Considerations,"
The Handbook of Photovoltaic Applications. Atlanta, Ga.: Fairmont Press, 1986, pp.
1932.
39. Van Overstraeten, R.J., and Mertens, R.P., Physics, Technology, and Use of
Photovoltaics. Boston: Adam Hilger, 1986.
40. McDaniels, David K., The Sun: Our Future Energy Source, 2
nd
ed. New York:
Wiley, 1984.
41. Feynman, Richard P., Leighton, Robert B. and Sands, Matthew, The Feynman
Lectures on Physics, Vol. 3, Reading, Mass.: Addison-Wesley, 1965.
42. Takahashi, K. and Konagai, M., Amorphous Silicon Solar Cells. New York: Wiley,
1986.
43. Duffie, John A., and Beckman, William A., Solar Engineering of Thermal
Processes. New York: Wiley, 1980.
44. Rosa, Richard J., Magnetohydrodynamic Energy Conversion, rev. ed. Washington:
Hemisphere, 1987.
472
45. Gregory, Derek P., The Hydrogen Economy, Scientific American, Vol. 228,
No.1, (January 1973) 1321.
46. Gregory, D. P. and Pangborn, J.B., "Hydrogen Energy", Ann. Rev. Energy, 1
(1976): 279310.
47. Cogineni, M. Rao, Andrus, H.E. Jr., and Jones, T.J., "Advanced Energy Systems."
Proceedings of the American Power Conference, Vol. 50, 1988, pp. 282287.
48. Bajura, R. A., and Halow, J.S., " Looking Beyond the Demonstration Plants:
Longer-Term, Coal-Based Technology Options." Proceedings of the American Power
Conference, Vol. 50, 1988, pp. 4956.
49. DeMeo, Edgar, et al., "Thin Films: Expanding the Solar Marketplace", EPRI
Journal, March 1989: 415.
50. Wood, Bernard W., Applications of Thermodynamics, 2
nd
ed. Reading, Mass.:
Addison-Wesley, 1982.
51. Womack, G. J., MHD Power Generation: Engineering Aspects. London: Chapman
and Hall, 1969.
52. Soo, S. L., Direct Energy Conversion. Engelwood Cliffs, N.J.: Prentice Hall, 1968.
53. Kettani, M. Ali, Direct Energy Conversion. Reading, Mass.: Addison Wesley,
1970.
54. Sutton, George W., Direct Energy Conversion. New York: McGraw-Hill, 1966.
55. Pitts, Donald R., and Sissom, Leighton E., Heat Transfer, Shaum's Outline Series.
New York: McGraw-Hill, 1977.
56. Anon., The Astronomical Almanac. Washington, D.C.: U. S. Government Printing
Office, 1990.
57. Parsons, Robert A. (Ed.), The ASHRAE Handbook, HVAC Systems and Appli-
cations Volume. Atlanta, Ga.: American Society of Heating, Refrigerating, and Air
Conditioning Engineers, 1987.
58. DeMeo, Edgar, "Getting Down to Business with Thin Films," EPRI Journal,
March 1989: 415.
473
59. Taylor, Roger W., Cummings, John E., and Swanson, Richard M., "High Efficiency
Photovoltaic Device Development: An Example of the R&D Process" Proceedings of
the American Power Conference, Vol. 47, 1985, pp. 255259.
60. Bockris, J. O. M., Energy The Solar-Hydrogen Alternative. New York: Wiley,
1975.
61. Williams, L. O., Hydrogen Power, Elmsford, N. Y.: Pergamon Press, 1980.
62. Sze, S. M., Semiconductor Devices Physics and Technology. New York: Wiley,
1985.
63. Moore, Taylor, et al., "Opening the Door for Utility Photovoltaics," EPRI Journal,
JanuaryFebruary 1987: 515.
64. Griffiths, David, J., Introduction to Electrodynamics, 2
nd
ed. Engelwood Cliffs,
N. J.: Prentice-Hall, 1989.
65. Anon., Solar Electric Generating Stations (SEGS), IEEE Power Engineering
Review, August, 1989: 48.
66. Anon., Promise of Solar Energy Being Fulfilled in California, Power, October
1989: s32s36.
67. Romano, Samuel, Fuel Cells for Transportation, Mechanical Engineering,
August 1989: 7477.
68. Hirschenhofer, J. H., International Developments in Fuel Cells, Mechanical
Engineering, August 1989: 7883.
69. Carlson, D. E., Photovoltaic Technologies for Commercial Power Generation,
Annual Review of Energy, Vol. 15, 1990, pp. 8598.
70. MacDonald, Gordon J., The Future of Methane as an Energy Resource, Annual
Review of Energy, Vol. 15, 1990, pp. 5383.
71. Moore, Taylor, et al., On-Site Utility Applications for Photovoltaics, EPRI
Journal, March 1991: 2637.
72. Moore, Taylor, et al., Thin Films: Expanding the Solar Marketplace, EPRI
Journal, March 1989: 415.
474
73. Smock, Robert W., Second Generation Fuel Cell Technology Moves Toward
Demos, Power Engineering, June 1990: 10.
74. Sapre, Alex R., Properties, Performance and Emissions of Medium-Concentration
Methanol-Gasoline Blends in a Single-Cylinder, Spark-Ignition Engine, SAE Paper
881679, October 1988.
75. Douglas, John, Beyond Steam: Breaking Through Performance Limits, EPRI
Journal, December 1990: 511.
76. Graff, Eric, Texas Instruments Co. Personal Communication, May 24, 1991.
77. Chase, M. W. Jr., et al., JANAF Thermodynamic Tables, 3
rd
ed., J. Phys. Chem.
Ref. Data 14, Supplement No. 1, 1985.
78. Douglas, John, et al., Fuel Cells for Urban Power, EPRI Journal, September
1991: 511.
79. Howell, John R., Bannerot, Richard B., and Vliet, Gary C., Solar-Thermal Energy
Systems. New York: McGraw-Hill, 1982.
80. Levine, Jules D., et al., Basic Properties of the Spheral Solar Cell. 22
nd
Photovoltaic Specialists Conference, Las Vegas, Nev., 1991.
81. International Fuel Cells: Clean, Reliable Fuel Cell Energy,
www.internationalfuelcells.com/index_fl1.shtml, (November 14, 2000)
82. Rulseh, Ted, Fuel Cells: From Promise to Performance, Grid, Spring/Summer
2000: 15.
83. Santa Clara Demonstration Project, www.ttcorp.com/fccg/scdpnew1.htm,
(November 14, 2000)
84. Fuel Cell Energy, Carbonate Fuel Cell Manufacturer,
www.ttcorp.com/fccg/erc_abt.htm, (November 15, 2000)
85. Welcome to Fuel Cell Energy, Inc., www.fuelcellenergy.com/, Whats New?,
(November 15, 2000)
86. Library of Fuel Cell Related Publications, http://216.51.18.233/biblio.html,
(November 14, 2000)
475
87. Archer, David H., and Wimer, John G., A Phosphoric Acid Fuel Cell
Cogeneration System Retrofit to a Large Office Building, Department of Energy
FETC-97/1044, April 1997., www.fetc.doe.gov/netltv/index.html, (November 15,
2000)
88. DaimlerChrysler Offers First Commercial Fuel Cell Buses to Transit Agencies,
www.hfcletter.com/letter/may00/feature.html, (November 15, 2000)
EXERCISES
11.1* Derive an expression for the battery power output, in terms of E and R
i
/R
o
, for
the linear model discussed in connection with Example 11.2. Nondimension-alize
the power by dividing by E
2
/R
o
. Use a spreadsheet to tabulate and plot the
dimensionless power as a function of R
i
/R
o
.
11.2* Derive an expression for the linear-battery-model power output nondimensional-
ized by E
2
/R
i
in terms of the internal-to-external resistance ratio. Use a
spreadsheet to tabulate the dimensionless power function, and plot it. Is there a
condition that produces an extreme value of the dimensionless power? If so, use
calculus methods to derive the condition.
11.3 An automobile storage battery with an open-circuit voltage of 12.8V is rated at
260 A-hr. The internal resistance of the battery is 0.2 5. Estimate the maximum
duration of current flow and its value through an external resistance of 1.8 5.
11.4 A battery electrical storage plant is to be designed for 20-MW peak power
delivery for a duration of four hours. The plant uses 600 A-hr batteries
operating at 400 volts DC. Estimate the minimum number of batteries and the
current in each during peak operation.
11.5 A hydrogen-oxygen fuel cell operates with a voltage of 0.7v with water-vapor
product. Calculate the work per kg-mole of hydrogen, in kJ and in kW-hr, and
determine the cell efficiency.
11.6 A neighborhood fuel cell power plant is to be designed for an electrical power
output of 2000 kW with liquid-water product. Estimate the flow rates of
hydrogen and oxygen during peak power production, assuming that an 80%
efficient power conditioner is used to convert DC to AC power and that the fuel
cell efficiency is 55%. What is the plant heat rate?
___________________
* Exercise numbers with an asterisk involve computer usage.
476
11.7 A hydrogen-oxygen fuel cell has liquid water as product when it operates at 0.82
volts. What is the electrical energy output, in kJ / kg-mole of hydrogen, and the
cell efficiency?
11.8 Prepare a typed three-page, double-spaced memorandum outlining the design of
the power train of a hydrogen-oxygen fuel-cell-powered automobile, giving the
design criteria, system description, and quantitative preliminary design data on
the power and fuel supply systems.
11.9 A hydrogen-oxygen fuel cell stack produces 50 kW of DC power at an efficiency
of 60%, with water-vapor as product. What is the hydrogen mass flow rate, in
g/s, and the cell voltage?
11.10 A fuel cell power plant is to be designed for an electrical power output of 200-
MW with liquid-water product. Estimate the flow rates of hydrogen and oxygen
during peak power production with an 85% efficient power conditioner and fuel
cell efficiency of 55%. What is the plant heat rate?
477
C H A P T E R E L E V E N
Energy System Alternatives
Part 2. MHD, Solar Energy, a Hydrogen Economy and Concluding Remarks
11.4 Magnetohydrodynamic Energy Conversion
Magnetohydrodynamic energy conversion, popularly known as MHD, is another form
of direct energy conversion in which electricity is produced from fossil fuels without
first producing mechanical energy. The process involves the use of a powerful
magnetic field to create an electric field normal to the flow of an electrically
conducting fluid through a channel, as suggested by Equation (11.13) and depicted in
Figure (11.19). The flow velocity u is parallel to the channel axis, taken in the y-
direction. The drift of electrons induced by this lateral electric field produces an
electric current, represented by the current density vector J. Electrodes in opposite
side walls of the MHD flow channel provide an interface to an external circuit.
Electrons pass from the fluid at one wall to an electrode, to an external load, to the
electrode on the opposite wall, and then back to the fluid, completing a circuit. Thus
the MHD channel flow is a direct current source that can be applied directly to an
external load or can be linked with a power-conditioning inverter to produce
alternating current.
MHD effects can be produced with electrons in metallic liquids such as mercury
and sodium or in hot gases containing ions and free electrons. In both cases, the
electrons are highly mobile and move readily among the atoms and ions while local
net charge neutrality is maintained. That is, while electrons may move with ease, any
small volume of the fluid contains the same total positive charges on the ions and
negative electron charges, because any charge imbalance would produce large
electrostatic forces to restore the balance.
Though liquid metal MHD has been demonstrated experimentally, most
theoretical and experimental work and power plant development and application
studies have focussed on high-temperature ionized gas as the working fluid.
Unfortunately, most common gases do not ionize significantly at temperatures
attainable with fossil fuel chemical reactions. This makes it necessary to seed the hot
gas with small amounts of vapor of readily ionizable materials such as the alkali
metals. The resulting ions and electrons make the hot gas sufficiently electrically
conducting that it may be influenced by the applied magnetic field.
The ionization potentials are measures of the energy needed to free valence
electrons from an atom. Materials such as cesium and potassium have ionization
potentials low enough that they ionize at the temperatures attainable with combustion
478
reactions in air. Recovery and reuse of seed materials from the MHD channel exhaust
are usually considered necessary from both economic and pollution standpoints.
Ionized Gases in Electromagnetic Fields
Before analyzing the MHD channel, we will consider briefly the behavior of
electrons in an ionized gas in the presence of electromagnetic fields.
In a gas at or near equilibrium, atoms, ions, and electrons are in random motion.
At any given spatial position their velocities are distributed about a mean velocity that
increases with increase in the local temperature. Consider just one of the free
electrons moving, without collision, in a plane normal to a uniform magnetic field, as
in Figure 11.20. The electron experiences a constant force qc
e
B normal to its path
according to Equation (11.11). Here, q is the charge of the electron and c
e
the
magnitude of its velocity. Because the force is normal to its path, the electron travels
with constant velocity on a circular path around magnetic lines of force. By Newtons
Second Law, the force on the electron is
F = m
e
c
e
2
/r = qc
e
B [N] (11.21)
It follows that the angular frequency of the electron about a line of force c
e
/r, called
its cyclotron frequency, is
& = c
e
/r = qB/m
e
[s
1
] (11.22)
The electron cyclotron frequency is independent of electron velocity and is dependent
479
only on the magnetic field strength and electron properties. Although the cyclotron
motions of electrons exist in gases when strong magnetic fields are present, the
circular paths of the electrons may be disrupted by collisions with other particles.
The likelihood of collisions between particles depends on their effective sizes:
larger particles will collide more frequently. The probability of collision is taken as
proportional to the collision cross-section Q of the particle, which may be thought of
as its area. The frequency of collision of electrons &
c
is given by the product of the
electron number density, n
e
[electrons/m
3
], the collision cross-section, Q [m
2
], and the
velocity, c
e
[m/s]:
&
c
= n
e
Qc
e
= 1/: [collisions per s] (11.23)
Here, the mean time between collisions, : [s], is the inverse of the collision
frequency.
The ratio of the cyclotron frequency to the collision frequency 6/6
c
, is called the
Hall parameter. It indicates the relative importance of the magnetic field and
collisions in controlling electron motion in the ionized gas. The Hall parameter is
related to the magnetic field intensity by
6/6
c
= 6: = qB: /m
e
= qB/n
e
m
e
Qc
e
[dl] (11.24)
It is proportional to the number of cyclotron loops made per collision. A Hall
parameter large compared with one indicates magnetic-field-dominated motion of
480
electrons, while a small value implies that collisions quickly break up ordered motions
produced by the magnetic field.
At least three velocities are of importance in a conducting gas in a MHD channel.
First, the velocity of the gas stream is given by u (assumed constant for the present
case for an appropriately designed channel). Secondly, the velocities of individual
electrons c
e
, as just introduced, are distributed about an average value that increases
with the local temperature. In the absence of electromagnetic fields, the average value
of c
e
over all electrons is the flow velocity u; i.e., on the average the electrons move
with the gas flow. When fields are present, however, there may be an average motion
of electrons relative to the gas. It is the ease of this motion that determines the
conductivity of the gas. The third velocity, the relative velocity of an electron w
e
, is
defined as the vector difference of its absolute velocity and the mean fluid velocity:
w
e
= c
e
u [m/s]
The drift velocity w
e
, is the magnitude of the average of the relative velocities of the
electrons. In the absence of fields, the average of c
e
is u, and thus the drift velocity is
zero. When an electric field is present, however, the transport of negative charge by
electrons represents a current flow in the gas.
Another important parameter, the electron mobility , is a measure of the
response of electrons to an electric field. It is defined as the ratio of the magnitude of
the electron drift velocity w
e
to the local electric field intensity:
= w
e
/E [m
2
/V-s] (11.25)
If it is assumed that an electron loses all of its drift velocity on collision, the accel-
eration of the electron may be approximated by the ratio of the drift velocity to the
mean time between collisions. Because the force due to the electric field is given by
qE, Newtons Second Law allows the drift velocity to be expressed as
w
e
= qE:/m
e
[m /s] (11.26)
The electron mobility can then be written as
= q: /m
e
[m
2
/V-s] (11.27)
Using equation (11.24), the product B becomes the Hall parameter:
B = q: B/m
e
= 6: = 6/6
c
[dl] (11.28)
Thus the Hall parameter is large for gases of high electron mobility in strong magnetic
fields. It will be seen that this can have a significant effect on MHD channel design.
Assuming electrons as the dominant charge carriers, the current density can also
481
be related to the electron mobility through the drift velocity:
J = n
e
qw
e
= n
e
q
2
:E/m
e
= n
e
qE [A /m
2
] (11.29)
The electron conductivity of a stationary gas is then given by:
o = J/E = n
e
q [(5-m)
-1
] (11.30)
Thus high electron mobility and electron number density are essential to achieve the
high conductivity needed in an MHD generator.
Analysis of a Segmented Electrode MHD Generator
Consider the one dimensional flow of a gas in an MHD channel coupled with a simple
three-dimensional model of the electromagnetic phenomena. Rather than the
continuous electrode configuration shown in Figure 11.19, we examine a refined
configuration, shown in Figure 11.21. Here the electrodes, set in opposite electrically
insulated channel walls, are segmented in the streamwise direction. This eliminates a
return path along the wall for axial electrical currents in the flow.
By the same notation as in Figure 11.19, a seeded, ionized gas flows through the
segmented-electrode channel in the y-direction with a constant velocity u. A uniform
magnetic field in the z-direction exists throughout the gas in the channel. A force
given by quB, and thus an equivalent electric field uB is imposed on the flow in
the channel. Therefore, positive ions tend to drift in the positive x-direction and
electrons drift in the negative x-direction toward the right electrodes. Because their
mobility is much greater than that of the relatively massive ions, the electrons are the
primary charge carriers. The electrons are collected at the right electrodes and flow
through the external circuits returning to the channel at the left electrodes, as shown
in Figure 11.21.
When the channel is under an electrical load, the current density vector in the x-
direction induces a force on the fluid in the negative y-direction. Thus the x-comp-
onent of J interacts with the magnetic field to produce the axial electric field
component E
y
= JB that opposes the flow velocity u. In order to maintain a
constant velocity in the duct, a streamwise pressure gradient, dp/dy, must balance the
force due to this axial electric field and the viscous forces. Thus, ignoring viscous
resistance, the axial force on the gas per unit volume is
F
y
= |JB| = JB = dp/dy [N/m
3
] (11.31)
where the negative sign indicates that the magnetic force is directed upstream. As a
482
result dp/dy < 0, indicating that the flow pressure drops as y increases. The resulting
net pressure force in the positive y-direction balances the magnetic and viscous forces
and maintains the flow velocity constant. A compressor is therefore required
upstream of the channel to pressurize the flow, to support the field-induced
streamwise pressure gradient, and thus to maintain the steady flow in the channel.
With segmented electrodes there is no axial current in the channel (Jy = 0), and
thus the current density component J
x
= J is proportional to the net electric field in
the x- direction:
J = o (uB E
x
) [A/m
2
] (11.32)
The combined electrical resistance of the MHD channel flow and the external load
governs the available potential at the MHD electrodes. If the external circuit is open,
J = 0; hence, Equation (11.32) indicates that E
x
|
open
= uB. With a finite external
resistance, current flows and the electrode potential is reduced below the open-circuit
value. Thus, under load, the channel voltage drops to a fraction K of the open-circuit
voltage. Hence, we may write E
x
= KuB, where K is called the channel load factor
and where 0 K 1. The current density then becomes
483
J = ouB(1 K) [A/m
2
] (11.33)
The electrical power delivered to the load per unit volume of channel is then given by
Power|
out
= J(E = ou
2
B
2
K(1 K) [W/m
3
] (11.34)
Returning now to consideration of the streamwise electrical fluid interaction, we
write the steady-flow form of the First Law for an adiabatic control volume, including
the work done against the body force, as
m(h
1
+ u
1
2
/2) = m(h
2
+ u
2
2
/2) + mw [J/s] (11.35)
where m is the channel mass flow rate. Work is positive here because it is done by the
fluid in the channel to produce the electrical current flow to the external load. For
constant velocity in the channel, this becomes
h
2
= h
1
w = h
1
(Power|
out
)(Volume)/m
= h
1
ou
2
B
2
K(1 K)/p [kJ/kg] (11.36)
where p is the gas density. Thus the work delivered to the load reduces the thermal
energy of the flow. We have seen that a compressor is required to pressurize the flow
in the channel and that heating of the flow provides a high entrance enthalpy and
work output.
From Equations (11.31) and (11.33), the electrical retarding force on the flow is
F
y
= ouB
2
(1 K) [N/m
3
] (11.37)
and the fluid power to push the gas through the channel per unit volume is
Power|
in
= |F
y
u| = ou
2
B
2
(1 K) [W/m
3
] (11.38)
The Ohmic or I
2
R loss is given, using Equation (11.33), by
J
2
/o = [ouB(1 K)]
2
/o = o (uB)
2
(1 2K + K
2
)
= ou
2
B
2
(1 K) ou
2
B
2
K(1 K) [W/m
3
] (11.39)
Comparing equations (11.34) and (11.38) with equation (11.39), we see that the
ohmic loss is the difference between the power required to push the flow through the
channel and the useful power through the load.
The efficiency of the channel is defined as the ratio of the Power|
out
to Power|
in
.
By Equations (11.34) and (11.38), the MHD channel efficiency is
484
= Power|
out
/Power|
in
= K [dl] (11.40)
Thus the electrical efficiency of the segmented electrode MHD channel is equal to the
channel load factor. Examination of Equation (11.34) shows that the power output
vanishes when K = 0 and when K = 1. Thus there must be an intermediate value of K
that maximizes the power output. By differentiation of Equation (11.34) with respect
to K, the usual methods of calculus indicate that the power is maximized when K =
0.5. Thus operation at this value implies that 50% of the flow energy input to the
channel is converted to electricity, and the remainder is dissipated in the flow channel.
This energy is not lost from the flow but is an irreversibility that is reflected in a loss
in ability of the flow to do work.
EXAMPLE 11.6
A 10-m
3
MHD generator with segmented electrodes has a short-circuit current
density of 12,000 amperes per square meter. The gas conductivity is 20 (Ohm-m)
-1
.
If flow and magnetic field conditions are unchanged when the load factor is 0.6,
what is the output power? What is the actual current density in the channel? If the
magnetic field is doubled in strength, by what factor would you expect the output
power to change?
Solution
For a short-circuit condition, the load factor is zero, and Equation (11.33) yields
J
sc
= ouB = 12000 A/m
2
Then
uB = J
sc
/o = 12000/20 = 600 V/m.
The power output is then given by Equation (11.34):
Power = ou
2
B
2
K(1 K)V = 20(600)
2
(0.6)(0.4)(10) = 17,280,000 W = 17.28 MW
The channel current density is then given by
J = ouB(1 K) = 20(600)(0.4) = 4800 A/m
2
.
If the magnetic field strength is doubled, Equation (11.34) shows that the power
output is increased by a factor of four, assuming there is no change in the flow or
load conditions.
____________________________________________________________________
485
Other MHD Configurations
The preceding discussion of the segmented electrode MHD channel provides a
brief insight into the fundamentals of MHD power. Other electrode configurations
include the Faraday continuous electrode generator and the so-called Hall generator.
In the former case, with continuous electrodes, the electric field in the y-direction
leads to a streamwise electrical current in a circuit that is completed in the continuous
conducting electrodes. The resulting current along the channel axis, called the Hall
current, contributes nothing to external power delivered in the Faraday generator. It
is shown in references 1 and 44 that the power output for the continuous electrode
generator is influenced by the Hall parameter and is given by Equation (11.34) with
the right-hand side divided by the factor 1 + (B)
2
. Thus high values of the Hall
parameter drastically reduce the channel power output relative to the segmented
electrode generator.
Rather than attempting to circumvent the Hall current, the Hall generator seeks to
employ it by using the electrode configuration shown in Figure 11.22. In the Hall
configuration, the electrodes are designed to short circuit the cross-channel electric
current and pass the axial Hall current through the load. The Hall generator power
output also depends on the Hall parameter, but in a more complex way than in the
continuous electrode Faraday configuration. The reader is referred to references 1
and 44 for further detail.
MHD channels, like gas turbines, may be operated on open or closed cycles.
Normally, combustion-driven MHD systems use an open-cycle, such as that shown in
Figure 11.23, where pressurized combustion takes place upstream of the MHD
channel. As with the gas turbine, the temperature of the channel exhaust is high,
making it advantageous to employ regenerative heat exchange and/or a bottoming
cycle such as the steam turbine in Figure 11.23. For MHD channels with steam
bottoming cycles, overall efficiencies in the range of 5060% are predicted.
486
If a DC source, rather that a load, is applied to the electrodes of a properly
contoured Faraday channel, the energy in the flow may be increased and the flow
accelerated. The electric field in this case exceeds the uB term in Equation (11.32),
reversing the direction of the current density and thus the direction of the J B force.
The MHD channel may then be used for propulsion through expulsion of mass in the
same way as in a jet engine or rocket.

487
11.5 Solar Energy
The preceding pages have dealt with the conversion of energy from fossil and nuclear
fuels, all finite resources. While the need may not be immediate, the day is
approaching when the Earths fossil and nuclear resources will no longer satisfy
mans need to grow and prosper. We must therefore consider more seriously the
effective utilization of the readily available and, for practical purposes, eternal energy
source provided by the sun.
Ancient peoples learned to use the sun for survival and comfort. Not very long
ago a clothesline and wind formed the mechanism of a solar clothes dryer. Powered
by the sun, the atmospheric engine that produces weather change provides the wind
to fill sails and turn windmills to produce small amounts of power at a few select
locations. Passive solar architecture has recently attracted widespread interest, and
solar collectors mounted on roofs for water heating and space heating have become
commonplace in many areas. Figure 11.24 shows fixed and tracking solar arrays that
produce electricity to supplement or replace grid power at a remote location.
A major problem connected with using the sun for power generation is the same
characteristic that allows the survival of human life on earth: the low intensity levels
of solar radiation. It is well known that the two planets closest to the sun have
average temperatures higher than the Earths and that the outer planets are colder
because of the inverse square law of radiative transfer of the suns radiation field.
Higher solar fluxes at Earths surface would clearly make the sun a more easily
engineered radiation source. Let us estimate the intensity of the solar radiation
arriving at Earth.
488
Consider the geometry of the Earthsun system and the spherically symmetric
nature of the sun's radiation field presented in Figure 11.25. Assuming that the sun
radiates energy uniformly in all directions at a rate of E kW, the radiant flux density
crossing any sphere concentric with the sun is given by dividing E by the area of
the sphere. Thus the radiant flux density, or irradiance, at a distance r from the sun
center is
= E/(4z r
2
) [kW/m
2
] (11.41)
In order to evaluate , it is necessary to calculate the rate of energy emitted by the
sun per unit area of its surface,
s
. While the temperature at the center of the sun is
much hotter, solar radiation approximates blackbody radiation at a temperature of
5762 K. Using the Stefan-Boltzmann constant, o = 5.6696110
8
W/m
2
-K
4
, the
blackbody radiation law (discussed later in more detail) gives the rate of energy
emission per unit area of the suns surface as

s
= oT
4
= 5.66961 10
-8
(5762)
4
(10
3
)= 62,495 kW/m
2


Applying conservation of solar energy to concentric spheres makes it clear that
energy emitted uniformly from a sphere at the suns radius r
s
will be distributed over a
wider area when passing through a sphere of larger radius. Thus, eliminating E for
two concentric spheres from Equation (11.41) shows that radiant flux density scales
inversely as the area ratio or square of the radius ratio of the spheres:
=
s
( r
s
/r )
2
[kW/m
2
] (11.42)
This and Equation (11.41) are both mathematical expressions of the inverse square
law for solar radiation.
489
As in Figure 11.25, taking the suns diameter to be 865,400 miles and the
Earthsun distance as 93,000,000 miles, the solar radiant flux density, or solar
constant of radiation, reaching Earths orbit is

e
=
s
( r
s
/r
e
)
2
= 62,495[(865,400/2)/93,000,000]
2
= 1.353 kW/m
2
Thus the value of the solar constant is the rate at which solar radiation crosses a unit
area normal to the suns rays at the distance of Earth from the sun. A more precise
value for the solar constant is
e
= 1.357 kW/m
2
, or 430.2 Btu/hr-ft
2
(ref. 39).
While solar radiation may be viewed as a divergent spherical radiation field on the
scale of the solar system, a calculation of the angle of divergence at the earth's
distance indicates that its rays are essentially parallel on the scale of almost all human
activities. Thus it is common to assume a constant radiation flux density with parallel
rays in analyzing terrestrial solar radiation problems.
Some of the solar radiation arriving at the earths surface is scattered and
reflected in the atmosphere. Thus solar radiation consists of direct (parallel) and
diffuse components. Moreover, absorption, reflection, and scattering in the
atmosphere reduces the maximum direct radiation flux density arriving at sea level to
about
dir
= 1 kW/m
2
. When the sky is clear, the direct component dominates. But
the direct component may essentially vanish on overcast days, leaving only a diffuse
component. The calculation of the solar performance of space vehicles is usually
simplified by the absence of a diffuse component. However, for near-Earth satellites,
radiation emitted from Earth and solar radiation reflected from Earth could be
significant.
Matter interacts with solar radiation in three basic ways: it can absorb the
radiation, transmit it, or reflect it. These actions are represented by characteristics
called, respectively, absorptance A, transmittance T, and reflectance R. Each is
expressed as a fraction of the total incident radiation. Thus the radiation energy
reflected from a surface with reflectance R and a given area S is RS.
Consider a layer of material with surface area S normal to a radiation field with
radiant flux . Conservation of energy requires that the rate of energy incident on the
surface equal the sum of the rates of energy reflected, transmitted, and absorbed.
Thus S = RS + TS + AS. Thus the sum of the reflectance, the transmittance,
and the absorptance must equal 1:
R + T + A = 1 [dl] (11.43)
Let us apply this statement of energy conservation to the Earths atmosphere: On a
clear day, the atmospheric reflectance is small, hence any radiation not absorbed is
transmitted to the surface (T + A 1). On a cloudy day, reflection from and
absorption by clouds are significant, and the transmitted radiation becomes a small
fraction of the incoming solar irradiance (R + A 1); only the diffuse component
scattered by the clouds remains.
490
Spectral Characteristics
Though it is usually convenient to deal with total radiation quantities, sometimes it is
necessary to consider wavelength-dependent, or spectral, effects. The material
radiative properties just introduced above are sometimes frequency or wavelength
dependent. Thus, while solar radiation in space approximates a blackbody spectral
distribution, radiation penetrating to Earths surface deviates significantly from the
blackbody distribution because of scattering and strong absorption bands due to
atmospheric water vapor, carbon dioxide, dust, and other substances that remove
significant amounts of energy from the incident radiation at certain wave lengths.
The eye itself is a highly wavelength-selective radiation sensor, being limited to
observing radiation only in the range of about 0.4 to 0.7 microns. A micron is 10
6
meters.
Consider the Planck equation for the blackbody spectral distribution of radiation
F
b
(&), where wavelength & is in microns [ ] (refs. 37, 43 and 55):
F
b
(&) = 2zhc
2
&
--5
/(e
hc/(k&T)
1) [Btu/(ft
2
-hr-) | W/(m
2
-)]
The Planck equation may be written in terms of a single parameter &T, where
wavelength is in microns and temperature is in appropriate absolute units:
F
b
(&T)/T
5
= 2zhc
2
(&T)
--5
/(e
hc/(k&T)
1)
= 3.74210
8
(&T)
5
/(e
14381/(&T)
1) [W/(m
2
--K
5
)] (11.44a)
= 1.187x10
8
( &T)
--5
/(e
25896/(&T)
1) [Btu/(ft
2
-hr--R
5
)] (11.44b)
Figure 11.26 shows the Planck blackbody radiation distributions for two different
temperatures as a function of wave length, one approximating solar radiation at
10,000 R (5555.5K) and the other much closer to, but above, the normal terrestrial
temperature of 1000R (555.5K). At first glance the radiation levels appear
comparable; but they actually they are vastly different from each other (by a factor of
10
5
), because the Planck function is divided by oT
5
, to allow display on the same
scale.
The figure makes clear that in the spectral range to which the eye is sensitive, the
visible range, little radiation emitted by relatively cool terrestrial objects is visible; and
almost all of what we see is reflected solar radiation or other high-temperature-source
radiation (such as from high-temperature lamp filaments or from flames). The vast
difference in the wave lengths of the peaks shows why it is important to consider
spectral effects in dealing with solar radiation.
491
The Wien displacement law, a simple relation derivable from the Planck equation,
given in both English and SI units,
&
max
T = 5215.6 [-R] (11.45a)
= 2897.6 [-K] (11.45b)
shows that the wavelength of the peak of the blackbody radiation distribution, &
max
,
is inversely proportional to the temperature, as may be verified numerically for the
two peaks in Figure 11.26 ( &
max
= 5.215 and 0.5215).
Integration of F
b
over all wavelengths from zero to infinity, using Equation
(11.44) yields the Stefan-Boltzmann law for the blackbody flux
b
:

"

"

b
= 1 F
b
d& = T
4
1

[F
b
(&T)/T
5
]d(&T) = o T
4
[Btu/hr-ft
2
|W/m
2
] (11.46)

0 0
which was used earlier to estimate the radiative flux from the surface of the sun and
the terrestrial solar constant.
It is useful to sum the contributions to blackbody emission from zero to a given
wavelength by an integration of F
b
, as was done for the entire spectral range in
Equation (11.46). Letting = &T, we define a function -(&T) as a dimensionless
fraction of the blackbody irradiance from = 0 to = &T:
492

&T
-(&T) = T
4
/
b
1 [F
b
()/T
5
]d [dl]

0
Figure 11.27 shows a log-log graph of the Planck distribution and -(&T). A table of
the latter function, calculated by numerical integration using a spreadsheet, is
provided in Appendix I. The dimensional blackbody flux between any two wave
lengths for a given temperature may be determined from a difference of sigma
functions as:
(&T)
2
(&T)
1
=
(&T)2
= T
4
1[F
b
()/T
5
]d = [-(&T)
2
- -(&T)
1
]oT
4
[Btu/hr-ft
2
|W/m
2
]

(&T)1
EXAMPLE 11.7
Consider a window, normal to the suns rays, covering a solar collector mounted on a
satellite in near-Earth orbit. The window has a transmittance of 0.9 in the range of
wavelengths from 0.22.0 and 0 at other wavelengths. What is the fraction of
incident solar radiation transmitted by the window, and what is the rate of useful
energy transfer to a circulating fluid in a 4 4-m flat plate collector if the collector
absorbs 85% of the transmitted radiation?
493
Solution
The only radiation transmitted is between 0.2 and 2.0 . Because the effective
temperature of the solar radiation is 10,000 R, the values of &T and - for these two
wavelengths are
&T = (0.2)(10000) = 2000 -R and -(2000) = 0.0013
and
&T = (2.0)(10000) = 20,000 -R and -(20,000) = 0.934
using the / table in Appendix I.
The transmitted fraction of the blackbody incident radiant energy is the product of
the fraction of radiation in the transmitted spectral range and the window
transmittance:
(0.9)(0.934 0.0013) = 0.839
The radiation that heats the circulating fluid is then the product of the transmitted
spectral fraction, the absorptance, the area, and the near-earth solar constant:
(0.839)(0.85)(4
2
)(1.357) = 15.5 kW.
____________________________________________________________________
Example 11.7 dealt with a constant transmittance over a single spectral interval.
More complex radiation characteristics may be treated in a similar way by summing
the contributions of more than one spectral band.
Earth-Sun Geometry and Solar Collectors
Radiative transfer from the sun to a plane surface depends on the orientation of the
surface to the suns rays. If parallel rays irradiate a surface, the total energy rate per
unit area is given by the product of the irradiation and the cosine of the angle
between the surface normal and the suns rays: cos0. The following discusses ways
in which the cosine function can be evaluated.
Consider the component of radiation falling on a terrestrial horizontal surface
with unit normal n, when the suns rays are in the direction of a second unit vector s.
Following the notation of Figure 11.28, the two unit vectors n and s can be expressed
in terms of the orthogonal unit vectors i, j, and k:
n = n
x
i + n
y
j + n
z
k and s = s
x
i + s
y
j + s
z
k
where n
x
, n
y
, n
z
, and s
x
, s
y
and s
z
are the direction cosines of the two vectors. Note
that the direction cosines must satisfy the following conditions:
494
n ( n = n
x
2
+ n
y
2
+ n
z
2
= 1 and s ( s = s
x
2
+ s
y
2
+ s
z
2
= 1
for n and s each to be of unit magnitude. The fraction of the maximum solar radiation
falling on the unit area, then, is given by the scalar product:
cos 0 = n ( s = n
x
s
x
+ n
y
s
y
+ n
z
s
z
(11.47a)
Figure 11.29 shows these unit vectors set at the center of the earth. The unit
vector n points to the zenith of the observer and is normal to the horizontal surface at
P. Here the x-axis is taken through the intersection of the meridional plane containing
n and the equatorial plane. The z-axis points north and the y axis is selected to
complete a right-handed coordinate system. The angle L is the latitude of n. In this
system the position of the sun is determined by two convenient angles: H and .
Examination of Figure 11.29 shows that the components of s on the coordinate axes
are
s
x
= cos cos H s
y
= cos sin H and s
z
= sin
Similarly, n
x
= cos L, n
y
= 0, and n
z
= sin L. Thus the cosine of the sun-surface angle
given by n ( s using Equation (11.47a) is
cos 0 = cos cos H cos L + sin sin L (11.47)
495
Thus the cosine of the angle of the suns rays falling on a horizontal surface depends
on the latitude of the surface and the angles H and of the sun.
Now consider the determination of H and . First we define the ecliptic as the
plane of earths annual motion around the sun, as shown in Figure 11.30. Because the
earths axis always points in approximately the same direction in space and is inclined
at 23.5 to the normal to the ecliptic, the apparent position of the sun as viewed from
Earth ranges above and below the equator by 23.5 annually. This movement is
designated by the solar declination angle in Figure 11.29, measured from the
equatorial plane along a meridian of longitude. It can be seen from Figure 11.30 that
varies from + 23.5 degrees on June 21 to 23.5 on December 21.
The hour angle H of the sun in Figure 11.29 is the angle measured in the plane of
the equator between the observers meridional plane and the meridional plane of the
sun. Earth rotates once or 360 about its axis in 24 hours; hence, the hour angle
depends on time, as its name implies. If solar time is measured from solar noon
(when the sun is at its highest point in the sky at the observers meridian), the hour
angle may be computed from the solar time using the factor 360/24 = 15 per hour.
The hour angle is positive when the sun is east of the observer and negative when it is
west. Thus at 3:00 P.M. solar time, the sun is 3 hours past solar noon and, therefore,
has an hour angle of 3(15) = 45 (west of the observer).
496
Care should be taken to distinguish between solar time and time defined by law
called civil time. In the continental United States, for instance, there are four time
zones defined by law in which standard time decreases by one hour for each 15 of
longitude from the east to the west coast. This allows a uniform time within a zone
while approximating solar time. Exceptions have been made to accomodate irregular
state boundaries. Thus standard time deviates from solar time by several minutes,
depending on the longitude of the observer. Moreover, by law, daylight saving time
differs from standard time. In the spring and fall, clocks are advanced and set back an
hour, respectively. Under daylight saving time, the civil time in the summer would be
1 pm at any location where it is noon standard time. Thus solar time can deviate from
daylight saving time by more than an hour at some locations.
EXAMPLE 11.8
What is the incident radiative energy rate falling on a 7 10-m horizontal roof on a
clear day at 40 north latitude, at a solar time of 10 A.M. on December 21?
Solution
Figure 11.30 shows that on December 21 the solar declination angle = 23.5.
At 10 A.M. sun time, the hour angle is 2 hr 15/hr = 30. By Equation (11.47), the
angle of the sun relative to the roof vertical is
cos 0 = cos cos H cos L + sin sin L
= cos(23.5) cos(30) cos(40) + sin(23.5) sin(40) = 0.352.
Taking the solar constant at Earths surface as 1.0 kW / m
2
, the incident energy on
the roof is
(0.352)(70)(1.0) = 24.64 kW
497
Note that the solar angle 0 is independent of the sign of the hour angle. Thus
cos0 is a symmetric function of H, and the same irradiance occurs at 10 A.M. and
2 P.M. solar time.
____________________________________________________________________
EXAMPLE 11.9
What is the irradiance on an east-facing vertical wall in kW / m
2
, under the conditions
of Example 11.8?
Solution
A unit vector on an east-facing wall at the observer location in Figure 11.29 is
directed along the y-axis and is therefore simply j. The cosine of the angle between
the east-facing-wall normal and the solar direction vector s is
j ( s = s
y
= cos sin H = cos(23.5) sin(30) = 0.4585
The solar irradiance is then (1.0)(0.4585) = 0.4585 kW/m
2
. Here, the hour angle
dependency is antisymmetric. It would give a negative result for 2 P.M. solar time
(H = 30). Thus, after solar noon, when j ( s < 0, the negative sign indicates that
the sun is behind the east-facing wall and that the wall of the building is in the shade.
____________________________________________________________________
Solar collectors can be fixed in position or they can track the sun. Fixed collectors
for year-round use in the northern hemisphere are normally oriented facing the south
with a tilt angle that is approximately equal to the collector latitude. For a south-
facing collector tilted at an angle with respect to the horizontal, the collector
normal makes an angle of L with the equatorial plane in Figure 11.29. The angle
of the collector normal, n, with the sun direction may then be determined using
n = i cos (L ) + k sin (L )
Then cos 0 is
cos 0 = n ( s = cos(L ) cos cosH + sin(L )sin
Note that this equation may also be obtained by replacing the latitude in Equation
(11.47) with L .
For sun-tracking solar collectors, two degrees of angular freedom are required for
perfect tracking. Typically, such collectors would pivot about horizontal and vertical
axes dictated by the local solar azimuth and elevation. Their angular motion may be
preprogrammed using astronomical data such as those from reference 56, or, it could
be controlled by a sun-seeking control system.
498
Solar Thermal Electric Generating Stations
Large thermal applications of solar energy to produce electrical power are located at
two sites in the Mohave desert of California (refs. 65 and 66). These facilities,
(Figure 11.31) called solar electric generating stations-SEGS, consist of 14-MW,
30-MW, and 80-MW units employing line-focusing parallel-trough solar collectors to
provide heat for reheat steam turbine systems. The SEGS plants in the Mojave Desert
make up the world's largest parabolic trough facility. In the year 2000, there were
nine plants, which provide a combined capacity of 354 MW (ref. 89). Deployment of
additional plants is not expected to occur until at least 2002. When completed, the 12
SEGS units will have a total electrical generating capacity of about 600 megawatts.
Reflected solar radiation from the mirrored-glass sun-tracking horizontal-axis
parabolic collectors is focused on an evacuated tubular-heat-collection element
through which a heat transfer fluid flows. After leaving the collector, the hot fluid
heats water in a steam generator before returning to loop through the collectors, as
seen in Figure 11.32. The resulting super heated steam is used in Rankine-cycle
reheat steam turbine generators. Cooling towers reject heat from the condensers to
the surrounding desert air.
Supplemental heat is provided, when required, by boilers burning natural gas, as
shown in Figure 11.32, or, in the newer designs, by gas-fired heaters that heat the
collector heat transfer fluid. This supplemental heat is required to ensure that full
SEGS plant design output is obtained during the periods of peak demand for
electricity in Southern Californiafrom noon to 6 pm between June and September.
499
The large land area required by SEGS plants is evident from Figure 11.31.
References 65 and 66 give insight into some of the technical issues faced in the
development of SEGS systems; issues that include periodic mirror washing, breakage
of the heat collection elements, wind loading, and other operational considerations.
Updated information on the SEGS system and other solar-thermal programs is given
in references 89 to 92.
Solar Photovoltaics
Photovoltaic cells have gained wide use in recent years as small scale power sources
for watches, calculators and other such devices. Less evident to the public is the
widespread research and development effort on electric power production using solar
photovoltaics. Over two billion dollars in corporate funds have been invested in
photovoltaics (ref. 58). The major goal is to provide cheap and efficient direct
conversion of solar photons into electricity, using light-sensitive devices with few or
500
no moving parts. Success could provide a sorely-needed long-term energy source that
could benefit most of the peoples of the world.
Photovoltaics rely on specially prepared materials called semiconductors, which
produce useful current flows when illuminated with solar or artificial radiation. They
are typically thin layers of materials such as crystalline silicon, with electrical leads
mounted on opposite faces, as shown in Figure 11.33. The silicon is usually mounted
on a substrate that provides both structural support and cooling to conduct away heat
created by nonproductive radiation absorption. The exposed silicon is usually covered
with a transparent, antireflecting protective coating to reduce energy loss via surface
reflection.
Crystalline semiconductors are near perfect geometric lattices of atoms that were
usually produced by a crystal growth method known as the Czochralski process (CZ),
which involves slowly turning a seed crystal of pure silicon as it is withdrawn from a
bath of high-purity molten silicon. The CZ process forms an ingot that may be 15 cm
in diameter and over one meter long. Thin wafers of silicon are then sliced from the
ingot in a slow, delicate process. Other methods, such as casting of square ingots, are
in use also. The research and development of more cost-efficient techniques for the
large-scale production of semiconductors has a continuing high priority. The
extensive use of semiconductors in the computer and electronics industries provides
substantial motivation for continued research in semiconductor production methods.
501
After slicing, silicon crystals are "doped" with occasional special impurity atoms,
perhaps a few foreign atoms per million silicon atoms in the lattice. This is typically
achieved by heating the wafers and exposing their surfaces to vapors of the doping
material, called a dopant. This process allows the dopant to diffuse to a controlled
depth in the crystals. Semiconducting crystals are electrical insulators at low
temperature and weak conductors of electricity at room temperature. The presence of
impurities provides charge carriers that substantially enhance the material electrical
conductivity when it is exposed to radiation. The following considers how photon
absorption in the crystals produces an electrical potential and direct current.
Electrons in semiconductors may exist in a band of bound energy states called a
valence band. This is analogous to the bound energy levels of individual atoms. As
with individual atoms, the absorption of a photon in a semiconductor may change the
energy state of an electron. If the photon energy equals or exceeds a threshold level,
the electron may be excited into a conduction band, where it is free to move
throughout the material, obviously enhancing the electrical conductivity of the
material.
Consider silicon again as an example of semiconductor behavior. Silicon atoms
have four electrons in their outer shell. If impurity atoms in a silicon crystalline lattice
have five electrons in their outer shell (atoms such as arsenic or phosphorus) the
silicon crystal has an overabundance of electrons (and positive charge) and is there-
fore known as an n-type (negative) semiconductor. The extra electrons associated
with impurity atoms are loosely bound just below the conduction band. Small
amounts of energy from the thermal motions in the lattice or from absorption of
photons allow these electrons from the impurity atoms (called donor atoms) to move
freely in the crystal. The result is a neutral material containing mobile negative-charge
carriers.
Now consider another type of crystalline silicon semiconductor, the p-type, which
has positive charge carriers. If, in the silicon crystal,, the impurity atoms have three
electrons instead of five in their outer shells (as in boron or gallium), the impurity
atoms can easily snatch electrons from nearby silicon atoms leaving positively charged
silicon sites called holes and fixed negative dopant atoms. These impurity sites are
called acceptors because they draw electrons from silicon atoms, thus creating
positive holes in the lattice. This type of semiconductor is called a p-type, because the
holes are positive charge carriers. When an electron abandons one silicon site for
another, a hole disappears at its destination and new hole is created at its point of
origin. Thus a p-type semiconductor has holes that may move through the material as
positive-charge carriers.
When an external electric field is applied to an n-type semiconductor, electrons
will move toward the region of high potential. However, the electrons are restrained
by the positive fixed donor sites, resulting in a charge distribution in balance with the
applied field. In a p-type semiconductor, its positive holes would move toward low
potential until a stable charge distribution with the negative acceptor sites is
established. Thus, because of the fixed charges at donor and acceptor sites, the
502
charge carriers will move just far enough to set up charge distributions that are in
balance with the external field.
Consider layers of p-type and n-type semiconductors brought together to form an
electrically neutral slab with a common interface called a p-n junction. Because of
concentration gradients of free electrons and holes across the junction, some
electrons from the n-type will cross into the p-type, while holes move a short distance
into the n-type. The diffusion of holes and electrons rapidly creates and is balanced by
an electric field in a thin space-charge region less than a micron thick, as indicated in
Figure 11.33. As a result, the p-type material is at a higher potential than the n-type.
Thus the two materials on either side of the junction are each at different potentials
without the benefit of an external electric field, thanks to the electric field at the p-n
junction.
Now lets consider radiation incident on the p-n semiconductor. Photons have an
energy h+, where h is Plancks constant and + is the frequency of the radiation.
When a p-type material near a p-n junction is irradiated by an energetic photon, the
photon may be absorbed, raising an electron into the conduction band and leaving a
hole behind. Thus a single photon creates an electron-hole pair. Conduction band
electrons readily move across the junction into the n-type material to a region of
lower potential energy, while the holes tend to move in the opposite direction and
thus remain in the p-material. Likewise, electron-hole pairs created by irradiation of
n-type material cause holes to move into the p-material, leaving the electrons behind.
Thus the photons provide the energy for a pumping process that separates and
selectively drives charges across the interface. These actions increase the positive
charge in the p-type and the negative charge in the n-type materials, opposing the
electric field produced by diffusion due to charge concentration gradients. This
process continues until the electric fields balance each other.
When an external load is connected to the irradiated cell, electrons flow from the
n-type material through the external circuit while holes move in the opposite
direction. The net current flow through the load is the sum of both the electron flow
and the hole flow through the semiconductor layers. Since the number of charge
carriers driven through the load depends on the number of photon excitations, the
total cell current and power output depend on the junction surface area and on the
intensity of solar irradiance.
A silicon solar cell may be 10 cm by 10 cm, and have an open circuit voltage of
about 0.5 V. At 10% efficiency it would deliver a power output of 1 W when
receiving peak solar irradiance on Earth of 1.0 kW/m
2
.
Power = (1.0)(10/100)
2
(0.1)(1000) = 1.0 W
The band gap, or energy separation, between conduction and valence bands is 1.1 eV
for silicon p-n junctions. This is the energy necessary to move an electron into the
conduction band of the semiconductor.
503
Thus, to excite electrons into the conduction band, photons must have a
frequency equal to or greater than E/h, the photon energy (equal to band gap energy)
divided by Plancks constant
+ = (1.1 eV)(1.60210
19
J/eV)/(6.62610
34
J-s) = 2.6610
14
s
1
and a wave length no greater than c/+, the speed of light divided by the photon
frequency:
& = (2.997910
8
m/s)(10
6
/m)/(2.6610
14
s
1
) = 1.127
Photons with lower frequencies and longer wave lengths, and therefore energies
less than the band-gap energy, cannot raise electrons to the conduction band and may
be transmitted through the material without effect. On the other hand, one photon can
excite only one electron into the conduction band, and any excess photon energy
beyond the band gap value only heats the semiconductor. Thus photon wave lengths
greater and less than the bandgap value result in inefficiency in converting incident
radiation to electricity.
The p-n junction acts like a combination of a current source and a diode in
parallel as shown in Figure 11.34. For a given level of cell irradiation, a cell electrical
characteristic may be represented by
I = I
sc
I
o
(e
qV/kT
1) [A] (11.48)
where k is the Boltzmann constant, q is the electronic charge, and I
o
is called the dark
current. The short-circuit current I
sc
(corresponding to a cell potential difference =0)
is proportional to the rate of incident irradiance. The dark current I
o
is related to the
cell open-circuit potential difference V
oc
by setting I = 0 in Equation (11.48). Thus:
504
Thus
I
o
/I
sc
= 1 /(e
qVoc/kT
1).
By combining these two equations, we can write the cell characteristic in
nondimensional form as
I /I
sc
= 1 (I
o
/I
sc
)(e
qV/kT
1) = 1 (e
qV /kT
1)/(e
qVoc /kT
1) [dl] (11.49)
The cell power output is the product of the current and cell potential difference:
P = IV = [I
sc
I
o
(e
qV/kT
1)]V [W]
Nondimensionalizing the power by dividing it by I
sc
V
oc
gives
P/I
sc
V
oc
= [1 (e
qV /kT
1)/(e
qVoc /kT
1)](V/V
oc
) [dl] (11.50)
The nondimensional current and power characteristics are shown in Figure (11.35). It
may be seen from the figure that peak cell power increases linearly with output
voltage for small values of voltage, reaches a maximum at between 80% and 90% of
the open circuit voltage, and drops rapidly thereafter. The maximum power is about
80% of I
sc
V
oc
. For given values of I
sc
and V
oc
, the maximum power occurs at particular
values of current and voltage (indicated by the circle on the current characteristic),
and thus at a single load resistance. For other resistive loads the power output is
reduced.
505
EXAMPLE 11.10
For a photocell with an open-circuit voltage of 0.6 V at 350K, evaluate qV
oc
/kT and
the nondimensional current and power at V/ V
oc
= 0.8. Propose a simplification of the
model given earlier for large values of the voltage parameter.
Solution
For T = 350K and V
oc
= 0.6 V, the dimensionless voltage parameter is
qV
oc
/kT = 1.60210
19
0.6 / (1.3810
23
350) = 19.9
Using Equation (11.49), the current ratio is then
I /I
sc
= 1 (e
0.819.9
1)/(e
19.9
1) = 0.9813
and the power ratio is
P/I
sc
V
oc
= (I/I
sc
)(V/V
oc
) = 0.98130.8 = 0.785
It is clear that for large values of the voltage parameter, 1 may be neglected with
respect to the exponentials; hence we may write the following excellent
approximations:
I /I
sc
= 1 e
(qVoc/kT)(V/Voc

1)
and
P/I
sc
V
oc
= [1 e
(qVoc/kT)(V/Voc

1)
](V/V
oc
)
The reader may verify numerically the accuracy of these approximations.
____________________________________________________________________
The cell efficiency is the ratio of the maximum cell power output to the rate of
incident radiant energy normal to the cell, P
m
/E
inc
, where P
m
is the product of the cell
current and the voltage at maximum power point. For a given irradiance, doubling
the cell efficiency implies doubling the cell current and power output. Let us consider
a few of the types of energy losses that contribute to low cell efficiency in converting
energy from the radiation field into electricity.
It has been seen that in silicon, the minimum photon energy required to create an
electron-hole pair is 1.1 ev and that (1) photons with energies less than 1.1 ev are not
absorbed by the semiconductor; and (2) the excess energy of photons with greater
than the required energy is converted to heat, since a photon can create only one
electron-hole pair. For silicon cells, these losses exceed 50% of the incident energy
(ref. 11.59). Thus the nature of the solar spectrum and the excitation energy of
506
particular junction materials influences the cells efficiency. Analyses of these losses
indicate that the silicon band-gap energy is lower than optimum for the solar specral
distribution. References 39 and 42 indicate that cadmium telluride, CdTe, and gallium
arsenide, GaAs, have near-optimum band-gap energies around 1.4 eV for the solar
application.
Another loss that contributes to inefficiency is reflection at the cell surface.
Antireflection coatings are currently used to reduce this loss to a few percent of the
incident energy. When these and other losses are accounted for, a maximum
conversion efficiency of single-crystal silicon cells in sunlight is about 25%. Values of
23.2% and 22.3% have been obtained in two laboratories when high efficiency was
the objective (ref. 69). The best efficiency of commercial silicon cells is about 15%.
Solar Cell Design
Other semiconducting materials that have received less attention than silicon have
been found to use the solar spectrum more efficiently, as indicated above, and thus
offer potential for higher conversion efficiency. Research is also in progress on cells
made of thin layers of several junction materials that each work best in different parts
of the spectrum. Thus, if a top layer converts high-frequency photons efficiently and
allows lower frequency photons to pass to a lower layer to be converted by a
semiconductor with a lower band-gap energy, a larger part of the spectrum may be
used efficiently. For instance, as Figure 11.36 shows for a two junction cell,
507
ultraviolet and visible wavelength photons may be absorbed near the top junction and
infrared photons near the bottom.
Regardless of the individual cell characteristics, in order to achieve power outputs
of significance for utility and industrial applications it is necessary to string the cells
together in arrays. Identical cells connected in series all have the same current; and
their combined voltage is the sum of the individual cell voltages at the given current
flow, as shown in Figure 11.37. For example, using a typical value for the open-
circuit voltage and the voltage condition for maximum cell power, in order to get a
voltage of about 14 V to charge a 12-V battery it is necessary to bring together about
14 V/[(0.5V
oc
/cell) (.8V/V
oc
)] = 35 cells
in series. For 10-cm by 10-cm cells, such a string would have a maximum power
output of about
(35 cells)(1 watt /cell) = 35 W
and an area of 351010 = 3500 cm
2
or 0.35 m
2
.
In order to achieve high current flow, it is necessary to connect cells or strings of
cells in parallel. In this case the currents are additive for a given cell potential, as seen
in Figure 11.38. While high voltages are desirable to reduce ohmic losses and reduce
wire size, according to reference 38 limitations on insulations and safety concerns will
limit the voltage levels achieved by solar arrays. Since the National Electric Code
does not provide for equipment ratings above 250 V DC, higher voltages may imply
increased costs for solar power systems.
In the event of cell damage, loss of one cell in a parallel string of cells means the
loss of only the power of that cell, whereas loss of a single cell in a series string
508
causes a large loss in power because of the large increase in series resistance of the
string. Shading from the sun of a single cell in series has a similar effect, because the
reduction in incident radiation cuts the current carrying capability of the cell and
hence the entire string. Circuitry is usually provided to allow current to bypass a
defective cell.
EXAMPLE 11.11
A near-Earth satellite requires a maximum of 10 kW of electrical power. Estimate the
required collector area and the number of 10-cm by 10-cm cells, each having a
conversion efficiency of 14%.
Solution
Using a solar constant of 1.357 kW/m
2
, the required area is determined by
dividing the design power requirement by the amount of the incident radiation that is
converted to electricity by the cells:
10/[(0.14)(1.357)] = 52.64 m
2
The number of 10 by 10 cells is then
52.64/(10/100)
2
= 5264 cells
____________________________________________________________________

The direct conversion of solar radiation to electricity is very attractive from the
point of view of the long-term reliability of the source and environmental
509
acceptability. There are, however, several fairly obvious adverse characteristics of
solar conversion. First, terrestrial applications suffer from the limited daily availability
of sunshine. The frequent coincidence of the daily peak irradiance and utility demand
peaks is advantageous but does not compensate for the wide daily variability of the
solar source. The occurrence of cloudy days, sometimes several successive ones, and
the inevitable daily sunset indicate the need for energy storage if solar energy is to
provide a reliable primary source of electricity. For remote, stand-alone locations this
implies the use of batteries or other storage devices to satisfy 24 hr/day demand.
Figure 11.39 shows a remote photovoltaic-powered telecommunication site located
on a mountain top. The system comprises the cell array, the storage batteries, the
telecommunications load, and the electronics needed to control battery charging and
load matching. The system shown is said to have recovered its cost in a year and to
produce annual savings of $60,000.
In industrialized countries, such as the United States, where utility grids penetrate
to most parts of the country, linkages with utilities seem to offer the best hope for
widespread photovoltaic use, because the existing utility grids can provide the needed
backup. Both decentralized and central-station solar conversion appear to be
possibilities for utility involvement. Moreover, the Public Utilities Regulatory Policy
Act (PURPA) offers other possibilities by encouraging third-party as well as utility
and customer ownership arrangements.
510
The high cost and low efficiency of solar cells are major deterrents to their
widespread application for power generation. Although the costs of solar cells have
been declining and cell efficiencies increasing over the years, solar cells still are
economically suited for only a limited number of applications such as those where
cost is not a major factor (e.g., military and aerospace applications) or where the
alternatives are expensive (e.g., energy sources for remote installations). Nevertheless
the annual production of photovoltaics has been increasing and the resulting product-
ion experience will help develop production techniques that, together with increased
volume, should further drive down their prices. It is likely that the demand for photo-
voltaic power generation would increase dramatically if solar cells become available
in a price range below $1/W, depending on the price of natural gas, oil and coal.
Concentrating Solar Cell Systems
One approach to reducing the cost and increasing the efficiency of photovoltaics
is the development of a concentrating solar cell system that focuses radiation on the
cell. The use of a Fresnel lens or other type of concentrator increases the incident
energy on a given cell area and, consequently, the cell power output. A photograph of
such a concentrating array is shown in Figure 11.40. Each of the 14 elements in each
511
parquet concentrates energy from a 5-inch-square Fresnel lens onto a 1/4-inch silicon
cell. Unlike nonconcentrating cells, the concentrating units only function under clear
sky conditions and derive no benefit from diffuse radiation.
Cells with high concentration ratios must be cooled because of high solar
intensities on the cells. Some of the details of the EPRI-Stanford cell system adapted
from reference 63 are given in Figure 11.41. According to that reference and
reference 49, efficiencies as high as 28% have been reached in experimental
crystalline silicon concentrator cells. Reference 59 suggests that the required high
efficiencies for commercialization of concentrating cells are being achieved today and
that attention can be focussed on production and cost reduction efforts for this type.
512
Other Approaches
Major reasons for the high cost of solar arrays is the complexity and labor
intensiveness of production of high-quality crystalline silicon. Noncrystalline silicon,
or amorphous silicon, may also be used for photovoltaic cells, but with a practical
conversion efficiency limit of about 14%. The best commercially available amorphous
cells have an efficiency of about 6%. Crystalline silicon currently has most of the
market but amorphous silicon and other non-crystalline semiconductors are receiving
considerable research attention. Whereas crystalline cells are cut from carefully grown
crystals, amorphous cells may be created by vacuum deposition of a thin film of
silicon on a substrate such as glass. While not without problems, manufacturing
techniques for amorphous materials appear to offer greater potential for low-cost
mass production than those for crystalline cells. One of the current research problems,
however, is that amorphous silicon loses some of its effectiveness rapidly upon
exposure to light. This has not stopped its use in some applications but is a serious
concern.
An exciting approach to photovoltaic power technology was announced in 1991
by Texas Instruments and Southern California Edison. The concept, referred to as
Spheral Solar
TM*
technology, involves the use of 17,000 tiny silicon balls per 100 cm
2
supported on flexible aluminum foil sheets, as seen in Figure 11.42. The spheres are
metallurgical grade p-type silicon with surfaces doped with an n-type material so that
each sphere is an individual solar cell. The spheres are set in perforations in a foil
513
layer that forms the contact with the n-layer. Both sides of the spheres are coated
with transparent ethylene vinyl acetate. The rear tips of the spheres are etched,
exposing p-type material where another foil layer forms the contact with the p-layer.
Several features claimed for the spheral technology offer hope for a breakthrough
in the production of solar electricity:
+ The silicon used is inexpensive, low purity, metallurgical grade.
+ The technology uses low-cost production methods that provide an almost 100%
yield of manufactured laminates.
+ Since each sphere is a solar cell, the failure of an individual sphere has a
negligible influence on system performance.
+ The flexible nature of the laminate makes it adaptable to a wide range of
applications (Figure 11.43).
Module efficiencies of about 810% are expected (ref. 76). Reference 80
indicates that the highest efficiency attained during R&D testing was 11.5%. A line
for pilot production prototype modules was established in 1991, with production
commercial planned for 1994. More recent information is available in reference 96.
The application and sales of photovoltaics have been growing continually in the
last 20 years. Though photovoltaics continue to offer great hope for large-scale
power production, there remains a diversity of opinion regarding the avenues and
rates of commercialization of photovoltaics in power production applications (ref.
49).
514
11.6 A Hydrogen Economy
Coal, natural gas, petroleum, and uranium are all primary energy sources, mainly
for heat. On the other hand, electricity is a convenient form of energy, or work,
derived from a primary source and may therefore may be called a secondary energy
source. Electricity plays an important role in the world energy system because it is a
convenient and inexpensive source of both heat and work. It is used as readily for
lighting and cooling as for heating and mechanical power delivery. It is readily
transmitted over moderate distances and is relatively safe and non-polluting. Its
pervasive influences on society within the worlds energy system are such that we
have what is sometimes referred to as an electrical economy.
However, electricity has failed to gain a foothold in most modes of transportation,
primarily because of the lack of a compact and flexible means of storing it. Some
progress in this area may be anticipated because of renewed interest in electric cars,
trucks and other road vehicles. A primary dissatisfaction with electricity as a means of
energy application lies in the facts that an electrical economy requires the
consumption of about three units of primary energy for each unit of secondary energy
produced and that most of the primary energy conversion processes have adverse
environmental consequences.
Much interest has been expressed in supplementing or replacing electricity with
another secondary energy source, with hydrogen being the leading contender.
Methanol, ethanol, liquefied natural gas (LNG), and compressed natural gas (CNG)
are other possibilities. A number of advantages may be attributed to employing
hydrogen as a secondary energy source:
+ Hydrogen may be produced by chemical processes from fossil fuels, by
hydrolysis of water with oxygen as a by-product, or by thermal decomposition.
According to reference 16, electrolysis cells produce hydrogen at efficiencies
between 60 and 69%; 75 to 80% was feasible with 1973 technology, and 85% is
expected in a well-developed hydrogen economy.

+ Hydrogen can be used as a fuel to produce power with almost no direct
environmental pollution, because the principal product is water vapor.
Combustion of hydrogen produces no carbon products and therefore no
greenhouse gases. Oxides of nitrogen would remain as pollutants but should be
more easily controllable because of the absence of carbon and sulfur-containing
pollutants.
+ Internal combustion engines can use hydrogen with minor modifications, some-
times with improved efficiency.
+ Fuel cells employing hydrogen can be used to produce electricity at high
efficiencies not bounded by the Carnot limit and with little environmental impact.
515
+ Hydrogen could be produced by electrolysis at large base-loaded electrical
power plants during periods of low demand for electricity, thus providing an
opportunity for electrical energy storage when used with fuel cells or other
efficient energy converters.
+ Hydrogen could be transported in pipelines similar to natural gas pipelines. In
some cases, existing pipelines could be used with relatively little modification.
Liquid hydrogen has been routinely shipped in special rail cars and trucks for many
years.
+ Hydrogen can be stored in the same ways that natural gas and helium are stored
now, underground or in liquefied form in special storage tanks.
+ Hydrogen has a very high heating value on a mass basis but a low volumetric
value because of its high specific volume at standard pressure and temperature.
The numerous attractive features of hydrogen as a fuel are to a certain extent offset
by some serious concerns, which are the objects of extensive engineering research:
First, the ignition energy of hydrogen is low and the flammability limits are wide, so
hydrogen is readily ignited. While this is advantageous in combustion systems, great
care must be taken in storing and handling hydrogen. Though an atypical event, the
Hindenburg disaster perpetually reminds us of these concerns. On the other hand,
because hydrogen is lighter than air and diffuses more rapidly than other gases, it is
more readily diluted and disperses quickly, characteristics that tend to reduce fire and
explosion hazards.
The hazards associated with using hydrogen gas should not be minimized, but to
put things in perspective, we should remember that society has enthusiastically adopted
an automobile that commonly carries ten to twenty gallons of gasoline, a very
hazardous fuel. Large storage tanks of gasoline are maintained and freely accessed by
untrained users in the midst of residential areas. Trucks loaded with gasoline routinely
service and pass through these same areas.
Second, hydrogens high specific volume makes its storage a problem, especially in
transportation applications, where space for fuel storage is costly. In addition to storage
as a compressed gas, it may be liquefied and stored at cryogenic temperatures, or it
may be stored in metal hydrides. In the latter cases, the additional equipment space,
expense and complexity must be considered in evaluating feasibility and design.
Finally, while gasoline and natural gas remain readily available and at a modest
price, hydrogen will have little opportunity to become established as an important
secondary fuel. For ground transportation, as a replacement fuel for gasoline, hydrogen
must compete with relatively inexpensive methanol and ethanol (ref. 9). Heavily
subsidized ethanol is currently available in the United States in a 10% blend with
gasoline and there is considerable interest in compressed natural gas and richer
methanol mixtures for ground vehicles (ref. 74)
516
EXAMPLE 11.12
Using reasonable estimates of unit efficiencies for generation, transport, and utilization,
compare the overall energy efficiencies of nuclear-electric and nuclear-hydrogen
economies in providing mechanical work.
Solution
For the nuclear-electric economy, mechanical energy is produced in the sequence
Fission $Electricity $Transmission $Electric motor
which, using unit efficiencies in the order given, would have an efficiency of about
(0.32)(0.9)(0.9) = 0.259

For the nuclear-powered hydrogen economy the appropriate chain is
Fission $Electricity $Electrolysis $Hydrogen $Transmission $Fuel cell $Motor
Here the overall efficiency is estimated to be
(0.32)(0.85)(0.9)(0.6)(0.9) = 0.132
Note that neither case includes the energy costs of mining and processing nuclear fuel.
Nevertheless, this example suggests that, despite hydrogens many advantages, its use
as a secondary fuel may lead to inefficient resource utilization. This conclusion is
discussed more fully in reference 16.
_____________________________________________________________________
One can readily appreciate the beauty of the concept of a solar-energy-driven
hydrogen-powered cycle in which hydrogen produced by electrolysis of seawater using
solar photovoltaic energy, reacts and delivers power and heat in a high-efficiency and
non-polluting fuel cell at the point of use, with product water ascending into the
atmosphere, where it eventually returns to the sea as rain. The problems in developing
and adopting such a cycle for commercial use are great, but the future needs of Earth
are so serious that such concepts at least provide directions in which research should
proceed. While the hydrogen economy may not displace the electric economy, when the
politics and economics are right, society will find ways to use hydrogen as a supplement
to electricity as a secondary fuel.
11.7 Concluding Remarks
It is clear that the seriousness of Earth's energy and environmental problems and the
growing diversity of propulsion and power production options ensures stimulating
517
careers for engineers far into the future. Attractive, mid-term alternatives exist to the
conventional, state-of-the-art, coal-burning power plant with advanced scrubber
technology. Despite the risks involved, it seems clear that numerous other power
options will find commercial use as dictated by local and regional conditions and
available technologies and resources.
A recurring question in all of the developments we have discussed exists: Once the
feasibility of a new technology has been established, how can it be rapidly brought to a
commercial stage in the absence of massive government support for development and
demonstration plants? Under existing economic and regulatory structures in the United
States, power utilities cannot make massive investments in technologies that involve
significant risks or costs that are not competitive with existing methods. The prices and
risks of new technologies will remain high, however, until a significant number of units
have been ordered that can absorb research, development, and production costs. In
many cases it is unlikely that timely U.S. investment capital will be available for
demonstration plants to provide visible confidence-building utility experience. While
U.S. governmental support exists, it appears that much of the costs and risks, together
with the successes, will be borne internationally.
An important long-term question remains: How can humankind make the transition
from a resource-depleting, highly polluting society to some semblance of a steady-state,
environmentally acceptable, energy economy based on renewable energy sources? This
is not a question for the energy conversion engineer alone. Indeed, it involves political,
moral, and social issues that transcend the boundaries of science and engineering. Can a
smooth transition be achieved that avoids cataclysmic change and minimizes painful
societal dislocations? Perhaps the internationalization of the leadership in technology
will help bring suitable global responses to these formidable challenges. Regardless of
the future course, it must be a responsibility of engineers to keep the long-term needs
of Earth and its inhabitants in mind as they make technical decisions to satisfy present
needs and desires and continue the quest for technical progress.
Bibliography and References
1. Angrist, Stanley W., Direct Energy Conversion, 3
rd
ed. Newton, Mass.: Allyn and
Bacon, 1976.
2. Spitzer, Lyman, Physics of Fully Ionized Gases. New York: Wiley-Interscience,
1956.
3. Appleby, A. J., "Advanced Fuel Cells and Their Future Market," Ann. Rev. Energy,
13 (1988): 267316.
4. McLarnon, Frank R., and Cairns, Elton J., "Energy Storage," Ann. Rev. Energy, 14
(1989): 241271.
518
5. Mellde, Rolf W., "Advanced Automobile Engines For Fuel Economy, Low
Emissions, and Multifuel Capability," Ann. Rev. Energy, 14 (1989): 425444.
6. Jackson, John David, Classical Electrodynamics. New York: Wiley, 1962.
7. Fraas, Arthur P., Engineering Evaluation of Energy Systems. New York:
McGraw-Hill, 1982.
8. Vincent, Colin A., et al., Modern Batteries. Baltimore: Edward Arnold, 1984.
9. Sperling, Daniel, and DeLuchi, Mark A., Transportation Energy Futures, Ann.
Rev. Energy, 14 ( 1989): 375424.
10. Fickett, A. P., "Fuel Cell Power Plants," Scientific American, December 1978: 70.
11. Society of Automotive Engineers, Automotive Handbook, 4
th
ed., Robert Bosch
GmbH, 1996.
12. Mayfield, Manville J., Beyma, Edmund F., and Nelkin, Gary A., "Update on U.S.
Department of Energys Phosphoric Acid Fuel Cell Program." Proceedings of the
Sixteenth Energy Technology Conference, February 28March 2, 1989, Government
Institutes, Inc., pp. 184196.
13. Myles, K. M., and Krumpelt, M., "Status of Molten Carbonate Fuel Cell Technol-
ogy." Proceedings of the Sixteenth Energy Technology Conference, February 28
March 2, 1989, Government Institutes, Inc., pp. 197-204.
14. Bates, J. Lambert, "Solid Oxide Fuel Cells: A Materials Challenge." Proceedings of
the Sixteenth Energy Technology Conference, February 28March 2, 1989, Govern-
ment Institutes, Inc., pp. 205219.
15. Gillis, Edward, "Fuel Cells," EPRI Journal, September 1989: 3436.
16. Harder, Edwin L., Fundamentals of Energy Production. New York: Wiley, 1982.
17. Sissine, F., "Fuel Cells for Electric Power Production: Future Potential, Federal
Role and Policy Options," in Fuel Cells:Trends In Research and Applications, ed. A. J.
Appleby. Washington: Hemisphere, 1987.
18. Appleby, A. J., "Phosphoric Acid Fuel Cells," in Fuel Cells:Trends In Research
and Applications, ed. A. J. Appleby. Washington: Hemisphere, 1987.
519
19. Appleby, A. J. (Ed.), Fuel Cells:Trends In Research and Applications,
Washington: Hemisphere. 1987.
20. Ketelaar, J. A. A., "Molten Carbonate Fuel Cells," Fuel Cells:Trends In Research
and Applications, Ed. A. J. Appleby. Washington: Hemisphere, 1987.
21. Kinoshita, K., McLarnon, R. R., and Cairns, E.J., Fuel Cells: A Handbook. U.S.
Department of Energy METC-88/6096, 1988.
22. Berry, D.A. and Mayfield, M.J., Fuel Cells, Technology Status Report, U.S.
Department of Energy METC-89/0266, 1988.
23. Anon., Fuel Cell Systems Program Plan, FY 1990, U.S.Department of Energy,
FE-0106P, October 1989.
24. Huber, W. J., Proceedings of the First Annual Fuel Cells Contractors Review
Meeting, U.S.Department of Energy METC-89/6105, May 1989.
25. Anon., 1988 Fuel Cell Seminar. Washington, D.C.: Courtesy Associates, 1988.
26. Feynman, Richard P., Leighton, Robert B., and Sands, Matthew, The Feynman
Lectures on Physics, Vol. 2. Reading, Mass.: Addison-Wesley, 1964.
27. Anon., Battery Service Manual. Chicago: Battery Council International, 1987.
28. Kotz, John C., and Purcell, Keith F., Chemistry and Chemical Reactivity.
Philadelphia: Saunders, 1987.
29. Goodman, Frank, "Power Electronics for Renewables," EPRI Journal,
January/February 1988: 4447.
30. Schaefer, John, "Photovoltaic Operating Experience," EPRI Journal, March 1988:
4042.
31. Peterson, Terry, "Amorphous Silicon Thin Film Solar Cells," EPRI Journal, June
1988: 4144.
32. Dostalek, Frank, "High Concentration Photovoltaics," EPRI Journal, March 1989:
4649.
33. Morris, Douglas, "The Chino Battery Facility," EPRI Journal, March 1988: 4650.
520
34. Purcell, Gary, and Driggans, Rick, "Electric Vehicle Testing at TVA," EPRI
Journal, March 1988: 4446.
35. Anon., The Storage Battery. Horsham, Pa.: Exide Corp., 1980.
36. Makanski, Jason, "Fuel Cells Extend Boundaries of Process/Power Integration,"
Power, May 1990: 8286.
37. Chapman, Alan J., Heat Transfer. New York: Macmillan, 1968.
38. Swanson, Theodore D., "Large-Scale Photovoltaic System Design Considerations,"
The Handbook of Photovoltaic Applications. Atlanta, Ga.: Fairmont Press, 1986, pp.
1932.
39. Van Overstraeten, R.J., and Mertens, R.P., Physics, Technology, and Use of
Photovoltaics. Boston: Adam Hilger, 1986.
40. McDaniels, David K., The Sun: Our Future Energy Source, 2
nd
ed. New York:
Wiley, 1984.
41. Feynman, Richard P., Leighton, Robert B., and Sands, Matthew, The Feynman
Lectures on Physics, Vol. 3. Reading, Mass.: Addison-Wesley, 1965.
42. Takahashi, K., and Konagai, M., Amorphous Silicon Solar Cells. New York:
Wiley, 1986.
43. Duffie, John A., and Beckman, William A., Solar Engineering of Thermal
Processes. New York: Wiley, 1980.
44. Rosa, Richard J., Magnetohydrodynamic Energy Conversion, rev. ed. Washington:
Hemisphere, 1987.
45. Gregory, Derek P., The Hydrogen Economy, Scientific American, Vol. 228,
No.1. (January 1973) 1321.
46. Gregory, D. P., and Pangborn, J.B., "Hydrogen Energy," Ann. Rev. Energy, 1
(1976): 279310.
47. Cogineni, M. Rao, Andrus, H.E. Jr., and Jones, T.J., "Advanced Energy Systems."
Proceedings of the American Power Conference, Vol. 50, 1988, pp. 282287.
521
48. Bajura, R. A., and Halow, J.S., " Looking Beyond the Demonstration Plants:
Longer-Term, Coal-Based Technology Options." Proceedings of the American Power
Conference, Vol. 50, 1988, pp. 4956.
49. DeMeo, Edgar, et al., "Thin Films: Expanding the Solar Marketplace," EPRI
Journal, March 1989: pp. 415.
50. Wood, Bernard W., Applications of Thermodynamics, 2
nd
ed. Reading, Mass.:
Addison-Wesley, 1982.
51. Womack, G. J., MHD Power Generation: Engineering Aspects. London: Chapman
and Hall, 1969.
52. Soo, S. L., Direct Energy Conversion. Engelwood Cliffs, N.J.: Prentice Hall, 1968.
53. Kettani, M. Ali, Direct Energy Conversion. Reading, Mass.: Addison Wesley,
1970.
54. Sutton, George W., Direct Energy Conversion. New York: McGraw-Hill, 1966.
55. Pitts, Donald R., and Sissom, Leighton E., Heat Transfer, Shaum's Outline Series.
New York: McGraw-Hill, 1977.
56. Anon., The Astronomical Almanac. Washington, D.C.: U. S. Government Printing
Office, 1990.
57. Parsons, Robert A. (Ed.), The ASHRAE Handbook, HVAC Systems and Appli-
cations Volume. Atlanta, Ga.: American Society of Heating, Refrigerating, and Air
Conditioning Engineers, 1987.
58. DeMeo, Edgar, "Getting Down to Business with Thin Films," EPRI Journal,
March 1989: 415.
59. Taylor, Roger W., Cummings, John E., and Swanson, Richard M., "High Efficiency
Photovoltaic Device Development: An Example of the R&D Process," Proceedings of
the American Power Conference, Vol. 47, 1985, pp. 255259.
60. Bockris, J. O. M., Energy: The Solar-Hydrogen Alternative. New York: Wiley,
1975.
61. Williams, L. O., Hydrogen Power. Elmsford, N. Y.: Pergamon Press, 1980.
522
62. Sze, S. M., Semiconductor Devices Physics and Technology. New York: Wiley,
1985.
63. Moore, Taylor, et al., "Opening the Door for Utility Photovoltaics," EPRI Journal,
JanuaryFebruary 1987: 515.
64. Griffiths, David, J., Introduction to Electrodynamics, 2
nd
ed. Engelwood Cliffs,
N. J.: Prentice-Hall, 1989.
65. Anon., Solar Electric Generating Stations (SEGS), IEEE Power Engineering
Review, August, 1989: 48.
66. Anon., Promise of Solar Energy Being Fulfilled in California, Power, October
1989: s32s36.
67. Romano, Samuel, Fuel Cells for Transportation, Mechanical Engineering,
August 1989: 7477.
68. Hirschenhofer, J. H., International Developments in Fuel Cells, Mechanical
Engineering, August 1989: 7883.
69. Carlson, D. E., Photovoltaic Techniques for Commercial Power Generation,
Annual Review of Energy, Vol. 15, 1990, pp. 8598.
70. MacDonald, Gordon J., The Future of Methane as an Energy Resource, Annual
Review of Energy, Vol. 15, 1990, pp. 5383.
71. Moore, Taylor, et al., On-Site Utility Applications for Photovoltaics, EPRI
Journal, March 1991: 2637.
72. Moore, Taylor, et al., Thin Films: Expanding the Solar Marketplace, EPRI
Journal, March 1989: 415.
73. Smock, Robert W., Second Generation Fuel Cell Technology Moves Toward
Demos, Power Engineering, June 1990: 10.
74. Sapre, Alex R., Properties, Performance and Emissions of Medium-Concentration
Methanol-Gasoline Blends in a Single-Cylinder, Spark-Ignition Engine, SAE Paper
881679, October 1988.
75. Douglas, John, Beyond Steam: Breaking Through Performance Limits, EPRI
Journal, December 1990: 511.
523
76. Graff, Eric, Texas Instruments Co. Personal Communication, May 24, 1991.
77. Chase, M. W. Jr., et al., JANAF Thermochemical Tables, 3
rd
ed., J. Phys. Chem.
Ref. Data 14, Supplement No. 1, 1985.
78. Douglas, John, et al., Fuel Cells for Urban Power, EPRI Journal, September
1991: 511.
79. Howell, John R., Bannerot, Richard B., and Vliet, Gary C., Solar-Thermal Energy
Systems. New York: McGraw-Hill, 1982.
80. Levine, Jules D., et al., Basic Properties of the Spheral Solar Cell. 22
nd
Photovoltaic Specialists Conference, Las Vegas, Nev., 1991.
81. International Fuel Cells: Clean, Reliable Fuel Cell Energy,
www.internationalfuelcells.com/index_fl1.shtml (November 14, 2000).
82. Rulseh, Ted, Fuel Cells: From Promise to Performance, Grid, Spring/Summer
2000: 15.
83. Santa Clara Demonstration Project, www.ttcorp.com/fccg/scdpnew1.htm
(November 14, 2000).
84. Fuel Cell Energy, Carbonate Fuel Cell Manufacturer,
www.ttcorp.com/fccg/erc_abt.htm (November 15, 2000).
85. Welcome to Fuel Cell Energy, Inc., www.fuelcellenergy.com/homeframe.html
(December 9, 2000).
86. Library of Fuel Cell Related Publications, http://216.51.18.233/biblio.html
(November 14, 2000)
87. Archer, David H. and Wimer, John G., A Phosphoric Acid Fuel Cell Cogeneration
System Retrofit to a Large Office Building, Department of Energy FETC-97/1044,
April 1997., www.fetc.doe.gov/netltv/index.html (November 15, 2000).
88. DaimlerChrysler Offers First Commercial Fuel Cell Buses to Transit Agencies,
www.hfcletter.com/letter/may00/feature.html (November 15, 2000).
89. TroughNet Projects - Projects Deployed,
www.eren.doe.gov/troughnet/deployed.html (November 23, 2000).
524
90. Solar Fact Sheets: Solar Thermal Electricity, Solar Energy Industries
Association, www.seia.org/sf/sfsolthe.htm (November 23, 2000).
91. Solar Thermal Electric Power Plant,
www.magnet.consortia.org.il/ConSolar/stepp.html (November 23, 2000).
92. About FPL Energy, www.fplenergy.com/aboutfpl/solar-1.htm (November 23,
2000).
93. US Department of Energy PV Home Page,
www.eren.doe.gov/pv/pvmenu.cgi?site=pv&idx=0&body=video.html (November 24,
2000).
94. Solar Information Center - Photovoltaic generation systems - Kyocera Solar,
Inc., www.kyocerasolar.com/info/solarenergy.html (November 23, 2000).
95. Photovoltaics Program, http://www.sandia.gov/pv/ ( November 24, 2000).
96. TI Seeks Buyer For Spheral Solar Technology,
www.ti.com/corp/docs/press/company/1995/510no.shtml (November 25, 2000).
EXERCISES
11.1* Derive an expression for the battery power output, in terms of E and R
i
/R
o
, for
the linear model discussed in connection with Example 11.2. Nondimensionalize
the power by dividing by E
2
/R
o
. Use a spreadsheet to tabulate and plot the
dimensionless power as a function of R
i
/R
o
.
11.2* Derive an expression for the linear-battery-model power output nondimension-
alized by E
2
/R
i
in terms of the internal-to-external resistance ratio. Use a
spreadsheet to tabulate the dimensionless power function, and plot it. Is there a
condition that produces an extreme value of the dimensionless power? If so,
use calculus methods to derive the condition.
11.3 An automobile storage battery with and open-circuit voltage of 12.8V is rated
at 260 A-hr. The internal resistance of the battery is 0.2 5. Estimate the
maximum duration of current flow and its value through an external resistance
of 1.8 5.
_________________________
*Exercise numbers with an asterisk involve computer usage.
525
11.4 A battery electrical storage plant is to be designed for 20-MW peak power
delivery for a duration of four hours. The plant uses 600 A-hr batteries
operating at 400 volts DC. Estimate the minimum number of batteries and the
current in each during peak operation.
11.5 A hydrogen-oxygen fuel cell operates with a voltage of 0.7 volts with water-
vapor product. Calculate the work per kg-mole of hydrogen, in kJ and in kW-
hr, and determine the cell efficiency.
11.6 A neighborhood fuel cell power plant is to be designed for an electrical power
output of 2000 kW with liquid-water product. Estimate the flow rates of
hydrogen and oxygen during peak power production, assuming that an 80%
efficient power conditioner is used to convert DC to AC power and the fuel cell
efficiency is 55%. What is the plant heat rate?
11.7 A hydrogen-oxygen fuel cell has liquid water as product when it operates at
0.82 volts. What is the electrical energy output in kJ / kg-mole of hydrogen,
and the cell efficiency?
11.8 Prepare a typed three-page, double-spaced memorandum outlining the design of
the power train of a hydrogen-oxygen fuel-cell-powered automobile, giving the
design criteria, system description, and quantitative preliminary design data on
the power and fuel supply system.
11.9 A hydrogen-oxygen fuel cell stack produces 50 kW of DC power at an
efficiency of 60%, with water vapor as product. What is the hydrogen mass
flow rate, in g/s, and the cell voltage?
11.10 A fuel cell power plant is to be designed for an electrical power output of 200
MW with liquid-water product. Estimate the flow rates of hydrogen and
oxygen during peak power production with an 85% efficient power conditioner
and fuel cell efficiency of 55%. What is the plant heat rate?
11.11 Determine the fraction of the solar spectrum that lies in the visible wavelengths
between 0.4 and 0.7 . What is the ratio of the energy in this visible range to
that in a range of the same width between 2.0 and 2.3 ?
11.12 It is desired to have a window in a south-facing wall shaded by a 1-m overhang
at noon on June 21 and fully exposed to the sun at noon on December 21.
Determine the maximum vertical size of the window for a house at latitude 35
north.
526
11.13 A skylight in a horizontal roof is 10ft. above the floor of the room below.
Determine the distance that the image of the skylight on the floor at noon
moves between December 21 and June 21 at latitude 30 north. Sketch and
label a plan view of the two positions.
11.14 Derive an equation for the duration of daylight as a function of latitude for
December 21 and June 21. Use a spreadsheet to create a table and a plot of the
hours of daylight as a function of latitude for December 21 and June 21.

11.15 Perform an analysis analogous to Example 11.12, comparing the energy
efficiency of using utility central solar photovoltaic electricity with (1) an
electric heat pump for space heating and (2) with solar hydrogen production for
space heating using a furnace.
11.16 An MHD generator uses helium seeded with cesium at 2200K to give an
electrical conductivity of 10 (5-m)
1
. The gas travels at 1000 m/s in a magnetic
field of 3 Webers/m
2
. What MHD generator volume is needed to produce
50MW of output power with a load factor is 0.6?
11.17 The electrical conductivity of C
2
H
4
burned in oxygen at 3000K with a small
amount of potassium seed is 60 (5-m)
1
. An MHD generator operates with a
gas velocity of 1000 m/s, the magnetic field intensity is 5 tesla, the channel is 1
meter square in cross-section, and the load factor is 0.5. What is the open-
circuit voltage, the load potential difference, and the short-circuit and operating
current density? If the electrode area is 50% of the wall area and the channel is
10 m long, what is the current and the power output?
11.18 Prepare a preliminary design of a solar photovoltaic system to provide 1.0 kW
of stand-alone, 24 hour / day power to a travel trailer. Write a report giving
details, including a schematic of the overall system, a cost estimate, the cell
array design, and a discussion of the assumptions on which the design is based.
11.19 Estimate the electrical power requirement in kW, of a 1400-ft
2
floor area (three
bedroom home) with three occupants. Using your home power estimate, predict
the power requirement for a city of 300,000 people. Use these results to
estimate the area of silicon solar cells required to satisfy the community power
requirements. Write a short narrative discussing your assumptions and analysis.
11.20 Estimate the efficiency of a parquet of an EPRI-Stanford concentrating solar
cell.
527
11.21 According to reference 65, a 400-MW expansion of the SEGS plants in
southern California is expected to cost $1.4 billion. What is the expected
capital cost of the generation facilities, in dollars per kW of capacity? Estimate
the minimum cost of electricity per kW-h generated by the new facilities if they
are operated at full capacity for six hours per day for 30 years.
11.22 Evaluate the efficiency of a solar-photovoltaic-powered hydrogen economy for
comparison with the nuclear-powered version given in Example 11.12.
Consider the cases where the energy source is (a) photovoltaic electricity, and
(b) the sun.
11.23 Assuming 8% efficiency for a spheral solar laminate, what is the maximum
electrical output of a one square meter sheet? Estimate the peak and the annual
electrical loads for three-person family home. Determine the required area for a
fixed spheral solar installation. Indicate clearly the assumptions made.
11.24 Assuming 10% efficiency for a spheral solar laminate, what is the maximum
electrical output of a one square foot sheet? Estimate the peak and the annual
electrical loads for three-person family home. Determine the required area for a
fixed spheral solar installation. Indicate clearly the assumptions made.
Table A.1 Physical Constants
__________________________________________________
Name Value Units of measure
Speed of light in a vacuum 2.9979x10
8
m/s
Gravitational constant 6.673x10
11
N-m
2
/ kg
2
Avogadro's number 6.022x10
23
atoms/g-mole
Boltzmann constant 1.38x10
23
J / K
Universal gas constant 0.082057 L-atm/g-mole -K
8.314 kJ /kg-mole - K
1545.3 ft-lb
f
/lb-mole - R
1.986 Btu /lb-mole - R
1.986 cal / g-mole - K
0.730 atm-ft
3
/lb-mole - R
10.73 psia - ft
3
/lb-mole - R
Volume of ideal gas, at STP 22.41 m
3
/kg-mole
Unified atomic mass unit, amu 1.660531x10
27
kg
Planck's constant 6.626196x10
34
J-s
Electron charge 1.60219210
19
C
Electron rest mass 9.109558x10
31
kg
5.485930x10
4
amu
Proton rest mass 1.672614x10
27
kg
1.00727661 amu
Neutron rest mass 1.674920x10
27
kg
1.00866520 amu
Electron-charge-to-mass ratio 1.758803x10
11
C / kg
Stefan-Boltzmann constant 5.66961x10
8
W / m
2
- K
4
Faraday's constant 9.6487x10
7
C / kg-mole
________________________________________________________
Table A.2 Conversion Factors
________________________________________________________________________________
Length Volume
1 ft = 0.3084 m I liter = 10
3
m
3
1 in = 2.540 cm = 1000 cm
3
1 mile = 5280 ft = 0.035313 ft
3
= 1.6093 km = 0.26417 gal
1 km = 1000 m = 61.025 in
3
1 m = 100 cm 1 gal = 3.7854 liter
= 1.0936 yd = 0.13368 ft
3
= 3.2808 ft I ft
3
= 28.317 liter
1 cm = 0.3937 in. = 7.4805 gal
1 in
3
= 16.387 cm
3
Mass
1 Ib
m
= 0.45359237 kg
= 7000 grain Force
1 slug = 32.174 Ib
m
I Ib
f
= 4.4482 N
= 14.5939 kg = 444,800 dyne
1 kg = 1000 g = 32.174 Ib
m
-ft/s
2
= 2.2046 Ib
m
1 N = 1 kg-m/s
2
1 ton: = 0.22481 Ib
f
metric = 1000 kg 1 dyne= 1 g-cm/s
2
short = 2000 Ib
m
= 10
5
N
Pressure Time
1 kPa = I000 N / m
2
1 h = 3600 s
= 20.886 Ib
f
/ft
2
I min = 60 s
1 atm = 760 torr 1 ms = 10
3
s
= 1.01325 x 10
5
N/m
2
1 s = 10
6
s
= 14.696 Ib
f
/in
2
= 29.92 in. Hg Energy
1 torr = 1 mm Hg 1 J = 1 kg-m
2
/s
2
= 1.933 10
2
psi = 9.47810
4
Btu
1 mm Hg = 0.01934 Ib
f
/in
2
= 10
7
erg
1 bar = 0.9869 atm 1 erg = 1 dyne-cm
= 10
5
N /m
2
1cal = 4.186 J
= 10
6
dyne/cm
2
1 Btu = 252.16 cal
1 in. Hg = 0.491 Ib
f
/in
2
= 1.05504 kJ
= 0.0334 atm = 778.16 ft-lb
f
= 33,864 dyne/cm
2
1 ft-lb
f
= 1.3558 J
1 dyne/cm
2
= 10
1
N/m
2
1 ev = 1.602 x 10
19
J
Table A.2 (continued)
________________________________________________________________________________
Temperature Power
1 K = 1.8 R 1 W = 1 J/s
K = C + 273.15 = 1 kg-m
2
/s
3
C = (F 32)/1.8 = 860.42 cal /hr
R = F + 459.67 1 kW = 1000 W
= 3412.2 Btu/h
Electromagnetic units = 1.341 hp
1 ampere = 1 C/s = 737.56 Ib
f
-ft/s
= 1 W/v 1 hp = 2544.5 Btu/h
1 volt = 1 J/C = 745.7 W
1 ohm = 1 v/A = 550 ft-lb
f
/s
1 farad = 1 A-s/v = 33,000 ft-lb
f
/min
1 henry = 1 v-s/A
1 weber = 1 v-s Specific Energy
1 tesla = 1 Wb/m
2
1 Btu/Ib
m
= 2.3259 kJ/kg
= 1 N/A-m
= 10
4
gauss Energy Flux
1 Btu/ft
2
-s = 11.356 kW/m
2
Density
1 Ib
m
/ft
3
= 0.01602 g/cm
3
= 16.02 kg / m
3
APPENDIX B
Properties of Steam
(English units)
Table B.1 Saturated Steam: Temperature Table
Table B.2 Saturated Steam: Pressure Table
Figure B.1 Mollier Diagram for Steam (two parts)
Figure B.2 TemperatureEntropy Diagram for Steam
Figure B.3 PressureEnthalpy Diagram for Steam
This page is intentionally blank.
APPENDIX C
Properties of Steam
(SI units)
Table C.1 Saturated Steam (Temperature)
From NBS/NRC Steam Tables by L. Haar, et.al., New York: Hemisphere Publishing,
1984; with permission
APPENDIX C
Properties of Steam
(SI units)
Figure C.1 Isentropic Exponent for Steam
Figure C.2 Mollier Diagram for Steam
Figure C.3 PressureEnthalpy Diagram for Steam
Figure C.4 TemperatureEntropy Diagram for Steam
From NBS/NRC Steam Tables by L. Haar, et.al., New York: Hemisphere Publishing,
1984; with permission
AP P E N D I X D
Enthalpy of
Selected Substances
Table D.1 Enthalpy (Btu/lb-mole)
Table D.2 Enthalpy (Btu/Ibm)
Table D.3 Enthalpy (kJ/kg)
Table D.4 Enthalpy (kJ/g-mole)
Reproduced with Permission from: Chase, M.W. Jr., Davies, C.A., Downey, J.R., Frurip
D.J., McDonald, R.A., JANAF Thermochernical Tables, Third Edition, Part
1 (Al-Co) and Part H (Cr-Zr), J. Phys. Chem. Ref. Data 14, Supplement No. 1, 1985.
The primary data in the JANAF Tables is presented on a gram-mole basis in S1 units. He
the primary enthalpy data is presented in units of kJ/gram-mole. Tables in other sets of uni
are derived from this primary table. For instance enthalpy in kJ/kg is obtained by dividin
the primary values by the appropriate molecular masses and multiplying by 1000. Mass-base
values in the English system are obtained from the SI mass-based values by multiplying by th
conversion factor 0.43021 Btu-kg/kJ-lbm. Mole-based values in the English system are obtaine
directly from the primary values by multiplying by (0.43021)(1000
JANAF Table temperatures are given in degrees Kelvin. Rankine temperatures listed in t
present tables are a factor of 1.8 times the Kelvin values
Table D.1 Enthalpy (Btu/lb-mole
TEMPERATURE ENTHALPY (Btu/lb-mole)
R K O2 N2 C CO CO2 H2 H2O SO2
_______________ _____________________________________________________________________
0 0 -3736 -3730 -452 -3730 -4028 -3643 -4261 -4540
180 100 -2486 -2481 -426 -2482 -2777 -2352 -2846 -3105
360 200 -1234 -1229 -286 -1230 -1469 -1193 -1412 -1607
536.7 298.15 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
540 300 23 23 7 23 30 23 27 32
720 400 1301 1278 447 1280 1722 1273 1485 1828
900 500 2617 2543 1017 2552 3573 2530 2979 3768
1080 600 3977 3826 1696 3847 5553 3791 4518 5827
1260 700 5377 5135 2459 5172 7638 5055 6106 7980
1440 800 6812 6473 3286 6529 9811 6325 7745 10205
1620 900 8278 7840 4161 7916 12059 7604 9438 12486
1800 1000 9767 9234 5074 9331 14368 8897 11185 14811
1980 1100 11277 10652 6018 10770 16728 10204 12988 17171
2160 1200 12803 12093 6987 12231 19133 11528 14845 19559
2340 1300 14345 13553 7976 13710 21574 12871 16753 21970
2520 1400 15899 15030 8982 15205 24047 14232 18711 24401
2700 1500 17466 16522 10004 16714 26546 15612 20715 26847
2880 1600 19044 18028 11038 18234 29069 17011 22762 29307
3060 1700 20632 19544 12085 19766 31612 18428 24848 31780
3240 1800 22230 21071 13142 21307 34172 19862 26971 34263
3420 1900 23839 22607 14208 22860 36748 21313 29128 36755
3600 2000 25458 24151 15283 24412 39338 22780 31315 39257
3780 2100 27086 25702 16367 25974 41940 24263 33531 41765
3960 2200 28725 27259 17458 27542 44553 25759 35773 44281
4140 2300 30373 28822 18557 29118 47177 27270 38040 46803
4320 2400 32030 30390 19662 30684 49809 28793 40328 49332
4500 2500 33698 31963 20774 32259 52450 30329 42637 51866
4680 2600 35374 33540 21893 33846 55098 31877 44966 54405
4860 2700 37059 35122 23018 35436 57754 33436 47312 56950
5040 2800 38753 36707 24148 37030 60416 35006 49674 59499
5220 2900 40455 38295 25285 38627 63084 36586 52051 62053
5400 3000 42166 39887 26427 40226 65759 38177 54443 64611
Table D.1 continued. Enthalpy (Btu/lb-mole
TEMPERATURE ENTHALPY (Btu/lb-mole)
R K O2 N2 C CO CO2 H2 H2O SO2
_______________ _____________________________________________________________________
5580 3100 43885 41481 27574 41829 68438 39777 56848 67173
5760 3200 45612 43079 28727 43434 71123 41387 59264 69740
5940 3300 47346 44678 29885 45041 73812 43006 61693 72310
6120 3400 49088 46281 31049 46651 76507 44634 64133 74885
6300 3500 50836 47885 32218 48263 79206 46271 66583 77462
6480 3600 52591 49492 33392 49877 81909 47917 69042 80044
6660 3700 54352 51101 34570 51493 84616 49571 71510 82630
6840 3800 56120 52712 35754 53111 87328 51233 73988 85219
7020 3900 57893 54324 36943 54731 90043 52904 76473 87811
7200 4000 59672 55939 38136 56353 92763 54583 78966 90407
7380 4100 61457 57555 39335 57976 95486 56269 81466 93005
7560 4200 63247 59173 40538 59601 98213 57964 83973 95608
7740 4300 65043 60793 41746 61228 100943 59667 86487 98214
7920 4400 66843 62414 42959 62856 103677 61377 89007 100822
8100 4500 68650 64037 44165 64486 106414 63095 91533 103434
8280 4600 70461 65661 45398 66118 109155 64820 94065 106049
8460 4700 72277 67287 46625 67751 111899 66553 96603 108668
8640 4800 74099 68914 47857 69385 114646 68292 99145 111289
8820 4900 75927 70543 49093 71021 117397 70039 101693 113913
9000 5000 77760 72173 50333 72658 120150 71792 104246 116541
9180 5100 79599 73805 51579 74297 122907 73552 106803 119171
9360 5200 81444 75438 52829 75937 125668 75317 109366 121805
9540 5300 83295 77073 54083 77578 128433 77089 111934 124441
9720 5400 85153 78709 55342 79222 131202 78867 114507 127081
9900 5500 87017 80347 56606 80861 133974 80649 117085 129723
10080 5600 88889 81986 57874 82504 136751 82437 119668 132368
10260 5700 90769 83626 59146 84150 139532 84230 122256 135016
10440 5800 92657 85268 60423 85799 142316 86026 124849 137667
10620 5900 94552 86912 61705 87448 145105 87827 127447 140321
10800 6000 96457 88558 62991 89099 147897 89630 130050 142979
Table D.2. Enthalpy (Btu/lbm)
TEMPERATURE ENTHALPY (Btu/lbm)
R K O2 N2 C CO CO2 H2 H2O SO2
_______________ ______________________________________________________________________
0 0 -116.7 -133.2 -37.6 -133.2 -91.5 -1806.8 -236.5 -252.0
180 100 -77.7 -88.6 -35.5 -88.6 -63.1 -1166.9 -158.0 -172.3
360 200 -38.6 -43.9 -23.8 -43.9 -33.4 -592.0 -78.4 -89.2
536.7 298.15 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0
540 300 0.7 0.8 0.6 0.8 0.7 11.3 1.5 1.8
720 400 40.7 45.6 37.2 45.7 39.1 631.4 82.4 101.5
900 500 81.8 90.8 84.7 91.1 81.2 1255.2 165.4 209.1
1080 600 124.3 136.6 141.2 137.3 126.2 1880.2 250.8 323.4
1260 700 168.0 183.3 204.7 184.7 173.6 2507.2 338.9 442.9
1440 800 212.9 231.1 273.5 233.1 222.9 3137.4 429.9 566.4
1620 900 258.7 279.9 346.4 282.6 274.0 3772.0 523.9 693.0
1800 1000 305.2 329.7 422.5 333.1 326.5 4413.1 620.9 822.1
1980 1100 352.4 380.3 501.1 384.5 380.1 5061.6 720.9 953.1
2160 1200 400.1 431.7 581.7 436.7 434.7 5718.4 824.0 1085.6
2340 1300 448.3 483.9 664.0 489.5 490.2 6384.4 929.9 1219.5
2520 1400 496.9 536.6 747.8 542.8 546.4 7059.6 1038.6 1354.4
2700 1500 545.8 589.9 832.9 596.7 603.2 7744.2 1149.8 1490.2
2880 1600 595.1 643.6 919.0 651.0 660.5 8438.0 1263.4 1626.7
3060 1700 644.8 697.8 1006.1 705.7 718.3 9140.9 1379.2 1764.0
3240 1800 694.7 752.3 1094.1 760.7 776.5 9852.4 1497.1 1901.8
3420 1900 745.0 807.1 1182.9 816.1 835.0 10571.9 1616.8 2040.2
3600 2000 795.6 862.2 1272.4 871.5 893.8 11299.6 1738.2 2179.0
3780 2100 846.5 917.6 1362.7 927.3 953.0 12035.0 1861.2 2318.2
3960 2200 897.6 973.2 1453.5 983.3 1012.3 12777.4 1985.6 2457.9
4140 2300 949.2 1029.0 1545.0 1039.5 1072.0 13526.6 2111.4 2597.9
4320 2400 1001.0 1085.0 1637.0 1095.5 1131.8 14282.3 2238.5 2738.2
4500 2500 1053.0 1141.1 1729.6 1151.7 1191.8 15044.1 2366.6 2878.9
4680 2600 1105.4 1197.4 1822.7 1208.3 1251.9 15811.9 2495.9 3019.8
4860 2700 1158.1 1253.9 1916.4 1265.1 1312.3 16585.3 2626.1 3161.1
5040 2800 1211.0 1310.5 2010.5 1322.0 1372.8 17364.0 2757.2 3302.6
5220 2900 1264.2 1367.2 2105.1 1379.0 1433.4 18148.0 2889.2 3444.3
5400 3000 1317.7 1424.0 2200.2 1436.1 1494.2 18936.9 3021.9 3586.3
Table D.2 continued. Enthalpy (Btu/lbm
TEMPERATURE ENTHALPY (Btu/lbm)
R K O2 N2 C CO CO2 H2 H2O SO2
_______________ ______________________________________________________________________
5580 3100 1371.4 1480.9 2295.8 1493.3 1555.1 19730.8 3155.4 3728.5
5760 3200 1425.4 1538.0 2391.7 1550.6 1616.1 20529.3 3289.5 3871.0
5940 3300 1479.6 1595.1 2488.2 1608.0 1677.2 21332.5 3424.4 4013.7
6120 3400 1534.0 1652.3 2585.1 1665.5 1738.4 22140.0 3559.8 4156.6
6300 3500 1588.6 1709.6 2682.4 1723.0 1799.7 22952.0 3695.8 4299.6
6480 3600 1643.5 1766.9 2780.1 1780.7 1861.1 23768.2 3832.3 4442.9
6660 3700 1698.5 1824.4 2878.2 1838.4 1922.7 24588.6 3969.3 4586.5
6840 3800 1753.7 1881.9 2976.8 1896.1 1984.3 25413.3 4106.8 4730.2
7020 3900 1809.2 1939.5 3075.8 1953.9 2046.0 26242.0 4244.7 4874.0
7200 4000 1864.8 1997.1 3175.1 2011.9 2107.8 27074.6 4383.1 5018.1
7380 4100 1920.5 2054.8 3274.9 2069.8 2169.6 27911.4 4521.9 5162.4
7560 4200 1976.5 2112.6 3375.1 2127.8 2231.6 28751.9 4661.0 5306.8
7740 4300 2032.6 2170.4 3475.7 2185.9 2293.6 29596.6 4800.6 5451.5
7920 4400 2088.9 2228.3 3576.6 2244.0 2355.8 30444.8 4940.4 5596.3
8100 4500 2145.3 2286.2 3677.0 2302.2 2418.0 31296.9 5080.7 5741.2
8280 4600 2201.9 2344.2 3779.7 2360.5 2480.2 32152.6 5221.2 5886.4
8460 4700 2258.7 2402.2 3881.9 2418.8 2542.6 33012.2 5362.1 6031.7
8640 4800 2315.6 2460.3 3984.4 2477.1 2605.0 33875.0 5503.2 6177.2
8820 4900 2372.7 2518.5 4087.3 2535.5 2667.5 34741.4 5644.6 6322.9
9000 5000 2430.0 2576.7 4190.6 2594.0 2730.1 35611.0 5786.3 6468.7
9180 5100 2487.5 2635.0 4294.3 2652.5 2792.7 36484.0 5928.2 6614.7
9360 5200 2545.1 2693.3 4398.3 2711.0 2855.4 37359.8 6070.5 6760.9
9540 5300 2603.0 2751.6 4502.8 2769.6 2918.3 38238.8 6213.0 6907.3
9720 5400 2661.0 2810.0 4607.6 2828.3 2981.2 39120.5 6355.8 7053.8
9900 5500 2719.3 2868.5 4712.8 2886.8 3044.2 40004.6 6498.9 7200.4
10080 5600 2777.8 2927.0 4818.4 2945.5 3107.3 40891.5 6642.3 7347.3
10260 5700 2836.5 2985.6 4924.3 3004.3 3170.5 41780.5 6786.0 7494.2
10440 5800 2895.5 3044.2 5030.7 3063.1 3233.7 42671.7 6929.9 7641.4
10620 5900 2954.8 3102.9 5137.3 3122.0 3297.1 43564.7 7074.1 7788.7
10800 6000 3014.3 3161.7 5244.4 3180.9 3360.5 44459.5 7218.6 7936.2
Table D.3. Enthalpy (kJ/kg)
TEMPERATURE ENTHALPY (kJ/kg)
R K O2 N2 C CO CO2 H2 H2O SO2
_______________ ______________________________________________________________________
0 0 -271.3 -309.5 -87.5 -309.6 -212.8 -4199.9 -549.7 -585.7
180 100 -180.6 -205.9 -82.5 -206.0 -146.7 -2712.3 -367.2 -400.6
360 200 -89.6 -102.0 -55.4 -102.0 -77.6 -1376.0 -182.2 -207.4
536.7 298.15 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0
540 300 1.7 1.9 1.3 1.9 1.6 26.3 3.4 4.1
720 400 94.5 106.1 86.5 106.2 91.0 1467.8 191.6 235.9
900 500 190.1 211.0 196.9 211.7 188.7 2917.7 384.4 486.1
1080 600 288.9 317.5 328.3 319.2 293.3 4370.5 582.9 751.8
1260 700 390.6 426.2 475.9 429.2 403.4 5827.9 787.7 1029.5
1440 800 494.8 537.2 635.8 541.8 518.2 7292.7 999.2 1316.7
1620 900 601.3 650.6 805.3 656.9 636.9 8767.9 1217.7 1611.0
1800 1000 709.5 766.3 982.0 774.4 758.9 10257.9 1443.2 1911.0
1980 1100 819.1 884.0 1164.7 893.8 883.5 11765.4 1675.8 2215.5
2160 1200 930.0 1003.5 1352.1 1015.0 1010.5 13292.2 1915.3 2523.5
2340 1300 1042.0 1124.7 1543.5 1137.7 1139.5 14840.3 2161.5 2834.6
2520 1400 1154.9 1247.3 1738.3 1261.8 1270.1 16409.7 2414.1 3148.2
2700 1500 1268.7 1371.1 1936.0 1387.0 1402.1 18001.0 2672.7 3463.8
2880 1600 1383.3 1496.0 2136.2 1513.2 1535.3 19613.6 2936.7 3781.3
3060 1700 1498.7 1621.9 2338.7 1640.3 1669.6 21247.5 3205.9 4100.2
3240 1800 1614.8 1748.6 2543.3 1768.1 1804.8 22901.3 3479.9 4420.6
3420 1900 1731.7 1876.0 2749.6 1897.0 1940.9 24573.9 3758.1 4742.2
3600 2000 1849.2 2004.2 2957.7 2025.8 2077.7 26265.4 4040.3 5064.9
3780 2100 1967.5 2132.9 3167.4 2155.5 2215.1 27974.7 4326.2 5388.6
3960 2200 2086.5 2262.1 3378.7 2285.6 2353.1 29700.4 4615.5 5713.2
4140 2300 2206.3 2391.8 3591.2 2416.4 2491.7 31442.0 4907.9 6038.6
4320 2400 2326.7 2522.0 3805.2 2546.3 2630.7 33198.4 5203.2 6364.8
4500 2500 2447.8 2652.5 4020.4 2677.0 2770.2 34969.2 5501.1 6691.8
4680 2600 2569.5 2783.4 4236.9 2808.7 2910.1 36754.0 5801.5 7019.4
4860 2700 2691.9 2914.6 4454.5 2940.7 3050.4 38551.6 6104.2 7347.7
5040 2800 2815.0 3046.2 4673.3 3072.9 3190.9 40361.6 6409.0 7676.6
5220 2900 2938.6 3178.0 4893.3 3205.5 3331.9 42184.0 6715.7 8006.1
5400 3000 3062.9 3310.1 5114.2 3338.2 3473.1 44017.9 7024.3 8336.1
Table D.3 continued. Enthalpy (kJ/kg)
TEMPERATURE ENTHALPY (kJ/kg)
R K O2 N2 C CO CO2 H2 H2O SO2
_______________ ______________________________________________________________________
5580 3100 3187.8 3442.4 5336.4 3471.2 3614.7 45863.1 7334.5 8666.7
5760 3200 3313.2 3574.9 5559.5 3604.4 3756.4 47719.2 7646.4 8997.9
5940 3300 3439.2 3707.7 5783.6 3737.8 3898.5 49586.3 7959.8 9329.5
6120 3400 3565.7 3840.7 6008.8 3871.3 4040.8 51463.3 8274.5 9661.7
6300 3500 3692.7 3973.8 6235.0 4005.1 4183.3 53350.7 8590.6 9994.3
6480 3600 3820.2 4107.1 6462.2 4139.1 4326.1 55248.0 8907.9 10327.4
6660 3700 3948.1 4240.7 6690.3 4273.2 4469.1 57154.8 9226.4 10661.0
6840 3800 4076.5 4374.3 6919.4 4407.4 4612.3 59071.9 9546.0 10995.0
7020 3900 4205.3 4508.2 7149.4 4541.8 4755.8 60998.0 9866.6 11329.4
7200 4000 4334.5 4642.2 7380.4 4676.4 4899.4 62933.5 10188.3 11664.4
7380 4100 4464.2 4776.3 7612.4 4811.1 5043.2 64878.5 10510.8 11999.7
7560 4200 4594.2 4910.6 7845.2 4946.0 5187.2 66832.3 10834.3 12335.4
7740 4300 4724.6 5044.9 8079.0 5081.0 5331.4 68795.6 11158.6 12671.6
7920 4400 4855.4 5179.5 8313.7 5216.1 5475.8 70767.4 11483.8 13008.2
8100 4500 4986.6 5314.2 8547.0 5351.4 5620.4 72748.0 11809.7 13345.2
8280 4600 5118.2 5448.9 8785.8 5486.8 5765.2 74737.1 12136.4 13682.6
8460 4700 5250.2 5583.9 9023.2 5622.3 5910.1 76735.1 12463.8 14020.4
8640 4800 5382.5 5718.9 9261.5 5757.9 6055.2 78740.6 12791.9 14358.6
8820 4900 5515.3 5854.1 9500.8 5893.7 6200.5 80754.5 13120.6 14697.2
9000 5000 5648.4 5989.4 9740.8 6029.5 6345.9 82775.8 13449.9 15036.2
9180 5100 5782.0 6124.8 9981.8 6165.5 6491.5 84805.1 13779.9 15375.6
9360 5200 5916.0 6260.3 10223.7 6301.6 6637.3 86840.8 14110.5 15715.4
9540 5300 6050.4 6396.0 10466.5 6437.8 6783.3 88883.9 14441.8 16055.6
9720 5400 6185.4 6531.8 10710.2 6574.2 6929.6 90933.5 14773.8 16396.1
9900 5500 6320.8 6667.7 10954.7 6710.3 7076.0 92988.6 15106.4 16737.0
10080 5600 6456.8 6803.7 11200.1 6846.6 7222.7 95050.1 15439.7 17078.3
10260 5700 6593.3 6939.8 11446.3 6983.2 7369.6 97116.6 15773.6 17420.0
10440 5800 6730.5 7076.1 11693.5 7120.0 7516.6 99188.0 16108.1 17762.0
10620 5900 6868.2 7212.5 11941.5 7256.9 7663.9 101264 16443.4 18104.4
10800 6000 7006.6 7349.1 12190.4 7393.9 7811.4 103344 16779.3 18447.3
Table D.4. Enthalpy (kJ/g-mole)
TEMPERATURE ENTHALPY (kJ/g-mole)
R K O2 N2 C CO CO2 H2 H2O SO2
_______________ ______________________________________________________________________
0 0 -8.683 -8.670 -1.051 -8.671 -9.364 -8.467 -9.904 -10.552
180 100 -5.779 -5.768 -0.991 -5.769 -6.456 -5.468 -6.615 -7.217
360 200 -2.868 -2.857 -0.665 -2.858 -3.414 -2.774 -3.282 -3.736
536.7 298.15 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000
540 300 0.054 0.054 0.016 0.054 0.069 0.053 0.062 0.074
720 400 3.025 2.971 1.039 2.976 4.003 2.959 3.452 4.250
900 500 6.084 5.911 2.365 5.931 8.305 5.882 6.925 8.758
1080 600 9.244 8.894 3.943 8.942 12.907 8.811 10.501 13.544
1260 700 12.499 11.937 5.716 12.023 17.754 11.749 14.192 18.548
1440 800 15.835 15.046 7.637 15.177 22.806 14.702 18.002 23.721
1620 900 19.241 18.223 9.672 18.401 28.030 17.676 21.938 29.023
1800 1000 22.703 21.463 11.795 21.690 33.397 20.680 26.000 34.428
1980 1100 26.212 24.760 13.989 25.035 38.884 23.719 30.191 39.914
2160 1200 29.761 28.109 16.240 28.430 44.473 26.797 34.506 45.464
2340 1300 33.344 31.503 18.539 31.868 50.148 29.918 38.942 51.069
2520 1400 36.957 34.936 20.879 35.343 55.896 33.082 43.493 56.718
2700 1500 40.599 38.405 23.253 38.850 61.705 36.290 48.151 62.404
2880 1600 44.266 41.904 25.658 42.385 67.569 39.541 52.908 68.123
3060 1700 47.958 45.429 28.090 45.945 73.480 42.835 57.758 73.870
3240 1800 51.673 48.978 30.547 49.526 79.431 46.169 62.693 79.642
3420 1900 55.413 52.548 33.026 53.136 85.419 49.541 67.706 85.436
3600 2000 59.175 56.137 35.525 56.744 91.439 52.951 72.790 91.250
3780 2100 62.961 59.742 38.044 60.376 97.488 56.397 77.941 97.081
3960 2200 66.769 63.361 40.581 64.021 103.562 59.876 83.153 102.929
4140 2300 70.600 66.995 43.134 67.683 109.660 63.387 88.421 108.792
4320 2400 74.453 70.640 45.704 71.324 115.779 66.928 93.741 114.669
4500 2500 78.328 74.296 48.289 74.985 121.917 70.498 99.108 120.559
4680 2600 82.224 77.963 50.889 78.673 128.073 74.096 104.520 126.462
4860 2700 86.141 81.639 53.503 82.369 134.246 77.720 109.973 132.376
5040 2800 90.079 85.323 56.131 86.074 140.433 81.369 115.464 138.302
5220 2900 94.036 89.015 58.773 89.786 146.636 85.043 120.990 144.238
5400 3000 98.013 92.715 61.427 93.504 152.852 88.740 126.549 150.184
Table D.4 continued. Enthalpy (kJ/g-mole
TEMPERATURE ENTHALPY (kJ/g-mole)
R K O2 N2 C CO CO2 H2 H2O SO2
_______________ ______________________________________________________________________
5580 3100 102.009 96.421 64.095 97.229 159.081 92.460 132.139 156.140
5760 3200 106.023 100.134 66.775 100.960 165.321 96.202 137.757 162.106
5940 3300 110.054 103.852 69.467 104.696 171.573 99.966 143.403 168.081
6120 3400 114.102 107.577 72.172 108.438 177.836 103.750 149.073 174.065
6300 3500 118.165 111.306 74.889 112.185 184.109 107.555 154.768 180.057
6480 3600 122.245 115.041 77.617 115.937 190.393 111.380 160.485 186.058
6660 3700 126.339 118.781 80.357 119.693 196.686 115.224 166.222 192.068
6840 3800 130.447 122.525 83.109 123.454 202.989 119.089 171.980 198.086
7020 3900 134.569 126.274 85.872 127.219 209.301 122.972 177.757 204.111
7200 4000 138.705 130.027 88.646 130.989 215.622 126.874 183.552 210.145
7380 4100 142.854 133.784 91.432 134.762 221.951 130.795 189.363 216.186
7560 4200 147.015 137.545 94.229 138.540 228.290 134.734 195.191 222.235
7740 4300 151.188 141.309 97.037 142.321 234.637 138.692 201.034 228.292
7920 4400 155.374 145.078 99.856 146.106 240.991 142.667 206.892 234.356
8100 4500 159.572 148.850 102.658 149.895 247.354 146.660 212.764 240.427
8280 4600 163.783 152.625 105.526 153.687 253.725 150.670 218.650 246.506
8460 4700 168.005 156.405 108.378 157.483 260.103 154.698 224.548 252.592
8640 4800 172.240 160.187 111.240 161.282 266.489 158.741 230.458 258.685
8820 4900 176.488 163.973 114.114 165.084 272.882 162.801 236.380 264.785
9000 5000 180.749 167.763 116.997 168.890 279.283 166.876 242.313 270.893
9180 5100 185.023 171.556 119.892 172.699 285.691 170.967 248.258 277.007
9360 5200 189.311 175.352 122.797 176.511 292.109 175.071 254.215 283.128
9540 5300 193.614 179.152 125.713 180.326 298.535 179.190 260.184 289.257
9720 5400 197.933 182.955 128.640 184.146 304.971 183.322 266.164 295.392
9900 5500 202.267 186.761 131.577 187.957 311.416 187.465 272.157 301.534
10080 5600 206.618 190.571 134.524 191.775 317.870 191.621 278.161 307.683
10260 5700 210.987 194.384 137.482 195.603 324.334 195.787 284.177 313.838
10440 5800 215.375 198.201 140.451 199.434 330.806 199.963 290.204 320.000
10620 5900 219.782 202.023 143.429 203.268 337.288 204.148 296.244 326.169
10800 6000 224.210 205.848 146.419 207.106 343.779 208.341 302.295 332.346
APPENDIX E
Properties of
Selected Coals
Table E.1 Analyses of Selected U.S. Coals, as mined
Table E.2 Typical analyses of Coals of the World
APPENDIX F
Thermodynamic properties
of Refrigerants
Figure F.1 Thermodynamic Properties of R-12 (English units)
Figure F.2 Thermodynamic Properties of R-22 (English units)
Figure F.3 Thermodynamic Properties of R-123 (English units)
Figure F.4 Thermodynamic Properties of R-123a (English units)
Figure F.5 Thermodynamic Properties of R-134a (SI units)
This page is intentionally blank.
APPENDIX H
Properties of the 1976
U.S. Standard Atmosphere
Table H.1 Properties of the 1976 U.S. Standard Atmosphere (SI units)
Table H.2 Properties of the 1976 U.S. Standard Atmoshere (English units)
APPENDIX I
Blackbody Spectral Distribution Function
The Planck function divided by the fifth power of the temperature and the
Stefan-Boltzmann constant is multiplied by 100,000 so that it plots nicely
versus the wavelength-temperature product, Lambda-T, as in Figure 11.27.
SIGMA was calculated by summing the product of the tabulated Planck
function and the abscissa interval (100) to the desired value of lambda-T.
The sum must then be divided by 1000 to compensate for the 100,000 factor.
Note the distinction between the Stefan-Boltzmann constant (Sigma) and
the cumulative radiation function (SIGMA).
c1 = 118700000 Btu-micron^4/ft^2-hr
c2 = 25896 micron-degree R
Lambda-T Fb(Lambda-T)/Sigma-T^5 SIGMA
micron-R 1/(micron-R) dimensionless
x100,000
1000 3.926E-05 3.926E-08
1100 0.000256682 2.95942E-07
1200 0.001181568 1.47751E-06
1300 0.004164636 5.64215E-06
1400 0.011928687 1.75708E-05
1500 0.028995038 4.65659E-05
1600 0.061770887 0.000108337
1700 0.11819881 0.000226536
1800 0.207027327 0.000433563
1900 0.336873778 0.000770437
2000 0.515283226 0.00128572
2100 0.747952401 0.002033672
2200 1.038219036 0.003071891
2300 1.386845559 0.004458737
2400 1.792070875 0.006250808
2500 2.249871296 0.008500679
2600 2.754359627 0.011255039
2700 3.298254226 0.014553293
2800 3.87336131 0.018426654
2900 4.471028633 0.022897683
3000 5.082543507 0.027980226
3100 5.699460885 0.033679687
3200 6.313857168 0.039993544
3300 6.918512359 0.046912057
3400 7.507027618 0.054419084
3500 8.073887592 0.062492972
3600 8.614477758 0.07110745
3700 9.12506675 0.080232516
3800 9.602762863 0.089835279
3900 10.04545268 0.099880732
Lambda-T Fb(Lambda-T)/Sigma-T^5 SIGMA
micron-R 1/(micron-R) dimensionless
x100,000
4000 10.45172852 0.110332461
4100 10.82081001 0.121153271
4200 11.152464 0.132305735
4300 11.44692597 0.143752661
4400 11.70482499 0.155457486
4500 11.9271139 0.167384599
4600 12.11500549 0.179499605
4700 12.26991521 0.19176952
4800 12.39341038 0.204162931
4900 12.48716597 0.216650096
5000 12.55292639 0.229203023
5100 12.59247315 0.241795496
5200 12.6075976 0.254403094
5300 12.60007853 0.267003172
5400 12.5716639 0.279574836
5500 12.52405626 0.292098892
5600 12.45890147 0.304557794
5700 12.37778011 0.316935574
5800 12.28220131 0.329217775
5900 12.17359857 0.341391374
6000 12.05332729 0.353444701
6100 11.92266363 0.365367365
6200 11.78280457 0.377150169
6300 11.6348688 0.388785038
6400 11.47989844 0.400264937
6500 11.31886126 0.411583798
6600 11.15265333 0.422736451
6700 10.98210197 0.433718553
6800 10.80796898 0.444526522
6900 10.63095392 0.455157476
7000 10.4516975 0.465609173
7100 10.27078501 0.475879958
7200 10.08874964 0.485968708
7300 9.906075829 0.495874784
7400 9.723202485 0.505597986
7500 9.540526075 0.515138513
7600 9.358403632 0.524496916
7700 9.177155612 0.533674072
7800 8.997068608 0.54267114
7900 8.818397933 0.551489538
8000 8.641370049 0.560130908
8100 8.466184858 0.568597093
8200 8.293017853 0.576890111
8300 8.12202213 0.585012133
8400 7.95333027 0.592965463
8500 7.787056092 0.60075252
8600 7.623296286 0.608375816
8700 7.462131926 0.615837948
8800 7.303629879 0.623141578
8900 7.147844105 0.630289422
Lambda-T Fb(Lambda-T)/Sigma-T^5 SIGMA
micron-R 1/(micron-R) dimensionless
x100,000
9000 6.994816861 0.637284239
9100 6.844579811 0.644128818
9200 6.697155054 0.650825973
9300 6.552556067 0.65737853
9400 6.410788573 0.663789318
9500 6.271851341 0.670061169
9600 6.135736916 0.676196906
9700 6.002432297 0.682199339
9800 5.871919548 0.688071258
9900 5.744176362 0.693815435
10000 5.619176579 0.699434611
10100 5.496890652 0.704931502
10200 5.377286082 0.710308788
10300 5.260327805 0.715569116
10400 5.145978545 0.720715094
10500 5.034199146 0.725749293
10600 4.924948859 0.730674242
10700 4.818185608 0.735492428
10800 4.713866235 0.740206294
10900 4.611946716 0.744818241
11000 4.512382358 0.749330623
11100 4.415127973 0.753745751
11200 4.320138045 0.758065889
11300 4.227366866 0.762293256
11400 4.136768666 0.766430025
11500 4.048297729 0.770478322
11600 3.961908497 0.774440231
11700 3.877555654 0.778317787
11800 3.795194213 0.782112981
11900 3.714779583 0.78582776
12000 3.636267632 0.789464028
12100 3.559614744 0.793023643
12200 3.484777862 0.796508421
12300 3.41171453 0.799920135
12400 3.340382931 0.803260518
12500 3.270741911 0.80653126
12600 3.202751009 0.809734011
12700 3.136370475 0.812870381
12800 3.071561285 0.815941943
12900 3.008285156 0.818950228
13000 2.946504554 0.821896732
13100 2.886182704 0.824782915
13200 2.82728359 0.827610199
13300 2.769771958 0.830379971
13400 2.713613318 0.833093584
13500 2.658773939 0.835752358
13600 2.60522085 0.838357579
13700 2.552921826 0.840910501
13800 2.501845393 0.843412346
13900 2.451960812 0.845864307
Lambda-T Fb(Lambda-T)/Sigma-T^5 SIGMA
micron-R 1/(micron-R) dimensionless
x100,000
14000 2.403238073 0.848267545
14100 2.355647887 0.850623193
14200 2.309161674 0.852932354
14300 2.263751554 0.855196106
14400 2.219390335 0.857415496
14500 2.1760515 0.859591548
14600 2.133709199 0.861725257
14700 2.09233823 0.863817595
14800 2.051914034 0.865869509
14900 2.012412676 0.867881922
15000 1.973810837 0.869855733
15100 1.936085795 0.871791819
15200 1.89921542 0.873691034
15300 1.863178154 0.875554212
15400 1.827953001 0.877382165
15500 1.793519515 0.879175685
15600 1.759857785 0.880935543
15700 1.726948422 0.882662491
15800 1.694772551 0.884357263
15900 1.663311791 0.886020575
16000 1.632548251 0.887653124
16100 1.60246451 0.889255588
16200 1.573043612 0.890828632
16300 1.544269048 0.892372901
16400 1.51612475 0.893889025
16500 1.488595076 0.895377621
16600 1.4616648 0.896839285
16700 1.435319102 0.898274604
16800 1.409543555 0.899684148
16900 1.384324117 0.901068472
17000 1.359647121 0.902428119
17100 1.335499261 0.903763618
17200 1.311867588 0.905075486
17300 1.288739494 0.906364226
17400 1.266102709 0.907630328
17500 1.243945289 0.908874274
17600 1.222255604 0.910096529
17700 1.201022337 0.911297552
17800 1.180234467 0.912477786
17900 1.159881267 0.913637667
18000 1.139952293 0.91477762
18100 1.120437377 0.915898057
18200 1.10132662 0.916999384
18300 1.082610382 0.918081994
18400 1.06427928 0.919146273
18500 1.046324175 0.920192597
18600 1.028736168 0.921221334
18700 1.011506593 0.92223284
18800 0.994627013 0.923227467
18900 0.978089209 0.924205556
Lambda-T Fb(Lambda-T)/Sigma-T^5 SIGMA
micron-R 1/(micron-R) dimensionless
x100,000
19000 0.961885177 0.925167442
19100 0.946007123 0.926113449
19200 0.930447451 0.927043896
19300 0.915198768 0.927959095
19400 0.900253868 0.928859349
19500 0.885605733 0.929744954
19600 0.871247525 0.930616202
19700 0.857172583 0.931473375
19800 0.843374417 0.932316749
19900 0.829846703 0.933146596
20000 0.816583279 0.933963179
20100 0.80357814 0.934766757
20200 0.790825435 0.935557583
20300 0.778319459 0.936335902
20400 0.766054655 0.937101957
20500 0.754025605 0.937855982
20600 0.742227027 0.938598209
20700 0.730653775 0.939328863
20800 0.719300828 0.940048164
20900 0.708163296 0.940756327
21000 0.697236407 0.941453564
21100 0.686515509 0.942140079
21200 0.675996069 0.942816075
21300 0.665673662 0.943481749
21400 0.655543976 0.944137293
21500 0.645602804 0.944782896
21600 0.635846044 0.945418742
21700 0.626269693 0.946045011
21800 0.616869849 0.946661881
21900 0.607642702 0.947269524
22000 0.598584538 0.947868108
22100 0.589691733 0.9484578
22200 0.580960749 0.949038761
22300 0.572388137 0.949611149
22400 0.563970528 0.95017512
22500 0.555704637 0.950730824
22600 0.547587256 0.951278411
22700 0.539615256 0.951818027
22800 0.531785581 0.952349812
22900 0.524095249 0.952873908
23000 0.516541348 0.953390449
23100 0.509121036 0.95389957
23200 0.501831539 0.954401402
23300 0.494670147 0.954896072
23400 0.487634214 0.955383706
23500 0.480721158 0.955864427
23600 0.473928455 0.956338355
23700 0.467253643 0.956805609
23800 0.460694314 0.957266303
23900 0.454248117 0.957720552
Lambda-T Fb(Lambda-T)/Sigma-T^5 SIGMA
micron-R 1/(micron-R) dimensionless
x100,000
24000 0.447912759 0.958168464
24100 0.441685995 0.95861015
24200 0.435565634 0.959045716
24300 0.429549536 0.959475265
24400 0.42363561 0.959898901
24500 0.417821812 0.960316723
24600 0.412106146 0.960728829
24700 0.406486658 0.961135316
24800 0.400961444 0.961536277
24900 0.395528638 0.961931806
25000 0.390186419 0.962321992
25100 0.384933006 0.962706925
25200 0.379766658 0.963086692
25300 0.374685673 0.963461378
25400 0.369688389 0.963831066
25500 0.364773178 0.964195839
25600 0.359938449 0.964555778
25700 0.355182648 0.96491096
25800 0.350504254 0.965261464
25900 0.345901779 0.965607366
26000 0.341373769 0.96594874
26100 0.336918802 0.966285659
26200 0.332535485 0.966618194
26300 0.328222458 0.966946417
26400 0.323978389 0.967270395
26500 0.319801976 0.967590197
26600 0.315691944 0.967905889
26700 0.311647046 0.968217536
26800 0.307666063 0.968525202
26900 0.3037478 0.96882895
27000 0.299891089 0.969128841
27100 0.296094787 0.969424936
27200 0.292357775 0.969717294
27300 0.288678958 0.970005973
27400 0.285057264 0.97029103
27500 0.281491643 0.970572521
27600 0.277981069 0.970850503
27700 0.274524537 0.971125027
27800 0.27112106 0.971396148
27900 0.267769677 0.971663918
28000 0.264469442 0.971928387
28100 0.261219432 0.972189607
28200 0.258018743 0.972447625
28300 0.254866487 0.972702492
28400 0.251761797 0.972954254
28500 0.248703823 0.973202958
28600 0.245691732 0.973448649
28700 0.242724709 0.973691374
28800 0.239801956 0.973931176
28900 0.236922689 0.974168099
Lambda-T Fb(Lambda-T)/Sigma-T^5 SIGMA
micron-R 1/(micron-R) dimensionless
x100,000
29000 0.234086142 0.974402185
29100 0.231291563 0.974633476
29200 0.228538218 0.974862015
29300 0.225825385 0.97508784
29400 0.223152357 0.975310992
29500 0.220518442 0.975531511
29600 0.217922962 0.975749434
29700 0.215365251 0.975964799
29800 0.212844659 0.976177644
29900 0.210360545 0.976388004
30000 0.207912285 0.976595916
30100 0.205499264 0.976801416
30200 0.20312088 0.977004537
30300 0.200776545 0.977205313
30400 0.198465679 0.977403779
30500 0.196187716 0.977599967
30600 0.1939421 0.977793909
30700 0.191728285 0.977985637
30800 0.189545739 0.978175183
30900 0.187393935 0.978362577
31000 0.185272361 0.978547849
31100 0.183180512 0.978731029
31200 0.181117894 0.978912147
31300 0.179084023 0.979091231
31400 0.177078421 0.97926831
31500 0.175100623 0.97944341
31600 0.173150172 0.979616561
31700 0.171226618 0.979787787
31800 0.16932952 0.979957117
31900 0.167458447 0.980124575
32000 0.165612974 0.980290188
32100 0.163792686 0.980453981
32200 0.161997174 0.980615978
32300 0.160226038 0.980776204
32400 0.158478884 0.980934683
32500 0.156755326 0.981091438
32600 0.155054987 0.981246493
32700 0.153377494 0.981399871
32800 0.151722482 0.981551593
32900 0.150089594 0.981701683
33000 0.148478478 0.981850161
33100 0.146888789 0.98199705
33200 0.145320188 0.98214237
33300 0.143772343 0.982286143
33400 0.142244927 0.982428388
33500 0.14073762 0.982569125
33600 0.139250107 0.982708375
33700 0.137782079 0.982846157
33800 0.136333232 0.982982491
33900 0.134903269 0.983117394
Lambda-T Fb(Lambda-T)/Sigma-T^5 SIGMA
micron-R 1/(micron-R) dimensionless
x100,000
34000 0.133491896 0.983250886
34100 0.132098827 0.983382985
34200 0.130723778 0.983513708
34300 0.129366474 0.983643075
34400 0.128026641 0.983771101
34500 0.126704012 0.983897805
34600 0.125398324 0.984023204
34700 0.124109319 0.984147313
34800 0.122836744 0.98427015
34900 0.121580348 0.98439173
35000 0.120339889 0.98451207
35100 0.119115124 0.984631185
35200 0.117905819 0.984749091
35300 0.11671174 0.984865803
35400 0.115532659 0.984981335
35500 0.114368353 0.985095704
35600 0.1132186 0.985208922
35700 0.112083185 0.985321006
35800 0.110961895 0.985431967
35900 0.10985452 0.985541822
36000 0.108760855 0.985650583
36100 0.107680698 0.985758264
36200 0.10661385 0.985864877
36300 0.105560116 0.985970438
36400 0.104519305 0.986074957
36500 0.103491227 0.986178448
36600 0.102475696 0.986280924
36700 0.101472532 0.986382396
36800 0.100481554 0.986482878
36900 0.099502586 0.98658238
37000 0.098535454 0.986680916
37100 0.097579989 0.986778496
37200 0.096636023 0.986875132
37300 0.095703391 0.986970835
37400 0.09478193 0.987065617
37500 0.093871482 0.987159489
37600 0.092971889 0.987252461
37700 0.092082998 0.987344544
37800 0.091204657 0.987435748
37900 0.090336717 0.987526085
38000 0.08947903 0.987615564
38100 0.088631454 0.987704195
38200 0.087793845 0.987791989
38300 0.086966064 0.987878955
38400 0.086147973 0.987965103
38500 0.085339438 0.988050443
38600 0.084540326 0.988134983
38700 0.083750505 0.988218734
38800 0.082969847 0.988301703
38900 0.082198226 0.988383902
Lambda-T Fb(Lambda-T)/Sigma-T^5 SIGMA
micron-R 1/(micron-R) dimensionless
x100,000
39000 0.081435515 0.988465337
39100 0.080681594 0.988546019
39200 0.079936341 0.988625955
39300 0.079199638 0.988705155
39400 0.078471367 0.988783626
39500 0.077751414 0.988861378
39600 0.077039664 0.988938417
39700 0.076336008 0.989014753
39800 0.075640335 0.989090394
39900 0.074952537 0.989165346
40000 0.074272508 0.989239619
40100 0.073600143 0.989313219
40200 0.07293534 0.989386154
40300 0.072277996 0.989458432
40400 0.071628013 0.98953006
40500 0.070985292 0.989601045
40600 0.070349736 0.989671395
40700 0.069721249 0.989741116
40800 0.069099739 0.989810216
40900 0.068485113 0.989878701
41000 0.067877279 0.989946578
41100 0.067276149 0.990013855
41200 0.066681634 0.990080536
41300 0.066093647 0.99014663
41400 0.065512104 0.990212142
41500 0.064936919 0.990277079
41600 0.06436801 0.990341447
41700 0.063805295 0.990405252
41800 0.063248693 0.990468501
41900 0.062698126 0.990531199
42000 0.062153516 0.990593353
42100 0.061614785 0.990654967
42200 0.061081858 0.990716049
42300 0.06055466 0.990776604
42400 0.060033118 0.990836637
42500 0.059517159 0.990896154
42600 0.059006713 0.990955161
42700 0.058501708 0.991013663
42800 0.058002076 0.991071665
42900 0.057507748 0.991129172
43000 0.057018658 0.991186191
43100 0.056534738 0.991242726
43200 0.056055925 0.991298782
43300 0.055582153 0.991354364
43400 0.055113359 0.991409477
43500 0.054649481 0.991464127
43600 0.054190457 0.991518317
43700 0.053736227 0.991572053
43800 0.053286731 0.99162534
43900 0.05284191 0.991678182
44000 0.052401706 0.991730584

You might also like